zshall man page on Alpinelinux

Man page or keyword search:  
man Server   18016 pages
apropos Keyword Search (all sections)
Output format
Alpinelinux logo
[printable version]

ZSHALL(1)							     ZSHALL(1)

NAME
       zshall - the Z shell meta-man page

OVERVIEW
       Because	zsh contains many features, the zsh manual has been split into
       a number of sections.  This manual page includes all the separate  man‐
       ual pages in the following order:

       zshroadmap   Informal introduction to the manual
       zshmisc	    Anything not fitting into the other sections
       zshexpn	    Zsh command and parameter expansion
       zshparam	    Zsh parameters
       zshoptions   Zsh options
       zshbuiltins  Zsh built-in functions
       zshzle	    Zsh command line editing
       zshcompwid   Zsh completion widgets
       zshcompsys   Zsh completion system
       zshcompctl   Zsh completion control
       zshmodules   Zsh loadable modules
       zshcalsys    Zsh built-in calendar functions
       zshtcpsys    Zsh built-in TCP functions
       zshzftpsys   Zsh built-in FTP client
       zshcontrib   Additional zsh functions and utilities

DESCRIPTION
       Zsh  is	a  UNIX	 command  interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive
       login shell and as a shell script command processor.  Of	 the  standard
       shells,	zsh most closely resembles ksh but includes many enhancements.
       Zsh has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable
       command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history mech‐
       anism, and a host of other features.

AUTHOR
       Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad <pf@zsh.org>.	  Zsh  is  now
       maintained  by  the  members of the zsh-workers mailing list <zsh-work‐
       ers@zsh.org>.   The  development	 is  currently	coordinated  by	 Peter
       Stephenson <pws@zsh.org>.  The coordinator can be contacted at <coordi‐
       nator@zsh.org>, but matters relating to the code should generally go to
       the mailing list.

AVAILABILITY
       Zsh  is available from the following anonymous FTP sites.  These mirror
       sites are kept frequently up to date.  The sites marked with (H) may be
       mirroring ftp.cs.elte.hu instead of the primary site.

       Primary site
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/

       Australia
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/
	      http://mirror.dejanseo.com.au/pub/zsh/

       Hungary
	      ftp://ftp.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/

	      The  up-to-date  source  code is available via anonymous CVS and
	      Git from Sourceforge.  See  http://sourceforge.net/projects/zsh/
	      for  details.  A summary of instructions for the CVS and Git ar‐
	      chives can be found at http://zsh.sourceforget.net/.

MAILING LISTS
       Zsh has 3 mailing lists:

       <zsh-announce@zsh.org>
	      Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the
	      monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)

       <zsh-users@zsh.org>
	      User discussions.

       <zsh-workers@zsh.org>
	      Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.

       To subscribe or unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative
       address for the mailing list.

       <zsh-announce-subscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-users-subscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-workers-subscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-announce-unsubscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-users-unsubscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-workers-unsubscribe@zsh.org>

       YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED.  All
       submissions  to	zsh-announce are automatically forwarded to zsh-users.
       All submissions to zsh-users are automatically forwarded	 to  zsh-work‐
       ers.

       If  you	have  problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing
       lists, send mail to <listmaster@zsh.org>.  The mailing lists are	 main‐
       tained by Karsten Thygesen <karthy@kom.auc.dk>.

       The  mailing  lists  are archived; the archives can be accessed via the
       administrative addresses listed above.  There is also a	hypertext  ar‐
       chive,	maintained   by	  Geoff	  Wing	 <gcw@zsh.org>,	 available  at
       http://www.zsh.org/mla/.

THE ZSH FAQ
       Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by Peter
       Stephenson  <pws@zsh.org>.   It	is  regularly  posted to the newsgroup
       comp.unix.shell and the zsh-announce mailing list.  The latest  version
       can    be    found   at	 any   of   the	  Zsh	FTP   sites,   or   at
       http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.	 The contact address for  FAQ-related  matters
       is <faqmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH WEB PAGE
       Zsh  has	 a  web page which is located at http://www.zsh.org/.  This is
       maintained by Karsten Thygesen <karthy@zsh.org>,	 of  SunSITE  Denmark.
       The contact address for web-related matters is <webmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH USERGUIDE
       A  userguide is currently in preparation.  It is intended to complement
       the manual, with explanations and hints on issues where the manual  can
       be cabbalistic, hierographic, or downright mystifying (for example, the
       word `hierographic' does not exist).  It can be viewed in  its  current
       state  at  http://zsh.sourceforge.net/Guide/.   At the time of writing,
       chapters dealing with startup files and their contents and the new com‐
       pletion system were essentially complete.

THE ZSH WIKI
       A  `wiki'  website for zsh has been created at http://www.zshwiki.org/.
       This is a site which can be added to and	 modified  directly  by	 users
       without any special permission.	You can add your own zsh tips and con‐
       figurations.

INVOCATION
       The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to deter‐
       mine where the shell will read commands from:

       -c     Take  the	 first	argument  as a command to execute, rather than
	      reading commands from a script or standard input.	 If  any  fur‐
	      ther  arguments  are  given,  the	 first	one is assigned to $0,
	      rather than being used as a positional parameter.

       -i     Force shell to be interactive.  It is still possible to  specify
	      a script to execute.

       -s     Force shell to read commands from the standard input.  If the -s
	      flag is not present and an argument is given, the first argument
	      is taken to be the pathname of a script to execute.

       If  there are any remaining arguments after option processing, and nei‐
       ther of the options -c or -s was supplied, the first argument is	 taken
       as  the file name of a script containing shell commands to be executed.
       If the option PATH_SCRIPT is set, and the file name does not contain  a
       directory  path	(i.e.  there is no `/' in the name), first the current
       directory and then the command path given  by  the  variable  PATH  are
       searched	 for  the  script.   If the option is not set or the file name
       contains a `/' it is used directly.

       After the  first	 one  or  two  arguments  have	been  appropriated  as
       described above, the remaining arguments are assigned to the positional
       parameters.

       For further options,  which  are	 common	 to  invocation	 and  the  set
       builtin, see zshoptions(1).

       Options	may  be specified by name using the -o option.	-o acts like a
       single-letter option, but takes a following string as the option	 name.
       For example,

	      zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr

       runs  the  script  scr,	setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding
       letter `-x' and the SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  by  name.   Options  may  be
       turned  off  by	name  by using +o instead of -o.  -o can be stacked up
       with preceding single-letter options, so for example `-xo  shwordsplit'
       or `-xoshwordsplit' is equivalent to `-x -o shwordsplit'.

       Options	may  also  be  specified  by  name  in	GNU long option style,
       `--option-name'.	 When this is done, `-' characters in the option  name
       are permitted: they are translated into `_', and thus ignored.  So, for
       example, `zsh  --sh-word-split'	invokes	 zsh  with  the	 SH_WORD_SPLIT
       option  turned  on.   Like other option syntaxes, options can be turned
       off by replacing the initial `-' with a `+'; thus `+-sh-word-split'  is
       equivalent  to  `--no-sh-word-split'.   Unlike  other  option syntaxes,
       GNU-style long options cannot be stacked with any other options, so for
       example	`-x-shwordsplit'  is  an error, rather than being treated like
       `-x --shwordsplit'.

       The special GNU-style option `--version' is handled; it sends to	 stan‐
       dard  output  the shell's version information, then exits successfully.
       `--help' is also handled; it sends to standard output a list of options
       that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits successfully.

       Option  processing  may	be finished, allowing following arguments that
       start with `-' or `+' to be treated as normal arguments, in  two	 ways.
       Firstly,	 a lone `-' (or `+') as an argument by itself ends option pro‐
       cessing.	 Secondly, a special option `--' (or `+-'), which may be spec‐
       ified  on its own (which is the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked
       with preceding options (so `-x-' is equivalent to  `-x  --').   Options
       are not permitted to be stacked after `--' (so `-x-f' is an error), but
       note the GNU-style option form discussed above,	where  `--shwordsplit'
       is permitted and does not end option processing.

       Except  when  the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect,
       the option `-b' (or `+b') ends option processing.  `-b' is  like	 `--',
       except that further single-letter options can be stacked after the `-b'
       and will take effect as normal.

COMPATIBILITY
       Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or ksh  respec‐
       tively;	more  precisely,  it  looks at the first letter of the name by
       which it was invoked, excluding any initial `r' (assumed to  stand  for
       `restricted'),  and  if	that  is `s' or `k' it will emulate sh or ksh.
       Furthermore, if invoked as su (which happens on	certain	 systems  when
       the shell is executed by the su command), the shell will try to find an
       alternative name from the SHELL environment variable and perform emula‐
       tion based on that.

       In sh and ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not spe‐
       cial and not initialized by the shell:  ARGC,  argv,  cdpath,  fignore,
       fpath,  HISTCHARS,  mailpath,  MANPATH,	manpath, path, prompt, PROMPT,
       PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status, watch.

       The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.	 Login	shells
       source /etc/profile followed by $HOME/.profile.	If the ENV environment
       variable is set on  invocation,	$ENV  is  sourced  after  the  profile
       scripts.	 The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion, command
       substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted	 as  a
       pathname.   Note	 that the PRIVILEGED option also affects the execution
       of startup files.

       The following options are set if the shell is invoked  as  sh  or  ksh:
       NO_BAD_PATTERN,	  NO_BANG_HIST,	   NO_BG_NICE,	 NO_EQUALS,   NO_FUNC‐
       TION_ARGZERO, GLOB_SUBST,  NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT,  NO_HUP,  INTERACTIVE_COM‐
       MENTS,  KSH_ARRAYS,  NO_MULTIOS, NO_NOMATCH, NO_NOTIFY, POSIX_BUILTINS,
       NO_PROMPT_PERCENT,    RM_STAR_SILENT,	SH_FILE_EXPANSION,    SH_GLOB,
       SH_OPTION_LETTERS,   SH_WORD_SPLIT.    Additionally  the	 BSD_ECHO  and
       IGNORE_BRACES options are set if zsh  is	 invoked  as  sh.   Also,  the
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT,  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  PROMPT_BANG,	PROMPT_SUBST  and SIN‐
       GLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.

RESTRICTED SHELL
       When the basename of the command used to invoke	zsh  starts  with  the
       letter  `r'  or the `-r' command line option is supplied at invocation,
       the shell becomes  restricted.	Emulation  mode	 is  determined	 after
       stripping  the  letter `r' from the invocation name.  The following are
       disabled in restricted mode:

       ·      changing directories with the cd builtin

       ·      changing or unsetting the PATH, path, MODULE_PATH,  module_path,
	      SHELL,  HISTFILE,	 HISTSIZE,  GID,  EGID,	 UID,  EUID, USERNAME,
	      LD_LIBRARY_PATH,	  LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,	    LD_PRELOAD	   and
	      LD_AOUT_PRELOAD parameters

       ·      specifying command names containing /

       ·      specifying command pathnames using hash

       ·      redirecting output to files

       ·      using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another
	      command

       ·      using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process' argument and envi‐
	      ronment space

       ·      using  the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external com‐
	      mands

       ·      turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED

       These restrictions are enforced after  processing  the  startup	files.
       The  startup  files  should set up PATH to point to a directory of com‐
       mands which can be safely invoked in the restricted environment.	  They
       may also add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.

       Restricted  mode	 can  also  be	activated  any	time  by  setting  the
       RESTRICTED option.   This  immediately  enables	all  the  restrictions
       described  above	 even if the shell still has not processed all startup
       files.

STARTUP/SHUTDOWN FILES
       Commands are first read from /etc/zshenv; this  cannot  be  overridden.
       Subsequent behaviour is modified by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options; the
       former affects all startup files, while the second only affects	global
       startup	files  (those  shown here with an path starting with a /).  If
       one of the options is  unset  at	 any  point,  any  subsequent  startup
       file(s)	of the corresponding type will not be read.  It is also possi‐
       ble for a file in  $ZDOTDIR  to	re-enable  GLOBAL_RCS.	Both  RCS  and
       GLOBAL_RCS are set by default.

       Commands	 are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv.  If the shell is a login
       shell, commands are read from /etc/zprofile  and	 then  $ZDOTDIR/.zpro‐
       file.   Then,  if  the  shell  is  interactive,	commands are read from
       /etc/zshrc and then $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc.  Finally, if the shell is a	 login
       shell, /etc/zlogin and $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.

       When  a	login  shell  exits,  the  files  $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout  and  then
       /etc/zlogout are read.  This happens with either an explicit  exit  via
       the exit or logout commands, or an implicit exit by reading end-of-file
       from the terminal.  However, if the shell terminates  due  to  exec'ing
       another	process,  the  logout  files  are  not	read.	These are also
       affected by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options.  Note  also	that  the  RCS
       option  affects	the saving of history files, i.e. if RCS is unset when
       the shell exits, no history file will be saved.

       If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead.  Files listed above as being
       in /etc may be in another directory, depending on the installation.

       As /etc/zshenv is run for all instances of zsh, it is important that it
       be kept as small as possible.  In particular, it is a good idea to  put
       code  that does not need to be run for every single shell behind a test
       of the form `if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...' so that it will not be executed
       when zsh is invoked with the `-f' option.

       Any  of	these files may be pre-compiled with the zcompile builtin com‐
       mand (see zshbuiltins(1)).  If a compiled file exists  (named  for  the
       original	 file plus the .zwc extension) and it is newer than the origi‐
       nal file, the compiled file will be used instead.

ZSHROADMAP(1)							 ZSHROADMAP(1)

NAME
       zshroadmap - informal introduction to the zsh manual

       The Zsh Manual, like the shell itself, is large and often  complicated.
       This section of the manual provides some pointers to areas of the shell
       that are likely to be of particular interest to new  users,  and	 indi‐
       cates where in the rest of the manual the documentation is to be found.

WHEN THE SHELL STARTS
       When it starts, the shell reads commands from various files.  These can
       be  created  or	edited	to  customize  the  shell.   See  the  section
       Startup/Shutdown Files in zsh(1).

       If no personal initialization files exist for the current user, a func‐
       tion is run to help you change some of the most	common	settings.   It
       won't appear if your administrator has disabled the zsh/newuser module.
       The function is designed to be self-explanatory.	 You  can  run	it  by
       hand  with  `autoload -Uz zsh-newuser-install; zsh-newuser-install -f'.
       See also the section User Configuration Functions in zshcontrib(1).

INTERACTIVE USE
       Interaction with the shell uses the builtin Zsh Line Editor, ZLE.  This
       is described in detail in zshzle(1).

       The  first  decision a user must make is whether to use the Emacs or Vi
       editing mode as the  keys  for  editing	are  substantially  different.
       Emacs  editing  mode  is probably more natural for beginners and can be
       selected explicitly with the command bindkey -e.

       A history mechanism for retrieving previously typed lines (most	simply
       with  the  Up or Down arrow keys) is available; note that, unlike other
       shells, zsh will not save these lines when the shell exits  unless  you
       set  appropriate variables, and the number of history lines retained by
       default is quite small (30 lines).  See the description	of  the	 shell
       variables  (referred  to	 in the documentation as parameters) HISTFILE,
       HISTSIZE and SAVEHIST in zshparam(1).

       The shell now supports the UTF-8 character set (and also others if sup‐
       ported  by  the	operating system).  This is (mostly) handled transpar‐
       ently by the shell, but the degree of support in terminal emulators  is
       variable.   There  is  some  discussion	of  this  in  the  shell  FAQ,
       http://zsh.dotsrc.org/FAQ/ .  Note in  particular  that	for  combining
       characters  to  be  handled the option COMBINING_CHARS needs to be set.
       Because the shell is now more sensitive to the definition of the	 char‐
       acter  set, note that if you are upgrading from an older version of the
       shell you should ensure that the appropriate variable, either LANG  (to
       affect  all  aspects  of	 the shell's operation) or LC_CTYPE (to affect
       only the handling of character sets) is set to  an  appropriate	value.
       This  is true even if you are using a single-byte character set includ‐
       ing extensions of ASCII such as ISO-8859-1  or  ISO-8859-15.   See  the
       description of LC_CTYPE in zshparam(1).

   Completion
       Completion  is  a feature present in many shells. It allows the user to
       type only a part (usually the prefix) of a word and have the shell fill
       in  the rest.  The completion system in zsh is programmable.  For exam‐
       ple, the shell can be set to complete email addresses in	 arguments  to
       the  mail command from your ~/.abook/addressbook; usernames, hostnames,
       and even remote paths in arguments to scp, and so  on.	Anything  that
       can  be written in or glued together with zsh can be the source of what
       the line editor offers as possible completions.

       Zsh has two completion systems, an old, so  called  compctl  completion
       (named  after  the builtin command that serves as its complete and only
       user interface), and a new one, referred to as  compsys,	 organized  as
       library	of builtin and user-defined functions.	The two systems differ
       in their interface for specifying the  completion  behavior.   The  new
       system  is  more customizable and is supplied with completions for many
       commonly used commands; it is therefore to be preferred.

       The completion system must be enabled explicitly when the shell starts.
       For more information see zshcompsys(1).

   Extending the line editor
       Apart from completion, the line editor is highly extensible by means of
       shell functions.	 Some useful functions are provided  with  the	shell;
       they provide facilities such as:

       insert-composed-char
	      composing characters not found on the keyboard

       match-words-by-style
	      configuring what the line editor considers a word when moving or
	      deleting by word

       history-beginning-search-backward-end, etc.
	      alternative ways of searching the shell history

       replace-string, replace-pattern
	      functions for replacing strings or patterns globally in the com‐
	      mand line

       edit-command-line
	      edit the command line with an external editor.

       See  the	 section  `ZLE Functions' in zshcontrib(1) for descriptions of
       these.

OPTIONS
       The shell has a large number of options	for  changing  its  behaviour.
       These  cover  all aspects of the shell; browsing the full documentation
       is the only good way to become acquainted with the many	possibilities.
       See zshoptions(1).

PATTERN MATCHING
       The  shell  has	a  rich	 set  of patterns which are available for file
       matching (described in the documentation as `filename  generation'  and
       also  known for historical reasons as `globbing') and for use when pro‐
       gramming.  These are described in the section `Filename Generation'  in
       zshexpn(1).

       Of particular interest are the following patterns that are not commonly
       supported by other systems of pattern matching:

       **     for matching over multiple directories

       ~, ^   the  ability  to	exclude	 patterns  from	 matching   when   the
	      EXTENDED_GLOB option is set

       (...)  glob  qualifiers, included in parentheses at the end of the pat‐
	      tern, which select  files	 by  type  (such  as  directories)  or
	      attribute (such as size).

GENERAL COMMENTS ON SYNTAX
       Although	 the  syntax  of zsh is in ways similar to the Korn shell, and
       therefore more remotely to the original UNIX shell, the	Bourne	shell,
       its  default  behaviour	does  not entirely correspond to those shells.
       General shell syntax is introduced in the section  `Shell  Grammar'  in
       zshmisc(1).

       One  commonly encountered difference is that variables substituted onto
       the command line are not split into words.  See the description of  the
       shell option SH_WORD_SPLIT in the section `Parameter Expansion' in zsh‐
       expn(1).	 In zsh, you can either explicitly request the splitting (e.g.
       ${=foo})	 or  use  an  array when you want a variable to expand to more
       than one word.  See the section `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).

PROGRAMMING
       The most convenient way of adding enhancements to the  shell  is	 typi‐
       cally  by  writing  a  shell  function  and  arranging  for  it	to  be
       autoloaded.  Functions are described in the section `Functions' in zsh‐
       misc(1).	  Users	 changing  from	 the  C shell and its relatives should
       notice that aliases are less used in zsh as they don't perform argument
       substitution, only simple text replacement.

       A few general functions, other than those for the line editor described
       above, are provided with the shell and are described in	zshcontrib(1).
       Features include:

       promptinit
	      a	 prompt theme system for changing prompts easily, see the sec‐
	      tion `Prompt Themes'

       zsh-mime-setup
	      a MIME-handling system which dispatches  commands	 according  to
	      the suffix of a file as done by graphical file managers

       zcalc  a calculator

       zargs  a version of xargs that makes the find command redundant

       zmv    a command for renaming files by means of shell patterns.

ZSHMISC(1)							    ZSHMISC(1)

NAME
       zshmisc - everything and then some

SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES
       A  simple  command is a sequence of optional parameter assignments fol‐
       lowed by	 blank-separated  words,  with	optional  redirections	inter‐
       spersed.	 The first word is the command to be executed, and the remain‐
       ing words, if any, are arguments to the command.	 If a command name  is
       given,  the parameter assignments modify the environment of the command
       when it is executed.  The value of a simple command is its exit status,
       or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.	 For example,

	      echo foo

       is a simple command with arguments.

       A  pipeline  is	either	a simple command, or a sequence of two or more
       simple commands where each command is separated from the next by `|' or
       `|&'.   Where commands are separated by `|', the standard output of the
       first command is connected to the standard input of the next.  `|&'  is
       shorthand for `2>&1 |', which connects both the standard output and the
       standard error of the command to the standard input of the  next.   The
       value  of a pipeline is the value of the last command, unless the pipe‐
       line is preceded by `!' in which case the value is the logical  inverse
       of the value of the last command.  For example,

	      echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'

       is  a  pipeline,	 where	the output (`foo' plus a newline) of the first
       command will be passed to the input of the second.

       If a pipeline is preceded by `coproc', it is executed as a coprocess; a
       two-way pipe is established between it and the parent shell.  The shell
       can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the `>&p' and `<&p'
       redirection  operators  or  with	 `print -p' and `read -p'.  A pipeline
       cannot be preceded by both `coproc' and `!'.  If job control is active,
       the coprocess can be treated in other than input and output as an ordi‐
       nary background job.

       A sublist is either a single pipeline, or a sequence  of	 two  or  more
       pipelines separated by `&&' or `||'.  If two pipelines are separated by
       `&&', the second pipeline  is  executed	only  if  the  first  succeeds
       (returns	 a  zero status).  If two pipelines are separated by `||', the
       second is executed only if the first fails (returns a nonzero  status).
       Both  operators	have  equal  precedence and are left associative.  The
       value of the sublist is the value of the last pipeline  executed.   For
       example,

	      dmesg | grep panic && print yes

       is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple com‐
       mand which will be executed if and only if the grep command  returns  a
       zero  status.   If it does not, the value of the sublist is that return
       status, else it is the status returned by the print  (almost  certainly
       zero).

       A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is
       terminated by `;', `&', `&|', `&!', or a newline.  This terminator  may
       optionally  be  omitted from the last sublist in the list when the list
       appears as a complex command inside `(...)' or `{...}'.	When a sublist
       is  terminated  by  `;'	or  newline,  the shell waits for it to finish
       before executing the next sublist.  If a sublist	 is  terminated	 by  a
       `&',  `&|',  or `&!', the shell executes the last pipeline in it in the
       background, and does not wait for it to	finish	(note  the  difference
       from  other  shells which execute the whole sublist in the background).
       A backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.

       More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell commands what‐
       soever,	including the complex commands below; this is implied wherever
       the word `list' appears in later descriptions.  For example,  the  com‐
       mands in a shell function form a special sort of list.

PRECOMMAND MODIFIERS
       A  simple  command may be preceded by a precommand modifier, which will
       alter how the  command  is  interpreted.	  These	 modifiers  are	 shell
       builtin	commands  with	the exception of nocorrect which is a reserved
       word.

       -      The command is executed with a  `-'  prepended  to  its  argv[0]
	      string.

       builtin
	      The  command  word is taken to be the name of a builtin command,
	      rather than a shell function or external command.

       command [ -pvV ]
	      The command word is taken to be the name of an external command,
	      rather than a shell function or builtin.	 If the POSIX_BUILTINS
	      option is set, builtins will also be executed but	 certain  spe‐
	      cial  properties	of  them  are suppressed. The -p flag causes a
	      default path to be searched instead of that in $path.  With  the
	      -v flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equiva‐
	      lent to whence -v.

       exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ]
	      The following command together with  any	arguments  is  run  in
	      place of the current process, rather than as a sub-process.  The
	      shell does not fork and is replaced.  The shell does not	invoke
	      TRAPEXIT,	 nor  does  it	source zlogout files.  The options are
	      provided for compatibility with other shells.

	      The -c option clears the environment.

	      The -l option is equivalent to the  -  precommand	 modifier,  to
	      treat  the  replacement command as a login shell; the command is
	      executed with a - prepended to its argv[0]  string.   This  flag
	      has no effect if used together with the -a option.

	      The  -a  option is used to specify explicitly the argv[0] string
	      (the name of the command as seen by the process  itself)	to  be
	      used  by	the  replacement command and is directly equivalent to
	      setting a value for the ARGV0 environment variable.

       nocorrect
	      Spelling correction is not done on any of the words.  This  must
	      appear  before  any  other  precommand modifier, as it is inter‐
	      preted immediately, before any  parsing  is  done.   It  has  no
	      effect in non-interactive shells.

       noglob Filename	generation  (globbing)	is not performed on any of the
	      words.

COMPLEX COMMANDS
       A complex command in zsh is one of the following:

       if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi
	      The if list is executed, and if it returns a zero	 exit  status,
	      the then list is executed.  Otherwise, the elif list is executed
	      and if its status is zero, the then list is executed.   If  each
	      elif list returns nonzero status, the else list is executed.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term do list done
	      where  term  is  at  least one newline or ;.  Expand the list of
	      words, and set the parameter name to each of them in turn,  exe‐
	      cuting list each time.  If the in word is omitted, use the posi‐
	      tional parameters instead of the words.

	      More than one parameter name  can	 appear	 before	 the  list  of
	      words.  If N names are given, then on each execution of the loop
	      the next N words are assigned to the  corresponding  parameters.
	      If  there	 are  more  names  than remaining words, the remaining
	      parameters are each set to the empty string.  Execution  of  the
	      loop ends when there is no remaining word to assign to the first
	      name.  It is only possible for in to appear as the first name in
	      the  list,  else	it  will  be treated as marking the end of the
	      list.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) do list done
	      The arithmetic expression expr1 is evaluated first (see the sec‐
	      tion  `Arithmetic Evaluation').  The arithmetic expression expr2
	      is repeatedly evaluated until it	evaluates  to  zero  and  when
	      non-zero,	 list  is executed and the arithmetic expression expr3
	      evaluated.  If any expression is omitted, then it behaves as  if
	      it evaluated to 1.

       while list do list done
	      Execute  the  do	list  as long as the while list returns a zero
	      exit status.

       until list do list done
	      Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit
	      status.

       repeat word do list done
	      word  is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression, which
	      must evaluate to a number n.  list is then executed n times.

	      The repeat syntax is disabled by default when the	 shell	starts
	      in  a  mode emulating another shell.  It can be enabled with the
	      command `enable -r repeat'

       case word in [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list  (;;|;&|;|)	]  ...
       esac
	      Execute  the list associated with the first pattern that matches
	      word, if any.  The form of the patterns is the same as that used
	      for filename generation.	See the section `Filename Generation'.

	      If  the  list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than
	      ;;, the following list is also executed.	The rule for the  ter‐
	      minator of the following list ;;, ;& or ;| is applied unless the
	      esac is reached.

	      If the list that is executed is terminated  with	;|  the	 shell
	      continues	 to scan the patterns looking for the next match, exe‐
	      cuting the corresponding list, and applying  the	rule  for  the
	      corresponding  terminator	 ;;,  ;& or ;|.	 Note that word is not
	      re-expanded; all applicable patterns are tested  with  the  same
	      word.

       select name [ in word ... term ] do list done
	      where  term  is one or more newline or ; to terminate the words.
	      Print the set of words, each preceded by a number.   If  the  in
	      word  is	omitted,  use  the positional parameters.  The PROMPT3
	      prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor if the
	      shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard input.
	      If this line consists of the number of one of the listed	words,
	      then the parameter name is set to the word corresponding to this
	      number.  If this line is empty, the selection  list  is  printed
	      again.   Otherwise,  the	value  of the parameter name is set to
	      null.  The contents of the line  read  from  standard  input  is
	      saved  in the parameter REPLY.  list is executed for each selec‐
	      tion until a break or end-of-file is encountered.

       ( list )
	      Execute list in a subshell.  Traps set by the trap  builtin  are
	      reset to their default values while executing list.

       { list }
	      Execute list.

       { try-list } always { always-list }
	      First  execute  try-list.	  Regardless of errors, or break, con‐
	      tinue, or return commands encountered within  try-list,  execute
	      always-list.   Execution	then  continues from the result of the
	      execution of try-list; in other words, any error, or break, con‐
	      tinue,  or  return  command  is treated in the normal way, as if
	      always-list were not  present.   The  two	 chunks	 of  code  are
	      referred to as the `try block' and the `always block'.

	      Optional	newlines  or  semicolons  may appear after the always;
	      note, however, that they may not appear  between	the  preceding
	      closing brace and the always.

	      An `error' in this context is a condition such as a syntax error
	      which causes the shell to abort execution of the	current	 func‐
	      tion,  script,  or  list.	  Syntax  errors encountered while the
	      shell is parsing the code do not cause  the  always-list	to  be
	      executed.	  For  example, an erroneously constructed if block in
	      try-list would cause the shell to abort during parsing, so  that
	      always-list  would not be executed, while an erroneous substitu‐
	      tion such as ${*foo*} would cause a run-time error, after	 which
	      always-list would be executed.

	      An  error	 condition  can	 be  tested and reset with the special
	      integer variable TRY_BLOCK_ERROR.	 Outside  an  always-list  the
	      value  is	 irrelevant,  but  it  is  initialised	to -1.	Inside
	      always-list, the	value  is  1  if  an  error  occurred  in  the
	      try-list,	 else  0.   If	TRY_BLOCK_ERROR is set to 0 during the
	      always-list, the error  condition	 caused	 by  the  try-list  is
	      reset,  and  shell execution continues normally after the end of
	      always-list.  Altering the value during the try-list is not use‐
	      ful (unless this forms part of an enclosing always block).

	      Regardless  of TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, after the end of always-list the
	      normal shell status $? is the value returned  from  always-list.
	      This   will   be	non-zero  if  there  was  an  error,  even  if
	      TRY_BLOCK_ERROR was set to zero.

	      The following executes the given code, ignoring  any  errors  it
	      causes.	This is an alternative to the usual convention of pro‐
	      tecting code by executing it in a subshell.

		     {
			 # code which may cause an error
		       } always {
			 # This code is executed regardless of the error.
			 (( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
		     }
		     # The error condition has been reset.

	      An exit command (or a return command executed at	the  outermost
	      function	level  of  a  script) encountered in try-list does not
	      cause the execution of always-list.  Instead,  the  shell	 exits
	      immediately after any EXIT trap has been executed.

       function word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] command
	      where term is one or more newline or ;.  Define a function which
	      is referenced by any one of word.	 Normally, only	 one  word  is
	      provided;	 multiple  words  are  usually only useful for setting
	      traps.  The body of the function is the list between the	{  and
	      }.  See the section `Functions'.

	      If  the  option  SH_GLOB	is  set	 for  compatibility with other
	      shells, then whitespace may appear between between the left  and
	      right  parentheses  when there is a single word;	otherwise, the
	      parentheses will be treated as forming  a	 globbing  pattern  in
	      that case.

       time [ pipeline ]
	      The  pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported on
	      the standard error in the form specified by the TIMEFMT  parame‐
	      ter.   If	 pipeline is omitted, print statistics about the shell
	      process and its children.

       [[ exp ]]
	      Evaluates the conditional expression exp and return a zero  exit
	      status if it is true.  See the section `Conditional Expressions'
	      for a description of exp.

ALTERNATE FORMS FOR COMPLEX COMMANDS
       Many of	zsh's  complex	commands  have	alternate  forms.   These  are
       non-standard  and  are  likely not to be obvious even to seasoned shell
       programmers; they should not be used anywhere that portability of shell
       code is a concern.

       The short versions below only work if sublist is of the form `{ list }'
       or if the SHORT_LOOPS option is set.  For the if, while and until  com‐
       mands, in both these cases the test part of the loop must also be suit‐
       ably delimited, such as by `[[ ... ]]' or `(( ... ))', else the end  of
       the  test will not be recognized.  For the for, repeat, case and select
       commands no such special form for the arguments is necessary,  but  the
       other  condition (the special form of sublist or use of the SHORT_LOOPS
       option) still applies.

       if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
	      An alternate form of if.	The rules mean that

		     if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
		       print yes
		     }

	      works, but

		     if true {	# Does not work!
		       print yes
		     }

	      does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.

       if list sublist
	      A short form of the alternate `if'.  The same limitations on the
	      form of list apply as for the previous form.

       for name ... ( word ... ) sublist
	      A short form of for.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term sublist
	      where  term is at least one newline or ;.	 Another short form of
	      for.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) sublist
	      A short form of the arithmetic for command.

       foreach name ... ( word ... ) list end
	      Another form of for.

       while list { list }
	      An alternative form of while.  Note the limitations on the  form
	      of list mentioned above.

       until list { list }
	      An  alternative form of until.  Note the limitations on the form
	      of list mentioned above.

       repeat word sublist
	      This is a short form of repeat.

       case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... }
	      An alternative form of case.

       select name [ in word term ] sublist
	      where term is at least one  newline  or  ;.   A  short  form  of
	      select.

RESERVED WORDS
       The  following  words are recognized as reserved words when used as the
       first word of a command unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:

       do done esac then elif else fi for case if while function  repeat  time
       until select coproc nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { }

       Additionally,  `}'  is  recognized  in  any  position  if  neither  the
       IGNORE_BRACES option nor the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option is set.

ERRORS
       Certain errors are treated as fatal by the  shell:  in  an  interactive
       shell,  they  cause  control  to	 return	 to the command line, and in a
       non-interactive shell they cause the shell to  be  aborted.   In	 older
       versions	 of  zsh,  a  non-interactive shell running a script would not
       abort completely, but would resume execution at the next command to  be
       read  from the script, skipping the remainder of any functions or shell
       constructs such as loops or conditions; this somewhat illogical	behav‐
       iour can be recovered by setting the option CONTINUE_ON_ERROR.

       Fatal errors found in non-interactive shells include:
       Failure to parse shell options passed when invoking the shell
       Failure to change options with the set builtin
       Parse errors of all sorts, including failures to parse
	      mathematical expressions
       Failures to set or modify variable behaviour with typeset,
	      local, declare, export, integer, float
       Execution of incorrectly positioned loop control structures
	      (continue, break)
       Attempts to use regular expression with no regular expression
	      module available
       Disallowed operations when the RESTRICTED options is set
       Failure to create a pipe needed for a pipeline
       Failure to create a multio
       Failure to autoload a module needed for a declared shell feature
       Errors creating command or process substitutions
       Syntax errors in glob qualifiers
       File generation errors where not caught by the option BAD_PATTERN
       All bad patterns used for matching within case statements
       File generation failures where not caused by NO_MATCH or
       All file generation errors where the pattern was used to create a
	      multio
       Memory errors where detected by the shell
       Invalid subscripts to shell variables
       Attempts to assign read-only variables
       Logical errors with variables such as assignment to the wrong type
       Use of invalid variable names
       Errors in variable substitution syntax
       Failure to convert characters in $'...' expressions
	      similar options

       If  the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, more errors associated with shell
       builtin commands are treated as fatal, as specified by the POSIX	 stan‐
       dard.

COMMENTS
       In  non-interactive  shells, or in interactive shells with the INTERAC‐
       TIVE_COMMENTS option set, a word beginning with the third character  of
       the  histchars  parameter (`#' by default) causes that word and all the
       following characters up to a newline to be ignored.

ALIASING
       Every token in the shell input is checked to see if there is  an	 alias
       defined	for  it.  If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias if it
       is in command position (if it could be the first word of a simple  com‐
       mand),  or  if the alias is global.  If the text ends with a space, the
       next word in the shell input is treated as though it  were  in  command
       position	 for  purposes	of alias expansion.  An alias is defined using
       the alias builtin; global aliases may be defined using the -g option to
       that builtin.

       Alias  expansion	 is done on the shell input before any other expansion
       except history expansion.  Therefore, if an alias is  defined  for  the
       word  foo,  alias expansion may be avoided by quoting part of the word,
       e.g. \foo.  Any form of quoting works, although	there  is  nothing  to
       prevent	an  alias  being  defined  for the quoted form such as \foo as
       well.  For use with completion, which would remove an initial backslash
       followed	 by  a character that isn't special, it may be more convenient
       to quote the word by starting with a single quote, i.e.	'foo;  comple‐
       tion will automatically add the trailing single quote.

       There is a commonly encountered problem with aliases illustrated by the
       following code:

	      alias echobar='echo bar'; echobar

       This prints a message that the command  echobar	could  not  be	found.
       This happens because aliases are expanded when the code is read in; the
       entire line is read in one go, so that when echobar is executed	it  is
       too late to expand the newly defined alias.  This is often a problem in
       shell scripts, functions, and code executed with `source' or `.'.  Con‐
       sequently,  use	of  functions  rather  than  aliases is recommended in
       non-interactive code.

       Note also the unhelpful interaction of  aliases	and  function  defini‐
       tions:

	      alias func='noglob func'
	      func() {
		  echo Do something with $*
	      }

       Because	aliases	 are expanded in function definitions, this causes the
       following command to be executed:

	      noglob func() {
		  echo Do something with $*
	      }

       which defines noglob as well as func as functions with the body	given.
       To  avoid this, either quote the name func or use the alternative func‐
       tion definition form `function func'.  Ensuring the  alias  is  defined
       after  the function works but is problematic if the code fragment might
       be re-executed.

QUOTING
       A character may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself)  by  pre‐
       ceding it with a `\'.  `\' followed by a newline is ignored.

       A string enclosed between `$'' and `'' is processed the same way as the
       string arguments of the print builtin, and the resulting string is con‐
       sidered to be entirely quoted.  A literal `'' character can be included
       in the string by using the `\'' escape.

       All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes	('')  that  is
       not  preceded by a `$' are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear within
       single quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES is set, in which case a  pair
       of single quotes are turned into a single quote.	 For example,

	      print ''''

       outputs	nothing	 apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set, but one
       single quote if it is set.

       Inside double quotes (""), parameter and	 command  substitution	occur,
       and `\' quotes the characters `\', ``', `"', and `$'.

REDIRECTION
       If  a  command is followed by & and job control is not active, then the
       default standard input for the command is  the  empty  file  /dev/null.
       Otherwise,  the environment for the execution of a command contains the
       file descriptors of the invoking	 shell	as  modified  by  input/output
       specifications.

       The following may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or
       follow a complex command.  Expansion occurs before  word	 or  digit  is
       used except as noted below.  If the result of substitution on word pro‐
       duces more than one filename,  redirection  occurs  for	each  separate
       filename in turn.

       < word Open file word for reading as standard input.

       <> word
	      Open  file  word	for reading and writing as standard input.  If
	      the file does not exist then it is created.

       > word Open file word for writing as standard output.  If the file does
	      not exist then it is created.  If the file exists, and the CLOB‐
	      BER option is unset, this causes	an  error;  otherwise,	it  is
	      truncated to zero length.

       >| word
       >! word
	      Same  as	>, except that the file is truncated to zero length if
	      it exists, even if CLOBBER is unset.

       >> word
	      Open file word for writing in append mode	 as  standard  output.
	      If  the  file  does  not exist, and the CLOBBER option is unset,
	      this causes an error; otherwise, the file is created.

       >>| word
       >>! word
	      Same as >>, except that the file	is  created  if	 it  does  not
	      exist, even if CLOBBER is unset.

       <<[-] word
	      The  shell  input is read up to a line that is the same as word,
	      or to an end-of-file.  No parameter expansion, command substitu‐
	      tion or filename generation is performed on word.	 The resulting
	      document, called a here-document, becomes the standard input.

	      If any character of word is quoted with single or double	quotes
	      or a `\', no interpretation is placed upon the characters of the
	      document.	 Otherwise, parameter and command substitution occurs,
	      `\'  followed  by	 a newline is removed, and `\' must be used to
	      quote the characters `\', `$', ``' and the  first	 character  of
	      word.

	      Note  that  word itself does not undergo shell expansion.	 Back‐
	      quotes in word do not have  their	 usual	effect;	 instead  they
	      behave  similarly	 to  double quotes, except that the backquotes
	      themselves are passed through unchanged.	(This  information  is
	      given for completeness and it is not recommended that backquotes
	      be used.)	 Quotes in the form $'...' have their standard	effect
	      of expanding backslashed references to special characters.

	      If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and
	      from the document.

       <<< word
	      Perform shell expansion on word and pass the result to  standard
	      input.  This is known as a here-string.  Compare the use of word
	      in here-documents above,	where  word  does  not	undergo	 shell
	      expansion.

       <& number
       >& number
	      The  standard  input/output  is  duplicated from file descriptor
	      number (see dup2(2)).

       <& -
       >& -   Close the standard input/output.

       <& p
       >& p   The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the  standard
	      input/output.

       >& word
       &> word
	      (Except  where `>& word' matches one of the above syntaxes; `&>'
	      can always be used to avoid  this	 ambiguity.)   Redirects  both
	      standard	output	and  standard error (file descriptor 2) in the
	      manner of `> word'.  Note that  this  does  not  have  the  same
	      effect as `> word 2>&1' in the presence of multios (see the sec‐
	      tion below).

       >&| word
       >&! word
       &>| word
       &>! word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>| word'.

       >>& word
       &>> word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>> word'.

       >>&| word
       >>&! word
       &>>| word
       &>>! word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>>| word'.

       If  one	of  the above is preceded by a digit, then the file descriptor
       referred to is that specified by the digit instead of the default 0  or
       1.   The order in which redirections are specified is significant.  The
       shell evaluates each redirection in  terms  of  the  (file  descriptor,
       file) association at the time of evaluation.  For example:

	      ... 1>fname 2>&1

       first associates file descriptor 1 with file fname.  It then associates
       file descriptor 2 with the file associated with file descriptor 1 (that
       is,  fname).  If the order of redirections were reversed, file descrip‐
       tor 2 would be associated with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1
       had  been)  and	then  file  descriptor 1 would be associated with file
       fname.

       The `|&' command separator described in Simple Commands & Pipelines  in
       zshmisc(1) is a shorthand for `2>&1 |'.

       The  various  forms of process substitution, `<(list)', and `=(list())'
       for input and `>(list)' for output, are often used together with	 redi‐
       rection.	  For example, if word in an output redirection is of the form
       `>(list)' then the output is piped to the command represented by	 list.
       See Process Substitution in zshexpn(1).

OPENING FILE DESCRIPTORS USING PARAMETERS
       When  the shell is parsing arguments to a command, and the shell option
       IGNORE_BRACES is not set, a different form of redirection  is  allowed:
       instead	of  a digit before the operator there is a valid shell identi‐
       fier enclosed in braces.	 The shell will open  a	 new  file  descriptor
       that is guaranteed to be at least 10 and set the parameter named by the
       identifier to the file descriptor opened.   No  whitespace  is  allowed
       between the closing brace and the redirection character.	 For example:

	      ... {myfd}>&1

       This opens a new file descriptor that is a duplicate of file descriptor
       1 and sets the parameter myfd to the number  of	the  file  descriptor,
       which  will  be at least 10.  The new file descriptor can be written to
       using the syntax >&$myfd.

       The syntax {varid}>&-, for example {myfd}>&-, may be used  to  close  a
       file  descriptor opened in this fashion.	 Note that the parameter given
       by varid must previously be set to a file descriptor in this case.

       It is an error to open or close a file descriptor in this fashion  when
       the  parameter  is  readonly.   However,	 it is not an error to read or
       write a file descriptor using <&$param or >&$param if  param  is	 read‐
       only.

       If  the option CLOBBER is unset, it is an error to open a file descrip‐
       tor using a parameter that is already set to an	open  file  descriptor
       previously allocated by this mechanism.	Unsetting the parameter before
       using it for allocating a file descriptor avoids the error.

       Note that this mechanism merely allocates or closes a file  descriptor;
       it does not perform any redirections from or to it.  It is usually con‐
       venient to allocate a file descriptor prior to use as  an  argument  to
       exec.   The  syntax  does not in any case work when used around complex
       commands such as parenthesised subshells or loops,  where  the  opening
       brace  is  interpreted  as part of a command list to be executed in the
       current shell.

       The following shows a typical sequence of allocation, use, and  closing
       of a file descriptor:

	      integer myfd
	      exec {myfd}>~/logs/mylogfile.txt
	      print This is a log message. >&$myfd
	      exec {myfd}>&-

       Note  that  the	expansion  of  the  variable in the expression >&$myfd
       occurs at the point the redirection  is	opened.	  This	is  after  the
       expansion  of  command arguments and after any redirections to the left
       on the command line have been processed.

MULTIOS
       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,
       the  shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
       its input to all the specified outputs, similar to  tee,	 provided  the
       MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default.  Thus:

	      date >foo >bar

       writes  the date to two files, named `foo' and `bar'.  Note that a pipe
       is an implicit redirection; thus

	      date >foo | cat

       writes the date to the file `foo', and also pipes it to cat.

       If the MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator  is
       also subjected to filename generation (globbing).  Thus

	      : > *

       will  truncate  all files in the current directory, assuming there's at
       least one.  (Without the MULTIOS option, it would create an empty  file
       called `*'.)  Similarly, you can do

	      echo exit 0 >> *.sh

       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,
       the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that	copies
       all  the specified inputs to its output in the order specified, similar
       to cat, provided the MULTIOS option is set.  Thus

	      sort <foo <fubar

       or even

	      sort <f{oo,ubar}

       is equivalent to `cat foo fubar | sort'.

       Expansion of the redirection argument occurs at the point the redirect‐
       ion  is	opened,	 at the point described above for the expansion of the
       variable in >&$myfd.

       Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

	      cat bar | sort <foo

       is equivalent to `cat bar foo | sort' (note the order of the inputs).

       If the MULTIOS option is unset, each redirection replaces the  previous
       redirection for that file descriptor.  However, all files redirected to
       are actually opened, so

	      echo foo > bar > baz

       when MULTIOS is unset will truncate bar, and write `foo' into baz.

       There is a problem when an output multio is  attached  to  an  external
       program.	 A simple example shows this:

	      cat file >file1 >file2
	      cat file1 file2

       Here,  it  is  possible that the second `cat' will not display the full
       contents of file1  and  file2  (i.e.  the  original  contents  of  file
       repeated twice).

       The  reason  for	 this  is  that	 the multios are spawned after the cat
       process is forked from the parent shell, so the parent shell  does  not
       wait for the multios to finish writing data.  This means the command as
       shown can exit before file1 and file2 are  completely  written.	 As  a
       workaround,  it	is possible to run the cat process as part of a job in
       the current shell:

	      { cat file } >file >file2

       Here, the {...} job will pause to wait for both files to be written.

REDIRECTIONS WITH NO COMMAND
       When a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators and
       zero or more parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave
       in several ways.

       If the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD  is  set,
       an error is caused.  This is the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by
       default when emulating csh.

       If the option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin `:' is inserted as a  com‐
       mand  with  the given redirections.  This is the default when emulating
       sh or ksh.

       Otherwise, if the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a
       command	with  the given redirections.  If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD
       are set, then the value of the latter will be used instead of  that  of
       the  former  when the redirection is an input.  The default for NULLCMD
       is `cat' and for READNULLCMD is `more'. Thus

	      < file

       shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a
       terminal.  NULLCMD and READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.

COMMAND EXECUTION
       If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it.
       If there exists a shell function by that name, the function is  invoked
       as  described  in  the  section	`Functions'.   If there exists a shell
       builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.

       Otherwise, the shell searches each element of  $path  for  a  directory
       containing  an  executable  file by that name.  If the search is unsuc‐
       cessful, the shell prints an error message and returns a	 nonzero  exit
       status.

       If  execution  fails  because the file is not in executable format, and
       the file is not a directory, it	is  assumed  to	 be  a	shell  script.
       /bin/sh	is  spawned to execute it.  If the program is a file beginning
       with `#!', the remainder of the first line specifies an interpreter for
       the program.  The shell will execute the specified interpreter on oper‐
       ating systems that do not handle this executable format in the kernel.

       If no external command is found but a  function	command_not_found_han‐
       dler  exists  the  shell	 executes  this function with all command line
       arguments.  The function should return status zero if  it  successfully
       handled	the  command,  or non-zero status if it failed.	 In the latter
       case the standard handling is applied: `command not found'  is  printed
       to  standard  error and the shell exits with status 127.	 Note that the
       handler is executed in a subshell forked to execute  an	external  com‐
       mand,  hence  changes  to  directories,	shell parameters, etc. have no
       effect on the main shell.

FUNCTIONS
       Shell functions are defined with the function reserved word or the spe‐
       cial  syntax  `funcname	()'.   Shell  functions are read in and stored
       internally.  Alias names are resolved when the function is read.	 Func‐
       tions  are  executed  like  commands with the arguments passed as posi‐
       tional parameters.  (See the section `Command Execution'.)

       Functions execute in the same process as the caller and share all files
       and  present  working  directory	 with  the caller.  A trap on EXIT set
       inside a function is executed after the function completes in the envi‐
       ronment of the caller.

       The return builtin is used to return from function calls.

       Function	 identifiers  can be listed with the functions builtin.	 Func‐
       tions can be undefined with the unfunction builtin.

AUTOLOADING FUNCTIONS
       A function can be marked as undefined using the	autoload  builtin  (or
       `functions  -u'	or `typeset -fu').  Such a function has no body.  When
       the function is first executed, the shell searches for  its  definition
       using the elements of the fpath variable.  Thus to define functions for
       autoloading, a typical sequence is:

	      fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
	      autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...

       The usual alias expansion during reading	 will  be  suppressed  if  the
       autoload builtin or its equivalent is given the option -U. This is rec‐
       ommended for the use of functions supplied with the  zsh	 distribution.
       Note  that  for functions precompiled with the zcompile builtin command
       the flag -U must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as the cor‐
       responding information is compiled into the latter.

       For  each  element  in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files,
       the newest of which is used to load the definition for the function:

       element.zwc
	      A file created with  the	zcompile  builtin  command,  which  is
	      expected	to  contain  the  definitions for all functions in the
	      directory named element.	The file is treated in the same manner
	      as  a  directory	containing files for functions and is searched
	      for the definition of the function.   If the definition  is  not
	      found,  the  search for a definition proceeds with the other two
	      possibilities described below.

	      If element already includes a .zwc extension (i.e. the extension
	      was  explicitly  given by the user), element is searched for the
	      definition of the function without comparing its age to that  of
	      other  files;  in	 fact, there does not need to be any directory
	      named element without the suffix.	  Thus	including  an  element
	      such as `/usr/local/funcs.zwc' in fpath will speed up the search
	      for functions, with the  disadvantage  that  functions  included
	      must  be	explicitly recompiled by hand before the shell notices
	      any changes.

       element/function.zwc
	      A file created with zcompile, which is expected to  contain  the
	      definition  for function.	 It may include other function defini‐
	      tions as well, but those are neither loaded nor executed; a file
	      found  in	 this way is searched only for the definition of func‐
	      tion.

       element/function
	      A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for func‐
	      tion.

       In  summary, the order of searching is, first, in the parents of direc‐
       tories in fpath for the newer of	 either	 a  compiled  directory	 or  a
       directory  in fpath; second, if more than one of these contains a defi‐
       nition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in	the  fpath  is
       chosen;	and  third, within a directory, the newer of either a compiled
       function or an ordinary function definition is used.

       If the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is set, or the file contains only  a	simple
       definition of the function, the file's contents will be executed.  This
       will normally define the function in question,  but  may	 also  perform
       initialization, which is executed in the context of the function execu‐
       tion, and may therefore define local parameters.	 It is an error if the
       function is not defined by loading the file.

       Otherwise,  the	function body (with no surrounding `funcname() {...}')
       is taken to be the complete contents of the file.  This form allows the
       file  to be used directly as an executable shell script.	 If processing
       of the file results in the  function  being  re-defined,	 the  function
       itself  is  not re-executed.  To force the shell to perform initializa‐
       tion and then call the function defined, the file should	 contain  ini‐
       tialization code (which will be executed then discarded) in addition to
       a complete function definition (which will be retained  for  subsequent
       calls to the function), and a call to the shell function, including any
       arguments, at the end.

       For example, suppose the autoload file func contains

	      func() { print This is func; }
	      print func is initialized

       then `func; func' with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both  messages  on
       the  first  call, but only the message `This is func' on the second and
       subsequent calls.  Without KSH_AUTOLOAD set, it will produce  the  ini‐
       tialization  message  on	 the  first call, and the other message on the
       second and subsequent calls.

       It is also possible  to	create	a  function  that  is  not  marked  as
       autoloaded,  but	 which loads its own definition by searching fpath, by
       using `autoload -X' within a shell function.  For example, the  follow‐
       ing are equivalent:

	      myfunc() {
		autoload -X
	      }
	      myfunc args...

       and

	      unfunction myfunc	  # if myfunc was defined
	      autoload myfunc
	      myfunc args...

       In  fact,  the  functions  command outputs `builtin autoload -X' as the
       body of an autoloaded function.	This is done so that

	      eval "$(functions)"

       produces a reasonable result.  A true autoloaded function can be	 iden‐
       tified  by  the	presence  of  the  comment  `# undefined' in the body,
       because all comments are discarded from defined functions.

       To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without execut‐
       ing myfunc, use:

	      autoload +X myfunc

ANONYMOUS FUNCTIONS
       If  no  name  is given for a function, it is `anonymous' and is handled
       specially.  Either form of function definition may be used: a `()' with
       no  preceding  name, or a `function' with an immediately following open
       brace.  The function is executed immediately at the point of definition
       and  is	not  stored  for  future  use.	 The  function	name is set to
       `(anon)'.

       Arguments to the function may be specified as words following the clos‐
       ing  brace  defining the function, hence if there are none no arguments
       (other than $0) are set.	 This is a difference from the way other func‐
       tions  are  parsed: normal function definitions may be followed by cer‐
       tain keywords such as `else' or `fi', which will be  treated  as	 argu‐
       ments  to anonymous functions, so that a newline or semicolon is needed
       to force keyword interpretation.

       Note also that the argument list of any enclosing script or function is
       hidden  (as  would  be  the  case for any other function called at this
       point).

       Redirections may be applied to the anonymous function in the same  man‐
       ner  as	to a current-shell structure enclosed in braces.  The main use
       of anonymous functions is to provide a scope for local variables.  This
       is  particularly	 convenient  in start-up files as these do not provide
       their own local variable scope.

       For example,

	      variable=outside
	      function {
		local variable=inside
		print "I am $variable with arguments $*"
	      } this and that
	      print "I am $variable"

       outputs the following:

	      I am inside with arguments this and that
	      I am outside

       Note that function definitions with arguments that expand  to  nothing,
       for  example `name=; function $name { ... }', are not treated as anony‐
       mous functions.	Instead, they are treated as normal  function  defini‐
       tions where the definition is silently discarded.

SPECIAL FUNCTIONS
       Certain functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell.

   Hook Functions
       For the functions below, it is possible to define an array that has the
       same name as the function with `_functions' appended.  Any  element  in
       such an array is taken as the name of a function to execute; it is exe‐
       cuted in the same context and with the  same  arguments	as  the	 basic
       function.   For example, if $chpwd_functions is an array containing the
       values `mychpwd', `chpwd_save_dirstack', then  the  shell  attempts  to
       execute	the functions `chpwd', `mychpwd' and `chpwd_save_dirstack', in
       that order.  Any function that does not exist is silently  ignored.   A
       function	 found	by  this mechanism is referred to elsewhere as a `hook
       function'.  An error in any function causes subsequent functions not to
       be  run.	 Note further that an error in a precmd hook causes an immedi‐
       ately following periodic function not to run (though it may run at  the
       next opportunity).

       chpwd  Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.

       periodic
	      If  the parameter PERIOD is set, this function is executed every
	      $PERIOD seconds, just before a prompt.  Note  that  if  multiple
	      functions	 are  defined  using the array periodic_functions only
	      one period is applied to the complete set of functions, and  the
	      scheduled time is not reset if the list of functions is altered.
	      Hence the set of functions is always called together.

       precmd Executed before each prompt.  Note that precommand functions are
	      not  re-executed	simply because the command line is redrawn, as
	      happens, for example, when a notification about an  exiting  job
	      is displayed.

       preexec
	      Executed	just  after a command has been read and is about to be
	      executed.	 If the history mechanism is active (and the line  was
	      not discarded from the history buffer), the string that the user
	      typed is passed as the first argument, otherwise it is an	 empty
	      string.	The  actual  command  that will be executed (including
	      expanded aliases) is passed in two different forms:  the	second
	      argument	is  a single-line, size-limited version of the command
	      (with things like function bodies elided);  the  third  argument
	      contains the full text that is being executed.

       zshaddhistory
	      Executed	when  a	 history line has been read interactively, but
	      before it is executed.  The sole argument is the	complete  his‐
	      tory  line  (so  that  any  terminating  newline	will  still be
	      present).

	      If any of the hook functions returns status 1 (or	 any  non-zero
	      value  other  than  2,  though this is not guaranteed for future
	      versions of the shell) the  history  line	 will  not  be	saved,
	      although	it  lingers in the history until the next line is exe‐
	      cuted, allowing you to reuse or edit it immediately.

	      If any of the hook functions returns status 2 the	 history  line
	      will  be	saved on the internal history list, but not written to
	      the history file.	 In case of a  conflict,  the  first  non-zero
	      status value is taken.

	      A	 hook function may call `fc -p ...' to switch the history con‐
	      text so that the history is saved in a different file  from  the
	      that  in	the  global  HISTFILE parameter.  This is handled spe‐
	      cially: the history context is automatically restored after  the
	      processing of the history line is finished.

	      The  following  example  function	 works with one of the options
	      INC_APPEND_HISTORY or SHARE_HISTORY set, in order that the  line
	      is written out immediately after the history entry is added.  It
	      first adds the history line to the normal history with the  new‐
	      line  stripped, which is usually the correct behaviour.  Then it
	      switches the history context so that the line will be written to
	      a history file in the current directory.

		     zshaddhistory() {
		       print -sr -- ${1%%$'\n'}
		       fc -p .zsh_local_history
		     }

       zshexit
	      Executed at the point where the main shell is about to exit nor‐
	      mally.  This is not called by exiting subshells,	nor  when  the
	      exec  precommand	modifier  is  used before an external command.
	      Also, unlike TRAPEXIT, it is not called when functions exit.

   Trap Functions
       The functions below are treated specially but do not have corresponding
       hook arrays.

       TRAPNAL
	      If defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever
	      the shell catches a signal SIGNAL, where NAL is a signal name as
	      specified	 for  the  kill	 builtin.   The	 signal number will be
	      passed as the first parameter to the function.

	      If a function of this form is defined and null,  the  shell  and
	      processes spawned by it will ignore SIGNAL.

	      The return status from the function is handled specially.	 If it
	      is zero, the signal is assumed to have been handled, and	execu‐
	      tion  continues  normally.   Otherwise, the shell will behave as
	      interrupted except  that	the  return  status  of	 the  trap  is
	      retained.

	      Programs	terminated  by	uncaught  signals typically return the
	      status 128 plus the signal number.  Hence the  following	causes
	      the  handler for SIGINT to print a message, then mimic the usual
	      effect of the signal.

		     TRAPINT() {
		       print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
		       return $(( 128 + $1 ))
		     }

	      The functions TRAPZERR, TRAPDEBUG and TRAPEXIT  are  never  exe‐
	      cuted inside other traps.

       TRAPDEBUG
	      If  the  option  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD	 is set (as it is by default),
	      executed before each command; otherwise executed after each com‐
	      mand.  See the description of the trap builtin in zshbuiltins(1)
	      for details of additional features provided in debug traps.

       TRAPEXIT
	      Executed when the shell exits,  or  when	the  current  function
	      exits  if	 defined  inside  a  function.	The value of $? at the
	      start of execution is the exit status of the shell or the return
	      status of the function exiting.

       TRAPZERR
	      Executed	whenever  a  command has a non-zero exit status.  How‐
	      ever, the function is not executed if the command occurred in  a
	      sublist  followed	 by  `&&' or `||'; only the final command in a
	      sublist of this type causes the trap to be executed.  The	 func‐
	      tion TRAPERR acts the same as TRAPZERR on systems where there is
	      no SIGERR (this is the usual case).

       The functions beginning `TRAP' may alternatively be  defined  with  the
       trap  builtin:	this  may be preferable for some uses.	Setting a trap
       with one form removes any trap of the other form for the	 same  signal;
       removing	 a  trap in either form removes all traps for the same signal.
       The forms

	      TRAPNAL() {
	       # code
	      }

       ('function traps') and

	      trap '
	       # code
	      ' NAL

       ('list traps') are equivalent in most ways, the	exceptions  being  the
       following:

       ·      Function	traps  have  all  the  properties of normal functions,
	      appearing in the list of functions and being called  with	 their
	      own  function context rather than the context where the trap was
	      triggered.

       ·      The return status from function  traps  is  special,  whereas  a
	      return from a list trap causes the surrounding context to return
	      with the given status.

       ·      Function traps are not reset  within  subshells,	in  accordance
	      with  zsh	 behaviour;  list  traps are reset, in accordance with
	      POSIX behaviour.

JOBS
       If the MONITOR option is set, an interactive  shell  associates	a  job
       with  each  pipeline.  It keeps a table of current jobs, printed by the
       jobs command, and assigns them small integer numbers.  When  a  job  is
       started	asynchronously	with  `&', the shell prints a line to standard
       error which looks like:

	      [1] 1234

       indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
       1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.

       If  a  job  is  started with `&|' or `&!', then that job is immediately
       disowned.  After startup, it does not have a place in  the  job	table,
       and is not subject to the job control features described here.

       If  you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the
       key ^Z (control-Z) which sends a TSTP signal to the current job:	  this
       key  may	 be redefined by the susp option of the external stty command.
       The shell will then normally indicate  that  the	 job  has  been	 `sus‐
       pended',	 and  print another prompt.  You can then manipulate the state
       of this job, putting it in the background with the bg command,  or  run
       some  other  commands  and  then eventually bring the job back into the
       foreground with the foreground command fg.  A ^Z takes  effect  immedi‐
       ately  and is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input
       are discarded when it is typed.

       A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from
       the terminal.

       Note  that  if  the  job running in the foreground is a shell function,
       then suspending it will have the effect of causing the shell  to	 fork.
       This  is	 necessary  to	separate the function's state from that of the
       parent shell performing the job control, so that the latter can	return
       to  the	command	 line prompt.  As a result, even if fg is used to con‐
       tinue the job the function will no longer be part of the parent	shell,
       and any variables set by the function will not be visible in the parent
       shell.  Thus the behaviour is different from the case where  the	 func‐
       tion  was  never suspended.  Zsh is different from many other shells in
       this regard.

       The same behaviour is found when the shell is  executing	 code  as  the
       right  hand  side  of a pipeline or any complex shell construct such as
       if, for, etc., in order that the entire block of code can be managed as
       a  single job.  Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
       but this can be disabled by giving the command `stty tostop'.   If  you
       set this tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to
       produce output like they do when they try to read input.

       When a command is suspended and continued later with  the  fg  or  wait
       builtins,  zsh  restores tty modes that were in effect when it was sus‐
       pended.	This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is  contin‐
       ued via `kill -CONT', nor when it is continued with bg.

       There  are  several  ways  to refer to jobs in the shell.  A job can be
       referred to by the process ID of any process of the job or  by  one  of
       the following:

       %number
	      The job with the given number.
       %string
	      Any job whose command line begins with string.
       %?string
	      Any job whose command line contains string.
       %%     Current job.
       %+     Equivalent to `%%'.
       %-     Previous job.

       The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.  It nor‐
       mally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked	 so  that  no  further
       progress	 is possible.  If the NOTIFY option is not set, it waits until
       just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.  All such notifi‐
       cations	are  sent directly to the terminal, not to the standard output
       or standard error.

       When the monitor mode is on, each background job that  completes	 trig‐
       gers any trap set for CHLD.

       When  you  try  to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended,
       you will be warned that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.   You  may
       use  the	 jobs command to see what they are.  If you do this or immedi‐
       ately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the
       suspended  jobs will be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent a
       SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.

       To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs,  either  use  the
       nohup command (see nohup(1)) or the disown builtin.

SIGNALS
       The INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the com‐
       mand is followed by `&' and the MONITOR	option	is  not	 active.   The
       shell  itself  always ignores the QUIT signal.  Otherwise, signals have
       the values inherited by the shell from its parent (but see the  TRAPNAL
       special functions in the section `Functions').

       Certain	jobs  are  run	asynchronously	by  the shell other than those
       explicitly put into the background; even in cases where the shell would
       usually wait for such jobs, an explicit exit command or exit due to the
       option ERR_EXIT will cause the shell to exit without waiting.  Examples
       of  such	 asynchronous  jobs  are process substitution, see the section
       PROCESS SUBSTITUTION in the zshexpn(1) manual  page,  and  the  handler
       processes for multios, see the section MULTIOS in the zshmisc(1) manual
       page.

ARITHMETIC EVALUATION
       The shell can perform integer and  floating  point  arithmetic,	either
       using the builtin let, or via a substitution of the form $((...)).  For
       integers, the shell is usually compiled to use 8-byte  precision	 where
       this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes.  This can be tested,
       for example, by giving the command `print - $(( 12345678901 ))'; if the
       number  appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8 bytes.  Floating
       point arithmetic always uses the `double'  type	with  whatever	corre‐
       sponding precision is provided by the compiler and the library.

       The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each
       is evaluated separately.	 Since many of the  arithmetic	operators,  as
       well  as	 spaces, require quoting, an alternative form is provided: for
       any command which begins with a `((', all the characters until a match‐
       ing  `))'  are  treated as a quoted expression and arithmetic expansion
       performed as for an argument of	let.   More  precisely,	 `((...))'  is
       equivalent  to  `let  "..."'.  The return status is 0 if the arithmetic
       value of the expression is non-zero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an error
       occurred.

       For example, the following statement

	      (( val = 2 + 1 ))

       is equivalent to

	      let "val = 2 + 1"

       both  assigning	the  value 3 to the shell variable val and returning a
       zero status.

       Integers can be in bases other than 10.	A leading `0x' or `0X' denotes
       hexadecimal.   Integers may also be of the form `base#n', where base is
       a decimal number between two and thirty-six representing the arithmetic
       base  and  n  is	 a number in that base (for example, `16#ff' is 255 in
       hexadecimal).  The base# may also be omitted, in which case base 10  is
       used.  For backwards compatibility the form `[base]n' is also accepted.

       An  integer expression or a base given in the form `base#n' may contain
       underscores (`_') after the leading digit for  visual  guidance;	 these
       are  ignored  in	 computation.	Examples  are 1_000_000 or 0xffff_ffff
       which are equivalent to 1000000 and 0xffffffff respectively.

       It is also possible to specify a base to be used for output in the form
       `[#base]',  for	example	 `[#16]'.  This is used when outputting arith‐
       metical substitutions or when assigning to scalar  parameters,  but  an
       explicitly  defined  integer  or	 floating  point parameter will not be
       affected.  If an integer variable is implicitly defined	by  an	arith‐
       metic  expression,  any	base  specified in this way will be set as the
       variable's output arithmetic base as if the option  `-i	base'  to  the
       typeset builtin had been used.  The expression has no precedence and if
       it occurs more than once in a mathematical expression, the last encoun‐
       tered  is  used.	  For  clarity it is recommended that it appear at the
       beginning of an expression.  As an example:

	      typeset -i 16 y
	      print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
	      print $x $y

       outputs first `8#40', the rightmost value in the given output base, and
       then  `8#40 16#20', because y has been explicitly declared to have out‐
       put base 16, while x (assuming it does not already exist) is implicitly
       typed  by  the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the output base
       8.

       If the C_BASES option is set, hexadecimal numbers  in  the  standard  C
       format,	for  example 0xFF instead of the usual `16#FF'.	 If the option
       OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by default), octal numbers will  be
       treated	similarly  and	hence appear as `077' instead of `8#77'.  This
       option has no effect on the output of bases other than hexadecimal  and
       octal, and these formats are always understood on input.

       When  an output base is specified using the `[#base]' syntax, an appro‐
       priate base prefix will be output if necessary, so that the value  out‐
       put  is	valid  syntax  for  input.   If	 the # is doubled, for example
       `[##16]', then no base prefix is output.

       Floating point constants are recognized by the presence	of  a  decimal
       point  or an exponent.  The decimal point may be the first character of
       the constant, but the exponent character e or E may not, as it will  be
       taken  for  a  parameter name.  All numeric parts (before and after the
       decimal point and in the exponent) may contain  underscores  after  the
       leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation.

       An  arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax and associativity
       of expressions as in C.

       In the native mode of operation, the following operators are  supported
       (listed in decreasing order of precedence):

       + - ! ~ ++ --
	      unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}cre‐
	      ment
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       < > <= >=
	      comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &&     logical AND
       || ^^  logical OR, XOR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
	      assignment
       ,      comma operator

       The operators `&&', `||', `&&=', and `||='  are	short-circuiting,  and
       only  one of the latter two expressions in a ternary operator is evalu‐
       ated.  Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR, and XOR operators.

       With the option C_PRECEDENCES the precedences (but no other properties)
       of the operators are altered to be the same as those in most other lan‐
       guages that support the relevant operators:

       + - ! ~ ++ --
	      unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}cre‐
	      ment
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       < > <= >=
	      comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       &&     logical AND
       ^^     logical XOR
       ||     logical OR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
	      assignment
       ,      comma operator

       Note  the  precedence  of exponentiation in both cases is below that of
       unary operators, hence `-3**2' evaluates as `9', not -9.	 Use parenthe‐
       ses  where  necessary: `-(3**2)'.  This is for compatibility with other
       shells.

       Mathematical functions can be  called  with  the	 syntax	 `func(args)',
       where  the  function  decides  if  the  args  is	 used as a string or a
       comma-separated list of arithmetic  expressions.	 The  shell  currently
       defines	no mathematical functions by default, but the module zsh/math‐
       func may be loaded with the zmodload builtin to provide standard float‐
       ing point mathematical functions.

       An  expression of the form `##x' where x is any character sequence such
       as `a', `^A', or `\M-\C-x' gives the value of  this  character  and  an
       expression of the form `#foo' gives the value of the first character of
       the contents of the parameter foo.  Character values are	 according  to
       the  character  set used in the current locale; for multibyte character
       handling the option MULTIBYTE must be set.  Note that this form is dif‐
       ferent  from `$#foo', a standard parameter substitution which gives the
       length of the parameter foo.  `#\' is accepted instead of `##', but its
       use is deprecated.

       Named  parameters  and  subscripted  arrays  can	 be referenced by name
       within an arithmetic expression without using the  parameter  expansion
       syntax.	For example,

	      ((val2 = val1 * 2))

       assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.

       An  internal  integer representation of a named parameter can be speci‐
       fied with the integer builtin.  Arithmetic evaluation is	 performed  on
       the  value  of each assignment to a named parameter declared integer in
       this manner.  Assigning a floating point number to an  integer  results
       in rounding down to the next integer.

       Likewise,  floating  point  numbers  can	 be  declared  with  the float
       builtin; there are two types, differing only in their output format, as
       described  for  the typeset builtin.  The output format can be bypassed
       by using arithmetic substitution instead of the parameter substitution,
       i.e.  `${float}'	 uses  the  defined  format,  but  `$((float))' uses a
       generic floating point format.

       Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where neces‐
       sary.   In  addition,  if  any operator which requires an integer (`~',
       `&', `|', `^', `%', `<<', `>>' and their equivalents  with  assignment)
       is given a floating point argument, it will be silently rounded down to
       the next integer.

       Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different
       times; there is no memory of the numeric type in this case.

       If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously
       being declared, it will be implicitly typed as  integer	or  float  and
       retain  that  type either until the type is explicitly changed or until
       the end of the scope.  This  can	 have  unforeseen  consequences.   For
       example, in the loop

	      for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
	      # use $f
	      done

       if  f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it
       to be created as an integer, and consequently the operation `f +=  0.1'
       will  always cause the result to be truncated to zero, so that the loop
       will fail.  A simple fix would be to turn the initialization into `f  =
       0.0'.   It is therefore best to declare numeric variables with explicit
       types.

CONDITIONAL EXPRESSIONS
       A conditional expression is used with the [[ compound command  to  test
       attributes  of  files  and  to compare strings.	Each expression can be
       constructed from one or more of the following unary or  binary  expres‐
       sions:

       -a file
	      true if file exists.

       -b file
	      true if file exists and is a block special file.

       -c file
	      true if file exists and is a character special file.

       -d file
	      true if file exists and is a directory.

       -e file
	      true if file exists.

       -f file
	      true if file exists and is a regular file.

       -g file
	      true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.

       -h file
	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -k file
	      true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.

       -n string
	      true if length of string is non-zero.

       -o option
	      true if option named option is on.  option may be a single char‐
	      acter, in which case it is a single letter  option  name.	  (See
	      the section `Specifying Options'.)

       -p file
	      true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).

       -r file
	      true if file exists and is readable by current process.

       -s file
	      true if file exists and has size greater than zero.

       -t fd  true  if file descriptor number fd is open and associated with a
	      terminal device.	(note: fd is not optional)

       -u file
	      true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.

       -w file
	      true if file exists and is writable by current process.

       -x file
	      true if file exists and is executable by	current	 process.   If
	      file  exists  and	 is  a directory, then the current process has
	      permission to search in the directory.

       -z string
	      true if length of string is zero.

       -L file
	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -O file
	      true if file exists and is owned by the  effective  user	ID  of
	      this process.

       -G file
	      true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID
	      of this process.

       -S file
	      true if file exists and is a socket.

       -N file
	      true if file exists and its access time is not  newer  than  its
	      modification time.

       file1 -nt file2
	      true if file1 exists and is newer than file2.

       file1 -ot file2
	      true if file1 exists and is older than file2.

       file1 -ef file2
	      true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.

       string = pattern
       string == pattern
	      true  if string matches pattern.	The `==' form is the preferred
	      one.  The `=' form is for backward compatibility and  should  be
	      considered obsolete.

       string != pattern
	      true if string does not match pattern.

       string =~ regexp
	      true  if	string	matches the regular expression regexp.	If the
	      option RE_MATCH_PCRE is set regexp is tested as a	 PCRE  regular
	      expression  using	 the  zsh/pcre	module, else it is tested as a
	      POSIX extended regular expression using  the  zsh/regex  module.
	      Upon  successful match, some variables will be updated; no vari‐
	      ables are changed if the matching fails.

	      If the option BASH_REMATCH is not set the scalar parameter MATCH
	      is set to the substring that matched the pattern and the integer
	      parameters MBEGIN and MEND to the index of the  start  and  end,
	      respectively,  of	 the  match  in string, such that if string is
	      contained in variable var the expression `${var[$MBEGIN,$MEND]}'
	      is  identical to `$MATCH'.  The setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS
	      is respected.  Likewise, the array match	is  set	 to  the  sub‐
	      strings that matched parenthesised subexpressions and the arrays
	      mbegin and mend to the indices of the start and  end  positions,
	      respectively,  of	 the substrings within string.	The arrays are
	      not set if there were  no	 parenthesised	subexpresssions.   For
	      example,	if  the string `a short string' is matched against the
	      regular  expression  `s(...)t',  then   (assuming	  the	option
	      KSH_ARRAYS is not set) MATCH, MBEGIN and MEND are `short', 3 and
	      7, respectively, while match, mbegin and mend are	 single	 entry
	      arrays containing the strings `hor', `4' and `6, respectively.

	      If  the option BASH_REMATCH is set the array BASH_REMATCH is set
	      to the substring that matched the pattern followed by  the  sub‐
	      strings  that  matched  parenthesised  subexpressions within the
	      pattern.

       string1 < string2
	      true if string1 comes before string2 based  on  ASCII  value  of
	      their characters.

       string1 > string2
	      true  if	string1	 comes	after  string2 based on ASCII value of
	      their characters.

       exp1 -eq exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically equal to exp2.  Note that for purely
	      numeric  comparisons use of the ((...)) builtin described in the
	      section `ARITHMETIC EVALUATION' is more convenient  than	condi‐
	      tional expressions.

       exp1 -ne exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2.

       exp1 -lt exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2.

       exp1 -gt exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2.

       exp1 -le exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ge exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2.

       ( exp )
	      true if exp is true.

       ! exp  true if exp is false.

       exp1 && exp2
	      true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.

       exp1 || exp2
	      true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.

       Normal  shell  expansion	 is  performed on the file, string and pattern
       arguments, but the result of each expansion is constrained to be a sin‐
       gle  word, similar to the effect of double quotes.  Filename generation
       is not performed on any form of argument to conditions.	However,  pat‐
       tern  metacharacters are active for the pattern arguments; the patterns
       are the same as those used for filename generation, see zshexpn(1), but
       there  is  no  special  behaviour  of `/' nor initial dots, and no glob
       qualifiers are allowed.

       In each of the above expressions, if file is of the  form  `/dev/fd/n',
       where  n	 is  an	 integer, then the test applied to the open file whose
       descriptor number is n, even if the underlying system does not  support
       the /dev/fd directory.

       In  the	forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions exp undergo
       arithmetic expansion as if they were enclosed in $((...)).

       For example, the following:

	      [[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.

       tests if either file foo or file bar exists, and if so, if the value of
       the  parameter  report  begins  with  `y'; if the complete condition is
       true, the message `File exists.' is printed.

EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES
       Prompt sequences undergo a special form of  expansion.	This  type  of
       expansion is also available using the -P option to the print builtin.

       If the PROMPT_SUBST option is set, the prompt string is first subjected
       to parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic  expansion.
       See zshexpn(1).

       Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.

       If  the	PROMPT_BANG  option is set, a `!' in the prompt is replaced by
       the current history event number.  A literal `!'	 may  then  be	repre‐
       sented as `!!'.

       If  the	PROMPT_PERCENT	option	is  set, certain escape sequences that
       start with `%' are expanded.  Many escapes are  followed	 by  a	single
       character,  although  some  of  these take an optional integer argument
       that should appear between the  `%'  and	 the  next  character  of  the
       sequence.   More	 complicated escape sequences are available to provide
       conditional expansion.

SIMPLE PROMPT ESCAPES
   Special characters
       %%     A `%'.

       %)     A `)'.

   Login information
       %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.
	      If the name starts with `/dev/tty', that prefix is stripped.

       %M     The full machine hostname.

       %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	 An integer may follow the `%'
	      to specify how many components  of  the  hostname	 are  desired.
	      With a negative integer, trailing components of the hostname are
	      shown.

       %n     $USERNAME.

       %y     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.
	      This does not treat `/dev/tty' names specially.

   Shell state
       %#     A	 `#'  if  the  shell is running with privileges, a `%' if not.
	      Equivalent to `%(!.#.%%)'.  The definition of `privileged',  for
	      these  purposes,	is  that either the effective user ID is zero,
	      or, if POSIX.1e capabilities are supported, that	at  least  one
	      capability  is  raised  in  either  the Effective or Inheritable
	      capability vectors.

       %?     The return status of the last command executed just  before  the
	      prompt.

       %_     The  status  of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs (like `if'
	      and `for') that have been started on the command line. If	 given
	      an  integer  number  that	 many strings will be printed; zero or
	      negative or no integer means print as many as there  are.	  This
	      is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines and PS4 for
	      debugging with the XTRACE option; in the	latter	case  it  will
	      also work non-interactively.

       %d
       /      Current  working	directory.   If an integer follows the `%', it
	      specifies a number of trailing components of the current working
	      directory	 to show; zero means the whole path.  A negative inte‐
	      ger specifies leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the	 first
	      component.

       %~     As  %d  and %/, but if the current working directory starts with
	      $HOME, that part is replaced by a `~'. Furthermore, if it has  a
	      named  directory	as  its prefix, that part is replaced by a `~'
	      followed by the name of the directory, but only if the result is
	      shorter  than the full path; see Dynamic and Static named direc‐
	      tories in zshexpn(1).

       %h
       %!     Current history event number.

       %i     The line number currently being executed in the script,  sourced
	      file,  or	 shell	function given by %N.  This is most useful for
	      debugging as part of $PS4.

       %I     The line number currently being executed in the file  %x.	  This
	      is similar to %i, but the line number is always a line number in
	      the file where the code was defined, even if the code is a shell
	      function.

       %j     The number of jobs.

       %L     The current value of $SHLVL.

       %N     The name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh
	      is currently executing, whichever was started most recently.  If
	      there is none, this is equivalent to the parameter $0.  An inte‐
	      ger may follow the `%' to specify a number of trailing path com‐
	      ponents  to  show; zero means the full path.  A negative integer
	      specifies leading components.

       %x     The name of the file containing the source code currently	 being
	      executed.	 This behaves as %N except that function and eval com‐
	      mand names are not shown,	 instead  the  file  where  they  were
	      defined.

       %c
       %.
       %C     Trailing component of the current working directory.  An integer
	      may follow the `%' to get more than one component.  Unless  `%C'
	      is used, tilde contraction is performed first.  These are depre‐
	      cated as %c and %C are equivalent to %1~ and %1/,	 respectively,
	      while explicit positive integers have the same effect as for the
	      latter two sequences.

   Date and time
       %D     The date in yy-mm-dd format.

       %T     Current time of day, in 24-hour format.

       %t
       %@     Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

       %*     Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.

       %w     The date in day-dd format.

       %W     The date in mm/dd/yy format.

       %D{string}
	      string is formatted using	 the  strftime	function.   See	 strf‐
	      time(3)  for  more details.  Various zsh extensions provide num‐
	      bers with no leading zero or space if the	 number	 is  a	single
	      digit:

	      %f     a day of the month
	      %K     the hour of the day on the 24-hour clock
	      %L     the hour of the day on the 12-hour clock

	      The  GNU extension that a `-' between the % and the format char‐
	      acter causes a leading zero or space to be stripped  is  handled
	      directly	by  the shell for the format characters d, f, H, k, l,
	      m, M, S and y; any other format characters are provided to strf‐
	      time()  with any leading `-', present, so the handling is system
	      dependent.  Further GNU extensions are not supported at present.

   Visual effects
       %B (%b)
	      Start (stop) boldface mode.

       %E     Clear to end of line.

       %U (%u)
	      Start (stop) underline mode.

       %S (%s)
	      Start (stop) standout mode.

       %F (%f)
	      Start (stop) using a different foreground colour,	 if  supported
	      by  the  terminal.  The colour may be specified two ways: either
	      as a numeric argument, as normal, or by  a  sequence  in	braces
	      following	 the  %F, for example %F{red}.	In the latter case the
	      values  allowed  are  as	described  for	the  fg	 zle_highlight
	      attribute;  see Character Highlighting in zshzle(1).  This means
	      that numeric colours are allowed in the second format also.

       %K (%k)
	      Start (stop) using a different bacKground colour.	 The syntax is
	      identical to that for %F and %f.

       %{...%}
	      Include  a  string  as  a	 literal  escape sequence.  The string
	      within the braces should not change the cursor position.	 Brace
	      pairs can nest.

	      A	 positive  numeric argument between the % and the { is treated
	      as described for %G below.

       %G     Within a %{...%} sequence, include a `glitch': that  is,	assume
	      that  a  single  character width will be output.	This is useful
	      when outputting characters that otherwise	 cannot	 be  correctly
	      handled  by  the	shell,	such as the alternate character set on
	      some terminals.  The characters  in  question  can  be  included
	      within  a	 %{...%} sequence together with the appropriate number
	      of %G sequences to  indicate  the	 correct  width.   An  integer
	      between  the  `%' and `G' indicates a character width other than
	      one.  Hence %{seq%2G%} outputs seq and assumes it takes  up  the
	      width of two standard characters.

	      Multiple uses of %G accumulate in the obvious fashion; the posi‐
	      tion of the %G is unimportant.  Negative integers are  not  han‐
	      dled.

	      Note  that  when	prompt truncation is in use it is advisable to
	      divide up output into  single  characters	 within	 each  %{...%}
	      group so that the correct truncation point can be found.

CONDITIONAL SUBSTRINGS IN PROMPTS
       %v     The  value  of  the  first element of the psvar array parameter.
	      Following the `%' with an integer	 gives	that  element  of  the
	      array.  Negative integers count from the end of the array.

       %(x.true-text.false-text)
	      Specifies	 a  ternary expression.	 The character following the x
	      is arbitrary; the same character is used to  separate  the  text
	      for  the	`true'	result from that for the `false' result.  This
	      separator may not appear in the true-text, except as part	 of  a
	      %-escape	sequence.  A `)' may appear in the false-text as `%)'.
	      true-text and false-text	may  both  contain  arbitrarily-nested
	      escape sequences, including further ternary expressions.

	      The  left	 parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a positive
	      integer n, which defaults to zero.  A negative integer  will  be
	      multiplied  by  -1.  The test character x may be any of the fol‐
	      lowing:

	      !	     True if the shell is running with privileges.
	      #	     True if the effective uid of the current process is n.
	      ?	     True if the exit status of the last command was n.
	      _	     True if at least n shell constructs were started.
	      C
	      /	     True if the current absolute path has at least n elements
		     relative  to  the root directory, hence / is counted as 0
		     elements.
	      c
	      .
	      ~	     True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at
		     least  n elements relative to the root directory, hence /
		     is counted as 0 elements.
	      D	     True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).
	      d	     True if the day of the month is equal to n.
	      g	     True if the effective gid of the current process is n.
	      j	     True if the number of jobs is at least n.
	      L	     True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n.
	      l	     True if at least n characters have already	 been  printed
		     on the current line.
	      S	     True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n.
	      T	     True if the time in hours is equal to n.
	      t	     True if the time in minutes is equal to n.
	      v	     True if the array psvar has at least n elements.
	      V	     True  if  element	n  of  the  array  psvar  is  set  and
		     non-empty.
	      w	     True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).

       %<string<
       %>string>
       %[xstring]
	      Specifies truncation behaviour for the remainder of  the	prompt
	      string.	 The   third,	deprecated,   form  is	equivalent  to
	      `%xstringx', i.e. x may be `<' or `>'.   The  numeric  argument,
	      which  in	 the  third form may appear immediately after the `[',
	      specifies the maximum permitted length of	 the  various  strings
	      that  can	 be  displayed in the prompt.  The string will be dis‐
	      played in place of the truncated portion	of  any	 string;  note
	      this does not undergo prompt expansion.

	      The  forms  with `<' truncate at the left of the string, and the
	      forms with `>' truncate at the right of the string.   For	 exam‐
	      ple,  if	the  current  directory	 is  `/home/pike',  the prompt
	      `%8<..<%/' will expand to `..e/pike'.  In this string, the  ter‐
	      minating	character (`<', `>' or `]'), or in fact any character,
	      may be quoted by a preceding `\'; note when using print -P, how‐
	      ever, that this must be doubled as the string is also subject to
	      standard	print  processing,  in	addition  to  any  backslashes
	      removed  by a double quoted string:  the worst case is therefore
	      `print -P "%<\\\\<<..."'.

	      If the string is longer than the specified truncation length, it
	      will appear in full, completely replacing the truncated string.

	      The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of
	      the string, or to the end of the next  enclosing	group  of  the
	      `%('  construct,	or  to	the next truncation encountered at the
	      same grouping level (i.e. truncations inside a  `%('  are	 sepa‐
	      rate), which ever comes first.  In particular, a truncation with
	      argument zero (e.g. `%<<') marks the end of  the	range  of  the
	      string  to  be truncated while turning off truncation from there
	      on. For example, the prompt  '%10<...<%~%<<%#  '	will  print  a
	      truncated representation of the current directory, followed by a
	      `%' or `#', followed by a space.	Without the `%<<',  those  two
	      characters would be included in the string to be truncated.

ZSHEXPN(1)							    ZSHEXPN(1)

NAME
       zshexpn - zsh expansion and substitution

DESCRIPTION
       The  following types of expansions are performed in the indicated order
       in five steps:

       History Expansion
	      This is performed only in interactive shells.

       Alias Expansion
	      Aliases are expanded immediately	before	the  command  line  is
	      parsed as explained under Aliasing in zshmisc(1).

       Process Substitution
       Parameter Expansion
       Command Substitution
       Arithmetic Expansion
       Brace Expansion
	      These  five  are performed in one step in left-to-right fashion.
	      After these expansions, all unquoted occurrences of the  charac‐
	      ters `\', `'' and `"' are removed.

       Filename Expansion
	      If  the  SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order of expansion
	      is modified for compatibility with sh and	 ksh.	In  that  case
	      filename	expansion  is performed immediately after alias expan‐
	      sion, preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.

       Filename Generation
	      This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done
	      last.

       The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.

HISTORY EXPANSION
       History	expansion  allows you to use words from previous command lines
       in the command line you are typing.  This simplifies  spelling  correc‐
       tions and the repetition of complicated commands or arguments.

       Immediately  before  execution,	each  command  is saved in the history
       list, the size of which is controlled by the HISTSIZE  parameter.   The
       one  most  recent  command  is always retained in any case.  Each saved
       command in the history list is called a history event and is assigned a
       number,	beginning  with 1 (one) when the shell starts up.  The history
       number that you may  see	 in  your  prompt  (see	 EXPANSION  OF	PROMPT
       SEQUENCES  in  zshmisc(1))  is the number that is to be assigned to the
       next command.

   Overview
       A history expansion begins with the first character  of	the  histchars
       parameter,  which is `!' by default, and may occur anywhere on the com‐
       mand line; history expansions do not nest.  The `!' can be escaped with
       `\' or can be enclosed between a pair of single quotes ('') to suppress
       its special meaning.  Double quotes will not work for this.   Following
       this history character is an optional event designator (see the section
       `Event Designators') and then an optional word designator (the  section
       `Word  Designators');  if  neither  of these designators is present, no
       history expansion occurs.

       Input lines  containing	history	 expansions  are  echoed  after	 being
       expanded,  but  before  any  other expansions take place and before the
       command is executed.  It is this expanded form that is recorded as  the
       history event for later references.

       By  default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the
       same event as any preceding history reference on that command line;  if
       it  is the only history reference in a command, it refers to the previ‐
       ous command.  However, if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY	is  set,  then
       every  history  reference  with no event specification always refers to
       the previous command.

       For example, `!' is the event designator for the previous  command,  so
       `!!:1'  always  refers  to  the first word of the previous command, and
       `!!$' always refers to the last word of	the  previous  command.	  With
       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then `!:1' and `!$' function in the same manner
       as `!!:1' and `!!$', respectively.  Conversely,	if  CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY
       is  unset,  then	 `!:1'	and  `!$'  refer  to the first and last words,
       respectively, of the same event referenced by the nearest other history
       reference  preceding them on the current command line, or to the previ‐
       ous command if there is no preceding reference.

       The character sequence `^foo^bar' (where `^'  is	 actually  the	second
       character of the histchars parameter) repeats the last command, replac‐
       ing the string foo with bar.  More precisely, the sequence  `^foo^bar^'
       is synonymous with `!!:s^foo^bar^', hence other modifiers (see the sec‐
       tion  `Modifiers')  may	follow	the   final   `^'.    In   particular,
       `^foo^bar^:G' performs a global substitution.

       If  the	shell encounters the character sequence `!"' in the input, the
       history mechanism is temporarily disabled until the current  list  (see
       zshmisc(1))  is	fully parsed.  The `!"' is removed from the input, and
       any subsequent `!' characters have no special significance.

       A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history  sup‐
       port is provided by the fc builtin.

   Event Designators
       An  event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in the his‐
       tory list.  In the list below, remember that the initial	 `!'  in  each
       item  may  be  changed  to  another  character by setting the histchars
       parameter.

       !      Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, new‐
	      line,  `=' or `('.  If followed immediately by a word designator
	      (see the section `Word Designators'), this forms a history  ref‐
	      erence with no event designator (see the section `Overview').

       !!     Refer  to	 the  previous	command.   By  itself,	this expansion
	      repeats the previous command.

       !n     Refer to command-line n.

       !-n    Refer to the current command-line minus n.

       !str   Refer to the most recent command starting with str.

       !?str[?]
	      Refer to the most recent command containing str.	 The  trailing
	      `?'  is necessary if this reference is to be followed by a modi‐
	      fier or followed by any text that is not to be  considered  part
	      of str.

       !#     Refer  to the current command line typed in so far.  The line is
	      treated as if it were complete up	 to  and  including  the  word
	      before the one with the `!#' reference.

       !{...} Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if neces‐
	      sary).

   Word Designators
       A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line
       are to be included in a history reference.  A `:' usually separates the
       event specification from the word designator.  It may be	 omitted  only
       if  the	word designator begins with a `^', `$', `*', `-' or `%'.  Word
       designators include:

       0      The first input word (command).
       n      The nth argument.
       ^      The first argument.  That is, 1.
       $      The last argument.
       %      The word matched by (the most recent) ?str search.
       x-y    A range of words; x defaults to 0.
       *      All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
       x*     Abbreviates `x-$'.
       x-     Like `x*' but omitting word $.

       Note that a `%' word designator works only when used in	one  of	 `!%',
       `!:%'  or `!?str?:%', and only when used after a !? expansion (possibly
       in an earlier command).	Anything else results in  an  error,  although
       the error may not be the most obvious one.

   Modifiers
       After  the  optional  word designator, you can add a sequence of one or
       more of the following modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.	  These	 modi‐
       fiers  also  work  on  the  result of filename generation and parameter
       expansion, except where noted.

       a      Turn a file name into an absolute path:	prepends  the  current
	      directory, if necessary, and resolves any use of `..' and `.' in
	      the path.	 Note that the transformation takes place even if  the
	      file or any intervening directories do not exist.

       A      As  `a',	but also resolve use of symbolic links where possible.
	      Note that resolution of `..' occurs before  resolution  of  sym‐
	      bolic  links.   This  call is equivalent to a unless your system
	      has the realpath system call (modern systems do).

       c      Resolve a command name into an absolute path  by	searching  the
	      command path given by the PATH variable.	This does not work for
	      commands containing directory parts.  Note also that  this  does
	      not  usually  work as a glob qualifier unless a file of the same
	      name is found in the current directory.

       e      Remove all but the part of the filename extension following  the
	      `.';  see	 the  definition  of  the  filename  extension	in the
	      description of the r modifier below.   Note  that	 according  to
	      that definition the result will be empty if the string ends with
	      a `.'.

       h      Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving  the  head.	  This
	      works like `dirname'.

       l      Convert the words to all lowercase.

       p      Print  the  new  command but do not execute it.  Only works with
	      history expansion.

       q      Quote the substituted  words,  escaping  further	substitutions.
	      Works with history expansion and parameter expansion, though for
	      parameters it is only useful if the  resulting  text  is	to  be
	      re-evaluated such as by eval.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.

       r      Remove a filename extension leaving the root name.  Strings with
	      no filename extension are not altered.  A filename extension  is
	      a `.' followed by any number of characters (including zero) that
	      are neither `.' nor `/' and that continue	 to  the  end  of  the
	      string.  For example, the extension of `foo.orig.c' is `.c', and
	      `dir.c/foo' has no extension.

       s/l/r[/]
	      Substitute r for l as described below.  The substitution is done
	      only  for	 the  first string that matches l.  For arrays and for
	      filename generation, this applies to each word of	 the  expanded
	      text.  See below for further notes on substitutions.

	      The  forms  `gs/l/r' and `s/l/r/:G' perform global substitution,
	      i.e. substitute every occurrence of r for l.  Note that the g or
	      :G must appear in exactly the position shown.

	      See further notes on this form of substitution below.

       &      Repeat  the  previous  s	substitution.  Like s, may be preceded
	      immediately by a g.  In parameter expansion the  &  must	appear
	      inside braces, and in filename generation it must be quoted with
	      a backslash.

       t      Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the tail.	  This
	      works like `basename'.

       u      Convert the words to all uppercase.

       x      Like  q, but break into words at whitespace.  Does not work with
	      parameter expansion.

       The s/l/r/ substitution works as follows.   By  default	the  left-hand
       side  of	 substitutions	are  not patterns, but character strings.  Any
       character can be used as the delimiter in place of  `/'.	  A  backslash
       quotes	the   delimiter	  character.	The   character	 `&',  in  the
       right-hand-side r, is replaced by the text from the  left-hand-side  l.
       The  `&'	 can  be  quoted with a backslash.  A null l uses the previous
       string either from the previous l or from the contextual scan string  s
       from  `!?s'.  You can omit the rightmost delimiter if a newline immedi‐
       ately follows r; the rightmost `?' in a context scan can	 similarly  be
       omitted.	 Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across
       all forms of expansion.

       Note that if a `&' is used within glob qualifers an extra backslash  is
       needed as a & is a special character in this case.

       If  the	option HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l is treated as a pattern of
       the usual form described in  the	 section  FILENAME  GENERATION	below.
       This can be used in all the places where modifiers are available; note,
       however, that in globbing qualifiers parameter substitution has already
       taken  place,  so parameters in the replacement string should be quoted
       to ensure they are replaced at the correct time.	 Note also  that  com‐
       plicated	 patterns  used	 in  globbing qualifiers may need the extended
       glob qualifier notation (#q:s/.../.../) in order for the shell to  rec‐
       ognize the expression as a glob qualifier.  Further, note that bad pat‐
       terns in the substitution are not subject to the NO_BAD_PATTERN	option
       so will cause an error.

       When  HIST_SUBST_PATTERN	 is set, l may start with a # to indicate that
       the pattern must match at the start of the string  to  be  substituted,
       and a % may appear at the start or after an # to indicate that the pat‐
       tern must match at the end of the string to be substituted.  The % or #
       may be quoted with two backslashes.

       For  example,  the following piece of filename generation code with the
       EXTENDED_GLOB option:

	      print *.c(#q:s/#%(#b)s(*).c/'S${match[1]}.C'/)

       takes the expansion of *.c and  applies	the  glob  qualifiers  in  the
       (#q...)	expression, which consists of a substitution modifier anchored
       to the start and end of each word (#%).	This turns  on	backreferences
       ((#b)),	so  that  the  parenthesised subexpression is available in the
       replacement string as ${match[1]}.  The replacement string is quoted so
       that the parameter is not substituted before the start of filename gen‐
       eration.

       The following f, F, w and W modifiers work only with  parameter	expan‐
       sion and filename generation.  They are listed here to provide a single
       point of reference for all modifiers.

       f      Repeats the immediately (without	a  colon)  following  modifier
	      until the resulting word doesn't change any more.

       F:expr:
	      Like  f,	but repeats only n times if the expression expr evalu‐
	      ates to n.  Any character can be used instead  of	 the  `:';  if
	      `(',  `[',  or `{' is used as the opening delimiter, the closing
	      delimiter should be ')', `]', or `}', respectively.

       w      Makes the immediately following modifier work on	each  word  in
	      the string.

       W:sep: Like  w  but  words are considered to be the parts of the string
	      that are separated by sep. Any character can be used instead  of
	      the `:'; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.

PROCESS SUBSTITUTION
       Each  part  of  a  command  argument  that  takes  the  form `<(list)',
       `>(list)' or `=(list)' is subject to process substitution.  The expres‐
       sion  may be preceded or followed by other strings except that, to pre‐
       vent clashes with commonly occurring strings  and  patterns,  the  last
       form  must  occur at the start of a command argument, and the forms are
       only expanded when  first  parsing  command  or	assignment  arguments.
       Process	substitutions  may be used following redirection operators; in
       this case, the substitution must appear with no trailing string.

       In the case of the < or > forms, the shell runs the commands in list as
       a  subprocess of the job executing the shell command line.  If the sys‐
       tem supports the /dev/fd mechanism, the command argument is the name of
       the  device  file corresponding to a file descriptor; otherwise, if the
       system supports named pipes (FIFOs), the command	 argument  will	 be  a
       named  pipe.   If the form with > is selected then writing on this spe‐
       cial file will provide input for list.  If < is	used,  then  the  file
       passed  as  an  argument	 will  be  connected to the output of the list
       process.	 For example,

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |
	      tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null

       cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files file1 and file2 respectively, pastes
       the  results  together,	and  sends  it	to  the processes process1 and
       process2.

       If =(...) is used instead of <(...), then the file passed as  an	 argu‐
       ment  will be the name of a temporary file containing the output of the
       list process.  This may be used instead of the <	 form  for  a  program
       that expects to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the input file.

       There is an optimisation for substitutions of the form =(<<<arg), where
       arg is a single-word argument to the here-string redirection <<<.  This
       form produces a file name containing the value of arg after any substi‐
       tutions have been performed.  This is handled entirely within the  cur‐
       rent  shell.   This  is	effectively  the  reverse  of the special form
       $(<arg) which treats arg as a file name and replaces it with the file's
       contents.

       The = form is useful as both the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementa‐
       tion of <(...) have drawbacks.  In the former case, some programmes may
       automatically  close  the  file descriptor in question before examining
       the file on the command line, particularly if  this  is	necessary  for
       security	 reasons such as when the programme is running setuid.	In the
       second case, if the programme does not actually open the file, the sub‐
       shell  attempting  to read from or write to the pipe will (in a typical
       implementation, different operating systems may have  different	behav‐
       iour)  block for ever and have to be killed explicitly.	In both cases,
       the shell actually supplies the information using a pipe, so that  pro‐
       grammes that expect to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the file will not work.

       Also  note  that	 the  previous example can be more compactly and effi‐
       ciently written (provided the MULTIOS option is set) as:

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) \
	      > >(process1) > >(process2)

       The shell uses pipes instead of	FIFOs  to  implement  the  latter  two
       process substitutions in the above example.

       There  is  an additional problem with >(process); when this is attached
       to an external command, the parent shell does not wait for  process  to
       finish  and  hence  an immediately following command cannot rely on the
       results being complete.	The problem  and  solution  are	 the  same  as
       described  in the section MULTIOS in zshmisc(1).	 Hence in a simplified
       version of the example above:

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process)

       (note that no MULTIOS are involved), process will be run asynchronously
       as far as the parent shell is concerned.	 The workaround is:

	      { paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) } > >(process)

       The  extra  processes here are spawned from the parent shell which will
       wait for their completion.

       Another problem arises any time a job with a substitution that requires
       a  temporary  file  is  disowned by the shell, including the case where
       `&!' or `&|' appears at the end of a command containing a  subsitution.
       In  that case the temporary file will not be cleaned up as the shell no
       longer has any memory of the job.  A workaround is to use  a  subshell,
       for example,

	      (mycmd =(myoutput)) &!

       as  the forked subshell will wait for the command to finish then remove
       the temporary file.

       A general workaround to ensure a process substitution  endures  for  an
       appropriate length of time is to pass it as a parameter to an anonymous
       shell function (a piece of shell code  that  is	run  immediately  with
       function scope).	 For example, this code:

	      () {
		 print File $1:
		 cat $1
	      } =(print This be the verse)

       outputs something resembling the following

	      File /tmp/zsh6nU0kS:
	      This be the verse

       The  temporary file created by the process substitution will be deleted
       when the function exits.

PARAMETER EXPANSION
       The character `$' is used to introduce parameter expansions.  See  zsh‐
       param(1) for a description of parameters, including arrays, associative
       arrays, and subscript notation to access individual array elements.

       Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters  are  not
       automatically  split  on	 whitespace unless the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is
       set; see references to this option below for more details.  This is  an
       important difference from other shells.

       In  the	expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of
       the pattern is the same as that used for filename generation;  see  the
       section	`Filename  Generation'.	  Note that these patterns, along with
       the replacement text of any substitutions, are  themselves  subject  to
       parameter  expansion,  command  substitution, and arithmetic expansion.
       In addition to the following operations, the colon modifiers  described
       in  the	section	 `Modifiers' in the section `History Expansion' can be
       applied:	 for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs string substitution  on
       the expansion of parameter $i.

       ${name}
	      The  value,  if  any, of the parameter name is substituted.  The
	      braces are required if the expansion is to be followed by a let‐
	      ter,  digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted as part
	      of name.	In addition, more complicated  forms  of  substitution
	      usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only
	      apply if the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set,  are  a  single  sub‐
	      script  or  any colon modifiers appearing after the name, or any
	      of the characters `^', `=', `~', `#' or `+' appearing before the
	      name, all of which work with or without braces.

	      If  name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is not
	      set, then the value of each element of name is substituted,  one
	      element  per word.  Otherwise, the expansion results in one word
	      only; with KSH_ARRAYS, this is the first element	of  an	array.
	      No   field   splitting   is   done  on  the  result  unless  the
	      SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  is	 set.	See  also  the	flags  =   and
	      s:string:.

       ${+name}
	      If  name is the name of a set parameter `1' is substituted, oth‐
	      erwise `0' is substituted.

       ${name-word}
       ${name:-word}
	      If name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then  substi‐
	      tute  its	 value; otherwise substitute word.  In the second form
	      name may be omitted, in which case word is always substituted.

       ${name+word}
       ${name:+word}
	      If name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then  substi‐
	      tute word; otherwise substitute nothing.

       ${name=word}
       ${name:=word}
       ${name::=word}
	      In  the first form, if name is unset then set it to word; in the
	      second form, if name is unset or null then set it to  word;  and
	      in  the  third  form,  unconditionally set name to word.	In all
	      forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.

       ${name?word}
       ${name:?word}
	      In the first form, if name is set, or in the second form if name
	      is  both set and non-null, then substitute its value; otherwise,
	      print word and exit from the shell.  Interactive shells  instead
	      return  to the prompt.  If word is omitted, then a standard mes‐
	      sage is printed.

       In any of the above expressions that test a variable and substitute  an
       alternate  word,	 note  that  you can use standard shell quoting in the
       word  value  to	selectively  override  the  splitting  done   by   the
       SH_WORD_SPLIT option and the = flag, but not splitting by the s:string:
       flag.

       In the following expressions, when name is an array and	the  substitu‐
       tion is not quoted, or if the `(@)' flag or the name[@] syntax is used,
       matching and replacement is performed on each array element separately.

       ${name#pattern}
       ${name##pattern}
	      If the pattern matches the beginning of the value of name,  then
	      substitute  the  value of name with the matched portion deleted;
	      otherwise, just substitute the value  of	name.	In  the	 first
	      form,  the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second
	      form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name%pattern}
       ${name%%pattern}
	      If the pattern matches the end of the value of name,  then  sub‐
	      stitute the value of name with the matched portion deleted; oth‐
	      erwise, just substitute the value of name.  In the  first	 form,
	      the  smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second form,
	      the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name:#pattern}
	      If the pattern matches the value of name,	 then  substitute  the
	      empty  string; otherwise, just substitute the value of name.  If
	      name is an array the matching array elements  are	 removed  (use
	      the `(M)' flag to remove the non-matched elements).

       ${name:|arrayname}
	      If  arrayname is the name (N.B., not contents) of an array vari‐
	      able, then any elements contained in arrayname are removed  from
	      the substitution of name.	 If the substitution is scalar, either
	      because name is a scalar variable or the expression  is  quoted,
	      the  elements of arrayname are instead tested against the entire
	      expression.

       ${name:*arrayname}
	      Similar to the preceding subsitution, but in the opposite sense,
	      so that entries present in both the original substitution and as
	      elements of arrayname are retained and others removed.

       ${name:offset}
       ${name:offset:length}
	      This syntax gives effects similar to parameter  subscripting  in
	      the  form $name[start,end], but is compatible with other shells;
	      note that both offset and	 length	 are  interpreted  differently
	      from the components of a subscript.

	      If offset is non-negative, then if the variable name is a scalar
	      substitute the contents  starting	 offset	 characters  from  the
	      first  character	of the string, and if name is an array substi‐
	      tute elements starting offset elements from the  first  element.
	      If length is given, substitute that many characters or elements,
	      otherwise the entire rest of the scalar or array.

	      A positive offset is always treated as the offset of a character
	      or  element  in  name from the first character or element of the
	      array (this is different from native  zsh	 subscript  notation).
	      Hence  0	refers to the first character or element regardless of
	      the setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS.

	      A negative offset counts backwards from the end of the scalar or
	      array,  so that -1 corresponds to the last character or element,
	      and so on.

	      When positive, length counts from the offset position toward the
	      end  of  the scalar or array.  When negative, length counts back
	      from the end.  If this results in a position smaller  than  off‐
	      set, a diagnostic is printed and nothing is substituted.

	      The option MULTIBYTE is obeyed, i.e. the offset and length count
	      multibyte characters where appropriate.

	      offset and length undergo the same set of shell substitutions as
	      for  scalar  assignment;	in  addition, they are then subject to
	      arithmetic evaluation.  Hence, for example

		     print ${foo:3}
		     print ${foo: 1 + 2}
		     print ${foo:$(( 1 + 2))}
		     print ${foo:$(echo 1 + 2)}

	      all have the same effect, extracting the string starting at  the
	      fourth  character	 of  $foo  if  the  substution would otherwise
	      return a scalar, or the array starting at the fourth element  if
	      $foo   would  return  an	array.	 Note  that  with  the	option
	      KSH_ARRAYS $foo always returns a scalar (regardless of  the  use
	      of  the  offset syntax) and a form such as $foo[*]:3 is required
	      to extract elements of an array named foo.

	      If offset is negative, the - may not  appear  immediately	 after
	      the  : as this indicates the ${name:-word} form of substitution.
	      Instead, a space may be inserted	before	the  -.	  Furthermore,
	      neither offset nor length may begin with an alphabetic character
	      or & as these are used to indicate history-style modifiers.   To
	      substitute  a value from a variable, the recommended approach is
	      to precede it with a $ as this signifies the intention  (parame‐
	      ter substitution can easily be rendered unreadable); however, as
	      arithmetic substitution  is  performed,  the  expression	${var:
	      offs} does work, retrieving the offset from $offs.

	      For  further  compatibility with other shells there is a special
	      case for array offset 0.	This usually  accesses	to  the	 first
	      element  of  the array.  However, if the substitution refers the
	      positional parameter array, e.g. $@ or $*, then offset 0 instead
	      refers to $0, offset 1 refers to $1, and so on.  In other words,
	      the  positional  parameter  array	 is  effectively  extended  by
	      prepending  $0.  Hence ${*:0:1} substitutes $0 and ${*:1:1} sub‐
	      stitutes $1.

       ${name/pattern/repl}
       ${name//pattern/repl}
	      Replace the longest possible match of pattern in	the  expansion
	      of  parameter name by string repl.  The first form replaces just
	      the first occurrence, the second	form  all  occurrences.	  Both
	      pattern  and  repl are subject to double-quoted substitution, so
	      that expressions like ${name/$opat/$npat} will  work,  but  note
	      the  usual rule that pattern characters in $opat are not treated
	      specially unless either the option GLOB_SUBST is set,  or	 $opat
	      is instead substituted as ${~opat}.

	      The pattern may begin with a `#', in which case the pattern must
	      match at the start of the string, or `%', in which case it  must
	      match  at	 the end of the string, or `#%' in which case the pat‐
	      tern must match the entire string.  The repl  may	 be  an	 empty
	      string,  in  which  case	the final `/' may also be omitted.  To
	      quote the final `/' in other cases it should be  preceded	 by  a
	      single backslash; this is not necessary if the `/' occurs inside
	      a substituted parameter.	Note also that the `#',	 `%'  and  `#%
	      are  not	active	if  they occur inside a substituted parameter,
	      even at the start.

	      The first `/' may be preceded by a `:', in which case the	 match
	      will  only succeed if it matches the entire word.	 Note also the
	      effect of the I and S parameter expansion flags below;  however,
	      the flags M, R, B, E and N are not useful.

	      For example,

		     foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
		     print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
		     print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}

	      Here, the `~' ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pat‐
	      tern rather than a plain string.	In the first case, the longest
	      match for t*e is substituted and the result is `spy star', while
	      in the second case, the  shortest	 matches  are  taken  and  the
	      result is `spy spy lispy star'.

       ${#spec}
	      If spec is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length
	      in characters of the result instead of the  result  itself.   If
	      spec  is	an array expression, substitute the number of elements
	      of the result.  This has the side-effect that joining is skipped
	      even  in quoted forms, which may affect other sub-expressions in
	      spec.  Note that `^', `=', and `~', below, must  appear  to  the
	      left of `#' when these forms are combined.

       ${^spec}
	      Turn  on	the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation of spec;
	      if the `^' is doubled, turn it off.  When this  option  is  set,
	      array expansions of the form foo${xx}bar, where the parameter xx
	      is set to	 (a  b	c),  are  substituted  with  `fooabar  foobbar
	      foocbar'	instead	 of  the  default `fooa b cbar'.  Note that an
	      empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

	      Internally, each such expansion is converted into the equivalent
	      list    for    brace    expansion.     E.g.,   ${^var}   becomes
	      {$var[1],$var[2],...}, and is processed as described in the sec‐
	      tion  `Brace  Expansion'	below.	 If  word splitting is also in
	      effect the $var[N] may themselves be split into  different  list
	      elements.

       ${=spec}
	      Perform  word splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT during
	      the evaluation of spec, but regardless of whether the  parameter
	      appears  in  double  quotes; if the `=' is doubled, turn it off.
	      This forces parameter expansions to be split into separate words
	      before  substitution, using IFS as a delimiter.  This is done by
	      default in most other shells.

	      Note that splitting is applied to word in the  assignment	 forms
	      of  spec	before	the  assignment	 to  name  is performed.  This
	      affects the result of array assignments with the A flag.

       ${~spec}
	      Turn on the GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec; if the
	      `~'  is  doubled,	 turn  it  off.	  When this option is set, the
	      string resulting from the expansion will	be  interpreted	 as  a
	      pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in filename expansion
	      and filename generation and pattern-matching contexts  like  the
	      right hand side of the `=' and `!=' operators in conditions.

	      In  nested  substitutions, note that the effect of the ~ applies
	      to the result of the current level of substitution.  A surround‐
	      ing  pattern  operation on the result may cancel it.  Hence, for
	      example, if the parameter foo is set to  *,  ${~foo//\*/*.c}  is
	      substituted  by  the pattern *.c, which may be expanded by file‐
	      name  generation,	 but  ${${~foo}//\*/*.c}  substitutes  to  the
	      string *.c, which will not be further expanded.

       If  a ${...} type parameter expression or a $(...) type command substi‐
       tution is used in place of name above, it is  expanded  first  and  the
       result is used as if it were the value of name.	Thus it is possible to
       perform nested operations:  ${${foo#head}%tail} substitutes  the	 value
       of  $foo	 with both `head' and `tail' deleted.  The form with $(...) is
       often useful in combination with the  flags  described  next;  see  the
       examples	 below.	  Each	name or nested ${...} in a parameter expansion
       may also be followed by a subscript expression as  described  in	 Array
       Parameters in zshparam(1).

       Note  that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in which
       case  only  the	part  inside  is  treated  as  quoted;	for   example,
       ${(f)"$(foo)"}  quotes  the  result  of $(foo), but the flag `(f)' (see
       below) is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions.   Note  fur‐
       ther that quotes are themselves nested in this context; for example, in
       "${(@f)"$(foo)"}", there are two sets of quotes,	 one  surrounding  the
       whole  expression,  the	other  (redundant)  surrounding	 the $(foo) as
       before.

   Parameter Expansion Flags
       If the opening brace is directly followed by  an	 opening  parenthesis,
       the  string  up	to the matching closing parenthesis will be taken as a
       list of flags.  In cases where repeating a flag is meaningful, the rep‐
       etitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(q%q%q)' means the same
       thing as the more readable `(%%qqq)'.  The  following  flags  are  sup‐
       ported:

       #      Evaluate	the  resulting words as numeric expressions and output
	      the characters corresponding to  the  resulting  integer.	  Note
	      that  this  form	is entirely distinct from use of the # without
	      parentheses.

	      If the MULTIBYTE option is set and the number  is	 greater  than
	      127  (i.e.  not  an  ASCII character) it is treated as a Unicode
	      character.

       %      Expand all % escapes in the resulting words in the same  way  as
	      in prompts (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)). If
	      this flag is given twice, full prompt expansion is done  on  the
	      resulting words, depending on the setting of the PROMPT_PERCENT,
	      PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.

       @      In double quotes, array elements are put	into  separate	words.
	      E.g.,   `"${(@)foo}"'   is   equivalent	to  `"${foo[@]}"'  and
	      `"${(@)foo[1,2]}"' is the same as `"$foo[1]"  "$foo[2]"'.	  This
	      is  distinct  from field splitting by the f, s or z flags, which
	      still applies within each array element.

       A      Create an array parameter with  `${...=...}',  `${...:=...}'  or
	      `${...::=...}'.	If  this flag is repeated (as in `AA'), create
	      an associative array parameter.  Assignment is made before sort‐
	      ing  or  padding; if field splitting is active, the word part is
	      split before assignment.	The name part  may  be	a  subscripted
	      range for ordinary arrays; the word part must be converted to an
	      array, for example by using `${(AA)=name=...}' to activate field
	      splitting, when creating an associative array.

       a      Sort  in	array  index  order;  when  combined  with `O' sort in
	      reverse array index order.  Note that `a' is  therefore  equiva‐
	      lent  to the default but `Oa' is useful for obtaining an array's
	      elements in reverse order.

       c      With ${#name}, count the total number of characters in an array,
	      as  if  the elements were concatenated with spaces between them.
	      This is not a true join of the array, so other expressions  used
	      with  this  flag may have an effect on the elements of the array
	      before it is counted.

       C      Capitalize the resulting words.  `Words' in this case refers  to
	      sequences	 of  alphanumeric characters separated by non-alphanu‐
	      merics, not to words that result from field splitting.

       D      Assume the string or  array  elements  contain  directories  and
	      attempt  to  substitute the leading part of these by names.  The
	      remainder of the path (the whole of it if the leading  part  was
	      not  subsituted)	is then quoted so that the whole string can be
	      used as a shell argument.	 This is the reverse of `~'  substitu‐
	      tion:  see the section FILENAME EXPANSION below.

       e      Perform parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
	      expansion on the result. Such expansions can be nested  but  too
	      deep recursion may have unpredictable effects.

       f      Split  the result of the expansion at newlines. This is a short‐
	      hand for `ps:\n:'.

       F      Join the words of arrays together using newline as a  separator.
	      This is a shorthand for `pj:\n:'.

       g:opts:
	      Process  escape  sequences like the echo builtin when no options
	      are given (g::).	With the o option, octal escapes don't take  a
	      leading  zero.   With the c option, sequences like `^X' are also
	      processed.  With the e  option,  processes  `\M-t'  and  similar
	      sequences	 like  the  print  builtin.   With both of the o and e
	      options, behaves like the print builtin except that in  none  of
	      these modes is `\c' interpreted.

       i      Sort case-insensitively.	May be combined with `n' or `O'.

       k      If  name	refers	to  an	associative array, substitute the keys
	      (element names) rather than the values of	 the  elements.	  Used
	      with  subscripts	(including  ordinary arrays), force indices or
	      keys to be substituted even if the subscript form refers to val‐
	      ues.   However,  this  flag  may	not be combined with subscript
	      ranges.

       L      Convert all letters in the result to lower case.

       n      Sort decimal integers numerically; if the first differing	 char‐
	      acters  of  two test strings are not digits, sorting is lexical.
	      Integers with more initial zeroes are sorted before  those  with
	      fewer  or	 none.	 Hence	the  array `foo1 foo02 foo2 foo3 foo20
	      foo23' is sorted into the order shown.  May be combined with `i'
	      or `O'.

       o      Sort  the resulting words in ascending order; if this appears on
	      its own the sorting is lexical and  case-sensitive  (unless  the
	      locale renders it case-insensitive).  Sorting in ascending order
	      is the default for other forms of sorting, so this is ignored if
	      combined with `a', `i' or `n'.

       O      Sort  the	 resulting words in descending order; `O' without `a',
	      `i' or `n' sorts in reverse lexical order.  May be combined with
	      `a', `i' or `n' to reverse the order of sorting.

       P      This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as
	      a further parameter name, whose value will be used where	appro‐
	      priate.	Note  that flags set with one of the typeset family of
	      commands (in particular case transformations) are not applied to
	      the value of name used in this fashion.

	      If  used	with  a	 nested parameter or command substitution, the
	      result of that will be taken as a parameter  name	 in  the  same
	      way.   For  example,  if	you  have `foo=bar' and `bar=baz', the
	      strings ${(P)foo}, ${(P)${foo}}, and ${(P)$(echo bar)}  will  be
	      expanded to `baz'.

       q      Quote  characters that are special to the shell in the resulting
	      words with backslashes; unprintable or  invalid  characters  are
	      quoted  using  the  $'\NNN'  form, with separate quotes for each
	      octet.

	      If this flag is given twice, the resulting words are  quoted  in
	      single  quotes  and  if  it  is given three times, the words are
	      quoted in double quotes; in these forms no special  handling  of
	      unprintable  or invalid characters is attempted.	If the flag is
	      given four times, the words are quoted in single quotes preceded
	      by  a  $.	 Note that in all three of these forms quoting is done
	      unconditionally, even if	this  does  not	 change	 the  way  the
	      resulting string would be interpreted by the shell.

	      If a q- is given (only a single q may appear), a minimal form of
	      single quoting is used that only quotes the string if needed  to
	      protect  special characters.  Typically this form gives the most
	      readable output.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.

       t      Use a string describing the type	of  the	 parameter  where  the
	      value  of	 the  parameter would usually appear. This string con‐
	      sists of keywords separated by hyphens (`-'). The first  keyword
	      in  the  string  describes  the  main  type,  it	can  be one of
	      `scalar', `array',  `integer',  `float'  or  `association'.  The
	      other keywords describe the type in more detail:

	      local  for local parameters

	      left   for left justified parameters

	      right_blanks
		     for right justified parameters with leading blanks

	      right_zeros
		     for right justified parameters with leading zeros

	      lower  for parameters whose value is converted to all lower case
		     when it is expanded

	      upper  for parameters whose value is converted to all upper case
		     when it is expanded

	      readonly
		     for readonly parameters

	      tag    for tagged parameters

	      export for exported parameters

	      unique for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of dupli‐
		     cated values

	      hide   for parameters with the `hide' flag

	      special
		     for special parameters defined by the shell

       u      Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.

       U      Convert all letters in the result to upper case.

       v      Used with k, substitute (as two consecutive words) both the  key
	      and the value of each associative array element.	Used with sub‐
	      scripts, force values to be substituted even  if	the  subscript
	      form refers to indices or keys.

       V      Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.

       w      With  ${#name}, count words in arrays or strings; the s flag may
	      be used to set a word delimiter.

       W      Similar to w  with  the  difference  that	 empty	words  between
	      repeated delimiters are also counted.

       X      With  this  flag,	 parsing  errors occurring with the Q, e and #
	      flags or the pattern matching forms  such	 as  `${name#pattern}'
	      are reported.  Without the flag, errors are silently ignored.

       z      Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing
	      to find the words, i.e. taking into account any quoting  in  the
	      value.   Comments	 are  not  treated  specially  but as ordinary
	      strings, similar to interactive shells with the INTERACTIVE_COM‐
	      MENTS  option  unset  (however, see the Z flag below for related
	      options)

	      Note that this is done very late,	 even  later  than  the	 `(s)'
	      flag.  So to access single words in the result use nested expan‐
	      sions as in `${${(z)foo}[2]}'. Likewise, to remove the quotes in
	      the resulting words use `${(Q)${(z)foo}}'.

       0      Split  the  result  of  the  expansion on null bytes.  This is a
	      shorthand for `ps:\0:'.

       The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as
       shown.  Any character, or the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]',
       or `<...>', may be used in place of a colon  as	delimiters,  but  note
       that when a flag takes more than one argument, a matched pair of delim‐
       iters must surround each argument.

       p      Recognize the same escape sequences  as  the  print  builtin  in
	      string arguments to any of the flags described below that follow
	      this argument.

       ~      Force string arguments to any of the  flags  below  that	follow
	      within  the parentheses to be treated as patterns.  Compare with
	      a ~ outside parentheses, which  forces  the  entire  substituted
	      string to be treated as a pattern.  Hence, for example,
	      [[ "?" = ${(~j.|.)array} ]]
       with  the  EXTENDED_GLOB option set succeeds if and only if $array con‐
       tains the string `?' as an element.  The argument may  be  repeated  to
       toggle the behaviour; its effect only lasts to the end of the parenthe‐
       sised group.

       j:string:
	      Join the words of arrays together using string as	 a  separator.
	      Note  that  this	occurs before field splitting by the s:string:
	      flag or the SH_WORD_SPLIT option.

       l:expr::string1::string2:
	      Pad the resulting words on the left.  Each word  will  be	 trun‐
	      cated if required and placed in a field expr characters wide.

	      The arguments :string1: and :string2: are optional; neither, the
	      first, or both may be given.  Note that the same pairs of delim‐
	      iters  must  be used for each of the three arguments.  The space
	      to the left will be filled with string1 (concatenated  as	 often
	      as  needed)  or spaces if string1 is not given.  If both string1
	      and string2 are given, string2 is inserted once directly to  the
	      left  of	each  word,  truncated if necessary, before string1 is
	      used to produce any remaining padding.

	      If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, the flag  m	 may  also  be
	      given,  in which case widths will be used for the calculation of
	      padding; otherwise individual multibyte characters  are  treated
	      as occupying one unit of width.

	      If  the  MULTIBYTE  option  is  not  in effect, each byte in the
	      string is treated as occupying one unit of width.

	      Control characters are always assumed to be one unit wide;  this
	      allows  the  mechanism  to be used for generating repetitions of
	      control characters.

       m      Only useful together with one of the flags l or r or with the  #
	      length operator when the MULTIBYTE option is in effect.  Use the
	      character width reported by the system in calculating  how  much
	      of  the  string it occupies or the overall length of the string.
	      Most printable characters have a width of one unit, however cer‐
	      tain  Asian character sets and certain special effects use wider
	      characters; combining characters have zero width.	 Non-printable
	      characters are arbitrarily counted as zero width; how they would
	      actually be displayed will vary.

	      If the m is repeated, the character either counts	 zero  (if  it
	      has zero width), else one.  For printable character strings this
	      has the effect of counting the number of glyphs  (visibly	 sepa‐
	      rate characters), except for the case where combining characters
	      themselves have non-zero width (true in certain alphabets).

       r:expr::string1::string2:
	      As l, but pad the words on the right and insert string2  immedi‐
	      ately to the right of the string to be padded.

	      Left  and	 right padding may be used together.  In this case the
	      strategy is to apply left padding to the	first  half  width  of
	      each  of	the  resulting	words, and right padding to the second
	      half.  If the string to be padded has odd width the  extra  pad‐
	      ding is applied on the left.

       s:string:
	      Force  field  splitting  at  the	separator string.  Note that a
	      string of two or more characters means that  all	of  them  must
	      match  in	 sequence;  this  differs from the treatment of two or
	      more characters in the IFS parameter.  See also the =  flag  and
	      the  SH_WORD_SPLIT option.  An empty string may also be given in
	      which case every character will be a separate element.

	      For historical reasons, the usual	 behaviour  that  empty	 array
	      elements	are  retained  inside  double  quotes  is disabled for
	      arrays generated by splitting; hence the following:

		     line="one::three"
		     print -l "${(s.:.)line}"

	      produces two lines of output for one and three  and  elides  the
	      empty  field.  To override this behaviour, supply the "(@)" flag
	      as well, i.e.  "${(@s.:.)line}".

       Z:opts:
	      As z but takes a combination of option letters between a follow‐
	      ing pair of delimiter characters.	 With no options the effect is
	      identical to z.  (Z+c+) causes comments to be parsed as a string
	      and retained; any field in the resulting array beginning with an
	      unquoted comment character is a comment.	(Z+C+) causes comments
	      to  be  parsed  and removed.  The rule for comments is standard:
	      anything between a word starting with  the  third	 character  of
	      $HISTCHARS,  default  #,	up  to	the next newline is a comment.
	      (Z+n+) causes unquoted newlines to be treated as ordinary white‐
	      space,  else  they  are treated as if they are shell code delim‐
	      iters and converted to semicolons.  Options are combined	within
	      the same set of delimiters, e.g. (Z+Cn+).

       _:flags:
	      The  underscore (_) flag is reserved for future use.  As of this
	      revision of zsh, there are no valid flags; anything following an
	      underscore,  other  than an empty pair of delimiters, is treated
	      as an error, and the flag itself has no effect.

       The following flags are meaningful with the  ${...#...}	or  ${...%...}
       forms.  The S and I flags may also be used with the ${.../...} forms.

       S      Search  substrings  as  well as beginnings or ends; with # start
	      from the beginning and with % start from the end of the  string.
	      With  substitution  via  ${.../...}  or  ${...//...},  specifies
	      non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead of the long‐
	      est match should be replaced.

       I:expr:
	      Search  the  exprth  match  (where  expr evaluates to a number).
	      This only applies when searching for substrings, either with the
	      S	 flag,	or  with  ${.../...} (only the exprth match is substi‐
	      tuted) or ${...//...} (all matches from the exprth on  are  sub‐
	      stituted).  The default is to take the first match.

	      The  exprth  match  is  counted such that there is either one or
	      zero matches from each starting position in the string, although
	      for  global  substitution	 matches overlapping previous replace‐
	      ments are ignored.  With the ${...%...} and  ${...%%...}	forms,
	      the starting position for the match moves backwards from the end
	      as the index increases, while with the other forms it moves for‐
	      ward from the start.

	      Hence with the string
		     which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
	      substitutions  of	 the form ${(SI:N:)string#w*ch} as N increases
	      from 1 will match	 and  remove  `which',	`witch',  `witch'  and
	      `wich';  the form using `##' will match and remove `which switch
	      is the right switch for Ipswich', `witch is the right switch for
	      Ipswich',	 `witch	 for  Ipswich'	and `wich'. The form using `%'
	      will remove the same matches as for `#', but in  reverse	order,
	      and the form using `%%' will remove the same matches as for `##'
	      in reverse order.

       B      Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.

       E      Include the index of the end of the match in the result.

       M      Include the matched portion in the result.

       N      Include the length of the match in the result.

       R      Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).

   Rules
       Here is a summary of the rules  for  substitution;  this	 assumes  that
       braces are present around the substitution, i.e. ${...}.	 Some particu‐
       lar examples are given below.  Note  that  the  Zsh  Development	 Group
       accepts	no  responsibility for any brain damage which may occur during
       the reading of the following rules.

       1. Nested substitution
	      If multiple nested ${...} forms  are  present,  substitution  is
	      performed	 from the inside outwards.  At each level, the substi‐
	      tution takes account of whether the current value is a scalar or
	      an  array,  whether  the whole substitution is in double quotes,
	      and what flags are supplied to the current  level	 of  substitu‐
	      tion,  just  as  if  the nested substitution were the outermost.
	      The flags are not propagated up to enclosing substitutions;  the
	      nested  substitution  will return either a scalar or an array as
	      determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting.  All the
	      following	 steps	take  place  where applicable at all levels of
	      substitution.  Note that, unless the `(P)' flag is present,  the
	      flags  and  any  subscripts  apply  directly to the value of the
	      nested  substitution;  for  example,  the	 expansion   ${${foo}}
	      behaves exactly the same as ${foo}.

	      At  each	nested	level  of  substitution, the substituted words
	      undergo all forms of single-word substitution (i.e. not filename
	      generation),  including  command substitution, arithmetic expan‐
	      sion and filename expansion (i.e. leading ~ and =).   Thus,  for
	      example,	${${:-=cat}:h}	expands to the directory where the cat
	      program resides.	(Explanation: the internal substitution has no
	      parameter	 but  a default value =cat, which is expanded by file‐
	      name expansion to a  full	 path;	the  outer  substitution  then
	      applies  the  modifier  :h  and  takes the directory part of the
	      path.)

       2. Internal parameter flags
	      Any parameter flags set by one of the  typeset  family  of  com‐
	      mands,  in particular the L, R, Z, u and l flags for padding and
	      capitalization, are applied directly  to	the  parameter	value.
	      Note  these flags are options to the command, e.g. `typeset -Z';
	      they are not the same as the flags used within parameter substi‐
	      tutions.

       3. Parameter subscripting
	      If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such
	      as ${var[3]}, the effect of subscripting is applied directly  to
	      the  parameter.	Subscripts are evaluated left to right; subse‐
	      quent subscripts apply to the scalar or array value  yielded  by
	      the  previous  subscript.	 Thus if var is an array, ${var[1][2]}
	      is the second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is
	      the entire third word (the second word of the range of words two
	      through four of the original array).  Any number	of  subscripts
	      may appear.  Flags such as (k) and (v) which alter the result of
	      subscripting are applied.

       4. Parameter name replacement
	      The effect of any (P) flag, which treats the value so far	 as  a
	      parameter	 name and replaces it with the corresponding value, is
	      applied.

       5. Double-quoted joining
	      If the value after this process is an array, and	the  substitu‐
	      tion  appears  in double quotes, and neither an (@) flag nor a #
	      length operator is present at the current level, then  words  of
	      the  value  are joined with the first character of the parameter
	      $IFS, by default a space, between each word (single word	arrays
	      are not modified).  If the (j) flag is present, that is used for
	      joining instead of $IFS.

       6. Nested subscripting
	      Any remaining subscripts (i.e. of	 a  nested  substitution)  are
	      evaluated	 at this point, based on whether the value is an array
	      or a scalar.  As with 3., multiple subscripts can appear.	  Note
	      that  ${foo[2,4][2]} is thus equivalent to ${${foo[2,4]}[2]} and
	      also to "${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substitution  returns
	      an  array	 in  both  cases), but not to "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the
	      nested substitution returns a scalar because of the quotes).

       7. Modifiers
	      Any modifiers, as specified by a trailing `#', `%', `/'  (possi‐
	      bly  doubled) or by a set of modifiers of the form :... (see the
	      section `Modifiers' in the  section  `History  Expansion'),  are
	      applied to the words of the value at this level.

       8. Character evaluation
	      Any  (#)	flag  is applied, evaluating the result so far numeri‐
	      cally as a character.

       9. Length
	      Any initial # modifier, i.e. in the form	${#var},  is  used  to
	      evaluate the length of the expression so far.

       10. Forced joining
	      If  the  `(j)'  flag is present, or no `(j)' flag is present but
	      the string is to be split as given by rule 11., and joining  did
	      not  take	 place	at  step 5., any words in the value are joined
	      together using the given string or the first character  of  $IFS
	      if  none.	 Note that the `(F)' flag implicitly supplies a string
	      for joining in this manner.

       11. Simple word splitting
	      If one of the `(s)' or `(f)' flags are present, or the `=' spec‐
	      ifier  was  present  (e.g. ${=var}), the word is split on occur‐
	      rences of the specified string, or (for = with  neither  of  the
	      two flags present) any of the characters in $IFS.

	      If  no `(s)', `(f)' or `=' was given, but the word is not quoted
	      and the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set, the word is split on occur‐
	      rences  of  any of the characters in $IFS.  Note this step, too,
	      takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.

       12. Case modification
	      Any case modification from one of the flags (L), (U) or  (C)  is
	      applied.

       13. Escape sequence replacement
	      First any replacements from the (g) flag are performed, then any
	      prompt-style formatting from the (%) family of flags is applied.

       14. Quote application
	      Any quoting or unquoting using (q) and (Q) and related flags  is
	      applied.

       15. Directory naming
	      Any directory name substitution using (D) flag is applied.

       16. Visibility enhancement
	      Any  modifications to make characters visible using the (V) flag
	      are applied.

       17. Lexical word splitting
	      If the '(z)' flag or one of the  forms  of  the  '(Z)'  flag  is
	      present,	the  word is split as if it were a shell command line,
	      so that quotation marks and other	 metacharacters	 are  used  to
	      decide  what constitutes a word.	Note this form of splitting is
	      entirely distinct from that described by rule 11.: it  does  not
	      use $IFS, and does not cause forced joining.

       18. Uniqueness
	      If the result is an array and the `(u)' flag was present, dupli‐
	      cate elements are removed from the array.

       19. Ordering
	      If the result is still an array and one of the  `(o)'  or	 `(O)'
	      flags was present, the array is reordered.

       20. Re-evaluation
	      Any  `(e)'  flag	is  applied  to	 the  value,  forcing it to be
	      re-examined for new parameter substitutions, but also  for  com‐
	      mand and arithmetic substitutions.

       21. Padding
	      Any padding of the value by the `(l.fill.)' or `(r.fill.)' flags
	      is applied.

       22. Semantic joining
	      In contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word  to
	      result,  all  words are rejoined with the first character of IFS
	      between.	So in `${(P)${(f)lines}}' the  value  of  ${lines}  is
	      split  at	 newlines,  but then must be joined again before the P
	      flag can be applied.

	      If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.

       23. Empty argument removal
	      If the substitution  does	 not  appear  in  double  quotes,  any
	      resulting zero-length argument, whether from a scalar or an ele‐
	      ment of an array, is elided from the list of arguments  inserted
	      into the command line.

	      Strictly speaking, the removal happens later as the same happens
	      with other forms of substitution; the point to note here is sim‐
	      ply that it occurs after any of the above parameter operations.

   Examples
       The  flag  f  is	 useful	 to split a double-quoted substitution line by
       line.  For example, ${(f)"$(<file)"} substitutes the contents  of  file
       divided	so  that each line is an element of the resulting array.  Com‐
       pare this with the effect of $(<file) alone, which divides the file  up
       by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire con‐
       tent of the file a single string.

       The following illustrates the rules for	nested	parameter  expansions.
       Suppose that $foo contains the array (bar baz):

       "${(@)${foo}[1]}"
	      This  produces  the  result  b.	First,	the inner substitution
	      "${foo}", which has no array (@) flag, produces  a  single  word
	      result "bar baz".	 The outer substitution "${(@)...[1]}" detects
	      that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `(@)' flag) the sub‐
	      script picks the first character.

       "${${(@)foo}[1]}"
	      This produces the result `bar'.  In this case, the inner substi‐
	      tution "${(@)foo}" produces the array `(bar  baz)'.   The	 outer
	      substitution "${...[1]}" detects that this is an array and picks
	      the first word.  This is similar to the simple case "${foo[1]}".

       As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo
       contains the array `(ax1 bx1)'.	Then

       ${(s/x/)foo}
	      produces the words `a', `1 b' and `1'.

       ${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
	      produces `a', `1', `b' and `1'.

       ${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
	      produces	`a'  and ` b' (note the extra space).  As substitution
	      occurs before either joining or splitting, the operation	 first
	      generates	 the  modified	array (ax bx), which is joined to give
	      "ax bx", and then split to give `a', ` b'	 and  `'.   The	 final
	      empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.

COMMAND SUBSTITUTION
       A  command  enclosed  in	 parentheses  preceded	by a dollar sign, like
       `$(...)', or quoted with grave accents, like ``...`', is replaced  with
       its  standard  output, with any trailing newlines deleted.  If the sub‐
       stitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the output is  broken  into
       words  using  the  IFS parameter.  The substitution `$(cat foo)' may be
       replaced by the equivalent but faster `$(<foo)'.	 In  either  case,  if
       the  option GLOB_SUBST is set, the output is eligible for filename gen‐
       eration.

ARITHMETIC EXPANSION
       A string of the form `$[exp]' or `$((exp))'  is	substituted  with  the
       value  of the arithmetic expression exp.	 exp is subjected to parameter
       expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion before	it  is
       evaluated.  See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation'.

BRACE EXPANSION
       A  string  of the form `foo{xx,yy,zz}bar' is expanded to the individual
       words `fooxxbar', `fooyybar' and `foozzbar'.   Left-to-right  order  is
       preserved.   This  construct  may  be  nested.  Commas may be quoted in
       order to include them literally in a word.

       An expression of the form `{n1..n2}', where n1 and n2 are integers,  is
       expanded to every number between n1 and n2 inclusive.  If either number
       begins with a zero, all the resulting numbers will be padded with lead‐
       ing  zeroes to that minimum width, but for negative numbers the - char‐
       acter is also included in the width.  If the numbers are in  decreasing
       order the resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.

       An  expression  of  the	form  `{n1..n2..n3}', where n1, n2, and n3 are
       integers, is expanded as above, but only	 every	n3th  number  starting
       from n1 is output.  If n3 is negative the numbers are output in reverse
       order, this is slightly different from simply swapping n1 and n2 in the
       case  that  the	step n3 doesn't evenly divide the range.  Zero padding
       can be specified in any of the three  numbers,  specifying  it  in  the
       third  can  be  useful to pad for example `{-99..100..01}' which is not
       possible to specify by putting a 0 on either of the first  two  numbers
       (i.e. pad to two characters).

       If  a  brace  expression	 matches  none	of the above forms, it is left
       unchanged, unless the option  BRACE_CCL	(an  abbreviation  for	`brace
       character  class')  is  set.  In that case, it is expanded to a list of
       the individual characters between the braces sorted into the  order  of
       the characters in the ASCII character set (multibyte characters are not
       currently handled).  The syntax is similar to  a	 [...]	expression  in
       filename	 generation:  `-'  is  treated	specially to denote a range of
       characters, but `^' or `!' as the first character is treated  normally.
       For  example, `{abcdef0-9}' expands to 16 words 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 a b
       c d e f.

       Note that brace expansion is not part  of  filename  generation	(glob‐
       bing);  an  expression  such  as */{foo,bar} is split into two separate
       words */foo and */bar before filename generation takes place.  In  par‐
       ticular,	 note  that  this  is  liable to produce a `no match' error if
       either of the two expressions does not match; this is to be  contrasted
       with  */(foo|bar),  which  is treated as a single pattern but otherwise
       has similar effects.

       To combine brace expansion with array expansion, see the ${^spec}  form
       described in the section Parameter Expansion above.

FILENAME EXPANSION
       Each  word  is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `~'.	 If it
       does, then the word up to a `/', or the end of the word if there is  no
       `/',  is	 checked  to  see  if it can be substituted in one of the ways
       described here.	If so, then  the  `~'  and  the	 checked  portion  are
       replaced with the appropriate substitute value.

       A `~' by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME.  A `~' followed by a
       `+' or a `-' is replaced by  current  or	 previous  working  directory,
       respectively.

       A  `~'  followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that posi‐
       tion in the directory stack.  `~0' is equivalent to `~+', and  `~1'  is
       the  top	 of  the  stack.  `~+' followed by a number is replaced by the
       directory at that position in the directory stack.  `~+0' is equivalent
       to  `~+', and `~+1' is the top of the stack.  `~-' followed by a number
       is replaced by the directory that many positions from the bottom of the
       stack.	`~-0'  is  the	bottom	of  the stack.	The PUSHD_MINUS option
       exchanges the effects of `~+' and `~-' where they  are  followed	 by  a
       number.

   Dynamic named directories
       If  the	function  zsh_directory_name  exists,  or  the	shell variable
       zsh_directory_name_functions exists and contains an array  of  function
       names,  then the functions are used to implement dynamic directory nam‐
       ing.  The functions are tried in order until one returns	 status	 zero,
       so it is important that functions test whether they can handle the case
       in question and return an appropriate status.

       A `~' followed by a  string  namstr  in	unquoted  square  brackets  is
       treated	specially  as  a  dynamic directory name.  Note that the first
       unquoted closing square bracket always terminates  namstr.   The	 shell
       function	 is  passed two arguments: the string n (for name) and namstr.
       It should either set the array reply to a single element which  is  the
       directory  corresponding	 to the name and return status zero (executing
       an assignment as the last  statement  is	 usually  sufficient),	or  it
       should return status non-zero.  In the former case the element of reply
       is used as the directory; in the latter case the substitution is deemed
       to  have	 failed.  If all functions fail and the option NOMATCH is set,
       an error results.

       The functions defined as above are also used to see if a directory  can
       be turned into a name, for example when printing the directory stack or
       when expanding %~ in prompts.  In this case each function is passed two
       arguments:  the	string d (for directory) and the candidate for dynamic
       naming.	The function should either  return  non-zero  status,  if  the
       directory  cannot  be named by the function, or it should set the array
       reply to consist of two elements: the first is the dynamic name for the
       directory (as would appear within `~[...]'), and the second is the pre‐
       fix length of the directory to be replaced.  For example, if the	 trial
       directory   is	/home/myname/src/zsh   and   the   dynamic   name  for
       /home/myname/src (which has 16 characters) is s, then the function sets

	      reply=(s 16)

       The directory name so returned is compared with possible	 static	 names
       for  parts of the directory path, as described below; it is used if the
       prefix length matched (16 in the example) is longer than	 that  matched
       by any static name.

       It  is not a requirement that a function implements both n and d calls;
       for example, it might be	 appropriate  for  certain  dynamic  forms  of
       expansion  not  to  be contracted to names.  In that case any call with
       the first argument d should cause a non-zero status to be returned.

       The completion system calls `zsh_directory_name c' followed by  equiva‐
       lent calls to elements of the array zsh_directory_name_functions, if it
       exists, in order to complete dynamic names for directories.   The  code
       for this should be as for any other completion function as described in
       zshcompsys(1).

       As a working example, here is a function that expands any dynamic names
       beginning  with	the string p: to directories below /home/pws/perforce.
       In this simple case a static name for the directory would  be  just  as
       effective.

	      zsh_directory_name() {
		emulate -L zsh
		setopt extendedglob
		local -a match mbegin mend
		if [[ $1 = d ]]; then
		  # turn the directory into a name
		  if [[ $2 = (#b)(/home/pws/perforce/)([^/]##)* ]]; then
		    typeset -ga reply
		    reply=(p:$match[2] $(( ${#match[1]} + ${#match[2]} )) )
		  else
		    return 1
		  fi
		elif [[ $1 = n ]]; then
		  # turn the name into a directory
		  [[ $2 != (#b)p:(?*) ]] && return 1
		  typeset -ga reply
		  reply=(/home/pws/perforce/$match[1])
		elif [[ $1 = c ]]; then
		  # complete names
		  local expl
		  local -a dirs
		  dirs=(/home/pws/perforce/*(/:t))
		  dirs=(p:${^dirs})
		  _wanted dynamic-dirs expl 'dynamic directory' compadd -S\] -a dirs
		  return
		else
		  return 1
		fi
		return 0
	      }

   Static named directories
       A `~' followed by anything not already covered consisting of any number
       of alphanumeric characters or underscore (`_'), hyphen  (`-'),  or  dot
       (`.')  is  looked up as a named directory, and replaced by the value of
       that named directory if found.  Named directories  are  typically  home
       directories  for	 users on the system.  They may also be defined if the
       text after the `~' is the name of a string shell parameter whose	 value
       begins with a `/'.  Note that trailing slashes will be removed from the
       path to the directory (though the original parameter is not modified).

       It is also possible to define directory names using the	-d  option  to
       the hash builtin.

       When the shell prints a path (e.g. when expanding %~ in prompts or when
       printing the directory stack), the path is checked to see if it	has  a
       named  directory	 as  its  prefix.   If	so, then the prefix portion is
       replaced with a `~' followed by the name of the directory.  The shorter
       of  the two ways of referring to the directory is used, i.e. either the
       directory name or the full path; the name is used if they are the  same
       length.	 The parameters $PWD and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in this
       fashion.

   `=' expansion
       If a word begins with an unquoted `=' and the EQUALS option is set, the
       remainder  of the word is taken as the name of a command.  If a command
       exists by that name, the word is replaced by the full pathname  of  the
       command.

   Notes
       Filename	 expansion  is performed on the right hand side of a parameter
       assignment, including those appearing after  commands  of  the  typeset
       family.	 In  this  case,  the  right  hand  side  will be treated as a
       colon-separated list in the manner of the PATH parameter, so that a `~'
       or  an  `=' following a `:' is eligible for expansion.  All such behav‐
       iour can be disabled by quoting the `~', the `=', or the whole  expres‐
       sion (but not simply the colon); the EQUALS option is also respected.

       If  the option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument in
       the form `identifier=expression' becomes eligible for file expansion as
       described  in  the  previous  paragraph.	  Quoting  the	first `=' also
       inhibits this.

FILENAME GENERATION
       If a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the  characters  `*',
       `(',  `|',  `<',	 `[', or `?', it is regarded as a pattern for filename
       generation, unless the GLOB option  is  unset.	If  the	 EXTENDED_GLOB
       option is set, the `^' and `#' characters also denote a pattern; other‐
       wise they are not treated specially by the shell.

       The word is replaced with a list of sorted  filenames  that  match  the
       pattern.	  If  no  matching  pattern is found, the shell gives an error
       message, unless the NULL_GLOB option is set, in which case the word  is
       deleted;	 or unless the NOMATCH option is unset, in which case the word
       is left unchanged.

       In filename generation, the character `/' must be  matched  explicitly;
       also, a `.' must be matched explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or
       after a `/', unless the GLOB_DOTS option is set.	 No  filename  genera‐
       tion pattern matches the files `.' or `..'.  In other instances of pat‐
       tern matching, the `/' and `.' are not treated specially.

   Glob Operators
       *      Matches any string, including the null string.

       ?      Matches any character.

       [...]  Matches any of the enclosed characters.	Ranges	of  characters
	      can  be  specified by separating two characters by a `-'.	 A `-'
	      or `]' may be matched by including it as the first character  in
	      the  list.   There are also several named classes of characters,
	      in the form `[:name:]' with the following meanings.   The	 first
	      set  use the macros provided by the operating system to test for
	      the given character combinations,	 including  any	 modifications
	      due to local language settings, see ctype(3):

	      [:alnum:]
		     The character is alphanumeric

	      [:alpha:]
		     The character is alphabetic

	      [:ascii:]
		     The  character  is 7-bit, i.e. is a single-byte character
		     without the top bit set.

	      [:blank:]
		     The character is either space or tab

	      [:cntrl:]
		     The character is a control character

	      [:digit:]
		     The character is a decimal digit

	      [:graph:]
		     The character is a printable character other than	white‐
		     space

	      [:lower:]
		     The character is a lowercase letter

	      [:print:]
		     The character is printable

	      [:punct:]
		     The  character  is printable but neither alphanumeric nor
		     whitespace

	      [:space:]
		     The character is whitespace

	      [:upper:]
		     The character is an uppercase letter

	      [:xdigit:]
		     The character is a hexadecimal digit

	      Another set of named classes is handled internally by the	 shell
	      and is not sensitive to the locale:

	      [:IDENT:]
		     The  character is allowed to form part of a shell identi‐
		     fier, such as a parameter name

	      [:IFS:]
		     The character is used as an input field  separator,  i.e.
		     is contained in the IFS parameter

	      [:IFSSPACE:]
		     The  character  is	 an IFS white space character; see the
		     documentation for IFS in the zshparam(1) manual page.

	      [:WORD:]
		     The character is treated as part of a word; this test  is
		     sensitive to the value of the WORDCHARS parameter

	      Note  that the square brackets are additional to those enclosing
	      the whole set of characters, so to test for  a  single  alphanu‐
	      meric  character	you  need `[[:alnum:]]'.  Named character sets
	      can be used alongside other types, e.g. `[[:alpha:]0-9]'.

       [^...]
       [!...] Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in
	      the given set.

       <[x]-[y]>
	      Matches  any  number  in the range x to y, inclusive.  Either of
	      the numbers may be omitted to make the range  open-ended;	 hence
	      `<->' matches any number.	 To match individual digits, the [...]
	      form is more efficient.

	      Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent  to  patterns  of
	      this  form;  for	example, <0-9>* will actually match any number
	      whatsoever at the start of the string, since  the	 `<0-9>'  will
	      match  the first digit, and the `*' will match any others.  This
	      is a trap for the unwary, but is in fact	an  inevitable	conse‐
	      quence  of  the rule that the longest possible match always suc‐
	      ceeds.  Expressions such as  `<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*'	 can  be  used
	      instead.

       (...)  Matches  the  enclosed  pattern.	This is used for grouping.  If
	      the KSH_GLOB option is set, then a `@', `*',  `+',  `?'  or  `!'
	      immediately  preceding the `(' is treated specially, as detailed
	      below. The option SH_GLOB prevents bare parentheses  from	 being
	      used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still available.

	      Note  that  grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it
	      is an error to have a `/' within a group (this only applies  for
	      patterns	used in filename generation).  There is one exception:
	      a group of the form (pat/)# appearing as a complete path segment
	      can match a sequence of directories.  For example, foo/(a*/)#bar
	      matches foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.

       x|y    Matches either x or y.  This operator has lower precedence  than
	      any  other.   The	 `|'  character must be within parentheses, to
	      avoid interpretation as a pipeline.

       ^x     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches anything except the
	      pattern x.  This has a higher precedence than `/', so `^foo/bar'
	      will search directories in `.' except `./foo' for a  file	 named
	      `bar'.

       x~y    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Match anything that matches
	      the pattern x but does not match y.  This has  lower  precedence
	      than  any	 operator except `|', so `*/*~foo/bar' will search for
	      all files in all directories in `.'  and then exclude  `foo/bar'
	      if there was such a match.  Multiple patterns can be excluded by
	      `foo~bar~baz'.  In the exclusion pattern (y), `/'	 and  `.'  are
	      not treated specially the way they usually are in globbing.

       x#     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches zero or more occur‐
	      rences of the pattern x.	This  operator	has  high  precedence;
	      `12#'  is	 equivalent to `1(2#)', rather than `(12)#'.  It is an
	      error for an unquoted `#' to follow something  which  cannot  be
	      repeated;	 this includes an empty string, a pattern already fol‐
	      lowed by `##', or parentheses when part of  a  KSH_GLOB  pattern
	      (for  example,  `!(foo)#'	 is  invalid  and  must be replaced by
	      `*(!(foo))').

       x##    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches one or more	occur‐
	      rences  of  the  pattern	x.  This operator has high precedence;
	      `12##' is equivalent to `1(2##)', rather than `(12)##'.  No more
	      than  two	 active `#' characters may appear together.  (Note the
	      potential clash with glob qualifiers in the form `1(2##)'	 which
	      should therefore be avoided.)

   ksh-like Glob Operators
       If  the KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be modi‐
       fied by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  This character need not
       be unquoted to have special effects, but the `(' must be.

       @(...) Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `(...)'.)

       *(...) Match  any  number  of occurrences.  (Like `(...)#', except that
	      recursive directory searching is not supported.)

       +(...) Match at least one occurrence.   (Like  `(...)##',  except  that
	      recursive directory searching is not supported..)

       ?(...) Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `(|...)'.)

       !(...) Match   anything	but  the  expression  in  parentheses.	 (Like
	      `(^(...))'.)

   Precedence
       The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `^', `/', `~',
       `|'  (lowest);  the remaining operators are simply treated from left to
       right as part of a string, with `#' and `##' applying to	 the  shortest
       possible	 preceding unit (i.e. a character, `?', `[...]', `<...>', or a
       parenthesised expression).  As mentioned above, a `/' used as a	direc‐
       tory  separator	may not appear inside parentheses, while a `|' must do
       so; in patterns used in other contexts than  filename  generation  (for
       example,	 in  case statements and tests within `[[...]]'), a `/' is not
       special; and `/' is also not special  after  a  `~'  appearing  outside
       parentheses in a filename pattern.

   Globbing Flags
       There  are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the
       end of the enclosing group or to the end of the pattern;	 they  require
       the  EXTENDED_GLOB  option. All take the form (#X) where X may have one
       of the following forms:

       i      Case insensitive:	 upper or lower case characters in the pattern
	      match upper or lower case characters.

       l      Lower  case  characters in the pattern match upper or lower case
	      characters; upper case characters	 in  the  pattern  still  only
	      match upper case characters.

       I      Case  sensitive:	locally negates the effect of i or l from that
	      point on.

       b      Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern;
	      this  does not work in filename generation.  When a pattern with
	      a set of active parentheses is matched, the strings  matched  by
	      the  groups  are	stored in the array $match, the indices of the
	      beginning of the matched parentheses in the array	 $mbegin,  and
	      the  indices  of the end in the array $mend, with the first ele‐
	      ment of each array  corresponding	 to  the  first	 parenthesised
	      group, and so on.	 These arrays are not otherwise special to the
	      shell.  The indices use the same convention  as  does  parameter
	      substitution,  so that elements of $mend and $mbegin may be used
	      in subscripts; the KSH_ARRAYS  option  is	 respected.   Sets  of
	      globbing flags are not considered parenthesised groups; only the
	      first nine active parentheses can be referenced.

	      For example,

		     foo="a string with a message"
		     if [[ $foo = (a|an)' '(#b)(*)' '* ]]; then
		       print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
		     fi

	      prints `string with a'.  Note  that  the	first  parenthesis  is
	      before the (#b) and does not create a backreference.

	      Backreferences  work  with  all  forms of pattern matching other
	      than filename generation, but note that when performing  matches
	      on  an  entire array, such as ${array#pattern}, or a global sub‐
	      stitution, such as ${param//pat/repl}, only  the	data  for  the
	      last  match  remains  available.	In the case of global replace‐
	      ments this may still be useful.  See the example for the m  flag
	      below.

	      The  numbering  of  backreferences strictly follows the order of
	      the opening parentheses  from  left  to  right  in  the  pattern
	      string,  although	 sets of parentheses may be nested.  There are
	      special rules for parentheses followed by `#' or `##'.  Only the
	      last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for example, in `[[
	      abab =  (#b)([ab])#  ]]',	 only  the  final  `b'	is  stored  in
	      match[1].	  Thus extra parentheses may be necessary to match the
	      complete segment: for example, use  `X((ab|cd)#)Y'  to  match  a
	      whole  string  of either `ab' or `cd' between `X' and `Y', using
	      the value of $match[1] rather than $match[2].

	      If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some
	      cases  it	 may  be  necessary to initialise them beforehand.  If
	      some of the backreferences fail to match	--  which  happens  if
	      they are in an alternate branch which fails to match, or if they
	      are followed by # and matched zero times	--  then  the  matched
	      string is set to the empty string, and the start and end indices
	      are set to -1.

	      Pattern matching with backreferences  is	slightly  slower  than
	      without.

       B      Deactivate  backreferences,  negating  the  effect of the b flag
	      from that point on.

       cN,M   The flag (#cN,M) can be used anywhere that the # or ## operators
	      can  be  used  except in the expressions `(*/)#' and `(*/)##' in
	      filename generation, where `/' has special meaning; it cannot be
	      combined	with  other  globbing  flags  and  a bad pattern error
	      occurs if it is misplaced.  It is equivalent to the  form	 {N,M}
	      in  regular  expressions.	  The  previous	 character or group is
	      required to match between N and M times,	inclusive.   The  form
	      (#cN) requires exactly N matches; (#c,M) is equivalent to speci‐
	      fying N as 0; (#cN,) specifies that there is no maximum limit on
	      the number of matches.

       m      Set  references to the match data for the entire string matched;
	      this is similar to backreferencing and does not work in filename
	      generation.   The	 flag must be in effect at the end of the pat‐
	      tern, i.e. not local to a group. The parameters $MATCH,  $MBEGIN
	      and  $MEND  will be set to the string matched and to the indices
	      of the beginning and end of the string, respectively.   This  is
	      most  useful in parameter substitutions, as otherwise the string
	      matched is obvious.

	      For example,

		     arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
		     print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}

	      forces all the matches (i.e. all vowels) into uppercase,	print‐
	      ing `vEldt jynx grImps wAqf zhO bUck'.

	      Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match
	      references, other than the extra substitutions required for  the
	      replacement strings in cases such as the example shown.

       M      Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be
	      created.

       anum   Approximate matching: num	 errors	 are  allowed  in  the	string
	      matched by the pattern.  The rules for this are described in the
	      next subsection.

       s, e   Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each
	      must  appear  on	its own:  `(#s)' and `(#e)' are the only valid
	      forms.  The `(#s)' flag succeeds only at the start of  the  test
	      string, and the `(#e)' flag succeeds only at the end of the test
	      string; they correspond to  `^'  and  `$'	 in  standard  regular
	      expressions.  They are useful for matching path segments in pat‐
	      terns other than those in filename generation (where  path  seg‐
	      ments  are  in  any  case	 treated  separately).	 For  example,
	      `*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*' matches a path segment `test' in any of
	      the   following	strings:   test,  test/at/start,  at/end/test,
	      in/test/middle.

	      Another  use  is	in   parameter	 substitution;	 for   example
	      `${array/(#s)A*Z(#e)}'  will  remove  only  elements of an array
	      which match the complete pattern `A*Z'.  There are other ways of
	      performing many operations of this type, however the combination
	      of the substitution operations `/' and `//' with the `(#s)'  and
	      `(#e)' flags provides a single simple and memorable method.

	      Note that assertions of the form `(^(#s))' also work, i.e. match
	      anywhere except at the start of the string, although this	 actu‐
	      ally  means  `anything except a zero-length portion at the start
	      of  the  string';	 you  need  to	use  `(""~(#s))'  to  match  a
	      zero-length portion of the string not at the start.

       q      A	 `q' and everything up to the closing parenthesis of the glob‐
	      bing flags are ignored by the pattern matching  code.   This  is
	      intended	to support the use of glob qualifiers, see below.  The
	      result is that the pattern `(#b)(*).c(#q.)' can be used both for
	      globbing and for matching against a string.  In the former case,
	      the `(#q.)' will be treated as a glob qualifier and  the	`(#b)'
	      will  not be useful, while in the latter case the `(#b)' is use‐
	      ful for backreferences and the `(#q.)' will  be  ignored.	  Note
	      that colon modifiers in the glob qualifiers are also not applied
	      in ordinary pattern matching.

       u      Respect the current locale in determining the presence of multi‐
	      byte  characters	in  a pattern, provided the shell was compiled
	      with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT.  This overrides  the  MULTIBYTE  option;
	      the  default  behaviour  is  taken  from the option.  Compare U.
	      (Mnemonic: typically multibyte characters are  from  Unicode  in
	      the UTF-8 encoding, although any extension of ASCII supported by
	      the system library may be used.)

       U      All characters are considered to be a  single  byte  long.   The
	      opposite of u.  This overrides the MULTIBYTE option.

       For  example,  the  test	 string	 fooxx	can  be matched by the pattern
       (#i)FOOXX, but not by (#l)FOOXX,	 (#i)FOO(#I)XX	or  ((#i)FOOX)X.   The
       string  (#ia2)readme specifies case-insensitive matching of readme with
       up to two errors.

       When using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and	 EXTENDED_GLOB
       must  be	 set  and  the left parenthesis should be preceded by @.  Note
       also that the flags do not affect letters inside [...] groups, in other
       words  (#i)[a-z]	 still	matches only lowercase letters.	 Finally, note
       that when examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must
       be  searched  for  all files which match, so that a pattern of the form
       (#i)/foo/bar/... is potentially slow.

   Approximate Matching
       When matching approximately, the shell keeps  a	count  of  the	errors
       found,  which  cannot exceed the number specified in the (#anum) flags.
       Four types of error are recognised:

       1.     Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.

       2.     Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.

       3.     A character missing in the target string, as  with  the  pattern
	      road and target string rod.

       4.     An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove
	      and strove.

       Thus, the pattern (#a3)abcd matches dcba, with the errors occurring  by
       using  the first rule twice and the second once, grouping the string as
       [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].

       Non-literal parts of the pattern must match exactly, including  charac‐
       ters  in	 character  ranges:  hence (#a1)???  matches strings of length
       four, by applying rule 4 to an empty  part  of  the  pattern,  but  not
       strings	of  length  two, since all the ? must match.  Other characters
       which must match exactly are initial  dots  in  filenames  (unless  the
       GLOB_DOTS option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that a/bc is
       two errors from ab/c (the slash cannot be transposed with another char‐
       acter).	 Similarly,  errors  are counted separately for non-contiguous
       strings in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef is two errors from aebf.

       When using exclusion  via  the  ~  operator,  approximate  matching  is
       treated entirely separately for the excluded part and must be activated
       separately.  Thus, (#a1)README~READ_ME matches READ.ME but not READ_ME,
       as  the	trailing  READ_ME  is matched without approximation.  However,
       (#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME does not match any pattern of the form READ?ME
       as all such forms are now excluded.

       Apart  from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however,
       the maximum errors allowed may be altered  locally,  and	 this  can  be
       delimited  by  grouping.	 For example, (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox allows one
       error in total, which may not occur in the dog section, and the pattern
       (#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox	 is  equivalent.  Note that the point at which
       an error is first found is the crucial one for establishing whether  to
       use   approximation;  for  example,  (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz  will  not	 match
       abcdxyz, because the error occurs at the `x',  where  approximation  is
       turned off.

       Entire	path   segments	  may	be   matched  approximately,  so  that
       `(#a1)/foo/d/is/available/at/the/bar' allows one error in any path seg‐
       ment.   This  is	 much  less efficient than without the (#a1), however,
       since every directory in the  path  must	 be  scanned  for  a  possible
       approximate  match.   It is best to place the (#a1) after any path seg‐
       ments which are known to be correct.

   Recursive Globbing
       A pathname component of the form `(foo/)#' matches a path consisting of
       zero or more directories matching the pattern foo.

       As  a  shorthand, `**/' is equivalent to `(*/)#'; note that this there‐
       fore matches files in the current directory as well as  subdirectories.
       Thus:

	      ls (*/)#bar

       or

	      ls **/bar

       does  a	recursive  directory search for files named `bar' (potentially
       including the file `bar' in the current directory).  This form does not
       follow  symbolic links; the alternative form `***/' does, but is other‐
       wise identical.	Neither of these can be combined with other  forms  of
       globbing	 within the same path segment; in that case, the `*' operators
       revert to their usual effect.

   Glob Qualifiers
       Patterns used for filename generation may end in a list	of  qualifiers
       enclosed	 in  parentheses.  The qualifiers specify which filenames that
       otherwise match the given pattern will  be  inserted  in	 the  argument
       list.

       If the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses
       containing no `|' or `(' characters (or `~' if it is special) is	 taken
       as  a set of glob qualifiers.  A glob subexpression that would normally
       be taken as glob qualifiers, for example `(^x)', can be	forced	to  be
       treated	as  part  of  the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in
       this case producing `((^x))'.

       If the option EXTENDED_GLOB is set, a different syntax for glob	quali‐
       fiers  is  available,  namely  `(#qx)'  where x is any of the same glob
       qualifiers used in the other format.  The qualifiers must still	appear
       at  the	end  of	 the pattern.  However, with this syntax multiple glob
       qualifiers may be chained together.  They are treated as a logical  AND
       of  the	individual sets of flags.  Also, as the syntax is unambiguous,
       the expression will be treated as glob  qualifiers  just	 as  long  any
       parentheses contained within it are balanced; appearance of `|', `(' or
       `~' does not negate the effect.	Note that qualifiers  will  be	recog‐
       nised  in  this form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end of
       the pattern, for example `*(#q*)(.)' will recognise executable  regular
       files if both options are set; however, mixed syntax should probably be
       avoided for the sake of clarity.

       A qualifier may be any one of the following:

       /      directories

       F      `full' (i.e. non-empty) directories.   Note  that	 the  opposite
	      sense (^F) expands to empty directories and all non-directories.
	      Use (/^F) for empty directories.

       .      plain files

       @      symbolic links

       =      sockets

       p      named pipes (FIFOs)

       *      executable plain files (0100)

       %      device files (character or block special)

       %b     block special files

       %c     character special files

       r      owner-readable files (0400)

       w      owner-writable files (0200)

       x      owner-executable files (0100)

       A      group-readable files (0040)

       I      group-writable files (0020)

       E      group-executable files (0010)

       R      world-readable files (0004)

       W      world-writable files (0002)

       X      world-executable files (0001)

       s      setuid files (04000)

       S      setgid files (02000)

       t      files with the sticky bit (01000)

       fspec  files with access rights matching spec. This spec may be a octal
	      number optionally preceded by a `=', a `+', or a `-'. If none of
	      these characters is given, the behavior is the same as for  `='.
	      The octal number describes the mode bits to be expected, if com‐
	      bined with a `=', the value  given  must	match  the  file-modes
	      exactly,	with a `+', at least the bits in the given number must
	      be set in the file-modes, and with a `-', the bits in the number
	      must  not be set. Giving a `?' instead of a octal digit anywhere
	      in the  number  ensures  that  the  corresponding	 bits  in  the
	      file-modes  are  not checked, this is only useful in combination
	      with `='.

	      If the qualifier `f' is followed by any other character anything
	      up  to the next matching character (`[', `{', and `<' match `]',
	      `}', and `>' respectively, any other character  matches  itself)
	      is  taken	 as a list of comma-separated sub-specs. Each sub-spec
	      may be either an octal number as described above or  a  list  of
	      any of the characters `u', `g', `o', and `a', followed by a `=',
	      a `+', or a `-', followed by a list of  any  of  the  characters
	      `r',  `w',  `x', `s', and `t', or an octal digit. The first list
	      of characters specify which access rights are to be checked.  If
	      a	 `u'  is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a
	      `g' is given, those of the group are checked,  a	`o'  means  to
	      test  those  of  other users, and the `a' says to test all three
	      groups. The `=', `+', and `-' again says how the modes are to be
	      checked  and  have  the  same meaning as described for the first
	      form above. The second list of  characters  finally  says	 which
	      access  rights  are to be expected: `r' for read access, `w' for
	      write access, `x' for the right  to  execute  the	 file  (or  to
	      search a directory), `s' for the setuid and setgid bits, and `t'
	      for the sticky bit.

	      Thus, `*(f70?)' gives the files for which the  owner  has	 read,
	      write, and execute permission, and for which other group members
	      have no rights, independent of the permissions for other	users.
	      The  pattern `*(f-100)' gives all files for which the owner does
	      not have execute permission,  and	 `*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)'  gives  the
	      files  for  which	 the  owner and the other members of the group
	      have at least write permission, and for which other users	 don't
	      have read or execute permission.

       estring
       +cmd   The string will be executed as shell code.  The filename will be
	      included in the list if and only if the code returns a zero sta‐
	      tus (usually the status of the last command).

	      In  the  first  form,  the first character after the `e' will be
	      used as a separator and anything up to the next matching separa‐
	      tor  will	 be taken  as the string; `[', `{', and `<' match `]',
	      `}', and `>', respectively, while any  other  character  matches
	      itself.  Note  that  expansions  must be quoted in the string to
	      prevent them  from  being	 expanded  before  globbing  is	 done.
	      string  is  then executed as shell code.	The string globqual is
	      appended to the array zsh_eval_context the  duration  of	execu‐
	      tion.

	      During  the  execution  of  string  the filename currently being
	      tested is available in the parameter REPLY; the parameter may be
	      altered  to a string to be inserted into the list instead of the
	      original filename.  In addition, the parameter reply may be  set
	      to an array or a string, which overrides the value of REPLY.  If
	      set to an array, the latter is inserted into  the	 command  line
	      word by word.

	      For   example,  suppose  a  directory  contains  a  single  file
	      `lonely'.	 Then the  expression  `*(e:'reply=(${REPLY}{1,2})':)'
	      will cause the words `lonely1' and `lonely2' to be inserted into
	      the command line.	 Note the quoting of string.

	      The form +cmd has the same  effect,  but	no  delimiters	appear
	      around  cmd.   Instead,  cmd is taken as the longest sequence of
	      characters following the + that are alphanumeric or  underscore.
	      Typically cmd will be the name of a shell function that contains
	      the appropriate test.  For example,

		     nt() { [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] }
		     NTREF=reffile
		     ls -l *(+nt)

	      lists all files in the directory that have  been	modified  more
	      recently than reffile.

       ddev   files on the device dev

       l[-|+]ct
	      files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+),
	      or equal to ct

       U      files owned by the effective user ID

       G      files owned by the effective group ID

       uid    files owned by user ID id if that is a  number.	Otherwise,  id
	      specifies a user name: the character after the `u' will be taken
	      as a separator and the string between it and the	next  matching
	      separator will be taken as a user name.  The starting separators
	      `[', `{', and `<' match the final separators `]', `}', and  `>',
	      respectively;  any other character matches itself.  The selected
	      files are those owned by this user.  For	example,  `u:foo:'  or
	      `u[foo]' selects files owned by user `foo'.

       gid    like uid but with group IDs or names

       a[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      files  accessed  exactly	n days ago.  Files accessed within the
	      last n days are selected using a	negative  value	 for  n	 (-n).
	      Files accessed more than n days ago are selected by a positive n
	      value (+n).  Optional unit specifiers `M', `w', `h', `m' or  `s'
	      (e.g.  `ah5') cause the check to be performed with months (of 30
	      days), weeks, hours, minutes or seconds instead of days, respec‐
	      tively.  An explicit `d' for days is also allowed.

	      Any  fractional  part  of the difference between the access time
	      and the current part in the appropriate units is ignored in  the
	      comparison.   For	 instance,  `echo  *(ah-5)'  would  echo files
	      accessed within the last five hours, while `echo *(ah+5)'	 would
	      echo  files  accessed  at least six hours ago, as times strictly
	      between five and six hours are treated as five hours.

       m[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      like the file access qualifier, except that  it  uses  the  file
	      modification time.

       c[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      like  the	 file  access  qualifier, except that it uses the file
	      inode change time.

       L[+|-]n
	      files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n
	      bytes in length.

	      If  this flag is directly followed by a `k' (`K'), `m' (`M'), or
	      `p' (`P') (e.g. `Lk-50') the check is performed with  kilobytes,
	      megabytes,  or  blocks  (of  512 bytes) instead.	In this case a
	      file is regarded as "exactly" the size if the file size  rounded
	      up  to  the next unit is equal to the test size.	Hence `*(Lm1)'
	      matches files from 1 byte up to 1 Megabyte inclusive.  Note also
	      that  the	 set  of files "less than" the test size only includes
	      files that would not match the equality  test;  hence  `*(Lm-1)'
	      only matches files of zero size.

       ^      negates all qualifiers following it

       -      toggles  between	making	the  qualifiers work on symbolic links
	      (the default) and the files they point to

       M      sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern

       T      appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames, analogous to
	      the LIST_TYPES option, for the current pattern (overrides M)

       N      sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern

       D      sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern

       n      sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern

       oc     specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. If c is n
	      they are sorted by name (the default);  if  it  is  L  they  are
	      sorted  depending	 on  the size (length) of the files; if l they
	      are sorted by the number of links; if a, m, or c they are sorted
	      by  the  time  of the last access, modification, or inode change
	      respectively; if d, files in subdirectories appear before	 those
	      in  the current directory at each level of the search -- this is
	      best combined with other criteria, for example `odon' to sort on
	      names  for  files within the same directory; if N, no sorting is
	      performed.  Note that a, m, and c compare the  age  against  the
	      current  time,  hence the first name in the list is the youngest
	      file. Also note  that  the  modifiers  ^	and  -	are  used,  so
	      `*(^-oL)'	 gives	a  list	 of  all  files sorted by file size in
	      descending order, following any symbolic links.	Unless	oN  is
	      used, multiple order specifiers may occur to resolve ties.

	      oe  and  o+  are	special cases; they are each followed by shell
	      code, delimited as for the e glob qualifier and the + glob qual‐
	      ifier  respectively  (see above).	 The code is executed for each
	      matched file with the parameter REPLY set to  the	 name  of  the
	      file  on	entry  and globsort appended to zsh_eval_context.  The
	      code should modify the parameter	REPLY  in  some	 fashion.   On
	      return,  the  value of the parameter is used instead of the file
	      name as the string on which to sort.  Unlike other  sort	opera‐
	      tors,  oe and o+ may be repeated, but note that the maximum num‐
	      ber of sort operators of any kind that may appear	 in  any  glob
	      expression is 12.

       Oc     like  `o',  but  sorts in descending order; i.e. `*(^oc)' is the
	      same as `*(Oc)' and `*(^Oc)' is the same as `*(oc)';  `Od'  puts
	      files in the current directory before those in subdirectories at
	      each level of the search.

       [beg[,end]]
	      specifies which of the matched filenames should be  included  in
	      the  returned  list.  The	 syntax	 is the same as for array sub‐
	      scripts. beg and the optional end may  be	 mathematical  expres‐
	      sions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
	      them count from the last	match  backward.  E.g.:	 `*(-OL[1,3])'
	      gives a list of the names of the three largest files.

       Pstring
	      The  string  will	 be prepended to each glob match as a separate
	      word.  string is delimited in the same way as arguments to the e
	      glob  qualifier described above.	The qualifier can be repeated;
	      the words are prepended separately so that the resulting command
	      line contains the words in the same order they were given in the
	      list of glob qualifiers.

	      A typical use for this is to prepend an option before all occur‐
	      rences  of a file name; for example, the pattern `*(P:-f:)' pro‐
	      duces the command line arguments `-f file1 -f file2 ...'

       More than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas.  The
       whole  list  matches  if at least one of the sublists matches (they are
       `or'ed, the qualifiers in the sublists are `and'ed).  Some  qualifiers,
       however,	 affect	 all  matches generated, independent of the sublist in
       which they are given.  These are the qualifiers	`M',  `T',  `N',  `D',
       `n', `o', `O' and the subscripts given in brackets (`[...]').

       If  a  `:' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression
       in parenthesis is interpreted as a modifier  (see  the  section	`Modi‐
       fiers'  in  the	section	 `History  Expansion').	 Each modifier must be
       introduced by a separate `:'.  Note also that the result after  modifi‐
       cation  does not have to be an existing file.  The name of any existing
       file can be followed by a modifier of  the  form	 `(:..)'  even	if  no
       actual  filename	 generation is performed, although note that the pres‐
       ence of the parentheses causes the entire expression to be subjected to
       any global pattern matching options such as NULL_GLOB. Thus:

	      ls *(-/)

       lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and

	      ls *(%W)

       lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and

	      ls *(W,X)

       lists  all  files  in  the current directory that are world-writable or
       world-executable, and

	      echo /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)

       outputs the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the	string
       `foo' in /tmp, ignoring symlinks, and

	      ls *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)

       lists  all  files  having a link count of one whose names contain a dot
       (but not those starting with  a	dot,  since  GLOB_DOTS	is  explicitly
       switched off) except for lex.c, lex.h, parse.c and parse.h.

	      print b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)

       demonstrates  how  colon	 modifiers and other qualifiers may be chained
       together.  The ordinary qualifier `.' is applied first, then the	 colon
       modifiers  in order from left to right.	So if EXTENDED_GLOB is set and
       the base pattern matches the regular file builtin.pro, the  shell  will
       print `shmiltin.shmo'.

ZSHPARAM(1)							   ZSHPARAM(1)

NAME
       zshparam - zsh parameters

DESCRIPTION
       A  parameter  has  a name, a value, and a number of attributes.	A name
       may be any sequence of alphanumeric characters and underscores, or  the
       single  characters `*', `@', `#', `?', `-', `$', or `!'.	 The value may
       be a scalar (a string), an integer, an array (indexed numerically),  or
       an  associative array (an unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed by
       name).  To declare the type of a parameter, or to assign	 a  scalar  or
       integer value to a parameter, use the typeset builtin.

       The  value  of  a  scalar  or integer parameter may also be assigned by
       writing:

	      name=value

       If the integer attribute, -i, is set for name, the value is subject  to
       arithmetic  evaluation.	 Furthermore,  by  replacing  `=' with `+=', a
       parameter can be added or appended to.  See the section `Array  Parame‐
       ters' for additional forms of assignment.

       To  refer to the value of a parameter, write `$name' or `${name}'.  See
       Parameter Expansion in zshexpn(1) for complete details.

       In the parameter lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates  that  the
       parameter  is  special.	 Special  parameters  cannot  have  their type
       changed or their readonly attribute turned off, and if a special param‐
       eter  is	 unset,	 then  later recreated, the special properties will be
       retained.  `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not exist  when  the
       shell initializes in sh or ksh emulation mode.

ARRAY PARAMETERS
       To assign an array value, write one of:

	      set -A name value ...
	      name=(value ...)

       If  no  parameter  name exists, an ordinary array parameter is created.
       If the parameter name exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by	a  new
       array.  Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:

	      typeset -a name

       Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:

	      typeset -A name

       When  name refers to an associative array, the list in an assignment is
       interpreted as alternating keys and values:

	      set -A name key value ...
	      name=(key value ...)

       Every key must have a value in this case.  Note that  this  assigns  to
       the entire array, deleting any elements that do not appear in the list.

       To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:

	      set -A name
	      name=()

   Array Subscripts
       Individual  elements  of an array may be selected using a subscript.  A
       subscript of the form `[exp]' selects the single element exp, where exp
       is  an arithmetic expression which will be subject to arithmetic expan‐
       sion as if it were surrounded by `$((...))'.  The elements are numbered
       beginning  with	1,  unless  the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case
       they are numbered from zero.

       Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter	 name,
       thus  `${foo[2]}' is equivalent to `$foo[2]'.  If the KSH_ARRAYS option
       is set, the braced form is  the	only  one  that	 works,	 as  bracketed
       expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.

       If  the	KSH_ARRAYS  option  is not set, then by default accesses to an
       array element with a subscript that evaluates to zero return  an	 empty
       string,	while  an  attempt  to	write such an element is treated as an
       error.  For backward compatibility the KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT option can be
       set  to	cause  subscript  values  0  and  1  to be equivalent; see the
       description of the option in zshoptions(1).

       The same subscripting syntax is used  for  associative  arrays,	except
       that  no	 arithmetic expansion is applied to exp.  However, the parsing
       rules for arithmetic expressions still apply,  which  affects  the  way
       that  certain special characters must be protected from interpretation.
       See Subscript Parsing below for details.

       A subscript of the form `[*]' or `[@]' evaluates to all elements of  an
       array;  there  is no difference between the two except when they appear
       within double  quotes.	`"$foo[*]"'  evaluates	to  `"$foo[1]  $foo[2]
       ..."', whereas `"$foo[@]"' evaluates to `"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]" ...'.  For
       associative arrays, `[*]' or `[@]' evaluate to all the  values,	in  no
       particular order.  Note that this does not substitute the keys; see the
       documentation for the `k' flag under Parameter Expansion Flags in  zsh‐
       expn(1) for complete details.  When an array parameter is referenced as
       `$name' (with no subscript) it  evaluates  to  `$name[*]',  unless  the
       KSH_ARRAYS  option  is  set  in which case it evaluates to `${name[0]}'
       (for an associative array, this means the value of the key  `0',	 which
       may not exist even if there are values for other keys).

       A subscript of the form `[exp1,exp2]' selects all elements in the range
       exp1 to exp2, inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and	so  do
       not  support  ranges.) If one of the subscripts evaluates to a negative
       number, say -n, then the nth element from the end of the array is used.
       Thus `$foo[-3]' is the third element from the end of the array foo, and
       `$foo[1,-1]' is the same as `$foo[*]'.

       Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in  which  case
       the  subscripts	specify	 a substring to be extracted.  For example, if
       FOO is set to `foobar', then `echo $FOO[2,5]' prints `ooba'.

   Array Element Assignment
       A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:

	      name[exp]=value

       In this form of assignment the element or range	specified  by  exp  is
       replaced	 by  the  expression  on the right side.  An array (but not an
       associative array) may be created by assignment to a range or  element.
       Arrays  do  not nest, so assigning a parenthesized list of values to an
       element or range changes the number of elements in the array,  shifting
       the  other  elements  to accommodate the new values.  (This is not sup‐
       ported for associative arrays.)

       This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:

	      typeset "name[exp]"=value

       The value may not be a parenthesized  list  in  this  case;  only  sin‐
       gle-element assignments may be made with typeset.  Note that quotes are
       necessary in this case to prevent the brackets from  being  interpreted
       as filename generation operators.  The noglob precommand modifier could
       be used instead.

       To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `()' to that element.
       To delete an element of an associative array, use the unset command:

	      unset "name[exp]"

   Subscript Flags
       If  the	opening	 bracket,  or  the  comma in a range, in any subscript
       expression is directly followed by an opening parenthesis,  the	string
       up  to the matching closing one is considered to be a list of flags, as
       in `name[(flags)exp]'.

       The flags s, n and b take an argument; the delimiter is shown below  as
       `:',  but  any  character,  or  the  matching  pairs  `(...)', `{...}',
       `[...]', or `<...>', may be used, but note that	`<...>'	 can  only  be
       used if the subscript is inside a double quoted expression or a parame‐
       ter substitution enclosed in braces  as	otherwise  the	expression  is
       interpreted as a redirection.

       The flags currently understood are:

       w      If  the  parameter  subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes
	      subscripting work on words instead of characters.	  The  default
	      word  separator  is  whitespace.	This flag may not be used with
	      the i or I flag.

       s:string:
	      This gives the string that separates words (for use with	the  w
	      flag).  The delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       p      Recognize	 the same escape sequences as the print builtin in the
	      string argument of a subsequent `s' flag.

       f      If the parameter subscripted is a scalar then  this  flag	 makes
	      subscripting work on lines instead of characters, i.e. with ele‐
	      ments separated by newlines.  This is a shorthand for `pws:\n:'.

       r      Reverse subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as
	      a	 pattern  and  the result is the first matching array element,
	      substring or word (if the parameter is an	 array,	 if  it	 is  a
	      scalar,  or if it is a scalar and the `w' flag is given, respec‐
	      tively).	The subscript used is the number of the matching  ele‐
	      ment,  so	 that  pairs of subscripts such as `$foo[(r)??,3]' and
	      `$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]' are possible if  the	parameter  is  not  an
	      associative  array.   If	the parameter is an associative array,
	      only the value part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and
	      the result is that value.

	      If  a  search  through an ordinary array failed, the search sets
	      the subscript to one past	 the  end  of  the  array,  and	 hence
	      ${array[(r)pattern]} will substitute the empty string.  Thus the
	      success of a search can be tested by using  the  (i)  flag,  for
	      example (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not in effect):

		     [[ ${array[(i)pattern]} -le ${#array} ]]

	      If KSH_ARRAYS is in effect, the -le should be replaced by -lt.

       R      Like  `r',  but  gives  the last match.  For associative arrays,
	      gives all possible matches. May be used for assigning  to	 ordi‐
	      nary  array  elements,  but  not	for  assigning	to associative
	      arrays.  On failure, for normal arrays this has  the  effect  of
	      returning	 the  element  corresponding  to  subscript 0; this is
	      empty unless one of the options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
	      is in effect.

	      Note that in subscripts with both `r' and `R' pattern characters
	      are active  even	if  they  were	substituted  for  a  parameter
	      (regardless  of  the  setting  of GLOB_SUBST which controls this
	      feature in normal pattern matching).  The flag `e' can be	 added
	      to  inhibit  pattern  matching.	As  this flag does not inhibit
	      other forms of substitution, care is  still  required;  using  a
	      parameter to hold the key has the desired effect:

		     key2='original key'
		     print ${array[(Re)$key2]}

       i      Like `r', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not
	      be combined with a second argument.  On  the  left  side	of  an
	      assignment,  behaves  like `r'.  For associative arrays, the key
	      part of each pair is compared to	the  pattern,  and  the	 first
	      matching	key  found  is the result.  On failure substitutes the
	      length of the array plus one, as discussed under the description
	      of `r', or the empty string for an associative array.

       I      Like `i', but gives the index of the last match, or all possible
	      matching keys in an associative array.  On  failure  substitutes
	      0,  or  the empty string for an associative array.  This flag is
	      best when testing for values or keys that do not exist.

       k      If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes
	      the  keys	 to  be interpreted as patterns, and returns the value
	      for the first key found where exp is matched by the  key.	  Note
	      this  could be any such key as no ordering of associative arrays
	      is defined.  This flag does not work on  the  left  side	of  an
	      assignment  to an associative array element.  If used on another
	      type of parameter, this behaves like `r'.

       K      On an associative array this is like `k' but returns all	values
	      where  exp is matched by the keys.  On other types of parameters
	      this has the same effect as `R'.

       n:expr:
	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them give  the  nth
	      or  nth  last  match  (if	 expr  evaluates  to n).  This flag is
	      ignored when the array is associative.  The delimiter  character
	      : is arbitrary; see above.

       b:expr:
	      If  combined  with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them begin at the
	      nth or nth last element, word, or character (if  expr  evaluates
	      to n).  This flag is ignored when the array is associative.  The
	      delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       e      This flag causes any pattern matching that would be performed on
	      the  subscript  to  use  plain  string  matching instead.	 Hence
	      `${array[(re)*]}' matches only the array element whose value  is
	      *.  Note that other forms of substitution such as parameter sub‐
	      stitution are not inhibited.

	      This flag can also be used to force * or @ to be interpreted  as
	      a	 single	 key rather than as a reference to all values.	It may
	      be used for either purpose on the left side of an assignment.

       See Parameter Expansion	Flags  (zshexpn(1))  for  additional  ways  to
       manipulate the results of array subscripting.

   Subscript Parsing
       This  discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to
       patterns used for reverse subscripting (the `r', `R', `i', etc. flags),
       but  it	may also affect parameter substitutions that appear as part of
       an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.

       It is possible to avoid the use of subscripts in assignments  to	 asso‐
       ciative array elements by using the syntax:

		 aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')

       This  adds  a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and
       replaces the value for the existing key if it is.

       The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is  that
       all  text between the opening `[' and the closing `]' is interpreted as
       if it were in double quotes (see zshmisc(1)).  However,	unlike	double
       quotes  which  normally	cannot	nest, subscript expressions may appear
       inside double-quoted strings or inside other subscript expressions  (or
       both!), so the rules have two important differences.

       The first difference is that brackets (`[' and `]') must appear as bal‐
       anced pairs in a subscript expression unless they  are  preceded	 by  a
       backslash  (`\').  Therefore, within a subscript expression (and unlike
       true double-quoting) the sequence `\[' becomes `[', and similarly  `\]'
       becomes	`]'.  This applies even in cases where a backslash is not nor‐
       mally required; for example, the pattern `[^[]' (to match any character
       other than an open bracket) should be written `[^\[]' in a reverse-sub‐
       script pattern.	However, note that `\[^\[\]' and even `\[^[]' mean the
       same  thing,  because  backslashes are always stripped when they appear
       before brackets!

       The same rule applies to parentheses (`(' and `)') and braces (`{'  and
       `}'):  they must appear either in balanced pairs or preceded by a back‐
       slash, and backslashes that protect parentheses or braces  are  removed
       during parsing.	This is because parameter expansions may be surrounded
       by balanced braces, and subscript  flags	 are  introduced  by  balanced
       parentheses.

       The  second  difference is that a double-quote (`"') may appear as part
       of a subscript expression without being preceded by  a  backslash,  and
       therefore  that the two characters `\"' remain as two characters in the
       subscript (in true double-quoting, `\"' becomes `"').  However, because
       of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear must
       occur in balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash.	This makes  it
       more  difficult	to  write  a subscript expression that contains an odd
       number of double-quote characters, but the reason for  this  difference
       is  so  that  when  a  subscript	 expression  appears  inside true dou‐
       ble-quotes, one can still write `\"' (rather than `\\\"') for `"'.

       To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in  an  assignment,  use
       the typeset builtin and an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to
       the value of that key, again use double quotes:

	      typeset -A aa
	      typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
	      print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"

       It is important to note that the quoting rules do  not  change  when  a
       parameter expansion with a subscript is nested inside another subscript
       expression.  That is, it is not necessary to use additional backslashes
       within the inner subscript expression; they are removed only once, from
       the innermost subscript outwards.  Parameters are  also	expanded  from
       the innermost subscript first, as each expansion is encountered left to
       right in the outer expression.

       A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing  is
       not  different  from  double quote parsing.  As in true double-quoting,
       the sequences `\*', and `\@' remain as two characters when they	appear
       in  a subscript expression.  To use a literal `*' or `@' as an associa‐
       tive array key, the `e' flag must be used:

	      typeset -A aa
	      aa[(e)*]=star
	      print $aa[(e)*]

       A last detail must be considered	 when  reverse	subscripting  is  per‐
       formed.	 Parameters  appearing	in  the subscript expression are first
       expanded and then the complete expression is interpreted as a  pattern.
       This has two effects: first, parameters behave as if GLOB_SUBST were on
       (and it cannot be turned	 off);	second,	 backslashes  are  interpreted
       twice, once when parsing the array subscript and again when parsing the
       pattern.	 In a reverse subscript, it's  necessary  to  use  four	 back‐
       slashes	to cause a single backslash to match literally in the pattern.
       For complex patterns, it is often easiest to assign the desired pattern
       to  a  parameter	 and  then  refer  to that parameter in the subscript,
       because then the backslashes, brackets,	parentheses,  etc.,  are  seen
       only  when the complete expression is converted to a pattern.  To match
       the value of a parameter literally in a reverse subscript, rather  than
       as  a  pattern, use `${(q)name}' (see zshexpn(1)) to quote the expanded
       value.

       Note that the `k' and `K' flags are reverse subscripting for  an	 ordi‐
       nary  array, but are not reverse subscripting for an associative array!
       (For an associative array, the keys in the array itself are interpreted
       as  patterns  by	 those	flags; the subscript is a plain string in that
       case.)

       One final note, not directly related to subscripting: the numeric names
       of positional parameters (described below) are parsed specially, so for
       example `$2foo' is equivalent to `${2}foo'.   Therefore,	 to  use  sub‐
       script  syntax  to extract a substring from a positional parameter, the
       expansion must be surrounded by braces; for example, `${2[3,5]}' evalu‐
       ates  to	 the  third  through fifth characters of the second positional
       parameter, but `$2[3,5]' is the entire  second  parameter  concatenated
       with the filename generation pattern `[3,5]'.

POSITIONAL PARAMETERS
       The  positional parameters provide access to the command-line arguments
       of a shell function, shell script, or the shell itself; see the section
       `Invocation', and also the section `Functions'.	The parameter n, where
       n is a number, is the nth positional parameter.	The parameter `$0'  is
       a special case, see the section `Parameters Set By The Shell'.

       The  parameters	*, @ and argv are arrays containing all the positional
       parameters; thus `$argv[n]', etc., is equivalent to simply `$n'.	  Note
       that the options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT apply to these arrays
       as well, so with either of those options set, `${argv[0]}'  is  equiva‐
       lent to `$1' and so on.

       Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts
       by using the set builtin, by assigning to the argv array, or by	direct
       assignment  of  the  form  `n=value' where n is the number of the posi‐
       tional parameter to be changed.	This also creates (with empty  values)
       any of the positions from 1 to n that do not already have values.  Note
       that, because the positional parameters form an array, an array assign‐
       ment  of	 the  form  `n=(value  ...)' is allowed, and has the effect of
       shifting all the values at positions greater than n by  as  many	 posi‐
       tions as necessary to accommodate the new values.

LOCAL PARAMETERS
       Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.  (Param‐
       eters are dynamically scoped.)  The typeset builtin, and	 its  alterna‐
       tive  forms  declare, integer, local and readonly (but not export), can
       be used to declare a parameter as being local to the innermost scope.

       When a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parame‐
       ter  of	that  name  is	used.  (That is, the local parameter hides any
       less-local parameter.)  However, assigning to a non-existent parameter,
       or  declaring  a	 new parameter with export, causes it to be created in
       the outermost scope.

       Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.  unset can be used to
       delete  a  parameter while it is still in scope; any outer parameter of
       the same name remains hidden.

       Special parameters may also be made local; they	retain	their  special
       attributes  unless  either  the existing or the newly-created parameter
       has the -h (hide) attribute.  This may have unexpected  effects:	 there
       is  no  default	value,	so  if there is no assignment at the point the
       variable is made local, it will be set to an empty value	 (or  zero  in
       the case of integers).  The following:

	      typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH

       is  valid  for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes called from
       it to find the programs in /new/directory inside a function.

       Note that the restriction in older versions of zsh that	local  parame‐
       ters were never exported has been removed.

PARAMETERS SET BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:

       ! <S>  The  process  ID	of  the last command started in the background
	      with &, or put into the background with the bg builtin.

       # <S>  The number of positional parameters in decimal.  Note that  some
	      confusion	 may  occur  with the syntax $#param which substitutes
	      the length of param.  Use ${#} to resolve ambiguities.  In  par‐
	      ticular,	the  sequence  `$#-...' in an arithmetic expression is
	      interpreted as the length of the parameter -, q.v.

       ARGC <S> <Z>
	      Same as #.

       $ <S>  The process ID of this shell.   Note  that  this	indicates  the
	      original	shell  started	by  invoking zsh; all processes forked
	      from the shells without executing a new program,	such  as  sub‐
	      shells started by (...), substitute the same value.

       - <S>  Flags  supplied  to  the	shell  on  invocation or by the set or
	      setopt commands.

       * <S>  An array containing the positional parameters.

       argv <S> <Z>
	      Same as *.  Assigning  to	 argv  changes	the  local  positional
	      parameters,  but argv is not itself a local parameter.  Deleting
	      argv with unset in any function deletes it everywhere,  although
	      only  the	 innermost positional parameter array is deleted (so *
	      and @ in other scopes are not affected).

       @ <S>  Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.

       ? <S>  The exit status returned by the last command.

       0 <S>  The name used  to	 invoke	 the  current  shell.	If  the	 FUNC‐
	      TION_ARGZERO  option  is	set,  this is set temporarily within a
	      shell function to the name of the function, and within a sourced
	      script to the name of the script.

       status <S> <Z>
	      Same as ?.

       pipestatus <S> <Z>
	      An  array	 containing the exit statuses returned by all commands
	      in the last pipeline.

       _ <S>  The last argument of the previous command.  Also, this parameter
	      is  set in the environment of every command executed to the full
	      pathname of the command.

       CPUTYPE
	      The machine type (microprocessor class  or  machine  model),  as
	      determined at run time.

       EGID <S>
	      The effective group ID of the shell process.  If you have suffi‐
	      cient privileges, you may change the effective group ID  of  the
	      shell  process  by  assigning to this parameter.	Also (assuming
	      sufficient privileges), you may start a single  command  with  a
	      different effective group ID by `(EGID=gid; command)'

       EUID <S>
	      The  effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have suffi‐
	      cient privileges, you may change the effective user  ID  of  the
	      shell  process  by  assigning to this parameter.	Also (assuming
	      sufficient privileges), you may start a single  command  with  a
	      different effective user ID by `(EUID=uid; command)'

       ERRNO <S>
	      The  value  of  errno (see errno(3)) as set by the most recently
	      failed system call.  This	 value	is  system  dependent  and  is
	      intended	for  debugging	purposes.   It is also useful with the
	      zsh/system module which allows the number to be  turned  into  a
	      name or message.

       GID <S>
	      The  real group ID of the shell process.	If you have sufficient
	      privileges, you may change the group ID of the shell process  by
	      assigning	 to  this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privi‐
	      leges), you may start a single command under a  different	 group
	      ID by `(GID=gid; command)'

       HISTCMD
	      The  current  history  line  number  in an interactive shell, in
	      other words the line number for the command that caused $HISTCMD
	      to be read.

       HOST   The current hostname.

       LINENO <S>
	      The  line	 number of the current line within the current script,
	      sourced file, or shell function being  executed,	whichever  was
	      started most recently.  Note that in the case of shell functions
	      the line number refers to the function as	 it  appeared  in  the
	      original	definition,  not necessarily as displayed by the func‐
	      tions builtin.

       LOGNAME
	      If the corresponding variable is not set in the  environment  of
	      the  shell, it is initialized to the login name corresponding to
	      the current login session. This parameter is exported by default
	      but this can be disabled using the typeset builtin.

       MACHTYPE
	      The  machine  type  (microprocessor  class or machine model), as
	      determined at compile time.

       OLDPWD The previous working directory.  This is set when the shell ini‐
	      tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       OPTARG <S>
	      The  value  of the last option argument processed by the getopts
	      command.

       OPTIND <S>
	      The index of the last option argument processed by  the  getopts
	      command.

       OSTYPE The operating system, as determined at compile time.

       PPID <S>
	      The process ID of the parent of the shell.  As for $$, the value
	      indicates the parent of the original shell and does  not	change
	      in subshells.

       PWD    The  present working directory.  This is set when the shell ini‐
	      tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       RANDOM <S>
	      A pseudo-random integer from 0 to 32767,	newly  generated  each
	      time  this parameter is referenced.  The random number generator
	      can be seeded by assigning a numeric value to RANDOM.

	      The  values   of	 RANDOM	  form	 an   intentionally-repeatable
	      pseudo-random  sequence;	subshells  that	 reference RANDOM will
	      result in identical pseudo-random values	unless	the  value  of
	      RANDOM  is  referenced  or seeded in the parent shell in between
	      subshell invocations.

       SECONDS <S>
	      The number of seconds since shell invocation.  If this parameter
	      is assigned a value, then the value returned upon reference will
	      be the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds	 since
	      the assignment.

	      Unlike other special parameters, the type of the SECONDS parame‐
	      ter can be changed using the typeset command.  Only integer  and
	      one  of  the  floating  point  types  are allowed.  For example,
	      `typeset -F SECONDS' causes the value to be reported as a float‐
	      ing  point  number.  The value is available to microsecond accu‐
	      racy, although the shell may show more or fewer digits depending
	      on  the  use  of typeset.	 See the documentation for the builtin
	      typeset in zshbuiltins(1) for more details.

       SHLVL <S>
	      Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.

       signals
	      An array containing the names of the signals.

       TRY_BLOCK_ERROR <S>
	      In an always block, indicates whether the preceding list of code
	      caused  an error.	 The value is 1 to indicate an error, 0 other‐
	      wise.  It may be reset, clearing the error condition.  See  Com‐
	      plex Commands in zshmisc(1)

       TTY    The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.

       TTYIDLE <S>
	      The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or
	      -1 if there is no such tty.

       UID <S>
	      The real user ID of the shell process.  If you  have  sufficient
	      privileges, you may change the user ID of the shell by assigning
	      to this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient  privileges),  you
	      may  start  a  single  command  under  a	different  user	 ID by
	      `(UID=uid; command)'

       USERNAME <S>
	      The username corresponding to the real  user  ID	of  the	 shell
	      process.	 If you have sufficient privileges, you may change the
	      username (and also the user ID and group ID)  of	the  shell  by
	      assigning	 to  this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privi‐
	      leges), you may start a single command under a  different	 user‐
	      name  (and  user	ID  and group ID) by `(USERNAME=username; com‐
	      mand)'

       VENDOR The vendor, as determined at compile time.

       zsh_eval_context <S> <Z> (ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) indicating the context of	 shell
	      code that is being run.  Each time a piece of shell code that is
	      stored within the shell is  executed  a  string  is  temporarily
	      appended	to the array to indicate the type of operation that is
	      being performed.	Read in order the array gives an indication of
	      the  stack of operations being performed with the most immediate
	      context last.

	      Note that the variable does not give  information	 on  syntactic
	      context  such  as	 pipelines or subshells.  Use $ZSH_SUBSHELL to
	      detect subshells.

	      The context is one of the following:
	      cmdarg Code specified by the -c option to the command line  that
		     invoked the shell.

	      cmdsubst
		     Command substitution using the `...` or $(...) construct.

	      equalsubst
		     File substitution using the =(...) construct.

	      eval   Code executed by the eval builtin.

	      evalautofunc
		     Code executed with the KSH_AUTOLOAD mechanism in order to
		     define an autoloaded function.

	      fc     Code from the shell history executed by the -e option  to
		     the fc builtin.

	      file   Lines  of code being read directly from a file, for exam‐
		     ple by the source builtin.

	      filecode
		     Lines of code being read from  a  .zwc  file  instead  of
		     directly from the source file.

	      globqual
		     Code executed by the e or + glob qualifier.

	      globsort
		     Code executed to order files by the o glob qualifier.

	      insubst
		     File substitution using the <(...) construct.

	      loadautofunc
		     Code  read	 directly  from a file to define an autoloaded
		     function.

	      outsubst
		     File substitution using the >(...) construct.

	      sched  Code executed by the sched builtin.

	      shfunc A shell function.

	      stty   Code passed to stty by  the  STTY	environment  variable.
		     Normally  this  is	 passed	 directly to the system's stty
		     command, so this value is unlikely to be  seen  in	 prac‐
		     tice.

	      style  Code  executed as part of a style retrieved by the zstyle
		     builtin from the zsh/zutil module.

	      toplevel
		     The highest execution level of a  script  or  interactive
		     shell.

	      trap   Code  executed  as	 a  trap  defined by the trap builtin.
		     Traps defined as functions have the context  shfunc.   As
		     traps  are asynchronous they may have a different hierar‐
		     chy from other code.

	      zpty   Code executed by the zpty builtin from the zsh/zpty  mod‐
		     ule.

	      zregexparse-guard
		     Code  executed as a guard by the zregexparse command from
		     the zsh/zutil module.

	      zregexparse-action
		     Code executed as an action	 by  the  zregexparse  command
		     from the zsh/zutil module.

       ZSH_NAME
	      Expands  to  the	basename  of  the  command used to invoke this
	      instance of zsh.

       ZSH_PATCHLEVEL
	      The revision string for the version number of the ChangeLog file
	      in  the  zsh distribution.  This is most useful in order to keep
	      track of	versions  of  the  shell  during  development  between
	      releases;	 hence most users should not use it and should instead
	      rely on $ZSH_VERSION.

       zsh_scheduled_events
	      See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ZSH_SUBSHELL
	      Readonly integer.	 Initially zero,  incremented  each  time  the
	      shell  forks  to	create	a  subshell for executing code.	 Hence
	      `(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)' and `print $(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)'  out‐
	      put 1, while `( (print $ZSH_SUBSHELL) )' outputs 2.

       ZSH_VERSION
	      The version number of the release of zsh.

PARAMETERS USED BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are used by the shell.

       In  cases  where	 there are two parameters with an upper- and lowercase
       form of the same name, such as path and PATH, the lowercase form is  an
       array and the uppercase form is a scalar with the elements of the array
       joined together by colons.  These are similar to tied  parameters  cre‐
       ated  via `typeset -T'.	The normal use for the colon-separated form is
       for exporting to the environment, while the array  form	is  easier  to
       manipulate  within  the	shell.	Note that unsetting either of the pair
       will unset the other; they retain their special properties when	recre‐
       ated, and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.

       ARGV0  If  exported,  its value is used as the argv[0] of external com‐
	      mands.  Usually used in constructs like `ARGV0=emacs nethack'.

       BAUD   The rate in bits per second at which data reaches the  terminal.
	      The line editor will use this value in order to compensate for a
	      slow terminal by delaying updates to the	display	 until	neces‐
	      sary.   If  the parameter is unset or the value is zero the com‐
	      pensation mechanism is turned off.  The parameter is not set  by
	      default.

	      This parameter may be profitably set in some circumstances, e.g.
	      for slow modems dialing into a communications server,  or	 on  a
	      slow  wide  area	network.  It should be set to the baud rate of
	      the slowest part of the link for best performance.

       cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of  directories  specifying  the
	      search path for the cd command.

       COLUMNS <S>
	      The  number  of  columns	for  this  terminal session.  Used for
	      printing select lists and for the line editor.

       CORRECT_IGNORE
	      If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction.  Any
	      potential	 correction  that matches the pattern is ignored.  For
	      example, if the value is `_*' then completion functions  (which,
	      by  convention,  have  names  beginning  with `_') will never be
	      offered as spelling corrections.	The pattern does not apply  to
	      the  correction  of  file	 names,	 as applied by the CORRECT_ALL
	      option (so with the example just given files beginning with  `_'
	      in the current directory would still be completed).

       DIRSTACKSIZE
	      The  maximum size of the directory stack, by default there is no
	      limit.  If the stack gets larger than this, it will be truncated
	      automatically.  This is useful with the AUTO_PUSHD option.

       ENV    If the ENV environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as sh
	      or ksh, $ENV is sourced after the profile scripts.  The value of
	      ENV  is  subjected to parameter expansion, command substitution,
	      and arithmetic expansion before being interpreted as a pathname.
	      Note that ENV is not used unless zsh is emulating sh or ksh.

       FCEDIT The  default  editor  for the fc builtin.	 If FCEDIT is not set,
	      the parameter EDITOR is used; if	that  is  not  set  either,  a
	      builtin default, usually vi, is used.

       fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)
	      An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files
	      to be ignored during filename completion.	 However,  if  comple‐
	      tion only generates files with suffixes in this list, then these
	      files are completed anyway.

       fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)
	      An array (colon separated list) of  directories  specifying  the
	      search  path  for	 function  definitions.	 This path is searched
	      when a function with the -u attribute is referenced.  If an exe‐
	      cutable  file is found, then it is read and executed in the cur‐
	      rent environment.

       histchars <S>
	      Three characters used by the shell's history and lexical	analy‐
	      sis  mechanism.  The first character signals the start of a his‐
	      tory expansion (default `!').  The second character signals  the
	      start  of a quick history substitution (default `^').  The third
	      character is the comment character (default `#').

	      The characters must be in the ASCII character set;  any  attempt
	      to  set  histchars to characters with a locale-dependent meaning
	      will be rejected with an error message.

       HISTCHARS <S> <Z>
	      Same as histchars.  (Deprecated.)

       HISTFILE
	      The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits.
	      If unset, the history is not saved.

       HISTORY_IGNORE
	      If  set,	is  treated as a pattern at the time history files are
	      written.	Any potential history entry that matches  the  pattern
	      is  skipped.   For example, if the value is `fc *' then commands
	      that invoke the interactive history editor are never written  to
	      the history file (compare the HIST_NO_STORE option or the zshad‐
	      dhistory hook, either of which would prevent such commands  from
	      being added to the interactive history at all).

       HISTSIZE <S>
	      The  maximum  number  of	events	stored in the internal history
	      list.  If you use	 the  HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST  option,  setting
	      this  value larger than the SAVEHIST size will give you the dif‐
	      ference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.

       HOME <S>
	      The default argument for the cd command.	This is not set	 auto‐
	      matically	 by  the  shell in sh, ksh or csh emulation, but it is
	      typically present in the environment anyway, and if  it  becomes
	      set it has its usual special behaviour.

       IFS <S>
	      Internal	field  separators  (by default space, tab, newline and
	      NUL), that are used to separate words which result from  command
	      or  parameter expansion and words read by the read builtin.  Any
	      characters from the set space, tab and newline  that  appear  in
	      the IFS are called IFS white space.  One or more IFS white space
	      characters or one non-IFS white space  character	together  with
	      any  adjacent  IFS white space character delimit a field.	 If an
	      IFS white space character appears	 twice	consecutively  in  the
	      IFS,  this  character  is treated as if it were not an IFS white
	      space character.

	      If the parameter is unset, the default is used.  Note this has a
	      different effect from setting the parameter to an empty string.

       KEYBOARD_HACK
	      This  variable defines a character to be removed from the end of
	      the command line	before	interpreting  it  (interactive	shells
	      only). It is intended to fix the problem with keys placed annoy‐
	      ingly close to return and replaces  the  SUNKEYBOARDHACK	option
	      which did this for backquotes only.  Should the chosen character
	      be one of singlequote, doublequote or backquote, there must also
	      be an odd number of them on the command line for the last one to
	      be removed.

	      For backward compabitility, if  the  SUNKEYBOARDHACK  option  is
	      explicitly set, the value of KEYBOARD_HACK reverts to backquote.
	      If the option is explicitly  unset,  this	 variable  is  set  to
	      empty.

       KEYTIMEOUT
	      The  time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another
	      key to be pressed when reading bound multi-character sequences.

       LANG <S>
	      This variable determines the locale category  for	 any  category
	      not specifically selected via a variable starting with `LC_'.

       LC_ALL <S>
	      This variable overrides the value of the `LANG' variable and the
	      value of any of the other variables starting with `LC_'.

       LC_COLLATE <S>
	      This variable determines the locale category for character  col‐
	      lation  information within ranges in glob brackets and for sort‐
	      ing.

       LC_CTYPE <S>
	      This variable determines the locale category for character  han‐
	      dling  functions.	  If  the  MULTIBYTE  option is in effect this
	      variable or LANG should contain a value that reflects the	 char‐
	      acter  set  in  use,  even if it is a single-byte character set,
	      unless only the 7-bit subset (ASCII) is used.  For  example,  if
	      the  character  set  is  ISO-8859-1,  a  suitable value might be
	      en_US.iso88591 (certain Linux distributions) or  en_US.ISO8859-1
	      (MacOS).

       LC_MESSAGES <S>
	      This  variable  determines the language in which messages should
	      be written.  Note that zsh does not use message catalogs.

       LC_NUMERIC <S>
	      This variable affects the decimal point character and  thousands
	      separator character for the formatted input/output functions and
	      string conversion functions.  Note that zsh ignores this setting
	      when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.

       LC_TIME <S>
	      This  variable  determines the locale category for date and time
	      formatting in prompt escape sequences.

       LINES <S>
	      The number of lines for this terminal session.  Used for	print‐
	      ing select lists and for the line editor.

       LISTMAX
	      In the line editor, the number of matches to list without asking
	      first. If the value is negative, the list will be	 shown	if  it
	      spans  at most as many lines as given by the absolute value.  If
	      set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the listing would
	      scroll off the screen.

       LOGCHECK
	      The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity
	      using the watch parameter.

       MAIL   If this parameter is set and mailpath  is	 not  set,  the	 shell
	      looks for mail in the specified file.

       MAILCHECK
	      The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.

       mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list) of filenames to check for new
	      mail.  Each filename can be followed by a `?' and a message that
	      will  be printed.	 The message will undergo parameter expansion,
	      command substitution and arithmetic expansion with the  variable
	      $_  defined  as  the  name  of  the  file that has changed.  The
	      default message is `You have new mail'.	If  an	element	 is  a
	      directory	 instead  of  a	 file the shell will recursively check
	      every file in every subdirectory of the element.

       manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) whose value is not used  by  the
	      shell.   The manpath array can be useful, however, since setting
	      it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.

       match
       mbegin
       mend   Arrays set by the shell when the b globbing flag is used in pat‐
	      tern matches.  See the subsection Globbing flags in the documen‐
	      tation for Filename Generation in zshexpn(1).

       MATCH
       MBEGIN
       MEND   Set by the shell when the m globbing flag	 is  used  in  pattern
	      matches.	See the subsection Globbing flags in the documentation
	      for Filename Generation in zshexpn(1).

       module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list)  of  directories	that  zmodload
	      searches	for dynamically loadable modules.  This is initialized
	      to a standard  pathname,	usually	 `/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VER‐
	      SION'.   (The  `/usr/local/lib' part varies from installation to
	      installation.)  For security reasons, any value set in the envi‐
	      ronment when the shell is started will be ignored.

	      These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic
	      module loading.

       NULLCMD <S>
	      The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no
	      command.	 Defaults to cat.  For sh/ksh behavior, change this to
	      :.  For csh-like behavior, unset this parameter; the shell  will
	      print an error message if null commands are entered.

       path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list)  of directories to search for
	      commands.	 When this parameter is set, each directory is scanned
	      and all files found are put in a hash table.

       POSTEDIT <S>
	      This  string  is output whenever the line editor exits.  It usu‐
	      ally contains termcap strings to reset the terminal.

       PROMPT <S> <Z>
       PROMPT2 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT3 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT4 <S> <Z>
	      Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.

       prompt <S> <Z>
	      Same as PS1.

       PROMPT_EOL_MARK
	      When  the	 PROMPT_CR  and	 PROMPT_SP  options   are   set,   the
	      PROMPT_EOL_MARK  parameter  can be used to customize how the end
	      of partial lines are shown.   This  parameter  undergoes	prompt
	      expansion,  with the PROMPT_PERCENT option set.  If not set, the
	      default behavior is equivalent to the value `%B%S%#%s%b'.

       PS1 <S>
	      The primary prompt string, printed before a command is read.  It
	      undergoes	 a  special  form of expansion before being displayed;
	      see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).	The default is
	      `%m%# '.

       PS2 <S>
	      The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more informa‐
	      tion to complete a command.  It is expanded in the same  way  as
	      PS1.  The default is `%_> ', which displays any shell constructs
	      or quotation marks which are currently being processed.

       PS3 <S>
	      Selection prompt used within a select loop.  It is  expanded  in
	      the same way as PS1.  The default is `?# '.

       PS4 <S>
	      The  execution  trace prompt.  Default is `+%N:%i> ', which dis‐
	      plays the name of the current shell structure and the line  num‐
	      ber within it.  In sh or ksh emulation, the default is `+ '.

       psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list) whose elements can be used in
	      PROMPT strings.  Setting psvar also sets PSVAR, and vice versa.

       READNULLCMD <S>
	      The command name to assume if  a	single	input  redirection  is
	      specified with no command.  Defaults to more.

       REPORTTIME
	      If  nonnegative,	commands whose combined user and system execu‐
	      tion times (measured in seconds) are  greater  than  this	 value
	      have  timing  statistics printed for them.  Output is suppressed
	      for commands executed within the line editor, including  comple‐
	      tion;  commands  explicitly  marked  with the time keyword still
	      cause the summary to be printed in this case.

       REPLY  This parameter is reserved by convention to pass	string	values
	      between  shell  scripts and shell builtins in situations where a
	      function call or redirection are impossible or undesirable.  The
	      read  builtin  and the select complex command may set REPLY, and
	      filename generation both sets and examines its value when evalu‐
	      ating  certain  expressions.  Some modules also employ REPLY for
	      similar purposes.

       reply  As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.

       RPROMPT <S>
       RPS1 <S>
	      This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side  of  the	screen
	      when  the	 primary  prompt is being displayed on the left.  This
	      does not work if the  SINGLE_LINE_ZLE  option  is	 set.	It  is
	      expanded in the same way as PS1.

       RPROMPT2 <S>
       RPS2 <S>
	      This  prompt  is	displayed on the right-hand side of the screen
	      when the secondary prompt is being displayed on the left.	  This
	      does  not	 work  if  the	SINGLE_LINE_ZLE	 option is set.	 It is
	      expanded in the same way as PS2.

       SAVEHIST
	      The maximum number of history events  to	save  in  the  history
	      file.

       SPROMPT <S>
	      The  prompt  used	 for  spelling	correction.  The sequence `%R'
	      expands to the string which presumably  needs  spelling  correc‐
	      tion,  and  `%r'	expands to the proposed correction.  All other
	      prompt escapes are also allowed.

       STTY   If this parameter is set in a command's environment,  the	 shell
	      runs  the stty command with the value of this parameter as argu‐
	      ments in order to set up the terminal before executing the  com‐
	      mand. The modes apply only to the command, and are reset when it
	      finishes or is suspended. If the command is suspended  and  con‐
	      tinued  later with the fg or wait builtins it will see the modes
	      specified by STTY, as if it were not  suspended.	 This  (inten‐
	      tionally)	 does  not apply if the command is continued via `kill
	      -CONT'.  STTY is ignored if the command  is  run	in  the	 back‐
	      ground,  or  if  it  is  in the environment of the shell but not
	      explicitly assigned to in the input line.	 This  avoids  running
	      stty  at	every  external	 command by accidentally exporting it.
	      Also note that STTY should not be used for window size  specifi‐
	      cations; these will not be local to the command.

       TERM <S>
	      The type of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up term‐
	      cap sequences.  An assignment to TERM causes zsh to  re-initial‐
	      ize  the	terminal,  even	 if  the  value does not change (e.g.,
	      `TERM=$TERM').  It is necessary to make such an assignment  upon
	      any  change to the terminal definition database or terminal type
	      in order for the new settings to take effect.

       TERMINFO <S>
	      A reference to a compiled description of the terminal,  used  by
	      the  `terminfo' library when the system has it; see terminfo(5).
	      If set, this causes the shell to reinitialise the terminal, mak‐
	      ing the workaround `TERM=$TERM' unnecessary.

       TIMEFMT
	      The  format  of process time reports with the time keyword.  The
	      default is `%J  %U user %S system %P cpu %*E total'.  Recognizes
	      the  following  escape sequences, although not all may be avail‐
	      able on all systems, and some that are available may not be use‐
	      ful:

	      %%     A `%'.
	      %U     CPU seconds spent in user mode.
	      %S     CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
	      %E     Elapsed time in seconds.
	      %P     The CPU percentage, computed as (100*%U+%S)/%E.
	      %W     Number of times the process was swapped.
	      %X     The  average  amount in (shared) text space used in kilo‐
		     bytes.
	      %D     The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in
		     kilobytes.
	      %K     The total space used (%X+%D) in kilobytes.
	      %M     The  maximum memory the process had in use at any time in
		     megabytes.
	      %F     The number of  major  page	 faults	 (page	needed	to  be
		     brought from disk).
	      %R     The number of minor page faults.
	      %I     The number of input operations.
	      %O     The number of output operations.
	      %r     The number of socket messages received.
	      %s     The number of socket messages sent.
	      %k     The number of signals received.
	      %w     Number of voluntary context switches (waits).
	      %c     Number of involuntary context switches.
	      %J     The name of this job.

	      A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags print‐
	      ing time.	 This cause the time to be printed  in	`hh:mm:ss.ttt'
	      format  (hours  and  minutes  are	 only  printed if they are not
	      zero).

       TMOUT  If this parameter is nonzero, the shell  will  receive  an  ALRM
	      signal  if  a command is not entered within the specified number
	      of seconds after issuing	a  prompt.  If	there  is  a  trap  on
	      SIGALRM,	it will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled using
	      the value of the TMOUT parameter after executing the  trap.   If
	      no  trap	is  set, and the idle time of the terminal is not less
	      than the value of the TMOUT parameter, zsh  terminates.	Other‐
	      wise  a  new  alarm is scheduled to TMOUT seconds after the last
	      keypress.

       TMPPREFIX
	      A pathname prefix which the shell will  use  for	all  temporary
	      files.   Note  that  this should include an initial part for the
	      file name as well	 as  any  directory  names.   The  default  is
	      `/tmp/zsh'.

       watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list)  of  login/logout  events  to
	      report.	If  it	contains  the  single  word  `all',  then  all
	      login/logout  events  are	 reported.   If it contains the single
	      word `notme', then all events are reported as with `all'	except
	      $USERNAME.   An entry in this list may consist of a username, an
	      `@' followed by a remote hostname, and a `%' followed by a  line
	      (tty).   Any  or	all  of	 these components may be present in an
	      entry; if a login/logout	event  matches	all  of	 them,	it  is
	      reported.

       WATCHFMT
	      The  format  of  login/logout  reports if the watch parameter is
	      set.  Default is `%n has %a %l from %m'.	Recognizes the follow‐
	      ing escape sequences:

	      %n     The name of the user that logged in/out.

	      %a     The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".

	      %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on.

	      %M     The full hostname of the remote host.

	      %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	If only the IP address
		     is available or the utmp field contains the  name	of  an
		     X-windows display, the whole name is printed.

		     NOTE:  The	 `%m' and `%M' escapes will work only if there
		     is a host name field in the utmp on your machine.	Other‐
		     wise they are treated as ordinary strings.

	      %S (%s)
		     Start (stop) standout mode.

	      %U (%u)
		     Start (stop) underline mode.

	      %B (%b)
		     Start (stop) boldface mode.

	      %t
	      %@     The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

	      %T     The time, in 24-hour format.

	      %w     The date in `day-dd' format.

	      %W     The date in `mm/dd/yy' format.

	      %D     The date in `yy-mm-dd' format.

	      %(x:true-text:false-text)
		     Specifies	a ternary expression.  The character following
		     the x is arbitrary; the same character is used  to	 sepa‐
		     rate  the	text  for  the "true" result from that for the
		     "false" result.  Both the separator and the right	paren‐
		     thesis  may be escaped with a backslash.  Ternary expres‐
		     sions may be nested.

		     The test character x may be any one of `l', `n',  `m'  or
		     `M',  which indicate a `true' result if the corresponding
		     escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may
		     be	 `a',  which  indicates a `true' result if the watched
		     user has logged in, or `false'  if	 he  has  logged  out.
		     Other  characters evaluate to neither true nor false; the
		     entire expression is omitted in this case.

		     If the result is `true', then the true-text is  formatted
		     according	to  the	 rules	above  and  printed,  and  the
		     false-text is skipped.   If  `false',  the	 true-text  is
		     skipped  and  the	false-text  is	formatted and printed.
		     Either or both of the branches may	 be  empty,  but  both
		     separators must be present in any case.

       WORDCHARS <S>
	      A	 list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word
	      by the line editor.

       ZBEEP  If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the
	      same  codes  as  the bindkey command as described in the zsh/zle
	      module entry in zshmodules(1), that will be output to the termi‐
	      nal  instead  of beeping.	 This may have a visible instead of an
	      audible effect; for example,  the	 string	 `\e[?5h\e[?5l'	 on  a
	      vt100 or xterm will have the effect of flashing reverse video on
	      and off (if you usually use reverse video, you  should  use  the
	      string  `\e[?5l\e[?5h' instead).	This takes precedence over the
	      NOBEEP option.

       ZDOTDIR
	      The directory to search for shell startup files  (.zshrc,	 etc),
	      if not $HOME.

       ZLE_LINE_ABORTED
	      This  parameter  is set by the line editor when an error occurs.
	      It contains the line that was being edited at the point  of  the
	      error.   `print -zr -- $ZLE_LINE_ABORTED' can be used to recover
	      the line.	 Only the most recent line of this kind is remembered.

       ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS
       ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS
	      These parameters are used by the line editor.  In	 certain  cir‐
	      cumstances suffixes (typically space or slash) added by the com‐
	      pletion system will be removed automatically, either because the
	      next editing command was not an insertable character, or because
	      the character was marked as requiring the suffix to be removed.

	      These variables can contain the sets  of	characters  that  will
	      cause  the  suffix to be removed.	 If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is
	      set, those characters will cause the suffix to  be  removed;  if
	      ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS  is  set, those characters will cause the
	      suffix to be removed and replaced by a space.

	      If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is not set, the default behaviour  is
	      equivalent to:

		     ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$' \t\n;&|'

	      If  ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS  is  set but is empty, no characters
	      have this behaviour.  ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS  takes  precedence,
	      so that the following:

		     ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$'&|'

	      causes  the  characters  `&' and `|' to remove the suffix but to
	      replace it with a space.

	      To  illustrate  the  difference,	 suppose   that	  the	option
	      AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH	 is  in	 effect and the directory DIR has just
	      been completed, with an appended /,  following  which  the  user
	      types  `&'.  The default result is `DIR&'.  With ZLE_REMOVE_SUF‐
	      FIX_CHARS set but without including `&' the result  is  `DIR/&'.
	      With  ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS  set	 to  include `&' the result is
	      `DIR &'.

	      Note that certain	 completions  may  provide  their  own	suffix
	      removal  or  replacement	behaviour  which  overrides the values
	      described here.  See the completion system documentation in zsh‐
	      compsys(1).

       ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT <S>
	      If set, used to give the indentation between the right hand side
	      of the right prompt in the line  editor  as  given  by  RPS1  or
	      RPROMPT  and the right hand side of the screen.  If not set, the
	      value 1 is used.

	      Typically this will be used to set the value to 0	 so  that  the
	      prompt  appears  flush  with  the right hand side of the screen.
	      This is not the default as many terminals	 do  not  handle  this
	      correctly,  in particular when the prompt appears at the extreme
	      bottom right of the screen.  Recent virtual terminals  are  more
	      likely  to  handle this case correctly.  Some experimentation is
	      necessary.

ZSHOPTIONS(1)							 ZSHOPTIONS(1)

NAME
       zshoptions - zsh options

SPECIFYING OPTIONS
       Options are primarily referred to by name.  These names are case insen‐
       sitive and underscores are ignored.  For example, `allexport' is equiv‐
       alent to `A__lleXP_ort'.

       The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with	 `no',
       so  `setopt  No_Beep' is equivalent to `unsetopt beep'.	This inversion
       can only be done once, so `nonobeep' is not a synonym for `beep'.  Sim‐
       ilarly,	`tify'	is  not	 a  synonym  for  `nonotify' (the inversion of
       `notify').

       Some options also have one or more single letter names.	There are  two
       sets of single letter options: one used by default, and another used to
       emulate sh/ksh (used when the SH_OPTION_LETTERS option  is  set).   The
       single  letter  options	can be used on the shell command line, or with
       the set, setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options  preceded
       by `-'.

       The  sense  of  the  single letter options may be inverted by using `+'
       instead of `-'.	Some of the single letter option  names	 refer	to  an
       option  being  off,  in which case the inversion of that name refers to
       the option being on.  For example, `+n' is the short  name  of  `exec',
       and `-n' is the short name of its inversion, `noexec'.

       In  strings  of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup,
       trailing whitespace will be ignored; for example the  string  `-f     '
       will  be treated just as `-f', but the string `-f i' is an error.  This
       is because many systems which implement the `#!' mechanism for  calling
       scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.

DESCRIPTION OF OPTIONS
       In  the	following  list,  options set by default in all emulations are
       marked <D>; those set by default only in csh, ksh, sh,  or  zsh	emula‐
       tions  are  marked  <C>,	 <K>,  <S>,  <Z> as appropriate.  When listing
       options (by `setopt', `unsetopt', `set -o' or `set +o'),	 those	turned
       on  by  default	appear	in the list prefixed with `no'.	 Hence (unless
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT is set), `setopt' shows all options whose settings are
       changed from the default.

   Changing Directories
       AUTO_CD (-J)
	      If  a  command is issued that can't be executed as a normal com‐
	      mand, and the command is the name of a directory, perform the cd
	      command to that directory.

       AUTO_PUSHD (-N)
	      Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.

       CDABLE_VARS (-T)
	      If  the  argument	 to  a	cd  command (or an implied cd with the
	      AUTO_CD option set) is not a directory, and does not begin  with
	      a	 slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded by
	      a `~' (see the section `Filename Expansion').

       CHASE_DOTS
	      When changing to a directory  containing	a  path	 segment  `..'
	      which  would otherwise be treated as canceling the previous seg‐
	      ment in the path (in other words, `foo/..' would be removed from
	      the  path,  or  if  `..' is the first part of the path, the last
	      part of the current working directory would be removed), instead
	      resolve  the  path  to  the  physical directory.	This option is
	      overridden by CHASE_LINKS.

	      For example,  suppose  /foo/bar  is  a  link  to	the  directory
	      /alt/rod.	  Without this option set, `cd /foo/bar/..' changes to
	      /foo; with it set, it changes to /alt.  The same applies if  the
	      current  directory  is  /foo/bar and `cd ..' is used.  Note that
	      all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.

       CHASE_LINKS (-w)
	      Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing direc‐
	      tory.   This also has the effect of CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a `..' path
	      segment will be treated as referring  to	the  physical  parent,
	      even if the preceding path segment is a symbolic link.

       POSIX_CD
	      Modifies	the  behaviour of cd, chdir and pushd commands to make
	      them more compatible with the POSIX standard. The behaviour with
	      the  option  unset  is described in the documentation for the cd
	      builtin in zshbuiltins(1).  If the option is set, the shell does
	      not test for directories beneath the local directory (`.') until
	      after all directories in cdpath have been tested.

	      Also, if the option is set, the conditions under which the shell
	      prints  the new directory after changing to it are modified.  It
	      is no longer restricted to interactive shells (although printing
	      of  the  directory stack with pushd is still limited to interac‐
	      tive shells); and any use of a component of CDPATH, including  a
	      `.'  but	excluding an empty component that is otherwise treated
	      as `.', causes the directory to be printed.

       PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
	      Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the direc‐
	      tory stack.

       PUSHD_MINUS
	      Exchanges the meanings of `+' and `-' when used with a number to
	      specify a directory in the stack.

       PUSHD_SILENT (-E)
	      Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.

       PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)
	      Have pushd with no arguments act like `pushd $HOME'.

   Completion
       ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>
	      If unset, key functions that list completions try to  return  to
	      the  last prompt if given a numeric argument. If set these func‐
	      tions try to return to the last prompt if given no numeric argu‐
	      ment.

       ALWAYS_TO_END
	      If  a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and
	      a full completion is inserted, the cursor is moved to the end of
	      the  word.   That is, the cursor is moved to the end of the word
	      if either a single match is inserted or menu completion is  per‐
	      formed.

       AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>
	      Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.

       AUTO_MENU <D>
	      Automatically  use  menu completion after the second consecutive
	      request for completion, for example  by  pressing	 the  tab  key
	      repeatedly. This option is overridden by MENU_COMPLETE.

       AUTO_NAME_DIRS
	      Any  parameter  that  is set to the absolute name of a directory
	      immediately becomes a name for that directory, that will be used
	      by  the `%~' and related prompt sequences, and will be available
	      when completion is performed on a word starting with `~'.	 (Oth‐
	      erwise, the parameter must be used in the form `~param' first.)

       AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>
	      If  a  parameter	name  was  completed and a following character
	      (normally a space) automatically inserted, and the next  charac‐
	      ter  typed  is one of those that have to come directly after the
	      name (like `}', `:', etc.), the automatically added character is
	      deleted, so that the character typed comes immediately after the
	      parameter name.  Completion in a	brace  expansion  is  affected
	      similarly:  the  added character is a `,', which will be removed
	      if `}' is typed next.

       AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>
	      If a parameter is completed whose	 content  is  the  name	 of  a
	      directory, then add a trailing slash instead of a space.

       AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>
	      When  the	 last character resulting from a completion is a slash
	      and the next character typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or  a
	      character	 that ends a command (such as a semicolon or an amper‐
	      sand), remove the slash.

       BASH_AUTO_LIST
	      On an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when  the
	      completion  function  is called twice in succession.  This takes
	      precedence over AUTO_LIST.  The  setting	of  LIST_AMBIGUOUS  is
	      respected.   If  AUTO_MENU  is set, the menu behaviour will then
	      start with the third press.  Note that this will not  work  with
	      MENU_COMPLETE, since repeated completion calls immediately cycle
	      through the list in that case.

       COMPLETE_ALIASES
	      Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally  sub‐
	      stituted	before completion is attempted.	 The effect is to make
	      the alias a distinct command for completion purposes.

       COMPLETE_IN_WORD
	      If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion
	      is started. Otherwise it stays there and completion is done from
	      both ends.

       GLOB_COMPLETE
	      When the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all  the
	      words  resulting	from the expansion but generate matches as for
	      completion  and  cycle  through  them  like  MENU_COMPLETE.  The
	      matches  are  generated  as if a `*' was added to the end of the
	      word, or inserted at the cursor when  COMPLETE_IN_WORD  is  set.
	      This  actually  uses pattern matching, not globbing, so it works
	      not only for files but for any completion, such as options, user
	      names, etc.

	      Note  that  when	the  pattern matcher is used, matching control
	      (for example, case-insensitive or anchored matching)  cannot  be
	      used.   This  limitation only applies when the current word con‐
	      tains a pattern; simply turning on the GLOB_COMPLETE option does
	      not have this effect.

       HASH_LIST_ALL <D>
	      Whenever	 a   command  completion  or  spelling	correction  is
	      attempted, make sure the entire command path  is	hashed	first.
	      This  makes the first completion slower but avoids false reports
	      of spelling errors.

       LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>
	      This option works when AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also  set.
	      If there is an unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line,
	      that is done without a completion list being displayed; in other
	      words,  auto-listing  behaviour  only  takes  place when nothing
	      would be inserted.  In the case of  BASH_AUTO_LIST,  this	 means
	      that the list will be delayed to the third call of the function.

       LIST_BEEP <D>
	      Beep  on	an ambiguous completion.  More accurately, this forces
	      the completion widgets to return status 1 on an  ambiguous  com‐
	      pletion,	which  causes  the shell to beep if the option BEEP is
	      also set; this may be modified if completion is  called  from  a
	      user-defined widget.

       LIST_PACKED
	      Try  to  make the completion list smaller (occupying less lines)
	      by printing the matches in columns with different widths.

       LIST_ROWS_FIRST
	      Lay out the matches in  completion  lists	 sorted	 horizontally,
	      that  is, the second match is to the right of the first one, not
	      under it as usual.

       LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>
	      When listing files that are possible completions, show the  type
	      of each file with a trailing identifying mark.

       MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)
	      On  an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or
	      beeping, insert the first match immediately.  Then when  comple‐
	      tion  is	requested again, remove the first match and insert the
	      second match, etc.  When there are no more matches, go  back  to
	      the  first one again.  reverse-menu-complete may be used to loop
	      through the list in the other direction. This  option  overrides
	      AUTO_MENU.

       REC_EXACT (-S)
	      In  completion, recognize exact matches even if they are ambigu‐
	      ous.

   Expansion and Globbing
       BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>
	      If a pattern for filename generation is badly formed,  print  an
	      error  message.	(If  this option is unset, the pattern will be
	      left unchanged.)

       BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>
	      In a glob pattern, treat a trailing  set	of  parentheses	 as  a
	      qualifier	 list,	if it contains no `|', `(' or (if special) `~'
	      characters.  See the section `Filename Generation'.

       BRACE_CCL
	      Expand expressions in braces which would not  otherwise  undergo
	      brace  expansion	to a lexically ordered list of all the charac‐
	      ters.  See the section `Brace Expansion'.

       CASE_GLOB <D>
	      Make globbing (filename generation)  sensitive  to  case.	  Note
	      that  other  uses	 of patterns are always sensitive to case.  If
	      the option is unset, the presence of any character which is spe‐
	      cial  to	filename generation will cause case-insensitive match‐
	      ing.  For example, cvs(/) can match the directory CVS  owing  to
	      the   presence   of   the	  globbing  flag  (unless  the	option
	      BARE_GLOB_QUAL is unset).

       CASE_MATCH <D>
	      Make regular expressions using the zsh/regex  module  (including
	      matches with =~) sensitive to case.

       CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>
	      If  a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the
	      pattern from the argument list; do not report  an	 error	unless
	      all  the	patterns  in  a	 command  have	no matches.  Overrides
	      NOMATCH.

       EQUALS <Z>
	      Perform = filename expansion.  (See the section `Filename Expan‐
	      sion'.)

       EXTENDED_GLOB
	      Treat  the  `#',	`~' and `^' characters as part of patterns for
	      filename generation, etc.	 (An initial unquoted `~' always  pro‐
	      duces named directory expansion.)

       FORCE_FLOAT
	      Constants	 in  arithmetic evaluation will be treated as floating
	      point even without the use of a decimal point.  Integers in  any
	      base will be converted.

       GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>
	      Perform filename generation (globbing).  (See the section `File‐
	      name Generation'.)

       GLOB_ASSIGN <C>
	      If this option is set, filename generation  (globbing)  is  per‐
	      formed on the right hand side of scalar parameter assignments of
	      the form `name=pattern (e.g. `foo=*').  If the result  has  more
	      than  one	 word  the  parameter  will become an array with those
	      words as arguments. This option is provided for  backwards  com‐
	      patibility  only: globbing is always performed on the right hand
	      side of array  assignments  of  the  form	 `name=(value)'	 (e.g.
	      `foo=(*)')  and  this form is recommended for clarity; with this
	      option set, it is not possible to	 predict  whether  the	result
	      will be an array or a scalar.

       GLOB_DOTS (-4)
	      Do not require a leading `.' in a filename to be matched explic‐
	      itly.

       GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>
	      Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being
	      eligible	for  file  expansion  and filename generation, and any
	      characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible
	      for  filename generation.	 Braces (and commas in between) do not
	      become eligible for expansion.

       HIST_SUBST_PATTERN
	      Substitutions using the :s and :&	 history  modifiers  are  per‐
	      formed  with  pattern matching instead of string matching.  This
	      occurs wherever history  modifiers  are  valid,  including  glob
	      qualifiers  and  parameters.   See the section Modifiers in zsh‐
	      expn(1).

       IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>
	      Do not perform brace expansion.	For  historical	 reasons  this
	      also includes the effect of the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option.

       IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES
	      When  neither this option nor IGNORE_BRACES is set, a sole close
	      brace character `}' is syntactically significant at any point on
	      a	 command  line.	 This has the effect that no semicolon or new‐
	      line is necessary before the brace  terminating  a  function  or
	      current  shell  construct.  When either option is set, a closing
	      brace is syntactically significant  only	in  command  position.
	      Unlike  IGNORE_BRACES, this option does not disable brace expan‐
	      sion.

	      For example, with both options unset a function may  be  defined
	      in the following fashion:

		     args() { echo $# }

	      while  if either option is set, this does not work and something
	      equivalent to the following is required:

		     args() { echo $#; }

       KSH_GLOB <K>
	      In  pattern  matching,  the  interpretation  of  parentheses  is
	      affected by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  See the sec‐
	      tion `Filename Generation'.

       MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
	      All unquoted arguments of the form `anything=expression' appear‐
	      ing  after  the  command	name have filename expansion (that is,
	      where expression has a leading `~' or `=') performed on  expres‐
	      sion  as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is not
	      otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the	command	 as  a
	      single argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment.
	      For example, in echo  foo=~/bar:~/rod,  both  occurrences	 of  ~
	      would  be	 replaced.  Note that this happens anyway with typeset
	      and similar statements.

	      This option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option.   In
	      other  words,  if	 both options are in effect, arguments looking
	      like assignments will not undergo word splitting.

       MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)
	      Append a trailing `/' to	all  directory	names  resulting  from
	      filename generation (globbing).

       MULTIBYTE <C> <K> <Z>
	      Respect  multibyte  characters when found in strings.  When this
	      option is set, strings are examined using the system library  to
	      determine how many bytes form a character, depending on the cur‐
	      rent locale.  This affects the way  characters  are  counted  in
	      pattern matching, parameter values and various delimiters.

	      The  option  is  on  by  default	if the shell was compiled with
	      MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT except in sh emulation; otherwise it is off by
	      default  and  has no effect if turned on.	 The mode is off in sh
	      emulation for compatibility but for interactive use may need  to
	      be turned on if the terminal interprets multibyte characters.

	      If the option is off a single byte is always treated as a single
	      character.   This	 setting  is  designed	purely	for  examining
	      strings  known to contain raw bytes or other values that may not
	      be characters in the current locale.  It	is  not	 necessary  to
	      unset  the  option merely because the character set for the cur‐
	      rent locale does not contain multibyte characters.

	      The option does not affect the  shell's  editor,	 which	always
	      uses  the	 locale	 to  determine	multibyte characters.  This is
	      because the character set displayed by the terminal emulator  is
	      independent of shell settings.

       NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>
	      If  a  pattern  for filename generation has no matches, print an
	      error, instead of leaving it unchanged  in  the  argument	 list.
	      This also applies to file expansion of an initial `~' or `='.

       NULL_GLOB (-G)
	      If  a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the
	      pattern from the argument list instead of	 reporting  an	error.
	      Overrides NOMATCH.

       NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
	      If  numeric  filenames are matched by a filename generation pat‐
	      tern, sort the filenames numerically rather  than	 lexicographi‐
	      cally.

       RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)
	      Array  expansions of the form `foo${xx}bar', where the parameter
	      xx is set to (a b c),  are  substituted  with  `fooabar  foobbar
	      foocbar'	instead	 of  the  default `fooa b cbar'.  Note that an
	      empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

       REMATCH_PCRE <Z>
	      If set, regular expression matching with the  =~	operator  will
	      use  Perl-Compatible  Regular Expressions from the PCRE library,
	      if available.  If not set,  regular  expressions	will  use  the
	      extended regexp syntax provided by the system libraries.

       SH_GLOB <K> <S>
	      Disables	the special meaning of `(', `|', `)' and '<' for glob‐
	      bing the result of parameter and command substitutions,  and  in
	      some  other places where the shell accepts patterns.  If SH_GLOB
	      is set but KSH_GLOB is not, the shell allows the	interpretation
	      of  subshell  expressions	 enclosed in parentheses in some cases
	      where there is no space before  the  opening  parenthesis,  e.g.
	      !(true)  is  interpreted	as  if there were a space after the !.
	      This option is set by default if zsh is invoked as sh or ksh.

       UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>
	      Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when	 substituting.
	      Otherwise they are treated as an error.

       WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
	      Print  a warning message when a global parameter is created in a
	      function by an assignment.  This often indicates that a  parame‐
	      ter  has	not  been  declared  local  when  it should have been.
	      Parameters explicitly declared global  from  within  a  function
	      using  typeset -g do not cause a warning.	 Note that there is no
	      warning when a local parameter is assigned to in a nested	 func‐
	      tion, which may also indicate an error.

   History
       APPEND_HISTORY <D>
	      If  this	is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to
	      the history file, rather than replace it. Thus, multiple	paral‐
	      lel  zsh	sessions will all have the new entries from their his‐
	      tory lists added to the history file, in	the  order  that  they
	      exit.  The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it
	      when the number of lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by
	      $SAVEHIST (see also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

       BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>
	      Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the char‐
	      acter `!' specially.

       EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>
	      Save each command's beginning timestamp (in  seconds  since  the
	      epoch)  and  the duration (in seconds) to the history file.  The
	      format of this prefixed data is:

	      `: <beginning time>:<elapsed seconds>;<command>'.

       HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
	      Add `|' to output redirections in the history.  This allows his‐
	      tory references to clobber files even when CLOBBER is unset.

       HIST_BEEP <D>
	      Beep  when  an  attempt  is made to access a history entry which
	      isn't there.

       HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
	      If the internal history needs to be trimmed to add  the  current
	      command  line, setting this option will cause the oldest history
	      event that has a duplicate to be lost  before  losing  a	unique
	      event  from  the	list.	You should be sure to set the value of
	      HISTSIZE to a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to  give  you
	      some  room for the duplicated events, otherwise this option will
	      behave just like HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills  up
	      with unique events.

       HIST_FCNTL_LOCK
	      When  writing  out  the history file, by default zsh uses ad-hoc
	      file locking to avoid known problems with locking on some	 oper‐
	      ating systems.  With this option locking is done by means of the
	      system's fcntl call, where this method is available.  On	recent
	      operating	 systems  this may provide better performance, in par‐
	      ticular avoiding history corruption when	files  are  stored  on
	      NFS.

       HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
	      When  searching  for  history entries in the line editor, do not
	      display duplicates of a  line  previously	 found,	 even  if  the
	      duplicates are not contiguous.

       HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
	      If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates
	      an older one, the older command is removed from the  list	 (even
	      if it is not the previous event).

       HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)
	      Do  not  enter  command  lines into the history list if they are
	      duplicates of the previous event.

       HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)
	      Remove command lines from the history list when the first	 char‐
	      acter  on	 the  line  is	a  space,  or when one of the expanded
	      aliases contains a leading  space.   Only	 normal	 aliases  (not
	      global  or  suffix  aliases) have this behaviour.	 Note that the
	      command lingers in the internal history until the	 next  command
	      is  entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or
	      edit the line.  If you want to make it vanish right away without
	      entering another command, type a space and press return.

       HIST_LEX_WORDS
	      By  default,  shell  history that is read in from files is split
	      into words on all white space.  This means that  arguments  with
	      quoted  whitespace  are  not  correctly handled, with the conse‐
	      quence that references to words in history lines that have  been
	      read  from  a  file may be inaccurate.  When this option is set,
	      words read in from a history file are divided up	in  a  similar
	      fashion  to  normal  shell command line handling.	 Although this
	      produces more accurately delimited words, if  the	 size  of  the
	      history file is large this can be slow.  Trial and error is nec‐
	      essary to decide.

       HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
	      Remove function definitions from the history  list.   Note  that
	      the function lingers in the internal history until the next com‐
	      mand is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly  re‐
	      use or edit the definition.

       HIST_NO_STORE
	      Remove  the  history  (fc -l) command from the history list when
	      invoked.	Note that the command lingers in the internal  history
	      until  the  next command is entered before it vanishes, allowing
	      you to briefly reuse or edit the line.

       HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
	      Remove superfluous blanks from each command line being added  to
	      the history list.

       HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY <D>
	      When  the	 history  file	is re-written, we normally write out a
	      copy of the file named $HISTFILE.new and then rename it over the
	      old  one.	 However, if this option is unset, we instead truncate
	      the old history file and write out the new version in-place.  If
	      one  of  the  history-appending  options is enabled, this option
	      only has an effect when the enlarged history file	 needs	to  be
	      re-written  to  trim  it down to size.  Disable this only if you
	      have special needs, as doing so makes it possible to  lose  his‐
	      tory entries if zsh gets interrupted during the save.

	      When  writing  out a copy of the history file, zsh preserves the
	      old file's permissions and group information, but will refuse to
	      write  out  a  new  file	if  it would change the history file's
	      owner.

       HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
	      When writing out the history file, older commands that duplicate
	      newer ones are omitted.

       HIST_VERIFY
	      Whenever	the  user  enters a line with history expansion, don't
	      execute the line directly; instead,  perform  history  expansion
	      and reload the line into the editing buffer.

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY
	      This  options  works like APPEND_HISTORY except that new history
	      lines are added to the $HISTFILE incrementally (as soon as  they
	      are  entered),  rather  than waiting until the shell exits.  The
	      file will still be periodically re-written to trim it  when  the
	      number  of  lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by $SAVE‐
	      HIST (see also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

       SHARE_HISTORY <K>

	      This option both imports new commands from the history file, and
	      also  causes  your  typed commands to be appended to the history
	      file (the latter is like	specifying  INC_APPEND_HISTORY).   The
	      history  lines are also output with timestamps ala EXTENDED_HIS‐
	      TORY (which makes it easier to find the spot where we  left  off
	      reading the file after it gets re-written).

	      By  default,  history movement commands visit the imported lines
	      as well as the local lines, but you can toggle this on  and  off
	      with  the set-local-history zle binding.	It is also possible to
	      create a zle widget that will make some commands ignore imported
	      commands, and some include them.

	      If  you  find  that you want more control over when commands get
	      imported,	  you	may   wish   to	  turn	 SHARE_HISTORY	  off,
	      INC_APPEND_HISTORY  on,  and then manually import commands when‐
	      ever you need them using `fc -RI'.

   Initialisation
       ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)
	      All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.

       GLOBAL_EXPORT (<Z>)
	      If this option is set, passing  the  -x  flag  to	 the  builtins
	      declare,	float,	integer,  readonly and typeset (but not local)
	      will also set the -g flag;  hence	 parameters  exported  to  the
	      environment  will	 not  be made local to the enclosing function,
	      unless they were already or the flag +g is given explicitly.  If
	      the  option  is unset, exported parameters will be made local in
	      just the same way as any other parameter.

	      This option is set by default for backward compatibility; it  is
	      not  recommended	that  its behaviour be relied upon.  Note that
	      the builtin export always sets both the -x  and  -g  flags,  and
	      hence its effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing func‐
	      tion; this is the most portable way to achieve this behaviour.

       GLOBAL_RCS (-d) <D>
	      If this  option  is  unset,  the	startup	 files	/etc/zprofile,
	      /etc/zshrc,  /etc/zlogin	and  /etc/zlogout will not be run.  It
	      can be disabled and re-enabled at	 any  time,  including	inside
	      local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).

       RCS (+f) <D>
	      After  /etc/zshenv  is  sourced  on startup, source the .zshenv,
	      /etc/zprofile, .zprofile, /etc/zshrc, .zshrc, /etc/zlogin, .zlo‐
	      gin,  and	 .zlogout  files, as described in the section `Files'.
	      If this option is unset, the /etc/zshenv file is still  sourced,
	      but  any of the others will not be; it can be set at any time to
	      prevent the remaining startup files after the currently  execut‐
	      ing one from being sourced.

   Input/Output
       ALIASES <D>
	      Expand aliases.

       CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>
	      Allows  `>'  redirection to truncate existing files, and `>>' to
	      create files.  Otherwise `>!' or `>|' must be used to truncate a
	      file, and `>>!' or `>>|' to create a file.

       CORRECT (-0)
	      Try  to  correct	the spelling of commands.  Note that, when the
	      HASH_LIST_ALL option is not set or when some directories in  the
	      path  are	 not readable, this may falsely report spelling errors
	      the first time some commands are used.

	      The shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE may be set  to	a  pattern  to
	      match words that will never be offered as corrections.

       CORRECT_ALL (-O)
	      Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.

       DVORAK Use  the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty keyboard
	      as a basis for examining spelling mistakes for the  CORRECT  and
	      CORRECT_ALL options and the spell-word editor command.

       FLOW_CONTROL <D>
	      If  this	option	is  unset,  output flow control via start/stop
	      characters (usually  assigned  to	 ^S/^Q)	 is  disabled  in  the
	      shell's editor.

       IGNORE_EOF (-7)
	      Do  not  exit on end-of-file.  Require the use of exit or logout
	      instead.	However, ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell  to
	      exit anyway, to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.

	      Also,  if	 this  option  is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used,
	      widgets implemented by shell functions can be bound to EOF (nor‐
	      mally  Control-D)	 without  printing the normal warning message.
	      This works only for normal widgets, not for completion widgets.

       INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>
	      Allow comments even in interactive shells.

       HASH_CMDS <D>
	      Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.
	      Subsequent  invocations  of  the same command will use the saved
	      location, avoiding a path search.	 If this option is  unset,  no
	      path hashing is done at all.  However, when CORRECT is set, com‐
	      mands whose names do not appear in the functions or aliases hash
	      tables  are  hashed in order to avoid reporting them as spelling
	      errors.

       HASH_DIRS <D>
	      Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing
	      it,  as  well as all directories that occur earlier in the path.
	      Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor CORRECT is set.

       HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY
	      When hashing commands because of HASH_COMMANDS, check  that  the
	      file  to	be  hashed  is actually an executable.	This option is
	      unset by default as if the path contains a large number of  com‐
	      mands,  or  consists  of many remote files, the additional tests
	      can take a long time.  Trial and error is needed to show if this
	      option is beneficial.

       MAIL_WARNING (-U)
	      Print  a	warning message if a mail file has been accessed since
	      the shell last checked.

       PATH_DIRS (-Q)
	      Perform a path search even on  command  names  with  slashes  in
	      them.  Thus if `/usr/local/bin' is in the user's path, and he or
	      she types `X11/xinit',  the  command  `/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit'
	      will  be	executed  (assuming  it	 exists).  Commands explicitly
	      beginning with `/', `./' or `../' are not subject	 to  the  path
	      search.  This also applies to the `.' builtin.

	      Note  that  subdirectories  of  the current directory are always
	      searched for executables specified in  this  form.   This	 takes
	      place before any search indicated by this option, and regardless
	      of whether `.' or the current directory appear  in  the  command
	      search path.

       PATH_SCRIPT <K> <S>
	      If  this	option	is  not	 set,  a  script  passed  as the first
	      non-option argument to the shell must contain the	 name  of  the
	      file  to	open.	If this option is set, and the script does not
	      specify a directory path, the script is looked for first in  the
	      current  directory,  then	 in the command path.  See the section
	      INVOCATION in zsh(1).

       PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
	      Print eight bit characters literally in completion  lists,  etc.
	      This  option  is	not necessary if your system correctly returns
	      the printability of eight bit characters (see ctype(3)).

       PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)
	      Print the exit value of  programs	 with  non-zero	 exit  status.
	      This  is	only  available	 at  the  command  line in interactive
	      shells.

       RC_QUOTES
	      Allow the character sequence `'''	 to  signify  a	 single	 quote
	      within  singly  quoted  strings.	 Note  this  does not apply in
	      quoted strings using the format $'...', where a backslashed sin‐
	      gle quote can be used.

       RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>
	      Do not query the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*'.

       RM_STAR_WAIT
	      If  querying  the	 user  before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*',
	      first wait ten seconds and ignore anything typed in  that	 time.
	      This  avoids  the	 problem of reflexively answering `yes' to the
	      query when one didn't really mean it.  The wait  and  query  can
	      always be avoided by expanding the `*' in ZLE (with tab).

       SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>
	      Allow  the  short forms of for, repeat, select, if, and function
	      constructs.

       SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)
	      If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number  of
	      backquotes  on the line, ignore the trailing backquote.  This is
	      useful on some keyboards where the return key is too small,  and
	      the  backquote  key lies annoyingly close to it.	As an alterna‐
	      tive the variable KEYBOARD_HACK lets you choose the character to
	      be removed.

   Job Control
       AUTO_CONTINUE
	      With this option set, stopped jobs that are removed from the job
	      table with the disown builtin command are automatically  sent  a
	      CONT signal to make them running.

       AUTO_RESUME (-W)
	      Treat  single word simple commands without redirection as candi‐
	      dates for resumption of an existing job.

       BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>
	      Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option is set
	      by default.

       CHECK_JOBS <Z>
	      Report  the status of background and suspended jobs before exit‐
	      ing a shell with job control; a second attempt to exit the shell
	      will  succeed.   NO_CHECK_JOBS  is best used only in combination
	      with NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.

	      The check is omitted if the commands run from the previous  com‐
	      mand  line  included  a  `jobs' command, since it is assumed the
	      user is aware that there are background or  suspended  jobs.   A
	      `jobs' command run from one of the hook functions defined in the
	      section SPECIAL FUNCTIONS in zshmisc(1) is not counted for  this
	      purpose.

       HUP <Z>
	      Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.

       LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)
	      List jobs in the long format by default.

       MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)
	      Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.

       NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>
	      Report  the  status  of background jobs immediately, rather than
	      waiting until just before printing a prompt.

       POSIX_JOBS <K> <S>
	      This option makes job control  more  compliant  with  the	 POSIX
	      standard.

	      When the option is not set, the MONITOR option is unset on entry
	      to subshells, so that job control is no longer active.  When the
	      option  is set, the MONITOR option and job control remain active
	      in the subshell, but note that the subshell  has	no  access  to
	      jobs in the parent shell.

	      When  the option is not set, jobs put in the background or fore‐
	      ground with bg or fg are displayed  with	the  same  information
	      that  would  be  reported by jobs.  When the option is set, only
	      the text is  printed.   The  output  from	 jobs  itself  is  not
	      affected by the option.

	      When  the	 option	 is  not  set, job information from the parent
	      shell is saved for output within a subshell (for example, within
	      a	 pipeline).   When  the	 option	 is set, the output of jobs is
	      empty until a job is started within the subshell.

	      When the option is set, it becomes  possible  to	use  the  wait
	      builtin  to  wait for the last job started in the background (as
	      given by $!) even if that job has already	 exited.   This	 works
	      even  if	the  option is turned on temporarily around the use of
	      the wait builtin.

   Prompting
       PROMPT_BANG <K>
	      If set, `!' is  treated  specially  in  prompt  expansion.   See
	      EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

       PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>
	      Print  a	carriage  return  just before printing a prompt in the
	      line editor.  This is on by default  as  multi-line  editing  is
	      only  possible  if  the editor knows where the start of the line
	      appears.

       PROMPT_SP <D>
	      Attempt to preserve a partial line (i.e. a line that did not end
	      with  a  newline) that would otherwise be covered up by the com‐
	      mand prompt due to the PROMPT_CR option.	 This  works  by  out‐
	      putting  some  cursor-control  characters, including a series of
	      spaces, that should make the terminal wrap to the next line when
	      a	 partial line is present (note that this is only successful if
	      your terminal has automatic margins, which is typical).

	      When a partial line is preserved, by default  you	 will  see  an
	      inverse+bold  character  at  the end of the partial line:	 a "%"
	      for a normal user or a "#" for root.  If set, the shell  parame‐
	      ter PROMPT_EOL_MARK can be used to customize how the end of par‐
	      tial lines are shown.

	      NOTE: if the PROMPT_CR option is not set, enabling  this	option
	      will have no effect.  This option is on by default.

       PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>
	      If  set,	`%'  is	 treated  specially  in prompt expansion.  See
	      EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

       PROMPT_SUBST <K> <S>
	      If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
	      expansion	  are  performed  in  prompts.	 Substitutions	within
	      prompts do not affect the command status.

       TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
	      Remove any right prompt from display when	 accepting  a  command
	      line.   This  may	 be useful with terminals with other cut/paste
	      methods.

   Scripts and Functions
       C_BASES
	      Output hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example
	      `0xFF' instead of the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES
	      is also set (it is  not  by  default),  octal  numbers  will  be
	      treated  similarly  and hence appear as `077' instead of `8#77'.
	      This option has no effect on the choice of the output base,  nor
	      on  the  output of bases other than hexadecimal and octal.  Note
	      that these formats will be understood on input  irrespective  of
	      the setting of C_BASES.

       C_PRECEDENCES
	      This  alters  the	 precedence of arithmetic operators to be more
	      like C and other programming languages; the  section  ARITHMETIC
	      EVALUATION in zshmisc(1) has an explicit list.

       DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
	      Run  the	DEBUG  trap  before  each command; otherwise it is run
	      after each command.  Setting this option mimics the behaviour of
	      ksh 93; with the option unset the behaviour is that of ksh 88.

       ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)
	      If  a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR trap,
	      if set, and exit.	 This is disabled while running initialization
	      scripts.

	      The behaviour is also disabled inside DEBUG traps.  In this case
	      the option is handled specially: it is unset  on	entry  to  the
	      trap.   If  the  option  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD	 is  set,  as it is by
	      default, and the option ERR_EXIT is found to have	 been  set  on
	      exit,  then  the	command for which the DEBUG trap is being exe‐
	      cuted is skipped.	 The option is restored after the trap exits.

	      Exiting due to ERR_EXIT has certain interactions with  asynchro‐
	      nous jobs noted in the section JOBS in in zshmisc(1).

       ERR_RETURN
	      If a command has a non-zero exit status, return immediately from
	      the enclosing function.  The logic  is  identical	 to  that  for
	      ERR_EXIT,	 except	 that an implicit return statement is executed
	      instead of an exit.  This will trigger an exit at the  outermost
	      level of a non-interactive script.

       EVAL_LINENO <Z>
	      If  set, line numbers of expressions evaluated using the builtin
	      eval are tracked separately of the enclosing environment.	  This
	      applies  both to the parameter LINENO and the line number output
	      by the prompt escape %i.	If  the	 option	 is  set,  the	prompt
	      escape  %N will output the string `(eval)' instead of the script
	      or function name as an indication.   (The two prompt escapes are
	      typically used in the parameter PS4 to be output when the option
	      XTRACE is set.)  If EVAL_LINENO is unset, the line number of the
	      surrounding  script  or  function is retained during the evalua‐
	      tion.

       EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>
	      Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are read and
	      checked for syntax errors, but not executed.  This option cannot
	      be turned off in an interactive shell, except when `-n' is  sup‐
	      plied to the shell at startup.

       FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>
	      When  executing  a  shell	 function or sourcing a script, set $0
	      temporarily to the name of the function/script.

       LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>
	      If this option is set at the point of return from a shell	 func‐
	      tion, most options (including this one) which were in force upon
	      entry to	the  function  are  restored;  options	that  are  not
	      restored	are  PRIVILEGED	 and RESTRICTED.  Otherwise, only this
	      option and the XTRACE and PRINT_EXIT_VALUE options are restored.
	      Hence  if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the other
	      options in force at the point of return will remain so.  A shell
	      function	can  also guarantee itself a known shell configuration
	      with a formulation like  `emulate	 -L  zsh';  the	 -L  activates
	      LOCAL_OPTIONS.

       LOCAL_PATTERNS
	      If  this option is set at the point of return from a shell func‐
	      tion, the state of pattern disables, as  set  with  the  builtin
	      command  `disable -p', is restored to what it was when the func‐
	      tion was entered.	 The behaviour of this option  is  similar  to
	      the  effect  of  LOCAL_OPTIONS on options; hence `emulate -L sh'
	      (or indeed any other emulation with  the	-L  option)  activates
	      LOCAL_PATTERNS.

       LOCAL_TRAPS <K>
	      If  this	option is set when a signal trap is set inside a func‐
	      tion, then the previous status of the trap for that signal  will
	      be restored when the function exits.  Note that this option must
	      be set prior to altering	the  trap  behaviour  in  a  function;
	      unlike  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  the  value  on exit from the function is
	      irrelevant.  However, it does not need  to  be  set  before  any
	      global  trap  for	 that  to be correctly restored by a function.
	      For example,

		     unsetopt localtraps
		     trap - INT
		     fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }

	      will restore normal handling of SIGINT after the function exits.

       MULTI_FUNC_DEF <Z>
	      Allow definitions of multiple functions at once in the form `fn1
	      fn2...()';  if the option is not set, this causes a parse error.
	      Definition of multiple functions with the	 function  keyword  is
	      always  allowed.	 Multiple  function  definitions are not often
	      used and can cause obscure errors.

       MULTIOS <Z>
	      Perform implicit tees or cats  when  multiple  redirections  are
	      attempted (see the section `Redirection').

       OCTAL_ZEROES <S>
	      Interpret	 any integer constant beginning with a 0 as octal, per
	      IEEE Std 1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993).  This is not enabled  by
	      default as it causes problems with parsing of, for example, date
	      and time strings with leading zeroes.

	      Sequences of digits indicating a numeric base such as  the  `08'
	      component	 in `08#77' are always interpreted as decimal, regard‐
	      less of leading zeroes.

       PIPE_FAIL
	      By default, when a pipeline exits the exit  status  recorded  by
	      the shell and returned by the shell variable $? reflects that of
	      the rightmost element of a pipeline.  If this option is set, the
	      exit status instead reflects the status of the rightmost element
	      of the pipeline that was	non-zero,  or  zero  if	 all  elements
	      exited with zero status.

       SOURCE_TRACE
	      If  set,	zsh will print an informational message announcing the
	      name of each file it loads.  The format of the output is similar
	      to  that	for the XTRACE option, with the message <sourcetrace>.
	      A file may be loaded by the shell itself when it starts  up  and
	      shuts  down  (Startup/Shutdown  Files)  or  by  the  use	of the
	      `source' and `dot' builtin commands.

       TYPESET_SILENT
	      If this is unset, executing any of the `typeset' family of  com‐
	      mands with no options and a list of parameters that have no val‐
	      ues to be assigned but already exist will display the  value  of
	      the  parameter.	If  the option is set, they will only be shown
	      when parameters are selected with the `-m' option.   The	option
	      `-p' is available whether or not the option is set.

       VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)
	      Print shell input lines as they are read.

       XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)
	      Print  commands  and  their arguments as they are executed.  The
	      output is proceded by the value of $PS4, formatted as  described
	      in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

   Shell Emulation
       BASH_REMATCH
	      When  set,  matches  performed with the =~ operator will set the
	      BASH_REMATCH array variable, instead of the  default  MATCH  and
	      match  variables.	  The  first element of the BASH_REMATCH array
	      will contain the entire matched  text  and  subsequent  elements
	      will contain extracted substrings.  This option makes more sense
	      when KSH_ARRAYS is also set, so that the entire matched  portion
	      is  stored  at  index  0	and the first substring is at index 1.
	      Without this option, the	MATCH  variable	 contains  the	entire
	      matched text and the match array variable contains substrings.

       BSD_ECHO <S>
	      Make  the	 echo builtin compatible with the BSD echo(1) command.
	      This disables  backslashed  escape  sequences  in	 echo  strings
	      unless the -e option is specified.

       CONTINUE_ON_ERROR
	      If  a fatal error is encountered (see the section ERRORS in zsh‐
	      misc(1)), and the code is running in a script,  the  shell  will
	      resume  execution at the next statement in the script at the top
	      level, in other words outside all functions or shell  constructs
	      such  as	loops  and  conditions.	  This mimics the behaviour of
	      interactive shells, where the shell returns to the  line	editor
	      to  read	a new command; it was the normal behaviour in versions
	      of zsh before 5.0.1.

       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>
	      A history reference without an event specifier will always refer
	      to  the  previous	 command.  Without this option, such a history
	      reference refers to the same event as the previous history  ref‐
	      erence, defaulting to the previous command.

       CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>
	      Allow  loop  bodies  to take the form `list; end' instead of `do
	      list; done'.

       CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>
	      Changes the rules for single- and double-quoted  text  to	 match
	      that  of	csh.  These require that embedded newlines be preceded
	      by a backslash; unescaped newlines will cause an error  message.
	      In  double-quoted	 strings, it is made impossible to escape `$',
	      ``' or `"' (and `\' itself no longer needs  escaping).   Command
	      substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.

       CSH_NULLCMD <C>
	      Do  not  use  the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when running
	      redirections with no command.  This make such redirections  fail
	      (see the section `Redirection').

       KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>
	      Emulate  ksh  array  handling  as	 closely as possible.  If this
	      option is set, array elements are numbered from zero,  an	 array
	      parameter	 without subscript refers to the first element instead
	      of the whole array, and braces are required to  delimit  a  sub‐
	      script (`${path[2]}' rather than just `$path[2]').

       KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>
	      Emulate  ksh function autoloading.  This means that when a func‐
	      tion is autoloaded, the corresponding file is  merely  executed,
	      and  must define the function itself.  (By default, the function
	      is defined to the contents of the file.  However, the most  com‐
	      mon  ksh-style case - of the file containing only a simple defi‐
	      nition of the function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible
	      manner.)

       KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>
	      Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate
	      lists of set and unset options, all options  are	shown,	marked
	      `on' if they are in the non-default state, `off' otherwise.

       KSH_TYPESET <K>
	      Alters  the  way	arguments  to  the typeset family of commands,
	      including declare, export, float, integer, local	and  readonly,
	      are  processed.	Without	 this  option, zsh will perform normal
	      word splitting after command and parameter  expansion  in	 argu‐
	      ments  of	 an  assignment; with it, word splitting does not take
	      place in those cases.

       KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
	      Treat use of a subscript	of  value  zero	 in  array  or	string
	      expressions  as  a reference to the first element, i.e. the ele‐
	      ment that usually has the subscript 1.  Ignored if KSH_ARRAYS is
	      also set.

	      If  neither  this	 option	 nor KSH_ARRAYS is set, accesses to an
	      element of an array or string  with  subscript  zero  return  an
	      empty  element  or string, while attempts to set element zero of
	      an array or string are treated as an error.   However,  attempts
	      to  set  an  otherwise  valid subscript range that includes zero
	      will succeed.  For example, if KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is not set,

		     array[0]=(element)

	      is an error, while

		     array[0,1]=(element)

	      is not and will replace the first element of the array.

	      This option is for compatibility	with  older  versions  of  the
	      shell and is not recommended in new code.

       POSIX_ALIASES <K> <S>
	      When  this  option is set, reserved words are not candidates for
	      alias expansion:	it is still possible to declare any of them as
	      an  alias, but the alias will never be expanded.	Reserved words
	      are described in the section RESERVED WORDS in zshmisc(1).

	      Alias expansion takes place while text is being read; hence when
	      this  option is set it does not take effect until the end of any
	      function or other piece of shell code parsed as one unit.	  Note
	      this  may	 cause	differences  from  other  shells even when the
	      option is in effect.  For example, when running a	 command  with
	      `zsh  -c',  or even `zsh -o posixaliases -c', the entire command
	      argument is parsed as one unit, so aliases  defined  within  the
	      argument	are  not  available even in later lines.  If in doubt,
	      avoid use of aliases in non-interactive code.

       POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>
	      When this option is set the command builtin can be used to  exe‐
	      cute  shell  builtin  commands.  Parameter assignments specified
	      before shell functions and special builtins are kept  after  the
	      command  completes  unless  the special builtin is prefixed with
	      the command builtin.  Special builtins are  .,  :,  break,  con‐
	      tinue,  declare,	eval,  exit, export, integer, local, readonly,
	      return, set, shift, source, times, trap and unset.

	      In addition, various error conditions associated with the	 above
	      builtins	or  exec  cause a non-interactive shell to exit and an
	      interactive shell to return to its top-level processing.

       POSIX_IDENTIFIERS <K> <S>
	      When this option is set, only the ASCII characters a to z, A  to
	      Z,  0  to	 9  and	 _  may be used in identifiers (names of shell
	      parameters and modules).

	      When the option is unset	and  multibyte	character  support  is
	      enabled  (i.e.  it  is  compiled	in and the option MULTIBYTE is
	      set), then additionally any alphanumeric characters in the local
	      character set may be used in identifiers.	 Note that scripts and
	      functions written with this feature are not portable,  and  also
	      that  both  options must be set before the script or function is
	      parsed; setting them during execution is not sufficient  as  the
	      syntax  variable=value  has  already  been  parsed  as a command
	      rather than an assignment.

	      If multibyte character support is not compiled  into  the	 shell
	      this  option  is ignored; all octets with the top bit set may be
	      used in identifiers.  This is non-standard  but  is  the	tradi‐
	      tional zsh behaviour.

       POSIX_STRINGS <K> <S>
	      This  option affects processing of quoted strings.  Currently it
	      only affects the behaviour of null characters, i.e. character  0
	      in the portable character set corresponding to US ASCII.

	      When  this  option  is  not set, null characters embedded within
	      strings of the form $'...' are treated as	 ordinary  characters.
	      The  entire  string is maintained within the shell and output to
	      files where necessary, although owing  to	 restrictions  of  the
	      library  interface the string is truncated at the null character
	      in file names, environment variables, or in arguments to	exter‐
	      nal programs.

	      When  this  option is set, the $'...' expression is truncated at
	      the null character.  Note	 that  remaining  parts	 of  the  same
	      string beyond the termination of the quotes are not trunctated.

	      For example, the command line argument a$'b\0c'd is treated with
	      the option off as the characters a, b, null, c, d, and with  the
	      option on as the characters a, b, d.

       POSIX_TRAPS <K> <S>
	      When  the is option is set, the usual zsh behaviour of executing
	      traps for EXIT on exit from shell functions is  suppressed.   In
	      that case, manipulating EXIT traps always alters the global trap
	      for exiting the shell; the LOCAL_TRAPS option is ignored for the
	      EXIT trap.

       SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>
	      Perform  filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter
	      expansion, command substitution, arithmetic expansion and	 brace
	      expansion.  If this option is unset, it is performed after brace
	      expansion, so things like `~$USERNAME' and `~{pfalstad,rc}' will
	      work.

       SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>
	      Do  not  use  the	 values	 of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when doing
	      redirections, use `:' instead (see the section `Redirection').

       SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>
	      If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter
	      options  (which  are  used  with	set and setopt) like ksh does.
	      This also affects the value of the - special parameter.

       SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>
	      Causes field splitting to be  performed  on  unquoted  parameter
	      expansions.   Note  that this option has nothing to do with word
	      splitting.  (See the section `Parameter Expansion'.)

       TRAPS_ASYNC
	      While waiting for a program to  exit,  handle  signals  and  run
	      traps  immediately.   Otherwise  the  trap  is run after a child
	      process has exited.  Note this does  not	affect	the  point  at
	      which  traps  are	 run for any case other than when the shell is
	      waiting for a child process.

   Shell State
       INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)
	      This is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initiali‐
	      sation  if  the  standard	 input is a tty and commands are being
	      read from standard input.	 (See the discussion  of  SHIN_STDIN.)
	      This  heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for this
	      option on the command line.  The value of this option  can  only
	      be  changed  via	flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It
	      cannot be changed once zsh is running.

       LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)
	      This is a login shell.  If this option is	 not  explicitly  set,
	      the  shell  becomes  a login shell if the first character of the
	      argv[0] passed to the shell is a `-'.

       PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)
	      Turn on  privileged  mode.  This	is  enabled  automatically  on
	      startup  if  the	effective  user (group) ID is not equal to the
	      real user (group) ID.  Turning this option off causes the effec‐
	      tive  user  and  group  IDs to be set to the real user and group
	      IDs. This option disables sourcing user startup files.   If  zsh
	      is invoked as `sh' or `ksh' with this option set, /etc/suid_pro‐
	      file is sourced  (after  /etc/profile  on	 interactive  shells).
	      Sourcing	~/.profile  is	disabled  and  the contents of the ENV
	      variable is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the  -m
	      option of setopt and unsetopt, and changing it inside a function
	      always changes  it  globally  regardless	of  the	 LOCAL_OPTIONS
	      option.

       RESTRICTED (-r)
	      Enables  restricted  mode.   This option cannot be changed using
	      unsetopt, and setting it inside a	 function  always  changes  it
	      globally	regardless  of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.  See the sec‐
	      tion `Restricted Shell'.

       SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)
	      Commands are being read from the standard input.	 Commands  are
	      read  from standard input if no command is specified with -c and
	      no file of commands is specified.	 If SHIN_STDIN is set  explic‐
	      itly on the command line, any argument that would otherwise have
	      been taken as a file to run will instead be treated as a	normal
	      positional  parameter.   Note  that  setting  or	unsetting this
	      option on the command line does not necessarily affect the state
	      the option will have while the shell is running - that is purely
	      an indicator of whether on not commands are actually being  read
	      from  standard  input.   The  value  of  this option can only be
	      changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It  can‐
	      not be changed once zsh is running.

       SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)
	      If  the  shell  is reading from standard input, it exits after a
	      single command has been executed.	 This  also  makes  the	 shell
	      non-interactive, unless the INTERACTIVE option is explicitly set
	      on the command line.  The value  of  this	 option	 can  only  be
	      changed  via flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It can‐
	      not be changed once zsh is running.

   Zle
       BEEP (+B) <D>
	      Beep on error in ZLE.

       COMBINING_CHARS
	      Assume that the  terminal	 displays  combining  characters  cor‐
	      rectly.	Specifically, if a base alphanumeric character is fol‐
	      lowed by one or more zero-width punctuation  characters,	assume
	      that  the	 zero-width  characters will be displayed as modifica‐
	      tions to the base character within the same width.  Not all ter‐
	      minals handle this.  If this option is not set, zero-width char‐
	      acters are displayed separately with special mark-up.

	      If this option is set, the pattern  test	[[:WORD:]]  matches  a
	      zero-width  punctuation character on the assumption that it will
	      be used as part of a word in combination with a word  character.
	      Otherwise	 the  base  shell does not handle combining characters
	      specially.

       EMACS  If ZLE is loaded, turning on  this  option  has  the  equivalent
	      effect  of  `bindkey  -e'.  In addition, the VI option is unset.
	      Turning it off has no effect.  The option setting is not guaran‐
	      teed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided for
	      compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       OVERSTRIKE
	      Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.

       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>
	      Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.

	      Note that although this is on by default	in  ksh	 emulation  it
	      only provides superficial compatibility with the ksh line editor
	      and reduces the effectiveness of the zsh line editor.  As it has
	      no  effect  on shell syntax, many users may wish to disable this
	      option when using ksh emulation interactively.

       VI     If ZLE is loaded, turning on  this  option  has  the  equivalent
	      effect of `bindkey -v'.  In addition, the EMACS option is unset.
	      Turning it off has no effect.  The option setting is not guaran‐
	      teed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided for
	      compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       ZLE (-Z)
	      Use the zsh line editor.	Set by default in  interactive	shells
	      connected to a terminal.

OPTION ALIASES
       Some  options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used for
       output, but can be used just like normal option names  when  specifying
       options to the shell.

       BRACE_EXPAND
	      NO_IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)

       DOT_GLOB
	      GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)

       HASH_ALL
	      HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)

       HIST_APPEND
	      APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)

       HIST_EXPAND
	      BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)

       LOG    NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)

       MAIL_WARN
	      MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)

       ONE_CMD
	      SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)

       PHYSICAL
	      CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)

       PROMPT_VARS
	      PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)

       STDIN  SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)

       TRACK_ALL
	      HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)

SINGLE LETTER OPTIONS
   Default set
       -0     CORRECT
       -1     PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
       -2     NO_BAD_PATTERN
       -3     NO_NOMATCH
       -4     GLOB_DOTS
       -5     NOTIFY
       -6     BG_NICE
       -7     IGNORE_EOF
       -8     MARK_DIRS
       -9     AUTO_LIST
       -B     NO_BEEP
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -D     PUSHD_TO_HOME
       -E     PUSHD_SILENT
       -F     NO_GLOB
       -G     NULL_GLOB
       -H     RM_STAR_SILENT
       -I     IGNORE_BRACES
       -J     AUTO_CD
       -K     NO_BANG_HIST
       -L     SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
       -M     SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
       -N     AUTO_PUSHD
       -O     CORRECT_ALL
       -P     RC_EXPAND_PARAM
       -Q     PATH_DIRS
       -R     LONG_LIST_JOBS
       -S     REC_EXACT
       -T     CDABLE_VARS
       -U     MAIL_WARNING
       -V     NO_PROMPT_CR
       -W     AUTO_RESUME
       -X     LIST_TYPES
       -Y     MENU_COMPLETE
       -Z     ZLE
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_RCS
       -g     HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
       -h     HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -k     INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -w     CHASE_LINKS
       -x     XTRACE
       -y     SH_WORD_SPLIT

   sh/ksh emulation set
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -T     TRAPS_ASYNC
       -X     MARK_DIRS
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -b     NOTIFY
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_GLOB
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -x     XTRACE

   Also note
       -A     Used by set for setting arrays
       -b     Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
       -c     Used on the command line to specify a single command
       -m     Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting
       -o     Used in all places to allow use of long option names
       -s     Used by set to sort positional parameters

ZSHBUILTINS(1)							ZSHBUILTINS(1)

NAME
       zshbuiltins - zsh built-in commands

SHELL BUILTIN COMMANDS
       Some  shell  builtin  commands  take options as described in individual
       entries; these are often referred to in the list below  as  `flags'  to
       avoid  confusion	 with  shell options, which may also have an effect on
       the behaviour of	 builtin  commands.   In  this	introductory  section,
       `option'	 always	 has the meaning of an option to a command that should
       be familiar to most command line users.

       Typically, options  are	single	letters	 preceded  by  a  hyphen  (-).
       Options	that  take  an argument accept it either immediately following
       the option letter or after white space, for example `print  -C3	*'  or
       `print  -C  3 *' are equivalent.	 Arguments to options are not the same
       as arguments to the  command;  the  documentation  indicates  which  is
       which.	Options that do not take an argument may be combined in a sin‐
       gle word, for example `print -ca *' and `print -c -a *' are equivalent.

       Some shell builtin commands also	 take  options	that  begin  with  `+'
       instead of `-'.	The list below makes clear which commands these are.

       Options	(together with their individual arguments, if any) must appear
       in a group before any non-option arguments; once the  first  non-option
       argument has been found, option processing is terminated.

       All  builtin  commands other than precommand modifiers, even those that
       have no options, can be given the argument  `--'	 to  terminate	option
       processing.   This  indicates  that  the following words are non-option
       arguments, but is otherwise ignored.  This is  useful  in  cases	 where
       arguments  to  the command may begin with `-'.  For historical reasons,
       most builtin commands also recognize a single `-' in  a	separate  word
       for  this  purpose;  note  that this is less standard and use of `-- is
       recommended.

       - simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       . file [ arg ... ]
	      Read commands from file and execute them in  the	current	 shell
	      environment.

	      If  file	does  not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS is set, the
	      shell looks in the components of $path  to  find	the  directory
	      containing  file.	  Files	 in the current directory are not read
	      unless  `.'  appears  somewhere  in  $path.   If	a  file	 named
	      `file.zwc'  is  found,  is  newer than file, and is the compiled
	      form (created with the zcompile builtin) of file, then  commands
	      are read from that file instead of file.

	      If  any  arguments  arg  are  given,  they become the positional
	      parameters; the old positional parameters are restored when  the
	      file is done executing.  If file was not found the return status
	      is 127; if file was found	 but  contained	 a  syntax  error  the
	      return  status is 126; else the return status is the exit status
	      of the last command executed.

       : [ arg ... ]
	      This command does nothing, although normal  argument  expansions
	      is performed which may have effects on shell parameters.	A zero
	      exit status is returned.

       alias [ {+|-}gmrsL ] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      For each name with a corresponding value, define an  alias  with
	      that  value.   A trailing space in value causes the next word to
	      be checked for alias expansion.  If  the	-g  flag  is  present,
	      define  a global alias; global aliases are expanded even if they
	      do not occur in command position.

	      If the -s flag is present, define a suffix alias: if the command
	      word on a command line is in the form `text.name', where text is
	      any  non-empty  string,  it  is  replaced	 by  the  text	`value
	      text.name'.   Note that name is treated as a literal string, not
	      a pattern.  A trailing space in value is	not  special  in  this
	      case.  For example,

		     alias -s ps=gv

	      will  cause  the command `*.ps' to be expanded to `gv *.ps'.  As
	      alias expansion is carried out earlier than globbing, the `*.ps'
	      will  then  be  expanded.	 Suffix aliases constitute a different
	      name space from other aliases (so in the	above  example	it  is
	      still  possible  to  create an alias for the command ps) and the
	      two sets are never listed together.

	      For each name with no value, print the value of  name,  if  any.
	      With  no	arguments,  print  all currently defined aliases other
	      than suffix aliases.  If the -m flag is given the arguments  are
	      taken  as	 patterns (they should be quoted to preserve them from
	      being interpreted as glob patterns), and	the  aliases  matching
	      these  patterns  are  printed.  When printing aliases and one of
	      the -g, -r or -s flags is	 present,  restrict  the  printing  to
	      global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular alias
	      is one which is neither a global nor a suffix alias.   Using `+'
	      instead  of  `-',	 or  ending the option list with a single `+',
	      prevents the values of the aliases from being printed.

	      If the -L flag is present, then print each  alias	 in  a	manner
	      suitable	for  putting  in a startup script.  The exit status is
	      nonzero if a name (with no value) is given for  which  no	 alias
	      has been defined.

	      For  more	 on  aliases, include common problems, see the section
	      ALIASING in zshmisc(1).

       autoload [ {+|-}UXkmtz ] [ -w ] [ name ... ]
	      Equivalent to functions -u, with the exception of -X/+X and -w.

	      The flag -X may be used only inside a shell  function,  and  may
	      not be followed by a name.  It causes the calling function to be
	      marked for autoloading and then immediately loaded and executed,
	      with  the	 current  array of positional parameters as arguments.
	      This replaces the previous definition of the  function.	If  no
	      function	definition is found, an error is printed and the func‐
	      tion remains undefined and marked for autoloading.

	      The flag +X attempts to load each name as	 an  autoloaded	 func‐
	      tion,  but  does	not execute it.	 The exit status is zero (suc‐
	      cess) if the function was not previously defined and  a  defini‐
	      tion for it was found.  This does not replace any existing defi‐
	      nition of the function.  The exit status is nonzero (failure) if
	      the  function  was  already  defined  or	when no definition was
	      found.  In the latter case the function  remains	undefined  and
	      marked  for  autoloading.	  If ksh-style autoloading is enabled,
	      the function created will contain the contents of the file  plus
	      a call to the function itself appended to it, thus giving normal
	      ksh autoloading behaviour on the first call to the function.  If
	      the  -m flag is also given each name is treated as a pattern and
	      all functions already marked for autoload that match the pattern
	      are loaded.

	      With the -w flag, the names are taken as names of files compiled
	      with the zcompile builtin, and all functions defined in them are
	      marked for autoloading.

	      The flags -z and -k mark the function to be autoloaded using the
	      zsh or ksh style, as if the option KSH_AUTOLOAD  were  unset  or
	      were  set,  respectively.	 The flags override the setting of the
	      option at the time the function is loaded.

	      Note that the autoload command makes no attempt  to  ensure  the
	      shell  options  set  during the loading or execution of the file
	      have any particular value.  For this, the emulate command can be
	      used:

		     emulate zsh -c 'autoload -Uz func'

	      arranges	that  when  func  is loaded the shell is in native zsh
	      emulation, and this emulation is also applied when func is run.

       bg [ job ... ]
       job ... &
	      Put each specified job in the background, or the current job  if
	      none is specified.

       bindkey
	      See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       break [ n ]
	      Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop.
	      If n is specified, then break n levels instead of just one.

       builtin name [ args ... ]
	      Executes the builtin name, with the given args.

       bye    Same as exit.

       cap    See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       cd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
       cd [ -qsLP ] old new
       cd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
	      Change the current directory.  In the  first  form,  change  the
	      current directory to arg, or to the value of $HOME if arg is not
	      specified.  If arg is `-', change to the previous directory.

	      Otherwise, if arg begins with a slash, attempt to change to  the
	      directory given by arg.

	      If  arg  does  not  begin with a slash, the behaviour depends on
	      whether the current directory `.' occurs in the list of directo‐
	      ries  contained  in the shell parameter cdpath.  If it does not,
	      first attempt to change to the directory arg under  the  current
	      directory,  and  if that fails but cdpath is set and contains at
	      least one element attempt to change to the directory  arg	 under
	      each  component  of  cdpath  in  turn  until successful.	If `.'
	      occurs in cdpath, then cdpath is searched strictly in  order  so
	      that `.' is only tried at the appropriate point.

	      The  order  of testing cdpath is modified if the option POSIX_CD
	      is set, as described in the documentation for the option.

	      If no directory is found, the option CDABLE_VARS is set,	and  a
	      parameter	 named	arg  exists  whose  value begins with a slash,
	      treat its value as the directory.	 In that case,	the  parameter
	      is added to the named directory hash table.

	      The  second form of cd substitutes the string new for the string
	      old in the name of the current directory, and tries to change to
	      this new directory.

	      The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory stack,
	      and changes to that directory.  An argument  of  the  form  `+n'
	      identifies  a  stack entry by counting from the left of the list
	      shown by the dirs command, starting with zero.  An  argument  of
	      the  form `-n' counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option
	      is set, the meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook  function	 chpwd
	      and  the	functions in the array chpwd_functions are not called.
	      This is useful for calls to cd that do not change	 the  environ‐
	      ment seen by an interactive user.

	      If  the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current
	      directory if the given pathname contains symlinks.   If  the  -P
	      option is given or the CHASE_LINKS option is set, symbolic links
	      are resolved to their true values.  If the -L  option  is	 given
	      symbolic	links are retained in the directory (and not resolved)
	      regardless of the state of the CHASE_LINKS option.

       chdir  Same as cd.

       clone  See the section `The zsh/clone Module' in zshmodules(1).

       command [ -pvV ] simple command
	      The simple command argument is  taken  as	 an  external  command
	      instead  of  a  function	or  builtin  and  is  executed. If the
	      POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also be executed but
	      certain  special	properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag
	      causes a default path to be searched instead of that  in	$path.
	      With  the	 -v flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it
	      is equivalent to whence -v.

	      See also the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       comparguments
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compcall
	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compctl
	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compdescribe
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compfiles
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compgroups
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compquote
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptags
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptry
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compvalues
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       continue [ n ]
	      Resume the next iteration of the enclosing  for,	while,	until,
	      select  or  repeat  loop.	  If  n is specified, break out of n-1
	      loops and resume at the nth enclosing loop.

       declare
	      Same as typeset.

       dirs [ -c ] [ arg ... ]
       dirs [ -lpv ]
	      With no arguments, print the contents of	the  directory	stack.
	      Directories  are added to this stack with the pushd command, and
	      removed with the cd or popd commands.  If arguments  are	speci‐
	      fied,  load  them	 onto  the directory stack, replacing anything
	      that was there, and push the current directory onto the stack.

	      -c     clear the directory stack.

	      -l     print directory names in full instead of using of using ~
		     expressions  (see Dynamic and Static named directories in
		     zshexpn(1)).

	      -p     print directory entries one per line.

	      -v     number the directories in the stack when printing.

       disable [ -afmprs ] name ...
	      Temporarily disable the named hash table elements	 or  patterns.
	      The  default is to disable builtin commands.  This allows you to
	      use an external command with the same name as a builtin command.
	      The  -a  option  causes  disable	to  act	 on  regular or global
	      aliases.	The -s option causes disable to act on suffix aliases.
	      The  -f option causes disable to act on shell functions.	The -r
	      options causes disable to act on reserved words.	Without	 argu‐
	      ments  all  disabled  hash table elements from the corresponding
	      hash table are printed.  With the	 -m  flag  the	arguments  are
	      taken  as	 patterns (which should be quoted to prevent them from
	      undergoing filename expansion), and all hash table elements from
	      the  corresponding  hash	table matching these patterns are dis‐
	      abled.  Disabled objects can be enabled with the enable command.

	      With the option -p, name ... refer to elements  of  the  shell's
	      pattern  syntax  as  described  in the section `Filename Genera‐
	      tion'.  Certain elements can be disabled	separately,  as	 given
	      below.

	      Note  that  patterns not allowed by the current settings for the
	      options EXTENDED_GLOB, KSH_GLOB and SH_GLOB are  never  enabled,
	      regardless  of  the setting here.	 For example, if EXTENDED_GLOB
	      is not active, the pattern ^ is ineffective even if `disable  -p
	      "^"'  has	 not been issued.  The list below indicates any option
	      settings that restrict the use of the  pattern.	It  should  be
	      noted  that  setting SH_GLOB has a wider effect then merely dis‐
	      abling patterns as  certain  expressions,	 in  particular	 those
	      involving parentheses, are parsed differently.

	      The  following  patterns	may  be disabled; all the strings need
	      quoting on the command line to prevent them  from	 being	inter‐
	      preted  immediately as patterns and the patterns are shown below
	      in single quotes as a reminder.
	      '?'    The pattern character ?  wherever	it  occurs,  including
		     when preceding a parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.

	      '*'    The  pattern  character  *	 wherever it occurs, including
		     recursive globbing and when preceding a parenthesis  with
		     KSH_GLOB.

	      '['    Character classes.

	      '<' (NO_SH_GLOB)
		     Numeric ranges.

	      '|' (NO_SH_GLOB)
		     Alternation  in  grouped  patterns,  case	statements, or
		     KSH_GLOB parenthesised expressions.

	      '(' (NO_SH_GLOB)
		     Grouping using single parentheses.	 Disabling  this  does
		     not  disable  the	use  of parentheses for KSH_GLOB where
		     they are introduced by a special character, nor for  glob
		     qualifiers	 (use  `setopt	NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL'  to disable
		     glob qualifiers that use parentheses only).

	      '~' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
		     Exclusion in the form A~B.

	      '^' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
		     Exclusion in the form A^B.

	      '#' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
		     The pattern character # wherever it occurs, both for rep‐
		     etition of a previous pattern and for indicating globbing
		     flags.

	      '?(' (KSH_GLOB)
		     The grouping form ?(...).	Note this is also disabled  if
		     '?' is disabled.

	      '*(' (KSH_GLOB)
		     The  grouping form *(...).	 Note this is also disabled if
		     '*' is disabled.

	      '+(' (KSH_GLOB)
		     The grouping form +(...).

	      '!(' (KSH_GLOB)
		     The grouping form !(...).

	      '@(' (KSH_GLOB)
		     The grouping form @(...).

       disown [ job ... ]
       job ... &|
       job ... &!
	      Remove the specified jobs from the job table; the shell will  no
	      longer  report their status, and will not complain if you try to
	      exit an interactive shell with them running or stopped.	If  no
	      job is specified, disown the current job.

	      If  the  jobs are currently stopped and the AUTO_CONTINUE option
	      is not set, a warning is printed	containing  information	 about
	      how  to make them running after they have been disowned.	If one
	      of the latter two forms is used, the jobs will automatically  be
	      made  running,  independent  of the setting of the AUTO_CONTINUE
	      option.

       echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]
	      Write each arg on the standard output, with a  space  separating
	      each one.	 If the -n flag is not present, print a newline at the
	      end.  echo recognizes the following escape sequences:

	      \a     bell character
	      \b     backspace
	      \c     suppress final newline
	      \e     escape
	      \f     form feed
	      \n     linefeed (newline)
	      \r     carriage return
	      \t     horizontal tab
	      \v     vertical tab
	      \\     backslash
	      \0NNN  character code in octal
	      \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
	      \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
	      \UNNNNNNNN
		     unicode character code in hexadecimal

	      The -E flag, or the BSD_ECHO option,  can	 be  used  to  disable
	      these escape sequences.  In the latter case, -e flag can be used
	      to enable them.

       echotc See the section `The zsh/termcap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       echoti See the section `The zsh/terminfo Module' in zshmodules(1).

       emulate [ -LR ] [ {zsh|sh|ksh|csh} [ flags ... ] ]
	      Without any argument print current emulation mode.

	      With single argument set up zsh options to emulate the specified
	      shell  as	 much  as possible.  csh will never be fully emulated.
	      If the argument is not one of the shells listed above, zsh  will
	      be used as a default; more precisely, the tests performed on the
	      argument are the same as those used to determine	the  emulation
	      at  startup based on the shell name, see the section COMPATIBIL‐
	      ITY in zsh(1) .  In addition to setting shell options, the  com‐
	      mand  also restores the pristine state of pattern enables, as if
	      all patterns had been enabled using enable -p.

	      If the emulate command occurs inside a function  that  has  been
	      marked  for  execution tracing with functions -t then the xtrace
	      option will be turned on regardless of emulation mode  or	 other
	      options.	 Note that code executed inside the function by the .,
	      source, or  eval	commands  is  not  considered  to  be  running
	      directly	from  the function, hence does not provoke this behav‐
	      iour.

	      If the -R switch is given, all settable  options	are  reset  to
	      their  default  value  corresponding  to the specified emulation
	      mode, except for	certain	 options  describing  the  interactive
	      environment;  otherwise,	only  those  options  likely  to cause
	      portability problems in scripts and functions are	 altered.   If
	      the  -L  switch  is given, the options LOCAL_OPTIONS, LOCAL_PAT‐
	      TERNS and LOCAL_TRAPS will be set as well, causing  the  effects
	      of  the emulate command and any setopt, disable -p or enable -p,
	      and trap commands to be local  to	 the  immediately  surrounding
	      shell function, if any; normally these options are turned off in
	      all emulation modes except ksh. The -L switch is mutually exclu‐
	      sive with the use of -c in flags.

	      The  flags  may be any of the invocation-time flags described in
	      the section INVOCATION in zsh(1), except that `-o EMACS' and `-o
	      VI'  may not be used.  Flags such as `+r'/`+o RESTRICTED' may be
	      prohibited in some circumstances.

	      If -c arg appears in flags, arg is evaluated while the requested
	      emulation	 is temporarily in effect.  In this case the emulation
	      mode and all options  are	 restored  to  their  previous	values
	      before  emulate  returns.	 The -R switch may precede the name of
	      the shell to emulate; note this  has  a  meaning	distinct  from
	      including -R in flags.

	      Use  of -c enables `sticky' emulation mode for functions defined
	      within the evaluated expression:	the emulation mode is  associ‐
	      ated  thereafter with the function so that whenever the function
	      is executed the emulation (respecting the -R switch, if present)
	      and  all	options	 are set (and pattern disables cleared) before
	      entry to the function, and the state is restored after exit.  If
	      the  function  is called when the sticky emulation is already in
	      effect, either within an `emulate shell -c' expression or within
	      another  function with the same sticky emulation, entry and exit
	      from the function do not cause options to be altered (except due
	      to  standard processing such as the LOCAL_OPTIONS option).  This
	      also applies to functions marked for autoload within the	sticky
	      emulation; the appropriate set of options will be applied at the
	      point the function is loaded as well as when it is run.

	      For example:

		     emulate sh -c 'fni() { setopt cshnullglob; }
		     fno() { fni; }'
		     fno

	      The two functions fni and fno are defined with sticky sh	emula‐
	      tion.   fno  is  then  executed, causing options associated with
	      emulations to be set to their values in sh.  fni then calls fno;
	      because  fno  is	also marked for sticky sh emulation, no option
	      changes take place on entry to  or  exit	from  it.   Hence  the
	      option  cshnullglob,  turned off by sh emulation, will be turned
	      on within fni and remain on on return to fno.  On exit from fno,
	      the emulation mode and all options will be restored to the state
	      they were in before entry to the temporary emulation.

	      The documentation above is typically sufficient for the intended
	      purpose  of  executing code designed for other shells in a suit‐
	      able environment.	 More detailed rules follow.
	      1.     The sticky emulation  environment	provided  by  `emulate
		     shell  -c'	 is  identical	to that provided by entry to a
		     function marked for sticky emulation as a consequence  of
		     being  defined  in such an environment.  Hence, for exam‐
		     ple, the sticky emulation is  inherited  by  subfunctions
		     defined within functions with sticky emulation.
	      2.     No change of options takes place on entry to or exit from
		     functions that are not marked for sticky emulation, other
		     than  those that would normally take place, even if those
		     functions are called within sticky emulation.
	      3.     No special handling is provided for functions marked  for
		     autoload nor for functions present in wordcode created by
		     the zcompile command.
	      4.     The presence or absence of the -R switch to emulate  cor‐
		     responds  to  different  sticky  emulation	 modes, so for
		     example `emulate sh -c', `emulate -R sh -c' and  `emulate
		     csh -c' are treated as three distinct sticky emulations.
	      5.     Difference	 in  shell options supplied in addition to the
		     basic emulation also mean the sticky emulations are  dif‐
		     ferent,  so for example `emulate zsh -c' and `emulate zsh
		     -o cbases -c' are treated as distinct sticky emulations.

       enable [ -afmprs ] name ...
	      Enable the named hash table elements, presumably	disabled  ear‐
	      lier  with  disable.  The default is to enable builtin commands.
	      The -a option causes enable to act on regular or global aliases.
	      The  -s  option  causes enable to act on suffix aliases.	The -f
	      option causes enable to act on shell functions.  The  -r	option
	      causes  enable  to act on reserved words.	 Without arguments all
	      enabled hash table elements from the  corresponding  hash	 table
	      are  printed.   With the -m flag the arguments are taken as pat‐
	      terns (should be quoted) and all hash table  elements  from  the
	      corresponding  hash  table  matching these patterns are enabled.
	      Enabled objects can be disabled with the	disable	 builtin  com‐
	      mand.

	      enable  -p  reenables  patterns  disabled with disable -p.  Note
	      that it does not override globbing options; for example, `enable
	      -p  "~"'	does  not  cause  the pattern character ~ to be active
	      unless the EXTENDED_GLOB option is also set.  To enable all pos‐
	      sible  patterns  (so  that  they may be invidually disabled with
	      disable -p), use `setopt EXTENDED_GLOB KSH_GLOB NO_SH_GLOB'.

       eval [ arg ... ]
	      Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the result‐
	      ing  command(s) in the current shell process.  The return status
	      is the same as if the commands had been executed directly by the
	      shell;  if  there	 are no args or they contain no commands (i.e.
	      are an empty string or whitespace) the return status is zero.

       exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ] simple command
	      Replace the current shell with an external command  rather  than
	      forking.	 With  -c  clear the environment; with -l prepend - to
	      the argv[0] string of the command executed (to simulate a	 login
	      shell); with -a argv0 set the argv[0] string of the command exe‐
	      cuted.  See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       exit [ n ]
	      Exit the shell with the exit status specified by n; if  none  is
	      specified,  use  the exit status from the last command executed.
	      An EOF condition will also cause the shell to exit,  unless  the
	      IGNORE_EOF option is set.

	      See  notes  at  the end of the section JOBS in in zshmisc(1) for
	      some possibly unexpected interactions of the exit	 command  with
	      jobs.

       export [ name[=value] ... ]
	      The specified names are marked for automatic export to the envi‐
	      ronment of subsequently executed commands.  Equivalent to	 type‐
	      set -gx.	If a parameter specified does not already exist, it is
	      created in the global scope.

       false [ arg ... ]
	      Do nothing and return an exit status of 1.

       fc [ -e ename ] [ -m match ] [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -l [ -nrdfEiD ] [ -t timefmt ] [ -m match ]
	     [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -p [ -a ] [ filename [ histsize [ savehistsize ] ] ]
       fc -P
       fc -ARWI [ filename ]
	      Select a range of commands from first to last from  the  history
	      list.  The arguments first and last may be specified as a number
	      or as a string.  A negative number is used as an offset  to  the
	      current  history	event  number.	 A  string  specifies the most
	      recent event beginning with the given string.  All substitutions
	      old=new, if any, are then performed on the commands.

	      If  the  -l  flag is given, the resulting commands are listed on
	      standard output.	If the -m flag is also given the  first	 argu‐
	      ment  is taken as a pattern (should be quoted) and only the his‐
	      tory events matching this pattern will be shown.	Otherwise  the
	      editor  program ename is invoked on a file containing these his‐
	      tory events.  If ename is not given, the value of the  parameter
	      FCEDIT  is  used;	 if that is not set the value of the parameter
	      EDITOR is used; if that is not set a  builtin  default,  usually
	      `vi'  is	used.	If  ename  is `-', no editor is invoked.  When
	      editing is complete, the edited command is executed.

	      If first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent
	      event), or to -16 if the -l flag is given.  If last is not spec‐
	      ified, it will be set to first, or to  -1	 if  the  -l  flag  is
	      given.

	      The  flag	 -r reverses the order of the commands and the flag -n
	      suppresses command numbers when listing.

	      Also when listing,
	      -d     prints timestamps for each command
	      -f     prints full time-date stamps in the US  `MM/DD/YY	hh:mm'
		     format
	      -E     prints  full time-date stamps in the European `dd.mm.yyyy
		     hh:mm' format
	      -i     prints  full  time-date  stamps  in  ISO8601  `yyyy-mm-dd
		     hh:mm' format
	      -t fmt prints  time  and date stamps in the given format; fmt is
		     formatted with the strftime function with the zsh	exten‐
		     sions  described  for the %D{string} prompt format in the
		     section EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).  The
		     resulting formatted string must be no more than 256 char‐
		     acters or will not be printed.
	      -D     prints elapsed times; may be combined  with  one  of  the
		     options above.

	      `fc  -p'	pushes	the  current  history  list  onto  a stack and
	      switches to a new history list.  If the -a option is also speci‐
	      fied,  this  history  list will be automatically popped when the
	      current function scope is exited, which is a much	 better	 solu‐
	      tion than creating a trap function to call `fc -P' manually.  If
	      no arguments are specified, the  history	list  is  left	empty,
	      $HISTFILE	 is  unset, and $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are set to their
	      default values.  If one argument is given, $HISTFILE is  set  to
	      that filename, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are left unchanged, and the
	      history file is read in (if it exists)  to  initialize  the  new
	      list.   If a second argument is specified, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST
	      are instead set to the single specified numeric value.  Finally,
	      if a third argument is specified, $SAVEHIST is set to a separate
	      value from $HISTSIZE.  You are free to change these  environment
	      values  for  the new history list however you desire in order to
	      manipulate the new history list.

	      `fc -P' pops the history list back to an older list saved by `fc
	      -p'.   The  current  list is saved to its $HISTFILE before it is
	      destroyed (assuming that $HISTFILE and $SAVEHIST are set	appro‐
	      priately,	 of  course).  The values of $HISTFILE, $HISTSIZE, and
	      $SAVEHIST are restored to the values they had when `fc  -p'  was
	      called.	Note  that  this  restoration can conflict with making
	      these variables "local", so your best bet is to avoid local dec‐
	      larations	 for  these  variables	in functions that use `fc -p'.
	      The one other guaranteed-safe  combination  is  declaring	 these
	      variables	 to be local at the top of your function and using the
	      automatic option (-a) with `fc -p'.  Finally, note  that	it  is
	      legal to manually pop a push marked for automatic popping if you
	      need to do so before the function exits.

	      `fc -R' reads the history from the given file,  `fc  -W'	writes
	      the  history out to the given file, and `fc -A' appends the his‐
	      tory out to the given file.  If no filename  is  specified,  the
	      $HISTFILE	 is  assumed.	If  the -I option is added to -R, only
	      those events that are not already contained within the  internal
	      history  list are added.	If the -I option is added to -A or -W,
	      only  those  events  that	 are  new   since   last   incremental
	      append/write  to	the history file are appended/written.	In any
	      case, the created file will have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.

       fg [ job ... ]
       job ...
	      Bring each specified job in turn to the foreground.  If  no  job
	      is specified, resume the current job.

       float [ {+|-}EFHghlprtux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      Equivalent  to  typeset  -E,  except  that options irrelevant to
	      floating point numbers are not permitted.

       functions [ {+|-}UXkmtTuz ] [ name ... ]
       functions -M mathfn [ min [ max [ shellfn ] ] ]
       functions -M [ -m pattern ... ]
       functions +M [ -m ] mathfn
	      Equivalent to typeset -f, with the exception of the  -M  option.
	      Use of the -M option may not be combined with any of the options
	      handled by typeset -f.

	      functions -M mathfn defines mathfn as the name of a mathematical
	      function	recognised  in	all forms of arithmetical expressions;
	      see the  section	`Arithmetic  Evaluation'  in  zshmisc(1).   By
	      default mathfn may take any number of comma-separated arguments.
	      If min is given, it must have exactly min args; if min  and  max
	      are  both given, it must have at least min and at most max args.
	      max may be -1 to indicate that there is no upper limit.

	      By default the function is implemented by a  shell  function  of
	      the  same name; if shellfn is specified it gives the name of the
	      corresponding shell function while mathfn remains the name  used
	      in  arithmetical expressions.  The name of the function in $0 is
	      mathfn (not shellfn as would usually be the case), provided  the
	      option FUNCTION_ARGZERO is in effect.  The positional parameters
	      in the shell function correspond to the arguments of the	mathe‐
	      matical  function	 call.	 The  result  of the last arithmetical
	      expression evaluated inside the shell function (even if it is  a
	      form  that  normally  only returns a status) gives the result of
	      the mathematical function.

	      functions -M with no arguments lists all such user-defined func‐
	      tions  in	 the  same  form as a definition.  With the additional
	      option -m and a list of arguments, all  functions	 whose	mathfn
	      matches one of the pattern arguments are listed.

	      function +M removes the list of mathematical functions; with the
	      additional option -m the arguments are treated as	 patterns  and
	      all  functions  whose  mathfn  matches  the pattern are removed.
	      Note that the shell function implementing the behaviour  is  not
	      removed (regardless of whether its name coincides with mathfn).

	      For example, the following prints the cube of 3:

		     zmath_cube() { (( $1 * $1 * $1 )) }
		     functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
		     print $(( cube(3) ))

       getcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       getln [ -AclneE ] name ...
	      Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell
	      parameter name.  Equivalent to read -zr.

       getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]
	      Checks the args for legal options.  If the args are omitted, use
	      the  positional parameters.  A valid option argument begins with
	      a `+' or a `-'.  An argument not beginning with a `+' or a  `-',
	      or  the argument `--', ends the options.	Note that a single `-'
	      is not considered a valid option argument.   optstring  contains
	      the letters that getopts recognizes.  If a letter is followed by
	      a `:', that option requires an argument.	 The  options  can  be
	      separated from the argument by blanks.

	      Each  time  it  is  invoked, getopts places the option letter it
	      finds in the shell parameter name, prepended with a `+' when arg
	      begins  with  a  `+'.   The  index  of the next arg is stored in
	      OPTIND.  The option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.

	      The first option to be examined may  be  changed	by  explicitly
	      assigning	 to  OPTIND.  OPTIND has an initial value of 1, and is
	      normally reset to 1 upon exit from a shell function.  OPTARG  is
	      not  reset  and  retains	its value from the most recent call to
	      getopts.	If either of OPTIND or OPTARG is explicitly unset,  it
	      remains  unset,  and the index or option argument is not stored.
	      The option itself is still stored in name in this case.

	      A leading `:' in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of
	      any  invalid  option  in	OPTARG,	 and to set name to `?' for an
	      unknown option and to `:' when a required argument  is  missing.
	      Otherwise,  getopts sets name to `?' and prints an error message
	      when an option is invalid.  The  exit  status  is	 nonzero  when
	      there are no more options.

       hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name[=value] ] ...
	      hash  can be used to directly modify the contents of the command
	      hash table, and the named directory hash	table.	 Normally  one
	      would  modify these tables by modifying one's PATH (for the com‐
	      mand hash table) or by  creating	appropriate  shell  parameters
	      (for  the named directory hash table).  The choice of hash table
	      to work on is determined by the -d option;  without  the	option
	      the  command  hash  table is used, and with the option the named
	      directory hash table is used.

	      Given no arguments, and  neither	the  -r	 or  -f	 options,  the
	      selected hash table will be listed in full.

	      The  -r option causes the selected hash table to be emptied.  It
	      will be subsequently rebuilt in  the  normal  fashion.   The  -f
	      option  causes the selected hash table to be fully rebuilt imme‐
	      diately.	For the command hash table this hashes all  the	 abso‐
	      lute  directories	 in the PATH, and for the named directory hash
	      table this adds all users' home directories.  These two  options
	      cannot be used with any arguments.

	      The  -m  option  causes  the  arguments  to be taken as patterns
	      (which should be quoted) and the	elements  of  the  hash	 table
	      matching	those  patterns	 are printed.  This is the only way to
	      display a limited selection of hash table elements.

	      For each name with a corresponding  value,  put  `name'  in  the
	      selected	hash  table, associating it with the pathname `value'.
	      In the command hash table, this means that  whenever  `name'  is
	      used  as	a  command argument, the shell will try to execute the
	      file given by `value'.  In the named directory hash table,  this
	      means that `value' may be referred to as `~name'.

	      For  each	 name with no corresponding value, attempt to add name
	      to the hash table, checking what the appropriate value is in the
	      normal  manner  for  that	 hash  table.  If an appropriate value
	      can't be found, then the hash table will be unchanged.

	      The -v option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are
	      added  by explicit specification.	 If has no effect if used with
	      -f.

	      If the -L flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed
	      in the form of a call to hash.

       history
	      Same as fc -l.

       integer [ {+|-}Hghilprtux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      Equivalent  to  typeset  -i,  except  that options irrelevant to
	      integers are not permitted.

       jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]
       jobs -Z string
	      Lists information about each given job, or all jobs  if  job  is
	      omitted.	 The  -l flag lists process IDs, and the -p flag lists
	      process groups.  If the -r flag is specified only	 running  jobs
	      will be listed and if the -s flag is given only stopped jobs are
	      shown.  If the -d flag is given, the directory  from  which  the
	      job  was	started (which may not be the current directory of the
	      job) will also be shown.

	      The -Z option replaces  the  shell's  argument  and  environment
	      space  with  the	given  string,	truncated if necessary to fit.
	      This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1)) listings.  This fea‐
	      ture is typically used by daemons, to indicate their state.

       kill [ -s signal_name | -n signal_number | -sig ] job ...
       kill -l [ sig ... ]
	      Sends  either  SIGTERM or the specified signal to the given jobs
	      or processes.  Signals are given by number or by names, with  or
	      without  the  `SIG'  prefix.   If	 the  signal being sent is not
	      `KILL' or `CONT', then the job will be sent a `CONT'  signal  if
	      it  is stopped.  The argument job can be the process ID of a job
	      not in the job list.  In the second form, kill -l, if sig is not
	      specified	 the signal names are listed.  Otherwise, for each sig
	      that is a name, the corresponding signal number is listed.   For
	      each  sig	 that  is a signal number or a number representing the
	      exit status of a process which was terminated or	stopped	 by  a
	      signal the name of the signal is printed.

	      On  some systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a few
	      signals.	Typical examples are SIGCHLD and SIGCLD or SIGPOLL and
	      SIGIO, assuming they correspond to the same signal number.  kill
	      -l will only list the preferred form, however kill -l  alt  will
	      show  if	the  alternative  form corresponds to a signal number.
	      For example, under Linux kill -l IO and kill -l POLL both output
	      29, hence kill -IO and kill -POLL have the same effect.

	      Many  systems  will  allow  process IDs to be negative to kill a
	      process group or zero to kill the current process group.

       let arg ...
	      Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression.  See the  section
	      `Arithmetic  Evaluation'	in  zshmisc(1)	for  a	description of
	      arithmetic expressions.  The exit status is 0 if	the  value  of
	      the  last	 expression  is	 nonzero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an
	      error occurred.

       limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...
	      Set or display resource limits.  Unless the -s  flag  is	given,
	      the  limit  applies  only	 the  children of the shell.  If -s is
	      given without other arguments, the resource limits of  the  cur‐
	      rent  shell  is set to the previously set resource limits of the
	      children.

	      If limit is not specified, print the  current  limit  placed  on
	      resource,	 otherwise  set	 the limit to the specified value.  If
	      the -h flag is given, use hard limits instead  of	 soft  limits.
	      If no resource is given, print all limits.

	      When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort imme‐
	      diately if it detects a badly formed argument.  However,	if  it
	      fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue try‐
	      ing to set the remaining limits.

	      resource can be one of:

	      addressspace
		     Maximum amount of address space used.
	      aiomemorylocked
		     Maximum amount of memory locked in	 RAM  for  AIO	opera‐
		     tions.
	      aiooperations
		     Maximum number of AIO operations.
	      cachedthreads
		     Maximum number of cached threads.
	      coredumpsize
		     Maximum size of a core dump.
	      cputime
		     Maximum CPU seconds per process.
	      datasize
		     Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
	      descriptors
		     Maximum value for a file descriptor.
	      filesize
		     Largest single file allowed.
	      kqueues
		     Maximum number of kqueues allocated.
	      maxproc
		     Maximum number of processes.
	      maxpthreads
		     Maximum number of threads per process.
	      memorylocked
		     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
	      memoryuse
		     Maximum resident set size.
	      msgqueue
		     Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.
	      posixlocks
		     Maximum number of POSIX locks per user.
	      pseudoterminals
		     Maximum number of pseudo-terminals.
	      resident
		     Maximum resident set size.
	      sigpending
		     Maximum number of pending signals.
	      sockbufsize
		     Maximum size of all socket buffers.
	      stacksize
		     Maximum stack size for each process.
	      swapsize
		     Maximum amount of swap used.
	      vmemorysize
		     Maximum amount of virtual memory.

	      Which of these resource limits are available depends on the sys‐
	      tem.  resource can be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.  It
	      can also be an integer, which corresponds to the integer defined
	      for the resource by the operating system.

	      If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of
	      the  resources  configured into the shell, the shell will try to
	      read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if this
	      fails.   As  the shell does not store such resources internally,
	      an attempt to set the limit will fail unless the	-s  option  is
	      present.

	      limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:

	      nh     hours
	      nk     kilobytes (default)
	      nm     megabytes or minutes
	      [mm:]ss
		     minutes and seconds

	      The  limit  command  is  not  made available by default when the
	      shell starts in a mode emulating another shell.  It can be  made
	      available with the command `zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:limit'.

       local [ {+|-}AEFHUahlprtux ] [ -LRZi [ n ]] [ name[=value] ] ...
	      Same as typeset, except that the options -g, and -f are not per‐
	      mitted.  In this case the -x option does not force  the  use  of
	      -g, i.e. exported variables will be local to functions.

       log    List  all users currently logged in who are affected by the cur‐
	      rent setting of the watch parameter.

       logout [ n ]
	      Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.

       noglob simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       popd [ [-q] {+|-}n ]
	      Remove an entry from the directory stack, and perform  a	cd  to
	      the  new top directory.  With no argument, the current top entry
	      is removed.  An argument of the form  `+n'  identifies  a	 stack
	      entry  by	 counting  from the left of the list shown by the dirs
	      command, starting with zero.  An argument of the form -n	counts
	      from  the right.	If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings
	      of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook  function	 chpwd
	      and  the functions in the array $chpwd_functions are not called,
	      and the new directory stack is not printed.  This is useful  for
	      calls  to	 popd  that  do	 not change the environment seen by an
	      interactive user.

       print [ -abcDilmnNoOpPrsSz ] [ -u n ] [ -f format ] [ -C cols ]
	 [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]
	      With the `-f' option the arguments are printed as	 described  by
	      printf.	With  no flags or with the flag `-', the arguments are
	      printed on the standard output as described by  echo,  with  the
	      following	 differences:  the escape sequence `\M-x' metafies the
	      character x (sets the highest bit), `\C-x'  produces  a  control
	      character	 (`\C-@'  and  `\C-?'  give  the  characters  NUL  and
	      delete), and `\E' is a synonym for `\e'.	Finally, if not in  an
	      escape  sequence, `\' escapes the following character and is not
	      printed.

	      -a     Print arguments with the column incrementing first.  Only
		     useful with the -c and -C options.

	      -b     Recognize	all the escape sequences defined for the bind‐
		     key command, see zshzle(1).

	      -c     Print the arguments in columns.  Unless -a is also given,
		     arguments are printed with the row incrementing first.

	      -C cols
		     Print  the	 arguments in cols columns.  Unless -a is also
		     given, arguments are printed with	the  row  incrementing
		     first.

	      -D     Treat  the	 arguments  as paths, replacing directory pre‐
		     fixes  with  ~  expressions  corresponding	 to  directory
		     names, as appropriate.

	      -i     If	 given	together  with	-o or -O, sorting is performed
		     case-independently.

	      -l     Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spa‐
		     ces.

	      -m     Take  the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted),
		     and remove it from the argument list together with subse‐
		     quent arguments that do not match this pattern.

	      -n     Do not add a newline to the output.

	      -N     Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls.

	      -o     Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.

	      -O     Print the arguments sorted in descending order.

	      -p     Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.

	      -P     Perform   prompt	expansion  (see	 EXPANSION  OF	PROMPT
		     SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).

	      -r     Ignore the escape conventions of echo.

	      -R     Emulate the BSD echo  command,  which  does  not  process
		     escape  sequences	unless	the  -e flag is given.	The -n
		     flag suppresses the trailing newline.  Only the -e and -n
		     flags  are	 recognized  after -R; all other arguments and
		     options are printed.

	      -s     Place the results in the history list instead of  on  the
		     standard  output.	 Each argument to the print command is
		     treated as a single word in the  history,	regardless  of
		     its content.

	      -S     Place  the	 results in the history list instead of on the
		     standard output.  In this case only a single argument  is
		     allowed; it will be split into words as if it were a full
		     shell command line.  The effect is similar to reading the
		     line  from	 a history file with the HIST_LEX_WORDS option
		     active.

	      -u n   Print the arguments to file descriptor n.

	      -z     Push the arguments onto the editing buffer	 stack,	 sepa‐
		     rated by spaces.

	      If  any  of `-m', `-o' or `-O' are used in combination with `-f'
	      and there are no arguments (after the  removal  process  in  the
	      case of `-m') then nothing is printed.

       printf format [ arg ... ]
	      Print  the arguments according to the format specification. For‐
	      matting rules are the  same  as  used  in	 C.  The  same	escape
	      sequences	 as  for echo are recognised in the format. All C con‐
	      version specifications ending in one of csdiouxXeEfgGn are  han‐
	      dled.  In	 addition to this, `%b' can be used instead of `%s' to
	      cause escape sequences in the argument to be recognised and `%q'
	      can  be  used to quote the argument in such a way that allows it
	      to be reused as shell input. With the numeric format specifiers,
	      if the corresponding argument starts with a quote character, the
	      numeric value of the following character is used as  the	number
	      to  print	 otherwise  the argument is evaluated as an arithmetic
	      expression. See the  section  `Arithmetic	 Evaluation'  in  zsh‐
	      misc(1)  for a description of arithmetic expressions. With `%n',
	      the corresponding argument is taken as an	 identifier  which  is
	      created as an integer parameter.

	      Normally, conversion specifications are applied to each argument
	      in order but they can explicitly specify the nth argument is  to
	      be  used by replacing `%' by `%n$' and `*' by `*n$'.  It is rec‐
	      ommended that you do not mix references of this  explicit	 style
	      with  the normal style and the handling of such mixed styles may
	      be subject to future change.

	      If arguments remain unused after formatting, the	format	string
	      is reused until all arguments have been consumed. With the print
	      builtin, this can be suppressed by using the -r option. If  more
	      arguments	 are  required by the format than have been specified,
	      the behaviour is as if zero or an empty string had  been	speci‐
	      fied as the argument.

       pushd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
       pushd [ -qsLP ] old new
       pushd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
	      Change the current directory, and push the old current directory
	      onto the directory stack.	 In the first form, change the current
	      directory to arg.	 If arg is not specified, change to the second
	      directory on the stack (that is, exchange the top two  entries),
	      or  change  to  $HOME  if	 the PUSHD_TO_HOME option is set or if
	      there is only one entry on the stack.  Otherwise, arg is	inter‐
	      preted  as it would be by cd.  The meaning of old and new in the
	      second form is also the same as for cd.

	      The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the direc‐
	      tory  list.   An	argument  of  the form `+n' identifies a stack
	      entry by counting from the left of the list shown	 by  the  dirs
	      command,	starting  with	zero.	An  argument  of the form `-n'
	      counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option	 is  set,  the
	      meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If  the  -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd
	      and the functions in the array $chpwd_functions are not  called,
	      and  the new directory stack is not printed.  This is useful for
	      calls to pushd that do not change the  environment  seen	by  an
	      interactive user.

	      If  the  option  -q  is  not  specified  and  the	 shell	option
	      PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the directory  stack  will  be  printed
	      after a pushd is performed.

	      The  options  -s, -L and -P have the same meanings as for the cd
	      builtin.

       pushln [ arg ... ]
	      Equivalent to print -nz.

       pwd [ -rLP ]
	      Print the absolute pathname of the  current  working  directory.
	      If the -r or the -P flag is specified, or the CHASE_LINKS option
	      is set and the -L flag is not given, the printed path  will  not
	      contain symbolic links.

       r      Same as fc -e -.

       read [ -rszpqAclneE ] [ -t [ num ] ] [ -k [ num ] ] [ -d delim ]
	[ -u n ] [ name[?prompt] ] [ name ...  ]
	      Read  one	 line and break it into fields using the characters in
	      $IFS as separators, except as noted below.  The first  field  is
	      assigned to the first name, the second field to the second name,
	      etc., with leftover fields assigned to the last name.   If  name
	      is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply for arrays.

	      -r     Raw  mode:	 a  `\'	 at the end of a line does not signify
		     line continuation and backslashes in the line don't quote
		     the following character and are not removed.

	      -s     Don't  echo back characters if reading from the terminal.
		     Currently does not work with the -q option.

	      -q     Read only one character from the terminal and set name to
		     `y'  if  this  character was `y' or `Y' and to `n' other‐
		     wise.  With this flag set the return status is zero  only
		     if the character was `y' or `Y'.  This option may be used
		     with a timeout; if the read times out, or encounters  end
		     of	 file,	status	2 is returned.	Input is read from the
		     terminal unless one of -u or -p is present.  This	option
		     may also be used within zle widgets.

	      -k [ num ]
		     Read  only	 one (or num) characters.  All are assigned to
		     the first name, without word  splitting.	This  flag  is
		     ignored  when -q is present.  Input is read from the ter‐
		     minal unless one of -u or -p is present.  This option may
		     also be used within zle widgets.

		     Note  that	 despite  the  mnemonic `key' this option does
		     read full characters, which may consist of multiple bytes
		     if the option MULTIBYTE is set.

	      -z     Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it
		     to the first  name,  without  word	 splitting.   Text  is
		     pushed  onto  the stack with `print -z' or with push-line
		     from the line  editor  (see  zshzle(1)).	This  flag  is
		     ignored when the -k or -q flags are present.

	      -e
	      -E     The  input	 read is printed (echoed) to the standard out‐
		     put.  If the -e flag is used, no input is assigned to the
		     parameters.

	      -A     The  first	 name is taken as the name of an array and all
		     words are assigned to it.

	      -c
	      -l     These flags are allowed only if called inside a  function
		     used  for	completion (specified with the -K flag to com‐
		     pctl).  If the -c flag is given, the words of the current
		     command are read. If the -l flag is given, the whole line
		     is assigned as a scalar.  If both flags are  present,  -l
		     is used and -c is ignored.

	      -n     Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on
		     is read.  With -l, the index of the character the	cursor
		     is on is read.  Note that the command name is word number
		     1, not word 0, and that when the cursor is at the end  of
		     the  line,	 its character index is the length of the line
		     plus one.

	      -u n   Input is read from file descriptor n.

	      -p     Input is read from the coprocess.

	      -d delim
		     Input is terminated  by  the  first  character  of	 delim
		     instead of by newline.

	      -t [ num ]
		     Test if input is available before attempting to read.  If
		     num is present, it must begin with a digit	 and  will  be
		     evaluated	to  give  a  number of seconds, which may be a
		     floating point number; in this case the read times out if
		     input  is	not available within this time.	 If num is not
		     present, it is taken to be zero,  so  that	 read  returns
		     immediately  if  no  input	 is available.	If no input is
		     available, return status 1 and do not set any variables.

		     This option is not available when reading from the editor
		     buffer  with  -z, when called from within completion with
		     -c or -l, with -q which clears  the  input	 queue	before
		     reading,  or  within zle where other mechanisms should be
		     used to test for input.

		     Note that read does not attempt to alter the  input  pro‐
		     cessing  mode.   The  default mode is canonical input, in
		     which an entire line is read at a time, so usually	 `read
		     -t'  will not read anything until an entire line has been
		     typed.  However, when reading from the terminal  with  -k
		     input  is processed one key at a time; in this case, only
		     availability of the first character is  tested,  so  that
		     e.g. `read -t -k 2' can still block on the second charac‐
		     ter.  Use two instances of `read -t -k' if	 this  is  not
		     what is wanted.

	      If the first argument contains a `?', the remainder of this word
	      is used as a prompt on standard error when the shell is interac‐
	      tive.

	      The  value  (exit	 status)  of  read is 1 when an end-of-file is
	      encountered, or when -c or -l is present and the command is  not
	      called  from a compctl function, or as described for -q.	Other‐
	      wise the value is 0.

	      The behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u  and  -z
	      flags  is	 undefined.   Presently	 -q cancels all the others, -p
	      cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z cancels both -p  and
	      -u.

	      The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.

       readonly
	      Same as typeset -r.

       rehash Same as hash -r.

       return [ n ]
	      Causes  a shell function or `.' script to return to the invoking
	      script with the return status specified by n.  If n is  omitted,
	      the return status is that of the last command executed.

	      If  return  was  executed from a trap in a TRAPNAL function, the
	      effect is different for zero and non-zero return	status.	  With
	      zero  status  (or	 after	an  implicit  return at the end of the
	      trap), the shell will return to whatever it was previously  pro‐
	      cessing; with a non-zero status, the shell will behave as inter‐
	      rupted except that the return status of the  trap	 is  retained.
	      Note  that the numeric value of the signal which caused the trap
	      is passed as  the	 first	argument,  so  the  statement  `return
	      $((128+$1))'  will  return  the same status as if the signal had
	      not been trapped.

       sched  See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       set [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o [ option_name ] ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ] [
       arg ... ]
	      Set  the options for the shell and/or set the positional parame‐
	      ters, or declare and set an array.  If the -s option  is	given,
	      it  causes the specified arguments to be sorted before assigning
	      them to the positional parameters (or to the array name if -A is
	      used).   With  +s	 sort  arguments in descending order.  For the
	      meaning of the other flags, see  zshoptions(1).	Flags  may  be
	      specified by name using the -o option. If no option name is sup‐
	      plied with -o, the current option states are printed:   see  the
	      description  of setopt below for more information on the format.
	      With +o they are printed in a form that can be used as input  to
	      the shell.

	      If  the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array containing
	      the given args; if no name is specified, all arrays are  printed
	      together with their values.

	      If  +A  is  used	and name is an array, the given arguments will
	      replace the initial elements of that array; if no name is speci‐
	      fied, all arrays are printed without their values.

	      The  behaviour  of arguments after -A name or +A name depends on
	      whether the option KSH_ARRAYS is set.  If it  is	not  set,  all
	      arguments	 following  name  are treated as values for the array,
	      regardless of their form.	 If the option is set,	normal	option
	      processing  continues  at that point; only regular arguments are
	      treated as values for the array.	This means that

		     set -A array -x -- foo

	      sets array to `-x -- foo' if KSH_ARRAYS is not set, but sets the
	      array to foo and turns on the option `-x' if it is set.

	      If  the  -A  flag is not present, but there are arguments beyond
	      the options, the positional parameters are set.  If  the	option
	      list  (if	 any)  is terminated by `--', and there are no further
	      arguments, the positional parameters will be unset.

	      If no arguments and no `--' are given, then the names and values
	      of  all  parameters  are printed on the standard output.	If the
	      only argument is `+', the names of all parameters are printed.

	      For historical reasons, `set -' is treated as `set +xv' and `set
	      -	 args'	as  `set +xv -- args' when in any other emulation mode
	      than zsh's native mode.

       setcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       setopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
	      Set the options for the shell.   All  options  specified	either
	      with flags or by name are set.

	      If no arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently
	      set are printed.	The form is chosen so as to minimize the  dif‐
	      ferences from the default options for the current emulation (the
	      default emulation being native  zsh,  shown  as  <Z>  in	zshop‐
	      tions(1)).  Options that are on by default for the emulation are
	      shown with the prefix no only  if	 they  are  off,  while	 other
	      options are shown without the prefix no and only if they are on.
	      In addition to options changed from the  default	state  by  the
	      user,  any  options  activated  automatically  by the shell (for
	      example, SHIN_STDIN or INTERACTIVE) will be shown in  the	 list.
	      The  format  is further modified by the option KSH_OPTION_PRINT,
	      however the rationale for choosing options with or  without  the
	      no prefix remains the same in this case.

	      If  the  -m  flag	 is  given the arguments are taken as patterns
	      (which should be quoted to protect  them	from  filename	expan‐
	      sion),  and  all	options with names matching these patterns are
	      set.

	      Note that a bad option name does not cause execution  of	subse‐
	      quent  shell  code to be aborted; this is behaviour is different
	      from that of `set -o'.  This is because set  is  regarded	 as  a
	      special builtin by the POSIX standard, but setopt is not.

       shift [ n ] [ name ... ]
	      The  positional  parameters  ${n+1}  ...	are renamed to $1 ...,
	      where n is an arithmetic expression that defaults to 1.  If  any
	      names  are  given	 then  the arrays with these names are shifted
	      instead of the positional parameters.

       source file [ arg ... ]
	      Same as  `.',  except  that  the	current	 directory  is	always
	      searched	and  is	 always	 searched first, before directories in
	      $path.

       stat   See the section `The zsh/stat Module' in zshmodules(1).

       suspend [ -f ]
	      Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until  it
	      receives	a  SIGCONT.   Unless the -f option is given, this will
	      refuse to suspend a login shell.

       test [ arg ... ]
       [ [ arg ... ] ]
	      Like the system version of test.	Added for  compatibility;  use
	      conditional  expressions	instead	 (see the section `Conditional
	      Expressions').  The main	differences  between  the  conditional
	      expression  syntax  and the test and [ builtins are:  these com‐
	      mands are not handled syntactically, so  for  example  an	 empty
	      variable	expansion  may cause an argument to be omitted; syntax
	      errors cause status 2 to be returned instead of a	 shell	error;
	      and  arithmetic  operators  expect integer arguments rather than
	      arithmetic expressions.

	      The command attempts to implement POSIX and its extensions where
	      these are specified.  Unfortunately there are intrinsic ambigui‐
	      ties in the  syntax;  in	particular  there  is  no  distinction
	      between  test  operators	and  strings  that resemble them.  The
	      standard attempts to resolve these for small  numbers  of	 argu‐
	      ments  (up  to  four);  for five or more arguments compatibility
	      cannot be relied on.  Users are urged wherever possible  to  use
	      the `[[' test syntax which does not have these ambiguities.

       times  Print  the  accumulated  user and system times for the shell and
	      for processes run from the shell.

       trap [ arg ] [ sig ... ]
	      arg is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect  it  from
	      immediate	 evaluation by the shell) to be read and executed when
	      the shell receives any of the signals specified by one  or  more
	      sig  args.  Each sig can be given as a number, or as the name of
	      a signal either with or without the string SIG in front (e.g. 1,
	      HUP, and SIGHUP are all the same signal).

	      If  arg  is  `-',	 then the specified signals are reset to their
	      defaults, or, if no sig args are present, all traps are reset.

	      If arg is an  empty  string,  then  the  specified  signals  are
	      ignored by the shell (and by the commands it invokes).

	      If  arg  is  omitted but one or more sig args are provided (i.e.
	      the first argument is a valid signal number or name), the effect
	      is the same as if arg had been specified as `-'.

	      The  trap	 command  with	no arguments prints a list of commands
	      associated with each signal.

	      If sig is ZERR then arg will be executed after each command with
	      a nonzero exit status.  ERR is an alias for ZERR on systems that
	      have no SIGERR signal (this is the usual case).

	      If sig is DEBUG then arg will be executed before each command if
	      the  option  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), else
	      after each command.  Here, a `command' is what is described as a
	      `sublist'	 in the shell grammar, see the section SIMPLE COMMANDS
	      & PIPELINES in zshmisc(1).  If DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is  set  various
	      additional  features  are	 available.   First, it is possible to
	      skip the next command by setting the option  ERR_EXIT;  see  the
	      description  of the ERR_EXIT option in zshoptions(1).  Also, the
	      shell parameter ZSH_DEBUG_CMD is set to the string corresponding
	      to  the  command	to  be executed following the trap.  Note that
	      this string is reconstructed from the internal  format  and  may
	      not be formatted the same way as the original text.  The parame‐
	      ter is unset after the trap is executed.

	      If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement  is  executed	inside
	      the  body	 of a function, then the command arg is executed after
	      the function completes.  The value of $? at the start of	execu‐
	      tion is the exit status of the shell or the return status of the
	      function exiting.	 If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement is
	      not executed inside the body of a function, then the command arg
	      is executed when the shell terminates; the trap runs before  any
	      zshexit hook functions.

	      ZERR, DEBUG, and EXIT traps are not executed inside other traps.
	      ZERR and DEBUG traps are	kept  within  subshells,  while	 other
	      traps are reset.

	      Note  that traps defined with the trap builtin are slightly dif‐
	      ferent from those defined as `TRAPNAL () { ... }', as the latter
	      have  their  own function environment (line numbers, local vari‐
	      ables, etc.) while the former use the environment of the command
	      in which they were called.  For example,

		     trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG

	      will  print  the	line number of a command executed after it has
	      run, while

		     TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }

	      will always print the number zero.

	      Alternative signal names are allowed  as	described  under  kill
	      above.   Defining a trap under either name causes any trap under
	      an alternative name to be removed.  However, it  is  recommended
	      that  for	 consistency  users  stick  exclusively to one name or
	      another.

       true [ arg ... ]
	      Do nothing and return an exit status of 0.

       ttyctl -fu
	      The -f option freezes the tty, and -u unfreezes  it.   When  the
	      tty  is  frozen, no changes made to the tty settings by external
	      programs will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the
	      size  of the screen; the shell will simply reset the settings to
	      their previous values as soon as each command exits or  is  sus‐
	      pended.  Thus, stty and similar programs have no effect when the
	      tty is frozen.  Without options it reports whether the  terminal
	      is frozen or not.

       type [ -wfpams ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -v.

       typeset [ {+|-}AEFHUafghklprtuxmz ] [ -LRZi [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
       typeset -T [ {+|-}Urux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] SCALAR[=value] array [ sep ]
	      Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.

	      A parameter is created for each name that does not already refer
	      to one.  When inside a function, a new parameter is created  for
	      every  name  (even those that already exist), and is unset again
	      when the function completes.  See	 `Local	 Parameters'  in  zsh‐
	      param(1).	  The  same  rules  apply to special shell parameters,
	      which retain their special attributes when made local.

	      For each name=value assignment, the parameter  name  is  set  to
	      value.  Note that arrays currently cannot be assigned in typeset
	      expressions, only	 scalars  and  integers.   Unless  the	option
	      KSH_TYPESET  is  set, normal expansion rules apply to assignment
	      arguments, so value may be split into  separate  words;  if  the
	      option  is  set, assignments which can be recognised when expan‐
	      sion is performed are treated as single words.  For example  the
	      command  typeset	vbl=$(echo  one	 two) is treated as having one
	      argument if KSH_TYPESET is set, but otherwise is treated as hav‐
	      ing the two arguments vbl=one and two.

	      If  the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not set, for each remain‐
	      ing name that refers to a parameter that is set,	the  name  and
	      value of the parameter are printed in the form of an assignment.
	      Nothing is printed for newly-created  parameters,	 or  when  any
	      attribute	 flags	listed	below  are  given along with the name.
	      Using `+' instead of minus to introduce an  attribute  turns  it
	      off.

	      If  the -p option is given, parameters and values are printed in
	      the form of a typeset command and an assignment (which  will  be
	      printed  separately  for arrays and associative arrays), regard‐
	      less of other flags and options.	 Note  that  the  -h  flag  on
	      parameters is respected; no value will be shown for these param‐
	      eters.

	      If the -T option is  given,  two	or  three  arguments  must  be
	      present (an exception is that zero arguments are allowed to show
	      the list of parameters created in this fashion).	The first  two
	      are  the name of a scalar and an array parameter (in that order)
	      that will be tied together in the manner	of  $PATH  and	$path.
	      The  optional  third  argument  is  a single-character separator
	      which will be used to join the elements of the array to form the
	      scalar;  if  absent,  a  colon is used, as with $PATH.  Only the
	      first character of the separator is significant;	any  remaining
	      characters  are  ignored.	  Only	the  scalar  parameter	may be
	      assigned an initial value.  Both the scalar and  the  array  may
	      otherwise	 be manipulated as normal.  If one is unset, the other
	      will automatically be unset too.	There is no way of untying the
	      variables	 without unsetting them, or converting the type of one
	      of them with another typeset command; +T does not work,  assign‐
	      ing  an  array  to SCALAR is an error, and assigning a scalar to
	      array sets it to be a  single-element  array.   Note  that  both
	      `typeset	-xT ...' and `export -T ...' work, but only the scalar
	      will be marked for export.  Setting the value using  the	scalar
	      version  causes  a  split	 on  all  separators  (which cannot be
	      quoted).	It is possible to use the same two tied variables with
	      a	 different  separator  character  in  which case the variables
	      remain joined as before but the separator is changed.  This flag
	      has a different meaning when used with -f; see below.

	      The  -g  (global)	 flag  is treated specially: it means that any
	      resulting parameter will not be restricted to local scope.  Note
	      that  this  does not necessarily mean that the parameter will be
	      global, as the flag will apply to any existing  parameter	 (even
	      if unset) from an enclosing function.  This flag does not affect
	      the parameter after creation, hence it has no effect when	 list‐
	      ing  existing  parameters,  nor does the flag +g have any effect
	      except in combination with -m (see below).

	      If no name is present, the names and values  of  all  parameters
	      are printed.  In this case the attribute flags restrict the dis‐
	      play  to	only  those  parameters	 that	have   the   specified
	      attributes,  and using `+' rather than `-' to introduce the flag
	      suppresses printing of the values of parameters when there is no
	      parameter	 name.	Also, if the last option is the word `+', then
	      names are printed but values are not.

	      If the -m flag is given the name arguments are taken as patterns
	      (which  should be quoted).  With no attribute flags, all parame‐
	      ters (or functions with the -f flag)  with  matching  names  are
	      printed  (the  shell  option  TYPESET_SILENT is not used in this
	      case).  Note that -m is ignored if no patterns  are  given.   If
	      the  +g  flag is combined with -m, a new local parameter is cre‐
	      ated for every matching parameter that  is  not  already	local.
	      Otherwise	 -m  applies  all  other  flags	 or assignments to the
	      existing parameters.  Except  when  assignments  are  made  with
	      name=value,  using  +m  forces  the  matching  parameters	 to be
	      printed, even inside a function.

	      If no attribute flags are given and either no -m flag is present
	      or the +m form was used, each parameter name printed is preceded
	      by a list of the attributes of that parameter  (array,  associa‐
	      tion,   exported,	 integer,  readonly).	If  +m	is  used  with
	      attribute flags, and all those flags are introduced with +,  the
	      matching parameter names are printed but their values are not.

	      Attribute	 flags that transform the final value (-L, -R, -Z, -l,
	      u) are only applied to the expanded value	 at  the  point	 of  a
	      parameter	 expansion expression using `$'.  They are not applied
	      when a parameter is retrieved internally by the  shell  for  any
	      purpose.

	      The following attribute flags may be specified:

	      -A     The  names	 refer	to  associative	 array parameters; see
		     `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).

	      -L     Left justify and remove leading blanks from value.	 If  n
		     is	 nonzero,  it defines the width of the field.  If n is
		     zero, the width is determined by the width of  the	 value
		     of	 the first assignment.	In the case of numeric parame‐
		     ters, the length of the complete value  assigned  to  the
		     parameter	is  used to determine the width, not the value
		     that would be output.

		     The width is the count of characters, which may be multi‐
		     byte  characters  if  the	MULTIBYTE option is in effect.
		     Note that the screen width of the character is not	 taken
		     into  account;  if	 this  is  required,  use padding with
		     parameter expansion flags ${(ml...)...} as	 described  in
		     `Parameter Expansion Flags' in zshexpn(1).

		     When the parameter is expanded, it is filled on the right
		     with blanks or truncated if necessary to fit  the	field.
		     Note  truncation  can  lead  to  unexpected  results with
		     numeric parameters.  Leading zeros are removed if the  -Z
		     flag is also set.

	      -R     Similar  to  -L, except that right justification is used;
		     when the parameter is expanded, the field is left	filled
		     with  blanks  or truncated from the end.  May not be com‐
		     bined with the -Z flag.

	      -U     For arrays (but not for associative  arrays),  keep  only
		     the  first occurrence of each duplicated value.  This may
		     also be set for colon-separated special  parameters  like
		     PATH  or FIGNORE, etc.  This flag has a different meaning
		     when used with -f; see below.

	      -Z     Specially handled if set along with the -L flag.	Other‐
		     wise,  similar  to -R, except that leading zeros are used
		     for padding instead of  blanks  if	 the  first  non-blank
		     character	is  a digit.  Numeric parameters are specially
		     handled:  they  are  always  eligible  for	 padding  with
		     zeroes,  and  the	zeroes	are inserted at an appropriate
		     place in the output.

	      -a     The names refer to array parameters.  An array  parameter
		     may be created this way, but it may not be assigned to in
		     the typeset statement.  When displaying, both normal  and
		     associative arrays are shown.

	      -f     The  names refer to functions rather than parameters.  No
		     assignments can be made, and the only other  valid	 flags
		     are -t, -T, -k, -u, -U and -z.  The flag -t turns on exe‐
		     cution tracing for this function; the flag	 -T  does  the
		     same,  but	 turns off tracing on any function called from
		     the present one, unless that function also has the -t  or
		     -T	 flag.	 The  -u and -U flags cause the function to be
		     marked for autoloading; -U also causes alias expansion to
		     be	 suppressed  when  the	function is loaded.  The fpath
		     parameter will be searched to find the  function  defini‐
		     tion  when the function is first referenced; see the sec‐
		     tion `Functions'. The -k and -z flags make	 the  function
		     be	  loaded  using	 ksh-style  or	zsh-style  autoloading
		     respectively. If neither is given,	 the  setting  of  the
		     KSH_AUTOLOAD   option  determines	how  the  function  is
		     loaded.

	      -h     Hide: only useful for special  parameters	(those	marked
		     `<S>' in the table in zshparam(1)), and for local parame‐
		     ters with the same name as a  special  parameter,	though
		     harmless  for  others.   A	 special  parameter  with this
		     attribute will not retain its special  effect  when  made
		     local.  Thus after `typeset -h PATH', a function contain‐
		     ing `typeset PATH' will create an ordinary local  parame‐
		     ter  without the usual behaviour of PATH.	Alternatively,
		     the local parameter may itself be given  this  attribute;
		     hence  inside  a  function	 `typeset  -h PATH' creates an
		     ordinary local parameter and the special  PATH  parameter
		     is not altered in any way.	 It is also possible to create
		     a local parameter using `typeset +h special',  where  the
		     local  copy of special will retain its special properties
		     regardless of having the -h  attribute.   Global  special
		     parameters	 loaded from shell modules (currently those in
		     zsh/mapfile and zsh/parameter)  are  automatically	 given
		     the -h attribute to avoid name clashes.

	      -H     Hide  value:  specifies that typeset will not display the
		     value of the parameter when listing parameters; the  dis‐
		     play for such parameters is always as if the `+' flag had
		     been given.  Use of the parameter is  in  other  respects
		     normal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is
		     specified by name, or by  pattern	with  the  -m  option.
		     This   is	on  by	default	 for  the  parameters  in  the
		     zsh/parameter and zsh/mapfile  modules.   Note,  however,
		     that  unlike the -h flag this is also useful for non-spe‐
		     cial parameters.

	      -i     Use an internal integer representation.  If n is  nonzero
		     it	 defines  the  output arithmetic base, otherwise it is
		     determined by the first assignment.  Bases from 2	to  36
		     inclusive are allowed.

	      -E     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen‐
		     tation.  On output the variable will be converted to sci‐
		     entific  notation.	 If n is nonzero it defines the number
		     of significant figures to display; the default is ten.

	      -F     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen‐
		     tation.   On  output  the	variable  will be converted to
		     fixed-point decimal notation.  If n is nonzero it defines
		     the  number of digits to display after the decimal point;
		     the default is ten.

	      -l     Convert the result to lower case whenever	the  parameter
		     is expanded.  The value is not converted when assigned.

	      -r     The  given	 names are marked readonly.  Note that if name
		     is a special parameter, the  readonly  attribute  can  be
		     turned on, but cannot then be turned off.

	      -t     Tags  the named parameters.  Tags have no special meaning
		     to the shell.  This flag has  a  different	 meaning  when
		     used with -f; see above.

	      -u     Convert  the  result to upper case whenever the parameter
		     is expanded.  The value is not converted  when  assigned.
		     This  flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see
		     above.

	      -x     Mark for automatic export to the  environment  of	subse‐
		     quently  executed	commands.  If the option GLOBAL_EXPORT
		     is set, this implies the option -g,  unless  +g  is  also
		     explicitly	 given;	 in  other  words the parameter is not
		     made local to the enclosing function.  This is  for  com‐
		     patibility with previous versions of zsh.

       ulimit [ [ -SHacdfiklmnpqsTtvwx | -N resource [ limit ] ... ]
	      Set  or  display	resource limits of the shell and the processes
	      started by the shell.  The value of limit can be a number in the
	      unit  specified  below  or  one of the values `unlimited', which
	      removes the limit on the resource, or  `hard',  which  uses  the
	      current value of the hard limit on the resource.

	      By  default, only soft limits are manipulated. If the -H flag is
	      given use hard limits instead of soft limits.  If the -S flag is
	      given together with the -H flag set both hard and soft limits.

	      If no options are used, the file size limit (-f) is assumed.

	      If limit is omitted the current value of the specified resources
	      are printed.  When more than one resource value is printed,  the
	      limit name and unit is printed before each value.

	      When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort imme‐
	      diately if it detects a badly formed argument.  However,	if  it
	      fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue try‐
	      ing to set the remaining limits.

	      Not all the following resources are supported  on	 all  systems.
	      Running ulimit -a will show which are supported.

	      -a     Lists all of the current resource limits.
	      -b     Socket buffer size in bytes (N.B. not kilobytes)
	      -c     512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
	      -d     Kilobytes on the size of the data segment.
	      -f     512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
	      -i     The number of pending signals.
	      -k     The number of kqueues allocated.
	      -l     Kilobytes on the size of locked-in memory.
	      -m     Kilobytes on the size of physical memory.
	      -n     open file descriptors.
	      -p     The number of pseudo-terminals.
	      -q     Bytes in POSIX message queues.
	      -s     Kilobytes on the size of the stack.
	      -T     The number of simultaneous threads available to the user.
	      -t     CPU seconds to be used.
	      -u     The number of processes available to the user.
	      -v     Kilobytes on the size of virtual memory.  On some systems
		     this refers to the limit called `address space'.
	      -w     Kilobytes on the size of swapped out memory.
	      -x     The number of locks on files.

	      A resource may also be specified by  integer  in	the  form  `-N
	      resource', where resource corresponds to the integer defined for
	      the resource by the operating system.  This may be used  to  set
	      the  limits for resources known to the shell which do not corre‐
	      spond to option letters.	Such limits will be shown by number in
	      the output of `ulimit -a'.

	      The  number may alternatively be out of the range of limits com‐
	      piled into the shell.  The shell will try to read or  write  the
	      limit anyway, and will report an error if this fails.

       umask [ -S ] [ mask ]
	      The umask is set to mask.	 mask can be either an octal number or
	      a symbolic value as described in chmod(1).  If mask is  omitted,
	      the  current value is printed.  The -S option causes the mask to
	      be printed as a symbolic value.  Otherwise, the mask is  printed
	      as  an octal number.  Note that in the symbolic form the permis‐
	      sions you specify are those which are to be allowed (not denied)
	      to the users specified.

       unalias
	      Same as unhash -a.

       unfunction
	      Same as unhash -f.

       unhash [ -adfms ] name ...
	      Remove  the element named name from an internal hash table.  The
	      default is remove elements from the command hash table.  The  -a
	      option  causes  unhash to remove regular or global aliases; note
	      when removing a global aliases that the argument must be	quoted
	      to  prevent  it  from  being expanded before being passed to the
	      command.	The -s option causes unhash to remove suffix  aliases.
	      The  -f  option causes unhash to remove shell functions.	The -d
	      options causes unhash to remove named directories.   If  the  -m
	      flag  is	given  the  arguments are taken as patterns (should be
	      quoted) and all elements of the corresponding  hash  table  with
	      matching names will be removed.

       unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...
	      The  resource  limit for each resource is set to the hard limit.
	      If the -h flag is given and the  shell  has  appropriate	privi‐
	      leges,  the  hard	 resource  limit for each resource is removed.
	      The resources of the shell process are only changed  if  the  -s
	      flag is given.

	      The  unlimit  command  is not made available by default when the
	      shell starts in a mode emulating another shell.  It can be  made
	      available with the command `zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:unlimit'.

       unset [ -fmv ] name ...
	      Each  named  parameter  is unset.	 Local parameters remain local
	      even if unset; they appear unset within scope, but the  previous
	      value will still reappear when the scope ends.

	      Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset
	      by using subscript syntax on name, which should  be  quoted  (or
	      the  entire  command  prefixed  with noglob) to protect the sub‐
	      script from filename generation.

	      If the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as  patterns
	      (should  be  quoted)  and all parameters with matching names are
	      unset.  Note that this cannot be used when unsetting associative
	      array  elements, as the subscript will be treated as part of the
	      pattern.

	      The -v flag specifies that name refers to	 parameters.  This  is
	      the default behaviour.

	      unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.

       unsetopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
	      Unset  the  options for the shell.  All options specified either
	      with flags or by name are unset.	If no arguments are  supplied,
	      the names of all options currently unset are printed.  If the -m
	      flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which	should
	      be  quoted  to preserve them from being interpreted as glob pat‐
	      terns), and all options with names matching these	 patterns  are
	      unset.

       vared  See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       wait [ job ... ]
	      Wait  for	 the specified jobs or processes.  If job is not given
	      then all currently active child processes are waited for.	  Each
	      job can be either a job specification or the process ID of a job
	      in the job table.	 The exit status from this command is that  of
	      the job waited for.

       whence [ -vcwfpams ] name ...
	      For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a
	      command name.

	      -v     Produce a more verbose report.

	      -c     Print the results	in  a  csh-like	 format.   This	 takes
		     precedence over -v.

	      -w     For  each	name,  print `name: word' where word is one of
		     alias, builtin, command, function,	 hashed,  reserved  or
		     none,  according  as  name	 corresponds  to  an  alias, a
		     built-in command, an external command, a shell  function,
		     a command defined with the hash builtin, a reserved word,
		     or is not recognised.  This takes precedence over -v  and
		     -c.

	      -f     Causes  the contents of a shell function to be displayed,
		     which would otherwise not happen unless the -c flag  were
		     used.

	      -p     Do	 a  path  search  for  name  even  if  it is an alias,
		     reserved word, shell function or builtin.

	      -a     Do a search for all occurrences of	 name  throughout  the
		     command  path.   Normally	only  the  first occurrence is
		     printed.

	      -m     The arguments are taken as patterns (should  be  quoted),
		     and  the information is displayed for each command match‐
		     ing one of these patterns.

	      -s     If a pathname contains symlinks, print  the  symlink-free
		     pathname as well.

       where [ -wpms ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -ca.

       which [ -wpams ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -c.

       zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -t file [ name ... ]
	      This  builtin  command  can  be  used  to	 compile  functions or
	      scripts, storing the compiled form in a  file,  and  to  examine
	      files   containing   the	compiled  form.	  This	allows	faster
	      autoloading of functions and execution of	 scripts  by  avoiding
	      parsing of the text when the files are read.

	      The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a com‐
	      piled file.  If only the file argument is given, the output file
	      has the name `file.zwc' and will be placed in the same directory
	      as the file.  The shell will load the compiled file  instead  of
	      the  normal  function  file when the function is autoloaded; see
	      the section `Autoloading Functions' in zshmisc(1) for a descrip‐
	      tion  of	how  autoloaded functions are searched.	 The extension
	      .zwc stands for `zsh word code'.

	      If there is at least one name argument, all the named files  are
	      compiled	into  the output file given as the first argument.  If
	      file does not end	 in  .zwc,  this  extension  is	 automatically
	      appended.	  Files	 containing  multiple  compiled	 functions are
	      called `digest' files, and are intended to be used  as  elements
	      of the FPATH/fpath special array.

	      The  second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the compiled
	      definitions for all the named functions into file.  For -c,  the
	      names  must  be  functions  currently  defined in the shell, not
	      those marked for	autoloading.   Undefined  functions  that  are
	      marked for autoloading may be written by using the -a option, in
	      which case the fpath is searched and the contents of the defini‐
	      tion  files  for	those  functions,  if found, are compiled into
	      file.  If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined	 func‐
	      tions  and  functions  marked  for autoloading may be given.  In
	      either case, the functions in files written with the  -c	or  -a
	      option  will  be	autoloaded  as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option were
	      unset.

	      The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with
	      different	 options is that some definition files for autoloading
	      define multiple functions, including the function with the  same
	      name  as the file, and, at the end, call that function.  In such
	      cases the output of `zcompile -c' does  not  include  the	 addi‐
	      tional  functions defined in the file, and any other initializa‐
	      tion code in the file is lost.  Using `zcompile -a' captures all
	      this extra information.

	      If  the  -m option is combined with -c or -a, the names are used
	      as patterns and all functions whose names	 match	one  of	 these
	      patterns	will  be written. If no name is given, the definitions
	      of all functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded  will
	      be written.

	      The  third  form,	 with the -t option, examines an existing com‐
	      piled file.  Without further arguments, the names of the	origi‐
	      nal files compiled into it are listed.  The first line of output
	      shows the version of the shell which compiled the file  and  how
	      the file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping
	      it into memory).	With arguments,	 nothing  is  output  and  the
	      return  status  is set to zero if definitions for all names were
	      found in the compiled file, and non-zero if the  definition  for
	      at least one name was not found.

	      Other options:

	      -U     Aliases are not expanded when compiling the named files.

	      -R     When  the	compiled file is read, its contents are copied
		     into the shell's memory, rather than  memory-mapped  (see
		     -M).   This  happens automatically on systems that do not
		     support memory mapping.

		     When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions,
		     it	 is  often desirable to use this option; otherwise the
		     whole file, including the code to define functions	 which
		     have  already  been  defined,  will remain mapped, conse‐
		     quently wasting memory.

	      -M     The compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory  when
		     read.  This is done in such a way that multiple instances
		     of the shell running on the same  host  will  share  this
		     mapped file.  If neither -R nor -M is given, the zcompile
		     builtin decides what to do based on the size of the  com‐
		     piled file.

	      -k
	      -z     These  options  are  used when the compiled file contains
		     functions which are to be autoloaded. If -z is given, the
		     function will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option
		     is not set, even if it is set at the  time	 the  compiled
		     file is read, while if the -k is given, the function will
		     be loaded as if KSH_AUTOLOAD is set.  These options  also
		     take  precedence  over  any -k or -z options specified to
		     the autoload builtin. If  neither	of  these  options  is
		     given,  the  function will be loaded as determined by the
		     setting of the KSH_AUTOLOAD option at the time  the  com‐
		     piled file is read.

		     These  options may also appear as many times as necessary
		     between the listed names to specify the loading style  of
		     all following functions, up to the next -k or -z.

		     The created file always contains two versions of the com‐
		     piled format, one for big-endian  machines	 and  one  for
		     small-endian  machines.   The  upshot of this is that the
		     compiled file is machine independent and if it is read or
		     mapped,  only  one half of the file is actually used (and
		     mapped).

       zformat
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zftp   See the section `The zsh/zftp Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zle    See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       zmodload [ -dL ] [ ... ]
       zmodload -F [ -lLme -P param ] module [+-]feature...
       zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]
       zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
       zmodload -R modalias ...
	      Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.  Loading
	      of  modules  while the shell is running (`dynamical loading') is
	      not available on all operating systems, or on all	 installations
	      on  a particular operating system, although the zmodload command
	      itself is always available and can be used to manipulate modules
	      built  into  versions  of the shell executable without dynamical
	      loading.

	      Without arguments the names of all currently loaded binary  mod‐
	      ules  are	 printed.  The -L option causes this list to be in the
	      form of a series of zmodload  commands.	Forms  with  arguments
	      are:

	      zmodload [ -i ] name ...
	      zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
		     In	 the  simplest	case,  zmodload loads a binary module.
		     The module must be in a file with a  name	consisting  of
		     the specified name followed by a standard suffix, usually
		     `.so' (`.sl' on HPUX).  If the module  to	be  loaded  is
		     already loaded the duplicate module is ignored.  If zmod‐
		     load detects an inconsistency, such as an invalid	module
		     name  or circular dependency list, the current code block
		     is aborted.   Hence `zmodload module 2>/dev/null' is suf‐
		     ficient  to test whether a module is available.  If it is
		     available, the module is loaded if necessary, while if it
		     is	 not  available, non-zero status is silently returned.
		     The option -i is accepted for compatibility  but  has  no
		     effect.

		     The  named	 module is searched for in the same way a com‐
		     mand is, using $module_path instead of  $path.   However,
		     the  path	search	is performed even when the module name
		     contains a `/', which it usually does.  There is  no  way
		     to prevent the path search.

		     If	 the  module  supports	features (see below), zmodload
		     tries to enable all features when loading a  module.   If
		     the  module  was successfully loaded but not all features
		     could be enabled, zmodload returns status 2.

		     With -u, zmodload unloads modules.	 The same name must be
		     given  that  was given when the module was loaded, but it
		     is not necessary for the module to exist in the file sys‐
		     tem.  The -i option suppresses the error if the module is
		     already unloaded (or was never loaded).

		     Each module has a boot and a cleanup function.  The  mod‐
		     ule will not be loaded if its boot function fails.	 Simi‐
		     larly a module can only be unloaded if its cleanup	 func‐
		     tion runs successfully.

	      zmodload -F [ -almLe -P param ] module [+-]feature...
		     zmodload  -F  allows more selective control over the fea‐
		     tures provided by modules.	 With no  options  apart  from
		     -F,  the  module  named  module  is loaded, if it was not
		     already loaded, and the list of features is  set  to  the
		     required state.  If no features are specified, the module
		     is loaded, if it was not already loaded, but the state of
		     features is unchanged.  Each feature may be preceded by a
		     + to turn the feature on, or - to turn it off; the	 +  is
		     assumed if neither character is present.  Any feature not
		     explicitly mentioned is left in its current state; if the
		     module was not previously loaded this means any such fea‐
		     tures will remain disabled.  The return status is zero if
		     all  features  were  set, 1 if the module failed to load,
		     and 2 if some features could not be set (for  example,  a
		     parameter couldn't be added because there was a different
		     parameter of the same name) but the module was loaded.

		     The standard features are builtins,  conditions,  parame‐
		     ters  and math functions; these are indicated by the pre‐
		     fix `b:', `c:' (`C:' for an infix	condition),  `p:'  and
		     `f:',  respectively, followed by the name that the corre‐
		     sponding feature would have in the shell.	 For  example,
		     `b:strftime'  indicates  a	 builtin  named	 strftime  and
		     p:EPOCHSECONDS indicates a parameter named	 EPOCHSECONDS.
		     The module may provide other (`abstract') features of its
		     own as indicated by its documentation; these have no pre‐
		     fix.

		     With  -l  or  -L,	features  provided  by	the module are
		     listed.  With -l alone, a list of features together  with
		     their  states  is	shown,	one feature per line.  With -L
		     alone, a zmodload -F command  that	 would	cause  enabled
		     features  of  the	module to be turned on is shown.  With
		     -lL, a zmodload -F command that would cause all the  fea‐
		     tures  to be set to their current state is shown.	If one
		     of these combinations is given the option -P  param  then
		     the  parameter  param  is	set  to	 an array of features,
		     either features together with their state or (if -L alone
		     is given) enabled features.

		     With the option -L the module name may be omitted; then a
		     list of all enabled features for  all  modules  providing
		     features  is printed in the form of zmodload -F commands.
		     If -l is also given, the state of both enabled  and  dis‐
		     abled features is output in that form.

		     A	set of features may be provided together with -l or -L
		     and a module name; in that case only the state  of	 those
		     features  is considered.  Each feature may be preceded by
		     + or - but the character has no effect.   If  no  set  of
		     features is provided, all features are considered.

		     With  -e,	the  command  first  tests  that the module is
		     loaded; if it is not, status 1 is returned.  If the  mod‐
		     ule  is loaded, the list of features given as an argument
		     is examined.  Any feature given with no prefix is	simply
		     tested  to	 see  if  the  module provides it; any feature
		     given with a prefix + or - is tested to see  if  is  pro‐
		     vided  and	 in the given state.  If the tests on all fea‐
		     tures in the list succeed, status	0  is  returned,  else
		     status 1.

		     With  -m,	each  entry  in	 the given list of features is
		     taken as a pattern to be matched against the list of fea‐
		     tures  provided by the module.  An initial + or - must be
		     given explicitly.	This may not be combined with  the  -a
		     option as autoloads must be specified explicitly.

		     With  -a,	the  given  list  of  features	is  marked for
		     autoload from the specified module, which may not yet  be
		     loaded.   An  optional  +	may  appear before the feature
		     name.  If the feature is prefixed with  -,	 any  existing
		     autoload  is  removed.  The options -l and -L may be used
		     to list autoloads.	 Autoloading is specific to individual
		     features;	when  the  module is loaded only the requested
		     feature is enabled.  Autoload requests are	 preserved  if
		     the  module  is  subsequently  unloaded until an explicit
		     `zmodload -Fa module -feature' is issued.	It is  not  an
		     error  to	request	 an autoload for a feature of a module
		     that is already loaded.

		     When the  module  is  loaded  each	 autoload  is  checked
		     against  the features actually provided by the module; if
		     the feature is  not  provided  the	 autoload  request  is
		     deleted.	A  warning message is output; if the module is
		     being loaded to provide a	different  feature,  and  that
		     autoload  is successful, there is no effect on the status
		     of the current command.  If the module is already	loaded
		     at the time when zmodload -Fa is run, an error message is
		     printed and status 1 returned.

		     zmodload -Fa can be used with  the	 -l,  -L,  -e  and  -P
		     options   for   listing  and  testing  the	 existence  of
		     autoloadable features.  In this case -l is ignored if  -L
		     is	 specified.   zmodload	-FaL with no module name lists
		     autoloads for all modules.

		     Note that only standard features as described  above  can
		     be	 autoloaded;  other  features require the module to be
		     loaded before enabling.

	      zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
	      zmodload -d name dep ...
	      zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
		     The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies.
		     The  modules named in the second and subsequent arguments
		     will be loaded before the module named in the first argu‐
		     ment.

		     With  -d and one argument, all dependencies for that mod‐
		     ule are listed.  With -d and  no  arguments,  all	module
		     dependencies are listed.  This listing is by default in a
		     Makefile-like format.  The -L option changes this	format
		     to a list of zmodload -d commands.

		     If -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed.  If
		     only one argument is given,  all  dependencies  for  that
		     module are removed.

	      zmodload -ab [ -L ]
	      zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
	      zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
		     The  -ab  option defines autoloaded builtins.  It defines
		     the specified builtins.  When any of  those  builtins  is
		     called,  the  module  specified  in the first argument is
		     loaded and all its features are  enabled  (for  selective
		     control  of  features  use	 `zmodload -F -a' as described
		     above).  If only  the  name  is  given,  one  builtin  is
		     defined, with the same name as the module.	 -i suppresses
		     the  error	 if  the  builtin  is	already	  defined   or
		     autoloaded,  but  not if another builtin of the same name
		     is already defined.

		     With -ab and no arguments, all  autoloaded	 builtins  are
		     listed,  with  the	 module	 name  (if different) shown in
		     parentheses  after	 the  builtin  name.   The  -L	option
		     changes this format to a list of zmodload -a commands.

		     If	 -b  is	 used  together with the -u option, it removes
		     builtins previously defined with -ab.  This is only  pos‐
		     sible  if	the  builtin is not yet loaded.	 -i suppresses
		     the error if the builtin is  already  removed  (or	 never
		     existed).

		     Autoload  requests	 are  retained if the module is subse‐
		     quently unloaded until an explicit `zmodload -ub builtin'
		     is issued.

	      zmodload -ac [ -IL ]
	      zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
	      zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
		     The  -ac  option  is  used to define autoloaded condition
		     codes. The cond strings give the names of the  conditions
		     defined  by the module. The optional -I option is used to
		     define infix condition names. Without this option	prefix
		     condition names are defined.

		     If given no condition names, all defined names are listed
		     (as a series of zmodload commands if  the	-L  option  is
		     given).

		     The  -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded condi‐
		     tions.

	      zmodload -ap [ -L ]
	      zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
	      zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
		     The -p option is like the -b and -c  options,  but	 makes
		     zmodload work on autoloaded parameters instead.

	      zmodload -af [ -L ]
	      zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
	      zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
		     The  -f  option  is  like the -b, -p, and -c options, but
		     makes zmodload work on autoloaded math functions instead.

	      zmodload -a [ -L ]
	      zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
	      zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
		     Equivalent to -ab and -ub.

	      zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]
		     The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules;
		     if	 the  -A  option  is also given, module aliases corre‐
		     sponding to loaded modules are also shown.	 If  arguments
		     are  provided,  nothing  is printed; the return status is
		     set to zero if all strings given as arguments  are	 names
		     of loaded modules and to one if at least on string is not
		     the name of a loaded module.  This can be	used  to  test
		     for  the  availability  of things implemented by modules.
		     In this case, any aliases are automatically resolved  and
		     the -A flag is not used.

	      zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
		     For each argument, if both modalias and module are given,
		     define modalias to be an alias for the module module.  If
		     the  module  modalias  is	ever  subsequently  requested,
		     either via a call to zmodload or  implicitly,  the	 shell
		     will  attempt  to	load module instead.  If module is not
		     given, show the definition of modalias.  If no  arguments
		     are  given,  list all defined module aliases.  When list‐
		     ing, if the -L flag was also given, list  the  definition
		     as a zmodload command to recreate the alias.

		     The  existence of aliases for modules is completely inde‐
		     pendent of whether the name resolved is  actually	loaded
		     as	 a module: while the alias exists, loading and unload‐
		     ing the module under  any	alias  has  exactly  the  same
		     effect  as	 using	the resolved name, and does not affect
		     the connection between the alias and  the	resolved  name
		     which can be removed either by zmodload -R or by redefin‐
		     ing the alias.  Chains of aliases (i.e. where  the	 first
		     resolved  name  is	 itself an alias) are valid so long as
		     these are not circular.  As the  aliases  take  the  same
		     format as module names, they may include path separators:
		     in this case, there is no requirement for any part of the
		     path  named to exist as the alias will be resolved first.
		     For example, `any/old/alias' is always a valid alias.

		     Dependencies added to aliased modules are actually	 added
		     to	 the  resolved	module;	 these	remain if the alias is
		     removed.  It is valid to create an alias  whose  name  is
		     one of the standard shell modules and which resolves to a
		     different module.	However, if a module has dependencies,
		     it	 will  not  be	possible  to use the module name as an
		     alias as the module will already be marked as a  loadable
		     module in its own right.

		     Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload
		     command anywhere module  names  are  required.   However,
		     aliases will not be shown in lists of loaded modules with
		     a bare `zmodload'.

	      zmodload -R modalias ...
		     For each modalias argument that was previously defined as
		     a module alias via zmodload -A, delete the alias.	If any
		     was not defined, an error is caused and the remainder  of
		     the line is ignored.

	      Note  that  zsh  makes  no distinction between modules that were
	      linked into the shell and modules that are  loaded  dynamically.
	      In both cases this builtin command has to be used to make avail‐
	      able the builtins and other things defined  by  modules  (unless
	      the  module  is  autoloaded  on these definitions). This is true
	      even for systems that don't support dynamic loading of modules.

       zparseopts
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zprof  See the section `The zsh/zprof Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zpty   See the section `The zsh/zpty Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zregexparse
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zsocket
	      See the section `The zsh/net/socket Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zstyle See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ztcp   See the section `The zsh/net/tcp Module' in zshmodules(1).

ZSHZLE(1)							     ZSHZLE(1)

NAME
       zshzle - zsh command line editor

DESCRIPTION
       If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in interactive shells)
       and  the	 shell	input is attached to the terminal, the user is able to
       edit command lines.

       There are two  display  modes.	The  first,  multiline	mode,  is  the
       default.	  It only works if the TERM parameter is set to a valid termi‐
       nal type that can move the cursor up.  The second, single line mode, is
       used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or if the
       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set.  This mode is similar to ksh,  and  uses
       no termcap sequences.  If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option will be unset
       by default.

       The parameters BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line  edi‐
       tor.  See Parameters Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

       The  parameter zle_highlight is also used by the line editor; see Char‐
       acter Highlighting below.  Highlighting of special characters  and  the
       region between the cursor and the mark (as set with set-mark-command in
       Emacs mode) is enabled by default;  consult  this  reference  for  more
       information.   Irascible conservatives will wish to know that all high‐
       lighting may be disabled by the following setting:

	      zle_highlight=(none)

KEYMAPS
       A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between  key	sequences  and
       ZLE commands.  The empty key sequence cannot be bound.

       There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one
       or more names.  If all of a keymap's names are deleted, it  disappears.
       bindkey can be used to manipulate keymap names.

       Initially, there are six keymaps:

       emacs  EMACS emulation
       viins  vi emulation - insert mode
       vicmd  vi emulation - command mode
       isearch
	      incremental search mode
       command
	      read a command name
       .safe  fallback keymap

       The  `.safe'  keymap is special.	 It can never be altered, and the name
       can never be removed.  However, it can be linked to other names,	 which
       can  be	removed.   In  the  future other special keymaps may be added;
       users should avoid  using  names	 beginning  with  `.'  for  their  own
       keymaps.

       In addition to these names, either `emacs' or `viins' is also linked to
       the name `main'.	 If one of the VISUAL or EDITOR environment  variables
       contain	the  string  `vi'  when	 the  shell  starts up then it will be
       `viins', otherwise it will be `emacs'.  bindkey's  -e  and  -v  options
       provide a convenient way to override this default choice.

       When  the  editor starts up, it will select the `main' keymap.  If that
       keymap doesn't exist, it will use `.safe' instead.

       In the `.safe' keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert,	except
       for  ^J	(line  feed)  and  ^M (return) which are bound to accept-line.
       This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it means
       you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.

   Reading Commands
       When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence
       that is bound to some command and is also a prefix of  a	 longer	 bound
       string.	In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see if more char‐
       acters are typed, and if not (or they don't match any longer string) it
       will  execute  the  binding.  This timeout is defined by the KEYTIMEOUT
       parameter; its default is 0.4 sec.  There is no timeout if  the	prefix
       string is not itself bound to a command.

       The  key	 timeout  is also applied when ZLE is reading the bytes from a
       multibyte character string when it is in the appropriate	 mode.	 (This
       requires that the shell was compiled with multibyte mode enabled; typi‐
       cally also the locale has characters with the UTF-8 encoding,  although
       any multibyte encoding known to the operating system is supported.)  If
       the second or a subsequent byte is not read within the timeout  period,
       the shell acts as if ? were typed and resets the input state.

       As  well	 as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings,
       by using `bindkey -s'.  When such a sequence is read,  the  replacement
       string  is pushed back as input, and the command reading process starts
       again using these fake keystrokes.  This input can itself  invoke  fur‐
       ther replacement strings, but in order to detect loops the process will
       be stopped if there are twenty such replacements without a real command
       being read.

       A  key sequence typed by the user can be turned into a command name for
       use in user-defined widgets with	 the  read-command  widget,  described
       below.

ZLE BUILTINS
       The  ZLE	 module	 contains  three related builtin commands. The bindkey
       command manipulates keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes
       ZLE  on the value of a shell parameter; and the zle command manipulates
       editing widgets and allows command line access  to  ZLE	commands  from
       within shell functions.

       bindkey [ options ] -l [ -L ] [ keymap ... ]
       bindkey [ options ] -d
       bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...
       bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap
       bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
       bindkey [ options ] -m
       bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...
       bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]
	      bindkey's	 options  can be divided into three categories: keymap
	      selection for the current command, operation selection, and oth‐
	      ers.  The keymap selection options are:

	      -e     Selects  keymap `emacs' for any operations by the current
		     command, and also links `emacs' to `main' so that	it  is
		     selected by default the next time the editor starts.

	      -v     Selects  keymap `viins' for any operations by the current
		     command, and also links `viins' to `main' so that	it  is
		     selected by default the next time the editor starts.

	      -a     Selects  keymap `vicmd' for any operations by the current
		     command.

	      -M keymap
		     The keymap specifies a keymap name that is	 selected  for
		     any operations by the current command.

	      If  a keymap selection is required and none of the options above
	      are used, the `main' keymap is used.   Some  operations  do  not
	      permit a keymap to be selected, namely:

	      -l     List  all	existing  keymap  names;  if any arguments are
		     given, list just those keymaps.

		     If the -L option is also used, list in the form of	 bind‐
		     key commands to create or link the keymaps.  `bindkey -lL
		     main' shows which keymap is linked to `main', if any, and
		     hence if the standard emacs or vi emulation is in effect.
		     This option does not show the  .safe  keymap  because  it
		     cannot  be	 created  in that fashion; however, neither is
		     `bindkey -lL .safe' reported as an error, it simply  out‐
		     puts nothing.

	      -d     Delete  all  existing  keymaps  and  reset to the default
		     state.

	      -D keymap ...
		     Delete the named keymaps.

	      -A old-keymap new-keymap
		     Make the new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap, so that
		     both  names  refer	 to  the  same keymap.	The names have
		     equal standing; if either is deleted, the other  remains.
		     If there is already a keymap with the new-keymap name, it
		     is deleted.

	      -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
		     Create a new  keymap,  named  new-keymap.	 If  a	keymap
		     already  has  that name, it is deleted.  If an old-keymap
		     name is given, the new keymap  is	initialized  to	 be  a
		     duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will be empty.

	      To  use  a  newly	 created  keymap, it should be linked to main.
	      Hence the sequence of commands to create and use	a  new	keymap
	      `mymap'	initialized  from  the	emacs  keymap  (which  remains
	      unchanged) is:

		     bindkey -N mymap emacs
		     bindkey -A mymap main

	      Note that while `bindkey -A newmap main' will work  when	newmap
	      is emacs or viins, it will not work for vicmd, as switching from
	      vi insert to command mode becomes impossible.

	      The following operations act on the `main' keymap if  no	keymap
	      selection option was given:

	      -m     Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected
		     keymap.   Only  keys  that	 are  unbound  or   bound   to
		     self-insert are affected.

	      -r in-string ...
		     Unbind  the  specified in-strings in the selected keymap.
		     This is exactly equivalent	 to  binding  the  strings  to
		     undefined-key.

		     When -R is also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.

		     When  -p  is  also used, the in-strings specify prefixes.
		     Any binding that has the given in-string as a prefix, not
		     including	the  binding for the in-string itself, if any,
		     will be removed.  For example,

			    bindkey -rpM viins '^['

		     will remove all bindings in the vi-insert	keymap	begin‐
		     ning with an escape character (probably cursor keys), but
		     leave the binding for the escape character itself (proba‐
		     bly  vi-cmd-mode).	  This is incompatible with the option
		     -R.

	      -s in-string out-string ...
		     Bind each in-string to each out-string.   When  in-string
		     is	 typed,	 out-string will be pushed back and treated as
		     input to the line editor.	When -R is also	 used,	inter‐
		     pret the in-strings as ranges.

	      in-string command ...
		     Bind  each	 in-string  to each command.  When -R is used,
		     interpret the in-strings as ranges.

	      [ in-string ]
		     List key bindings.	 If an	in-string  is  specified,  the
		     binding  of  that	string	in the selected keymap is dis‐
		     played.  Otherwise, all  key  bindings  in	 the  selected
		     keymap  are  displayed.  (As a special case, if the -e or
		     -v option is used alone, the keymap is  not  displayed  -
		     the  implicit  linking  of keymaps is the only thing that
		     happens.)

		     When the  option  -p  is  used,  the  in-string  must  be
		     present.	The  listing shows all bindings which have the
		     given key sequence as a prefix, not including  any	 bind‐
		     ings for the key sequence itself.

		     When  the	-L  option is used, the list is in the form of
		     bindkey commands to create the key bindings.

       When the -R option is used as noted above, a valid  range  consists  of
       two  characters,	 with  an  optional  `-' between them.	All characters
       between the two specified, inclusive, are bound as specified.

       For either in-string or out-string, the following escape sequences  are
       recognised:

       \a     bell character
       \b     backspace
       \e, \E escape
       \f     form feed
       \n     linefeed (newline)
       \r     carriage return
       \t     horizontal tab
       \v     vertical tab
       \NNN   character code in octal
       \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
       \M[-]X character with meta bit set
       \C[-]X control character
       ^X     control character

       In  all	other  cases,  `\' escapes the following character.  Delete is
       written as `^?'.	 Note that `\M^?' and `^\M?' are  not  the  same,  and
       that  (unlike  emacs),  the bindings `\M-X' and `\eX' are entirely dis‐
       tinct, although they are initialized to the same bindings  by  `bindkey
       -m'.

       vared [ -Aache ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ]
	 [ -M main-keymap ] [ -m vicmd-keymap ]
	 [ -i init-widget ] [ -f finish-widget ]
	 [ -t tty ] name
	      The  value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit buffer,
	      and the line editor is invoked.  When the editor exits, name  is
	      set  to  the  string  value returned by the editor.  When the -c
	      flag is given, the parameter is created if  it  doesn't  already
	      exist.   The  -a	flag  may  be given with -c to create an array
	      parameter, or the -A flag to create an  associative  array.   If
	      the  type of an existing parameter does not match the type to be
	      created, the parameter is unset and recreated.

	      If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters
	      as  defined  in  $IFS  will be shown quoted with a backslash, as
	      will backslashes themselves.  Conversely, when the  edited  text
	      is  split	 into an array, a backslash quotes an immediately fol‐
	      lowing separator character or backslash; no other	 special  han‐
	      dling of backslashes, or any handling of quotes, is performed.

	      Individual  elements  of	existing  array	 or  associative array
	      parameters may be edited by using subscript syntax on name.  New
	      elements are created automatically, even without -c.

	      If  the  -p flag is given, the following string will be taken as
	      the prompt to display at the left.  If the -r flag is given, the
	      following	 string	 gives the prompt to display at the right.  If
	      the -h flag is specified, the history can be accessed from  ZLE.
	      If  the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an empty line
	      causes vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.

	      The -M option gives a keymap to link to the main	keymap	during
	      editing,	and  the -m option gives a keymap to link to the vicmd
	      keymap during editing.  For vi-style editing, this allows a pair
	      of  keymaps  to override viins and vicmd.	 For emacs-style edit‐
	      ing, only -M is normally needed but the -m option may  still  be
	      used.  On exit, the previous keymaps will be restored.

	      Vared  calls  the	 usual	`zle-line-init'	 and `zle-line-finish'
	      hooks before and after it takes control. Using  the  -i  and  -f
	      options,	it is possible to replace these with other custom wid‐
	      gets.

	      If `-t tty' is given, tty is the name of a terminal device to be
	      used  instead of the default /dev/tty.  If tty does not refer to
	      a terminal an error is reported.

       zle
       zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]
       zle -D widget ...
       zle -A old-widget new-widget
       zle -N widget [ function ]
       zle -C widget completion-widget function
       zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
       zle -M string
       zle -U string
       zle -K keymap
       zle -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
       zle -I
       zle -T [ tc function | -r tc | -L ]
       zle widget [ -n num ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
	      The zle builtin performs a number of different actions  concern‐
	      ing ZLE.

	      With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be
	      set.  It is zero if ZLE is currently active and widgets could be
	      invoked using this builtin command and non-zero otherwise.  Note
	      that even if non-zero status  is	returned,  zle	may  still  be
	      active  as  part	of  the completion system; this does not allow
	      direct calls to ZLE widgets.

	      Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:

	      -l [ -L | -a ]
		     List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the -L option
		     is	 used,	list in the form of zle commands to create the
		     widgets.

		     When combined with the -a option, all  widget  names  are
		     listed,  including	 the builtin ones. In this case the -L
		     option is ignored.

		     If at least one string is given, and -a is present or  -L
		     is	 not used, nothing will be printed.  The return status
		     will be zero if all strings are names of existing widgets
		     and  non-zero  if	at least one string is not a name of a
		     defined widget.  If -a is also present, all widget	 names
		     are  used	for  the comparison including builtin widgets,
		     else only user-defined widgets are used.

		     If at least one string is present and the	-L  option  is
		     used, user-defined widgets matching any string are listed
		     in the form of zle commands to create the widgets.

	      -D widget ...
		     Delete the named widgets.

	      -A old-widget new-widget
		     Make the new-widget name an alias for old-widget, so that
		     both  names  refer	 to  the  same widget.	The names have
		     equal standing; if either is deleted, the other  remains.
		     If there is already a widget with the new-widget name, it
		     is deleted.

	      -N widget [ function ]
		     Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a wid‐
		     get with the specified name, it is overwritten.  When the
		     new widget is invoked from within the editor, the	speci‐
		     fied  shell  function  is called.	If no function name is
		     specified, it defaults to the same name  as  the  widget.
		     For  further information, see the section Widgets in zsh‐
		     zle(1).

	      -C widget completion-widget function
		     Create a user-defined completion widget named widget. The
		     completion	 widget	 will behave like the built-in comple‐
		     tion-widget whose name is given as completion-widget.  To
		     generate  the  completions,  the  shell function function
		     will be called.  For further  information,	 see  zshcomp‐
		     wid(1).

	      -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
		     Redisplay	the  command  line;  this is to be called from
		     within a user-defined widget to allow changes  to	become
		     visible.	If  a  display-string  is given and not empty,
		     this is shown in the status line (immediately  below  the
		     line being edited).

		     If	 the  optional strings are given they are listed below
		     the prompt in  the	 same  way  as	completion  lists  are
		     printed.  If  no  strings	are given but the -c option is
		     used such a list is cleared.

		     Note that this option is only useful for widgets that  do
		     not  exit	immediately after using it because the strings
		     displayed will be erased immediately  after  return  from
		     the widget.

		     This  command  can	 safely be called outside user defined
		     widgets; if zle is active, the display will be refreshed,
		     while  if	zle  is not active, the command has no effect.
		     In this case there will usually be no other arguments.

		     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

	      -M string
		     As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below
		     the  command  line; unlike the -R option, the string will
		     not be put into the  status  line	but  will  instead  be
		     printed  normally	below the prompt.  This means that the
		     string will still be displayed after the  widget  returns
		     (until it is overwritten by subsequent commands).

	      -U string
		     This  pushes  the characters in the string onto the input
		     stack of ZLE.  After the widget currently	executed  fin‐
		     ishes  ZLE will behave as if the characters in the string
		     were typed by the user.

		     As ZLE uses a stack, if this option  is  used  repeatedly
		     the  last	string pushed onto the stack will be processed
		     first.  However, the characters in each  string  will  be
		     processed	in  the	 order	in  which  they	 appear in the
		     string.

	      -K keymap
		     Selects the keymap named keymap.  An error	 message  will
		     be displayed if there is no such keymap.

		     This  keymap selection affects the interpretation of fol‐
		     lowing keystrokes within this  invocation	of  ZLE.   Any
		     following	invocation  (e.g., the next command line) will
		     start as usual with the `main' keymap selected.

	      -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
		     Only available if your system supports one of the	`poll'
		     or `select' system calls; most modern systems do.

		     Installs handler (the name of a shell function) to handle
		     input from file descriptor fd.  When zle is attempting to
		     read data, it will examine both the terminal and the list
		     of handled fd's.  If data becomes available on a  handled
		     fd,  zle will call handler with the fd which is ready for
		     reading as the only argument.  If	the  handler  produces
		     output  to	 the  terminal, it should call `zle -I' before
		     doing so (see below).  The handler should not attempt  to
		     read  from	 the terminal.	Note that zle makes no attempt
		     to check  whether	this  fd  is  actually	readable  when
		     installing	 the  handler.	 The  user must make their own
		     arrangements for handling the file descriptor when zle is
		     not active.

		     If	 the option -w is also given, the handler is instead a
		     line editor widget, typically a shell function made  into
		     a	widget using zle -N.  In that case handler can use all
		     the facilities of zle to update the current editing line.
		     Note,  however,  that as handling fd takes place at a low
		     level changes  to	the  display  will  not	 automatically
		     appear; the widget should call zle -R to force redisplay.

		     Any  number  of  handlers for any number of readable file
		     descriptors may be installed.  Installing a  handler  for
		     an	 fd  which is already handled causes the existing han‐
		     dler to be replaced.

		     If no handler is given, but an fd is present, any handler
		     for  that fd is removed.  If there is none, an error mes‐
		     sage is printed and status 1 is returned.

		     If no arguments are given, or the -L option is  supplied,
		     a	list  of  handlers  is	printed in a form which can be
		     stored for later execution.

		     An fd (but not a handler) may optionally  be  given  with
		     the  -L  option; in this case, the function will list the
		     handler if any, else silently return status 1.

		     Note that this feature should be used with care.	Activ‐
		     ity  on one of the fd's which is not properly handled can
		     cause the terminal to become unusable.

		     Here is a simple example of using this feature.   A  con‐
		     nection  to  a  remote TCP port is created using the ztcp
		     command; see the description of the zsh/net/tcp module in
		     zshmodules(1).   Then a handler is installed which simply
		     prints out any data which	arrives	 on  this  connection.
		     Note that `select' will indicate that the file descriptor
		     needs handling if the remote side has closed the  connec‐
		     tion; we handle that by testing for a failed read.
			    if ztcp pwspc 2811; then
			      tcpfd=$REPLY
			      handler() {
				zle -I
				local line
				if ! read -r line <&$1; then
				  # select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
				  # so handle this specially.
				  print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
				  zle -F $1
				  return 1
				fi
				print -r - $line
			      }
			      zle -F $tcpfd handler
			    fi

	      -I     Unusually,	 this  option  is most useful outside ordinary
		     widget functions, though it may be used within if	normal
		     output  to	 the terminal is required.  It invalidates the
		     current zle display in preparation for output;  typically
		     this  will	 be from a trap function.  It has no effect if
		     zle is not active.	 When a trap exits, the	 shell	checks
		     to	 see if the display needs restoring, hence the follow‐
		     ing will print output in such a way as not to disturb the
		     line being edited:

			    TRAPUSR1() {
				# Invalidate zle display
			      [[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
				# Show output
			      print Hello
			    }

		     In	 general,  the	trap function may need to test whether
		     zle is active before using this method (as shown  in  the
		     example),	since  the  zsh/zle  module  may  not  even be
		     loaded; if it is not, the command can be skipped.

		     It is possible to call `zle -I' several times before con‐
		     trol  is returned to the editor; the display will only be
		     invalidated the first time to minimise disruption.

		     Note that there are normally better ways of  manipulating
		     the  display  from	 within zle widgets; see, for example,
		     `zle -R' above.

		     The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated,  even
		     though  this may have been by a previous call to `zle -I'
		     or by a system notification.  To test if a zle widget may
		     be	 called	 at  this point, execute zle with no arguments
		     and examine the return status.

	      -T     This is used to add, list or remove internal  transforma‐
		     tions on the processing performed by the line editor.  It
		     is typically used only for debugging or  testing  and  is
		     therefore of little interest to the general user.

		     `zle  -T  transformation  func'  specifies that the given
		     transformation (see below) is effected by shell  function
		     func.

		     `zle -Tr transformation' removes the given transformation
		     if it was present (it is not an error if none was).

		     `zle -TL' can be used to list  all	 transformations  cur‐
		     rently in operation.

		     Currently	the  only  transformation is tc.  This is used
		     instead of outputting  termcap  codes  to	the  terminal.
		     When  the	transformation is in operation the shell func‐
		     tion is passed the termcap code that would be  output  as
		     its  first	 argument; if the operation required a numeric
		     argument, that is passed as a second argument.  The func‐
		     tion  should  set	the shell variable REPLY to the trans‐
		     formed termcap code.  Typically this is used  to  produce
		     some  simply  formatted  version of the code and optional
		     argument for debugging or testing.	 Note that this trans‐
		     formation is not applied to other non-printing characters
		     such as carriage returns and newlines.

	      widget [ -n num ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
		     Invoke the specified widget.  This can only be done  when
		     ZLE   is	active;	  normally   this  will	 be  within  a
		     user-defined widget.

		     With the options -n and -N, the current  numerical	 argu‐
		     ment  will	 be  saved and then restored after the call to
		     widget; `-n num' sets the numerical argument  temporarily
		     to	 num,  while  `-N'  sets it to the default, i.e. as if
		     there were none.

		     With the option -K, keymap will be used  as  the  current
		     keymap  during the execution of the widget.  The previous
		     keymap will be restored when the widget exits.

		     Normally, calling a widget in this way does not  set  the
		     special  parameter WIDGET and related parameters, so that
		     the environment appears as if the top-level widget called
		     by	 the user were still active.  With the option -w, WID‐
		     GET and related parameters are set to reflect the	widget
		     being executed by the zle call.

		     Any  further arguments will be passed to the widget; note
		     that as standard argument handling is performed, any gen‐
		     eral  argument list should be preceded by --.  If it is a
		     shell function,  these  are  passed  down	as  positional
		     parameters; for builtin widgets it is up to the widget in
		     question what it does with them.  Currently arguments are
		     only handled by the incremental-search commands, the his‐
		     tory-search-forward and -backward and  the	 corresponding
		     functions prefixed by vi-, and by universal-argument.  No
		     error is flagged if the command does not  use  the	 argu‐
		     ments, or only uses some of them.

		     The  return status reflects the success or failure of the
		     operation carried out by  the  widget,  or	 if  it	 is  a
		     user-defined  widget the return status of the shell func‐
		     tion.

		     A non-zero return status causes the shell	to  beep  when
		     the  widget  exits,  unless the BEEP options was unset or
		     the widget was called via the zle	command.   Thus	 if  a
		     user defined widget requires an immediate beep, it should
		     call the beep widget directly.

WIDGETS
       All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'.  A	 widget's  job
       is  simply  to  perform	some  small action.  The ZLE commands that key
       sequences in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets.  Widgets can  be
       user-defined or built in.

       The  standard  widgets  built  into  ZLE are listed in Standard Widgets
       below.  Other built-in widgets can be defined  by  other	 modules  (see
       zshmodules(1)).	Each built-in widget has two names: its normal canoni‐
       cal name, and the same name preceded by a `.'.  The `.'	name  is  spe‐
       cial: it can't be rebound to a different widget.	 This makes the widget
       available even when its usual name has been redefined.

       User-defined widgets are defined using `zle  -N',  and  implemented  as
       shell  functions.  When the widget is executed, the corresponding shell
       function is executed, and can perform editing (or other)	 actions.   It
       is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names starting
       with `.'.

USER-DEFINED WIDGETS
       User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions, can execute
       any  normal  shell  command.   They can also run other widgets (whether
       built-in or user-defined) using the zle builtin command.	 The  standard
       input of the function is closed to prevent external commands from unin‐
       tentionally blocking ZLE by reading from the terminal, but read	-k  or
       read  -q can be used to read characters.	 Finally, they can examine and
       edit the ZLE buffer being edited by reading  and	 setting  the  special
       parameters described below.

       These  special parameters are always available in widget functions, but
       are not in any way special outside ZLE.	If they have some normal value
       outside	ZLE,  that  value is temporarily inaccessible, but will return
       when the widget function exits.	These special parameters in fact  have
       local scope, like parameters created in a function using local.

       Inside  completion  widgets and traps called while ZLE is active, these
       parameters are available read-only.

       BUFFER (scalar)
	      The entire contents of the edit buffer.  If it  is  written  to,
	      the  cursor remains at the same offset, unless that would put it
	      outside the buffer.

       BUFFERLINES (integer)
	      The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer  currently
	      displayed	 on  screen (i.e. without any changes to the preceding
	      parameters done after the last redisplay); read-only.

       CONTEXT (scalar)
	      The context in which zle was called to read a  line;  read-only.
	      One of the values:
       start  The start of a command line (at prompt PS1).

       cont   A continuation to a command line (at prompt PS2).

       select In a select loop.

       vared  Editing a variable in vared.

       CURSOR (integer)
	      The  offset  of  the cursor, within the edit buffer.  This is in
	      the  range  0  to	 $#BUFFER,  and	 is  by	 definition  equal  to
	      $#LBUFFER.   Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer will
	      result in the cursor being moved to the appropriate end  of  the
	      buffer.

       CUTBUFFER (scalar)
	      The  last item cut using one of the `kill-' commands; the string
	      which the next yank would insert in the line.  Later entries  in
	      the  kill ring are in the array killring.	 Note that the command
	      `zle copy-region-as-kill string' can be used to set the text  of
	      the  cut buffer from a shell function and cycle the kill ring in
	      the same way as interactively killing text.

       HISTNO (integer)
	      The current history number.  Setting this has the same effect as
	      moving  up  or  down in the history to the corresponding history
	      line.  An attempt to set it is ignored if the line is not stored
	      in  the  history.	  Note	this  is not the same as the parameter
	      HISTCMD, which always gives the number of the history line being
	      added  to	 the  main shell's history.  HISTNO refers to the line
	      being retrieved within zle.

       KEYMAP (scalar)
	      The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.

       KEYS (scalar)
	      The keys typed to invoke	this  widget,  as  a  literal  string;
	      read-only.

       killring (array)
	      The  array  of  previously  killed items, with the most recently
	      killed first.  This gives the items that would be retrieved by a
	      yank-pop	in  the	 same  order.	Note,  however,	 that the most
	      recently killed item is in $CUTBUFFER; $killring shows the array
	      of previous entries.

	      The  default size for the kill ring is eight, however the length
	      may be changed by normal array operations.  Any empty string  in
	      the kill ring is ignored by the yank-pop command, hence the size
	      of the array effectively sets the maximum	 length	 of  the  kill
	      ring,  while  the	 number	 of non-zero strings gives the current
	      length, both as seen by the user at the command line.

       LASTABORTEDSEARCH (scalar)
	      The last search string used by an interactive  search  that  was
	      aborted by the user (status 3 returned by the search widget).

       LASTSEARCH (scalar)
	      The last search string used by an interactive search; read-only.
	      This is set even if the search failed (status 0, 1 or 2 returned
	      by the search widget), but not if it was aborted by the user.

       LASTWIDGET (scalar)
	      The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.

       LBUFFER (scalar)
	      The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor posi‐
	      tion.  If it is assigned to, only that part  of  the  buffer  is
	      replaced,	 and  the  cursor remains between the new $LBUFFER and
	      the old $RBUFFER.

       MARK (integer)
	      Like CURSOR, but for the mark.

       NUMERIC (integer)
	      The numeric argument. If no numeric  argument  was  given,  this
	      parameter	 is  unset. When this is set inside a widget function,
	      builtin widgets called with the zle builtin command will use the
	      value assigned. If it is unset inside a widget function, builtin
	      widgets called behave as if no numeric argument was given.

       PENDING (integer)
	      The number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of	 bytes
	      which  have  already  been typed and can immediately be read. On
	      systems where the shell is not able  to  get  this  information,
	      this parameter will always have a value of zero.	Read-only.

       PREBUFFER (scalar)
	      In  a  multi-line	 input at the secondary prompt, this read-only
	      parameter contains the contents of the lines before the one  the
	      cursor is currently in.

       PREDISPLAY (scalar)
	      Text  to be displayed before the start of the editable text buf‐
	      fer.  This does not have to be a complete	 line;	to  display  a
	      complete	line, a newline must be appended explicitly.  The text
	      is reset on each new invocation (but not	recursive  invocation)
	      of zle.

       POSTDISPLAY (scalar)
	      Text  to be displayed after the end of the editable text buffer.
	      This does not have to be a complete line; to display a  complete
	      line, a newline must be prepended explicitly.  The text is reset
	      on each new invocation (but not recursive invocation) of zle.

       RBUFFER (scalar)
	      The part of the buffer that lies to  the	right  of  the	cursor
	      position.	 If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is
	      replaced, and the cursor remains between the  old	 $LBUFFER  and
	      the new $RBUFFER.

       REGION_ACTIVE (integer)
	      Indicates if the region is currently active.  It can be assigned
	      0 or 1 to deactivate and activate the region  respectively;  see
	      Character Highlighting below.

       region_highlight (array)
	      Each element of this array may be set to a string that describes
	      highlighting for an arbitrary region of the  command  line  that
	      will  take effect the next time the command line is redisplayed.
	      Highlighting of the non-editable parts of the  command  line  in
	      PREDISPLAY  and  POSTDISPLAY  are	 possible, but note that the P
	      flag is needed for character indexing to include PREDISPLAY.

	      Each string consists of the following parts:

	      Optionally, a `P' to signify that the start and end offset that
		     follow include any string set by the  PREDISPLAY  special
		     parameter; this is needed if the predisplay string itself
		     is to be highlighted.  Whitespace may follow the `P'.
	      A start offset in the same units as CURSOR, terminated by
		     whitespace.
	      An end offset in the same units as CURSOR, terminated by
		     whitespace.
	      A highlight specification in the same format as
		     used for contexts in  the	parameter  zle_highlight,  see
		     Character	Highlighting  below;  for example, standout or
		     fg=red,bold.

	      For example,

		     region_highlight=("P0 20 bold")

	      specifies that the first twenty characters of the text including
	      any predisplay string should be highlighted in bold.

	      Note that the effect of region_highlight is not saved and disap‐
	      pears as soon as the line is accepted.

       UNDO_CHANGE_NO (integer)
	      A number representing the state of the undo history.   The  only
	      use  of  this  is	 passing  as an argument to the undo widget in
	      order to undo back to the recorded point.	 Read-only.

       WIDGET (scalar)
	      The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.

       WIDGETFUNC (scalar)
	      The name of the shell function that implements a widget  defined
	      with  either  zle -N or zle -C.  In the former case, this is the
	      second argument to the zle -N command that defined  the  widget,
	      or  the  first argument if there was no second argument.	In the
	      latter case this is the third argument to	 the  zle  -C  command
	      that defined the widget.	Read-only.

       WIDGETSTYLE (scalar)
	      Describes	 the  implementation behind the completion widget cur‐
	      rently being executed; the second argument that followed zle  -C
	      when the widget was defined.  This is the name of a builtin com‐
	      pletion widget.  For widgets defined with zle -N this is set  to
	      the empty string.	 Read-only.

       ZLE_STATE (scalar)
	      Contains	a  set of space-separated words that describe the cur‐
	      rent zle state.

	      Currently, the states shown are the insert mode as  set  by  the
	      overwrite-mode  or  vi-replace  widgets and whether history com‐
	      mands  will  visit  imported  entries  as	 controlled   by   the
	      set-local-history widget.	 The string contains `insert' if char‐
	      acters to be inserted on the command line move existing  charac‐
	      ters  to	the  right or `overwrite' if characters to be inserted
	      overwrite existing characters.  It  contains  `localhistory'  if
	      only  local  history commands will be visited or `globalhistory'
	      if imported history commands will also be visited.

	      The substrings are sorted in alphabetical order so that  if  you
	      want  to test for two specific substrings in a future-proof way,
	      you can do match by doing:

		     if [[ $ZLE_STATE == *insert*globalhistory* ]]; then ...; fi

   Special Widgets
       There are a few user-defined widgets which are special  to  the	shell.
       If they do not exist, no special action is taken.  The environment pro‐
       vided is identical to that for any other editing widget.

       zle-isearch-exit
	      Executed at the end of incremental search at the point where the
	      isearch	 prompt	   is	removed	  from	 the   display.	   See
	      zle-isearch-update for an example.

       zle-isearch-update
	      Executed within incremental search when the display is about  to
	      be  redrawn.   Additional	 output	 below	the incremental search
	      prompt can be generated by using `zle  -M'  within  the  widget.
	      For example,

		     zle-isearch-update() { zle -M "Line $HISTNO"; }
		     zle -N zle-isearch-update

	      Note  the	 line  output  by `zle -M' is not deleted on exit from
	      incremental search.  This can be done  from  a  zle-isearch-exit
	      widget:

		     zle-isearch-exit() { zle -M ""; }
		     zle -N zle-isearch-exit

       zle-line-init
	      Executed	every  time  the  line editor is started to read a new
	      line of input.  The following example puts the line editor  into
	      vi command mode when it starts up.

		     zle-line-init() { zle -K vicmd; }
		     zle -N zle-line-init

	      (The command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is
	      equivalent to zle vi-cmd-mode.)

       zle-line-finish
	      This is similar to zle-line-init but is executed every time  the
	      line editor has finished reading a line of input.

       zle-history-line-set
	      Executed when the history line changes.

       zle-keymap-select
	      Executed every time the keymap changes, i.e. the special parame‐
	      ter KEYMAP is set to a different value, while the line editor is
	      active.	Initialising  the  keymap  when the line editor starts
	      does not cause the widget to be called.

	      The value $KEYMAP within the function reflects the  new  keymap.
	      The old keymap is passed as the sole argument.

	      This  can	 be used for detecting switches between the vi command
	      (vicmd) and insert (usually main) keymaps.

STANDARD WIDGETS
       The following is a list of all the standard widgets, and their  default
       bindings	 in  emacs  mode,  vi  command	mode  and  vi insert mode (the
       `emacs', `vicmd' and `viins' keymaps, respectively).

       Note that cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three  keymaps;
       the  shell assumes that the cursor keys send the key sequences reported
       by the  terminal-handling  library  (termcap  or	 terminfo).   The  key
       sequences  shown	 in  the  list are those based on the VT100, common on
       many modern terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound.  In
       the  case  of  the  viins  keymap,  the initial escape character of the
       sequences serves also to return to the vicmd keymap: whether this  hap‐
       pens is determined by the KEYTIMEOUT parameter, see zshparam(1).

   Movement
       vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)
	      Move  backward  one word, where a word is defined as a series of
	      non-blank characters.

       backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move backward one character.

       vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)
	      Move backward one character, without changing lines.

       backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       emacs-backward-word
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.

       beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the  beginning
	      of the line, move to the beginning of the previous line, if any.

       vi-beginning-of-line
	      Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.

       end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the line,
	      move to the end of the next line, if any.

       vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line.  If an argument is  given  to  this
	      command,	the cursor will be moved to the end of the line (argu‐
	      ment - 1) lines down.

       vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)
	      Move forward one word, where a word is defined as	 a  series  of
	      non-blank characters.

       vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)
	      Move  to	the  end of the current word, or, if at the end of the
	      current word, to the end of the  next  word,  where  a  word  is
	      defined as a series of non-blank characters.

       forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move forward one character.

       vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)
	      Move forward one character.

       vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)
	      Read  a character from the keyboard, and move to the next occur‐
	      rence of it in the line.

       vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)
	      Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to	 the  position
	      just before the next occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)
	      Read  a  character  from	the keyboard, and move to the previous
	      occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)
	      Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to	 the  position
	      just after the previous occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)
	      Move to the first non-blank character in the line.

       vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)
	      Move forward one word, vi-style.

       forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move  to the beginning of the next word.	The editor's idea of a
	      word is specified with the WORDCHARS parameter.

       emacs-forward-word
	      Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)
	      Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.

       vi-goto-mark (unbound) (`) (unbound)
	      Move to the specified mark.

       vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (') (unbound)
	      Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.

       vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi-find command.

       vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.

   History Control
       beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already  there,  move
	      to the first event in the history list.

       beginning-of-line-hist
	      Move  to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning
	      of the buffer, move to the previous history line.

       beginning-of-history
	      Move to the first event in the history list.

       down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)
	      Move down a line in the buffer, or  if  already  at  the	bottom
	      line, move to the next event in the history list.

       vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)
	      Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
	      line, move to the next event in the history list.	 Then move  to
	      the first non-blank character on the line.

       down-line-or-search
	      Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
	      line, search forward in the history for a	 line  beginning  with
	      the first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)
	      Move to the next event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-backward
	      Search  backward	in  the	 history for a line beginning with the
	      current line up to the cursor.  This leaves the  cursor  in  its
	      original position.

       end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move  to the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to the
	      last event in the history list.

       end-of-line-hist
	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the  buf‐
	      fer, move to the next history line.

       end-of-history
	      Move to the last event in the history list.

       vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)
	      Fetch  the history line specified by the numeric argument.  This
	      defaults to the current history line (i.e. the  one  that	 isn't
	      history yet).

       history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  backward	incrementally  for  a  specified  string.  The
	      search is case-insensitive if the search string  does  not  have
	      uppercase letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string
	      may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of  the
	      line.  When called from a user-defined function returns the fol‐
	      lowing statuses: 0, if the search succeeded; 1,  if  the	search
	      failed;  2,  if  the  search  term  was a bad pattern; 3, if the
	      search was aborted by the send-break command.

	      A restricted set	of  editing  functions	is  available  in  the
	      mini-buffer.   Keys are looked up in the special isearch keymap,
	      and if not found there in the main keymap (note that by  default
	      the  isearch  keymap is empty).  An interrupt signal, as defined
	      by the stty setting, will stop the search and  go	 back  to  the
	      original	line.	An  undefined  key  will have the same effect.
	      Note that the following always  perform  the  same  task	within
	      incremental searches and cannot be replaced by user defined wid‐
	      gets, nor can the set of functions be extended.	The  supported
	      functions are:

	      accept-and-hold
	      accept-and-infer-next-history
	      accept-line
	      accept-line-and-down-history
		     Perform  the  usual  function  after  exiting incremental
		     search.  The command line displayed is executed.

	      backward-delete-char
	      vi-backward-delete-char
		     Back up one place in the search history.  If  the	search
		     has been repeated this does not immediately erase a char‐
		     acter in the minibuffer.

	      accept-search
		     Exit incremental search, retaining the command  line  but
		     performing no further action.  Note that this function is
		     not bound by default and has no effect outside  incremen‐
		     tal search.

	      backward-delete-word
	      backward-kill-word
	      vi-backward-kill-word
		     Back  up  one  character  in  the minibuffer; if multiple
		     searches have been	 performed  since  the	character  was
		     inserted  the search history is rewound to the point just
		     before the character was entered.	 Hence	this  has  the
		     effect of repeating backward-delete-char.

	      clear-screen
		     Clear the screen, remaining in incremental search mode.

	      history-incremental-search-backward
		     Find the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buf‐
		     fer.

	      history-incremental-search-forward
		     Invert the sense of the search.

	      magic-space
		     Inserts a non-magical space.

	      quoted-insert
	      vi-quoted-insert
		     Quote the character to insert into the minibuffer.

	      redisplay
		     Redisplay the  command  line,  remaining  in  incremental
		     search mode.

	      vi-cmd-mode
		     Toggle between the `main' and `vicmd' keymaps; the `main'
		     keymap (insert mode) will be selected initially.

	      vi-repeat-search
	      vi-rev-repeat-search
		     Repeat the search.	 The direction of the search is	 indi‐
		     cated in the mini-buffer.

	      Any  character  that is not bound to one of the above functions,
	      or self-insert or self-insert-unmeta, will cause the mode to  be
	      exited.	The  character	is  then looked up and executed in the
	      keymap in effect at that point.

	      When called from a widget	 function  by  the  zle	 command,  the
	      incremental  search  commands  can take a string argument.  This
	      will be treated as a string of keys, as  for  arguments  to  the
	      bindkey command, and used as initial input for the command.  Any
	      characters in the string which are  unused  by  the  incremental
	      search will be silently ignored.	For example,

		     zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps

	      will  search  backwards for forceps, leaving the minibuffer con‐
	      taining the string `forceps'.

       history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search forward incrementally for a specified string.  The search
	      is case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase
	      letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string may begin
	      with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.  The
	      functions available in the mini-buffer are the same as for  his‐
	      tory-incremental-search-backward.

       history-incremental-pattern-search-backward
       history-incremental-pattern-search-forward
	      These widgets behave similarly to the corresponding widgets with
	      no -pattern, but the search string typed by the user is  treated
	      as  a  pattern,  respecting  the current settings of the various
	      options affecting pattern matching.  See FILENAME GENERATION  in
	      zshexpn(1)  for  a description of patterns.  If no numeric argu‐
	      ment was given lowercase letters in the search string may	 match
	      uppercase letters in the history.	 The string may begin with `^'
	      to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.

	      The prompt changes to indicate an invalid pattern; this may sim‐
	      ply indicate the pattern is not yet complete.

	      Note  that  only	non-overlapping	 matches  are  reported, so an
	      expression with wildcards may return fewer  matches  on  a  line
	      than are visible by inspection.

       history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  backward	in  the	 history for a line beginning with the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)
	      Search backward in the history  for  a  specified	 string.   The
	      string  may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning
	      of the line.

	      A restricted set	of  editing  functions	is  available  in  the
	      mini-buffer.   An	 interrupt signal, as defined by the stty set‐
	      ting,  will stop the search.  The	 functions  available  in  the
	      mini-buffer  are:	 accept-line,  backward-delete-char,  vi-back‐
	      ward-delete-char,	  backward-kill-word,	vi-backward-kill-word,
	      clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.

	      vi-cmd-mode  is treated the same as accept-line, and magic-space
	      is treated as a space.  Any other character that is not bound to
	      self-insert  or  self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. If
	      the function is called from vi command mode, the bindings of the
	      current insert mode will be used.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  forward  in  the	history	 for a line beginning with the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)
	      Search forward in the  history  for  a  specified	 string.   The
	      string  may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning
	      of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are  the
	      same  as	for  vi-history-search-backward.  Argument handling is
	      also the same as for that command.

       infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search in the history list for a line matching the  current  one
	      and fetch the event following it.

       insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the last word from the previous history event at the cur‐
	      sor position.  If a positive numeric argument is	given,	insert
	      that  word  from	the end of the previous history event.	If the
	      argument is zero or negative insert  that	 word  from  the  left
	      (zero  inserts  the previous command word).  Repeating this com‐
	      mand replaces the word just inserted with the last word from the
	      history  event prior to the one just used; numeric arguments can
	      be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.

	      When called from a shell function invoked	 from  a  user-defined
	      widget,  the command can take one to three arguments.  The first
	      argument specifies a history offset which applies to  successive
	      calls  to	 this  widget:	if  it is -1, the default behaviour is
	      used, while if it is 1,  successive  calls  will	move  forwards
	      through  the  history.  The value 0 can be used to indicate that
	      the history line examined by the previous execution of the  com‐
	      mand  will  be reexamined.  Note that negative numbers should be
	      preceded by  a  `--'  argument  to  avoid	 confusing  them  with
	      options.

	      If two arguments are given, the second specifies the word on the
	      command line in normal array index notation (as a	 more  natural
	      alternative to the prefix argument).  Hence 1 is the first word,
	      and -1 (the default) is the last word.

	      If a third argument is given, its value is ignored,  but	it  is
	      used  to signify that the history offset is relative to the cur‐
	      rent history line, rather than the one remembered after the pre‐
	      vious invocations of insert-last-word.

	      For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to

		     zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1

	      while the command

		     zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -

	      always  copies the first word of the line in the history immedi‐
	      ately before the line being edited.  This has  the  side	effect
	      that  later  invocations	of the widget will be relative to that
	      line.

       vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi history search.

       vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.

       up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)
	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already  at  the  top	 line,
	      move to the previous event in the history list.

       vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)
	      Move  up	a  line	 in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
	      move to the previous event in the history list.	Then  move  to
	      the first non-blank character on the line.

       up-line-or-search
	      Move  up	a  line	 in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
	      search backward in the history for a  line  beginning  with  the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)
	      Move to the previous event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-forward
	      Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the cur‐
	      rent line up to the cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its orig‐
	      inal position.

       set-local-history
	      By  default,  history movement commands visit the imported lines
	      as well as the local lines. This widget lets you toggle this  on
	      and  off,	 or  set  it  with the numeric argument. Zero for both
	      local and imported lines and nonzero for only local lines.

   Modifying Text
       vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)
	      Enter insert mode after the  current  cursor  position,  without
	      changing lines.

       backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Delete the character behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)
	      Delete  the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.
	      If in insert mode, this won't delete past the point where insert
	      mode was last entered.

       backward-delete-word
	      Delete the word behind the cursor.

       backward-kill-line
	      Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.

       backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the word behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)
	      Kill  the	 word  behind the cursor, without going past the point
	      where insert mode was last entered.

       capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Capitalize the current word and move past it.

       vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard,  and  kill  from  the
	      cursor  position	to  the	 endpoint of the movement.  Then enter
	      insert mode.  If the command is vi-change,  change  the  current
	      line.

       vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)
	      Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)
	      Kill the current line and enter insert mode.

       copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.

	      If   called  from	 a  ZLE	 widget	 function  in  the  form  `zle
	      copy-region-as-kill string' then string will  be	taken  as  the
	      text  to	copy to the kill buffer.  The cursor, the mark and the
	      text on the command line are not used in this case.

       copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.

       copy-prev-shell-word
	      Like copy-prev-word, but the word is found by using shell	 pars‐
	      ing,  whereas copy-prev-word looks for blanks. This makes a dif‐
	      ference when the word is quoted and contains spaces.

       vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard,  and  kill  from  the
	      cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.	If the command
	      is vi-delete, kill the current line.

       delete-char
	      Delete the character under the cursor.

       vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)
	      Delete the character under the cursor, without  going  past  the
	      end of the line.

       delete-word
	      Delete the current word.

       down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.

       kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the current word.

       gosmacs-transpose-chars
	      Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.

       vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)
	      Indent a number of lines.

       vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)
	      Enter insert mode.

       vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)
	      Move  to	the  first  non-blank  character on the line and enter
	      insert mode.

       vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)
	      Join the current line with the next one.

       kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.  If already on  the
	      end of the line, kill the newline character.

       vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)
	      Kill  from  the  cursor  back  to	 wherever insert mode was last
	      entered.

       vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)
	      Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.

       kill-region
	      Kill from the cursor to the mark.

       kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the entire buffer.

       kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the current line.

       vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)
	      Move to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches
	      the  one	under  the  cursor.  If the cursor is not on a bracket
	      character, move forward without going past the end of  the  line
	      to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.

       vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)
	      Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)
	      Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-oper-swap-case
	      Read  a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case of
	      all characters from the cursor position to the endpoint  of  the
	      movement.	  If  the  movement command is vi-oper-swap-case, swap
	      the case of all characters on the current line.

       overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.

       vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer before  the  cursor.   If
	      the  kill	 buffer	 contains  a  sequence of lines (as opposed to
	      characters), paste it above the current line.

       vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.	If the
	      kill  buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to charac‐
	      ters), paste it below the current line.

       quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the next character typed into the buffer  literally.   An
	      interrupt character will not be inserted.

       vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)
	      Display  a `^' at the cursor position, and insert the next char‐
	      acter typed into the buffer literally.  An  interrupt  character
	      will not be inserted.

       quote-line (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound)
	      Quote  the  current  line;  that	is, put a `'' character at the
	      beginning and the end, and convert all `'' characters to `'\'''.

       quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)
	      Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.

       vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)
	      Enter overwrite mode.

       vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi mode text modification.  If a count was  used
	      with the modification, it is remembered.	If a count is given to
	      this command, it overrides the remembered count, and  is	remem‐
	      bered  for future uses of this command.  The cut buffer specifi‐
	      cation is similarly remembered.

       vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)
	      Replace the character under the cursor  with  a  character  read
	      from the keyboard.

       self-insert  (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters and
       some control characters)
	      Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.

       self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert a character into the buffer after stripping the meta  bit
	      and converting ^M to ^J.

       vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)
	      Substitute the next character(s).

       vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)
	      Swap  the	 case  of the character under the cursor and move past
	      it.

       transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the two characters to the left of the cursor if at  end
	      of  line,	 else exchange the character under the cursor with the
	      character to the left.

       transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the current word with the one before it.

       vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)
	      Unindent a number of lines.

       up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.

       yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.

       yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Remove the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring	 (the  history
	      of  previously  killed  text)  and yank the new top.  Only works
	      following yank or yank-pop.

       vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy  the	region
	      from  the	 cursor	 position to the endpoint of the movement into
	      the kill buffer.	If the command is vi-yank,  copy  the  current
	      line.

       vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)
	      Copy the current line into the kill buffer.

       vi-yank-eol
	      Copy  the region from the cursor position to the end of the line
	      into the kill buffer.  Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi,
	      but it isn't what it actually does.

   Arguments
       digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)
	      Start  a	new  numeric argument, or add to the current one.  See
	      also vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line.  This only works if bound to
	      a key sequence ending in a decimal digit.

	      Inside  a	 widget	 function,  a call to this function treats the
	      last key of the key sequence which  called  the  widget  as  the
	      digit.

       neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Changes the sign of the following argument.

       universal-argument
	      Multiply	the argument of the next command by 4.	Alternatively,
	      if this command is followed by an	 integer  (positive  or	 nega‐
	      tive), use that as the argument for the next command.  Thus dig‐
	      its cannot be repeated using this command.  For example, if this
	      command occurs twice, followed immediately by forward-char, move
	      forward sixteen spaces; if instead it is followed	 by  -2,  then
	      forward-char, move backward two spaces.

	      Inside  a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `zle uni‐
	      versal-argument num', the numerical argument will be set to num;
	      this is equivalent to `NUMERIC=num'.

       argument-base
	      Use  the existing numeric argument as a numeric base, which must
	      be  in  the  range  2  to	 36  inclusive.	  Subsequent  use   of
	      digit-argument and universal-argument will input a new prefix in
	      the given base.  The usual hexadecimal convention is  used:  the
	      letter  a or A corresponds to 10, and so on.  Arguments in bases
	      requiring digits from 10 upwards	are  more  conveniently	 input
	      with  universal-argument, since ESC-a etc. are not usually bound
	      to digit-argument.

	      The function can be  used	 with  a  command  argument  inside  a
	      user-defined widget.  The following code sets the base to 16 and
	      lets the user input a hexadecimal argument until a  key  out  of
	      the digit range is typed:

		     zle argument-base 16
		     zle universal-argument

   Completion
       accept-and-menu-complete
	      In  a  menu  completion,	insert the current completion into the
	      buffer, and advance to the next possible completion.

       complete-word
	      Attempt completion on the current word.

       delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Delete the character under the cursor.  If the cursor is at  the
	      end of the line, list possible completions for the current word.

       expand-cmd-path
	      Expand the current command to its full pathname.

       expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)
	      Attempt  shell  expansion	 on  the current word.	If that fails,
	      attempt completion.

       expand-or-complete-prefix
	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.

       expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.

       expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word.

       list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)
	      List possible completions for the current word.

       list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)
	      List the expansion of the current word.

       magic-space
	      Perform history expansion and insert a space  into  the  buffer.
	      This is intended to be bound to space.

       menu-complete
	      Like  complete-word,  except  that menu completion is used.  See
	      the MENU_COMPLETE option.

       menu-expand-or-complete
	      Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.

       reverse-menu-complete
	      Perform menu completion, like menu-complete, except  that	 if  a
	      menu  completion	is  already  in progress, move to the previous
	      completion rather than the next.

       end-of-list
	      When a previous completion displayed a list  below  the  prompt,
	      this widget can be used to move the prompt below the list.

   Miscellaneous
       accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push  the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and execute
	      it.

       accept-and-infer-next-history
	      Execute the contents of the buffer.   Then  search  the  history
	      list for a line matching the current one and push the event fol‐
	      lowing onto the buffer stack.

       accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)
	      Finish editing the buffer.  Normally this causes the  buffer  to
	      be executed as a shell command.

       accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the
	      buffer stack.

       auto-suffix-remove
	      If the previous action added a suffix (space,  slash,  etc.)  to
	      the  word on the command line, remove it.	 Otherwise do nothing.
	      Removing the suffix ends any  active  menu  completion  or  menu
	      selection.

	      This  widget  is intended to be called from user-defined widgets
	      to enforce a desired suffix-removal behavior.

       auto-suffix-retain
	      If the previous action added a suffix (space,  slash,  etc.)  to
	      the  word on the command line, force it to be preserved.	Other‐
	      wise do nothing.	Retaining the suffix ends any active menu com‐
	      pletion or menu selection.

	      This  widget  is intended to be called from user-defined widgets
	      to enforce a desired suffix-preservation behavior.

       beep   Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.

       vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)
	      Enter command mode; that is, select the  `vicmd'	keymap.	  Yes,
	      this is bound by default in emacs mode.

       vi-caps-lock-panic
	      Hang  until  any lowercase key is pressed.  This is for vi users
	      without the mental capacity to keep track of their caps lock key
	      (like the author).

       clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)
	      Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.

       describe-key-briefly
	      Reads  a	key  sequence,	then prints the function bound to that
	      sequence.

       exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the cursor position (point) with the  position  of  the
	      mark.   Unless  a	 negative prefix argument is given, the region
	      between point and mark is activated so  that  it	can  be	 high‐
	      lighted.	 If  a	zero  prefix  argument is given, the region is
	      activated but point and mark are not swapped.

       execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (:) (unbound)
	      Read the name of an editor command and execute it.  A restricted
	      set  of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer.  Keys
	      are looked up in the special command keymap, and	if  not	 found
	      there  in	 the  main keymap.  An interrupt signal, as defined by
	      the stty setting, will abort the function.  Note that  the  fol‐
	      lowing   always	perform	  the	same   task  within  the  exe‐
	      cuted-named-cmd environment  and	cannot	be  replaced  by  user
	      defined  widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended.  The
	      allowed	functions    are:    backward-delete-char,    vi-back‐
	      ward-delete-char,	   clear-screen,   redisplay,	quoted-insert,
	      vi-quoted-insert,	  backward-kill-word,	vi-backward-kill-word,
	      kill-whole-line, vi-kill-line, backward-kill-line, list-choices,
	      delete-char-or-list, complete-word, accept-line,	expand-or-com‐
	      plete and expand-or-complete-prefix.

	      kill-region  kills the last word, and vi-cmd-mode is treated the
	      same as accept-line.  The space and tab characters, if not bound
	      to  one of these functions, will complete the name and then list
	      the possibilities if the AUTO_LIST option	 is  set.   Any	 other
	      character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta
	      will beep and be ignored.	 The bindings of  the  current	insert
	      mode will be used.

	      Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.

	      Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Pop  the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the cur‐
	      sor position.

       pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)
	      If there is no # character at the beginning of the  buffer,  add
	      one  to the beginning of each line.  If there is one, remove a #
	      from each line that has one.  In either case, accept the current
	      line.   The  INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for this to
	      have any usefulness.

       vi-pound-insert
	      If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line,
	      add  one.	 If there is one, remove it.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
	      option must be set for this to have any usefulness.

       push-input
	      Push the entire current  multiline  construct  onto  the	buffer
	      stack  and return to the top-level (PS1) prompt.	If the current
	      parser construct is only a single line,  this  is	 exactly  like
	      push-line.   Next	 time  the  editor starts up or is popped with
	      get-line, the construct will be popped off the top of the buffer
	      stack and loaded into the editing buffer.

       push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buf‐
	      fer.  Next time the editor starts up, the buffer will be	popped
	      off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing buf‐
	      fer.

       push-line-or-edit
	      At the top-level (PS1) prompt, equivalent to  push-line.	 At  a
	      secondary	 (PS2)	prompt, move the entire current multiline con‐
	      struct into the editor buffer.   The  latter  is	equivalent  to
	      push-input followed by get-line.

       read-command
	      Only  useful  from  a  user-defined widget.  A keystroke is read
	      just as in normal operation, but instead of  the	command	 being
	      executed	the  name  of  the  command  that would be executed is
	      stored in the shell parameter REPLY.  This can be	 used  as  the
	      argument	of  a  future zle command.  If the key sequence is not
	      bound, status 1 is returned; typically, however, REPLY is set to
	      undefined-key to indicate a useless key sequence.

       recursive-edit
	      Only  useful  from  a user-defined widget.  At this point in the
	      function, the editor regains control until one of	 the  standard
	      widgets  which  would  normally  cause zle to exit (typically an
	      accept-line caused by  hitting  the  return  key)	 is  executed.
	      Instead, control returns to the user-defined widget.  The status
	      returned is non-zero if the return was caused by an  error,  but
	      the  function  still  continues executing and hence may tidy up.
	      This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to alter the com‐
	      mand line or key bindings temporarily.

	      The following widget, caps-lock, serves as an example.
		     self-insert-ucase() {
		       LBUFFER+=${(U)KEYS[-1]}
		     }

		     integer stat

		     zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase
		     zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
		     zle -A accept-line caps-lock

		     zle recursive-edit
		     stat=$?

		     zle -A .self-insert self-insert
		     zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
		     zle -D save-caps-lock

		     (( stat )) && zle send-break

		     return $stat
	      This  causes  typed  letters  to	be  inserted capitalised until
	      either accept-line (i.e. typically the return key) is  typed  or
	      the  caps-lock  widget is invoked again; the later is handled by
	      saving the old definition of  caps-lock  as  save-caps-lock  and
	      then  rebinding  it  to  invoke accept-line.  Note that an error
	      from the recursive edit is detected as a non-zero return	status
	      and propagated by using the send-break widget.

       redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)
	      Redisplays the edit buffer.

       reset-prompt (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Force the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be
	      re-expanded, then redisplay  the	edit  buffer.	This  reflects
	      changes  both  to the prompt variables themselves and changes in
	      the expansion of the values (for example,	 changes  in  time  or
	      directory,  or  changes to the value of variables referred to by
	      the prompt).

	      Otherwise, the prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and
	      when the display as been interrupted by output from another part
	      of the shell (such as a job notification) which causes the  com‐
	      mand line to be reprinted.

       send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Abort  the  current editor function, e.g. execute-named-command,
	      or the editor itself, e.g. if you are in vared. Otherwise	 abort
	      the  parsing  of the current line; in this case the aborted line
	      is available in the shell variable ZLE_LINE_ABORTED.

       run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute  the  command
	      `run-help	 cmd',	where cmd is the current command.  run-help is
	      normally aliased to man.

       vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)
	      Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.  There are
	      35  buffers  that can be specified: the 26 `named' buffers "a to
	      "z and the nine `queued' buffers "1 to "9.   The	named  buffers
	      can also be specified as "A to "Z.

	      When a buffer is specified for a cut command, the text being cut
	      replaces the previous contents of the specified  buffer.	 If  a
	      named buffer is specified using a capital, the newly cut text is
	      appended to the buffer instead of overwriting it.

	      If no buffer is specified for a cut command, "1 is used, and the
	      contents of "1 to "8 are each shifted along one buffer; the con‐
	      tents of "9 is lost.

       vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)
	      Set the specified mark at the cursor position.

       set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Set the mark at the cursor position.  If called with a  negative
	      prefix  argument,	 do not set the mark but deactivate the region
	      so that it is no longer highlighted  (it	is  still  usable  for
	      other purposes).	Otherwise the region is marked as active.

       spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Attempt spelling correction on the current word.

       undefined-key
	      This  command  is executed when a key sequence that is not bound
	      to any command is typed.	By default it beeps.

       undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Incrementally undo the last text modification.  When called from
	      a	 user-defined  widget, takes an optional argument indicating a
	      previous	state  of  the	undo  history  as  returned   by   the
	      UNDO_CHANGE_NO  variable;	 modifications	are  undone until that
	      state is reached.

       redo   Incrementally redo undone text modifications.

       vi-undo-change (unbound) (u) (unbound)
	      Undo the last text modification.	If repeated, redo the  modifi‐
	      cation.

       what-cursor-position (^X=) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, dec‐
	      imal and hexadecimal number, the current cursor position	within
	      the buffer and the column of the cursor in the current line.

       where-is
	      Read  the name of an editor command and print the listing of key
	      sequences that invoke the specified command.  A  restricted  set
	      of  editing functions is available in the mini-buffer.  Keys are
	      looked up in the special command keymap, and if not found	 there
	      in the main keymap.

       which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push  the	 buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command
	      `which-command  cmd'.  where  cmd	 is   the   current   command.
	      which-command is normally aliased to whence.

       vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)
	      If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument,
	      continue the argument.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.

CHARACTER HIGHLIGHTING
       The line editor has the ability to highlight characters or  regions  of
       the  line  that	have a particular significance.	 This is controlled by
       the array parameter zle_highlight, if it has been set by the user.

       If the parameter contains the single entry  none	 all  highlighting  is
       turned off.  Note the parameter is still expected to be an array.

       Otherwise each entry of the array should consist of a word indicating a
       context for highlighting, then a colon, then a comma-separated list  of
       the types of highlighting to apply in that context.

       The contexts available for highlighting are the following:

       default
	      Any text within the command line not affected by any other high‐
	      lighting.	 Text outside the editable area of the command line is
	      not affected.

       isearch
	      When  one	 of  the incremental history search widgets is active,
	      the area of the command line matched by  the  search  string  or
	      pattern.

       region The  region  between the cursor (point) and the mark as set with
	      set-mark-command.	 The region  is	 only  highlighted  if	it  is
	      active,	 which	  is   the   case   if	 set-mark-command   or
	      exchange-point-and-mark has been called and  the	line  has  not
	      been  subsequently  modified.   The region can be deactivated by
	      calling set-mark-command with a  negative	 prefix	 argument,  or
	      reactivated  by calling exchange-point-and-mark with a zero pre‐
	      fix argument.  Note that whether or not the region is active has
	      no  effect  on  its  use	within	widgets,  it simply determines
	      whether it is highlighted.

       special
	      Individual characters that have no direct printable  representa‐
	      tion  but	 are  shown  in	 a  special manner by the line editor.
	      These characters are described below.

       suffix This context is used  in	completion  for	 characters  that  are
	      marked  as  suffixes that will be removed if the completion ends
	      at that point, the most obvious example being a slash (/)	 after
	      a directory name.	 Note that suffix removal is configurable; the
	      circumstances under which the suffix will be removed may	differ
	      for different completions.

       zle_highlight  may contain additional fields for controlling how termi‐
       nal sequences to change colours are output.  Each of the	 following  is
       followed	 by a colon and a string in the same form as for key bindings.
       This will not be necessary for the vast majority of  terminals  as  the
       defaults shown in parentheses are widely used.

       fg_start_code (\e[3)
	      The  start  of  the  escape  sequence for the foreground colour.
	      This is followed by an ASCII digit representing the colour.

       fg_default_code (9)
	      The number to use instead of the colour  to  reset  the  default
	      foreground colour.

       fg_end_code (m)
	      The end of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.

       bg_start_code (\e[4)
	      The  start  of  the  escape  sequence for the background colour.
	      This is followed by an ASCII digit representing the colour.

       bg_default_code (9)
	      The number to use instead of the colour  to  reset  the  default
	      background colour.

       bg_end_code (m)
	      The end of the escape sequence for the background colour.

       The  available  types of highlighting are the following.	 Note that not
       all types of highlighting are available on all terminals:

       none   No highlighting is applied to the given context.	It is not use‐
	      ful  for	this to appear with other types of highlighting; it is
	      used to override a default.

       fg=colour
	      The foreground colour should be set to colour, a decimal integer
	      or the name of one of the eight most widely-supported colours.

	      Not  all	terminals  support this and, of those that do, not all
	      provide facilities to test the support, hence  the  user	should
	      decide  based  on the terminal type.  Most terminals support the
	      colours black, red,  green,  yellow,  blue,  magenta,  cyan  and
	      white,  which  can  be set by name.  In addition. default may be
	      used to set the terminal's default foreground colour.  Abbrevia‐
	      tions  are  allowed;  b or bl selects black.  Some terminals may
	      generate additional  colours  if	the  bold  attribute  is  also
	      present.

	      On  recent  terminals and on systems with an up-to-date terminal
	      database the number of colours supported may be  tested  by  the
	      command  `echotc	Co'; if this succeeds, it indicates a limit on
	      the number of colours which will be enforced by the line editor.
	      The  number  of  colours is in any case limited to 256 (i.e. the
	      range 0 to 255).

	      Colour is also known as color.

       bg=colour
	      The background colour should be set to colour.  This works simi‐
	      larly  to	 the  foreground  colour, except the background is not
	      usually affected by the bold attribute.

       bold   The characters in the given context are shown in	a  bold	 font.
	      Not all terminals distinguish bold fonts.

       standout
	      The  characters in the given context are shown in the terminal's
	      standout mode.  The actual effect is specific to	the  terminal;
	      on  many terminals it is inverse video.  On some such terminals,
	      where the cursor does not blink it appears  with	standout  mode
	      negated, making it less than clear where the cursor actually is.
	      On such terminals one of the other effects may be preferable for
	      highlighting the region and matched search string.

       underline
	      The  characters in the given context are shown underlined.  Some
	      terminals show the foreground in a different colour instead;  in
	      this case whitespace will not be highlighted.

       The  characters	described above as `special' are as follows.  The for‐
       matting described here is used irrespective of whether  the  characters
       are highlighted:

       ASCII control characters
	      Control  characters in the ASCII range are shown as `^' followed
	      by the base character.

       Unprintable multibyte characters
	      This item applies to control characters not in the ASCII	range,
	      plus other characters as follows.	 If the MULTIBYTE option is in
	      effect, multibyte characters not in the ASCII character set that
	      are reported as having zero width are treated as combining char‐
	      acters when the option COMBINING_CHARS is on.  If the option  is
	      off,  or	if  a character appears where a combining character is
	      not valid, the character is treated as unprintable.

	      Unprintable multibyte characters are shown as a hexadecimal num‐
	      ber between angle brackets.  The number is the code point of the
	      character in the wide character set; this may or may not be Uni‐
	      code, depending on the operating system.

       Invalid multibyte characters
	      If  the  MULTIBYTE  option  is in effect, any sequence of one or
	      more bytes that does not form a valid character in  the  current
	      character	 set  is  treated as a series of bytes each shown as a
	      special character.  This case can be  distinguished  from	 other
	      unprintable characters as the bytes are represented as two hexa‐
	      decimal digits between angle brackets, as distinct from the four
	      or  eight	 digits	 that are used for unprintable characters that
	      are nonetheless valid in the current character set.

	      Not all systems support this: for it to work, the system's  rep‐
	      resentation of wide characters must be code values from the Uni‐
	      versal Character Set, as defined by IS0  10646  (also  known  as
	      Unicode).

       Wrapped double-width characters
	      When  a  double-width character appears in the final column of a
	      line, it is instead shown on the next line. The empty space left
	      in the original position is highlighted as a special character.

       If  zle_highlight  is  not set or no value applies to a particular con‐
       text, the defaults applied are equivalent to

	      zle_highlight=(region:standout special:standout
	      suffix:bold isearch:underline)

       i.e. both the region and special characters are shown in standout mode.

       Within widgets, arbitrary regions may be	 highlighted  by  setting  the
       special array parameter region_highlight; see above.

ZSHCOMPWID(1)							 ZSHCOMPWID(1)

NAME
       zshcompwid - zsh completion widgets

DESCRIPTION
       The shell's programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in two
       ways; here the low-level features supporting the newer,	function-based
       mechanism  are  defined.	  A  complete  set of shell functions based on
       these features is described in zshcompsys(1), and users with no	inter‐
       est in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing their own -- see
       dictionary entry for `hubris') should skip the  current	section.   The
       older  system based on the compctl builtin command is described in zsh‐
       compctl(1).

       Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin com‐
       mand provided by the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)). For example,

	      zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer

       defines	a widget named `complete'.  The second argument is the name of
       any of the builtin  widgets  that  handle  completions:	complete-word,
       expand-or-complete,	expand-or-complete-prefix,	menu-complete,
       menu-expand-or-complete,	  reverse-menu-complete,   list-choices,    or
       delete-char-or-list.  Note that this will still work even if the widget
       in question has been re-bound.

       When this newly defined widget is bound to  a  key  using  the  bindkey
       builtin	command	 defined in the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)), typing
       that key will call the shell function  `completer'.  This  function  is
       responsible  for	 generating  the  possible  matches using the builtins
       described below.	 As with other ZLE widgets,  the  function  is	called
       with its standard input closed.

       Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control again
       and treats the matches in the same manner as the specified builtin wid‐
       get, in this case expand-or-complete.

COMPLETION SPECIAL PARAMETERS
       The  parameters	ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS and ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS are
       used by the completion mechanism, but are not special.  See  Parameters
       Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

       Inside  completion  widgets,  and  any functions called from them, some
       parameters have special meaning; outside these functions they  are  not
       special	to  the	 shell	in any way.  These parameters are used to pass
       information between the completion code and the completion widget. Some
       of  the builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the cur‐
       rent values of these parameters.	 Any existing values  will  be	hidden
       during  execution  of  completion  widgets;  except  for compstate, the
       parameters are reset on each function exit (including  nested  function
       calls  from  within  the completion widget) to the values they had when
       the function was entered.

       CURRENT
	      This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor
	      is  currently  on	 in  the words array.  Note that this value is
	      only correct if the ksharrays option is not set.

       IPREFIX
	      Initially this will be set to the empty string.  This  parameter
	      functions	 like  PREFIX; it contains a string which precedes the
	      one in PREFIX and is not considered part of the list of matches.
	      Typically,  a string is transferred from the beginning of PREFIX
	      to the end of IPREFIX, for example:

		     IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
		     PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}

	      causes the part of the prefix up	to  and	 including  the	 first
	      equal  sign not to be treated as part of a matched string.  This
	      can be done automatically by the compset builtin, see below.

       ISUFFIX
	      As IPREFIX, but for a suffix that should not be considered  part
	      of  the matches; note that the ISUFFIX string follows the SUFFIX
	      string.

       PREFIX Initially this will be set to the part of the current word  from
	      the  beginning  of the word up to the position of the cursor; it
	      may be altered to give a common prefix for all matches.

       QIPREFIX
	      This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up to
	      the  word	 being	completed.  E.g.  when completing `"foo', this
	      parameter contains the double quote. If the -q option of compset
	      is used (see below), and the original string was `"foo bar' with
	      the cursor on the `bar', this parameter contains `"foo '.

       QISUFFIX
	      Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.

       SUFFIX Initially this will be set to the part of the current word  from
	      the cursor position to the end; it may be altered to give a com‐
	      mon suffix for all matches.  It is most useful when  the	option
	      COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on the com‐
	      mand line is treated as a prefix.

       compstate
	      This is an associative array with various keys and  values  that
	      the  completion  code uses to exchange information with the com‐
	      pletion widget.  The keys are:

	      all_quotes
		     The -q option of the compset builtin command (see	below)
		     allows  a quoted string to be broken into separate words;
		     if the cursor is on one of those words, that word will be
		     completed,	 possibly  invoking  `compset -q' recursively.
		     With this key it is possible to test the types of	quoted
		     strings  which  are  currently  broken into parts in this
		     fashion.  Its value contains one character for each quot‐
		     ing level.	 The characters are a single quote or a double
		     quote for strings quoted with these characters, a dollars
		     sign  for	strings quoted with $'...' and a backslash for
		     strings not starting with a quote character.   The	 first
		     character	in  the value always corresponds to the inner‐
		     most quoting level.

	      context
		     This will be set by the completion code  to  the  overall
		     context in which completion is attempted. Possible values
		     are:

		     array_value
			    when completing  inside  the  value	 of  an	 array
			    parameter assignment; in this case the words array
			    contains the words inside the parentheses.

		     brace_parameter
			    when completing the	 name  of  a  parameter	 in  a
			    parameter  expansion beginning with ${.  This con‐
			    text will also be set  when	 completing  parameter
			    flags  following  ${(; the full command line argu‐
			    ment is presented and the handler  must  test  the
			    value  to  be  completed to ascertain that this is
			    the case.

		     assign_parameter
			    when completing the	 name  of  a  parameter	 in  a
			    parameter assignment.

		     command
			    when  completing  for  a normal command (either in
			    command position or for an argument	 of  the  com‐
			    mand).

		     condition
			    when  completing  inside  a	 `[[...]]' conditional
			    expression; in this case the words array  contains
			    only the words inside the conditional expression.

		     math   when completing in a mathematical environment such
			    as a `((...))' construct.

		     parameter
			    when completing the	 name  of  a  parameter	 in  a
			    parameter expansion beginning with $ but not ${.

		     redirect
			    when completing after a redirection operator.

		     subscript
			    when completing inside a parameter subscript.

		     value  when  completing  the value of a parameter assign‐
			    ment.

	      exact  Controls the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is  set.
		     It	 will  be  set	to  accept  if an exact match would be
		     accepted, and will be unset otherwise.

		     If it was set when at least one match equal to the string
		     on the line was generated, the match is accepted.

	      exact_string
		     The  string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise
		     unset.

	      ignored
		     The number	 of  words  that  were	ignored	 because  they
		     matched  one  of the patterns given with the -F option to
		     the compadd builtin command.

	      insert This controls the manner in which	a  match  is  inserted
		     into  the command line.  On entry to the widget function,
		     if it is unset the command line is not to be changed;  if
		     set  to  unambiguous, any prefix common to all matches is
		     to be inserted; if set to automenu-unambiguous, the  com‐
		     mon  prefix  is to be inserted and the next invocation of
		     the completion code may start menu completion (due to the
		     AUTO_MENU	option	being set); if set to menu or automenu
		     menu completion will be started for the matches currently
		     generated	(in  the  latter case this will happen because
		     the AUTO_MENU is set). The value  may  also  contain  the
		     string  `tab' when the completion code would normally not
		     really do completion, but only insert the TAB character.

		     On exit it may be set to any of the values	 above	(where
		     setting  it  to the empty string is the same as unsetting
		     it), or to a number, in which case the match whose number
		     is	 given	will be inserted into the command line.	 Nega‐
		     tive numbers count backward from  the  last  match	 (with
		     `-1'  selecting  the  last match) and out-of-range values
		     are wrapped around, so that a value of zero  selects  the
		     last  match and a value one more than the maximum selects
		     the first. Unless the value of this key ends in a	space,
		     the match is inserted as in a menu completion, i.e. with‐
		     out automatically appending a space.

		     Both menu and automenu may also specify the number of the
		     match  to	insert,	 given	after  a  colon.  For example,
		     `menu:2' says to start menu  completion,  beginning  with
		     the second match.

		     Note  that	 a  value containing the substring `tab' makes
		     the matches generated be ignored  and  only  the  TAB  be
		     inserted.

		     Finally,  it  may	also  be  set  to all, which makes all
		     matches generated be inserted into the line.

	      insert_positions
		     When the completion system inserts an unambiguous	string
		     into the line, there may be multiple places where charac‐
		     ters are missing or where the character inserted  differs
		     from  at least one match.	The value of this key contains
		     a colon separated list of all these positions, as indexes
		     into the command line.

	      last_prompt
		     If	 this  is  set	to  a non-empty string for every match
		     added, the completion code will move the cursor  back  to
		     the  previous  prompt  after  the list of completions has
		     been displayed.  Initially this is set or unset according
		     to the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

	      list   This  controls whether or how the list of matches will be
		     displayed.	 If it is unset or empty they  will  never  be
		     listed;  if  its value begins with list, they will always
		     be listed; if it begins with autolist or ambiguous,  they
		     will  be  listed  when  the  AUTO_LIST  or LIST_AMBIGUOUS
		     options respectively would normally cause them to be.

		     If the substring force appears in the value,  this	 makes
		     the  list	be shown even if there is only one match. Nor‐
		     mally, the list would be shown only if there are at least
		     two matches.

		     The   value   contains   the   substring  packed  if  the
		     LIST_PACKED option is set. If this substring is given for
		     all  matches  added  to a group, this group will show the
		     LIST_PACKED  behavior.  The  same	 is   done   for   the
		     LIST_ROWS_FIRST option with the substring rows.

		     Finally,  if  the value contains the string explanations,
		     only the explanation strings, if any, will be listed  and
		     if	 it  contains  messages, only the messages (added with
		     the -x option of compadd) will be listed.	If it contains
		     both  explanations and messages both kinds of explanation
		     strings will be listed.  It will be set appropriately  on
		     entry to a completion widget and may be changed there.

	      list_lines
		     This gives the number of lines that are needed to display
		     the full list of completions.  Note that to calculate the
		     total number of lines to display you need to add the num‐
		     ber of lines needed for the command line to  this	value,
		     this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special
		     parameter.

	      list_max
		     Initially this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parame‐
		     ter.   It	may be set to any other value; when the widget
		     exits this value will be used in  the  same  way  as  the
		     value of LISTMAX.

	      nmatches
		     The  number of matches generated and accepted by the com‐
		     pletion code so far.

	      old_insert
		     On entry to the widget this will be set to the number  of
		     the match of an old list of completions that is currently
		     inserted into the command line.  If  no  match  has  been
		     inserted, this is unset.

		     As with old_list, the value of this key will only be used
		     if it is the string keep. If it was set to this value  by
		     the  widget  and there was an old match inserted into the
		     command line, this match will be kept and if the value of
		     the  insert  key  specifies  that another match should be
		     inserted, this will be inserted after the old one.

	      old_list
		     This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of com‐
		     pletions  from a previous completion at the time the wid‐
		     get is invoked.  This will usually be  the	 case  if  and
		     only  if  the previous editing operation was a completion
		     widget or one of the builtin  completion  functions.   If
		     there  is	a valid list and it is also currently shown on
		     the screen, the value of this key is shown.

		     After the widget has exited the value of this key is only
		     used  if it was set to keep.  In this case the completion
		     code will continue to use this old list.  If  the	widget
		     generated new matches, they will not be used.

	      parameter
		     The  name of the parameter when completing in a subscript
		     or in the value of a parameter assignment.

	      pattern_insert
		     Normally this is set to menu, which specifies  that  menu
		     completion	 will  be  used	 whenever a set of matches was
		     generated using pattern matching.	If it is  set  to  any
		     other non-empty string by the user and menu completion is
		     not selected by other  option  settings,  the  code  will
		     instead  insert  any  common  prefix  for	the  generated
		     matches as with normal completion.

	      pattern_match
		     Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE
		     option.   Initially  it  is set to `*' if and only if the
		     option is set.  The completion widget may set it to  this
		     value,  to	 an empty string (which has the same effect as
		     unsetting it), or to any other non-empty string.	If  it
		     is non-empty, unquoted metacharacters on the command line
		     will be treated as patterns; if it is `*', then addition‐
		     ally a wildcard `*' is assumed at the cursor position; if
		     it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated lit‐
		     erally.

		     Note that the matcher specifications given to the compadd
		     builtin command  are  not	used  if  this	is  set	 to  a
		     non-empty string.

	      quote  When  completing  inside quotes, this contains the quota‐
		     tion character (i.e. either  a  single  quote,  a	double
		     quote, or a backtick).  Otherwise it is unset.

	      quoting
		     When  completing inside single quotes, this is set to the
		     string single; inside double quotes, the  string  double;
		     inside  backticks,	 the string backtick.  Otherwise it is
		     unset.

	      redirect
		     The redirection operator when completing in a redirection
		     position, i.e. one of <, >, etc.

	      restore
		     This  is  set to auto before a function is entered, which
		     forces the special	 parameters  mentioned	above  (words,
		     CURRENT,  PREFIX,	IPREFIX,  SUFFIX,  and	ISUFFIX) to be
		     restored to  their	 previous  values  when	 the  function
		     exits.    If a function unsets it or sets it to any other
		     string, they will not be restored.

	      to_end Specifies the occasions on which the cursor is  moved  to
		     the  end  of a string when a match is inserted.  On entry
		     to a widget function, it may be single if this will  hap‐
		     pen when a single unambiguous match was inserted or match
		     if it will happen any time a match is inserted (for exam‐
		     ple,  by menu completion; this is likely to be the effect
		     of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).

		     On exit, it may be set to single as above.	 It  may  also
		     be	 set  to  always,  or to the empty string or unset; in
		     those cases the cursor will be moved to the  end  of  the
		     string always or never respectively.  Any other string is
		     treated as match.

	      unambiguous
		     This key is read-only and will always be set to the  com‐
		     mon  (unambiguous)	 prefix the completion code has gener‐
		     ated for all matches added so far.

	      unambiguous_cursor
		     This gives the position the cursor would be placed at  if
		     the  common  prefix in the unambiguous key were inserted,
		     relative to the value of that key. The  cursor  would  be
		     placed  before the character whose index is given by this
		     key.

	      unambiguous_positions
		     This contains all positions where characters in the unam‐
		     biguous   string  are  missing  or	 where	the  character
		     inserted differs from at least one of the	matches.   The
		     positions	are  given as indexes into the string given by
		     the value of the unambiguous key.

	      vared  If completion is called while editing a  line  using  the
		     vared  builtin,  the value of this key is set to the name
		     of the parameter given as an argument to vared.  This key
		     is only set while a vared command is active.

       words  This  array  contains the words present on the command line cur‐
	      rently being edited.

COMPLETION BUILTIN COMMANDS
       compadd [ -akqQfenUld12C ] [ -F array ]
       [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]
       [ -i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]
       [ -J name ] [ -V name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]
       [ -r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]
       [ -D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]
       [ -E number ]
       [ -M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ words ... ]

	      This builtin command can be used to  add	matches	 directly  and
	      control all the information the completion code stores with each
	      possible match. The return status is zero if at least one	 match
	      was added and non-zero if no matches were added.

	      The  completion  code  breaks  the string to complete into seven
	      fields in the order:

		     <ipre><apre><hpre><word><hsuf><asuf><isuf>

	      The first field is an ignored  prefix  taken  from  the  command
	      line,  the  contents  of	the  IPREFIX parameter plus the string
	      given with the -i option. With the -U option,  only  the	string
	      from the -i option is used. The field <apre> is an optional pre‐
	      fix string given with the -P option.   The  <hpre>  field	 is  a
	      string  that is considered part of the match but that should not
	      be shown when listing completions, given with the -p option; for
	      example,	functions  that do filename generation might specify a
	      common path prefix this way.  <word> is the part	of  the	 match
	      that  should  appear in the list of completions, i.e. one of the
	      words given at the end of the compadd command line. The suffixes
	      <hsuf>,  <asuf>  and  <isuf>  correspond to the prefixes <hpre>,
	      <apre> and <ipre> and are given by the options -s,  -S  and  -I,
	      respectively.

	      The supported flags are:

	      -P prefix
		     This  gives  a  string  to	 be  inserted before the given
		     words.  The string given is not considered as part of the
		     match  and	 any  shell  metacharacters  in it will not be
		     quoted when the string is inserted.

	      -S suffix
		     Like -P, but gives a string  to  be  inserted  after  the
		     match.

	      -p hidden-prefix
		     This gives a string that should be inserted into the com‐
		     mand line before the match but that should not appear  in
		     the  list of matches. Unless the -U option is given, this
		     string must be matched as part of the string on the  com‐
		     mand line.

	      -s hidden-suffix
		     Like `-p', but gives a string to insert after the match.

	      -i ignored-prefix
		     This  gives a string to insert into the command line just
		     before any string given with the  `-P'  option.   Without
		     `-P'  the string is inserted before the string given with
		     `-p' or directly before the match.

	      -I ignored-suffix
		     Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.

	      -a     With this flag the words are taken as names of arrays and
		     the possible matches are their values.  If only some ele‐
		     ments of the arrays are needed, the words may  also  con‐
		     tain subscripts, as in `foo[2,-1]'.

	      -k     With  this	 flag the words are taken as names of associa‐
		     tive arrays and the possible matches are their keys.   As
		     for  -a,  the  words  may	also contain subscripts, as in
		     `foo[(R)*bar*]'.

	      -d array
		     This adds per-match display  strings.  The	 array	should
		     contain  one  element per word given. The completion code
		     will then display the first element instead of the	 first
		     word, and so on. The array may be given as the name of an
		     array parameter or directly as a space-separated list  of
		     words in parentheses.

		     If	 there are fewer display strings than words, the left‐
		     over words will be displayed unchanged and if  there  are
		     more  display  strings  than  words, the leftover display
		     strings will be silently ignored.

	      -l     This option only has an effect if used together with  the
		     -d option. If it is given, the display strings are listed
		     one per line, not arrayed in columns.

	      -o     This option only has an effect if used together with  the
		     -d	 option.   If  it is given, the order of the output is
		     determined by the match strings;  otherwise it is	deter‐
		     mined  by	the display strings (i.e. the strings given by
		     the -d option).

	      -J name
		     Gives the name of the group of matches the	 words	should
		     be stored in.

	      -V name
		     Like -J but naming an unsorted group. These are in a dif‐
		     ferent name space than groups created with the -J flag.

	      -1     If given together with the -V option, makes only consecu‐
		     tive duplicates in the group be removed. If combined with
		     the -J option, this has  no  visible  effect.  Note  that
		     groups  with  and without this flag are in different name
		     spaces.

	      -2     If given together with the -J or  -V  option,  makes  all
		     duplicates	 be  kept. Again, groups with and without this
		     flag are in different name spaces.

	      -X explanation
		     The explanation string will be printed with the  list  of
		     matches, above the group currently selected.

	      -x message
		     Like  -X,	but  the message will be printed even if there
		     are no matches in the group.

	      -q     The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if
		     the  next	character  typed is a blank or does not insert
		     anything, or if the suffix consists of only one character
		     and the next character typed is the same character.

	      -r remove-chars
		     This is a more versatile form of the -q option.  The suf‐
		     fix given with -S or the slash automatically added	 after
		     completing	 directories  will be automatically removed if
		     the next character typed inserts one  of  the  characters
		     given  in	the  remove-chars.  This string is parsed as a
		     characters class and understands the backslash  sequences
		     used  by  the  print  command.  For example, `-r "a-z\t"'
		     removes the suffix if the next character typed inserts  a
		     lower  case  character  or a TAB, and `-r "^0-9"' removes
		     the suffix if the next character typed  inserts  anything
		     but  a  digit. One extra backslash sequence is understood
		     in this string:  `\-'  stands  for	 all  characters  that
		     insert  nothing.  Thus `-S "=" -q' is the same as `-S "="
		     -r "= \t\n\-"'.

		     This option may also be used without the -S option;  then
		     any automatically added space will be removed when one of
		     the characters in the list is typed.

	      -R remove-func
		     This is another form of the -r option. When a suffix  has
		     been  inserted  and the completion accepted, the function
		     remove-func will  be  called  after  the  next  character
		     typed.  It is passed the length of the suffix as an argu‐
		     ment and can use  the  special  parameters	 available  in
		     ordinary  (non-completion) zle widgets (see zshzle(1)) to
		     analyse and modify the command line.

	      -f     If this flag is given, all	 of  the  matches  built  from
		     words  are	 marked as being the names of files.  They are
		     not required to be actual filenames, but if they are, and
		     the  option  LIST_TYPES is set, the characters describing
		     the types of the files in the completion  lists  will  be
		     shown. This also forces a slash to be added when the name
		     of a directory is completed.

	      -e     This flag can be used to tell the	completion  code  that
		     the  matches  added  are  parameter names for a parameter
		     expansion.	 This  will  make  the	AUTO_PARAM_SLASH   and
		     AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be used for the matches.

	      -W file-prefix
		     This  string is a pathname that will be prepended to each
		     of the matches formed by the given	 words	together  with
		     any  prefix specified by the -p option to form a complete
		     filename for testing.  Hence it is only  useful  if  com‐
		     bined  with  the -f flag, as the tests will not otherwise
		     be performed.

	      -F array
		     Specifies an array containing  patterns.  Words  matching
		     one of these patterns are ignored, i.e. not considered to
		     be possible matches.

		     The array may be the name of an array parameter or a list
		     of	 literal  patterns enclosed in parentheses and quoted,
		     as in `-F "(*?.o *?.h)"'. If the  name  of	 an  array  is
		     given,  the  elements  of the array are taken as the pat‐
		     terns.

	      -Q     This flag instructs the completion code not to quote  any
		     metacharacters  in the words when inserting them into the
		     command line.

	      -M match-spec
		     This gives local match specifications as described	 below
		     in the section `Completion Matching Control'. This option
		     may  be  given  more  than	 once.	 In  this   case   all
		     match-specs  given	 are  concatenated with spaces between
		     them to form the specification string to use.  Note  that
		     they will only be used if the -U option is not given.

	      -n     Specifies that the words added are to be used as possible
		     matches, but are not to appear in the completion listing.

	      -U     If this flag is given, all words given will  be  accepted
		     and no matching will be done by the completion code. Nor‐
		     mally this is used in  functions  that  do	 the  matching
		     themselves.

	      -O array
		     If	 this  option is given, the words are not added to the
		     set of possible completions.  Instead, matching  is  done
		     as	 usual	and  all  of the words given as arguments that
		     match the string on the command line will	be  stored  in
		     the array parameter whose name is given as array.

	      -A array
		     As	 the  -O  option,  except that instead of those of the
		     words which match being stored in array, the strings gen‐
		     erated  internally by the completion code are stored. For
		     example, with a matching specification of `-M  "L:|no="',
		     the string `nof' on the command line and the string `foo'
		     as one of	the  words,  this  option  stores  the	string
		     `nofoo'  in  the  array, whereas the -O option stores the
		     `foo' originally given.

	      -D array
		     As with -O, the words are not added to the set of	possi‐
		     ble  completions.	 Instead,  the	completion  code tests
		     whether each word in turn matches what is	on  the	 line.
		     If	 the  nth  word does not match, the nth element of the
		     array is removed.	Elements for which  the	 corresponding
		     word is matched are retained.

	      -C     This  option  adds	 a  special match which expands to all
		     other matches when inserted into  the  line,  even	 those
		     that  are added after this option is used.	 Together with
		     the -d option it is possible to  specify  a  string  that
		     should  be	 displayed in the list for this special match.
		     If no string is given, it will be shown as a string  con‐
		     taining  the strings that would be inserted for the other
		     matches, truncated to the width of the screen.

	      -E     This option adds number empty  matches  after  the	 words
		     have  been	 added.	 An empty match takes up space in com‐
		     pletion listings but will never be inserted in  the  line
		     and can't be selected with menu completion or menu selec‐
		     tion.  This makes empty matches  only  useful  to	format
		     completion	 lists and to make explanatory string be shown
		     in completion lists (since empty  matches	can  be	 given
		     display strings with the -d option).  And because all but
		     one empty string would otherwise be removed, this	option
		     implies  the  -V  and  -2 options (even if an explicit -J
		     option is given).

	      -
	      --     This flag ends the list of flags and options.  All	 argu‐
		     ments  after  it  will  be	 taken	as the words to use as
		     matches even if they begin with hyphens.

	      Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than
	      once, the first one (and its argument) will be used.

       compset -p number
       compset -P [ number ] pattern
       compset -s number
       compset -S [ number ] pattern
       compset -n begin [ end ]
       compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
       compset -q
	      This  command simplifies modification of the special parameters,
	      while its return status allows tests on them to be carried out.

	      The options are:

	      -p number
		     If the contents of the PREFIX parameter  is  longer  than
		     number   characters,  the	first  number  characters  are
		     removed from it and  appended  to	the  contents  of  the
		     IPREFIX parameter.

	      -P [ number ] pattern
		     If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything
		     that matches the pattern, the matched portion is  removed
		     from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.

		     Without  the optional number, the longest match is taken,
		     but if number is given, anything up to the numberth match
		     is	 moved.	 If the number is negative, the numberth long‐
		     est match is moved. For example, if PREFIX	 contains  the
		     string  `a=b=c',  then  compset  -P  '*\='	 will move the
		     string `a=b=' into the IPREFIX parameter, but compset  -P
		     1 '*\=' will move only the string `a='.

	      -s number
		     As	 -p,  but transfer the last number characters from the
		     value of SUFFIX to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

	      -S [ number ] pattern
		     As -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and  transfer
		     the matched portion to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

	      -n begin [ end ]
		     If	 the current word position as specified by the parame‐
		     ter CURRENT is greater than or equal to  begin,  anything
		     up	 to  the  beginth word is removed from the words array
		     and the value of the parameter CURRENT is decremented  by
		     begin.

		     If	 the  optional	end is given, the modification is done
		     only if the current word position is also	less  than  or
		     equal  to	end. In this case, the words from position end
		     onwards are also removed from the words array.

		     Both begin and end may be	negative  to  count  backwards
		     from the last element of the words array.

	      -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
		     If	 one of the elements of the words array before the one
		     at the index given by the value of the parameter  CURRENT
		     matches  the  pattern  beg-pat,  all  elements  up to and
		     including the matching one are  removed  from  the	 words
		     array and the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the
		     same word in the changed array.

		     If the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and	 there
		     is	 an  element in the words array matching this pattern,
		     the parameters are modified only if  the  index  of  this
		     word  is higher than the one given by the CURRENT parame‐
		     ter (so that the matching word has to be after  the  cur‐
		     sor).  In	this  case,  the  words	 starting with the one
		     matching end-pat are also removed from the	 words	array.
		     If	 words	contains no word matching end-pat, the testing
		     and modification is performed as if it were not given.

	      -q     The word currently being completed	 is  split  on	spaces
		     into  separate  words, respecting the usual shell quoting
		     conventions.  The resulting words are stored in the words
		     array,  and CURRENT, PREFIX, SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and QISUF‐
		     FIX are modified to reflect the word part	that  is  com‐
		     pleted.

	      In  all  the  above  cases the return status is zero if the test
	      succeeded and the parameters were modified and  non-zero	other‐
	      wise. This allows one to use this builtin in tests such as:

		     if compset -P '*\='; then ...

	      This  forces anything up to and including the last equal sign to
	      be ignored by the completion code.

       compcall [ -TD ]
	      This allows the use of  completions  defined  with  the  compctl
	      builtin  from  within  completion	 widgets.  The list of matches
	      will be generated as if one of the non-widget  completion	 func‐
	      tions  (complete-word,  etc.)  had been called, except that only
	      compctls given for specific commands are used. To force the code
	      to  try completions defined with the -T option of compctl and/or
	      the default completion (whether defined by  compctl  -D  or  the
	      builtin  default)	 in  the  appropriate places, the -T and/or -D
	      flags can be passed to compcall.

	      The return status can be used to test if a matching compctl def‐
	      inition  was  found.  It	is non-zero if a compctl was found and
	      zero otherwise.

	      Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.

COMPLETION CONDITION CODES
       The following additional condition codes for use within the [[  ...  ]]
       construct  are available in completion widgets.	These work on the spe‐
       cial parameters.	 All of these tests  can  also	be  performed  by  the
       compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the contents of
       the special parameters are not modified.

       -prefix [ number ] pattern
	      true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.

       -suffix [ number ] pattern
	      true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.

       -after beg-pat
	      true if the test of the -N option with only  the	beg-pat	 given
	      would succeed.

       -between beg-pat end-pat
	      true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would suc‐
	      ceed.

COMPLETION MATCHING CONTROL
       It is possible by use of the -M option of the compadd  builtin  command
       to  specify  how the characters in the string to be completed (referred
       to here as the command line) map onto the characters  in	 the  list  of
       matches	produced by the completion code (referred to here as the trial
       completions). Note that this is not used if the command line contains a
       glob  pattern  and the GLOB_COMPLETE option is set or the pattern_match
       of the compstate special association is set to a non-empty string.

       The match-spec given as the argument to the -M option (see  `Completion
       Builtin	Commands' above) consists of one or more matching descriptions
       separated by whitespace.	 Each description consists of  a  letter  fol‐
       lowed  by  a  colon  and	 then  the patterns describing which character
       sequences on the line match which character sequences in the trial com‐
       pletion.	  Any  sequence of characters not handled in this fashion must
       match exactly, as usual.

       The forms of match-spec understood are as follows. In  each  case,  the
       form  with  an  upper case initial character retains the string already
       typed on the command line as the final result of completion, while with
       a  lower	 case  initial	character  the	string	on the command line is
       changed into the corresponding part of the trial completion.

       m:lpat=tpat
       M:lpat=tpat
	      Here, lpat is a pattern that matches on the command line, corre‐
	      sponding to tpat which matches in the trial completion.

       l:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       L:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       l:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       L:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       b:lpat=tpat
       B:lpat=tpat
	      These letters are for patterns that are anchored by another pat‐
	      tern on the left side. Matching for lpat and tpat is  as	for  m
	      and  M, but the pattern lpat matched on the command line must be
	      preceded by the pattern lanchor.	The lanchor can	 be  blank  to
	      anchor the match to the start of the command line string; other‐
	      wise the anchor can occur anywhere, but must match in  both  the
	      command line and trial completion strings.

	      If  no  lpat  is	given  but  a ranchor is, this matches the gap
	      between substrings matched by lanchor and ranchor.  Unlike  lan‐
	      chor,  the  ranchor  only	 needs	to  match the trial completion
	      string.

	      The b and B forms are similar to l and L with an	empty  anchor,
	      but  need to match only the beginning of the trial completion or
	      the word on the command line, respectively.

       r:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       R:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       r:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       R:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       e:lpat=tpat
       E:lpat=tpat
	      As l, L, b and B, with the difference that the command line  and
	      trial  completion patterns are anchored on the right side.  Here
	      an empty ranchor and the e and E forms force the	match  to  the
	      end of the trial completion or command line string.

       Each  lpat,  tpat  or anchor is either an empty string or consists of a
       sequence of literal characters (which may be quoted with a  backslash),
       question marks, character classes, and correspondence classes; ordinary
       shell patterns are not used.  Literal characters match only themselves,
       question marks match any character, and character classes are formed as
       for globbing and match any character in the given set.

       Correspondence classes are defined like character classes, but with two
       differences:  they  are	delimited  by  a  pair	of braces, and negated
       classes are not allowed, so the characters !  and  ^  have  no  special
       meaning	directly  after the opening brace.  They indicate that a range
       of characters on the line match a range of characters in the trial com‐
       pletion,	 but  (unlike  ordinary character classes) paired according to
       the corresponding position in the sequence.  For example, to  make  any
       ASCII  lower case letter on the line match the corresponding upper case
       letter in the trial completion, you can use  `m:{a-z}={A-Z}'  (however,
       see  below  for	the recommended form for this).	 More than one pair of
       classes can occur, in which case the first class before	the  =	corre‐
       sponds  to  the	first  after it, and so on.  If one side has more such
       classes than the other side, the superfluous classes behave like normal
       character  classes.   In	 anchor	 patterns  correspondence classes also
       behave like normal character classes.

       The standard `[:name:]' forms described for  standard  shell  patterns,
       see the section FILENAME GENERATION in zshexpn(1), may appear in corre‐
       spondence classes as well as normal character classes.  The  only  spe‐
       cial behaviour in correspondence classes is if the form on the left and
       the form on the right are each one of [:upper:], [:lower:].   In	 these
       cases  the  character in the word and the character on the line must be
       the same up to a difference in case.  Hence  to	make  any  lower  case
       character  on  the line match the corresponding upper case character in
       the trial completion you can use `m:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]}'.  Although
       the  matching  system does not yet handle multibyte characters, this is
       likely to be a future extension, at which point this syntax will handle
       arbitrary  alphabets;  hence this form, rather than the use of explicit
       ranges, is the recommended form.	 In other cases `[:name:]'  forms  are
       allowed.	  If  the  two	forms  on the left and right are the same, the
       characters must match exactly.  In remaining cases,  the	 corresponding
       tests  are  applied to both characters, but they are not otherwise con‐
       strained; any matching character in one	set  goes  with	 any  matching
       character  in  the  other  set:	this is equivalent to the behaviour of
       ordinary character classes.

       The pattern tpat may also be one or two stars, `*' or `**'. This	 means
       that the pattern on the command line can match any number of characters
       in the trial completion. In this case the pattern must be anchored  (on
       either  side); in the case of a single star, the anchor then determines
       how much of the trial completion is to be included -- only the  charac‐
       ters  up to the next appearance of the anchor will be matched. With two
       stars, substrings matched by the anchor can be matched, too.

       Examples:

       The keys of the options association defined by the parameter module are
       the option names in all-lower-case form, without underscores, and with‐
       out the optional no at the beginning even though	 the  builtins	setopt
       and  unsetopt  understand  option names with upper case letters, under‐
       scores, and the optional no.  The following alters the  matching	 rules
       so  that	 the  prefix  no and any underscore are ignored when trying to
       match the trial completions generated and upper	case  letters  on  the
       line match the corresponding lower case letters in the words:

	      compadd -M 'L:|[nN][oO]= M:_= M:{[:upper:]}={[:lower:]}' - \
		${(k)options}

       The  first  part says that the pattern `[nN][oO]' at the beginning (the
       empty anchor before the pipe symbol) of the string on the line  matches
       the  empty  string  in the list of words generated by completion, so it
       will be ignored if present. The second part does the same for an under‐
       score anywhere in the command line string, and the third part uses cor‐
       respondence classes so that any upper case letter on the	 line  matches
       the  corresponding  lower case letter in the word. The use of the upper
       case forms of the specification characters (L and  M)  guarantees  that
       what has already been typed on the command line (in particular the pre‐
       fix no) will not be deleted.

       Note that the use of L in the first part means  that  it	 matches  only
       when  at	 the  beginning	 of both the command line string and the trial
       completion.  I.e.,  the	string	`_NO_f'	 would	not  be	 completed  to
       `_NO_foo', nor would `NONO_f' be completed to `NONO_foo' because of the
       leading underscore or the second `NO' on the line which makes the  pat‐
       tern  fail  even	 though	 they  are otherwise ignored. To fix this, one
       would use `B:[nN][oO]=' instead of the first part. As described	above,
       this  matches  at the beginning of the trial completion, independent of
       other characters or substrings at the beginning	of  the	 command  line
       word which are ignored by the same or other match-specs.

       The second example makes completion case insensitive.  This is just the
       same as in the option example, except here we wish to retain the	 char‐
       acters in the list of completions:

	      compadd -M 'm:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]}' ...

       This  makes lower case letters match their upper case counterparts.  To
       make upper case letters match the lower case forms as well:

	      compadd -M 'm:{[:lower:][:upper:]}={[:upper:][:lower:]}' ...

       A nice example for the use of * patterns is  partial  word  completion.
       Sometimes  you  would  like  to	make  strings like `c.s.u' complete to
       strings like `comp.source.unix', i.e. the word on the command line con‐
       sists of multiple parts, separated by a dot in this example, where each
       part should be completed separately -- note,  however,  that  the  case
       where  each  part of the word, i.e. `comp', `source' and `unix' in this
       example, is to be completed from separate sets of matches is a  differ‐
       ent  problem  to be solved by the implementation of the completion wid‐
       get.  The example can be handled by:

	      compadd -M 'r:|.=* r:|=*' \
		- comp.sources.unix comp.sources.misc ...

       The first specification says that  lpat	is  the	 empty	string,	 while
       anchor  is  a dot; tpat is *, so this can match anything except for the
       `.' from the anchor in the trial completion word.  So in	 `c.s.u',  the
       matcher	sees `c', followed by the empty string, followed by the anchor
       `.', and likewise for the second dot, and replaces  the	empty  strings
       before  the  anchors,  giving `c[omp].s[ources].u[nix]', where the last
       part of the completion is just as normal.

       With the pattern shown above, the string `c.u' could not	 be  completed
       to  `comp.sources.unix'	because	 the  single  star  means  that no dot
       (matched by the anchor) can be  skipped.	 By  using  two	 stars	as  in
       `r:|.=**',  however,  `c.u'  could be completed to `comp.sources.unix'.
       This also shows that in some cases, especially if the anchor is a  real
       pattern,	 like a character class, the form with two stars may result in
       more matches than one would like.

       The second specification is needed to make this work when the cursor is
       in  the	middle	of  the string on the command line and the option COM‐
       PLETE_IN_WORD is set. In this case the completion code  would  normally
       try  to	match  trial  completions that end with the string as typed so
       far, i.e. it will only insert new characters  at	 the  cursor  position
       rather  than at the end.	 However in our example we would like the code
       to recognise matches which contain extra characters after the string on
       the  line  (the	`nix'  in  the	example).  Hence we say that the empty
       string at the end of the string on the line matches any	characters  at
       the end of the trial completion.

       More generally, the specification

	      compadd -M 'r:|[.,_-]=* r:|=*' ...

       allows one to complete words with abbreviations before any of the char‐
       acters in the square brackets.  For example, to complete	 veryverylong‐
       file.c  rather  than veryverylongheader.h with the above in effect, you
       can just type very.c before attempting completion.

       The specifications with both a left and a right anchor  are  useful  to
       complete	 partial  words	 whose parts are not separated by some special
       character. For example, in some places strings  have  to	 be  completed
       that are formed `LikeThis' (i.e. the separate parts are determined by a
       leading upper case letter) or maybe one has to  complete	 strings  with
       trailing	 numbers.  Here	 one  could  use the simple form with only one
       anchor as in:

	      compadd -M 'r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=* r:|=*' LikeTHIS FooHoo 5foo123 5bar234

       But with this, the string `H' would neither complete to `FooHoo' nor to
       `LikeTHIS'  because  in	each case there is an upper case letter before
       the `H' and that is matched by the anchor. Likewise, a `2' would not be
       completed.   In	 both	cases	this   could   be   changed  by	 using
       `r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=**', but then `H' completes to both  `LikeTHIS'  and
       `FooHoo'	 and a `2' matches the other strings because characters can be
       inserted before every upper case letter and digit. To  avoid  this  one
       would use:

	      compadd -M 'r:[^[:upper:]0-9]||[[:upper:]0-9]=** r:|=*' \
		  LikeTHIS FooHoo foo123 bar234

       By using these two anchors, a `H' matches only upper case `H's that are
       immediately  preceded   by   something	matching   the	 left	anchor
       `[^[:upper:]0-9]'.  The effect is, of course, that `H' matches only the
       string `FooHoo', a `2' matches only `bar234' and so on.

       When using the completion system (see zshcompsys(1)), users can	define
       match specifications that are to be used for specific contexts by using
       the matcher and matcher-list styles. The values for the latter will  be
       used everywhere.

COMPLETION WIDGET EXAMPLE
       The first step is to define the widget:

	      zle -C complete complete-word complete-files

       Then  the  widget  can be bound to a key using the bindkey builtin com‐
       mand:

	      bindkey '^X\t' complete

       After that the shell function complete-files will be invoked after typ‐
       ing  control-X  and TAB. The function should then generate the matches,
       e.g.:

	      complete-files () { compadd - * }

       This function will complete files in the current directory matching the
       current word.

ZSHCOMPSYS(1)							 ZSHCOMPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcompsys - zsh completion system

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the shell code for the `new' completion system, referred
       to as compsys.  It is written in shell functions based on the  features
       described in zshcompwid(1).

       The features are contextual, sensitive to the point at which completion
       is started.  Many completions are already provided.  For this reason, a
       user  can perform a great many tasks without knowing any details beyond
       how to initialize the system, which is described below  in  INITIALIZA‐
       TION.

       The context that decides what completion is to be performed may be
       ·      an  argument  or option position: these describe the position on
	      the command line at which completion is requested.  For  example
	      `first  argument	to  rmdir,  the	 word  being completed names a
	      directory';

       ·      a special context, denoting an element in	 the  shell's  syntax.
	      For  example  `a	word  in  command  position' or `an array sub‐
	      script'.

       A full context specification  contains  other  elements,	 as  we	 shall
       describe.

       Besides	commands  names and contexts, the system employs two more con‐
       cepts, styles and tags.	These provide ways for the user	 to  configure
       the system's behaviour.

       Tags  play  a dual role.	 They serve as a classification system for the
       matches, typically indicating a class of object that the user may  need
       to  distinguish.	 For example, when completing arguments of the ls com‐
       mand the user may prefer to try files before directories,  so  both  of
       these are tags.	They also appear as the rightmost element in a context
       specification.

       Styles modify various operations of the completion system, such as out‐
       put formatting, but also what kinds of completers are used (and in what
       order), or which tags are examined.  Styles may	accept	arguments  and
       are  manipulated	 using	the  zstyle  command  described in see zshmod‐
       ules(1).

       In summary, tags describe what the completion objects  are,  and	 style
       how they are to be completed.  At various points of execution, the com‐
       pletion system checks what styles and/or tags are defined for the  cur‐
       rent  context, and uses that to modify its behavior.  The full descrip‐
       tion of context handling, which determines how tags and other  elements
       of the context influence the behaviour of styles, is described below in
       COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION.

       When a completion is requested, a dispatcher function  is  called;  see
       the  description	 of  _main_complete  in	 the list of control functions
       below. This dispatcher decides which function should be called to  pro‐
       duce the completions, and calls it. The result is passed to one or more
       completers, functions that implement individual completion  strategies:
       simple  completion, error correction, completion with error correction,
       menu selection, etc.

       More generally, the shell functions contained in the completion	system
       are of two types:
       ·      those beginning `comp' are to be called directly; there are only
	      a few of these;

       ·      those beginning `_' are called  by  the  completion  code.   The
	      shell  functions	of this set, which implement completion behav‐
	      iour and may be bound to keystrokes, are referred	 to  as	 `wid‐
	      gets'.  These proliferate as new completions are required.

INITIALIZATION
       If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to call the
       shell function compinit from your initialization	 file;	see  the  next
       section.	  However,  the	 function  compinstall can be run by a user to
       configure various aspects of the completion system.

       Usually, compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if that  is
       not  writable  it will save it in another file and tell you that file's
       location.  Note that it is up to you to make sure that the lines	 added
       to  .zshrc are actually run; you may, for example, need to move them to
       an earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early.  So  long
       as you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the start
       and finish), you can rerun compinstall and it will correctly locate and
       modify  these lines.  Note, however, that any code you add to this sec‐
       tion by hand is likely to be lost if you	 rerun	compinstall,  although
       lines using the command `zstyle' should be gracefully handled.

       The  new	 code  will  take effect next time you start the shell, or run
       .zshrc by hand; there is also an option to make them take effect	 imme‐
       diately.	  However,  if	compinstall  has removed definitions, you will
       need to restart the shell to see the changes.

       To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory men‐
       tioned in your fpath parameter, which should already be the case if zsh
       was properly configured as long as your startup files do not remove the
       appropriate  directories	 from  fpath.	Then  it  must	be  autoloaded
       (`autoload -U compinstall' is recommended).  You can abort the  instal‐
       lation any time you are being prompted for information, and your .zshrc
       will not be altered at all; changes only take place right at  the  end,
       where you are specifically asked for confirmation.

   Use of compinit
       This section describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for
       the current session when called directly; if you have  run  compinstall
       it will be called automatically from your .zshrc.

       To  initialize  the system, the function compinit should be in a direc‐
       tory mentioned  in  the	fpath  parameter,  and	should	be  autoloaded
       (`autoload  -U  compinit'  is  recommended),  and  then	run  simply as
       `compinit'.  This will define a few utility functions, arrange for  all
       the necessary shell functions to be autoloaded, and will then re-define
       all widgets that do completion to use the new system.  If you  use  the
       menu-select  widget,  which  is	part  of  the zsh/complist module, you
       should make sure that that module is loaded before the call to compinit
       so  that	 that  widget  is  also re-defined.  If completion styles (see
       below) are set up  to  perform  expansion  as  well  as	completion  by
       default,	 and the TAB key is bound to expand-or-complete, compinit will
       rebind it to complete-word; this is necessary to use the	 correct  form
       of expansion.

       Should  you need to use the original completion commands, you can still
       bind keys to the old widgets by putting a `.' in front  of  the	widget
       name, e.g. `.expand-or-complete'.

       To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped
       configuration that will be read in on future invocations; this  is  the
       default,	 but can be turned off by calling compinit with the option -D.
       The dumped file is .zcompdump in the  same  directory  as  the  startup
       files  (i.e.  $ZDOTDIR  or $HOME); alternatively, an explicit file name
       can be given  by	 `compinit  -d	dumpfile'.   The  next	invocation  of
       compinit	 will  read  the dumped file instead of performing a full ini‐
       tialization.

       If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this
       and produce a new dump file.  However, if the name of a function or the
       arguments in the first line of a #compdef function (as described below)
       change,	it is easiest to delete the dump file by hand so that compinit
       will re-create it the next time it is run.  The check performed to  see
       if  there are new functions can be omitted by giving the option -C.  In
       this case the dump file	will  only  be	created	 if  there  isn't  one
       already.

       The  dumping  is	 actually  done by another function, compdump, but you
       will only need to run this yourself if  you  change  the	 configuration
       (e.g.  using  compdef)  and then want to dump the new one.  The name of
       the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.

       If the parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where
       completion  functions  can be found; this is only necessary if they are
       not already in the function search path.

       For security reasons compinit also  checks  if  the  completion	system
       would  use  files not owned by root or by the current user, or files in
       directories that are world- or group-writable or that are not owned  by
       root  or	 by the current user.  If such files or directories are found,
       compinit will ask if the completion system should really be  used.   To
       avoid  these tests and make all files found be used without asking, use
       the option -u, and to make compinit silently ignore all insecure	 files
       and  directories	 use  the  option  -i.	This security check is skipped
       entirely when the -C option is given.

       The security check can be retried at any time by running	 the  function
       compaudit.   This  is  the  same check used by compinit, but when it is
       executed directly any changes to fpath are made local to	 the  function
       so they do not persist.	The directories to be checked may be passed as
       arguments; if none are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find
       completion  system  directories, adding missing ones to fpath as neces‐
       sary.  To force a check of exactly the directories currently  named  in
       fpath,  set  _compdir  to  an  empty string before calling compaudit or
       compinit.

       The function bashcompinit provides compatibility with  bash's  program‐
       mable  completion system.  When run it will define the functions, comp‐
       gen and complete which correspond to the bash builtins  with  the  same
       names.	It  will then be possible to use completion specifications and
       functions written for bash.

   Autoloaded files
       The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is that they
       start with an underscore; as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parame‐
       ter must contain the directory in which they are stored.	  If  zsh  was
       properly	 installed on your system, then fpath/FPATH automatically con‐
       tains the required directories for the standard functions.

       For incomplete installations, if compinit does not  find	 enough	 files
       beginning with an underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it
       will try to find more by adding the directory _compdir  to  the	search
       path.  If that directory has a subdirectory named Base, all subdirecto‐
       ries will be added to the path.	Furthermore, if the subdirectory  Base
       has  a subdirectory named Core, compinit will add all subdirectories of
       the subdirectories is to the path: this allows the functions to	be  in
       the same format as in the zsh source distribution.

       When  compinit  is  run,	 it  searches  all  such  files accessible via
       fpath/FPATH and reads the first line of each of them.  This line should
       contain	one  of the tags described below.  Files whose first line does
       not start with one of these tags are not considered to be part  of  the
       completion system and will not be treated specially.

       The tags are:

       #compdef names... [ -[pP] patterns... [ -N names... ] ]
	      The  file	 will be made autoloadable and the function defined in
	      it will be called when completing names, each of which is either
	      the name of a command whose arguments are to be completed or one
	      of a number of special contexts in the form -context-  described
	      below.

	      Each  name may also be of the form `cmd=service'.	 When complet‐
	      ing the command cmd, the function typically behaves  as  if  the
	      command	(or  special  context)	service	 was  being  completed
	      instead.	This provides a way of altering the behaviour of func‐
	      tions that can perform many different completions.  It is imple‐
	      mented by setting the parameter $service when calling the	 func‐
	      tion;  the  function may choose to interpret this how it wishes,
	      and simpler functions will probably ignore it.

	      If the #compdef line contains one of the options -p or  -P,  the
	      words  following are taken to be patterns.  The function will be
	      called when completion is attempted for  a  command  or  context
	      that  matches  one  of  the patterns.  The options -p and -P are
	      used to specify patterns to be tried before or after other  com‐
	      pletions	respectively.  Hence -P may be used to specify default
	      actions.

	      The option -N is used after a list following -p or -P; it speci‐
	      fies that remaining words no longer define patterns.  It is pos‐
	      sible to toggle between the three options as many times as  nec‐
	      essary.

       #compdef -k style key-sequences...
	      This  option  creates  a widget behaving like the builtin widget
	      style and binds it to the	 given	key-sequences,	if  any.   The
	      style  must  be  one of the builtin widgets that perform comple‐
	      tion, namely complete-word, delete-char-or-list,	expand-or-com‐
	      plete,  expand-or-complete-prefix,  list-choices, menu-complete,
	      menu-expand-or-complete,	or  reverse-menu-complete.    If   the
	      zsh/complist  module  is	loaded	(see zshmodules(1)) the widget
	      menu-select is also available.

	      When one of the key-sequences is typed, the function in the file
	      will  be	invoked to generate the matches.  Note that a key will
	      not be re-bound if it already was (that is, was bound  to	 some‐
	      thing  other  than  undefined-key).   The widget created has the
	      same name as the file and can be bound to any other  keys	 using
	      bindkey as usual.

       #compdef -K widget-name style key-sequences ...
	      This  is	similar to -k except that only one key-sequences argu‐
	      ment may be given for each widget-name style pair.  However, the
	      entire  set  of three arguments may be repeated with a different
	      set of arguments.	 Note in particular that the widget-name  must
	      be  distinct  in	each  set.  If it does not begin with `_' this
	      will be added.  The widget-name should not clash with  the  name
	      of  any existing widget: names based on the name of the function
	      are most useful.	For example,

		     #compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
		       _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"

	      (all on one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion,
	      bound  to	 `^X^C',  and a widget _foo_list for listing, bound to
	      `^X^D'.

       #autoload [ options ]
	      Functions with the #autoload tag are marked for autoloading  but
	      are  not	otherwise treated specially.  Typically they are to be
	      called from within one of the completion functions.  Any options
	      supplied	will  be passed to the autoload builtin; a typical use
	      is +X to force the function to be loaded immediately.  Note that
	      the -U and -z flags are always added implicitly.

       The  #  is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed after it.
       The #compdef tags use the compdef function described  below;  the  main
       difference is that the name of the function is supplied implicitly.

       The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:

       -array-value-
	      The right hand side of an array-assignment (`foo=(...)')

       -brace-parameter-
	      The name of a parameter expansion within braces (`${...}')

       -assign-parameter-
	      The  name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left hand
	      side of an `='

       -command-
	      A word in command position

       -condition-
	      A word inside a condition (`[[...]]')

       -default-
	      Any word for which no other completion is defined

       -equal-
	      A word beginning with an equals sign

       -first-
	      This is tried before any other completion function.   The	 func‐
	      tion  called  may	 set the _compskip parameter to one of various
	      values: all: no further completion is attempted; a  string  con‐
	      taining  the substring patterns: no pattern completion functions
	      will be called; a string containing default:  the	 function  for
	      the  `-default-'	context	 will  not  be	called,	 but functions
	      defined for commands will

       -math- Inside mathematical contexts, such as `((...))'

       -parameter-
	      The name of a parameter expansion (`$...')

       -redirect-
	      The word after a redirection operator.

       -subscript-
	      The contents of a parameter subscript.

       -tilde-
	      After an initial tilde (`~'), but before the first slash in  the
	      word.

       -value-
	      On the right hand side of an assignment.

       Default	implementations	 are  supplied for each of these contexts.  In
       most cases the context -context-	 is  implemented  by  a	 corresponding
       function	 _context,  for example the context `-tilde-' and the function
       `_tilde').

       The contexts -redirect- and -value- allow extra context-specific infor‐
       mation.	(Internally, this is handled by the functions for each context
       calling the function _dispatch.)	 The extra information is added	 sepa‐
       rated by commas.

       For  the -redirect- context, the extra information is in the form `-re‐
       direct-,op,command', where op is the redirection operator  and  command
       is  the name of the command on the line.	 If there is no command on the
       line yet, the command field will be empty.

       For the -value- context, the form is `-value-,name,command', where name
       is  the	name of the parameter.	In the case of elements of an associa‐
       tive array,  for	 example  `assoc=(key  <TAB>',	name  is  expanded  to
       `name-key'.   In	 certain  special  contexts,  such as completing after
       `make CFLAGS=', the command part gives the name of  the	command,  here
       make; otherwise it is empty.

       It  is  not necessary to define fully specific completions as the func‐
       tions provided  will  try  to  generate	completions  by	 progressively
       replacing  the elements with `-default-'.  For example, when completing
       after `foo=<TAB>', _value will try the names `-value-,foo,'  (note  the
       empty	      command	       part),	       `-value-,foo,-default-'
       and`-value-,-default-,-default-', in that order, until it finds a func‐
       tion to handle the context.

       As an example:

	      compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'

       completes  files matching `*.log' after `2> <TAB>' for any command with
       no more specific handler defined.

       Also:

	      compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-

       specifies that _foo provides completions for the values	of  parameters
       for  which  no special function has been defined.  This is usually han‐
       dled by the function _value itself.

       The same lookup rules are used when looking  up	styles	(as  described
       below); for example

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'

       is  another  way	 to  make  completion  after `2> <TAB>' complete files
       matching `*.log'.

   Functions
       The following function  is  defined  by	compinit  and  may  be	called
       directly.

       compdef	[ -ane ] function names... [ -[pP] patterns... [ -N names... ]
       ]
       compdef -d names...
       compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequences...
       compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-sequences ...
	      The first form defines the function to call  for	completion  in
	      the given contexts as described for the #compdef tag above.

	      Alternatively,  all  the	arguments  may have the form `cmd=ser‐
	      vice'.   Here  service  should  already  have  been  defined  by
	      `cmd1=service' lines in #compdef files, as described above.  The
	      argument for cmd will be completed in the same way as service.

	      The function argument may alternatively be a  string  containing
	      almost  any  shell  code.	 If the string contains an equal sign,
	      the above will take precedence.  The option -e may  be  used  to
	      specify the first argument is to be evaluated as shell code even
	      if it contains an equal sign.  The string will be executed using
	      the eval builtin command to generate completions.	 This provides
	      a way of avoiding having to define a  new	 completion  function.
	      For  example,  to	 complete files ending in `.h' as arguments to
	      the command foo:

		     compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo

	      The option -n prevents any completions already defined  for  the
	      command or context from being overwritten.

	      The  option -d deletes any completion defined for the command or
	      contexts listed.

	      The names may also contain -p, -P and -N	options	 as  described
	      for  the #compdef tag.  The effect on the argument list is iden‐
	      tical, switching between	definitions  of	 patterns  tried  ini‐
	      tially,  patterns	 tried	finally,  and normal commands and con‐
	      texts.

	      The parameter $_compskip may be set by any function defined  for
	      a	 pattern context.  If it is set to a value containing the sub‐
	      string `patterns' none of the pattern-functions will be  called;
	      if it is set to a value containing the substring `all', no other
	      function will be called.

	      The form with -k defines a widget with  the  same	 name  as  the
	      function that will be called for each of the key-sequences; this
	      is like the #compdef -k tag.  The function should	 generate  the
	      completions  needed  and	will otherwise behave like the builtin
	      widget whose name is given as the style argument.	  The  widgets
	      usable   for   this   are:  complete-word,  delete-char-or-list,
	      expand-or-complete,   expand-or-complete-prefix,	 list-choices,
	      menu-complete,  menu-expand-or-complete,	and  reverse-menu-com‐
	      plete, as well as menu-select  if	 the  zsh/complist  module  is
	      loaded.	The  option  -n	 prevents the key being bound if it is
	      already to bound to something other than undefined-key.

	      The form with -K is similar and defines multiple	widgets	 based
	      on  the  same  function, each of which requires the set of three
	      arguments name, style and key-sequences, where  the  latter  two
	      are  as for -k and the first must be a unique widget name begin‐
	      ning with an underscore.

	      Wherever applicable, the -a option makes the function  autoload‐
	      able, equivalent to autoload -U function.

       The function compdef can be used to associate existing completion func‐
       tions with new commands.	 For example,

	      compdef _pids foo

       uses the function _pids to complete process IDs for the command foo.

       Note also the _gnu_generic function described below, which can be  used
       to complete options for commands that understand the `--help' option.

COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
       This section gives a short overview of how the completion system works,
       and then more detail on how users can configure how  and	 when  matches
       are generated.

   Overview
       When  completion is attempted somewhere on the command line the comple‐
       tion system first works out the context.	 This takes account of a  num‐
       ber  of things including the command word (such as `grep' or `zsh') and
       options to which the current word may be an argument (such as the  `-o'
       option to zsh which takes a shell option as an argument).

       This  context information is condensed into a string consisting of mul‐
       tiple fields separated by colons, referred to simply as	`the  context'
       in the remainder of the documentation.  This is used to look up styles,
       context-sensitive options that can be used to configure the  completion
       system.	 The  context used for lookup may vary during the same call to
       the completion system.

       The context string always consists of a fixed set of fields,  separated
       by  colons and with a leading colon before the first, in the form :com‐
       pletion:function:completer:command:argument:tag.	 These have  the  fol‐
       lowing meaning:

       ·      The literal string completion, saying that this style is used by
	      the completion system.   This  distinguishes  the	 context  from
	      those used by, for example, zle widgets and ZFTP functions.

       ·      The function, if completion is called from a named widget rather
	      than through the normal completion system.   Typically  this  is
	      blank,  but  it is set by special widgets such as predict-on and
	      the various functions in the Widget directory of	the  distribu‐
	      tion to the name of that function, often in an abbreviated form.

       ·      The completer currently active, the name of the function without
	      the leading underscore and with other underscores	 converted  to
	      hyphens.	 A `completer' is in overall control of how completion
	      is to be performed; `complete' is the simplest, but  other  com‐
	      pleters exist to perform related tasks such as correction, or to
	      modify the behaviour of a	 later	completer.   See  the  section
	      `Control Functions' below for more information.

       ·      The command or a special -context-, just at it appears following
	      the #compdef tag or the compdef function.	 Completion  functions
	      for commands that have sub-commands usually modify this field to
	      contain the name of the command followed by a minus sign and the
	      sub-command.   For  example, the completion function for the cvs
	      command sets this field to cvs-add when completing arguments  to
	      the add subcommand.

       ·      The  argument; this indicates which command line or option argu‐
	      ment we are completing.  For command  arguments  this  generally
	      takes  the  form	argument-n, where n is the number of the argu‐
	      ment, and for arguments to options the form option-opt-n where n
	      is  the  number of the argument to option opt.  However, this is
	      only the case if	the  command  line  is	parsed	with  standard
	      UNIX-style options and arguments, so many completions do not set
	      this.

       ·      The tag.	As described previously, tags are used to discriminate
	      between  the types of matches a completion function can generate
	      in a certain context.  Any completion function may use  any  tag
	      name  it	likes,	but  a	list  of the more common ones is given
	      below.

       The context is gradually put together as the  functions	are  executed,
       starting	 with  the  main  entry point, which adds :completion: and the
       function element if necessary.  The completer then adds	the  completer
       element.	  The  contextual  completion  adds  the  command and argument
       options.	 Finally, the tag is added when the types  of  completion  are
       known.  For example, the context name

	      :completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files

       says  that normal completion was attempted as the first argument to the
       option -o of the command dvips:

	      dvips -o ...

       and the completion function will generate filenames.

       Usually completion will be tried for all	 possible  tags	 in  an	 order
       given  by  the  completion  function.   However, this can be altered by
       using the tag-order style.  Completion is then restricted to  the  list
       of given tags in the given order.

       The  _complete_help  bindable  command  shows all the contexts and tags
       available for completion at a particular point.	This provides an  easy
       way  of	finding	 information  for  tag-order  and other styles.	 It is
       described in the section `Bindable Commands' below.

       Styles determine such things as how the matches	are  generated,	 simi‐
       larly  to  shell options but with much more control.  They can have any
       number of strings as their value.  They are  defined  with  the	zstyle
       builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).

       When  looking  up styles the completion system uses full context names,
       including the tag.  Looking up the value of a style therefore  consists
       of two things:  the context, which may be matched as a pattern, and the
       name of the style itself, which must be given exactly.

       For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple
       and  a  verbose	form  and  use	the verbose style to decide which form
       should be used.	To make all such functions use the verbose form, put

	      zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes

       in a startup file (probably .zshrc).  This gives the verbose style  the
       value  yes  in  every context inside the completion system, unless that
       context has a more specific definition.	It is best to avoid giving the
       context	as  `*' in case the style has some meaning outside the comple‐
       tion system.

       Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using  the
       compinstall function.

       A  more specific example of the use of the verbose style is by the com‐
       pletion for the kill builtin.  If the style is set, the	builtin	 lists
       full  job  texts and process command lines; otherwise it shows the bare
       job numbers and PIDs.  To turn the style off for this use only:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*' verbose no

       For even more control, the style can use one  of	 the  tags  `jobs'  or
       `processes'.  To turn off verbose display only for jobs:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no

       The  -e option to zstyle even allows completion function code to appear
       as the argument to a style; this requires  some	understanding  of  the
       internals  of completion functions (see see zshcompwid(1))).  For exam‐
       ple,

	      zstyle -e ':completion:*' hosts 'reply=($myhosts)'

       This forces the value of the hosts style to be read from	 the  variable
       myhosts each time a host name is needed; this is useful if the value of
       myhosts can change dynamically.	For another useful  example,  see  the
       example in the description of the file-list style below.	 This form can
       be slow and should be avoided for commonly examined styles such as menu
       and list-rows-first.

       Note  that  the	order in which styles are defined does not matter; the
       style mechanism uses the most specific possible match for a  particular
       style to determine the set of values.  More precisely, strings are pre‐
       ferred over patterns (for example, `:completion::complete:foo' is  more
       specific	 than `:completion::complete:*'), and longer patterns are pre‐
       ferred over shorter patterns.

       Style names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the  comple‐
       tion  function.	 However,  the following two sections list some of the
       most common tags and styles.

   Standard Tags
       Some of the following are only used when looking up  particular	styles
       and do not refer to a type of match.

       accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       all-expansions
	      used by the _expand completer when adding the single string con‐
	      taining all possible expansions

       all-files
	      for the names of all files (as distinct from a  particular  sub‐
	      set, see the globbed-files tag).

       arguments
	      for arguments to a command

       arrays for names of array parameters

       association-keys
	      for  keys	 of  associative arrays; used when completing inside a
	      subscript to a parameter of this type

       bookmarks
	      when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the	zftp  function
	      suite)

       builtins
	      for names of builtin commands

       characters
	      for  single  characters  in  arguments of commands such as stty.
	      Also used when completing character  classes  after  an  opening
	      bracket

       colormapids
	      for X colormap ids

       colors for color names

       commands
	      for  names  of external commands.	 Also used by complex commands
	      such as cvs when completing names subcommands.

       contexts
	      for contexts in arguments to the zstyle builtin command

       corrections
	      used by the _approximate and _correct  completers	 for  possible
	      corrections

       cursors
	      for cursor names used by X programs

       default
	      used  in	some  contexts to provide a way of supplying a default
	      when more specific tags are also valid.  Note that this  tag  is
	      used when only the function field of the context name is set

       descriptions
	      used  when  looking up the value of the format style to generate
	      descriptions for types of matches

       devices
	      for names of device special files

       directories
	      for names of directories -- local-directories  is	 used  instead
	      when  completing	arguments  of  cd and related builtin commands
	      when the cdpath array is set

       directory-stack
	      for entries in the directory stack

       displays
	      for X display names

       domains
	      for network domains

       expansions
	      used by the _expand completer for individual words  (as  opposed
	      to  the complete set of expansions) resulting from the expansion
	      of a word on the command line

       extensions
	      for X server extensions

       file-descriptors
	      for numbers of open file descriptors

       files  the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing file‐
	      names

       fonts  for X font names

       fstypes
	      for file system types (e.g. for the mount command)

       functions
	      names of functions -- normally shell functions, although certain
	      commands may understand other kinds of function

       globbed-files
	      for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern match‐
	      ing

       groups for names of user groups

       history-words
	      for words from the history

       hosts  for hostnames

       indexes
	      for array indexes

       jobs   for jobs (as listed by the `jobs' builtin)

       interfaces
	      for network interfaces

       keymaps
	      for names of zsh keymaps

       keysyms
	      for names of X keysyms

       libraries
	      for names of system libraries

       limits for system limits

       local-directories
	      for  names of directories that are subdirectories of the current
	      working directory when completing arguments of  cd  and  related
	      builtin  commands	 (compare path-directories) -- when the cdpath
	      array is unset, directories is used instead

       manuals
	      for names of manual pages

       mailboxes
	      for e-mail folders

       maps   for map names (e.g. NIS maps)

       messages
	      used to look up the format style for messages

       modifiers
	      for names of X modifiers

       modules
	      for modules (e.g. zsh modules)

       my-accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       named-directories
	      for named directories (you wouldn't  have	 guessed  that,	 would
	      you?)

       names  for all kinds of names

       newsgroups
	      for USENET groups

       nicknames
	      for nicknames of NIS maps

       options
	      for command options

       original
	      used  by	the _approximate, _correct and _expand completers when
	      offering the original string as a match

       other-accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       other-files
	      for the names of any non-directory files.	 This is used  instead
	      of all-files when the list-dirs-first style is in effect.

       packages
	      for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)

       parameters
	      for names of parameters

       path-directories
	      for  names  of  directories  found by searching the cdpath array
	      when completing arguments of cd  and  related  builtin  commands
	      (compare local-directories)

       paths  used  to	look  up  the values of the expand, ambiguous and spe‐
	      cial-dirs styles

       pods   for perl pods (documentation files)

       ports  for communication ports

       prefixes
	      for prefixes (like those of a URL)

       printers
	      for print queue names

       processes
	      for process identifiers

       processes-names
	      used to look up the command style when generating the  names  of
	      processes for killall

       sequences
	      for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)

       sessions
	      for sessions in the zftp function suite

       signals
	      for signal names

       strings
	      for  strings  (e.g.  the	replacement strings for the cd builtin
	      command)

       styles for styles used by the zstyle builtin command

       suffixes
	      for filename extensions

       tags   for tags (e.g. rpm tags)

       targets
	      for makefile targets

       time-zones
	      for time zones (e.g. when setting the TZ parameter)

       types  for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)

       urls   used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs

       users  for usernames

       values for one of a set of values in certain lists

       variant
	      used by _pick_variant to look up the command to run when	deter‐
	      mining what program is installed for a particular command name.

       visuals
	      for X visuals

       warnings
	      used to look up the format style for warnings

       widgets
	      for zsh widget names

       windows
	      for IDs of X windows

       zsh-options
	      for shell options

   Standard Styles
       Note  that the values of several of these styles represent boolean val‐
       ues.  Any of the strings `true', `on', `yes', and `1' can be  used  for
       the  value  `true' and any of the strings `false', `off', `no', and `0'
       for the value `false'.  The behavior for any other value	 is  undefined
       except  where  explicitly  mentioned.   The default value may be either
       true or false if the style is not set.

       Some of these styles are tested first for  every	 possible  tag	corre‐
       sponding to a type of match, and if no style was found, for the default
       tag.  The most notable styles of this type are  menu,  list-colors  and
       styles	controlling   completion   listing  such  as  list-packed  and
       last-prompt.  When tested for the default tag, only the function	 field
       of  the	context will be set so that a style using the default tag will
       normally be defined along the lines of:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...

       accept-exact
	      This is tested for the default tag in addition to the tags valid
	      for  the current context.	 If it is set to `true' and any of the
	      trial matches is the same as the string  on  the	command	 line,
	      this match will immediately be accepted (even if it would other‐
	      wise be considered ambiguous).

	      When completing pathnames (where the tag used is	`paths')  this
	      style accepts any number of patterns as the value in addition to
	      the boolean values.  Pathnames matching one  of  these  patterns
	      will  be	accepted immediately even if the command line contains
	      some more partially typed pathname components and these match no
	      file under the directory accepted.

	      This  style  is  also used by the _expand completer to decide if
	      words beginning with a tilde or parameter	 expansion  should  be
	      expanded.	  For example, if there are parameters foo and foobar,
	      the string `$foo' will only be expanded if accept-exact  is  set
	      to  `true';  otherwise  the completion system will be allowed to
	      complete $foo to $foobar. If the style  is  set  to  `continue',
	      _expand  will  add  the  expansion as a match and the completion
	      system will also be allowed to continue.

       accept-exact-dirs
	      This is used by filename completion.  Unlike accept-exact it  is
	      a	 boolean.  By default, filename completion examines all compo‐
	      nents of a path to see if there are completions of  that	compo‐
	      nent,  even if the component matches an existing directory.  For
	      example, when completion after /usr/bin/, the function  examines
	      possible completions to /usr.

	      When  this  style	 is true, any prefix of a path that matches an
	      existing directory is accepted without any attempt  to  complete
	      it  further.  Hence, in the given example, the path /usr/bin/ is
	      accepted immediately and completion tried in that directory.

	      If  you  wish  to	 inhibit  this	behaviour  entirely,  set  the
	      path-completion style (see below) to false.

       add-space
	      This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it is true (the
	      default), a space will be inserted  after	 all  words  resulting
	      from  the	 expansion, or a slash in the case of directory names.
	      If the value is `file', the completer will only add a  space  to
	      names  of	 existing  files.   Either a boolean true or the value
	      `file' may be combined with `subst', in which case the completer
	      will  not add a space to words generated from the expansion of a
	      substitution of the form `$(...)' or `${...}'.

	      The _prefix completer uses this style as a simple boolean	 value
	      to decide if a space should be inserted before the suffix.

       ambiguous
	      This  applies  when  completing non-final components of filename
	      paths, in other words those with a trailing  slash.   If	it  is
	      set,  the	 cursor	 is  left after the first ambiguous component,
	      even if menu completion is in use.  The style is	always	tested
	      with the paths tag.

       assign-list
	      When completing after an equals sign that is being treated as an
	      assignment, the completion system normally  completes  only  one
	      filename.	  In  some cases the value  may be a list of filenames
	      separated by colons, as with PATH and similar parameters.	  This
	      style  can  be  set  to a list of patterns matching the names of
	      such parameters.

	      The default is to complete lists	when  the  word	 on  the  line
	      already contains a colon.

       auto-description
	      If  set,	this style's value will be used as the description for
	      options that are not described by the completion functions,  but
	      that  have exactly one argument.	The sequence `%d' in the value
	      will be replaced by the description for this argument.   Depend‐
	      ing  on personal preferences, it may be useful to set this style
	      to something like `specify: %d'.	Note that this	may  not  work
	      for some commands.

       avoid-completer
	      This  is	used  by  the  _all_matches completer to decide if the
	      string consisting of all matches should be  added	 to  the  list
	      currently being generated.  Its value is a list of names of com‐
	      pleters.	If any of these is the name of the completer that gen‐
	      erated  the  matches  in this completion, the string will not be
	      added.

	      The default value for this style is `_expand _old_list  _correct
	      _approximate',  i.e.  it	contains  the  completers  for which a
	      string with all matches will almost never be wanted.

       cache-path
	      This style defines the path where	 any  cache  files  containing
	      dumped  completion  data	are  stored.   It  defaults to `$ZDOT‐
	      DIR/.zcompcache', or  `$HOME/.zcompcache'	 if  $ZDOTDIR  is  not
	      defined.	 The  completion  cache	 will  not  be used unless the
	      use-cache style is set.

       cache-policy
	      This style defines the function that will be used	 to  determine
	      whether  a  cache	 needs	rebuilding.   See  the	section on the
	      _cache_invalid function below.

       call-command
	      This style is used in the function for commands such as make and
	      ant  where calling the command directly to generate matches suf‐
	      fers problems such as being slow or, as in the case of make  can
	      potentially  cause actions in the makefile to be executed. If it
	      is set to `true' the command is called to generate matches.  The
	      default value of this style is `false'.

       command
	      In  many places, completion functions need to call external com‐
	      mands to generate the list of completions.  This	style  can  be
	      used  to override the command that is called in some such cases.
	      The elements of the value are joined with spaces to form a  com‐
	      mand  line  to execute.  The value can also start with a hyphen,
	      in which case the usual command will be added to the  end;  this
	      is  most	useful	for putting `builtin' or `command' in front to
	      make sure the appropriate version of a command  is  called,  for
	      example  to avoid calling a shell function with the same name as
	      an external command.

	      As an example, the completion function for process IDs uses this
	      style with the processes tag to generate the IDs to complete and
	      the list of processes  to	 display  (if  the  verbose  style  is
	      `true').	 The list produced by the command should look like the
	      output of the ps command.	 The first line is not displayed,  but
	      is searched for the string `PID' (or `pid') to find the position
	      of the process IDs in the following lines.  If the line does not
	      contain  `PID', the first numbers in each of the other lines are
	      taken as the process IDs to complete.

	      Note that the completion function	 generally  has	 to  call  the
	      specified	 command  for  each attempt to generate the completion
	      list.  Hence care should be taken to specify only commands  that
	      take  a  short  time to run, and in particular to avoid any that
	      may never terminate.

       command-path
	      This is a list of directories to search  for  commands  to  com‐
	      plete.   The  default for this style is the value of the special
	      parameter path.

       commands
	      This is used by the function  completing	sub-commands  for  the
	      system  initialisation scripts (residing in /etc/init.d or some‐
	      where not too far away from that).  Its values give the  default
	      commands to complete for those commands for which the completion
	      function isn't able to find them out automatically.  The default
	      for this style are the two strings `start' and `stop'.

       complete
	      This  is	used  by  the _expand_alias function when invoked as a
	      bindable command.	 If set to `true' and the word on the  command
	      line  is	not the name of an alias, matching alias names will be
	      completed.

       complete-options
	      This is used by the completer for	 cd,  chdir  and  pushd.   For
	      these  commands a - is used to introduce a directory stack entry
	      and completion of these  is  far	more  common  than  completing
	      options.	 Hence	unless the value of this style is true options
	      will not be completed, even after an initial -.  If it is	 true,
	      options  will  be completed after an initial - unless there is a
	      preceding -- on the command line.

       completer
	      The strings given as the value of this style provide  the	 names
	      of the completer functions to use. The available completer func‐
	      tions are described in the section `Control Functions' below.

	      Each string may be either the name of a completer function or  a
	      string  of the form `function:name'.  In the first case the com‐
	      pleter field of the context will contain the name	 of  the  com‐
	      pleter  without the leading underscore and with all other under‐
	      scores replaced by hyphens.  In the second case the function  is
	      the  name of the completer to call, but the context will contain
	      the user-defined name in the completer field of the context.  If
	      the  name	 starts with a hyphen, the string for the context will
	      be build from the name of the completer function as in the first
	      case with the name appended to it.  For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo

	      Here,  completion	 will call the _complete completer twice, once
	      using `complete' and once using `complete-foo' in the  completer
	      field  of	 the context.  Normally, using the same completer more
	      than once only makes sense when used with	 the  `functions:name'
	      form, because otherwise the context name will be the same in all
	      calls to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are the
	      _ignored and _prefix completers.

	      The  default  value for this style is `_complete _ignored': only
	      completion will be done, first using the ignored-patterns	 style
	      and the $fignore array and then without ignoring matches.

       condition
	      This  style is used by the _list completer function to decide if
	      insertion of matches  should  be	delayed	 unconditionally.  The
	      default is `true'.

       delimiters
	      This  style is used when adding a delimiter for use with history
	      modifiers or glob qualifiers that have delimited arguments.   It
	      is an array of preferred delimiters to add.  Non-special charac‐
	      ters are preferred as the completion system may otherwise become
	      confused.	  The  default list is :, +, /, -, %.  The list may be
	      empty to force a delimiter to be typed.

       disabled
	      If this is set to `true', the _expand_alias completer and	 bind‐
	      able  command  will  try	to  expand disabled aliases, too.  The
	      default is `false'.

       domains
	      A list of names of network domains for completion.  If  this  is
	      not   set,   domain   names   will   be	taken  from  the  file
	      /etc/resolv.conf.

       environ
	      The environ style is used when completing for `sudo'.  It is set
	      to  an  array of `VAR=value' assignments to be exported into the
	      local environment before the completion for the  target  command
	      is invoked.
	      zstyle ':completion:*:sudo::' environ \
		PATH="/sbin:/usr/sbin:$PATH" HOME="/root"

       expand This  style is used when completing strings consisting of multi‐
	      ple parts, such as path names.

	      If one of its values is the string `prefix', the partially typed
	      word  from  the line will be expanded as far as possible even if
	      trailing parts cannot be completed.

	      If one of its values is the string `suffix', matching names  for
	      components  after	 the  first  ambiguous one will also be added.
	      This means that the resulting string is the longest  unambiguous
	      string  possible.	 However, menu completion can be used to cycle
	      through all matches.

       fake   This style may be set for any completion context.	 It  specifies
	      additional  strings  that	 will always be completed in that con‐
	      text.  The form of each string is `value:description'; the colon
	      and  description may be omitted, but any literal colons in value
	      must be quoted with a backslash.	Any  description  provided  is
	      shown alongside the value in completion listings.

	      It  is  important to use a sufficiently restrictive context when
	      specifying fake strings.	Note that the  styles  fake-files  and
	      fake-parameters  provide	additional  features  when  completing
	      files or parameters.

       fake-always
	      This works  identically  to  the	fake  style  except  that  the
	      ignored-patterns style is not applied to it.  This makes it pos‐
	      sible to override a set of matches  completely  by  setting  the
	      ignored patterns to `*'.

	      The  following  shows  a way of supplementing any tag with arbi‐
	      trary data, but having it behave for  display  purposes  like  a
	      separate	tag.   In  this	 example  we  use  the features of the
	      tag-order style to divide the  named-directories	tag  into  two
	      when  performing completion with the standard completer complete
	      for arguments of cd.  The tag  named-directories-normal  behaves
	      as  normal,  but the tag named-directories-mine contains a fixed
	      set of directories.  This has the effect	of  adding  the	 match
	      group `extra directories' with the given completions.

		     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*' tag-order \
		       'named-directories:-mine:extra\ directories
		       named-directories:-normal:named\ directories *'
		     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
		       fake-always mydir1 mydir2
		     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
		       ignored-patterns '*'

       fake-files
	      This style is used when completing files and looked up without a
	      tag.  Its values are of the form `dir:names...'.	This will  add
	      the names (strings separated by spaces) as possible matches when
	      completing in the directory dir, even if no  such	 files	really
	      exist.   The  dir may be a pattern; pattern characters or colons
	      in dir should be quoted with a backslash to  be  treated	liter‐
	      ally.

	      This  can be useful on systems that support special file systems
	      whose top-level pathnames can not be listed  or  generated  with
	      glob  patterns.	It  can also be used for directories for which
	      one does not have read permission.

	      The pattern form can be used to add a certain `magic'  entry  to
	      all directories on a particular file system.

       fake-parameters
	      This  is	used  by  the completion function for parameter names.
	      Its values are names of parameters that might not yet be set but
	      should be completed nonetheless.	Each name may also be followed
	      by a colon and a string specifying the  type  of	the  parameter
	      (like  `scalar',	`array'	 or `integer').	 If the type is given,
	      the name will only be completed if parameters of that  type  are
	      required	in the particular context.  Names for which no type is
	      specified will always be completed.

       file-list
	      This style controls whether files completed using	 the  standard
	      builtin  mechanism  are to be listed with a long list similar to
	      ls -l.  Note that this feature uses the  shell  module  zsh/stat
	      for  file	 information;  this  loads the builtin stat which will
	      replace any external stat executable.  To avoid this the follow‐
	      ing code can be included in an initialization file:

		     zmodload -i zsh/stat
		     disable stat

	      The  style  may either be set to a true value (or `all'), or one
	      of the values `insert' or `list', indicating that files  are  to
	      be  listed in long format in all circumstances, or when attempt‐
	      ing to insert a file name, or when listing  file	names  without
	      attempting to insert one.

	      More  generally,	the  value may be an array of any of the above
	      values, optionally followed by =num.  If num is present it gives
	      the  maximum number of matches for which long listing style will
	      be used.	For example,

		     zstyle ':completion:*' file-list list=20 insert=10

	      specifies that long format will be used when listing  up	to  20
	      files  or	 inserting  a  file  with up to 10 matches (assuming a
	      listing is to be shown at all, for example on an ambiguous  com‐
	      pletion), else short format will be used.

		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' file-list '(( ${+NUMERIC} )) && reply=(true)'

	      specifies that long format will be used any time a numeric argu‐
	      ment is supplied, else short format.

       file-patterns
	      This is used by the standard function for completing  filenames,
	      _files.	If  the	 style	is unset up to three tags are offered,
	      `globbed-files',`directories' and `all-files', depending on  the
	      types of files  expected by the caller of _files.	 The first two
	      (`globbed-files'	and  `directories')   are   normally   offered
	      together to make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.

	      The  file-patterns  style	 provides  alternatives to the default
	      tags, which are not used.	 Its value consists of elements of the
	      form  `pattern:tag';  each string may contain any number of such
	      specifications separated by spaces.

	      The pattern is a pattern that is to be used  to  generate	 file‐
	      names.   Any  occurrence of the sequence `%p' is replaced by any
	      pattern(s) passed by the function calling _files.	 Colons in the
	      pattern  must  be	 preceded  by a backslash to make them distin‐
	      guishable from the colon before the tag.	If more than one  pat‐
	      tern  is	needed, the patterns can be given inside braces, sepa‐
	      rated by commas.

	      The tags of all strings in the value will be offered  by	_files
	      and  used	 when  looking	up other styles.  Any tags in the same
	      word will be offered at the same time and	 before	 later	words.
	      If no `:tag' is given the `files' tag will be used.

	      The  tag	may also be followed by an optional second colon and a
	      description, which will be used for the `%d' in the value of the
	      format style (if that is set) instead of the default description
	      supplied by the completion function.  If the  description	 given
	      here  contains itself a `%d', that is replaced with the descrip‐
	      tion supplied by the completion function.

	      For example, to make the rm command first complete only names of
	      object  files  and  then	the  names of all files if there is no
	      matching object file:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*' file-patterns \
			 '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'

	      To alter the default behaviour of file completion -- offer files
	      matching	a  pattern  and directories on the first attempt, then
	      all files -- to offer only matching files on the first  attempt,
	      then directories, and finally all files:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
			 '%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'

	      This  works  even	 where	there  is  no  special pattern: _files
	      matches all files using the pattern `*' at the  first  step  and
	      stops  when it sees this pattern.	 Note also it will never try a
	      pattern more than once for a single completion attempt.

	      During the execution of completion functions, the	 EXTENDED_GLOB
	      option  is  in  effect,  so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have
	      special meanings in the patterns.

       file-sort
	      The standard filename completion function uses this style	 with‐
	      out  a  tag  to  determine  in  which  order the names should be
	      listed; menu completion will cycle  through  them	 in  the  same
	      order.   The  possible values are: `size' to sort by the size of
	      the file; `links' to sort by the number of links	to  the	 file;
	      `modification' (or `time' or `date') to sort by the last modifi‐
	      cation time; `access' to sort  by	 the  last  access  time;  and
	      `inode' (or `change') to sort by the last inode change time.  If
	      the style is set to any other value, or is unset, files will  be
	      sorted alphabetically by name.  If the value contains the string
	      `reverse', sorting is done in the opposite order.	 If the	 value
	      contains the string `follow', timestamps are associated with the
	      targets of symbolic links; the default is to use the  timestamps
	      of the links themselves.

       filter This is used by the LDAP plugin for e-mail address completion to
	      specify the attributes to match against when filtering  entries.
	      So  for  example,	 if the style is set to `sn', matching is done
	      against surnames.	 Standard LDAP filtering  is  used  so	normal
	      completion  matching is bypassed.	 If this style is not set, the
	      LDAP plugin is skipped.  You may also need to  set  the  command
	      style to specify how to connect to your LDAP server.

       force-list
	      This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where
	      listing is done, even in cases where the list would  usually  be
	      suppressed.   For	 example,  normally  the list is only shown if
	      there are at least two different matches.	 By setting this style
	      to  `always',  the  list	will always be shown, even if there is
	      only a single match that	will  immediately  be  accepted.   The
	      style  may  also be set to a number.  In this case the list will
	      be shown if there are at least that many matches, even  if  they
	      would all insert the same string.

	      This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag
	      valid for the current completion.	  Hence	 the  listing  can  be
	      forced only for certain types of match.

       format If  this is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as a
	      string to	 display  above	 matches  in  completion  lists.   The
	      sequence	`%d'  in  this	string	will  be replaced with a short
	      description of what these matches are.   This  string  may  also
	      contain the following sequences to specify output attributes, as
	      described in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES  in  zsh‐
	      misc(1): `%B', `%S', `%U', `%F', `%K' and their lower case coun‐
	      terparts, as well as `%{...%}'.  `%F', `%K' and  `%{...%}'  take
	      arguments	 in  the same form as prompt expansion.	 Note that the
	      %G sequence is not available; an argument to `%{' should be used
	      instead.

	      The  style is tested with each tag valid for the current comple‐
	      tion before it is tested for the descriptions tag.   Hence  dif‐
	      ferent  format  strings  can  be	defined for different types of
	      match.

	      Note  also  that	some  completer	 functions  define  additional
	      `%'-sequences.   These are described for the completer functions
	      that make use of them.

	      Some completion functions display	 messages  that	 may  be  cus‐
	      tomised  by  setting this style for the messages tag.  Here, the
	      `%d' is replaced with a message given by	the  completion	 func‐
	      tion.

	      Finally,	the  format string is looked up with the warnings tag,
	      for use when no matches could be generated at all.  In this case
	      the  `%d' is replaced with the descriptions for the matches that
	      were  expected  separated	 by  spaces.   The  sequence  `%D'  is
	      replaced with the same descriptions separated by newlines.

	      It  is  possible to use printf-style field width specifiers with
	      `%d' and similar escape sequences.  This is handled by the zfor‐
	      mat  builtin  command  from  the	zsh/zutil  module, see zshmod‐
	      ules(1).

       glob   This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set  to	`true'
	      (the default), globbing will be attempted on the words resulting
	      from a previous substitution (see the substitute style) or  else
	      the original string from the line.

       global If  this	is set to `true' (the default), the _expand_alias com‐
	      pleter and bindable command will try to expand global aliases.

       group-name
	      The completion system can	 group	different  types  of  matches,
	      which  appear in separate lists.	This style can be used to give
	      the names of groups for particular tags.	For example,  in  com‐
	      mand  position  the completion system generates names of builtin
	      and external commands, names of  aliases,	 shell	functions  and
	      parameters  and reserved words as possible completions.  To have
	      the external commands and shell functions listed separately:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' group-name commands
		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' group-name functions

	      As a consequence, any match with the same tag will be  displayed
	      in the same group.

	      If  the  name  given is the empty string the name of the tag for
	      the matches will be used as the name of the group.  So, to  have
	      all  different  types  of	 matches displayed separately, one can
	      just set:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''

	      All matches for which no group name is defined will be put in  a
	      group named -default-.

       group-order
	      This  style is additional to the group-name style to specify the
	      order for display of the groups defined by that  style  (compare
	      tag-order,  which	 determines  which completions appear at all).
	      The groups named are shown in the given order; any other	groups
	      are shown in the order defined by the completion function.

	      For  example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions
	      and external commands appear in that order  when	completing  in
	      command position:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' group-order \
			    builtins functions commands

       groups A list of names of UNIX groups.  If this is not set, group names
	      are taken from the YP database or the file `/etc/group'.

       hidden If this is set to true, matches for the given context  will  not
	      be listed, although any description for the matches set with the
	      format style will be shown.  If it is set to `all', not even the
	      description will be displayed.

	      Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not
	      shown in the list.  To avoid having matches considered as possi‐
	      ble  completions	at all, the tag-order style can be modified as
	      described below.

       hosts  A list of names of hosts that should be completed.  If  this  is
	      not set, hostnames are taken from the file `/etc/hosts'.

       hosts-ports
	      This style is used by commands that need or accept hostnames and
	      network ports.  The strings in the value should be of  the  form
	      `host:port'.   Valid  ports  are	determined  by the presence of
	      hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.

       ignore-line
	      This is tested for each tag valid for  the  current  completion.
	      If  it  is  set to `true', none of the words that are already on
	      the line will be considered as possible completions.  If	it  is
	      set  to `current', the word the cursor is on will not be consid‐
	      ered as a possible completion.   The  value  `current-shown'  is
	      similar but only applies if the list of completions is currently
	      shown on the screen.  Finally, if the style is set  to  `other',
	      all  words  on  the  line	 except	 for  the  current one will be
	      excluded from the possible completions.

	      The values `current' and `current-shown'	are  a	bit  like  the
	      opposite	of  the accept-exact style:  only strings with missing
	      characters will be completed.

	      Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to	`true'
	      or  `other' for a general context such as `:completion:*'.  This
	      is because it would disallow completion of, for example, options
	      multiple	times  even  if	 the  command  in question accepts the
	      option more than once.

       ignore-parents
	      The style is tested without a tag	 by  the  function  completing
	      pathnames	 in  order to determine whether to ignore the names of
	      directories already mentioned in the current word, or  the  name
	      of the current working directory.	 The value must include one or
	      both of the following strings:

	      parent The name of any directory whose path is already contained
		     in	 the  word  on the line is ignored.  For example, when
		     completing after foo/../, the directory foo will  not  be
		     considered a valid completion.

	      pwd    The  name	of  the	 current working directory will not be
		     completed; hence, for example, completion after ../  will
		     not use the name of the current directory.

	      In addition, the value may include one or both of:

	      ..     Ignore  the  specified  directories only when the word on
		     the line contains the substring `../'.

	      directory
		     Ignore the	 specified  directories	 only  when  names  of
		     directories  are  completed, not when completing names of
		     files.

	      Excluded values act in  a	 similar  fashion  to  values  of  the
	      ignored-patterns style, so they can be restored to consideration
	      by the _ignored completer.

       extra-verbose
	      If set, the completion listing is more verbose at the cost of  a
	      probable	decrease  in completion speed.	Completion performance
	      will suffer if this style is set to `true'.

       ignored-patterns
	      A list of patterns; any trial completion	matching  one  of  the
	      patterns will be excluded from consideration.  The _ignored com‐
	      pleter can appear in the	list  of  completers  to  restore  the
	      ignored  matches.	  This	is  a more configurable version of the
	      shell parameter $fignore.

	      Note that the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set during	the  execution
	      of completion functions, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have
	      special meanings in the patterns.

       insert This style is used  by  the  _all_matches	 completer  to	decide
	      whether  to  insert  the	list  of  all  matches unconditionally
	      instead of adding the list as another match.

       insert-ids
	      When completing process IDs, for example	as  arguments  to  the
	      kill and wait builtins the name of a command may be converted to
	      the appropriate process ID.  A problem arises when  the  process
	      name  typed  is not unique.  By default (or if this style is set
	      explicitly to `menu') the name will be converted immediately  to
	      a	 set  of  possible IDs, and menu completion will be started to
	      cycle through them.

	      If the value of the style is `single', the shell will wait until
	      the user has typed enough to make the command unique before con‐
	      verting the name to an ID; attempts at completion will be unsuc‐
	      cessful  until  that  point.   If the value is any other string,
	      menu completion will be started when the	string	typed  by  the
	      user is longer than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.

       insert-tab
	      If  this	is  set to `true', the completion system will insert a
	      TAB character (assuming  that  was  used	to  start  completion)
	      instead  of  performing  completion  when	 there is no non-blank
	      character to the left of the cursor.  If it is set  to  `false',
	      completion will be done even there.

	      The  value  may  also contain the substrings `pending' or `pend‐
	      ing=val'.	 In this case, the typed character  will  be  inserted
	      instead  of  starting completion when there is unprocessed input
	      pending.	If a val is given, completion  will  not  be  done  if
	      there  are  at  least that many characters of unprocessed input.
	      This is often useful when pasting characters  into  a  terminal.
	      Note  however,  that it relies on the $PENDING special parameter
	      from the zsh/zle module being set properly which is not  guaran‐
	      teed on all platforms.

	      The  default value of this style is `true' except for completion
	      within vared builtin command where it is `false'.

       insert-unambiguous
	      This is used by the _match and _approximate  completers.	 These
	      completers  are  often  used with menu completion since the word
	      typed may bear little resemblance to the final completion.  How‐
	      ever,  if	 this  style  is `true', the completer will start menu
	      completion only if it could find no unambiguous  initial	string
	      at least as long as the original string typed by the user.

	      In  the  case of the _approximate completer, the completer field
	      in the context will already have been set to one of  correct-num
	      or  approximate-num, where num is the number of errors that were
	      accepted.

	      In the case of the _match completer, the style may also  be  set
	      to  the  string `pattern'.  Then the pattern on the line is left
	      unchanged if it does not match unambiguously.

       keep-prefix
	      This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it  is  `true',
	      the  completer  will  try to keep a prefix containing a tilde or
	      parameter expansion.  Hence,  for	 example,  the	string	`~/f*'
	      would  be	 expanded  to `~/foo' instead of `/home/user/foo'.  If
	      the style is set to `changed' (the  default),  the  prefix  will
	      only  be	left unchanged if there were other changes between the
	      expanded words and the original word from the command line.  Any
	      other value forces the prefix to be expanded unconditionally.

	      The  behaviour  of  expand  when	this style is true is to cause
	      _expand to give up when a single	expansion  with	 the  restored
	      prefix  is  the  same  as the original; hence any remaining com‐
	      pleters may be called.

       last-prompt
	      This is a more flexible form of the  ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT  option.
	      If it is true, the completion system will try to return the cur‐
	      sor to the previous command line after displaying	 a  completion
	      list.   It  is tested for all tags valid for the current comple‐
	      tion, then the default tag.  The cursor will be  moved  back  to
	      the  previous  line  if  this  style  is `true' for all types of
	      match.  Note that unlike the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option  this  is
	      independent of the numeric prefix argument.

       known-hosts-files
	      This  style  should  contain  a list of files to search for host
	      names and (if the use-ip style is set) IP addresses in a	format
	      compatible  with	ssh  known_hosts files.	 If it is not set, the
	      files /etc/ssh/ssh_known_hosts and ~/.ssh/known_hosts are used.

       list   This style is used by the _history_complete_word	bindable  com‐
	      mand.  If it is set to `true' it has no effect.  If it is set to
	      `false' matches will not be listed.  This overrides the  setting
	      of  the  options	controlling  listing  behaviour, in particular
	      AUTO_LIST.  The context  always  starts  with  `:completion:his‐
	      tory-words'.

       list-colors
	      If  the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to
	      set color specifications.	 This mechanism replaces  the  use  of
	      the  ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters described in the sec‐
	      tion `The zsh/complist Module' in zshmodules(1), but the	syntax
	      is the same.

	      If  this	style  is  set for the default tag, the strings in the
	      value are taken as specifications that are  to  be  used	every‐
	      where.  If it is set for other tags, the specifications are used
	      only for matches of the type described by the tag.  For this  to
	      work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty string.

	      In addition to setting styles for specific tags, it is also pos‐
	      sible to use group names specified explicitly by the  group-name
	      tag together with the `(group)' syntax allowed by the ZLS_COLORS
	      and ZLS_COLOURS parameters and simply using the default tag.

	      It is possible to use any color specifications  already  set  up
	      for the GNU version of the ls command:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors ${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}

	      The  default  colors  are the same as for the GNU ls command and
	      can be obtained by setting the style to an  empty	 string	 (i.e.
	      '').

       list-dirs-first
	      This is used by file completion.	If set, directories to be com‐
	      pleted are listed separately  from  and  before  completion  for
	      other  files,  regardless of tag ordering.  In addition, the tag
	      other-files is used in place  of	all-files  for	the  remaining
	      files,  to  indicate that no directories are presented with that
	      tag.

       list-grouped
	      If this style is `true' (the  default),  the  completion	system
	      will  try	 to  make  certain completion listings more compact by
	      grouping matches.	 For example, options for commands  that  have
	      the  same	 description  (shown  when the verbose style is set to
	      `true') will appear as a single entry.  However, menu  selection
	      can be used to cycle through all the matches.

       list-packed
	      This is tested for each tag valid in the current context as well
	      as the default tag.  If it is set to `true',  the	 corresponding
	      matches  appear  in  listings  as if the LIST_PACKED option were
	      set.  If it is set to `false', they are listed normally.

       list-prompt
	      If this style is set for the default tag, completion lists  that
	      don't  fit on the screen can be scrolled (see the description of
	      the zsh/complist module in zshmodules(1)).  The  value,  if  not
	      the  empty  string,  will be displayed after every screenful and
	      the shell will prompt for a key press; if the style  is  set  to
	      the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

	      The  value may contain the escape sequences: `%l' or `%L', which
	      will be replaced by the number of the last  line	displayed  and
	      the total number of lines; `%m' or `%M', the number of the  last
	      match shown and the total number of matches; and `%p' and	 `%P',
	      `Top'  when  at  the beginning of the list, `Bottom' when at the
	      end and the position shown as a percentage of the	 total	length
	      otherwise.  In each case the form with the uppercase letter will
	      be replaced by a string of fixed width,  padded  to  the	 right
	      with  spaces,  while  the	 lowercase  form will be replaced by a
	      variable width string.  As in other prompt strings,  the	escape
	      sequences	 `%S',	`%s',  `%B', `%b', `%U', `%u' for entering and
	      leaving the display modes	 standout,  bold  and  underline,  and
	      `%F',  `%f',  `%K',  `%k' for changing the foreground background
	      colour, are also available, as is the form `%{...%}' for enclos‐
	      ing escape sequences which display with zero (or, with a numeric
	      argument, some other) width.

	      After deleting this prompt the  variable	LISTPROMPT  should  be
	      unset for the removal to take effect.

       list-rows-first
	      This  style  is  tested in the same way as the list-packed style
	      and determines whether matches are to be listed in a  rows-first
	      fashion as if the LIST_ROWS_FIRST option were set.

       list-suffixes
	      This style is used by the function that completes filenames.  If
	      it is true, and completion is attempted on a  string  containing
	      multiple partially typed pathname components, all ambiguous com‐
	      ponents will be shown.  Otherwise, completion stops at the first
	      ambiguous component.

       list-separator
	      The  value  of this style is used in completion listing to sepa‐
	      rate the string to complete from	a  description	when  possible
	      (e.g.  when  completing  options).   It  defaults	 to  `--' (two
	      hyphens).

       local  This is for use with functions that complete URLs for which  the
	      corresponding files are available directly from the file system.
	      Its value should consist of three strings: a hostname, the  path
	      to  the default web pages for the server, and the directory name
	      used by a user placing web pages within their home area.

	      For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \
			 /var/http/public/toast public_html

	      Completion after `http://toast/stuff/' will look	for  files  in
	      the  directory  /var/http/public/toast/stuff,   while completion
	      after `http://toast/~yousir/' will look for files in the	direc‐
	      tory ~yousir/public_html.

       mail-directory
	      If  set,	zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found in the
	      directory specified.  It defaults to `~/Mail'.

       match-original
	      This is used by the _match completer.  If it  is	set  to	 only,
	      _match  will  try to generate matches without inserting a `*' at
	      the cursor position.  If set to any other	 non-empty  value,  it
	      will first try to generate matches without inserting the `*' and
	      if that yields no matches,  it  will  try	 again	with  the  `*'
	      inserted.	  If  it is unset or set to the empty string, matching
	      will only be performed with the `*' inserted.

       matcher
	      This style is tested separately for each tag valid in  the  cur‐
	      rent  context.   Its  value is added to any match specifications
	      given by the matcher-list style.	 It  should  be	 in  the  form
	      described	 in  the section `Completion Matching Control' in zsh‐
	      compwid(1).

       matcher-list
	      This style can be set to a list of match specifications that are
	      to  be applied everywhere. Match specifications are described in
	      the section `Completion Matching Control' in zshcompwid(1).  The
	      completion  system will try them one after another for each com‐
	      pleter selected.	For example, to try  first  simple  completion
	      and, if that generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

	      By  default  each	 specification replaces the previous one; how‐
	      ever, if a specification is prefixed with +, it is added to  the
	      existing list.  Hence it is possible to create increasingly gen‐
	      eral specifications without repetition:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' '+m{a-z}={A-Z}' '+m{A-Z}={a-z}'

	      It is possible to create match specifications valid for particu‐
	      lar  completers  by  using  the third field of the context.  For
	      example, to use the completers _complete and  _prefix  but  only
	      allow case-insensitive completion with _complete:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
			    '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

	      User-defined  names,  as	explained for the completer style, are
	      available.  This makes it possible to  try  the  same  completer
	      more  than  once	with different match specifications each time.
	      For example, to try normal completion without a match specifica‐
	      tion,  then  normal  completion  with case-insensitive matching,
	      then correction, and finally partial-word completion:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct _complete:foo
		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
			 '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
		     zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*' matcher-list \
			 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'

	      If the style is unset in any context no match  specification  is
	      applied.	 Note  also  that some completers such as _correct and
	      _approximate do not use the match specifications at all,	though
	      these  completers	 will  only  ever  be  called once even if the
	      matcher-list contains more than one element.

	      Where multiple specifications are useful, note that  the	entire
	      completion  is  done for each element of matcher-list, which can
	      quickly reduce the shell's performance.	As  a  rough  rule  of
	      thumb,  one  to  three strings will give acceptable performance.
	      On the other hand, putting multiple space-separated values  into
	      the  same	 string does not have an appreciable impact on perfor‐
	      mance.

	      If there is no current matcher or it is empty,  and  the	option
	      NO_CASE_GLOB  is	in effect, the matching for files is performed
	      case-insensitively in  any  case.	  However,  any	 matcher  must
	      explicitly   specify   case-insensitive	matching  if  that  is
	      required.

       max-errors
	      This is used by the _approximate and  _correct  completer	 func‐
	      tions  to	 determine the maximum number of errors to allow.  The
	      completer will try to generate completions by first allowing one
	      error,  then  two	 errors,  and  so  on, until either a match or
	      matches were found or the maximum number of errors given by this
	      style has been reached.

	      If  the  value for this style contains the string `numeric', the
	      completer function will take any numeric argument as the maximum
	      number of errors allowed. For example, with

		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric

	      two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with
	      a numeric argument of six (as in `ESC-6 TAB'), up to six	errors
	      are  accepted.  Hence with a value of `0 numeric', no correcting
	      completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument is given.

	      If the value contains the string	`not-numeric',	the  completer
	      will  not	 try  to  generate  corrected completions when given a
	      numeric argument, so in this case the  number  given  should  be
	      greater  than zero.  For example, `2 not-numeric' specifies that
	      correcting completion with two errors will usually be performed,
	      but  if  a numeric argument is given, correcting completion will
	      not be performed.

	      The default value for this style is `2 numeric'.

       max-matches-width
	      This style is used to determine the trade off between the	 width
	      of  the  display	used  for matches and the width used for their
	      descriptions when the verbose style is  in  effect.   The	 value
	      gives  the number of display columns to reserve for the matches.
	      The default is half the width of the screen.

	      This has the most impact when  several  matches  have  the  same
	      description  and	so  will  be grouped together.	Increasing the
	      style will allow more matches to be grouped together; decreasing
	      it will allow more of the description to be visible.

       menu   If  this	is  true in the context of any of the tags defined for
	      the current completion menu completion will be used.  The	 value
	      for  a  specific	tag  will  take	 precedence  over that for the
	      `default' tag.

	      If none of the values found in this way is true but at least one
	      is  set  to `auto', the shell behaves as if the AUTO_MENU option
	      is set.

	      If one of the values is explicitly set to false, menu completion
	      will  be	explicitly  turned  off,  overriding the MENU_COMPLETE
	      option and other settings.

	      In the form `yes=num', where `yes' may be any of the true values
	      (`yes', `true', `on' and `1'), menu completion will be turned on
	      if there are at least num matches.  In the form `yes=long', menu
	      completion  will	be  turned  on if the list does not fit on the
	      screen.  This does not activate menu completion  if  the	widget
	      normally	only  lists  completions,  but	menu completion can be
	      activated in that case with  the	value  `yes=long-list'	(Typi‐
	      cally, the value `select=long-list' described later is more use‐
	      ful as it provides control over scrolling.)

	      Similarly, with any of the `false' values (as in `no=10'),  menu
	      completion will not be used if there are num or more matches.

	      The value of this widget also controls menu selection, as imple‐
	      mented by the zsh/complist module.   The	following  values  may
	      appear either alongside or instead of the values above.

	      If  the  value contains the string `select', menu selection will
	      be started unconditionally.

	      In the form `select=num', menu selection will only be started if
	      there are at least num matches.  If the values for more than one
	      tag provide a number, the smallest number is taken.

	      Menu selection can be turned off explicitly by defining a	 value
	      containing the string`no-select'.

	      It  is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of
	      matches  does  not  fit  on  the	screen	by  using  the	 value
	      `select=long'.  To start menu selection even if the current wid‐
	      get only performs listing, use the value `select=long-list'.

	      To turn on menu completion or menu selection when a there are  a
	      certain number of matches or the list of matches does not fit on
	      the screen, both of `yes=' and `select='	may  be	 given	twice,
	      once with a number and once with `long' or `long-list'.

	      Finally,	it  is	possible to activate two special modes of menu
	      selection.  The word `interactive' in the value causes  interac‐
	      tive  mode  to  be  entered  immediately	when menu selection is
	      started; see the description of the zsh/complist module in  zsh‐
	      modules(1) for a description of interactive mode.	 Including the
	      string `search' does the same for incremental search  mode.   To
	      select   backward	  incremental	search,	  include  the	string
	      `search-backward'.

       muttrc If set, gives the location of the mutt configuration  file.   It
	      defaults to `~/.muttrc'.

       numbers
	      This is used with the jobs tag.  If it is `true', the shell will
	      complete job numbers instead of the shortest unambiguous	prefix
	      of  the job command text.	 If the value is a number, job numbers
	      will only be used if that many words from the  job  descriptions
	      are  required to resolve ambiguities.  For example, if the value
	      is `1', strings will only be used if  all	 jobs  differ  in  the
	      first word on their command lines.

       old-list
	      This  is	used  by  the  _oldlist	 completer.   If  it is set to
	      `always', then  standard	widgets	 which	perform	 listing  will
	      retain the current list of matches, however they were generated;
	      this can be turned off explicitly with the value `never', giving
	      the  behaviour  without the _oldlist completer.  If the style is
	      unset, or any other value, then the existing list of completions
	      is  displayed if it is not already; otherwise, the standard com‐
	      pletion list is generated; this  is  the	default	 behaviour  of
	      _oldlist.	  However, if there is an old list and this style con‐
	      tains the name of the  completer	function  that	generated  the
	      list, then the old list will be used even if it was generated by
	      a widget which does not do listing.

	      For example, suppose you type ^Xc to use the _correct_word  wid‐
	      get,  which  generates  a list of corrections for the word under
	      the cursor.  Usually, typing ^D would generate a	standard  list
	      of  completions for the word on the command line, and show that.
	      With _oldlist, it will instead  show  the	 list  of  corrections
	      already generated.

	      As  another  example  consider  the  _match  completer: with the
	      insert-unambiguous style set to `true' it inserts only a	common
	      prefix  string, if there is any.	However, this may remove parts
	      of the original pattern, so that further completion  could  pro‐
	      duce  more  matches  than	 on  the  first attempt.  By using the
	      _oldlist completer and setting this style to _match, the list of
	      matches generated on the first attempt will be used again.

       old-matches
	      This  is	used by the _all_matches completer to decide if an old
	      list of matches should be used if one exists.  This is  selected
	      by  one  of  the	`true' values or by the string `only'.	If the
	      value is `only', _all_matches will only  use  an	old  list  and
	      won't  have  any	effect	on the list of matches currently being
	      generated.

	      If this style  is	 set  it  is  generally	 unwise	 to  call  the
	      _all_matches completer unconditionally.  One possible use is for
	      either this style or the completer style to be defined with  the
	      -e option to zstyle to make the style conditional.

       old-menu
	      This  is	used  by the _oldlist completer.  It controls how menu
	      completion behaves when a completion has already	been  inserted
	      and  the	user types a standard completion key such as TAB.  The
	      default behaviour of _oldlist is	that  menu  completion	always
	      continues	 with the existing list of completions.	 If this style
	      is set to `false', however, a new completion is started  if  the
	      old  list	 was generated by a different completion command; this
	      is the behaviour without the _oldlist completer.

	      For example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a list of  correc‐
	      tions,  and menu completion is started in one of the usual ways.
	      Usually, or with this style set to false,	 typing	 TAB  at  this
	      point would start trying to complete the line as it now appears.
	      With _oldlist, it instead continues to cycle through the list of
	      corrections.

       original
	      This  is	used  by  the  _approximate and _correct completers to
	      decide if the original string should be added as a possible com‐
	      pletion.	 Normally, this is done only if there are at least two
	      possible corrections, but if this style is set to `true', it  is
	      always  added.   Note  that  the style will be examined with the
	      completer field in  the  context	name  set  to  correct-num  or
	      approximate-num,	where  num  is	the number of errors that were
	      accepted.

       packageset
	      This style is used  when	completing  arguments  of  the	Debian
	      `dpkg' program.  It contains an override for the default package
	      set for a given context.	For example,

		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
				    packageset avail

	      causes available packages, rather than only installed  packages,
	      to be completed for `dpkg --status'.

       path   The function that completes color names uses this style with the
	      colors tag.  The value should be the pathname of a file contain‐
	      ing  color  names	 in the format of an X11 rgb.txt file.	If the
	      style is not set but this file is found in one of various	 stan‐
	      dard locations it will be used as the default.

       path-completion
	      This  is used by filename completion.  By default, filename com‐
	      pletion examines all components of a path to see	if  there  are
	      completions  of that component.  For example, /u/b/z can be com‐
	      pleted to /usr/bin/zsh.  Explicitly setting this style to	 false
	      inhibits	this  behaviour for path components up to the / before
	      the cursor; this overrides the setting of accept-exact-dirs.

	      Even with the style set to false, it is still possible  to  com‐
	      plete  multiple paths by setting the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD and
	      moving the cursor back to the first component in the path to  be
	      completed.  For example, /u/b/z can be completed to /usr/bin/zsh
	      if the cursor is after the /u.

       pine-directory
	      If set, specifies the directory containing PINE  mailbox	files.
	      There  is no default, since recursively searching this directory
	      is inconvenient for anyone who doesn't use PINE.

       ports  A list of Internet service names (network	 ports)	 to  complete.
	      If  this	is  not	 set,  service	names  are taken from the file
	      `/etc/services'.

       prefix-hidden
	      This is used for certain completions which share a  common  pre‐
	      fix,  for	 example command options beginning with dashes.	 If it
	      is `true', the prefix will not be shown in the list of matches.

	      The default value for this style is `false'.

       prefix-needed
	      This style is also relevant for matches with  a  common  prefix.
	      If  it  is set to `true' this common prefix must be typed by the
	      user to generate the matches.

	      The style is applicable to the  options,	signals,  jobs,	 func‐
	      tions, and parameters completion tags.

	      For  command  options,  this means that the initial `-', `+', or
	      `--' must be typed explicitly before option names will  be  com‐
	      pleted.

	      For signals, an initial `-' is required before signal names will
	      be completed.

	      For jobs, an initial `%' is required before job  names  will  be
	      completed.

	      For  function  and  parameter  names,  an	 initial `_' or `.' is
	      required before function or parameter names starting with	 those
	      characters will be completed.

	      The  default  value  for	this style is `false' for function and
	      parameter completions, and  `true' otherwise.

       preserve-prefix
	      This style is used when completing path names.  Its value should
	      be  a pattern matching an initial prefix of the word to complete
	      that should be left  unchanged  under  all  circumstances.   For
	      example,	on  some  Unices  an initial `//' (double slash) has a
	      special meaning; setting this style to the string `//' will pre‐
	      serve it.	 As another example, setting this style to `?:/' under
	      Cygwin would allow completion after `a:/...' and so on.

       range  This is used by the _history  completer  and  the	 _history_com‐
	      plete_word bindable command to decide which words should be com‐
	      pleted.

	      If it is a singe number, only the last N words from the  history
	      will be completed.

	      If  it  is a range of the form `max:slice', the last slice words
	      will be completed; then if that yields  no  matches,  the	 slice
	      words  before those will be tried and so on.  This process stops
	      either when at least one match was been found, or max words have
	      been tried.

	      The default is to complete all words from the history at once.

       recursive-files
	      If  this	style  is set, its value is an array of patterns to be
	      tested against `$PWD/': note the trailing	 slash,	 which	allows
	      directories  in  the  pattern  to	 be delimited unambiguously by
	      including slashes on both sides.	If an ordinary file completion
	      fails  and  the  word  on	 the  command line does not yet have a
	      directory part to its name, the style  is	 retrieved  using  the
	      same tag as for the completion just attempted, then the elements
	      tested against $PWD/ in turn.  If one matches,  then  the	 shell
	      reattempts completion by prepending the word on the command line
	      with each directory in the expansion of **/*(/) in turn.	 Typi‐
	      cally the elements of the style will be set to restrict the num‐
	      ber of directories beneath the current one to a manageable  num‐
	      ber, for example `*/.git/*'.

	      For example,

		     zstyle ':completion:*' recursive-files '*/zsh/*'

	      If  the  current	directory is /home/pws/zsh/Src, then zle_trTAB
	      can be completed to Zle/zle_tricky.c.

       regular
	      This style is used by the _expand_alias completer	 and  bindable
	      command.	 If  set to `true' (the default), regular aliases will
	      be expanded but only in command  position.   If  it  is  set  to
	      `false',	regular aliases will never be expanded.	  If it is set
	      to `always', regular aliases will be expanded  even  if  not  in
	      command position.

       rehash If  this	is set when completing external commands, the internal
	      list (hash) of commands will be updated for each search by issu‐
	      ing the rehash command.  There is a speed penalty for this which
	      is only likely to be noticeable when  directories	 in  the  path
	      have slow file access.

       remote-access
	      If  set to false, certain commands will be prevented from making
	      Internet	connections  to	 retrieve  remote  information.	  This
	      includes the completion for the CVS command.

	      It  is not always possible to know if connections are in fact to
	      a remote site, so some may be prevented unnecessarily.

       remove-all-dups
	      The _history_complete_word bindable  command  and	 the  _history
	      completer	 use this to decide if all duplicate matches should be
	      removed, rather than just consecutive duplicates.

       select-prompt
	      If this is set for the default tag, its value will be  displayed
	      during  menu  selection (see the menu style above) when the com‐
	      pletion list does not fit on the screen as a  whole.   The  same
	      escapes as for the list-prompt style are understood, except that
	      the numbers refer to the match  or  line	the  mark  is  on.   A
	      default prompt is used when the value is the empty string.

       select-scroll
	      This  style  is  tested for the default tag and determines how a
	      completion list is scrolled during a  menu  selection  (see  the
	      menu  style  above) when the completion list does not fit on the
	      screen as a whole.  If the value is  `0'	(zero),	 the  list  is
	      scrolled	by  half-screenfuls;  if it is a positive integer, the
	      list is scrolled by the given number of lines; if it is a	 nega‐
	      tive number, the list is scrolled by a screenful minus the abso‐
	      lute value of the given number of	 lines.	  The  default	is  to
	      scroll by single lines.

       separate-sections
	      This style is used with the manuals tag when completing names of
	      manual pages.  If it is `true', entries for  different  sections
	      are  added  separately  using  tag names of the form `manual.X',
	      where X is the section number.  When  the	 group-name  style  is
	      also  in effect, pages from different sections will appear sepa‐
	      rately.  This style is also used similarly with the words	 style
	      when completing words for the dict command. It allows words from
	      different dictionary databases  to  be  added  separately.   The
	      default for this style is `false'.

       show-completer
	      Tested  whenever	a  new completer is tried.  If it is true, the
	      completion system outputs a progress message in the listing area
	      showing  what  completer	is  being  tried.  The message will be
	      overwritten by any output when  completions  are	found  and  is
	      removed after completion is finished.

       single-ignored
	      This  is	used  by the _ignored completer when there is only one
	      match.  If its value is `show', the single match	will  be  dis‐
	      played  but not inserted.	 If the value is `menu', then the sin‐
	      gle match and the original string are both added as matches  and
	      menu  completion	is started, making it easy to select either of
	      them.

       sort   Many completion widgets call _description at  some  point	 which
	      decides  whether the matches are added sorted or unsorted (often
	      indirectly via _wanted or _requested).  This style  can  be  set
	      explicitly  to one of the usual true or false values as an over‐
	      ride.  If it is not set for the context, the standard  behaviour
	      of the calling widget is used.

	      The style is tested first against the full context including the
	      tag, and if that fails to produce a value	 against  the  context
	      without the tag.

	      If the calling widget explicitly requests unsorted matches, this
	      is usually honoured.  However, the default (unsorted)  behaviour
	      of  completion for the command history may be overridden by set‐
	      ting the style to true.

	      In the _expand completer, if it is set to `true', the expansions
	      generated	 will  always be sorted.  If it is set to `menu', then
	      the expansions are only sorted when they are offered  as	single
	      strings  but  not	 in  the string containing all possible expan‐
	      sions.

       special-dirs
	      Normally, the completion code will  not  produce	the  directory
	      names  `.'  and  `..' as possible completions.  If this style is
	      set to `true', it will add both `.' and `..' as possible comple‐
	      tions; if it is set to `..', only `..' will be added.

	      The following example sets special-dirs to `..' when the current
	      prefix is empty, is a single `.', or consists  only  of  a  path
	      beginning with `../'.  Otherwise the value is `false'.

		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \
			'[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'

       squeeze-slashes
	      If  set  to  `true', sequences of slashes in filename paths (for
	      example in `foo//bar') will be treated as a single slash.	  This
	      is  the  usual behaviour of UNIX paths.  However, by default the
	      file completion function behaves as if there were a `*'  between
	      the slashes.

       stop   If  set  to  `true', the _history_complete_word bindable command
	      will stop once when reaching the beginning or end	 of  the  his‐
	      tory.   Invoking _history_complete_word will then wrap around to
	      the opposite end of the  history.	  If  this  style  is  set  to
	      `false'  (the default), _history_complete_word will loop immedi‐
	      ately as in a menu completion.

       strip-comments
	      If set to `true', this style causes non-essential	 comment  text
	      to  be  removed  from  completion matches.  Currently it is only
	      used when completing e-mail addresses where it removes any  dis‐
	      play  name  from	the  addresses,	 cutting  them	down  to plain
	      user@host form.

       subst-globs-only
	      This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to  `true',
	      the  expansion  will  only be used if it resulted from globbing;
	      hence, if expansions resulted from the  use  of  the  substitute
	      style  described	below,	but  these were not further changed by
	      globbing, the expansions will be rejected.

	      The default for this style is `false'.

       substitute
	      This boolean style controls whether the _expand  completer  will
	      first  try  to  expand  all substitutions in the string (such as
	      `$(...)' and `${...}').

	      The default is `true'.

       suffix This is used by the _expand completer if the word starts with  a
	      tilde  or	 contains  a  parameter	 expansion.   If  it is set to
	      `true', the word will only be expanded if it doesn't have a suf‐
	      fix,  i.e.  if it is something like `~foo' or `$foo' rather than
	      `~foo/' or `$foo/bar', unless that suffix itself contains	 char‐
	      acters  eligible	for  expansion.	 The default for this style is
	      `true'.

       tag-order
	      This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available  in
	      a particular context will be used.

	      The  values  for	the style are sets of space-separated lists of
	      tags.  The tags in each value will be tried at the same time; if
	      no  match	 is found, the next value is used.  (See the file-pat‐
	      terns style for an exception to this behavior.)

	      For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*' tag-order \
			 'commands functions'

	      specifies that  completion  in  command  position	 first	offers
	      external	commands  and shell functions.	Remaining tags will be
	      tried if no completions are found.

	      In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take  one
	      of the following forms:

	      -	     If	 any  value  consists  of only a hyphen, then only the
		     tags specified in the other values are  generated.	  Nor‐
		     mally  all tags not explicitly selected are tried last if
		     the specified tags fail to generate  any  matches.	  This
		     means  that  a  single  value consisting only of a single
		     hyphen turns off completion.

	      ! tags...
		     A string starting	with  an  exclamation  mark  specifies
		     names of tags that are not to be used.  The effect is the
		     same as if all other possible tags for  the  context  had
		     been listed.

	      tag:label ...
		     Here,  tag	 is  one  of the standard tags and label is an
		     arbitrary name.  Matches are generated as normal but  the
		     name  label  is used in contexts instead of tag.  This is
		     not useful in words starting with !.

		     If the label starts with a hyphen, the tag	 is  prepended
		     to	 the label to form the name used for lookup.  This can
		     be used to make the completion system try a  certain  tag
		     more  than	 once,	supplying different style settings for
		     each attempt; see below for an example.

	      tag:label:description
		     As before, but description will replace the `%d'  in  the
		     value of the format style instead of the default descrip‐
		     tion supplied by the completion function.	Spaces in  the
		     description  must	be  quoted  with  a backslash.	A `%d'
		     appearing in description is replaced with the description
		     given by the completion function.

	      In  any  of  the forms above the tag may be a pattern or several
	      patterns in the form `{pat1,pat2...}'.  In this case all	match‐
	      ing  tags	 will  be  used except for any given explicitly in the
	      same string.

	      One use of these features is to try one tag more than once, set‐
	      ting  other styles differently on each attempt, but still to use
	      all the other tags without having to repeat them all.  For exam‐
	      ple,  to	make  completion of function names in command position
	      ignore all the completion functions starting with an  underscore
	      the first time completion is tried:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' tag-order \
			 'functions:-non-comp *' functions
		     zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' ignored-patterns '_*'

	      On the first attempt, all tags will be offered but the functions
	      tag will be replaced by  functions-non-comp.   The  ignored-pat‐
	      terns  style  is	set for this tag to exclude functions starting
	      with an underscore.  If there are no matches, the	 second	 value
	      of  the  tag-order style is used which completes functions using
	      the default tag, this time  presumably  including	 all  function
	      names.

	      The matches for one tag can be split into different groups.  For
	      example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
			 'options:-long:long\ options
			  options:-short:short\ options
			  options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'

		     zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
		     zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
		     zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' ignored-patterns '???*'

	      With the group-names style set,  options	beginning  with	 `--',
	      options beginning with a single `-' or `+' but containing multi‐
	      ple characters, and single-letter options will be	 displayed  in
	      separate groups with different descriptions.

	      Another  use of patterns is to try multiple match specifications
	      one after another.  The matcher-list style offers something sim‐
	      ilar,  but  it is tested very early in the completion system and
	      hence can't be set for single commands  nor  for	more  specific
	      contexts.	  Here	is  how	 to  try normal completion without any
	      match specification and, if that generates no matches, try again
	      with  case-insensitive matching, restricting the effect to argu‐
	      ments of the command foo:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
		     zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'

	      First, all the tags offered when completing after foo are	 tried
	      using  the  normal  tag name.  If that generates no matches, the
	      second value of tag-order is used, which tries  all  tags	 again
	      except  that  this  time each has -case appended to its name for
	      lookup of styles.	 Hence this time the  value  for  the  matcher
	      style  from  the second call to zstyle in the example is used to
	      make completion case-insensitive.

	      It is possible to use the -e option of the zstyle	 builtin  com‐
	      mand  to specify conditions for the use of particular tags.  For
	      example:

		     zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
			 if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
			   reply=( )
			 else
			   reply=( - )
			 fi'

	      Completion in command position will be  attempted	 only  if  the
	      string typed so far is not empty.	 This is tested using the PRE‐
	      FIX special parameter;  see  zshcompwid  for  a  description  of
	      parameters which are special inside completion widgets.  Setting
	      reply to an empty array provides the default behaviour of trying
	      all  tags	 at  once;  setting  it	 to an array containing only a
	      hyphen disables the use of all tags and  hence  of  all  comple‐
	      tions.

	      If  no  tag-order	 style	has  been  defined  for a context, the
	      strings `(|*-)argument-*	(|*-)option-*  values'	and  `options'
	      plus all tags offered by the completion function will be used to
	      provide  a  sensible  default  behavior  that  causes  arguments
	      (whether normal command arguments or arguments of options) to be
	      completed before option names for most commands.

       urls   This is used together with the urls tag by functions  completing
	      URLs.

	      If  the  value  consists of more than one string, or if the only
	      string does not name a file or directory, the strings  are  used
	      as the URLs to complete.

	      If  the  value  contains	only one string which is the name of a
	      normal file the URLs are taken from that file  (where  the  URLs
	      may be separated by white space or newlines).

	      Finally,	if the only string in the value names a directory, the
	      directory hierarchy rooted at this directory gives  the  comple‐
	      tions.   The  top	 level	directory  should  be  the file access
	      method, such as `http', `ftp', `bookmark' and so	on.   In  many
	      cases  the  next	level  of directories will be a filename.  The
	      directory hierarchy can descend as deep as necessary.

	      For example,

		     zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls
		     mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub

	      allows  completion  of   all   the   components	of   the   URL
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub after suitable commands such as `netscape'
	      or `lynx'.  Note, however, that access  methods  and  files  are
	      completed	 separately, so if the hosts style is set hosts can be
	      completed without reference to the urls style.

	      See the description in the function _urls itself for more infor‐
	      mation (e.g. `more $^fpath/_urls(N)').

       use-cache
	      If  this	is  set, the completion caching layer is activated for
	      any  completions	 which	 use   it   (via   the	 _store_cache,
	      _retrieve_cache,	and  _cache_invalid functions).	 The directory
	      containing the cache files can be changed	 with  the  cache-path
	      style.

       use-compctl
	      If  this style is set to a string not equal to false, 0, no, and
	      off, the completion system may use any completion specifications
	      defined  with  the  compctl  builtin  command.   If the style is
	      unset, this is done only if the zsh/compctl  module  is  loaded.
	      The string may also contain the substring `first' to use comple‐
	      tions defined with `compctl -T', and the substring `default'  to
	      use the completion defined with `compctl -D'.

	      Note  that  this	is only intended to smooth the transition from
	      compctl to the new completion system and may  disappear  in  the
	      future.

	      Note also that the definitions from compctl will only be used if
	      there is no specific completion  function	 for  the  command  in
	      question.	  For example, if there is a function _foo to complete
	      arguments to the command foo, compctl will never be invoked  for
	      foo.   However,  the  compctl  version will be tried if foo only
	      uses default completion.

       use-ip By default, the function _hosts that completes host names strips
	      IP  addresses  from entries read from host databases such as NIS
	      and ssh files.  If this style  is	 true,	the  corresponding  IP
	      addresses	 can  be  completed as well.  This style is not use in
	      any context where the hosts style is set; note also it  must  be
	      set  before  the cache of host names is generated (typically the
	      first completion attempt).

       users  This may be set to a list of usernames to be completed.	If  it
	      is  not set all usernames will be completed.  Note that if it is
	      set only that list of users will be completed; this  is  because
	      on some systems querying all users can take a prohibitive amount
	      of time.

       users-hosts
	      The values of this style should be of the	 form  `user@host'  or
	      `user:host'.  It	is  used for commands that need pairs of user-
	      and hostnames.  These commands will complete usernames from this
	      style  (only),  and will restrict subsequent hostname completion
	      to hosts paired with that user in	 one  of  the  values  of  the
	      style.

	      It  is possible to group values for sets of commands which allow
	      a remote login, such as rlogin and ssh, by using the my-accounts
	      tag.  Similarly, values for sets of commands which usually refer
	      to the accounts of other people, such as talk and finger, can be
	      grouped  by  using the other-accounts tag.  More ambivalent com‐
	      mands may use the accounts tag.

       users-hosts-ports
	      Like users-hosts but used for commands like telnet and  contain‐
	      ing strings of the form `user@host:port'.

       verbose
	      If set, as it is by default, the completion listing is more ver‐
	      bose.  In particular many commands show descriptions for options
	      if this style is `true'.

       word   This  is	used by the _list completer, which prevents the inser‐
	      tion of completions until a second completion attempt  when  the
	      line has not changed.  The normal way of finding out if the line
	      has changed is to compare its entire contents  between  the  two
	      occasions.   If  this  style  is true, the comparison is instead
	      performed only on the current word.  Hence if completion is per‐
	      formed  on  another word with the same contents, completion will
	      not be delayed.

CONTROL FUNCTIONS
       The initialization script compinit redefines all the widgets which per‐
       form  completion	 to  call the supplied widget function _main_complete.
       This function acts as a wrapper calling the so-called `completer' func‐
       tions  that  generate  matches.	If _main_complete is called with argu‐
       ments, these are taken as the names of completer functions to be called
       in the order given.  If no arguments are given, the set of functions to
       try is taken from the completer style.  For example, to use normal com‐
       pletion and correction if that doesn't generate any matches:

	      zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct

       after  calling compinit. The default value for this style is `_complete
       _ignored', i.e. normally only ordinary completion is tried, first  with
       the  effect  of	the  ignored-patterns  style and then without it.  The
       _main_complete function uses the return status of the  completer	 func‐
       tions  to  decide  if other completers should be called.	 If the return
       status is zero, no other completers are tried  and  the	_main_complete
       function returns.

       If  the	first argument to _main_complete is a single hyphen, the argu‐
       ments will not be taken as names of completers.	 Instead,  the	second
       argument	 gives a name to use in the completer field of the context and
       the other arguments give a command name and arguments to call to gener‐
       ate the matches.

       The  following  completer  functions are contained in the distribution,
       although users may write their own.  Note that in contexts the  leading
       underscore  is  stripped,  for example basic completion is performed in
       the context `:completion::complete:...'.

       _all_matches
	      This completer can be used to add a  string  consisting  of  all
	      other matches.  As it influences later completers it must appear
	      as the first completer in the list.  The list of all matches  is
	      affected by the avoid-completer and old-matches styles described
	      above.

	      It may be useful to use the _generic function described below to
	      bind _all_matches to its own keystroke, for example:

		     zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
		     bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches

	      Note  that  this does not generate completions by itself:	 first
	      use any of the standard ways of generating  a  list  of  comple‐
	      tions, then use ^Xa to show all matches.	It is possible instead
	      to add a standard completer to the list  and  request  that  the
	      list of all matches should be directly inserted:

		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches _complete
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' insert true

	      In this case the old-matches style should not be set.

       _approximate
	      This  is similar to the basic _complete completer but allows the
	      completions to  undergo  corrections.   The  maximum  number  of
	      errors  can  be  specified  by  the  max-errors  style;  see the
	      description of approximate matching in zshexpn(1) for how errors
	      are  counted.   Normally this completer will only be tried after
	      the normal _complete completer:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate

	      This will give correcting completion if and only if normal  com‐
	      pletion  yields no possible completions.	When corrected comple‐
	      tions are found, the completer will normally start menu  comple‐
	      tion allowing you to cycle through these strings.

	      This  completer uses the tags corrections and original when gen‐
	      erating the possible corrections and the original	 string.   The
	      format style for the former may contain the additional sequences
	      `%e' and `%o' which will be replaced by  the  number  of	errors
	      accepted	to  generate  the corrections and the original string,
	      respectively.

	      The completer  progressively  increases  the  number  of	errors
	      allowed up to the limit by the max-errors style, hence if a com‐
	      pletion is found with one error, no completions with two	errors
	      will be shown, and so on.	 It modifies the completer name in the
	      context to indicate the number of errors	being  tried:  on  the
	      first  try  the completer field contains `approximate-1', on the
	      second try `approximate-2', and so on.

	      When _approximate is called from another function, the number of
	      errors to accept may be passed with the -a option.  The argument
	      is in the same format  as	 the  max-errors  style,  all  in  one
	      string.

	      Note  that  this completer (and the _correct completer mentioned
	      below) can be quite expensive to call, especially when  a	 large
	      number  of  errors are allowed.  One way to avoid this is to set
	      up the completer style using the -e option  to  zstyle  so  that
	      some  completers	are  only  used when completion is attempted a
	      second time on the same string, e.g.:

		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
		       if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
			 _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
			 reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
		       else
			 reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
		       fi'

	      This uses the HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special
	      parameters  that are available inside zle and completion widgets
	      to find out if the command line hasn't changed  since  the  last
	      time completion was tried.  Only then are the _ignored, _correct
	      and _approximate completers called.

       _complete
	      This completer generates all  possible  completions  in  a  con‐
	      text-sensitive  manner, i.e. using the settings defined with the
	      compdef function explained above and the current settings of all
	      special parameters.  This gives the normal completion behaviour.

	      To  complete  arguments  of commands, _complete uses the utility
	      function _normal, which is in turn responsible for  finding  the
	      particular function; it is described below.  Various contexts of
	      the form -context- are handled specifically. These are all  men‐
	      tioned above as possible arguments to the #compdef tag.

	      Before  trying  to find a function for a specific context, _com‐
	      plete checks if the  parameter  `compcontext'  is	 set.  Setting
	      `compcontext'  allows  the  usual	 completion  dispatching to be
	      overridden which is useful in places such	 as  a	function  that
	      uses vared for input. If it is set to an array, the elements are
	      taken to be the possible matches which will be  completed	 using
	      the tag `values' and the description `value'. If it is set to an
	      associative array, the keys are used as the possible completions
	      and  the	values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions for the
	      matches.	If `compcontext' is set to a string containing colons,
	      it  should  be of the form `tag:descr:action'.  In this case the
	      tag and descr give the tag and description to use and the action
	      indicates	 what should be completed in one of the forms accepted
	      by the _arguments utility function described below.

	      Finally, if `compcontext' is set to a string without colons, the
	      value  is	 taken as the name of the context to use and the func‐
	      tion defined for that context will be called.  For this purpose,
	      there  is	 a special context named -command-line- that completes
	      whole command lines (commands and their arguments).  This is not
	      used  by the completion system itself but is nonetheless handled
	      when explicitly called.

       _correct
	      Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word;
	      this is similar to _approximate but will not allow any number of
	      extra characters at the cursor  as  that	completer  does.   The
	      effect  is  similar to spell-checking.  It is based on _approxi‐
	      mate, but the completer field in the context name is correct.

	      For example, with:

		     zstyle ':completion:::::' completer _complete _correct _approximate
		     zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric

	      correction will accept up to two errors.	If a numeric  argument
	      is  given, correction will not be performed, but correcting com‐
	      pletion will be, and will accept as many errors as given by  the
	      numeric  argument.  Without a numeric argument, first correction
	      and then correcting completion will be tried, with the first one
	      accepting two errors and the second one accepting three errors.

	      When  _correct  is called as a function, the number of errors to
	      accept may be given following the -a option.  The argument is in
	      the same form a values to the accept style, all in one string.

	      This  completer  function	 is  intended  to  be used without the
	      _approximate completer or, as in the example,  just  before  it.
	      Using  it	 after	the  _approximate  completer  is useless since
	      _approximate will at least generate the corrected strings gener‐
	      ated by the _correct completer -- and probably more.

       _expand
	      This  completer function does not really perform completion, but
	      instead checks if the word on the command line is	 eligible  for
	      expansion	 and,  if  it is, gives detailed control over how this
	      expansion is done.  For this to happen,  the  completion	system
	      needs  to	 be invoked with complete-word, not expand-or-complete
	      (the default binding for TAB), as otherwise the string  will  be
	      expanded by the shell's internal mechanism before the completion
	      system is started.  Note also this completer  should  be	called
	      before the _complete completer function.

	      The  tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions for
	      the string containing all possible expansions,  expansions  when
	      adding  the  possible  expansions as single matches and original
	      when adding the original string from the	line.	The  order  in
	      which  these strings are generated, if at all, can be controlled
	      by the group-order and tag-order styles, as usual.

	      The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may con‐
	      tain  the	 sequence  `%o' which will be replaced by the original
	      string from the line.

	      The kind of expansion to be tried is controlled by  the  substi‐
	      tute, glob and subst-globs-only styles.

	      It is also possible to call _expand as a function, in which case
	      the different modes may be selected with options: -s for substi‐
	      tute, -g for glob and -o for subst-globs-only.

       _expand_alias
	      If  the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and no
	      other completers are called.  The types of aliases which are  to
	      be  expanded  can	 be controlled with the styles regular, global
	      and disabled.

	      This function is also a bindable command, see the section `Bind‐
	      able Commands' below.

       _history
	      Complete	words  from  the  shell's command  history.  This com‐
	      pleter can be controlled by the remove-all-dups, and sort styles
	      as for the _history_complete_word bindable command, see the sec‐
	      tion `Bindable Commands' below and the section `Completion  Sys‐
	      tem Configuration' above.

       _ignored
	      The  ignored-patterns  style  can	 be  set to a list of patterns
	      which are compared against possible completions;	matching  ones
	      are  removed.   With  this  completer those matches can be rein‐
	      stated, as if no ignored-patterns style were set.	 The completer
	      actually generates its own list of matches; which completers are
	      invoked is determined in the same way as for  the	 _prefix  com‐
	      pleter.  The single-ignored style is also available as described
	      above.

       _list  This completer allows the insertion of  matches  to  be  delayed
	      until  completion is attempted a second time without the word on
	      the line being changed.  On the first attempt, only the list  of
	      matches  will  be shown.	It is affected by the styles condition
	      and word, see  the  section  `Completion	System	Configuration'
	      above.

       _match This  completer  is intended to be used after the _complete com‐
	      pleter.  It behaves similarly but the string on the command line
	      may be a pattern to match against trial completions.  This gives
	      the effect of the GLOB_COMPLETE option.

	      Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from
	      the  line,  inserting a `*' at the cursor position and comparing
	      the resulting pattern with the possible  completions  generated.
	      This  can	 be  modified  with the match-original style described
	      above.

	      The generated matches will  be  offered  in  a  menu  completion
	      unless  the  insert-unambiguous  style is set to `true'; see the
	      description above for other options for this style.

	      Note that matcher specifications defined globally or used by the
	      completion  functions (the styles matcher-list and matcher) will
	      not be used.

       _menu  This completer was written as simple example  function  to  show
	      how  menu	 completion  can be enabled in shell code. However, it
	      has the notable effect of disabling menu selection which can  be
	      useful  with  _generic  based  widgets. It should be used as the
	      first completer in the list.  Note that this is  independent  of
	      the  setting  of the MENU_COMPLETE option and does not work with
	      the other menu completion widgets such as reverse-menu-complete,
	      or accept-and-menu-complete.

       _oldlist
	      This  completer  controls	 how  the  standard completion widgets
	      behave when there is an existing list of completions  which  may
	      have  been  generated  by	 a  special  completion	 (i.e. a sepa‐
	      rately-bound completion command).	 It allows the	ordinary  com‐
	      pletion  keys  to	 continue  to use the list of completions thus
	      generated, instead of producing a new list of  ordinary  contex‐
	      tual  completions.   It  should appear in the list of completers
	      before any of the widgets which generate matches.	 It  uses  two
	      styles:  old-list and old-menu, see the section `Completion Sys‐
	      tem Configuration' above.

       _prefix
	      This completer can be used to try	 completion  with  the	suffix
	      (everything after the cursor) ignored.  In other words, the suf‐
	      fix will not be considered to be part of the word	 to  complete.
	      The effect is similar to the expand-or-complete-prefix command.

	      The completer style is used to decide which other completers are
	      to be called to generate matches.	 If this style is  unset,  the
	      list  of	completers  set	 for  the  current  context is used --
	      except, of course, the _prefix completer	itself.	  Furthermore,
	      if  this	completer  appears  more than once in the list of com‐
	      pleters only those completers not	 already  tried	 by  the  last
	      invocation of _prefix will be called.

	      For example, consider this global completer style:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
			 _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo

	      Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring
	      the suffix.  If that doesn't generate any matches,  and  neither
	      does  the	 call to the _correct completer after it, _prefix will
	      be called a second time and, now only trying correction with the
	      suffix  ignored.	On the second invocation the completer part of
	      the context appears as `foo'.

	      To use _prefix as the last resort and try only normal completion
	      when it is invoked:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
		     zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete

	      The  add-space  style is also respected.	If it is set to `true'
	      then _prefix will insert a space between the  matches  generated
	      (if any) and the suffix.

	      Note  that this completer is only useful if the COMPLETE_IN_WORD
	      option is set; otherwise, the cursor will be moved to the end of
	      the  current word before the completion code is called and hence
	      there will be no suffix.

       _user_expand
	      This completer behaves similarly to the  _expand	completer  but
	      instead  performs	 expansions  defined  by  users.   The	styles
	      add-space and sort styles specific to the _expand completer  are
	      usable  with  _user_expand  in  addition to other styles handled
	      more generally by the completion system.	The tag all-expansions
	      is also available.

	      The  expansion  depends  on  the	array  style user-expand being
	      defined for the current context; remember that the  context  for
	      completers  is less specific than that for contextual completion
	      as the full context has not yet been  determined.	  Elements  of
	      the array may have one of the following forms:
	      $hash

		     hash  is  the name of an associative array.  Note this is
		     not a full parameter expression,  merely  a  $,  suitably
		     quoted  to	 prevent  immediate expansion, followed by the
		     name of an associative array.   If	 the  trial  expansion
		     word  matches  a  key in hash, the resulting expansion is
		     the corresponding value.
	      _func

		     _func is the name of a shell  function  whose  name  must
		     begin  with _ but is not otherwise special to the comple‐
		     tion system.  The function is called with the trial  word
		     as an argument.  If the word is to be expanded, the func‐
		     tion should set the array reply to a list of  expansions.
		     Optionally,  it can set REPLY to a word that will be used
		     as a description for the set of expansions.   The	return
		     status of the function is irrelevant.
BINDABLE COMMANDS
       In  addition  to	 the context-dependent completions provided, which are
       expected to work in an intuitively obvious way, there are a few widgets
       implementing  special  behaviour which can be bound separately to keys.
       The following is a list of these and their default bindings.

       _bash_completions
	      This function is used by two  widgets,  _bash_complete-word  and
	      _bash_list-choices.   It	exists	to  provide compatibility with
	      completion bindings in bash.  The last character of the  binding
	      determines  what is completed: `!', command names; `$', environ‐
	      ment variables; `@', host	 names;	 `/',  file  names;  `~'  user
	      names.   In bash, the binding preceded by `\e' gives completion,
	      and preceded by `^X' lists options.  As some of  these  bindings
	      clash with standard zsh bindings, only `\e~' and `^X~' are bound
	      by default.  To add the rest, the following should be  added  to
	      .zshrc after compinit has been run:

		     for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do
		       bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
		       bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
		     done

	      This  includes  the  bindings  for `~' in case they were already
	      bound to something else; the completion code does	 not  override
	      user bindings.

       _correct_filename (^XC)
	      Correct  the filename path at the cursor position.  Allows up to
	      six errors in the name.  Can also be called with an argument  to
	      correct a filename path, independently of zle; the correction is
	      printed on standard output.

       _correct_word (^Xc)
	      Performs correction of the current argument using the usual con‐
	      textual  completions as possible choices. This stores the string
	      `correct-word' in the function field of  the  context  name  and
	      then calls the _correct completer.

       _expand_alias (^Xa)
	      This  function can be used as a completer and as a bindable com‐
	      mand.  It expands the word the cursor is on if it is  an	alias.
	      The  types  of  alias expanded can be controlled with the styles
	      regular, global and disabled.

	      When used as a bindable command there is one additional  feature
	      that  can	 be  selected by setting the complete style to `true'.
	      In this case,  if	 the  word  is	not  the  name	of  an	alias,
	      _expand_alias  tries  to	complete the word to a full alias name
	      without expanding it.  It leaves the cursor directly  after  the
	      completed	 word  so  that	 invoking _expand_alias once more will
	      expand the now-complete alias name.

       _expand_word (^Xe)
	      Performs expansion on the current word:  equivalent to the stan‐
	      dard  expand-word	 command,  but	using  the  _expand completer.
	      Before calling it, the function field of the context is  set  to
	      `expand-word'.

       _generic
	      This  function  is  not  defined	as  a  widget and not bound by
	      default.	However, it can be used to define a  widget  and  will
	      then  store  the name of the widget in the function field of the
	      context and call the completion system.  This allows custom com‐
	      pletion  widgets	with  their  own  set  of style settings to be
	      defined easily.  For example, to define a widget	that  performs
	      normal completion and starts menu selection:

		     zle -C foo complete-word _generic
		     bindkey '...' foo
		     zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1

	      Note  in	particular that the completer style may be set for the
	      context in order to change the set of functions used to generate
	      possible	matches.   If _generic is called with arguments, those
	      are passed through to _main_complete as the list	of  completers
	      in place of those defined by the completer style.

       _history_complete_word (\e/)
	      Complete	words  from the shell's command history. This uses the
	      list, remove-all-dups, sort, and stop styles.

       _most_recent_file (^Xm)
	      Complete the name of the most recently  modified	file  matching
	      the  pattern on the command line (which may be blank).  If given
	      a numeric argument N, complete the Nth  most  recently  modified
	      file.  Note the completion, if any, is always unique.

       _next_tags (^Xn)
	      This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next
	      tag, or set of tags, either as given by the tag-order  style  or
	      as  set  by default; these matches would otherwise not be avail‐
	      able.  Successive invocations of the command cycle  through  all
	      possible sets of tags.

       _read_comp (^X^R)
	      Prompt the user for a string, and use that to perform completion
	      on the current  word.   There  are  two  possibilities  for  the
	      string.	First,	it  can	 be  a set of words beginning `_', for
	      example `_files -/', in which case the function with  any	 argu‐
	      ments  will  be called to generate the completions.  Unambiguous
	      parts of the function name will be completed automatically (nor‐
	      mal  completion is not available at this point) until a space is
	      typed.

	      Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to
	      compadd and should hence be an expression specifying what should
	      be completed.

	      A very restricted set of	editing	 commands  is  available  when
	      reading  the  string:  `DEL' and `^H' delete the last character;
	      `^U' deletes the line, and `^C' and  `^G'	 abort	the  function,
	      while  `RET'  accepts  the  completion.  Note the string is used
	      verbatim as a command line,  so  arguments  must	be  quoted  in
	      accordance with standard shell rules.

	      Once  a  string  has been read, the next call to _read_comp will
	      use the existing string instead of reading a new one.  To	 force
	      a	 new  string  to be read, call _read_comp with a numeric argu‐
	      ment.

       _complete_debug (^X?)
	      This widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a tem‐
	      porary  file  a trace of the shell commands executed by the com‐
	      pletion system.  Each completion attempt gets its own  file.   A
	      command  to  view	 each of these files is pushed onto the editor
	      buffer stack.

       _complete_help (^Xh)
	      This widget displays information about the  context  names,  the
	      tags,  and  the completion functions used when completing at the
	      current cursor position. If given a numeric argument other  than
	      1 (as in `ESC-2 ^Xh'), then the styles used and the contexts for
	      which they are used will be shown, too.

	      Note that the information about styles  may  be  incomplete;  it
	      depends  on  the information available from the completion func‐
	      tions called, which in turn is  determined  by  the  user's  own
	      styles and other settings.

       _complete_help_generic
	      Unlike  other  commands  listed  here, this must be created as a
	      normal ZLE widget rather than a completion widget (i.e. with zle
	      -N).   It is used for generating help with a widget bound to the
	      _generic widget that is described above.

	      If this widget is created using the name of the function, as  it
	      is  by  default, then when executed it will read a key sequence.
	      This is expected to be bound to a call to a completion  function
	      that  uses  the  _generic widget.	 That widget will be executed,
	      and information provided in  the	same  format  that  the	 _com‐
	      plete_help widget displays for contextual completion.

	      If  the  widget's name contains debug, for example if it is cre‐
	      ated as `zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic',
	      it  will	read and execute the keystring for a generic widget as
	      before, but then generate debugging information as done by _com‐
	      plete_debug for contextual completion.

	      If  the  widget's	 name  contains	 noread,  it  will  not read a
	      keystring but instead arrange that the next  use	of  a  generic
	      widget  run  in the same shell will have the effect as described
	      above.

	      The   widget   works   by	  setting    the    shell    parameter
	      ZSH_TRACE_GENERIC_WIDGET	which  is read by _generic.  Unsetting
	      the parameter cancels any pending effect of the noread form.

	      For example, after executing the following:

		     zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic
		     bindkey '^x:' _complete_debug_generic

	      typing `C-x :' followed by the key sequence for a generic widget
	      will cause trace output for that widget to be saved to a file.

       _complete_tag (^Xt)
	      This  widget completes symbol tags created by the etags or ctags
	      programmes (note there is no connection with the completion sys‐
	      tem's  tags) stored in a file TAGS, in the format used by etags,
	      or tags, in the format created by ctags.	It will look  back  up
	      the  path	 hierarchy for the first occurrence of either file; if
	      both exist, the file TAGS is preferred.	You  can  specify  the
	      full path to a TAGS or tags file by setting the parameter $TAGS‐
	      FILE or $tagsfile respectively.	The  corresponding  completion
	      tags used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writ‐
       ing completion functions.  If functions are  installed  in  subdirecto‐
       ries,  most of these reside in the Base subdirectory.  Like the example
       functions for commands in the distribution, the utility functions  gen‐
       erating	matches	 all follow the convention of returning status zero if
       they generated completions and  non-zero	 if  no	 matching  completions
       could be added.

       Two  more  features  are	 offered  by the _main_complete function.  The
       arrays compprefuncs and comppostfuncs may contain  names	 of  functions
       that  are  to be called immediately before or after completion has been
       tried.  A function will only be called once unless it explicitly	 rein‐
       serts itself into the array.

       _all_labels [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command args ... ]
	      This  is	a  convenient  interface  to  the _next_label function
	      below, implementing the loop shown in the	 _next_label  example.
	      The  command  and	 its  arguments	 are  called  to  generate the
	      matches.	The options stored in the parameter name will automat‐
	      ically  be  inserted  into the args passed to the command.  Nor‐
	      mally, they are put directly after the command, but  if  one  of
	      the  args	 is a single hyphen, they are inserted directly before
	      that.  If the hyphen is the last argument, it  will  be  removed
	      from  the	 argument  list	 before	 the  command is called.  This
	      allows _all_labels to be used in	almost	all  cases  where  the
	      matches can be generated by a single call to the compadd builtin
	      command or by a call to one of the utility functions.

	      For example:

		     local expl
		     ...
		     if _requested foo; then
		       ...
		       _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
		     fi

	      Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using com‐
	      padd  with  additional  options  which will take precedence over
	      those generated by _all_labels.

       _alternative [ -O name ] [ -C name ] spec ...
	      This function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags  are
	      available.   Essentially	it  implements	a  loop	 like  the one
	      described for the _tags function below.

	      The tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is  requested
	      are   described	using	the  specs  which  are	of  the	 form:
	      `tag:descr:action'.  The tags are offered using _tags and if the
	      tag is requested, the action is executed with the given descrip‐
	      tion descr.  The actions are those accepted  by  the  _arguments
	      function	(described  below), excluding the `->state' and `=...'
	      forms.

	      For example, the action may be a simple function call:

		     _alternative \
			 'users:user:_users' \
			 'hosts:host:_hosts'

	      offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches, generated by
	      the _users and _hosts functions respectively.

	      Like  _arguments,	 this function uses _all_labels to execute the
	      actions, which will loop over all sets of	 tags.	 Special  han‐
	      dling  is only required if there is an additional valid tag, for
	      example inside a function called from _alternative.

	      The option `-O name' is used in the same way as  by  the	_argu‐
	      ments  function.	In other words, the elements of the name array
	      will be passed to compadd when executing an action.

	      Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give  a  dif‐
	      ferent name for the argument context field.

       _arguments  [  -nswWCRS ] [ -A pat ] [ -O name ] [ -M matchspec ] [ : ]
       spec...
       _arguments [ opts... ] -- [ -i pats ] [ -s pair ] [ helpspec... ]
	      This function can be used to give a complete  specification  for
	      completion  for  a  command whose arguments follow standard UNIX
	      option and argument conventions.	Options to  _arguments	itself
	      must be in separate words, i.e. -s -w, not -sw.

	      When  calling _arguments, all specs that describe options of the
	      analyzed command line  must  precede  all	 specs	that  describe
	      non-option  (aka	"normal")  arguments of the analyzed line.  To
	      avoid ambiguity, all options to _arguments itself may  be	 sepa‐
	      rated from the spec forms by a single colon.

	      The  -s -w -W -A and -S options describe how parsing of the com‐
	      mand line should proceed, and are discussed  in  context	below.
	      The  `--' form is used to intuit spec forms from the help output
	      of the command being analyzed, and is described in detail below.
	      The opts for the `--' form are otherwise the same options as the
	      first form.  Note that `-s' following `--' has a distinct	 mean‐
	      ing from `-s' preceding `--', and both may appear.

	      With the option -n, _arguments sets the parameter NORMARG to the
	      position of the first normal argument in the $words array,  i.e.
	      the position after the end of the options.  If that argument has
	      not been reached, NORMARG is  set	 to  -1.   The	caller	should
	      declare  `integer NORMARG' if the -n option is passed; otherwise
	      the parameter is not used.

	      The option `-M matchspec' sets a match specification to  use  to
	      completion option names and values.  The default matchspec is:

		     r:|[_-]=* r:|=*

	      This allows partial word completion after `_' and `-', for exam‐
	      ple `-f-b' can be completed to `-foo-bar'.

	      Each of the following forms is a spec describing individual sets
	      of options or arguments on the command line being analyzed.

	      n:message:action
	      n::message:action
		     This  describes  the  n'th	 normal argument.  The message
		     will be printed  above  the  matches  generated  and  the
		     action  indicates	what can be completed in this position
		     (see below).  If there are two colons before the  message
		     the  argument  is optional.  If the message contains only
		     white space, nothing will be printed  above  the  matches
		     unless the action adds an explanation string itself.

	      :message:action
	      ::message:action
		     Similar, but describes the next argument, whatever number
		     that happens to be.  If all arguments  are	 specified  in
		     this  form	 in the correct order the numbers are unneces‐
		     sary.

	      *:message:action
	      *::message:action
	      *:::message:action
		     This describes how arguments  (usually  non-option	 argu‐
		     ments,  those  not	 beginning with - or +) are to be com‐
		     pleted when neither of the first two forms was  provided.
		     Any number of arguments can be completed in this fashion.

		     With  two	colons	before	the message, the words special
		     array and the CURRENT special parameter are  modified  to
		     refer  only  to  the  normal arguments when the action is
		     executed or evaluated.  With three colons before the mes‐
		     sage  they are modified to refer only to the normal argu‐
		     ments covered by this description.

	      optspec
	      optspec:...
		     This describes an option.	The colon  indicates  handling
		     for  one  or  more	 arguments to the option; if it is not
		     present, the option is assumed to take no arguments.

		     By default, options are multi-character name, one `-word'
		     per  option.   With -s, options may be single characters,
		     with more than one option per word, although words start‐
		     ing  with two hyphens, such as `--prefix', are still con‐
		     sidered complete option  names.   This  is	 suitable  for
		     standard GNU options.

		     The  combination  of  -s  with  -w	 allows	 single-letter
		     options to be combined in a single word even  if  one  or
		     more  of  the options take arguments.  For example, if -x
		     takes an argument, with no -s `-xy' is  considered	 as  a
		     single  (unhandled) option; with -s -xy is an option with
		     the argument `y'; with both -s and -w,  -xy  may  be  the
		     option -x and the option -y with arguments still to come.

		     The option -W takes this a stage further:	it is possible
		     to complete single-letter options even after an  argument
		     that occurs in the same word.  However, it depends on the
		     action performed whether options will really be completed
		     at	 this point.  For more control, use a utility function
		     like _guard as part of the action.

		     The following forms are available for  the	 initial  opt‐
		     spec, whether or not the option has arguments.

		     *optspec
			    Here  optspec is one of the remaining forms below.
			    This  indicates  the  following  optspec  may   be
			    repeated.	Otherwise  if the corresponding option
			    is already present on the command line to the left
			    of the cursor it will not be offered again.

		     -optname
		     +optname
			    In	the  simplest  form  the  optspec  is just the
			    option name beginning with a minus or a plus sign,
			    such as `-foo'.  The first argument for the option
			    (if any) must follow as a separate	word  directly
			    after the option.

			    Either  of `-+optname' and `+-optname' can be used
			    to specify that -optname  and  +optname  are  both
			    valid.

			    In all the remaining forms, the leading `-' may be
			    replaced by or paired with `+' in this way.

		     -optname-
			    The	 first	argument  of  the  option  must	  come
			    directly  after  the option name in the same word.
			    For example, `-foo-:...' specifies that  the  com‐
			    pleted   option   and   argument  will  look  like
			    `-fooarg'.

		     -optname+
			    The first argument may  appear  immediately	 after
			    optname in the same word, or may appear as a sepa‐
			    rate  word	after  the   option.	For   example,
			    `-foo+:...'	 specifies  that  the completed option
			    and argument will look like	 either	 `-fooarg'  or
			    `-foo arg'.

		     -optname=
			    The	 argument  may	appear as the next word, or in
			    same word as the option name provided that	it  is
			    separated  from  it by an equals sign, for example
			    `-foo=arg' or `-foo arg'.

		     -optname=-
			    The argument to the option must  appear  after  an
			    equals sign in the same word, and may not be given
			    in the next argument.

		     optspec[explanation]
			    An explanation string may be appended  to  any  of
			    the	 preceding forms of optspec by enclosing it in
			    brackets, as in `-q[query operation]'.

			    The verbose style is used to  decide  whether  the
			    explanation	 strings are displayed with the option
			    in a completion listing.

			    If no bracketed explanation string	is  given  but
			    the	 auto-description  style  is  set and only one
			    argument is described for this optspec, the	 value
			    of	the style is displayed, with any appearance of
			    the sequence `%d' in it replaced by the message of
			    the	 first	optarg	that  follows the optspec; see
			    below.

	      It is possible for options with a literal `+' or `=' to  appear,
	      but that character must be quoted, for example `-\+'.

	      The  options  -S and -A are available to simplify the specifica‐
	      tions for commands with standard option parsing.	 With  -S,  no
	      option  will  be	completed after a `--' appearing on its own on
	      the line; this argument will otherwise be ignored; hence in  the
	      line

		     foobar -x -- -y

	      the  `-x'	 is considered an option but the `-y' is considered an
	      argument, while the `--' is considered to be neither.

	      With -A, no options will be completed after the first non-option
	      argument	on  the	 line.	 The  -A must be followed by a pattern
	      matching all strings which are not to  be	 taken	as  arguments.
	      For  example,  to	 make _arguments stop completing options after
	      the first normal argument, but  ignoring	all  strings  starting
	      with  a hyphen even if they are not described by one of the opt‐
	      specs, the form is `-A "-*"'.

	      Each optarg following an optspec must take one of the  following
	      forms:

	      :message:action
	      ::message:action
		     An argument to the option; message and action are treated
		     as for ordinary arguments.	 In the first form, the	 argu‐
		     ment is mandatory, and in the second form it is optional.

		     This  group may be repeated for options which take multi‐
		     ple arguments.  In	 other	words,	:message1:action1:mes‐
		     sage2:action2  specifies  that the option takes two argu‐
		     ments.

	      :*pattern:message:action
	      :*pattern::message:action
	      :*pattern:::message:action
		     This describes multiple arguments.	 Only the last	optarg
		     for  an  option taking multiple arguments may be given in
		     this form.	 If the pattern is empty (i.e., :*:), all  the
		     remaining	words  on  the	line  are  to  be completed as
		     described by the action; otherwise, all the words	up  to
		     and  including a word matching the pattern are to be com‐
		     pleted using the action.

		     Multiple colons are treated as for the `*:...' forms  for
		     ordinary  arguments:  when the message is preceded by two
		     colons, the words special array and the  CURRENT  special
		     parameter are modified during the execution or evaluation
		     of the action to  refer  only  to	the  words  after  the
		     option.  When preceded by three colons, they are modified
		     to refer only to the words covered by this description.

       Any literal colon in an optname, message, or action must be preceded by
       a backslash, `\:'.

       Each  of	 the  forms  above may be preceded by a list in parentheses of
       option names and argument numbers.  If the given option is on the  com‐
       mand  line, the options and arguments indicated in parentheses will not
       be offered.  For	 example,  `(-two  -three  1)-one:...'	completes  the
       option  `-one';	if  this appears on the command line, the options -two
       and -three and the first ordinary argument will not be completed	 after
       it.   `(-foo):...' specifies an ordinary argument completion; -foo will
       not be completed if that argument is already present.

       Other items may appear in the list of excluded options to indicate var‐
       ious other items that should not be applied when the current specifica‐
       tion is matched: a single star (*) for the rest arguments (i.e. a spec‐
       ification   of	the   form  `*:...');  a  colon	 (:)  for  all	normal
       (non-option-) arguments; and a hyphen (-) for all options.   For	 exam‐
       ple,  if	 `(*)'	appears before an option and the option appears on the
       command line, the list of remaining arguments (those shown in the above
       table beginning with `*:') will not be completed.

       To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any of the
       forms above with `!'; then  the	form  will  no	longer	be  completed,
       although	 if  the  option  or argument appears on the command line they
       will be skipped as normal.  The main use for this is when the arguments
       are  given  by  an  array, and _arguments is called repeatedly for more
       specific contexts: on the first call  `_arguments  $global_options'  is
       used, and on subsequent calls `_arguments !$^global_options'.

       In each of the forms above the action determines how completions should
       be generated.  Except for the `->string' form below, the action will be
       executed by calling the _all_labels function to process all tag labels.
       No special handling of tags is needed unless a function call introduces
       a new one.

       The option `-O name' specifies the name of an array whose elements will
       be passed as arguments to functions called  to  execute	actions.   For
       example,	 this can be used to pass the same set of options for the com‐
       padd builtin to all actions.

       The forms for action are as follows.

	 (single unquoted space)
	      This is useful where an argument is required but it is not  pos‐
	      sible or desirable to generate matches for it.  The message will
	      be displayed but no completions listed.  Note that even in  this
	      case  the colon at the end of the message is needed; it may only
	      be omitted when neither a message nor an action is given.

       (item1 item2 ...)
	      One of a list of possible matches, for example:

		     :foo:(foo bar baz)

       ((item1\:desc1 ...))
	      Similar to the above, but with descriptions  for	each  possible
	      match.  Note the backslash before the colon.  For example,

		     :foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))

	      The  matches  will be listed together with their descriptions if
	      the description style is set with the values tag in the context.

       ->string
	      In this form, _arguments processes the arguments and options and
	      then returns control to the calling function with parameters set
	      to indicate the state of processing; the calling	function  then
	      makes  its  own  arrangements  for  generating completions.  For
	      example, functions that implement a state machine can  use  this
	      type of action.

	      Where  _arguments encounters action in the `->string' format, it
	      will strip all leading and trailing whitespace from  string  and
	      set  the	array  state  to  the  set of all strings for which an
	      action  is  to  be  performed.   The  elements  of   the	 array
	      state_descr  are	assigned  the corresponding message field from
	      each optarg containing such an action.

	      By default and in common with all other well behaved  completion
	      functions,  _arguments returns status zero if it was able to add
	      matches and non-zero otherwise. However, if  the	-R  option  is
	      given,  _arguments  will instead return a status of 300 to indi‐
	      cate that $state is to be handled.

	      In addition to $state and $state_descr, _arguments also sets the
	      global  parameters `context', `line' and `opt_args' as described
	      below, and does not reset any changes made to the special param‐
	      eters such as PREFIX and words.  This gives the calling function
	      the choice of resetting these parameters or propagating  changes
	      in them.

	      A	 function calling _arguments with at least one action contain‐
	      ing a `->string' must therefore declare appropriate local param‐
	      eters:

		     local context state state_descr line
		     typeset -A opt_args

	      to prevent _arguments from altering the global environment.

       {eval-string}
	      A	 string	 in  braces  is	 evaluated  as	shell code to generate
	      matches.	If the eval-string itself does not begin with an open‐
	      ing  parenthesis or brace it is split into separate words before
	      execution.

       = action
	      If the action starts with `= ' (an equals	 sign  followed	 by  a
	      space),  _arguments  will	 insert	 the  contents of the argument
	      field of the current context as the new  first  element  in  the
	      words  special array and increment the value of the CURRENT spe‐
	      cial parameter.  This has the effect of inserting a  dummy  word
	      onto the completion command line while not changing the point at
	      which completion is taking place.

	      This is most useful with one of the specifiers that restrict the
	      words on the command line on which the action is to operate (the
	      two- and three-colon forms above).  One particular use  is  when
	      an  action itself causes _arguments on a restricted range; it is
	      necessary to use this trick to  insert  an  appropriate  command
	      name into the range for the second call to _arguments to be able
	      to parse the line.

	word...
       word...
	      This covers all forms other than those  above.   If  the	action
	      starts with a space, the remaining list of words will be invoked
	      unchanged.

	      Otherwise it will be invoked  with  some	extra  strings	placed
	      after  the first word; these are to be passed down as options to
	      the compadd builtin.  They ensure that the  state	 specified  by
	      _arguments,  in particular the descriptions of options and argu‐
	      ments, is correctly passed to  the  completion  command.	 These
	      additional  arguments are taken from the array parameter `expl';
	      this will be set up before executing the action and hence may be
	      referred	to  inside  it,	 typically in an expansion of the form
	      `$expl[@]' which preserves empty elements of the array.

       During the performance of the action the array `line' will  be  set  to
       the  normal  arguments  from  the command line, i.e. the words from the
       command line after the command name excluding  all  options  and	 their
       arguments.  Options are stored in the associative array `opt_args' with
       option names as keys and their arguments as the	values.	  For  options
       that  have  more than one argument these are given as one string, sepa‐
       rated by colons.	 All colons in the  original  arguments	 are  preceded
       with backslashes.

       The  parameter  `context' is set when returning to the calling function
       to perform an action of the form `->string'.  It is set to an array  of
       elements	 corresponding	to  the elements of $state.  Each element is a
       suitable name for the argument field of the context: either a string of
       the  form `option-opt-n' for the n'th argument of the option -opt, or a
       string of the form `argument-n' for  the	 n'th  argument.   For	`rest'
       arguments,  that	 is  those in the list at the end not handled by posi‐
       tion, n is the string `rest'.  For example, when completing  the	 argu‐
       ment  of	 the -o option, the name is `option-o-1', while for the second
       normal (non-option-) argument it is `argument-2'.

       Furthermore, during the evaluation of the action the  context  name  in
       the  curcontext	parameter is altered to append the same string that is
       stored in the context parameter.

       The option -C tells _arguments to modify the curcontext	parameter  for
       an  action  of the form `->state'.  This is the standard parameter used
       to keep track of the current context.  Here it  (and  not  the  context
       array)  should  be  made local to the calling function to avoid passing
       back the modified value and should be initialised to the current	 value
       at the start of the function:

	      local curcontext="$curcontext"

       This is useful where it is not possible for multiple states to be valid
       together.

       It is possible to specify multiple sets of options and  arguments  with
       the  sets  separated  by single hyphens.	 The specifications before the
       first hyphen (if any) are shared by all the remaining sets.  The	 first
       word in every other set provides a name for the set which may appear in
       exclusion lists in specifications, either alone or before  one  of  the
       possible	 values	 described  above.   In	 the  second case a `-' should
       appear between this name and the remainder.

       For example:

	      _arguments \
		  -a \
		- set1 \
		  -c \
		- set2 \
		  -d \
		  ':arg:(x2 y2)'

       This defines two sets.  When the command line contains the option `-c',
       the  `-d'  option and the argument will not be considered possible com‐
       pletions.  When it contains `-d' or an argument, the option  `-c'  will
       not be considered.  However, after `-a' both sets will still be consid‐
       ered valid.

       If the name given for one of the mutually exclusive sets is of the form
       `(name)' then only one value from each set will ever be completed; more
       formally, all specifications are mutually exclusive to all other speci‐
       fications  in  the same set.  This is useful for defining multiple sets
       of options which are mutually exclusive and in which  the  options  are
       aliases for each other.	For example:

	      _arguments \
		  -a -b \
		- '(compress)' \
		  {-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
		- '(uncompress)' \
		  {-d,--decompress}'[decompress]'

       As  the	completion  code  has to parse the command line separately for
       each set this form of argument is slow and should  only	be  used  when
       necessary.   A useful alternative is often an option specification with
       rest-arguments (as in `-foo:*:...'); here the option -foo  swallows  up
       all remaining arguments as described by the optarg definitions.

       The option `--' allows _arguments to work out the names of long options
       that support the `--help' option which is standard  in  many  GNU  com‐
       mands.	The  command word is called with the argument `--help' and the
       output examined for option names.  Clearly, it can be dangerous to pass
       this  to commands which may not support this option as the behaviour of
       the command is unspecified.

       In addition to options, `_arguments --' will try to deduce the types of
       arguments available for options when the form `--opt=val' is valid.  It
       is also possible to provide hints by examining the  help	 text  of  the
       command	and adding helpspec of the form `pattern:message:action'; note
       that other _arguments spec forms are not used.  The pattern is  matched
       against	the help text for an option, and if it matches the message and
       action are used as for other argument specifiers.  The special case  of
       `*:'  means  both message and action are empty, which has the effect of
       causing options having no description in the help output to be  ordered
       in listings ahead of options that have a description.

       For example:

	      _arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
			    '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
			    '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
			    '*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'

       Here, `yes' and `no' will be completed as the argument of options whose
       description ends in a star; file names will be  completed  for  options
       that  contain the substring `=FILE' in the description; and directories
       will be completed for options  whose  description  contains  `=DIR'  or
       `=PATH'.	  The  last  three  are in fact the default and so need not be
       given explicitly, although it is possible to override the use of	 these
       patterns.  A typical help text which uses this feature is:

		-C, --directory=DIR	     change to directory DIR

       so that the above specifications will cause directories to be completed
       after `--directory', though not after `-C'.

       Note also that _arguments tries to find out automatically if the	 argu‐
       ment  for  an  option is optional.  This can be specified explicitly by
       doubling the colon before the message.

       If the pattern ends in `(-)', this will be removed from the pattern and
       the  action  will  be used only directly after the `=', not in the next
       word.  This is the behaviour of a normal specification defined with the
       form `=-'.

       The `_arguments --' can be followed by the option `-i patterns' to give
       patterns for options which are not to be completed.  The	 patterns  can
       be  given  as  the  name	 of an array parameter or as a literal list in
       parentheses.  For example,

	      _arguments -- -i \
		  "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"

       will cause completion to	 ignore	 the  options  `--enable-FEATURE'  and
       `--disable-FEATURE' (this example is useful with GNU configure).

       The  `_arguments	 --' form can also be followed by the option `-s pair'
       to describe option aliases.  The pair consists of a list of alternating
       patterns	 and corresponding replacements, enclosed in parens and quoted
       so that it forms a single argument word in the _arguments call.

       For example, some configure-script help output describes	 options  only
       as `--enable-foo', but the script also accepts the negated form `--dis‐
       able-foo'.  To allow completion of the second form:

	      _arguments -- -s "(#--enable- --disable-)"

       Finally, note that _arguments generally expects to be the primary func‐
       tion  handling  any  completion for which it is used.  It may have side
       effects which change the treatment of any matches added by other	 func‐
       tions  called  after  it.   To combine _arguments with other functions,
       those functions should be called either before _arguments, as an action
       within a spec, or in handlers for `->state' actions.

       Here is a more general example of the use of _arguments:

	      _arguments '-l+:left border:' \
			 '-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
			 '*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
			 ':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
			 '*:page number:'

       This  describes three options: `-l', `-format', and `-copy'.  The first
       takes one argument described as `left border' for which	no  completion
       will  be	 offered  because  of the empty action.	 Its argument may come
       directly after the `-l' or it may be given as  the  next	 word  on  the
       line.

       The  `-format' option takes one argument in the next word, described as
       `paper size' for which only the strings `letter' and `A4' will be  com‐
       pleted.

       The  `-copy'  option  may appear more than once on the command line and
       takes two arguments.  The first is mandatory and will be completed as a
       filename.   The	second is optional (because of the second colon before
       the description `resolution') and will be completed  from  the  strings
       `300' and `600'.

       The  last  two  descriptions say what should be completed as arguments.
       The first describes the first argument as a `postscript file' and makes
       files ending in `ps' or `eps' be completed.  The last description gives
       all other arguments the description `page numbers' but does  not	 offer
       completions.

       _cache_invalid cache_identifier
	      This  function returns status zero if the completions cache cor‐
	      responding to the given cache identifier needs  rebuilding.   It
	      determines  this	by  looking  up the cache-policy style for the
	      current context.	This should provide a function name  which  is
	      run  with	 the  full path to the relevant cache file as the only
	      argument.

	      Example:

		     _example_caching_policy () {
			 # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
			 local -a oldp
			 oldp=( "$1"(Nm+7) )
			 (( $#oldp ))
		     }

       _call_function return name [ args ... ]
	      If a function name exists, it is called with the arguments args.
	      The  return  argument gives the name of a parameter in which the
	      return status from the function name should be stored; if return
	      is empty or a single hyphen it is ignored.

	      The  return status of _call_function itself is zero if the func‐
	      tion name exists and was called and non-zero otherwise.

       _call_program tag string ...
	      This function provides a mechanism for the user to override  the
	      use  of an external command.  It looks up the command style with
	      the supplied tag.	 If the style is set, its value is used as the
	      command to execute.  The strings from the call to _call_program,
	      or from the style if set, are concatenated with  spaces  between
	      them  and	 the resulting string is evaluated.  The return status
	      is the return status of the command called.

       _combination [ -s pattern ] tag style spec ... field opts ...
	      This function is used to complete combinations of	 values,   for
	      example  pairs  of  hostnames and usernames.  The style argument
	      gives the style which defines the pairs; it is looked  up	 in  a
	      context with the tag specified.

	      The style name consists of field names separated by hyphens, for
	      example `users-hosts-ports'.  For each  field  for  a  value  is
	      already known, a spec of the form `field=pattern' is given.  For
	      example, if the command line so far specifies a user `pws',  the
	      argument `users=pws' should appear.

	      The  next	 argument  with no equals sign is taken as the name of
	      the field for which completions should be generated  (presumably
	      not one of the fields for which the value is known).

	      The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style.
	      These should contain the possible values for the combinations in
	      the  appropriate	order  (users,	hosts,	ports  in  the example
	      above).  The different  fields  the  values  for	the  different
	      fields  are  separated  by colons.  This can be altered with the
	      option -s to _combination which specifies a pattern.   Typically
	      this  is	a  character  class, as for example `-s "[:@]"' in the
	      case of the users-hosts style.	Each `field=pattern'  specifi‐
	      cation  restricts the completions which apply to elements of the
	      style with appropriately matching fields.

	      If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag, or
	      if  none	of  the strings in style's value match, but a function
	      name of the required field preceded by an underscore is defined,
	      that function will be called to generate the matches.  For exam‐
	      ple, if there is no `users-hosts-ports' or no matching  hostname
	      when  a  host  is required, the function `_hosts' will automati‐
	      cally be called.

	      If the same name is used for more than one field,	 in  both  the
	      `field=pattern'  and  the	 argument  that	 gives the name of the
	      field to be completed, the number of the	field  (starting  with
	      one)  may	 be  given after the fieldname, separated from it by a
	      colon.

	      All arguments after the required field name are passed  to  com‐
	      padd  when  generating  matches  from the style value, or to the
	      functions for the fields if they are called.

       _describe [ -oO | -t tag ] descr name1 [ name2 ] opts ... -- ...
	      This function associates completions with descriptions.	Multi‐
	      ple  groups  separated  by  -- can be supplied, potentially with
	      different completion options opts.

	      The descr is taken as a string to display above the  matches  if
	      the  format style for the descriptions tag is set.  This is fol‐
	      lowed by one or two names of arrays followed by options to  pass
	      to  compadd.   The first array contains the possible completions
	      with their descriptions in  the  form  `completion:description'.
	      Any  literal  colons  in	completion must be quoted with a back‐
	      slash.  If a second array is given, it should have the same num‐
	      ber  of  elements	 as  the first; in this case the corresponding
	      elements are added as possible completions instead of  the  com‐
	      pletion  strings from the first array.  The completion list will
	      retain the descriptions from the first array.  Finally, a set of
	      completion options can appear.

	      If  the  option  `-o'  appears  before  the  first argument, the
	      matches added will be treated as names of command options	 (N.B.
	      not  shell  options),  typically following a `-', `--' or `+' on
	      the command line.	 In this case _describe uses  the  prefix-hid‐
	      den, prefix-needed and verbose styles to find out if the strings
	      should be added as completions and if the descriptions should be
	      shown.   Without the `-o' option, only the verbose style is used
	      to decide how descriptions are shown.  If `-O' is	 used  instead
	      of  `-o',	 command  options are completed as above but _describe
	      will not handle the prefix-needed style.

	      With the -t option a tag can be specified.  The default is `val‐
	      ues' or, if the -o option is given, `options'.

	      If  selected  by	the  list-grouped style, strings with the same
	      description will appear together in the list.

	      _describe uses the _all_labels function to generate the matches,
	      so it does not need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.

       _description [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ spec ... ]
	      This function is not to be confused with the previous one; it is
	      used as a helper function for creating options to	 compadd.   It
	      is  buried  inside many of the higher level completion functions
	      and so often does not need to be called directly.

	      The styles listed below are tested in the current context	 using
	      the  given  tag.	The resulting options for compadd are put into
	      the array named name (this is  traditionally  `expl',  but  this
	      convention  is  not  enforced).	The description for the corre‐
	      sponding set of matches is passed to the function in descr.

	      The styles tested are: format, hidden, matcher, ignored-patterns
	      and  group-name.	The format style is first tested for the given
	      tag and then for the descriptions tag if	no  value  was	found,
	      while  the  remainder  are  only tested for the tag given as the
	      first argument.  The function also calls _setup which tests some
	      more styles.

	      The  string  returned by the format style (if any) will be modi‐
	      fied so that the sequence `%d' is replaced by the descr given as
	      the  third argument without any leading or trailing white space.
	      If, after removing the white  space,  the	 descr	is  the	 empty
	      string,  the  format  style will not be used and the options put
	      into the name array will not contain an explanation string to be
	      displayed above the matches.

	      If  _description	is  called with more than three arguments, the
	      additional specs should be of the form `char:str'.  These supply
	      escape sequence replacements for the format style: every appear‐
	      ance of `%char' will be replaced by string.

	      If the -x option is given, the description  will	be  passed  to
	      compadd  using  the  -x  option instead of the default -X.  This
	      means that the description will be displayed even if  there  are
	      no corresponding matches.

	      The  options  placed  in	the  array  name  take	account of the
	      group-name style, so matches are	placed	in  a  separate	 group
	      where necessary.	The group normally has its elements sorted (by
	      passing the option -J to compadd), but  if  an  option  starting
	      with  `-V',  `-J', `-1', or `-2' is passed to _description, that
	      option will be included in the array.  Hence it is possible  for
	      the  completion  group to be unsorted by giving the option `-V',
	      `-1V', or `-2V'.

	      In most cases, the function will be used like this:

		     local expl
		     _description files expl file
		     compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"

	      Note the use of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list  of
	      matches.	Almost all calls to compadd within the completion sys‐
	      tem use a	 similar  format;  this	 ensures  that	user-specified
	      styles are correctly passed down to the builtins which implement
	      the internals of completion.

       _dispatch context string ...
	      This sets the current context to context and looks  for  comple‐
	      tion  functions  to  handle  this context by hunting through the
	      list of command names or special contexts	 (as  described	 above
	      for compdef) given as string ....	 The first completion function
	      to be defined for one of the contexts in the  list  is  used  to
	      generate	matches.   Typically,  the last string is -default- to
	      cause the function for default completion to be used as a	 fall‐
	      back.

	      The  function  sets  the	parameter $service to the string being
	      tried, and sets the context/command field (the  fourth)  of  the
	      $curcontext  parameter  to  the context given as the first argu‐
	      ment.

       _files The function _files calls _path_files with all the arguments  it
	      was  passed  except for -g and -/.  The use of these two options
	      depends on the setting of the  file-patterns style.

	      This function  accepts  the  full	 set  of  options  allowed  by
	      _path_files, described below.

       _gnu_generic
	      This function is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function
	      described above.	It can be used to determine automatically  the
	      long  options  understood	 by  commands that produce a list when
	      passed the option `--help'.  It is intended  to  be  used	 as  a
	      top-level completion function in its own right.  For example, to
	      enable option completion for the commands foo and bar, use

		     compdef _gnu_generic foo bar

	      after the call to compinit.

	      The completion system as supplied is conservative in its use  of
	      this  function,  since  it  is  important to be sure the command
	      understands the option `--help'.

       _guard [ options ] pattern descr
	      This function is intended to be used in the action for the spec‐
	      ifications  passed  to  _arguments  and  similar	functions.  It
	      returns immediately with a non-zero return status if the	string
	      to  be  completed	 does  not  match the pattern.	If the pattern
	      matches, the descr is displayed; the function then returns  sta‐
	      tus  zero	 if the word to complete is not empty, non-zero other‐
	      wise.

	      The pattern may be preceded by any of the options understood  by
	      compadd  that  are passed down from _description, namely -M, -J,
	      -V, -1, -2, -n, -F  and  -X.   All  of  these  options  will  be
	      ignored.	 This  fits  in conveniently with the argument-passing
	      conventions of actions for _arguments.

	      As an example, consider a command	 taking	 the  options  -n  and
	      -none,  where -n must be followed by a numeric value in the same
	      word.  By using:

		     _arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'

	      _arguments can be made to	 both  display	the  message  `numeric
	      value'  and  complete  options  after `-n<TAB>'.	If the `-n' is
	      already followed by one or more digits (the  pattern  passed  to
	      _guard)  only the message will be displayed; if the `-n' is fol‐
	      lowed by another character, only options are completed.

       _message [ -r12 ] [ -VJ group ] descr
       _message -e [ tag ] descr
	      The descr is used in the same way as the third argument  to  the
	      _description  function,  except  that  the resulting string will
	      always be shown whether or not matches were generated.  This  is
	      useful  for displaying a help message in places where no comple‐
	      tions can be generated.

	      The format style is examined with the messages  tag  to  find  a
	      message;	the usual tag, descriptions, is used only if the style
	      is not set with the former.

	      If the -r option is given, no style is used; the descr is	 taken
	      literally	 as  the  string to display.  This is most useful when
	      the descr comes from a pre-processed argument list which already
	      contains an expanded description.

	      The  -12VJ options and the group are passed to compadd and hence
	      determine the group the message string is added to.

	      The second -e form gives a description for completions with  the
	      tag  tag	to be shown even if there are no matches for that tag.
	      This form is called by _arguments in the event that there is  no
	      action  for an option specification.  The tag can be omitted and
	      if so the tag is taken from the parameter $curtag; this is main‐
	      tained by the completion system and so is usually correct.  Note
	      that if there are no  matches  at	 the  time  this  function  is
	      called, compstate[insert] is cleared, so additional matches gen‐
	      erated later are not inserted on the command line.

       _multi_parts sep array
	      The argument sep is a separator character.   The	array  may  be
	      either  the name of an array parameter or a literal array in the
	      form `(foo bar)', a parenthesised list  of  words	 separated  by
	      whitespace.   The	 possible completions are the strings from the
	      array.  However, each chunk delimited by sep will	 be  completed
	      separately.  For example, the _tar function uses `_multi_parts /
	      patharray' to complete partial file paths from the  given	 array
	      of complete file paths.

	      The  -i option causes _multi_parts to insert a unique match even
	      if that requires multiple separators to be  inserted.   This  is
	      not  usually  the expected behaviour with filenames, but certain
	      other types of completion, for example those with a fixed set of
	      possibilities, may be more suited to this form.

	      Like  other  utility  functions, this function accepts the `-V',
	      `-J', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-f',  `-X',  `-M',  `-P',  `-S',	 `-r',
	      `-R', and `-q' options and passes them to the compadd builtin.

       _next_label [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ options ... ]
	      This  function  is used to implement the loop over different tag
	      labels for a particular tag as described above for the tag-order
	      style.   On each call it checks to see if there are any more tag
	      labels; if there is it returns status zero, otherwise  non-zero.
	      As  this	function  requires  a  current	tag to be set, it must
	      always follow a call to _tags or _requested.

	      The -x12VJ options and the first three arguments are  passed  to
	      the  _description	 function.   Where appropriate the tag will be
	      replaced by a tag label in this call.  Any description given  in
	      the  tag-order  style  is	 preferred  to	the  descr  passed  to
	      _next_label.

	      The options given after the descr are set in the parameter given
	      by name, and hence are to be passed to compadd or whatever func‐
	      tion is called to add the matches.

	      Here is a typical use of this function for  the  tag  foo.   The
	      call to _requested determines if tag foo is required at all; the
	      loop over _next_label handles any labels defined for the tag  in
	      the tag-order style.

		     local expl ret=1
		     ...
		     if _requested foo; then
		       ...
		       while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
			 compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
		       done
		       ...
		     fi
		     return ret

       _normal
	      This  is	the standard function called to handle completion out‐
	      side any special -context-.  It is called both to	 complete  the
	      command  word and also the arguments for a command.  In the sec‐
	      ond case, _normal looks for a special completion for  that  com‐
	      mand,  and  if  there  is	 none  it  uses the completion for the
	      -default- context.

	      A second use is to reexamine the command line specified  by  the
	      $words  array  and  the $CURRENT parameter after those have been
	      modified.	 For example, the  function  _precommand,  which  com‐
	      pletes  after  pre-command specifiers such as nohup, removes the
	      first word from the words array, decrements the CURRENT  parame‐
	      ter,  then  calls	 _normal again.	 The effect is that `nohup cmd
	      ...' is treated in the same way as `cmd ...'.

	      If the command name matches one of the patterns given by one  of
	      the  options  -p	or -P to compdef, the corresponding completion
	      function is called and then the parameter _compskip is  checked.
	      If  it  is set completion is terminated at that point even if no
	      matches have been found.	This is the  same  effect  as  in  the
	      -first- context.

       _options
	      This  can	 be  used  to complete the names of shell options.  It
	      provides a matcher specification that ignores  a	leading	 `no',
	      ignores underscores and allows upper-case letters to match their
	      lower-case  counterparts	 (for	example,   `glob',   `noglob',
	      `NO_GLOB'	 are  all completed).  Any arguments are propagated to
	      the compadd builtin.

       _options_set and _options_unset
	      These functions complete only set or  unset  options,  with  the
	      same matching specification used in the _options function.

	      Note  that  you  need to uncomment a few lines in the _main_com‐
	      plete function for these functions to work properly.  The	 lines
	      in  question  are	 used  to  store the option settings in effect
	      before the completion widget locally sets the options it	needs.
	      Hence  these  functions are not generally used by the completion
	      system.

       _parameters
	      This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.

	      The option `-g pattern'  limits  the  completion	to  parameters
	      whose type matches the pattern.  The type of a parameter is that
	      shown by `print ${(t)param}', hence judicious use of `*' in pat‐
	      tern is probably necessary.

	      All other arguments are passed to the compadd builtin.

       _path_files
	      This  function  is used throughout the completion system to com‐
	      plete filenames.	It allows completion of	 partial  paths.   For
	      example,	 the   string	`/u/i/s/sig'   may   be	 completed  to
	      `/usr/include/sys/signal.h'.

	      The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:

	      -f     Complete all filenames.  This is the default.

	      -/     Specifies that only directories should be completed.

	      -g pattern
		     Specifies that only files matching the pattern should  be
		     completed.

	      -W paths
		     Specifies	path  prefixes that are to be prepended to the
		     string from the command line to  generate	the  filenames
		     but  that should not be inserted as completions nor shown
		     in completion listings.  Here, paths may be the  name  of
		     an	 array	parameter, a literal list of paths enclosed in
		     parentheses or an absolute pathname.

	      -F ignored-files
		     This behaves as for the corresponding option to the  com‐
		     padd  builtin.   It gives direct control over which file‐
		     names should be ignored.  If the option is	 not  present,
		     the ignored-patterns style is used.

	      Both  _path_files	 and  _files also accept the following options
	      which are passed to compadd: `-J', `-V', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-X',
	      `-M', `-P', `-S', `-q', `-r', and `-R'.

	      Finally,	the  _path_files  function   uses  the	styles expand,
	      ambiguous, special-dirs, list-suffixes and  file-sort  described
	      above.

       _pick_variant [ -b builtin-label ] [ -c command ] [ -r name ]
	  label=pattern ... label [ args ... ]
	      This  function is used to resolve situations where a single com‐
	      mand name requires  more	than  one  type	 of  handling,	either
	      because  it has more than one variant or because there is a name
	      clash between two different commands.

	      The command to run is taken from the first element of the	 array
	      words  unless this is overridden by the option -c.  This command
	      is run and its output is compared with  a	 series	 of  patterns.
	      Arguments	 to  be	 passed to the command can be specified at the
	      end after all the other arguments.  The patterns to try in order
	      are given by the arguments label=pattern; if the output of `com‐
	      mand args ...' contains pattern, then label is selected  as  the
	      label  for  the command variant.	If none of the patterns match,
	      the final command label is selected and status 1 is returned.

	      If the `-b builtin-label' is given, the command is tested to see
	      if  it  is  provided as a shell builtin, possibly autoloaded; if
	      so, the label builtin-label is selected as  the  label  for  the
	      variant.

	      If  the  `-r  name'  is given, the label picked is stored in the
	      parameter named name.

	      The results are also  cached  in	the  _cmd_variant  associative
	      array indexed by the name of the command run.

       _regex_arguments name spec ...
	      This function generates a completion function name which matches
	      the specifications spec ..., a set  of  regular  expressions  as
	      described	 below.	  After running _regex_arguments, the function
	      name should be called as a normal completion function.  The pat‐
	      tern  to	be matched is given by the contents of the words array
	      up to the current cursor	position  joined  together  with  null
	      characters; no quotation is applied.

	      The  arguments  are grouped as sets of alternatives separated by
	      `|', which are tried one after  the  other  until	 one  matches.
	      Each  alternative consists of a one or more specifications which
	      are tried	 left  to  right,  with	 each  pattern	matched	 being
	      stripped	in  turn from the command line being tested, until all
	      of the group succeeds or until one fails; in  the	 latter	 case,
	      the  next	 alternative is tried.	This structure can be repeated
	      to arbitrary depth by using parentheses; matching proceeds  from
	      inside to outside.

	      A	 special  procedure  is	 applied  if  no test succeeds but the
	      remaining command line string contains no null character (imply‐
	      ing  the	remaining word is the one for which completions are to
	      be generated).  The  completion  target  is  restricted  to  the
	      remaining	 word  and  any actions for the corresponding patterns
	      are executed.  In this case, nothing is stripped from  the  com‐
	      mand line string.	 The order of evaluation of the actions can be
	      determined by the tag-order style; the various formats supported
	      by  _alternative	can  be used in action.	 The descr is used for
	      setting up the array parameter expl.

	      Specification arguments take one of following  forms,  in	 which
	      metacharacters such as `(', `)', `#' and `|' should be quoted.

	      /pattern/ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is a single primitive component.  The function tests
		     whether  the  combined  pattern  `(#b)((#B)pattern)looka‐
		     head*'  matches  the command line string.	If so, `guard'
		     is evaluated and its return status is examined to	deter‐
		     mine  if the test has succeeded.  The pattern string `[]'
		     is guaranteed never  to  match.   The  lookahead  is  not
		     stripped from the command line before the next pattern is
		     examined.

		     The argument starting with : is used in the  same	manner
		     as an argument to _alternative.

		     A	component is used as follows: pattern is tested to see
		     if the component already exists on the command line.   If
		     it	 does,	any  following	specifications are examined to
		     find something to complete.  If a	component  is  reached
		     but  no  such pattern exists yet on the command line, the
		     string containing the action is used to generate  matches
		     to insert at that point.

	      /pattern/+ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This  is  similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the left part of
		     the command line string (i.e. the part already matched by
		     previous patterns) is also considered part of the comple‐
		     tion target.

	      /pattern/- [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the actions of the
		     current  and previously matched patterns are ignored even
		     if the following `pattern' matches the empty string.

	      ( spec )
		     Parentheses may be used to groups specs; note each paren‐
		     thesis is a single argument to _regex_arguments.

	      spec # This allows any number of repetitions of spec.

	      spec spec
		     The  two  specs  are to be matched one after the other as
		     described above.

	      spec | spec
		     Either of the two specs can be matched.

	      The function _regex_words can be used as a  helper  function  to
	      generate	matches	 for  a set of alternative words possibly with
	      their own arguments as a command line argument.

	      Examples:

		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
		     /$'[^\0]#\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

	      This generates a function _tst that completes aaa	 as  its  only
	      argument.	  The  tag  and	 description  for the action have been
	      omitted for brevity (this works but is not recommended in normal
	      use).   The  first  component matches the command word, which is
	      arbitrary; the second matches  any argument.  As the argument is
	      also  arbitrary, any following component would not depend on aaa
	      being present.

		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
		     /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

	      This is a more typical use; it is	 similar,  but	any  following
	      patterns	would only match if aaa was present as the first argu‐
	      ment.

		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \( \
		     /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \
		     /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

	      In this example, an indefinite number of command	arguments  may
	      be completed.  Odd arguments are completed as aaa and even argu‐
	      ments as bbb.  Completion fails unless the set of	 aaa  and  bbb
	      arguments before the current one is matched correctly.

		     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
		     \( /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \| \
		     /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

	      This  is similar, but either aaa or bbb may be completed for any
	      argument.	 In this case _regex_words could be used to generate a
	      suitable expression for the arguments.

       _regex_words tag description spec ...
	      This  function  can  be  used  to	 generate  arguments  for  the
	      _regex_arguments command which may  be  inserted	at  any	 point
	      where  a set of rules is expected.  The tag and description give
	      a standard tag and description pertaining to  the	 current  con‐
	      text.   Each spec contains two or three arguments separated by a
	      colon: note that there is no leading colon in this case.

	      Each spec gives one of a set of words that may be	 completed  at
	      this point, together with arguments.  It is thus roughly equiva‐
	      lent to the _arguments function when used in normal  (non-regex)
	      completion.

	      The  part	 of  the spec before the first colon is the word to be
	      completed.  This may contain a *; the entire  word,  before  and
	      after  the  *  is	 completed,  but only the text before the * is
	      required for the context to be matched, so  that	further	 argu‐
	      ments may be completed after the abbreviated form.

	      The second part of spec is a description for the word being com‐
	      pleted.

	      The optional third part of the spec describes how words  follow‐
	      ing  the one being completed are themselves to be completed.  It
	      will be evaluated in order to avoid problems with quoting.  This
	      means  that  typically  it contains a reference to an array con‐
	      taining previously generated regex arguments.

	      The option -t term specifies a terminator for the	 word  instead
	      of the usual space.  This is handled as an auto-removable suffix
	      in the manner of the option -s sep to _values.

	      The result of the processing by _regex_words is  placed  in  the
	      array reply, which should be made local to the calling function.
	      If the set of words and arguments may be matched repeatedly, a #
	      should be appended to the generated array at that point.

	      For example:

		     local -a reply
		     _regex_words mydb-commands 'mydb commands' \
		       'add:add an entry to mydb:$mydb_add_cmds' \
		       'show:show entries in mydb'
		     _regex_arguments _mydb "$reply[@]"
		     _mydb "$@"

	      This  shows a completion function for a command mydb which takes
	      two command arguments, add and show.  show takes	no  arguments,
	      while  the  arguments  for  add have already been prepared in an
	      array mydb_add_cmds,  quite  possibly  by	 a  previous  call  to
	      _regex_words.

       _requested [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command args ... ] ]
	      This  function  is called to decide whether a tag already regis‐
	      tered by a call to _tags (see below) has been requested  by  the
	      user  and	 hence	completion  should  be	performed  for it.  It
	      returns status zero if the tag is requested and non-zero	other‐
	      wise.   The  function  is	 typically used as part of a loop over
	      different tags as follows:

		     _tags foo bar baz
		     while _tags; do
		       if _requested foo; then
			 ... # perform completion for foo
		       fi
		       ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
		       ... # exit loop if matches were generated
		     done

	      Note that the test for whether matches  were  generated  is  not
	      performed	 until the end of the _tags loop.  This is so that the
	      user can set the tag-order style to specify a set of tags to  be
	      completed at the same time.

	      If  name	and descr are given, _requested calls the _description
	      function with these arguments together with the  options	passed
	      to _requested.

	      If  command  is  given,  the _all_labels function will be called
	      immediately with the same arguments.  In simple cases this makes
	      it  possible to perform the test for the tag and the matching in
	      one go.  For example:

		     local expl ret=1
		     _tags foo bar baz
		     while _tags; do
		       _requested foo expl 'description' \
			   compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
		       ...
		       (( ret )) || break
		     done

	      If the command is not compadd, it must nevertheless be  prepared
	      to handle the same options.

       _retrieve_cache cache_identifier
	      This  function  retrieves	 completion  information from the file
	      given by cache_identifier, stored in a  directory	 specified  by
	      the  cache-path  style  which  defaults  to  ~/.zcompcache.  The
	      return status is zero if retrieval was successful.  It will only
	      attempt retrieval if the use-cache style is set, so you can call
	      this function without worrying about whether the user wanted  to
	      use the caching layer.

	      See _store_cache below for more details.

       _sep_parts
	      This  function  is  passed  alternating arrays and separators as
	      arguments.  The arrays specify completions for parts of  strings
	      to  be separated by the separators.  The arrays may be the names
	      of array parameters or a quoted list of  words  in  parentheses.
	      For   example,  with  the	 array	`hosts=(ftp  news)'  the  call
	      `_sep_parts '(foo bar)' @ hosts' will complete the  string   `f'
	      to `foo' and the string `b@n' to `bar@news'.

	      This  function  accepts  the  compadd  options `-V', `-J', `-1',
	      `-2', `-n', `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-r',	 `-R',	and  `-q'  and
	      passes them on to the compadd builtin used to add the matches.

       _setup tag [ group ]
	      This function sets up the special parameters used by the comple‐
	      tion system appropriately for the tag given as the  first	 argu‐
	      ment.	It   uses   the	  styles   list-colors,	  list-packed,
	      list-rows-first, last-prompt, accept-exact, menu and force-list.

	      The optional group supplies the name of the group in  which  the
	      matches  will be placed.	If it is not given, the tag is used as
	      the group name.

	      This function is	called	automatically  from  _description  and
	      hence is not normally called explicitly.

       _store_cache cache_identifier params ...
	      This function, together with _retrieve_cache and _cache_invalid,
	      implements a caching layer which can be used in  any  completion
	      function.	  Data	obtained  by  costly  operations are stored in
	      parameters; this function then dumps the values of those parame‐
	      ters  to	a  file.   The data can then be retrieved quickly from
	      that file via _retrieve_cache, even in  different	 instances  of
	      the shell.

	      The cache_identifier specifies the file which the data should be
	      dumped to.  The file is stored in a directory specified  by  the
	      cache-path style which defaults to ~/.zcompcache.	 The remaining
	      params arguments are the parameters to dump to the file.

	      The return status is zero if storage was successful.  The	 func‐
	      tion will only attempt storage if the use-cache style is set, so
	      you can call this function without worrying  about  whether  the
	      user wanted to use the caching layer.

	      The  completion  function may avoid calling _retrieve_cache when
	      it already has the  completion  data  available  as  parameters.
	      However,	in  that  case	it should call _cache_invalid to check
	      whether the data in the parameters and in the  cache  are	 still
	      valid.

	      See  the	_perl_modules completion function for a simple example
	      of the usage of the caching layer.

       _tags [ [ -C name ] tags ... ]
	      If called with arguments, these are taken to  be	the  names  of
	      tags  valid  for completions in the current context.  These tags
	      are stored internally and sorted by using the tag-order style.

	      Next, _tags is called repeatedly without arguments from the same
	      completion  function.  This successively selects the first, sec‐
	      ond, etc. set of tags requested by the user.  The return	status
	      is  zero	if  at least one of the tags is requested and non-zero
	      otherwise.  To test if a particular tag  is  to  be  tried,  the
	      _requested function should be called (see above).

	      If  `-C  name' is given, name is temporarily stored in the argu‐
	      ment field (the fifth) of the context in the curcontext  parame‐
	      ter  during  the	call  to _tags; the field is restored on exit.
	      This allows _tags to use a more specific context without	having
	      to change and reset the curcontext parameter (which has the same
	      effect).

       _values [ -O name ] [ -s sep ] [ -S sep ] [ -wC ] desc spec ...
	      This is used to complete arbitrary keywords (values)  and	 their
	      arguments, or lists of such combinations.

	      If  the  first argument is the option `-O name', it will be used
	      in the same way as by the _arguments function.  In other	words,
	      the  elements  of	 the name array will be passed to compadd when
	      executing an action.

	      If the first argument (or the first argument after `-O name') is
	      `-s',  the next argument is used as the character that separates
	      multiple values.	This character is  automatically  added	 after
	      each  value in an auto-removable fashion (see below); all values
	      completed by `_values -s' appear in the same word on the command
	      line, unlike completion using _arguments.	 If this option is not
	      present, only a single value will be completed per word.

	      Normally, _values will only use the current  word	 to  determine
	      which  values  are already present on the command line and hence
	      are not to be completed again.  If the -w option is given, other
	      arguments are examined as well.

	      The  first non-option argument is used as a string to print as a
	      description before listing the values.

	      All other arguments describe the possible values and their argu‐
	      ments  in the same format used for the description of options by
	      the _arguments function (see above).  The only  differences  are
	      that  no minus or plus sign is required at the beginning, values
	      can have only one argument, and the forms	 of  action  beginning
	      with an equal sign are not supported.

	      The  character  separating  a value from its argument can be set
	      using the option -S (like -s, followed by the character  to  use
	      as  the  separator in the next argument).	 By default the equals
	      sign will be used as the separator between values and arguments.

	      Example:

		     _values -s , 'description' \
			     '*foo[bar]' \
			     '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
			     'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'

	      This describes three possible values: `foo', `one',  and	`two'.
	      The  first  is  described	 as  `bar',  takes no argument and may
	      appear more than once.  The second is described as `number', may
	      appear   more  than  once,  and  takes  one  mandatory  argument
	      described as `first count'; no action is specified, so  it  will
	      not be completed.	 The `(two)' at the beginning says that if the
	      value `one' is on the line, the value `two' will	no  longer  be
	      considered  a  possible  completion.   Finally,  the  last value
	      (`two') is described as `another number' and takes  an  optional
	      argument	described  as `second count' for which the completions
	      (to appear after an `=') are `1', `2',  and  `3'.	  The  _values
	      function	will  complete lists of these values separated by com‐
	      mas.

	      Like _arguments, this function temporarily adds another  context
	      name  component to the arguments element (the fifth) of the cur‐
	      rent context while executing the action.	Here this name is just
	      the name of the value for which the argument is completed.

	      The  style verbose is used to decide if the descriptions for the
	      values (but not those for the arguments) should be printed.

	      The associative array val_args is	 used  to  report  values  and
	      their  arguments;	 this works similarly to the opt_args associa‐
	      tive array used by _arguments.  Hence the function calling _val‐
	      ues  should  declare  the	 local	parameters state, state_descr,
	      line, context and val_args:

		     local context state state_descr line
		     typeset -A val_args

	      when using an action of the form `->string'.  With this function
	      the context parameter will be set to the name of the value whose
	      argument is to be completed.  Note that for _values,  the	 state
	      and  state_descr	are scalars rather than arrays.	 Only a single
	      matching state is returned.

	      Note also that _values normally adds the character used  as  the
	      separator between values as an auto-removable suffix (similar to
	      a `/' after a directory).	 However, this is not possible	for  a
	      `->string'  action as the matches for the argument are generated
	      by the calling function.	To get the usual behaviour, the	 call‐
	      ing  function can add the separator x as a suffix by passing the
	      options `-qS x' either directly or indirectly to compadd.

	      The option -C is treated in the same way as it is by _arguments.
	      In  that	case  the  parameter  curcontext  should be made local
	      instead of context (as described above).

       _wanted [ -x ] [ -C name ]  [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command args ...
	      In many contexts, completion can only  generate  one  particular
	      set of matches, usually corresponding to a single tag.  However,
	      it is still  necessary  to  decide  whether  the	user  requires
	      matches of this type.  This function is useful in such a case.

	      The  arguments  to  _wanted are the same as those to _requested,
	      i.e. arguments to be passed to _description.  However,  in  this
	      case  the	 command is not optional;  all the processing of tags,
	      including the loop over both tags and tag labels and the genera‐
	      tion of matches, is carried out automatically by _wanted.

	      Hence  to offer only one tag and immediately add the correspond‐
	      ing matches with the given description:

		     local expl
		     _wanted tag expl 'description' \
			 compadd matches...

	      Note that, as for _requested, the command must be able to accept
	      options to be passed down to compadd.

	      Like  _tags  this function supports the -C option to give a dif‐
	      ferent name for the argument context field.  The -x  option  has
	      the same meaning as for _description.

COMPLETION DIRECTORIES
       In  the	source distribution, the files are contained in various subdi‐
       rectories of the Completion directory.  They may have been installed in
       the same structure, or into one single function directory.  The follow‐
       ing is a description of the  files  found  in  the  original  directory
       structure.   If	you  wish to alter an installed file, you will need to
       copy it to some directory which appears earlier in your fpath than  the
       standard directory where it appears.

       Base   The  core functions and special completion widgets automatically
	      bound to keys.  You will certainly need most  of	these,	though
	      will  probably  not need to alter them.  Many of these are docu‐
	      mented above.

       Zsh    Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and
	      utility  functions  for  this.   Some  of these are also used by
	      functions from the Unix directory.

       Unix   Functions for completing	arguments  of  external	 commands  and
	      suites  of  commands.   They may need modifying for your system,
	      although in many cases some attempt is made to decide which ver‐
	      sion  of	a command is present.  For example, completion for the
	      mount command tries to determine the system it  is  running  on,
	      while  completion for many other utilities try to decide whether
	      the GNU version of the command is in use, and hence whether  the
	      --help option is supported.

       X, AIX, BSD, ...
	      Completion  and  utility function for commands available only on
	      some systems.  These are not arranged  hierarchically,  so,  for
	      example, both the Linux and Debian directories, as well as the X
	      directory, may be useful on your system.

ZSHCOMPCTL(1)							 ZSHCOMPCTL(1)

NAME
       zshcompctl - zsh programmable completion

DESCRIPTION
       This version of zsh has two ways of performing completion of  words  on
       the  command  line.  New users of the shell may prefer to use the newer
       and more powerful system based on shell functions; this is described in
       zshcompsys(1),  and  the	 basic	shell  mechanisms which support it are
       described in zshcompwid(1).  This manual entry describes the older com‐
       pctl command.
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]
       compctl	[ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ] [ + options [
       -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]
       compctl -M match-specs ...
       compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]
       compctl + command ...

       Control the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied  set
       of options.  Various editing commands, notably expand-or-complete-word,
       usually bound to tab, will attempt to complete  a  word	typed  by  the
       user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually bound to ^D in
       EMACS editing mode, list the possibilities; compctl controls what those
       possibilities  are.  They may for example be filenames (the most common
       case, and  hence	 the  default),	 shell	variables,  or	words  from  a
       user-specified list.

COMMAND FLAGS
       Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each com‐
       mand or may use the default.  The behavior when completing the  command
       word  itself may also be separately specified.  These correspond to the
       following flags and arguments, all of which (except for -L) may be com‐
       bined with any combination of the options described subsequently in the
       section `Option Flags':

       command ...
	      controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed
	      last on the command line.	 If completion is attempted for a com‐
	      mand with a pathname containing slashes and no completion	 defi‐
	      nition  is  found,  the search is retried with the last pathname
	      component. If the command starts with a =, completion  is	 tried
	      with the pathname of the command.

	      Any  of the command strings may be patterns of the form normally
	      used for filename generation.  These should be quoted to protect
	      them  from  immediate  expansion; for example the command string
	      'foo*' arranges for completion  of  the  words  of  any  command
	      beginning	 with  foo.  When completion is attempted, all pattern
	      completions are tried in the reverse order of  their  definition
	      until one matches.  By default, completion then proceeds as nor‐
	      mal, i.e. the shell will try to generate more  matches  for  the
	      specific	command on the command line; this can be overridden by
	      including -tn in the flags for the pattern completion.

	      Note that aliases are expanded before the command name is deter‐
	      mined  unless  the COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set.  Commands may
	      not be combined with the -C, -D or -T flags.

       -C     controls completion when the command word itself is  being  com‐
	      pleted.  If no compctl -C command has been issued,  the names of
	      any executable command (whether in the path or specific  to  the
	      shell, such as aliases or functions) are completed.

       -D     controls	default	 completion behavior for the arguments of com‐
	      mands not assigned any special behavior.	If no compctl -D  com‐
	      mand has been issued, filenames are completed.

       -T     supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing
	      is done, even before processing for compctls  defined  for  spe‐
	      cific  commands.	 This  is especially useful when combined with
	      extended completion (the -x flag, see the section `Extended Com‐
	      pletion'	below).	 Using this flag you can define default behav‐
	      ior which will apply to all commands without exception,  or  you
	      can  alter the standard behavior for all commands.  For example,
	      if your access to the user database is too slow and/or  it  con‐
	      tains  too  many users (so that completion after `~' is too slow
	      to be usable), you can use

		     compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn

	      to complete the strings in the array friends after a  `~'.   The
	      C[...]  argument	is necessary so that this form of ~-completion
	      is not tried after the directory name is finished.

       -L     lists the existing completion behavior in a manner suitable  for
	      putting  into  a	start-up  script; the existing behavior is not
	      changed.	Any combination of the above forms,  or	 the  -M  flag
	      (which must follow the -L flag), may be specified, otherwise all
	      defined completions are listed.  Any other  flags	 supplied  are
	      ignored.

       no argument
	      If  no  argument is given, compctl lists all defined completions
	      in an abbreviated form;  with a list of options, all completions
	      with  those  flags  set  (not  counting extended completion) are
	      listed.

       If the + flag is alone and followed immediately by  the	command	 list,
       the  completion	behavior  for all the commands in the list is reset to
       the default.  In other words,  completion  will	subsequently  use  the
       options specified by the -D flag.

       The  form  with -M as the first and only option defines global matching
       specifications (see zshcompwid). The match specifications given will be
       used  for  every	 completion attempt (only when using compctl, not with
       the new completion system) and are tried in the order in which they are
       defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:

	      compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

       This  will first try completion without any global match specifications
       (the empty string) and, if that generates no  matches,  will  try  case
       insensitive completion.

OPTION FLAGS
       [ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]
       [ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]
       [ -K function ]
       [ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]
       [ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]
       [ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]
       [ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]
       [ -M match-spec ]

       The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for
       during completion.  Any combination of these flags  may	be  specified;
       the  result is a sorted list of all the possibilities.  The options are
       as follows.

   Simple Flags
       These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:

       -f     Filenames and file system paths.

       -/     Just file system paths.

       -c     Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins  and
	      reserved words.

       -F     Function names.

       -B     Names of builtin commands.

       -m     Names of external commands.

       -w     Reserved words.

       -a     Alias names.

       -R     Names of regular (non-global) aliases.

       -G     Names of global aliases.

       -d     This can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names
	      of disabled functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.

       -e     This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by  default,
	      but may be combined with -d; -de in combination with -F, -B, -w,
	      -a, -R and  -G  will  complete  names  of	 functions,  builtins,
	      reserved words or aliases whether or not they are disabled.

       -o     Names of shell options (see zshoptions(1)).

       -v     Names of any variable defined in the shell.

       -N     Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.

       -A     Array names.

       -I     Names of integer variables.

       -O     Names of read-only variables.

       -p     Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parame‐
	      ters).

       -Z     Names of shell special parameters.

       -E     Names of environment variables.

       -n     Named directories.

       -b     Key binding names.

       -j     Job names:  the first word of the	 job  leader's	command	 line.
	      This is useful with the kill builtin.

       -r     Names of running jobs.

       -z     Names of suspended jobs.

       -u     User names.

   Flags with Arguments
       These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of comple‐
       tions is to be made up:

       -k array
	      Names taken from the elements of $array (note that the `$'  does
	      not  appear  on  the command line).  Alternatively, the argument
	      array itself may be a set of space- or comma-separated values in
	      parentheses,  in which any delimiter may be escaped with a back‐
	      slash; in this case the argument should be quoted.  For example,

		     compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
				 coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit

       -g globstring
	      The globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be
	      quoted  to  protect  it  from immediate expansion. The resulting
	      filenames are taken as the  possible  completions.   Use	`*(/)'
	      instead  of `*/' for directories.	 The fignore special parameter
	      is not applied to the resulting files.  More  than  one  pattern
	      may  be given separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is
	      not part of globbing.  Use the  syntax  `(either|or)'  to	 match
	      alternatives.)

       -s subststring
	      The  subststring	is  split  into words and these words are than
	      expanded using all shell expansion mechanisms (see  zshexpn(1)).
	      The resulting words are taken as possible completions.  The fig‐
	      nore special parameter is not applied to	the  resulting	files.
	      Note that -g is faster for filenames.

       -K function
	      Call the given function to get the completions.  Unless the name
	      starts with an underscore, the function is passed two arguments:
	      the  prefix and the suffix of the word on which completion is to
	      be attempted, in other words those characters before the	cursor
	      position, and those from the cursor position onwards.  The whole
	      command line can be accessed with the -c and  -l	flags  of  the
	      read  builtin.  The function should set the variable reply to an
	      array containing the completions (one completion	per  element);
	      note  that reply should not be made local to the function.  From
	      such a function the command line can be accessed with the -c and
	      -l flags to the read builtin.  For example,

		     function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
		     compctl -K whoson talk

	      completes only logged-on users after `talk'.  Note that `whoson'
	      must return an array, so `reply=`users`' would be incorrect.

       -H num pattern
	      The possible completions are taken from  the  last  num  history
	      lines.   Only  words matching pattern are taken.	If num is zero
	      or negative the whole history is searched and if pattern is  the
	      empty  string  all words are taken (as with `*').	 A typical use
	      is

		     compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''

	      which forces completion to look back in the history list	for  a
	      word if no filename matches.

   Control Flags
       These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but manip‐
       ulate the options that do:

       -Q     This instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in  the
	      possible	completions.  Normally the results of a completion are
	      inserted into the command line with any metacharacters quoted so
	      that  they are interpreted as normal characters.	This is appro‐
	      priate for filenames and ordinary strings.  However, for special
	      effects,	such  as inserting a backquoted expression from a com‐
	      pletion array (-k) so that the expression will not be  evaluated
	      until the complete line is executed, this option must be used.

       -P prefix
	      The  prefix  is  inserted	 just before the completed string; any
	      initial part already typed will be completed and the whole  pre‐
	      fix ignored for completion purposes.  For example,

		     compctl -j -P "%" kill

	      inserts  a  `%'  after  the  kill command and then completes job
	      names.

       -S suffix
	      When a completion is found the suffix is inserted after the com‐
	      pleted  string.	In  the	 case of menu completion the suffix is
	      inserted immediately, but it is still possible to cycle  through
	      the list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.

       -W file-prefix
	      With  directory  file-prefix:   for command, file, directory and
	      globbing completion (options -c, -f, -/, -g), the file prefix is
	      implicitly added in front of the completion.  For example,

		     compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs

	      completes	 any subdirectories to any depth beneath the directory
	      ~/Mail, although that prefix does	 not  appear  on  the  command
	      line.   The  file-prefix may also be of the form accepted by the
	      -k flag, i.e. the name of an array or a literal list  in	paren‐
	      thesis.  In  this	 case  all the directories in the list will be
	      searched for possible completions.

       -q     If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes
	      the  suffix to be removed if the next character typed is a blank
	      or does not insert anything or if the suffix  consists  of  only
	      one  character  and the next character typed is the same charac‐
	      ter; this the same rule used for the  AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH  option.
	      The  option  is  most  useful for list separators (comma, colon,
	      etc.).

       -l cmd This option restricts the range of command line words  that  are
	      considered  to  be  arguments.   If  combined  with  one	of the
	      extended completion patterns  `p[...]',  `r[...]',  or  `R[...]'
	      (see  the	 section  `Extended  Completion'  below)  the range is
	      restricted to the range of arguments specified in the  brackets.
	      Completion is then performed as if these had been given as argu‐
	      ments to the cmd supplied with the option. If the cmd string  is
	      empty  the  first word in the range is instead taken as the com‐
	      mand name, and command name completion performed	on  the	 first
	      word in the range.  For example,

		     compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find

	      completes	 arguments  between  `-exec' and the following `;' (or
	      the end of the command line if there is no such  string)	as  if
	      they were a separate command line.

       -h cmd Normally	zsh  completes	quoted	strings	 as a whole. With this
	      option, completion can be done separately on different parts  of
	      such  strings. It works like the -l option but makes the comple‐
	      tion code work on the parts of the current word that  are	 sepa‐
	      rated by spaces. These parts are completed as if they were argu‐
	      ments to the given cmd. If cmd is the empty  string,  the	 first
	      part is completed as a command name, as with -l.

       -U     Use  the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they
	      actually match the word on the command line.  The word typed  so
	      far will be deleted.  This is most useful with a function (given
	      by the -K option) which can examine the word  components	passed
	      to  it  (or  via the read builtin's -c and -l flags) and use its
	      own criteria to decide what matches.  If there is no completion,
	      the original word is retained.  Since the produced possible com‐
	      pletions seldom have interesting common prefixes	and  suffixes,
	      menu  completion	is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is set and
	      this flag is used.

       -y func-or-var
	      The list provided by func-or-var is  displayed  instead  of  the
	      list  of	completions whenever a listing is required; the actual
	      completions to be inserted are not affected.  It can be provided
	      in  two ways. Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a $ it defines
	      a variable, or if it begins with a left  parenthesis  a  literal
	      array, which contains the list.  A variable may have been set by
	      a call to a function using the -K option.	 Otherwise it contains
	      the  name	 of  a	function  which will be executed to create the
	      list.  The function will be  passed  as  an  argument  list  all
	      matching	completions,  including prefixes and suffixes expanded
	      in full, and should set the array reply to the result.  In  both
	      cases,  the display list will only be retrieved after a complete
	      list of matches has been created.

	      Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in
	      length,  to  the original set of matches, and may be passed as a
	      scalar instead of an array.  No special formatting of characters
	      is performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines
	      are printed literally and if they appear output  in  columns  is
	      suppressed.

       -X explanation
	      Print  explanation  when trying completion on the current set of
	      options. A `%n' in this string is	 replaced  by  the  number  of
	      matches that were added for this explanation string.  The expla‐
	      nation only appears if completion was tried  and	there  was  no
	      unique  match,  or when listing completions. Explanation strings
	      will be listed together with the matches of the group  specified
	      together	with the -X option (using the -J or -V option). If the
	      same explanation string is given to  multiple  -X	 options,  the
	      string  appears  only  once  (for	 each group) and the number of
	      matches shown for the `%n' is the total number  of  all  matches
	      for each of these uses. In any case, the explanation string will
	      only be shown if there was at least  one	match  added  for  the
	      explanation string.

	      The  sequences  %B,  %b,	%S,  %s,  %U,  and  %u	specify output
	      attributes (bold, standout, and underline), %F, %f, %K, %k spec‐
	      ify  foreground  and background colours, and %{...%} can be used
	      to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.

       -Y explanation
	      Identical to -X, except that  the	 explanation  first  undergoes
	      expansion	 following  the	 usual	rules  for  strings  in double
	      quotes.  The expansion will be carried out after	any  functions
	      are  called for the -K or -y options, allowing them to set vari‐
	      ables.

       -t continue
	      The continue-string contains a character	that  specifies	 which
	      set of completion flags should be used next.  It is useful:

	      (i)  With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when
	      compctl would usually continue with  ordinary  processing	 after
	      finding matches; this can be suppressed with `-tn'.

	      (ii)  With  a  list of alternatives separated by +, when compctl
	      would normally stop  when	 one  of  the  alternatives  generates
	      matches.	 It  can be forced to consider the next set of comple‐
	      tions by adding `-t+' to the flags of the alternative before the
	      `+'.

	      (iii)  In	 an extended completion list (see below), when compctl
	      would normally continue until a  set  of	conditions  succeeded,
	      then use only the immediately following flags.  With `-t-', com‐
	      pctl will continue trying extended completions  after  the  next
	      `-';  with  `-tx'	 it  will  attempt completion with the default
	      flags, in other words those before the `-x'.

       -J name
	      This gives the name of the group the matches  should  be	placed
	      in. Groups are listed and sorted separately; likewise, menu com‐
	      pletion will offer the matches in the groups  in	the  order  in
	      which  the  groups  were defined. If no group name is explicitly
	      given, the matches are stored in	a  group  named	 default.  The
	      first  time  a group name is encountered, a group with that name
	      is created. After that all matches with the same group name  are
	      stored in that group.

	      This  can	 be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions.
	      For example, in

		     compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo

	      both files and variables are possible completions,  as  the  -t+
	      forces  both  sets  of alternatives before and after the + to be
	      considered at once.  Because of the  -J  options,	 however,  all
	      files are listed before all variables.

       -V name
	      Like  -J,	 but  matches  within  the group will not be sorted in
	      listings nor in menu completion. These unsorted groups are in  a
	      different	 name space from the sorted ones, so groups defined as
	      -J files and -V files are distinct.

       -1     If given together with the -V  option,  makes  only  consecutive
	      duplicates  in  the  group be removed. Note that groups with and
	      without this flag are in different name spaces.

       -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates
	      be kept. Again, groups with and without this flag are in differ‐
	      ent name spaces.

       -M match-spec
	      This defines additional  matching	 control  specifications  that
	      should  be  used	only  when testing words for the list of flags
	      this flag appears in. The format of  the	match-spec  string  is
	      described in zshcompwid.

ALTERNATIVE COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...

       The  form  with	`+' specifies alternative options. Completion is tried
       with the options before the first `+'. If this produces no matches com‐
       pletion	is  tried with the flags after the `+' and so on. If there are
       no flags after the last `+' and a match has not been found up  to  that
       point, default completion is tried.  If the list of flags contains a -t
       with a + character, the next list of flags is used even if the  current
       list produced matches.

       Additional  options are available that restrict completion to some part
       of the command line; this is referred to as `extended completion'.

EXTENDED COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
		[ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
		[ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

       The form with `-x'  specifies  extended	completion  for	 the  commands
       given;  as  shown, it may be combined with alternative completion using
       `+'.  Each pattern is examined in turn; when a match is found, the cor‐
       responding  options,  as described in the section `Option Flags' above,
       are used to generate possible completions.  If no pattern matches,  the
       options given before the -x are used.

       Note  that  each	 pattern  should  be supplied as a single argument and
       should be quoted to prevent expansion of metacharacters by the shell.

       A pattern is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it  matches  if
       at  least  one  of  these sub-patterns matches (they are `or'ed). These
       sub-patterns are in turn composed of other  sub-patterns	 separated  by
       white  spaces  which  match  if all of the sub-patterns match (they are
       `and'ed).  An element of the sub-patterns is of the form `c[...][...]',
       where  the pairs of brackets may be repeated as often as necessary, and
       matches if any of the sets of brackets match (an	 `or').	  The  example
       below makes this clearer.

       The elements may be any of the following:

       s[string]...
	      Matches  if the current word on the command line starts with one
	      of the strings given in brackets.	 The string is not removed and
	      is not part of the completion.

       S[string]...
	      Like s[string] except that the string is part of the completion.

       p[from,to]...
	      Matches  if the number of the current word is between one of the
	      from and to pairs inclusive. The comma and to are	 optional;  to
	      defaults	to  the	 same value as from.  The numbers may be nega‐
	      tive: -n refers to the n'th last word on the line.

       c[offset,string]...
	      Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the
	      current word position.  Usually offset will be negative.

       C[offset,pattern]...
	      Like c but using pattern matching instead.

       w[index,string]...
	      Matches  if  the	word  in position index is equal to the corre‐
	      sponding string.	Note that the word count  is  made  after  any
	      alias expansion.

       W[index,pattern]...
	      Like w but using pattern matching instead.

       n[index,string]...
	      Matches if the current word contains string.  Anything up to and
	      including the indexth occurrence of this string will not be con‐
	      sidered part of the completion, but the rest will.  index may be
	      negative to count from the end: in most cases, index will	 be  1
	      or -1.  For example,

		     compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk

	      will  usually  complete  usernames, but if you insert an @ after
	      the name, names from the array hosts (assumed to	contain	 host‐
	      names,  though  you  must	 make the array yourself) will be com‐
	      pleted.  Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.

       N[index,string]...
	      Like n except that the string  will  be  taken  as  a  character
	      class.   Anything	 up to and including the indexth occurrence of
	      any of the characters in string will not be considered  part  of
	      the completion.

       m[min,max]...
	      Matches  if  the	total number of words lies between min and max
	      inclusive.

       r[str1,str2]...
	      Matches if the cursor is after a	word  with  prefix  str1.   If
	      there  is also a word with prefix str2 on the command line after
	      the one matched by str1 it matches only if the cursor is	before
	      this  word. If the comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if the
	      cursor is after a word with prefix str1.

       R[str1,str2]...
	      Like r but using pattern matching instead.

       q[str]...
	      Matches the word currently being completed is in	single	quotes
	      and the str begins with the letter `s', or if completion is done
	      in double quotes and str starts with the letter `d', or if  com‐
	      pletion is done in backticks and str starts with a `b'.

EXAMPLE
	      compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
		-g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail

       This is to be interpreted as follows:

       If the current command is mail, then

	      if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f)
	      or (the current word begins with -f+)), then complete the
	      non-directory part (the `:t' glob modifier) of files in the directory
	      ~/Mail; else

	      if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then
	      complete any file; else

	      complete user names.

ZSHMODULES(1)							 ZSHMODULES(1)

NAME
       zshmodules - zsh loadable modules

DESCRIPTION
       Some  optional  parts  of zsh are in modules, separate from the core of
       the shell.  Each of these modules may be linked	in  to	the  shell  at
       build  time, or can be dynamically linked while the shell is running if
       the installation supports this feature.	Modules are linked at  runtime
       with the zmodload command, see zshbuiltins(1).

       The modules that are bundled with the zsh distribution are:

       zsh/attr
	      Builtins for manipulating extended attributes (xattr).

       zsh/cap
	      Builtins	for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability (privi‐
	      lege) sets.

       zsh/clone
	      A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.

       zsh/compctl
	      The compctl builtin for controlling completion.

       zsh/complete
	      The basic completion code.

       zsh/complist
	      Completion listing extensions.

       zsh/computil
	      A module with utility builtins needed  for  the  shell  function
	      based completion system.

       zsh/curses
	      curses windowing commands

       zsh/datetime
	      Some date/time commands and parameters.

       zsh/deltochar
	      A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' zap-to-char.

       zsh/example
	      An example of how to write a module.

       zsh/files
	      Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.

       zsh/langinfo
	      Interface to locale information.

       zsh/mapfile
	      Access to external files via a special associative array.

       zsh/mathfunc
	      Standard	scientific  functions  for use in mathematical evalua‐
	      tions.

       zsh/newuser
	      Arrange for files for new users to be installed.

       zsh/parameter
	      Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.

       zsh/pcre
	      Interface to the PCRE library.

       zsh/regex
	      Interface to the POSIX regex library.

       zsh/sched
	      A builtin that provides a timed execution	 facility  within  the
	      shell.

       zsh/net/socket
	      Manipulation of Unix domain sockets

       zsh/stat
	      A builtin command interface to the stat system call.

       zsh/system
	      A builtin interface to various low-level system features.

       zsh/net/tcp
	      Manipulation of TCP sockets

       zsh/termcap
	      Interface to the termcap database.

       zsh/terminfo
	      Interface to the terminfo database.

       zsh/zftp
	      A builtin FTP client.

       zsh/zle
	      The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.

       zsh/zleparameter
	      Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.

       zsh/zprof
	      A module allowing profiling for shell functions.

       zsh/zpty
	      A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.

       zsh/zselect
	      Block and return when file descriptors are ready.

       zsh/zutil
	      Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration
	      via styles.

THE ZSH/ATTR MODULE
       The zsh/attr module is used for manipulating extended attributes.   The
       -h  option  causes all commands to operate on symbolic links instead of
       their targets.  The builtins in this module are:

       zgetattr [ -h ] filename attribute [ parameter ]
	      Get the extended attribute attribute from	 the  specified	 file‐
	      name. If the optional argument parameter is given, the attribute
	      is set on that parameter instead of being printed to stdout.

       zsetattr [ -h ] filename attribute value
	      Set the extended attribute attribute on the  specified  filename
	      to value.

       zdelattr [ -h ] filename attribute
	      Remove the extended attribute attribute from the specified file‐
	      name.

       zlistattr [ -h ] filename [ parameter ]
	      List the extended attributes  currently  set  on	the  specified
	      filename.	 If the optional argument parameter is given, the list
	      of attributes is set on that parameter instead of being  printed
	      to stdout.

       zgetattr	 and  zlistattr allocate memory dynamically.  If the attribute
       or list of attributes grows between the allocation and the call to  get
       them,  they return 2.  On all other errors, 1 is returned.  This allows
       the calling function to check for this case and retry.

THE ZSH/CAP MODULE
       The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capabil‐
       ity sets.  If the operating system does not support this interface, the
       builtins defined by this module will do nothing.	 The builtins in  this
       module are:

       cap [ capabilities ]
	      Change  the  shell's  process  capability	 sets to the specified
	      capabilities, otherwise display the  shell's  current  capabili‐
	      ties.

       getcap filename ...
	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
	      It displays the capability sets on each specified filename.

       setcap capabilities filename ...
	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
	      It  sets	the  capability sets on each specified filename to the
	      specified capabilities.

THE ZSH/CLONE MODULE
       The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:

       clone tty
	      Creates a forked instance of the current shell, attached to  the
	      specified	 tty.  In the new shell, the PID, PPID and TTY special
	      parameters are changed appropriately.  $! is set to zero in  the
	      new shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original shell.

	      The  return status of the builtin is zero in both shells if suc‐
	      cessful, and non-zero on error.

	      The target of clone should be an unused  terminal,  such	as  an
	      unused virtual console or a virtual terminal created by

	      xterm  -e	 sh  -c	 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty; while :; do sleep
	      100000000; done'

	      Some words of explanation are warranted about  this  long	 xterm
	      command  line: when doing clone on a pseudo-terminal, some other
	      session ("session" meant as a unix session  group,  or  SID)  is
	      already owning the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh cannot acquire
	      the pseudo-terminal as a controlling tty. That means two things:

	      the job control  signals	will  go  to  the  sh-started-by-xterm
	      process
		    group  (that's why we disable INT QUIT and TSTP with trap;
	      otherwise
		    the while loop could get suspended or killed)

	      the cloned shell will have job control disabled, and the job
		    control keys (control-C, control-\ and control-Z) will not
	      work.

	      This does not apply when cloning to an unused vc.

	      Cloning  to  a used (and unprepared) terminal will result in two
	      processes reading simultaneously from the	 same  terminal,  with
	      input bytes going randomly to either process.

	      clone  is	 mostly	 useful	 as  a	shell built-in replacement for
	      openvt.

THE ZSH/COMPCTL MODULE
       The zsh/compctl module makes available two builtin  commands.  compctl,
       is the old, deprecated way to control completions for ZLE.  See zshcom‐
       pctl(1).	  The  other  builtin  command,	 compcall  can	be   used   in
       user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLETE MODULE
       The  zsh/complete module makes available several builtin commands which
       can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLIST MODULE
       The zsh/complist module offers three extensions to completion listings:
       the  ability to highlight matches in such a list, the ability to scroll
       through long lists and a different style of menu completion.

   Colored completion listings
       Whenever one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the
       zsh/complist  module  is	 loaded	 or  linked into the shell, completion
       lists will be colored.  Note, however, that complist will not automati‐
       cally  be loaded if it is not linked in:	 on systems with dynamic load‐
       ing, `zmodload zsh/complist' is required.

       The parameters ZLS_COLORS and  ZLS_COLOURS  describe  how  matches  are
       highlighted.  To turn on highlighting an empty value suffices, in which
       case all the default values given below will be used.   The  format  of
       the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU version of
       the ls command: a colon-separated list of specifications	 of  the  form
       `name=value'.   The  name  may be one of the following strings, most of
       which specify file types for which the value will be used.  The strings
       and their default values are:

       no 0   for  normal  text	 (i.e.	when displaying something other than a
	      matched file)

       fi 0   for regular files

       di 32  for directories

       ln 36  for symbolic links.  If this has the special value target,  sym‐
	      bolic  links are dereferenced and the target file used to deter‐
	      mine the display format.

       pi 31  for named pipes (FIFOs)

       so 33  for sockets

       bd 44;37
	      for block devices

       cd 44;37
	      for character devices

       or none
	      for a symlink to nonexistent file (default is the value  defined
	      for ln)

       mi none
	      for  a  non-existent file (default is the value defined for fi);
	      this code is currently not used

       su 37;41
	      for files with setuid bit set

       sg 30;43
	      for files with setgid bit set

       tw 30;42
	      for world writable directories with sticky bit set

       ow 34;43
	      for world writable directories without sticky bit set

       sa none
	      for files with an associated suffix alias; this is  only	tested
	      after specific suffixes, as described below

       st 37;44
	      for directories with sticky bit set but not world writable

       ex 35  for executable files

       lc \e[ for the left code (see below)

       rc m   for the right code

       tc 0   for  the character indicating the file type  printed after file‐
	      names if the LIST_TYPES option is set

       sp 0   for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column

       ec none
	      for the end code

       Apart from these strings, the name may also be an asterisk  (`*')  fol‐
       lowed by any string. The value given for such a string will be used for
       all files whose name ends with the string.  The name  may  also	be  an
       equals  sign (`=') followed by a pattern; the EXTENDED_GLOB option will
       be turned on for evaluation of the pattern.  The value given  for  this
       pattern will be used for all matches (not just filenames) whose display
       string are matched by the pattern.  Definitions for the form  with  the
       leading	equal  sign  take  precedence over the values defined for file
       types, which in turn take precedence over the  form  with  the  leading
       asterisk (file extensions).

       The  leading-equals  form  also allows different parts of the displayed
       strings to be colored differently.  For this, the pattern  has  to  use
       the `(#b)' globbing flag and pairs of parentheses surrounding the parts
       of the strings that are to be colored differently.  In  this  case  the
       value may consist of more than one color code separated by equal signs.
       The first code will be used for all parts for which no explicit code is
       specified and the following codes will be used for the parts matched by
       the  sub-patterns  in  parentheses.   For  example,  the	 specification
       `=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7'  will  be  used for all matches which are at least
       two characters long and will use the code `3' for the first  character,
       `7' for the last character and `0' for the rest.

       All  three  forms  of name may be preceded by a pattern in parentheses.
       If this is given, the value will be used only  for  matches  in	groups
       whose  names  are matched by the pattern given in the parentheses.  For
       example, `(g*)m*=43' highlights	all  matches  beginning	 with  `m'  in
       groups  whose names  begin with `g' using the color code `43'.  In case
       of the `lc', `rc', and `ec' codes, the group pattern is ignored.

       Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear
       in the parameter value until the first one matches which is then used.

       When  printing  a match, the code prints the value of lc, the value for
       the file-type or the last matching specification with a `*', the	 value
       of  rc,	the string to display for the match itself, and then the value
       of ec if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and rc if ec  is  not
       defined.

       The  default  values  are  ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and can be used on
       vt100 compatible terminals such as xterms.  On monochrome terminals the
       default	values	will have no visible effect.  The colors function from
       the contribution can be used to get associative arrays  containing  the
       codes  for ANSI terminals (see the section `Other Functions' in zshcon‐
       trib(1)).  For example, after loading  colors,  one  could  use	`$col‐
       ors[red]'  to  get  the	code  for  foreground  color  red  and	`$col‐
       ors[bg-green]' for the code for background color green.

       If the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these  parameters
       should  not  be	set  directly because the system controls them itself.
       Instead, the list-colors style should be used (see the section `Comple‐
       tion System Configuration' in zshcompsys(1)).

   Scrolling in completion listings
       To enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter
       must be set.  Its value will be used as the prompt; if it is the	 empty
       string,	a  default prompt will be used.	 The value may contain escapes
       of the form `%x'.  It supports the  escapes  `%B',  `%b',  `%S',	 `%s',
       `%U',  `%u',  `%F',  `%f',  `%K', `%k' and `%{...%}' used also in shell
       prompts as well as three pairs of additional sequences: a `%l' or  `%L'
       is  replaced  by the number of the last line shown and the total number
       of lines in the form `number/total'; a `%m' or `%M'  is	replaced  with
       the number of the last match shown and the total number of matches; and
       `%p' or `%P' is replaced with `Top', `Bottom' or the  position  of  the
       first line shown in percent of the total number of lines, respectively.
       In each of these cases the form	with  the  uppercase  letter  will  be
       replaced with a string of fixed width, padded to the right with spaces,
       while the lowercase form will not be padded.

       If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if
       the list should be shown.  Instead it immediately starts displaying the
       list, stopping after the first screenful, showing  the  prompt  at  the
       bottom,	waiting	 for  a	 keypress  after  temporarily switching to the
       listscroll keymap.  Some of the zle functions have  a  special  meaning
       while scrolling lists:

       send-break
	      stops listing discarding the key pressed

       accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history
       down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
	      scrolls forward one line

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
	      scrolls forward one screenful

       accept-search
	      stop listing but take no other action

       Every  other  character stops listing and immediately processes the key
       as usual.  Any key that is not bound in the listscroll keymap  or  that
       is  bound  to  undefined-key  is	 looked	 up  in	 the  keymap currently
       selected.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not
       be  set directly when using the shell function based completion system.
       Instead, the list-prompt style should be used.

   Menu selection
       The zsh/complist module also offers an alternative style	 of  selecting
       matches	from  a	 list, called menu selection, which can be used if the
       shell is set up to return to the last prompt after showing a completion
       list (see the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option in zshoptions(1)).

       Menu  selection	can  be	 invoked  directly  by	the widget menu-select
       defined by this module.	This is a standard  ZLE	 widget	 that  can  be
       bound to a key in the usual way as described in zshzle(1).

       Alternatively, the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which
       gives the minimum number of matches that must be	 present  before  menu
       selection is automatically turned on.  This second method requires that
       menu completion be started, either  directly  from  a  widget  such  as
       menu-complete,  or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or AUTO_MENU
       being set.  If MENUSELECT is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu  selection
       will always be started during an ambiguous menu completion.

       When  using the completion system based on shell functions, the MENUSE‐
       LECT parameter should not be used (like the ZLS_COLORS and  ZLS_COLOURS
       parameters  described  above).	Instead, the menu style should be used
       with the select=... keyword.

       After menu selection is started, the matches will be listed.  If	 there
       are  more  matches  than fit on the screen, only the first screenful is
       shown.  The matches to insert into the command  line  can  be  selected
       from  this  list.  In the list one match is highlighted using the value
       for ma from the ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter.  The default value
       for this is `7' which forces the selected match to be highlighted using
       standout mode on a vt100-compatible terminal.   If  neither  ZLS_COLORS
       nor  ZLS_COLOURS	 is set, the same terminal control sequence as for the
       `%S' escape in prompts is used.

       If there are more matches than fit on  the  screen  and	the  parameter
       MENUPROMPT  is set, its value will be shown below the matches.  It sup‐
       ports the same escape sequences as LISTPROMPT, but the  number  of  the
       match  or  line shown will be that of the one where the mark is placed.
       If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

       The MENUSCROLL parameter can  be	 used  to  specify  how	 the  list  is
       scrolled.   If the parameter is unset, this is done line by line, if it
       is set to `0' (zero), the list will scroll half the number of lines  of
       the  screen.  If the value is positive, it gives the number of lines to
       scroll and if it is negative, the list will be scrolled the  number  of
       lines of the screen minus the (absolute) value.

       As  for	the ZLS_COLORS, ZLS_COLOURS and LISTPROMPT parameters, neither
       MENUPROMPT nor MENUSCROLL should be set directly when using  the	 shell
       function	 based	completion  system.   Instead,	the  select-prompt and
       select-scroll styles should be used.

       The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in
       the  list.   These hidden matches are either matches for which the com‐
       pletion function which added them explicitly requested  that  they  not
       appear in the list (using the -n option of the compadd builtin command)
       or they are matches which  duplicate  a	string	already	 in  the  list
       (because	 they differ only in things like prefixes or suffixes that are
       not displayed).	In the list used for  menu  selection,	however,  even
       these  matches  are  shown  so  that it is possible to select them.  To
       highlight such matches the hi and du capabilities in the ZLS_COLORS and
       ZLS_COLOURS  parameters	are  supported for hidden matches of the first
       and second kind, respectively.

       Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around using the zle move‐
       ment functions.	When not all matches can be shown on the screen at the
       same time, the list will scroll up and down when crossing  the  top  or
       bottom  line.   The following zle functions have special meaning during
       menu selection.	Note that the following always perform the  same  task
       within  the  menu  selection map and cannot be replaced by user defined
       widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended:

       accept-line, accept-search
	      accept the current match and leave menu selection	 (but  do  not
	      cause the command line to be accepted)

       send-break
	      leaves  menu selection and restores the previous contents of the
	      command line

       redisplay, clear-screen
	      execute their normal function without leaving menu selection

       accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
	      accept the  currently  inserted  match  and  continue  selection
	      allowing to select the next match to insert into the line

       accept-and-infer-next-history
	      accepts  the  current  match and then tries completion with menu
	      selection again;	in the case of files this allows one to select
	      a directory and immediately attempt to complete files in it;  if
	      there are no matches, a message is shown and one can use undo to
	      go  back	to  completion	on the previous level, every other key
	      leaves menu selection (including the other zle  functions	 which
	      are otherwise special during menu selection)

       undo   removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of the
	      three functions before

       down-history, down-line-or-history
       vi-down-line-or-history,	 down-line-or-search
	      moves the mark one line down

       up-history, up-line-or-history
       vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
	      moves the mark one line up

       forward-char, vi-forward-char
	      moves the mark one column right

       backward-char, vi-backward-char
	      moves the mark one column left

       forward-word, vi-forward-word
       vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
	      moves the mark one screenful down

       backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word
	      moves the mark one screenful up

       vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
	      moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches

       vi-backward-blank-word
	      moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches

       beginning-of-history
	      moves the mark to the first line

       end-of-history
	      moves the mark to the last line

       beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
       beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
	      moves the mark to the leftmost column

       end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
       end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
	      moves the mark to the rightmost column

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
	      moves the mark to the next match

       reverse-menu-complete
	      moves the mark to the previous match

       vi-insert
	      this toggles between normal and interactive mode; in interactive
	      mode the keys bound to self-insert and self-insert-unmeta insert
	      into the command line as in  normal  editing  mode  but  without
	      leaving menu selection; after each character completion is tried
	      again and the list changes to contain only the new matches;  the
	      completion  widgets  make	 the  longest  unambiguous  string  be
	      inserted in the command line and undo  and  backward-delete-char
	      go back to the previous set of matches

       history-incremental-search-forward
       history-incremental-search-backward
	      this starts incremental searches in the list of completions dis‐
	      played;  in  this	 mode,	accept-line  only  leaves  incremental
	      search, going back to the normal menu selection mode

       All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function
       not listed leaves menu selection and executes  that  function.	It  is
       possible	 to  make  widgets  in the above list do the same by using the
       form of the widget with a  `.'  in  front.   For	 example,  the	widget
       `.accept-line'  has  the effect of leaving menu selection and accepting
       the entire command line.

       During this selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect.   Any  key
       that is not defined in this keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is
       looked up in the keymap currently selected.  This  is  used  to	ensure
       that  the  most important keys used during selection (namely the cursor
       keys, return, and TAB) have sensible defaults.  However,	 keys  in  the
       menuselect  keymap  can	be modified directly using the bindkey builtin
       command (see zshmodules(1)). For example, to make the return key	 leave
       menu selection without accepting the match currently selected one could
       call

	      bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break

       after loading the zsh/complist module.

THE ZSH/COMPUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used  by
       some  of	 the  completion  functions  in the completion system based on
       shell functions (see  zshcompsys(1)  ).	 Except	 for  compquote	 these
       builtin	commands  are  very  specialised and thus not very interesting
       when writing your own completion functions.  In summary, these  builtin
       commands are:

       comparguments
	      This  is	used by the _arguments function to do the argument and
	      command line parsing.  Like compdescribe it has an option -i  to
	      do  the  parsing	and initialize some internal state and various
	      options to access the state information to decide what should be
	      completed.

       compdescribe
	      This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for
	      the matches and to get the strings to add as matches with	 their
	      options.	 On  the first call one of the options -i or -I should
	      be supplied as the first argument.  In the first	case,  display
	      strings  without the descriptions will be generated, in the sec‐
	      ond case, the string used to separate  the  matches  from	 their
	      descriptions  must  be  given  as	 the  second  argument and the
	      descriptions (if any) will be shown.  All	 other	arguments  are
	      like the definition arguments to _describe itself.

	      Once  compdescribe  has been called with either the -i or the -I
	      option, it can be repeatedly called with the -g option  and  the
	      names  of	 five arrays as its arguments.	This will step through
	      the different sets of matches and store the options in the first
	      array,  the strings with descriptions in the second, the matches
	      for these in the third, the strings without descriptions in  the
	      fourth,  and the matches for them in the fifth array.  These are
	      then directly given to compadd to register the matches with  the
	      completion code.

       compfiles
	      Used  by	the _path_files function to optimize complex recursive
	      filename generation (globbing).  It does three things.  With the
	      -p  and -P options it builds the glob patterns to use, including
	      the paths already handled and trying to  optimize	 the  patterns
	      with  respect  to	 the  prefix  and suffix from the line and the
	      match specification currently used.   The	 -i  option  does  the
	      directory	 tests	for the ignore-parents style and the -r option
	      tests if a component for some of the matches are	equal  to  the
	      string  on  the  line  and  removes all other matches if that is
	      true.

       compgroups
	      Used by the _tags function to implement  the  internals  of  the
	      group-order  style.   This  only takes its arguments as names of
	      completion groups and creates the groups for it (all six	types:
	      sorted  and  unsorted,  both  without  removing duplicates, with
	      removing all duplicates and  with	 removing  consecutive	dupli‐
	      cates).

       compquote [ -p ] names ...
	      There  may be reasons to write completion functions that have to
	      add the matches using the -Q option to compadd and perform quot‐
	      ing  themselves.	Instead of interpreting the first character of
	      the all_quotes key of  the  compstate  special  association  and
	      using  the  q  flag  for	parameter expansions, one can use this
	      builtin command.	The arguments are the names of scalar or array
	      parameters  and  the  values  of	these parameters are quoted as
	      needed for the innermost quoting level.  If  the	-p  option  is
	      given,  quoting  is  done	 as if there is some prefix before the
	      values of the parameters, so that a leading equal sign will  not
	      be quoted.

	      The  return status is non-zero in case of an error and zero oth‐
	      erwise.

       comptags
       comptry
	      These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.

       compvalues
	      Like comparguments, but for the _values function.

THE ZSH/CURSES MODULE
       The zsh/curses module makes available one builtin command  and  various
       parameters.

   Builtin
       zcurses init
       zcurses end
       zcurses addwin targetwin nlines ncols begin_y begin_x [ parentwin ]
       zcurses delwin targetwin
       zcurses refresh [ targetwin ... ]
       zcurses touch targetwin ...
       zcurses move targetwin new_y new_x
       zcurses clear targetwin [ redraw | eol | bot ]
       zcurses position targetwin array
       zcurses char targetwin character
       zcurses string targetwin string
       zcurses border targetwin border
       zcurses attr targetwin [ {+/-}attribute | fg_col/bg_col ] [...]
       zcurses bg targetwin [ {+/-}attribute | fg_col/bg_col | @char ] [...]
       zcurses scroll targetwin [ on | off | {+/-}lines ]
       zcurses input targetwin [ param [ kparam [ mparam ] ] ]
       zcurses mouse [ delay num | {+/-}motion ]
       zcurses timeout targetwin intval
       zcurses querychar targetwin [ param ]
	      Manipulate  curses  windows.  All uses of this command should be
	      bracketed by `zcurses init' to initialise	 use  of  curses,  and
	      `zcurses	end'  to  end it; omitting `zcurses end' can cause the
	      terminal to be in an unwanted state.

	      The subcommand addwin creates a window  with  nlines  lines  and
	      ncols  columns.	Its  upper  left  corner will be placed at row
	      begin_y and column begin_x of the screen.	 targetwin is a string
	      and  refers  to  the  name  of  a	 window	 that is not currently
	      assigned.	 Note in particular the curses convention that	verti‐
	      cal values appear before horizontal values.

	      If addwin is given an existing window as the final argument, the
	      new window is created as a subwindow of parentwin.  This differs
	      from  an	ordinary  new  window in that the memory of the window
	      contents is shared with the parent's memory.  Subwindows must be
	      deleted  before their parent.  Note that the coordinates of sub‐
	      windows are relative to the screen,  not	the  parent,  as  with
	      other windows.

	      Use  the	subcommand  delwin  to	delete	a  window created with
	      addwin.  Note that end does not implicitly delete	 windows,  and
	      that delwin does not erase the screen image of the window.

	      The  window  corresponding  to the full visible screen is called
	      stdscr; it always exists after  `zcurses	init'  and  cannot  be
	      delete with delwin.

	      The  subcommand  refresh	will refresh window targetwin; this is
	      necessary to make any pending changes (such  as  characters  you
	      have  prepared  for  output  with	 char)	visible on the screen.
	      refresh without an argument causes the screen to be cleared  and
	      redrawn.	 If  multiple windows are given, the screen is updated
	      once at the end.

	      The subcommand touch marks the  targetwins  listed  as  changed.
	      This is necessary before refreshing windows if a window that was
	      in front of another window (which may be stdscr) is deleted.

	      The subcommand move moves the cursor position  in	 targetwin  to
	      new  coordinates	new_y  and  new_x.   Note  that the subcommand
	      string (but not the subcommand char) advances the	 cursor	 posi‐
	      tion over the characters added.

	      The subcommand clear erases the contents of targetwin.  One (and
	      no more than one) of three options may be specified.   With  the
	      option  redraw,  in  addition the next refresh of targetwin will
	      cause the screen to be cleared and repainted.  With  the	option
	      eol,  targetwin is only cleared to the end of the current cursor
	      line.  With the option bot, targetwin is cleared to the  end  of
	      the  window, i.e everything to the right and below the cursor is
	      cleared.

	      The subcommand position writes various positions associated with
	      targetwin into the array named array.  These are, in order:
	      -	     The y and x coordinates of the cursor relative to the top
		     left of targetwin
	      -	     The y and x coordinates of the top left of	 targetwin  on
		     the screen
	      -	     The size of targetwin in y and x dimensions.

	      Outputting  characters  and  strings  are	 achieved  by char and
	      string respectively.

	      To draw a border around window targetwin, use border.  Note that
	      the  border  is  not  subsequently  handled specially:  in other
	      words, the border is simply a set of characters  output  at  the
	      edge of the window.  Hence it can be overwritten, can scroll off
	      the window, etc.

	      The subcommand attr will set  targetwin's	 attributes  or	 fore‐
	      ground/background	 color	pair for any successive character out‐
	      put.  Each attribute given on the line may be prepended by  a  +
	      to  set  or a - to unset that attribute; + is assumed if absent.
	      The attributes supported are blink, bold, dim,  reverse,	stand‐
	      out, and underline.

	      Each  fg_col/bg_col attribute (to be read as `fg_col on bg_col')
	      sets the foreground and background color for  character  output.
	      The  color  default is sometimes available (in particular if the
	      library is ncurses), specifying  the  foreground	or  background
	      color   with   which  the	 terminal  started.   The  color  pair
	      default/default is always available.

	      bg overrides the color and other attributes of all characters in
	      the  window.   Its usual use is to set the background initially,
	      but it will overwrite the attributes of any  characters  at  the
	      time  when  it  is called.  In addition to the arguments allowed
	      with attr, an argument @char specifies a character to  be	 shown
	      in otherwise blank areas of the window.  Owing to limitations of
	      curses this cannot be a multibyte character (use of ASCII	 char‐
	      acters only is recommended).  As the specified set of attributes
	      override the existing background, turning attributes off in  the
	      arguments is not useful, though this does not cause an error.

	      The  subcommand  scroll can be used with on or off to enabled or
	      disable scrolling of a window when the  cursor  would  otherwise
	      move  below  the window due to typing or output.	It can also be
	      used with a positive or negative integer to scroll the window up
	      or  down	the given number of lines without changing the current
	      cursor position (which therefore appears to move in the opposite
	      direction	 relative  to  the  window).   In  the second case, if
	      scrolling is off it is temporarily turned on to allow the window
	      to be scrolled.

	      The  subcommand  input  reads a single character from the window
	      without echoing it back.	If param is supplied the character  is
	      assigned	to  the	 parameter  param,  else it is assigned to the
	      parameter REPLY.

	      If both param and kparam are supplied, the key is read in	 `key‐
	      pad'  mode.  In this mode special keys such as function keys and
	      arrow keys return the name of the key in the  parameter  kparam.
	      The  key	names  are  the	 macros	 defined  in  the  curses.h or
	      ncurses.h with the prefix `KEY_' removed; see also the  descrip‐
	      tion  of the parameter zcurses_keycodes below.  Other keys cause
	      a value to be set in param as before.  On	 a  successful	return
	      only  one	 of  param  or kparam contains a non-empty string; the
	      other is set to an empty string.

	      If mparam is also	 supplied,  input  attempts  to	 handle	 mouse
	      input.   This  is only available with the ncurses library; mouse
	      handling can be detected by checking  for	 the  exit  status  of
	      `zcurses mouse' with no arguments.  If a mouse button is clicked
	      (or double- or triple-clicked, or pressed	 or  released  with  a
	      configurable delay from being clicked) then kparam is set to the
	      string MOUSE, and mparam is set to an array  consisting  of  the
	      following elements:
	      -	     An	 identifier  to	 discriminate different input devices;
		     this is only rarely useful.
	      -	     The x, y and z coordinates of the mouse click relative to
		     the  full	screen,	 as three elements in that order (i.e.
		     the y coordinate is, unusually, after the x  coordinate).
		     The  z  coordinate	 is  only  available for a few unusual
		     input devices and is otherwise set to zero.
	      -	     Any events that occurred as separate items; usually there
		     will   be	just  one.   An	 event	consists  of  PRESSED,
		     RELEASED, CLICKED, DOUBLE_CLICKED or TRIPLE_CLICKED  fol‐
		     lowed  immediately (in the same element) by the number of
		     the button.
	      -	     If the shift key was pressed, the string SHIFT.
	      -	     If the control key was pressed, the string CTRL.
	      -	     If the alt key was pressed, the string ALT.

	      Not all mouse events may be passed through to the terminal  win‐
	      dow;  most  terminal  emulators  handle  some mouse events them‐
	      selves.  Note that the ncurses manual implies that  using	 input
	      both  with and without mouse handling may cause the mouse cursor
	      to appear and disappear.

	      The subcommand mouse can be used to configure  the  use  of  the
	      mouse.   There  is no window argument; mouse options are global.
	      `zcurses mouse' with no arguments returns status 0 if mouse han‐
	      dling is possible, else status 1.	 Otherwise, the possible argu‐
	      ments (which may be combined on the same command	line)  are  as
	      follows.	 delay	num  sets  the	maximum	 delay in milliseconds
	      between press and release events to be considered	 as  a	click;
	      the  value  0  disables click resolution, and the default is one
	      sixth of a second.  motion proceeded by  an  optional  `+'  (the
	      default) or - turns on or off reporting of mouse motion in addi‐
	      tion to clicks, presses and releases, which are always reported.
	      However,	it  appears reports for mouse motion are not currently
	      implemented.

	      The subcommand timeout specifies a timeout value for input  from
	      targetwin.  If intval is negative, `zcurses input' waits indefi‐
	      nitely for a character to be typed; this	is  the	 default.   If
	      intval is zero, `zcurses input' returns immediately; if there is
	      typeahead it is returned, else no input is done and status 1  is
	      returned.	  If  intval is positive, `zcurses input' waits intval
	      milliseconds for input and if there is none at the end  of  that
	      period returns status 1.

	      The  subcommand  querychar  queries the character at the current
	      cursor position.	The return values  are	stored	in  the	 array
	      named  param  if	supplied,  else in the array reply.  The first
	      value is the character (which may be a  multibyte	 character  if
	      the  system  supports them); the second is the color pair in the
	      usual fg_col/bg_col notation, or 0 if color  is  not  supported.
	      Any  attributes other than color that apply to the character, as
	      set with the subcommand attr, appear as additional elements.

   Parameters
       ZCURSES_COLORS
	      Readonly integer.	 The maximum number  of	 colors	 the  terminal
	      supports.	  This	value is initialised by the curses library and
	      is not available until the first time zcurses init is run.

       ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS
	      Readonly	integer.   The	 maximum   number   of	 color	 pairs
	      fg_col/bg_col  that  may	be defined in `zcurses attr' commands;
	      note this limit applies to all color pairs that have  been  used
	      whether  or  not	they are currently active.  This value is ini‐
	      tialised by the curses library and is not	 available  until  the
	      first time zcurses init is run.

       zcurses_attrs
	      Readonly	array.	The attributes supported by zsh/curses; avail‐
	      able as soon as the module is loaded.

       zcurses_colors
	      Readonly array.  The colors supported by	zsh/curses;  available
	      as soon as the module is loaded.

       zcurses_keycodes
	      Readonly	array.	 The values that may be returned in the second
	      parameter supplied to `zcurses input' in the order in which they
	      are  defined  internally	by  curses.  Not all function keys are
	      listed, only F0; curses reserves space for F0 up to F63.

       zcurses_windows
	      Readonly array.  The current list of windows, i.e.  all  windows
	      that  have  been	created	 with `zcurses addwin' and not removed
	      with `zcurses delwin'.

THE ZSH/DATETIME MODULE
       The zsh/datetime module makes available one builtin command:

       strftime [ -s scalar ] format epochtime
       strftime -r [ -q ] [ -s scalar ] format timestring
	      Output the date denoted by epochtime in the format specified.

	      With the option -r (reverse), use the format format to parse the
	      input  string  timestring and output the number of seconds since
	      the epoch at which the time occurred.  If no timezone is parsed,
	      the  current  timezone is used; other parameters are set to zero
	      if not present.  If timestring does not match format the command
	      returns  status  1;  it will additionally print an error message
	      unless the option -q (quiet) is given.   If  timestring  matches
	      format  but not all characters in timestring were used, the con‐
	      version succeeds; however, a warning is issued unless the option
	      -q is given.  The matching is implemented by the system function
	      strptime; see strptime(3).  This means that  zsh	format	exten‐
	      sions are not available, however for reverse lookup they are not
	      required.	 If the	 function  is  not  implemented,  the  command
	      returns status 2 and (unless -q is given) prints a message.

	      If  -s scalar is given, assign the date string (or epoch time in
	      seconds if -r is given) to scalar instead of printing it.

       The zsh/datetime module makes available	several	 parameters;  all  are
       readonly:

       EPOCHREALTIME
	      A	 floating point value representing the number of seconds since
	      the epoch.  The notional	accuracy  is  to  nanoseconds  if  the
	      clock_gettime  call  is available and to microseconds otherwise,
	      but in practice the range of double precision floating point and
	      shell scheduling latencies may be significant effects.

       EPOCHSECONDS
	      An  integer  value  representing the number of seconds since the
	      epoch.

       epochtime
	      An array value containing the number of seconds since the	 epoch
	      in  the  first  element  and the remainder of the time since the
	      epoch in nanoseconds in the second element.  To ensure  the  two
	      elements	are consistent the array should be copied or otherwise
	      referenced as a single substitution before the values are	 used.
	      The following idiom may be used:

		     for secs nsecs in $epochtime; do
		       ...
		     done

THE ZSH/DELTOCHAR MODULE
       The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:

       delete-to-char
	      Read  a  character from the keyboard, and delete from the cursor
	      position up to and including the next (or, with repeat count  n,
	      the  nth)	 instance  of  that character.	Negative repeat counts
	      mean delete backwards.

       zap-to-char
	      This behaves like delete-to-char, except that the	 final	occur‐
	      rence of the character itself is not deleted.

THE ZSH/EXAMPLE MODULE
       The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:

       example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]
	      Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.

       The  purpose  of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a
       module.

THE ZSH/FILES MODULE
       The zsh/files module makes available  some  common  commands  for  file
       manipulation  as	 builtins;  these commands are probably not needed for
       many normal situations but can be useful in emergency  recovery	situa‐
       tions  with  constrained	 resources.  The commands do not implement all
       features now required by relevant standards committees.

       For all commands, a variant beginning zf_ is also available and	loaded
       automatically.	Using the features capability of zmodload will let you
       load only those names you want.

       The commands loaded by default are:

       chgrp [ -hRs ] group filename ...
	      Changes group of files specified.	 This is equivalent  to	 chown
	      with a user-spec argument of `:group'.

       chown [ -hRs ] user-spec filename ...
	      Changes ownership and group of files specified.

	      The user-spec can be in four forms:

	      user   change owner to user; do not change group
	      user:: change owner to user; do not change group
	      user:  change  owner  to	user;  change  group to user's primary
		     group
	      user:group
		     change owner to user; change group to group
	      :group do not change owner; change group to group

	      In each case, the `:' may instead be a `.'.  The rule is that if
	      there  is a `:' then the separator is `:', otherwise if there is
	      a `.' then the separator is `.', otherwise there is  no  separa‐
	      tor.

	      Each  of user and group may be either a username (or group name,
	      as appropriate) or a decimal user ID (group ID).	Interpretation
	      as  a name takes precedence, if there is an all-numeric username
	      (or group name).

	      If the target is a symbolic link, the -h option causes chown  to
	      set the ownership of the link instead of its target.

	      The  -R option causes chown to recursively descend into directo‐
	      ries, changing the ownership of all files in the directory after
	      changing the ownership of the directory itself.

	      The  -s  option  is  a zsh extension to chown functionality.  It
	      enables paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid security  problems
	      involving	 a chown being tricked into affecting files other than
	      the ones intended.  It will refuse to follow symbolic links,  so
	      that  (for  example) ``chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd'' can't acci‐
	      dentally chown /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a  link  to
	      /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving directories,
	      so that a recursive chown of a deep directory tree can't end  up
	      recursively chowning /usr as a result of directories being moved
	      up the tree.

       ln [ -dfhins ] filename dest
       ln [ -dfhins ] filename ... dir
	      Creates hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links.  In the first	 form,
	      the specified destination is created, as a link to the specified
	      filename.	 In the second form, each of the filenames is taken in
	      turn,  and  linked to a pathname in the specified directory that
	      has the same last pathname component.

	      Normally, ln will not attempt to create hard links  to  directo‐
	      ries.   This check can be overridden using the -d option.	 Typi‐
	      cally only the super-user can actually succeed in creating  hard
	      links  to directories.  This does not apply to symbolic links in
	      any case.

	      By default, existing files cannot be replaced by links.  The  -i
	      option  causes  the  user to be queried about replacing existing
	      files.  The -f option  causes  existing  files  to  be  silently
	      deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.

	      The  -h and -n options are identical and both exist for compati‐
	      bility; either one indicates that if the	target	is  a  symlink
	      then  it	should not be dereferenced.  Typically this is used in
	      combination with -sf so that if an existing  link	 points	 to  a
	      directory then it will be removed, instead of followed.  If this
	      option is used with multiple filenames and the target is a  sym‐
	      bolic link pointing to a directory then the result is an error.

       mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...
	      Creates  directories.   With  the -p option, non-existing parent
	      directories are first created if necessary, and there will be no
	      complaint if the directory already exists.  The -m option can be
	      used to specify (in octal) a set of  file	 permissions  for  the
	      created  directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current
	      umask (see umask(2)) is used.

       mv [ -fi ] filename dest
       mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir
	      Moves files.  In the first form, the specified filename is moved
	      to  the  specified destination.  In the second form, each of the
	      filenames is taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the spec‐
	      ified directory that has the same last pathname component.

	      By  default,  the user will be queried before replacing any file
	      that the user cannot  write  to,	but  writable  files  will  be
	      silently	removed.   The -i option causes the user to be queried
	      about replacing any existing files.  The -f  option  causes  any
	      existing	files  to  be  silently deleted, without querying.  -f
	      takes precedence.

	      Note that this mv will not move files across devices.   Histori‐
	      cal  versions  of	 mv,  when actual renaming is impossible, fall
	      back on  copying	and  removing  files;  if  this	 behaviour  is
	      desired,	use  cp	 and rm manually.  This may change in a future
	      version.

       rm [ -dfirs ] filename ...
	      Removes files and directories specified.

	      Normally, rm will not remove directories	(except	 with  the  -r
	      option).	 The  -d  option causes rm to try removing directories
	      with unlink (see unlink(2)), the same  method  used  for	files.
	      Typically	 only the super-user can actually succeed in unlinking
	      directories in this way.	-d takes precedence over -r.

	      By default, the user will be queried before  removing  any  file
	      that  the	 user  cannot  write  to,  but	writable files will be
	      silently removed.	 The -i option causes the user to  be  queried
	      about  removing  any  files.   The  -f option causes files to be
	      silently deleted, without querying,  and	suppresses  all	 error
	      indications.  -f takes precedence.

	      The -r option causes rm to recursively descend into directories,
	      deleting all files in the directory before removing  the	direc‐
	      tory with the rmdir system call (see rmdir(2)).

	      The  -s  option  is  a  zsh  extension  to rm functionality.  It
	      enables paranoid behaviour, intended to  avoid  common  security
	      problems	involving  a  root-run	rm being tricked into removing
	      files other than the ones intended.  It will  refuse  to	follow
	      symbolic	links,	so  that  (for example) ``rm /tmp/foo/passwd''
	      can't accidentally remove /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to  be
	      a	 link  to  /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving
	      directories, so that a recursive removal	of  a  deep  directory
	      tree  can't  end	up  recursively	 removing  /usr as a result of
	      directories being moved up the tree.

       rmdir dir ...
	      Removes empty directories specified.

       sync   Calls the system call of the  same  name	(see  sync(2)),	 which
	      flushes  dirty  buffers to disk.	It might return before the I/O
	      has actually been completed.

THE ZSH/LANGINFO MODULE
       The zsh/langinfo module makes available one parameter:

       langinfo
	      An associative array that maps langinfo elements to  their  val‐
	      ues.

	      Your implementation may support a number of the following keys:

	      CODESET,	D_T_FMT,  D_FMT,  T_FMT,  RADIXCHAR, THOUSEP, YESEXPR,
	      NOEXPR,  CRNCYSTR,  ABDAY_{1..7},	  DAY_{1..7},	ABMON_{1..12},
	      MON_{1..12},   T_FMT_AMPM,   AM_STR,   PM_STR,  ERA,  ERA_D_FMT,
	      ERA_D_T_FMT, ERA_T_FMT, ALT_DIGITS

THE ZSH/MAPFILE MODULE
       The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter
       of the same name.

       mapfile
	      This  associative	 array	takes  as keys the names of files; the
	      resulting value is the  content  of  the	file.	The  value  is
	      treated  identically  to any other text coming from a parameter.
	      The value may also be assigned to, in which  case	 the  file  in
	      question	is  written (whether or not it originally existed); or
	      an element may be unset, which will delete the file in question.
	      For  example, `vared mapfile[myfile]' works as expected, editing
	      the file `myfile'.

	      When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of
	      files  in	 the  current  directory, and the values are empty (to
	      save a huge overhead in memory).	 Thus  ${(k)mapfile}  has  the
	      same  affect  as	the  glob operator *(D), since files beginning
	      with a dot are not special.  Care must be taken with expressions
	      such  as	rm  ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the
	      current directory without the usual `rm *' test.

	      The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files
	      referenced may not be written or deleted.

	      A	 file  may  conveniently be read into an array as one line per
	      element with the form `array=("${(f@)mapfile[filename]}")'.  The
	      double  quotes  and the `@' are necessary to prevent empty lines
	      from being removed.  Note that if the file ends with a  newline,
	      the  shell  will split on the final newline, generating an addi‐
	      tional  empty  field;  this   can	  be   suppressed   by	 using
	      `array=("${(f@)${mapfile[filename]%$'\n'}}")'.

   Limitations
       Although	 reading  and  writing	of the file in question is efficiently
       handled, zsh's internal memory management may be	 arbitrarily  baroque;
       however,	 mapfile  is  usually  very  much more efficient than anything
       involving a loop.  Note in particular that the whole  contents  of  the
       file  will  always  reside physically in memory when accessed (possibly
       multiple times, due to standard parameter substitution operations).  In
       particular,  this  means	 handling  of sufficiently long files (greater
       than the machine's swap space, or than the range of the	pointer	 type)
       will be incorrect.

       No  errors  are	printed	 or  flagged  for non-existent, unreadable, or
       unwritable files, as the parameter mechanism is too low	in  the	 shell
       execution hierarchy to make this convenient.

       It  is  unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet
       allow the user to specify the name of the shell parameter to  be	 given
       the special behaviour.

THE ZSH/MATHFUNC MODULE
       The  zsh/mathfunc  module  provides standard mathematical functions for
       use when evaluating mathematical formulae.  The syntax agrees with nor‐
       mal C and FORTRAN conventions, for example,

	      (( f = sin(0.3) ))

       assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.

       Most  functions	take  floating	point  arguments and return a floating
       point value.  However, any necessary conversions	 from  or  to  integer
       type  will  be  performed  automatically by the shell.  Apart from atan
       with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all	 func‐
       tions  behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C func‐
       tion, except that any arguments out of range for the function in	 ques‐
       tion will be detected by the shell and an error reported.

       The  following  functions  take a single floating point argument: acos,
       acosh, asin, asinh, atan, atanh, cbrt, ceil, cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp,
       expm1,  fabs,  floor,  gamma,  j0, j1, lgamma, log, log10, log1p, logb,
       sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1.  The atan function  can  optionally
       take  a	second	argument, in which case it behaves like the C function
       atan2.  The ilogb function takes a single floating point argument,  but
       returns an integer.

       The  function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which
       is the C variable of the same name, as  described  in  gamma(3).	  Note
       that  it	 is therefore only useful immediately after a call to gamma or
       lgamma.	Note also that `signgam()' and `signgam' are distinct  expres‐
       sions.

       The  following  functions  take two floating point arguments: copysign,
       fmod, hypot, nextafter.

       The following take an integer first argument and a floating point  sec‐
       ond argument: jn, yn.

       The  following take a floating point first argument and an integer sec‐
       ond argument: ldexp, scalb.

       The function abs does not convert the type of its single	 argument;  it
       returns	the  absolute  value  of  either a floating point number or an
       integer.	 The functions float and int convert their  arguments  into  a
       floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.

       Note  that  the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation
       as the `**' operator and is not provided here.

       The function rand48 is available if your system's mathematical  library
       has the function erand48(3).  It returns a pseudo-random floating point
       number between 0 and 1.	It takes a single string optional argument.

       If the argument is not present, the random number seed  is  initialised
       by  three calls to the rand(3) function --- this produces the same ran‐
       dom numbers as the next three values of $RANDOM.

       If the argument is present, it gives the name  of  a  scalar  parameter
       where  the  current  random  number  seed will be stored.  On the first
       call, the value must contain at least twelve  hexadecimal  digits  (the
       remainder of the string is ignored), or the seed will be initialised in
       the same manner as for a call to rand48 with no	argument.   Subsequent
       calls  to  rand48(param)	 will  then maintain the seed in the parameter
       param as a string of twelve hexadecimal digits, with no base signifier.
       The  random  number  sequences  for different parameters are completely
       independent, and are also independent from that used by calls to rand48
       with no argument.

       For example, consider

	      print $(( rand48(seed) ))
	      print $(( rand48() ))
	      print $(( rand48(seed) ))

       Assuming	 $seed	does  not  exist,  it will be initialised by the first
       call.  In the second call, the default seed is initialised; note,  how‐
       ever,  that  because of the properties of rand() there is a correlation
       between the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for more	secure
       uses,  you  should  generate  your  own	12-byte	 seed.	The third call
       returns to the same sequence of random numbers used in the first	 call,
       unaffected by the intervening rand48().

THE ZSH/NEWUSER MODULE
       The  zsh/newuser	 module	 is loaded at boot if it is available, the RCS
       option is set, and the PRIVILEGED option is not set (all three are true
       by default).  This takes place immediately after commands in the global
       zshenv file (typically /etc/zshenv), if any, have  been	executed.   If
       the  module  is	not available it is silently ignored by the shell; the
       module may safely be removed from $MODULE_PATH by the administrator  if
       it is not required.

       On  loading,  the  module  tests	 if any of the start-up files .zshenv,
       .zprofile, .zshrc or .zlogin exist in the directory given by the	 envi‐
       ronment	variable  ZDOTDIR, or the user's home directory if that is not
       set.  The test is not performed and the module halts processing if  the
       shell  was  in  an  emulation mode (i.e. had been invoked as some other
       shell than zsh).

       If none of the start-up files were found, the module then looks for the
       file  newuser  first in a sitewide directory, usually the parent direc‐
       tory of the site-functions directory, and if that is not found the mod‐
       ule searches in a version-specific directory, usually the parent of the
       functions  directory  containing	 version-specific  functions.	(These
       directories   can   be	configured   when   zsh	 is  built  using  the
       --enable-site-scriptdir=dir and --enable-scriptdir=dir flags to config‐
       ure,   respectively;   the   defaults  are  prefix/share/zsh  and  pre‐
       fix/share/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION where the default prefix is /usr/local.)

       If the file newuser is found, it is then sourced in the same manner  as
       a  start-up  file.   The	 file  is  expected to contain code to install
       start-up files for the user, however any valid shell code will be  exe‐
       cuted.

       The zsh/newuser module is then unconditionally unloaded.

       Note  that  it  is  possible  to achieve exactly the same effect as the
       zsh/newuser module by adding code to /etc/zshenv.   The	module	exists
       simply  to  allow  the shell to make arrangements for new users without
       the need for intervention by package maintainers and system administra‐
       tors.

       The  script  supplied  with  the	 module	 invokes  the  shell  function
       zsh-newuser-install.  This may be invoked directly by the user even  if
       the  zsh/newuser module is disabled.  Note, however, that if the module
       is not installed the function will not be installed either.  The	 func‐
       tion  is documented in the section User Configuration Functions in zsh‐
       contrib(1).

THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE
       The zsh/parameter module gives access to	 some  of  the	internal  hash
       tables used by the shell by defining some special parameters.

       options
	      The keys for this associative array are the names of the options
	      that can	be  set	 and  unset  using  the	 setopt	 and  unsetopt
	      builtins.	 The  value of each key is either the string on if the
	      option is currently set, or the string  off  if  the  option  is
	      unset.  Setting a key to one of these strings is like setting or
	      unsetting the option, respectively.  Unsetting  a	 key  in  this
	      array is like setting it to the value off.

       commands
	      This  array gives access to the command hash table. The keys are
	      the names of external commands, the values are the pathnames  of
	      the  files  that	would  be  executed  when the command would be
	      invoked. Setting a key in this array defines a new entry in this
	      table  in the same way as with the hash builtin. Unsetting a key
	      as in `unset "commands[foo]"' removes the entry  for  the	 given
	      key from the command hash table.

       functions
	      This  associative array maps names of enabled functions to their
	      definitions. Setting a key in it is  like	 defining  a  function
	      with  the name given by the key and the body given by the value.
	      Unsetting a key removes the definition for the function named by
	      the key.

       dis_functions
	      Like functions but for disabled functions.

       builtins
	      This  associative array gives information about the builtin com‐
	      mands currently enabled. The keys are the names of  the  builtin
	      commands	and the values are either `undefined' for builtin com‐
	      mands that will automatically be loaded from a module if invoked
	      or `defined' for builtin commands that are already loaded.

       dis_builtins
	      Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.

       reswords
	      This array contains the enabled reserved words.

       dis_reswords
	      Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.

       patchars
	      This array contains the enabled pattern characters.

       dis_patchars
	      Like patchars but for disabled pattern characters.

       aliases
	      This  maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to
	      their expansions.

       dis_aliases
	      Like aliases but for disabled regular aliases.

       galiases
	      Like aliases, but for global aliases.

       dis_galiases
	      Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.

       saliases
	      Like raliases, but for suffix aliases.

       dis_saliases
	      Like saliases but for disabled suffix aliases.

       parameters
	      The keys in this associative array are the names of the  parame‐
	      ters  currently  defined.	 The values are strings describing the
	      type of the parameter, in the same format used by the t  parame‐
	      ter  flag,  see  zshexpn(1) .  Setting or unsetting keys in this
	      array is not possible.

       modules
	      An associative array giving information about modules. The  keys
	      are   the	  names	 of  the  modules  loaded,  registered	to  be
	      autoloaded, or aliased. The value says  which  state  the	 named
	      module  is  in and is one of the strings `loaded', `autoloaded',
	      or `alias:name', where name is the name the  module  is  aliased
	      to.

	      Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

       dirstack
	      A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note
	      that the output of the dirs builtin command  includes  one  more
	      directory, the current working directory.

       history
	      This  associative	 array	maps history event numbers to the full
	      history lines.

       historywords
	      A special array containing the words stored in the history.

       jobdirs
	      This associative array maps job numbers to the directories  from
	      which  the  job was started (which may not be the current direc‐
	      tory of the job).

	      The keys of the associative arrays are usually  valid  job  num‐
	      bers,  and  these	 are  the  values  output  with,  for example,
	      ${(k)jobdirs}.  Non-numeric job  references  may	be  used  when
	      looking  up  a  value; for example, ${jobdirs[%+]} refers to the
	      current job.

       jobtexts
	      This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the com‐
	      mand lines that were used to start the jobs.

	      Handling	of  the	 keys of the associative array is as described
	      for jobdirs above.

       jobstates
	      This associative array gives information about the states of the
	      jobs  currently known. The keys are the job numbers and the val‐
	      ues are strings of the form  `job-state:mark:pid=state...'.  The
	      job-state	 gives the state the whole job is currently in, one of
	      `running', `suspended', or `done'. The mark is `+' for the  cur‐
	      rent  job, `-' for the previous job and empty otherwise. This is
	      followed by one `pid=state' for every process in	the  job.  The
	      pids are, of course, the process IDs and the state describes the
	      state of that process.

	      Handling of the keys of the associative array  is	 as  described
	      for jobdirs above.

       nameddirs
	      This  associative	 array	maps the names of named directories to
	      the pathnames they stand for.

       userdirs
	      This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their
	      home directories.

       usergroups
	      This  associative array maps names of system groups of which the
	      current user is a member to the corresponding group identifiers.
	      The  contents  are  the same as the groups output by the id com‐
	      mand.

       funcfiletrace
	      This array contains the absolute line numbers and	 corresponding
	      file  names  for	the  point where the current function, sourced
	      file, or (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval command was	 called.   The
	      array  is	 of  the same length as funcsourcetrace and functrace,
	      but differs from funcsourcetrace in that the line and  file  are
	      the point of call, not the point of definition, and differs from
	      functrace in that all values are absolute line numbers in files,
	      rather than relative to the start of a function, if any.

       funcsourcetrace
	      This  array  contains  the  file	names  and line numbers of the
	      points where the functions, sourced files, and  (if  EVAL_LINENO
	      is  set)	eval  commands	currently being executed were defined.
	      The line number is the line where the `function name'  or	 `name
	      ()'  started.   In  the case of an autoloaded function  the line
	      number is reported as zero.  The format of each element is file‐
	      name:lineno.  For functions autoloaded from a file in native zsh
	      format, where only the body of the function occurs in the	 file,
	      or  for  files  that  have  been	executed  by the source or `.'
	      builtins, the trace information is shown	as  filename:0,	 since
	      the entire file is the definition.

	      Most  users  will	 be interested in the information in the func‐
	      filetrace array instead.

       funcstack
	      This array contains the names of the functions,  sourced	files,
	      and  (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval commands. currently being exe‐
	      cuted. The first element is the name of the function  using  the
	      parameter.

       functrace
	      This  array  contains  the names and line numbers of the callers
	      corresponding to the functions currently	being  executed.   The
	      format  of  each element is name:lineno.	Callers are also shown
	      for sourced files; the caller is the point where the  source  or
	      `.' command was executed.

THE ZSH/PCRE MODULE
       The zsh/pcre module makes some commands available as builtins:

       pcre_compile [ -aimxs ] PCRE
	      Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.

	      Option -a will force the pattern to be anchored.	Option -i will
	      compile a case-insensitive pattern.  Option -m  will  compile  a
	      multi-line  pattern; that is, ^ and $ will match newlines within
	      the pattern.   Option  -x	 will  compile	an  extended  pattern,
	      wherein  whitespace and # comments are ignored.  Option -s makes
	      the dot metacharacter match all characters, including those that
	      indicate newline.

       pcre_study
	      Studies  the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in faster
	      matching.

       pcre_match [ -v var ] [ -a arr ] [ -n offset ] [ -b ] string
	      Returns successfully if string matches  the  previously-compiled
	      PCRE.

	      Upon  successful	match,	if  the expression captures substrings
	      within parentheses, pcre_match will  set	the  array  $match  to
	      those  substrings,  unless the -a option is given, in which case
	      it will set the array arr.  Similarly, the variable  MATCH  will
	      be  set  to the entire matched portion of the string, unless the
	      -v option is given, in which case the variable var will be  set.
	      No  variables are altered if there is no successful match.  A -n
	      option starts searching for a match from the byte	 offset	 posi‐
	      tion  in	string.	  If  the  -b  option  is  given, the variable
	      ZPCRE_OP will be set to an offset pair string, representing  the
	      byte  offset  positions of the entire matched portion within the
	      string.  For example, a ZPCRE_OP set to "32 45"  indicates  that
	      the  matched  portion  began on byte offset 32 and ended on byte
	      offset 44.  Here,	 byte  offset  position	 45  is	 the  position
	      directly	after the matched portion.  Keep in mind that the byte
	      position isn't necessarily the same as  the  character  position
	      when UTF-8 characters are involved.  Consequently, the byte off‐
	      set positions are only to be relied on in the context  of	 using
	      them for subsequent searches on string, using an offset position
	      as an argument to the -n option.	This is mostly used to	imple‐
	      ment the "find all non-overlapping matches" functionality.

	      A simple example of "find all non-overlapping matches":

		     string="The following zip codes: 78884 90210 99513"
		     pcre_compile -m "\d{5}"
		     accum=()
		     pcre_match -b -- $string
		     while [[ $? -eq 0 ]] do
			 b=($=ZPCRE_OP)
			 accum+=$MATCH
			 pcre_match -b -n $b[2] -- $string
		     done
		     print -l $accum

       The zsh/pcre module makes available the following test condition:
       expr -pcre-match pcre
	      Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.

	      For example,

	      [[  "$text"  -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] && print text variable contains
	      only "d's".

THE ZSH/REGEX MODULE
       The zsh/regex module makes available the following test condition:
       expr -regex-match regex
	      Matches a string against a POSIX	extended  regular  expression.
	      On successful match, matched portion of the string will normally
	      be placed in the MATCH variable.	If  there  are	any  capturing
	      parentheses within the regex, then the match array variable will
	      contain those.  If the match is not successful, then  the	 vari‐
	      ables will not be altered.

	      For example,

		     [[ alphabetical -regex-match ^a([^a]+)a([^a]+)a ]] &&
		     print -l $MATCH X $match

	      If the option REMATCH_PCRE is not set, then the =~ operator will
	      automatically load this module as needed	and  will  invoke  the
	      -regex-match operator.

	      If  BASH_REMATCH is set, then the array BASH_REMATCH will be set
	      instead of MATCH and match.

THE ZSH/SCHED MODULE
       The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command and one param‐
       eter.

       sched [-o] [+]hh:mm[:ss] command ...
       sched [-o] [+]seconds command ...
       sched [ -item ]
	      Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.  The
	      time may be specified in either absolute or relative  time,  and
	      either as hours, minutes and (optionally) seconds separated by a
	      colon, or seconds alone.	An absolute number  of	seconds	 indi‐
	      cates  the time since the epoch (1970/01/01 00:00); this is use‐
	      ful in combination with the features in the zsh/datetime module,
	      see the zsh/datetime module entry in zshmodules(1).

	      With  no	arguments,  prints the list of scheduled commands.  If
	      the scheduled command has the -o flag set, this is shown at  the
	      start of the command.

	      With the argument `-item', removes the given item from the list.
	      The numbering of the list is continuous and entries are in  time
	      order,  so  the  numbering  can change when entries are added or
	      deleted.

	      Commands are executed either immediately	before	a  prompt,  or
	      while the shell's line editor is waiting for input.  In the lat‐
	      ter case it is useful to be able to produce output that does not
	      interfere	 with  the line being edited.  Providing the option -o
	      causes the shell to clear the command line before the event  and
	      redraw  it  afterwards.	This should be used with any scheduled
	      event that produces visible output to the terminal;  it  is  not
	      needed,  for example, with output that updates a terminal emula‐
	      tor's title bar.

	      The sched builtin is not made  available	by  default  when  the
	      shell  starts in a mode emulating another shell.	It can be made
	      available with the command `zmodload -F zsh/sched b:sched'.

       zsh_scheduled_events
	      A readonly array corresponding to the events  scheduled  by  the
	      sched  builtin.  The indices of the array correspond to the num‐
	      bers shown when sched is run with no  arguments  (provided  that
	      the  KSH_ARRAYS option is not set).  The value of the array con‐
	      sists of the scheduled time in seconds since the epoch (see  the
	      section  `The zsh/datetime Module' for facilities for using this
	      number), followed by a colon, followed by any options (which may
	      be empty but will be preceded by a `-' otherwise), followed by a
	      colon, followed by the command to be executed.

	      The sched builtin should be used for  manipulating  the  events.
	      Note  that this will have an immediate effect on the contents of
	      the array, so that indices may become invalid.

THE ZSH/NET/SOCKET MODULE
       The zsh/net/socket module makes available one builtin command:

       zsocket [ -altv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
	      zsocket is implemented as a builtin to allow full use  of	 shell
	      command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

   Outbound Connections
       zsocket [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
	      Open a new Unix domain connection to filename.  The shell param‐
	      eter REPLY will be set to the file  descriptor  associated  with
	      that  connection.	  Currently,  only stream connections are sup‐
	      ported.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       zsocket -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
	      zsocket  -l will open a socket listening on filename.  The shell
	      parameter REPLY will be set to the  file	descriptor  associated
	      with that listener.

	      If  -d  is  specified,  its argument will be taken as the target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       zsocket -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
	      zsocket -a will accept an	 incoming  connection  to  the	socket
	      associated with listenfd.	 The shell parameter REPLY will be set
	      to the file descriptor associated with the inbound connection.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      If  -t  is specified, zsocket will return if no incoming connec‐
	      tion is pending.	Otherwise it will wait for one.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

THE ZSH/STAT MODULE
       The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command under two  pos‐
       sible names:

       zstat  [	 -gnNolLtTrs ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F fmt ] [
       +element ] [ file ... ]
       stat ...
	      The command acts as a front end to the  stat  system  call  (see
	      stat(2)).	  The  same command is provided with two names; as the
	      name stat is often used by an external command it is recommended
	      that  only  the  zstat form of the command is used.  This can be
	      arranged by loading the module with  the	command	 `zmodload  -F
	      zsh/stat b:zstat'.

	      If  the  stat  call  fails, the appropriate system error message
	      printed and status 1 is returned.	 The  fields  of  struct  stat
	      give  information	 about	the files provided as arguments to the
	      command.	In addition to those available from the stat call,  an
	      extra element `link' is provided.	 These elements are:

	      device The number of the device on which the file resides.

	      inode  The  unique  number  of  the file on this device (`inode'
		     number).

	      mode   The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access
		     permissions.   With  the -s option, this will be returned
		     as a string corresponding to the first column in the dis‐
		     play of the ls -l command.

	      nlink  The number of hard links to the file.

	      uid    The  user	ID  of	the  owner  of	the file.  With the -s
		     option, this is displayed as a user name.

	      gid    The group ID of the file.	With the -s  option,  this  is
		     displayed as a group name.

	      rdev   The  raw  device number.  This is only useful for special
		     devices.

	      size   The size of the file in bytes.

	      atime
	      mtime
	      ctime  The last access, modification and inode change  times  of
		     the  file,	 respectively,	as the number of seconds since
		     midnight GMT on 1st January, 1970.	 With the  -s  option,
		     these are printed as strings for the local time zone; the
		     format can be altered with the -F option, and with the -g
		     option the times are in GMT.

	      blksize
		     The number of bytes in one allocation block on the device
		     on which the file resides.

	      block  The number of disk blocks used by the file.

	      link   If the file is a link and the -L  option  is  in  effect,
		     this  contains  the name of the file linked to, otherwise
		     it is empty.  Note	 that  if  this	 element  is  selected
		     (``zstat  +link'')	 then  the  -L option is automatically
		     used.

	      A particular element may be selected by including its name  pre‐
	      ceded  by a `+' in the option list; only one element is allowed.
	      The element may be shortened to any unique set of leading	 char‐
	      acters.  Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.

	      Options:

	      -A array
		     Instead  of  displaying  the  results on standard output,
		     assign them to an array,  one  struct  stat  element  per
		     array  element for each file in order.  In this case nei‐
		     ther the name of the element nor the name	of  the	 files
		     appears  in array unless the -t or -n options were given,
		     respectively.  If -t is given, the element	 name  appears
		     as	 a  prefix  to the appropriate array element; if -n is
		     given, the file name appears as a separate array  element
		     preceding	all  the others.  Other formatting options are
		     respected.

	      -H hash
		     Similar to -A, but instead assign	the  values  to	 hash.
		     The keys are the elements listed above.  If the -n option
		     is provided then the name of the file is included in  the
		     hash with key name.

	      -f fd  Use  the  file  on	 file  descriptor  fd instead of named
		     files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.

	      -F fmt Supplies a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the for‐
		     matting of the time elements.  The -s option is implied.

	      -g     Show  the	time  elements	in  the GMT time zone.	The -s
		     option is implied.

	      -l     List the names of the type elements (to  standard	output
		     or	 an  array  as	appropriate)  and  return immediately;
		     options other than -A and arguments are ignored.

	      -L     Perform an lstat (see lstat(2)) rather than a stat system
		     call.   In	 this case, if the file is a link, information
		     about the link itself rather  than	 the  target  file  is
		     returned.	 This option is required to make the link ele‐
		     ment useful.  It's important to note  that	 this  is  the
		     exact opposite from ls(1), etc.

	      -n     Always  show  the names of files.	Usually these are only
		     shown when output is to standard output and there is more
		     than one file in the list.

	      -N     Never show the names of files.

	      -o     If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is
		     more useful for human consumption	than  the  default  of
		     decimal.	A  leading  zero will be printed in this case.
		     Note that this does not affect whether a raw or formatted
		     file  mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s
		     options, nor whether a mode is shown at all.

	      -r     Print raw data (the default format) alongside string data
		     (the  -s  format); the string data appears in parentheses
		     after the raw data.

	      -s     Print mode, uid, gid  and	the  three  time  elements  as
		     strings  instead  of numbers.  In each case the format is
		     like that of ls -l.

	      -t     Always show the type names for  the  elements  of	struct
		     stat.   Usually  these  are  only shown when output is to
		     standard  output  and  no	individual  element  has  been
		     selected.

	      -T     Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.

THE ZSH/SYSTEM MODULE
       The  zsh/system	module	makes  available  various builtin commands and
       parameters.

   Builtins
       syserror [ -e errvar ] [ -p prefix ] [ errno | errname ]
	      This command prints out the error message associated with errno,
	      a system error number, followed by a newline to standard error.

	      Instead of the error number, a name errname, for example ENOENT,
	      may be used.  The set of names is the same as  the  contents  of
	      the array errnos, see below.

	      If  the  string  prefix  is given, it is printed in front of the
	      error message, with no intervening space.

	      If errvar is supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is
	      assigned to the parameter names errvar and nothing is output.

	      A	 return	 status	 of  0	indicates the message was successfully
	      printed (although it may not be useful if the error  number  was
	      out  of  the  system's range), a return status of 1 indicates an
	      error in the parameters, and a return status of 2 indicates  the
	      error name was not recognised (no message is printed for this).

       sysread [ -c countvar ] [ -i infd ] [ -o outfd ]
	 [ -s bufsize ] [ -t timeout ] [ param ]
	      Perform  a single system read from file descriptor infd, or zero
	      if that is not given.  The result of the read is stored in param
	      or REPLY if that is not given.  If countvar is given, the number
	      of bytes read is assigned to the parameter named by countvar.

	      The maximum number of bytes read is bufsize or 8192 if  that  is
	      not  given, however the command returns as soon as any number of
	      bytes was successfully read.

	      If timeout is given, it specifies a timeout  in  seconds,	 which
	      may be zero to poll the file descriptor.	This is handled by the
	      poll system call if available, otherwise the select system  call
	      if available.

	      If  outfd	 is  given,  an attempt is made to write all the bytes
	      just read to the file descriptor outfd.  If this fails,  because
	      of a system error other than EINTR or because of an internal zsh
	      error during an interrupt, the bytes read but  not  written  are
	      stored  in  the parameter named by param if supplied (no default
	      is used in this case), and the number  of	 bytes	read  but  not
	      written  is stored in the parameter named by countvar if that is
	      supplied.	 If it was successful, countvar contains the full num‐
	      ber of bytes transferred, as usual, and param is not set.

	      The  error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally
	      so that shell interrupts are transparent	to  the	 caller.   Any
	      other error causes a return.

	      The possible return statuses are
	      0	     At	 least	one byte of data was successfully read and, if
		     appropriate, written.

	      1	     There was an error in  the	 parameters  to	 the  command.
		     This  is the only error for which a message is printed to
		     standard error.

	      2	     There was an error on the read, or on polling  the	 input
		     file descriptor for a timeout.  The parameter ERRNO gives
		     the error.

	      3	     Data were successfully read, but there was an error writ‐
		     ing them to outfd.	 The parameter ERRNO gives the error.

	      4	     The  attempt  to  read timed out.	Note this does not set
		     ERRNO as this is not a system error.

	      5	     No system error occurred, but zero bytes were read.  This
		     usually  indicates	 end  of file.	The parameters are set
		     according to the  usual  rules;  no  write	 to  outfd  is
		     attempted.

       syswrite [ -c countvar ] [ -o outfd ] data
	      The  data	 (a  single  string  of bytes) are written to the file
	      descriptor outfd, or 1 if that is not  given,  using  the	 write
	      system call.  Multiple write operations may be used if the first
	      does not write all the data.

	      If countvar is given, the number of byte written	is  stored  in
	      the parameter named by countvar; this may not be the full length
	      of data if an error occurred.

	      The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled  internally
	      by  retrying;  otherwise	an error causes the command to return.
	      For example, if the file descriptor is set to non-blocking  out‐
	      put,  an	error EAGAIN (on some systems, EWOULDBLOCK) may result
	      in the command returning early.

	      The return status may be 0 for success, 1 for an	error  in  the
	      parameters  to  the  command, or 2 for an error on the write; no
	      error message is printed in the last  case,  but	the  parameter
	      ERRNO will reflect the error that occurred.

       zsystem flock [ -t timeout ] [ -f var ] [-er] file
       zsystem flock -u fd_expr
	      The  builtin  zsystem's  subcommand flock performs advisory file
	      locking (via the fcntl(2) system call) over the entire  contents
	      of  the given file.  This form of locking requires the processes
	      accessing the file to cooperate; its most obvious use is between
	      two instances of the shell itself.

	      In  the  first form the named file, which must already exist, is
	      locked by opening a file descriptor to the file and  applying  a
	      lock to the file descriptor.  The lock terminates when the shell
	      process that created the lock exits; it is therefore often  con‐
	      venient to create file locks within subshells, since the lock is
	      automatically released when the subshell	exits.	 Status	 0  is
	      returned if the lock succeeds, else status 1.

	      In  the  second form the file descriptor given by the arithmetic
	      expression fd_expr  is  closed,  releasing  a  lock.   The  file
	      descriptor  can be queried by using the `-f var' form during the
	      lock; on a successful lock, the shell variable var is set to the
	      file  descriptor used for locking.  The lock will be released if
	      the file descriptor is closed by any other  means,  for  example
	      using `exec {var}>&-'; however, the form described here performs
	      a safety check that the file descriptor is in use for file lock‐
	      ing.

	      By default the shell waits indefinitely for the lock to succeed.
	      The option -t timeout specifies a timeout for the lock  in  sec‐
	      onds; currently this must be an integer.	The shell will attempt
	      to lock the file once a  second  during  this  period.   If  the
	      attempt times out, status 2 is returned.

	      If  the  option -e is given, the file descriptor for the lock is
	      preserved when the shell uses exec to start a new process;  oth‐
	      erwise it is closed at that point and the lock released.

	      If  the option -r is given, the lock is only for reading, other‐
	      wise it is for reading and  writing.   The  file	descriptor  is
	      opened accordingly.

       zsystem supports subcommand
	      The  builtin zsystem's subcommand supports tests whether a given
	      subcommand is supported.	It returns status 0 if so, else status
	      1.   It  operates silently unless there was a syntax error (i.e.
	      the wrong number of arguments), in  which	 case  status  255  is
	      returned.	  Status 1 can indicate one of two things:  subcommand
	      is known but not supported by the current operating  system,  or
	      subcommand  is not known (possibly because this is an older ver‐
	      sion of the shell before it was implemented).

   Parameters
       errnos A readonly array of the names of errors defined on  the  system.
	      These  are typically macros defined in C by including the system
	      header file errno.h.  The	 index	of  each  name	(assuming  the
	      option  KSH_ARRAYS  is  unset)  corresponds to the error number.
	      Error numbers num before the last known error which have no name
	      are given the name Enum in the array.

	      Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical
	      name is used.

       sysparams
	      A readonly associative array.  The keys are:
       pid    Returns the process ID of the  current  process,	even  in  sub‐
	      shells.	Compare	 $$,  which returns the process ID of the main
	      shell process.

       ppid   Returns the process ID of the parent  of	the  current  process,
	      even  in subshells.  Compare $PPID, which returns the process ID
	      of the parent of the main shell process.

THE ZSH/NET/TCP MODULE
       The zsh/net/tcp module makes available one builtin command:

       ztcp [ -acflLtv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
	      ztcp is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell com‐
	      mand line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

	      If  ztcp	is run with no options, it will output the contents of
	      its session table.

	      If it is run with only the option -L, it will  output  the  con‐
	      tents  of	 the  session table in a format suitable for automatic
	      parsing.	The option is ignored if given with a command to  open
	      or  close a session.  The output consists of a set of lines, one
	      per session, each containing the following elements separated by
	      spaces:

	      File descriptor
		     The  file descriptor in use for the connection.  For nor‐
		     mal inbound (I) and outbound (O) connections this may  be
		     read and written by the usual shell mechanisms.  However,
		     it should only be close with `ztcp -c'.

	      Connection type
		     A letter indicating how the session was created:

		     Z	    A session created with the zftp command.

		     L	    A connection opened for listening with `ztcp -l'.

		     I	    An inbound connection accepted with `ztcp -a'.

		     O	    An outbound connection  created  with  `ztcp  host
			    ...'.

	      The local host
		     This  is  usually	set  to	 an all-zero IP address as the
		     address of the localhost is irrelevant.

	      The local port
		     This is likely to be zero unless the  connection  is  for
		     listening.

	      The remote host
		     This  is  the fully qualified domain name of the peer, if
		     available, else an IP address.   It  is  an  all-zero  IP
		     address for a session opened for listening.

	      The remote port
		     This is zero for a connection opened for listening.

   Outbound Connections
       ztcp [ -v ] [ -d fd ] host [ port ]
	      Open  a  new TCP connection to host.  If the port is omitted, it
	      will default to port 23.	The connection will be	added  to  the
	      session  table  and the shell parameter REPLY will be set to the
	      file descriptor associated with that connection.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       ztcp -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] port
	      ztcp  -l	will  open a socket listening on TCP port.  The socket
	      will be added to the session table and the shell parameter REPLY
	      will  be	set  to	 the file descriptor associated with that lis‐
	      tener.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       ztcp -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
	      ztcp  -a	will accept an incoming connection to the port associ‐
	      ated with listenfd.  The connection will be added to the session
	      table  and  the  shell  parameter	 REPLY will be set to the file
	      descriptor associated with the inbound connection.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      If  -t  is specified, ztcp will return if no incoming connection
	      is pending.  Otherwise it will wait for one.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Closing Connections
       ztcp -cf [ -v ] [ fd ]
       ztcp -c [ -v ] [ fd ]
	      ztcp -c will close the socket associated with  fd.   The	socket
	      will be removed from the session table.  If fd is not specified,
	      ztcp will close everything in the session table.

	      Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see zshmodules(1) ) cannot
	      be closed this way.  In order to force such a socket closed, use
	      -f.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Example
       Here is how to create a TCP connection between two  instances  of  zsh.
       We  need	 to  pick  an unassigned port; here we use the randomly chosen
       5123.

       On host1,
	      zmodload zsh/net/tcp
	      ztcp -l 5123
	      listenfd=$REPLY
	      ztcp -a $listenfd
	      fd=$REPLY
       The second from last command blocks until there is an incoming  connec‐
       tion.

       Now  create  a connection from host2 (which may, of course, be the same
       machine):
	      zmodload zsh/net/tcp
	      ztcp host1 5123
	      fd=$REPLY

       Now on each host, $fd contains a file descriptor	 for  talking  to  the
       other.  For example, on host1:
	      print This is a message >&$fd
       and on host2:
	      read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line
       prints `This is a message'.

       To tidy up, on host1:
	      ztcp -c $listenfd
	      ztcp -c $fd
       and on host2
	      ztcp -c $fd

THE ZSH/TERMCAP MODULE
       The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:

       echotc cap [ arg ... ]
	      Output  the  termcap  value corresponding to the capability cap,
	      with optional arguments.

       The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:

       termcap
	      An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their
	      values.

THE ZSH/TERMINFO MODULE
       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:

       echoti cap [ arg ]
	      Output  the  terminfo value corresponding to the capability cap,
	      instantiated with arg if applicable.

       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:

       terminfo
	      An associative array that	 maps  terminfo	 capability  names  to
	      their values.

THE ZSH/ZFTP MODULE
       The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:

       zftp subcommand [ args ]
	      The  zsh/zftp  module  is a client for FTP (file transfer proto‐
	      col).  It is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell
	      command  line  editing,  file  I/O,  and job control mechanisms.
	      Often, users will access it via shell functions providing a more
	      powerful	interface; a set is provided with the zsh distribution
	      and is described in zshzftpsys(1).  However, the zftp command is
	      entirely usable in its own right.

	      All  commands  consist  of the command name zftp followed by the
	      name of a subcommand.  These are listed below.  The return  sta‐
	      tus  of  each  subcommand	 is supposed to reflect the success or
	      failure of the remote operation.	See a description of the vari‐
	      able ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on how responses from the
	      server may be printed.

   Subcommands
       open host[:port] [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]
	      Open a new FTP session to host, which  may  be  the  name	 of  a
	      TCP/IP  connected host or an IP number in the standard dot nota‐
	      tion.  If the argument is in the form host:port, open a  connec‐
	      tion to TCP port port instead of the standard FTP port 21.  This
	      may be the name of a TCP service or a number:  see the  descrip‐
	      tion of ZFTP_PORT below for more information.

	      If  IPv6	addresses in colon format are used, the host should be
	      surrounded by quoted square brackets to distinguish it from  the
	      port, for example '[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]'.  For consistency
	      this is allowed with all forms of host.

	      Remaining arguments are passed to the  login  subcommand.	  Note
	      that  if	no  arguments  beyond host are supplied, open will not
	      automatically call login.	 If no arguments at all are  supplied,
	      open will use the parameters set by the params subcommand.

	      After   a	  successful  open,  the  shell	 variables  ZFTP_HOST,
	      ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP and ZFTP_SYSTEM  are  available;  see	`Vari‐
	      ables' below.

       login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
       user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
	      Login  the  user name with parameters password and account.  Any
	      of the parameters can be omitted, and will be read from standard
	      input if needed (name is always needed).	If standard input is a
	      terminal, a prompt for each one  will  be	 printed  on  standard
	      error and password will not be echoed.  If any of the parameters
	      are not used, a warning message is printed.

	      After  a	successful  login,  the	 shell	variables   ZFTP_USER,
	      ZFTP_ACCOUNT and ZFTP_PWD are available; see `Variables' below.

	      This  command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in,
	      and the server will first be reinitialized for a new user.

       params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
       params -
	      Store the given parameters for a	later  open  command  with  no
	      arguments.   Only those given on the command line will be remem‐
	      bered.  If no arguments are given, the parameters currently  set
	      are  printed,  although  the  password  will appear as a line of
	      stars; the return status is one if no parameters were set,  zero
	      otherwise.

	      Any  of the parameters may be specified as a `?', which may need
	      to be quoted to protect it from shell expansion.	In this	 case,
	      the  appropriate	parameter  will be read from stdin as with the
	      login subcommand, including special handling  of	password.   If
	      the  `?' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt for
	      reading the parameter instead of the default message (any neces‐
	      sary punctuation and whitespace should be included at the end of
	      the prompt).  The first letter of the parameter  (only)  may  be
	      quoted  with  a `\'; hence an argument "\\$word" guarantees that
	      the string from the shell parameter $word will be treated liter‐
	      ally, whether or not it begins with a `?'.

	      If  instead  a  single `-' is given, the existing parameters, if
	      any, are deleted.	 In that case, calling open with no  arguments
	      will cause an error.

	      The  list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however it
	      will be deleted if the zsh/zftp module is unloaded.

	      For example,

		     zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '

	      will store the host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then
	      prompt  the  user	 for the corresponding password with the given
	      prompt.

       test   Test the connection; if the server  has  reported	 that  it  has
	      closed the connection (maybe due to a timeout), return status 2;
	      if no connection was open anyway, return status 1;  else	return
	      status  0.   The	test subcommand is silent, apart from messages
	      printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or error messages if the
	      connection closes.  There is no network overhead for this test.

	      The  test is only supported on systems with either the select(2)
	      or poll(2) system calls; otherwise the message `not supported on
	      this system' is printed instead.

	      The test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of
	      any other subcommand for the current session when	 a  connection
	      is open.

       cd directory
	      Change the remote directory to directory.	 Also alters the shell
	      variable ZFTP_PWD.

       cdup   Change the remote directory to the one higher in	the  directory
	      tree.  Note that cd .. will also work correctly on non-UNIX sys‐
	      tems.

       dir [ args... ]
	      Give a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.	 The args  are
	      passed directly to the server. The command's behaviour is imple‐
	      mentation dependent, but a UNIX server will typically  interpret
	      args as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments return
	      the result of `ls -l'. The directory is listed to standard  out‐
	      put.

       ls [ args ]
	      Give  a  (short) listing of the remote directory.	 With no args,
	      produces a raw list of the files in the directory, one per line.
	      Otherwise,  up to vagaries of the server implementation, behaves
	      similar to dir.

       type [ type ]
	      Change the type for the transfer to type, or print  the  current
	      type if type is absent.  The allowed values are `A' (ASCII), `I'
	      (Image, i.e. binary), or `B' (a synonym for `I').

	      The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.	However, if zftp finds
	      that  the remote host is a UNIX machine with 8-bit byes, it will
	      automatically switch to using binary  for	 file  transfers  upon
	      open.  This can subsequently be overridden.

	      The  transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a data
	      connection is established;  this	command	 involves  no  network
	      overhead.

       ascii  The same as type A.

       binary The same as type I.

       mode [ S | B ]
	      Set  the	mode  type to stream (S) or block (B).	Stream mode is
	      the default; block mode is not widely supported.

       remote files...
       local [ files... ]
	      Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local
	      files.   If there is more than one item on the list, the name of
	      the file is printed first.  The first number is the  file	 size,
	      the second is the last modification time of the file in the for‐
	      mat CCYYMMDDhhmmSS consisting of year, month, date,  hour,  min‐
	      utes  and	 seconds in GMT.  Note that this format, including the
	      length, is guaranteed, so that time strings can be directly com‐
	      pared  via  the [[ builtin's < and > operators, even if they are
	      too long to be represented as integers.

	      Not all servers support the commands for retrieving this	infor‐
	      mation.  In that case, the remote command will print nothing and
	      return status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.

	      The local command (but not remote) may be	 used  with  no	 argu‐
	      ments,  in  which case the information comes from examining file
	      descriptor zero.	This is the same file as seen by a put command
	      with no further redirection.

       get file [...]
	      Retrieve all files from the server, concatenating them and send‐
	      ing them to standard output.

       put file [...]
	      For each file, read a file from standard input and send that  to
	      the remote host with the given name.

       append file [...]
	      As  put, but if the remote file already exists, data is appended
	      to it instead of overwriting it.

       getat file point
       putat file point
       appendat file point
	      Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at
	      the  given point in the remote file.  This is useful for append‐
	      ing to an incomplete local file.	However, note that this	 abil‐
	      ity  is  not  universally supported by servers (and is not quite
	      the behaviour specified by the standard).

       delete file [...]
	      Delete the list of files on the server.

       mkdir directory
	      Create a new directory directory on the server.

       rmdir directory
	      Delete the directory directory  on the server.

       rename old-name new-name
	      Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.

       site args...
	      Send a host-specific command to the server.  You	will  probably
	      only need this if instructed by the server to use it.

       quote args...
	      Send  the raw FTP command sequence to the server.	 You should be
	      familiar with the FTP command set as defined  in	RFC959	before
	      doing  this.   Useful  commands may include STAT and HELP.  Note
	      also the mechanism for returning messages as described  for  the
	      variable	ZFTP_VERBOSE  below,  in  particular that all messages
	      from the control connection are sent to standard error.

       close
       quit   Close the current data connection.  This unsets the shell param‐
	      eters  ZFTP_HOST,	 ZFTP_PORT,  ZFTP_IP,  ZFTP_SYSTEM, ZFTP_USER,
	      ZFTP_ACCOUNT, ZFTP_PWD, ZFTP_TYPE and ZFTP_MODE.

       session [ sessname ]
	      Allows multiple FTP sessions to be used at once.	 The  name  of
	      the  session  is	an arbitrary string of characters; the default
	      session is called `default'.  If this command is called  without
	      an  argument,  it	 will  list  all the current sessions; with an
	      argument, it will either switch to the existing  session	called
	      sessname, or create a new session of that name.

	      Each  session remembers the status of the connection, the set of
	      connection-specific shell parameters (the same set as are	 unset
	      when a connection closes, as given in the description of close),
	      and any user parameters specified with  the  params  subcommand.
	      Changing	to  a previous session restores those values; changing
	      to a new session initialises them in the same way as if zftp had
	      just  been  loaded.  The name of the current session is given by
	      the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.

       rmsession [ sessname ]
	      Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is
	      deleted.	If the current session is deleted, the earliest exist‐
	      ing session becomes the new current session, otherwise the  cur‐
	      rent  session  is	 not changed.  If the session being deleted is
	      the only one, a new session  called  `default'  is  created  and
	      becomes  the  current  session;  note that this is a new session
	      even if the session being deleted is also called	`default'.  It
	      is  recommended  that  sessions  not be deleted while background
	      commands which use zftp are still active.

   Parameters
       The following shell parameters are used by  zftp.   Currently  none  of
       them are special.

       ZFTP_TMOUT
	      Integer.	The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to
	      complete before returning an error.  If this is not set when the
	      module  is  loaded,  it  will  be given the default value 60.  A
	      value of zero turns off timeouts.	 If a timeout  occurs  on  the
	      control  connection  it  will  be closed.	 Use a larger value if
	      this occurs too frequently.

       ZFTP_IP
	      Readonly.	 The IP address of the current connection in dot nota‐
	      tion.

       ZFTP_HOST
	      Readonly.	  The  hostname	 of the current remote server.	If the
	      host was	opened	as  an	IP  number,  ZFTP_HOST	contains  that
	      instead;	this  saves the overhead for a name lookup, as IP num‐
	      bers are most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.

       ZFTP_PORT
	      Readonly.	 The number of the remote TCP port to which  the  con‐
	      nection  is open (even if the port was originally specified as a
	      named service).  Usually this is the standard FTP port, 21.

	      In the unlikely event that your system does not have the	appro‐
	      priate conversion functions, this appears in network byte order.
	      If your system is little-endian, the port then consists  of  two
	      swapped  bytes  and  the standard port will be reported as 5376.
	      In that case, numeric ports passed to zftp open will  also  need
	      to be in this format.

       ZFTP_SYSTEM
	      Readonly.	  The  system  type  string  returned by the server in
	      response to an FTP SYST request.	The most interesting case is a
	      string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which ensures maximum compati‐
	      bility with a local UNIX host.

       ZFTP_TYPE
	      Readonly.	 The type to be used for data transfers ,  either  `A'
	      or `I'.	Use the type subcommand to change this.

       ZFTP_USER
	      Readonly.	 The username currently logged in, if any.

       ZFTP_ACCOUNT
	      Readonly.	  The  account name of the current user, if any.  Most
	      servers do not require an account name.

       ZFTP_PWD
	      Readonly.	 The current directory on the server.

       ZFTP_CODE
	      Readonly.	 The three digit code of the last FTP reply  from  the
	      server as a string.  This can still be read after the connection
	      is closed, and is not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_REPLY
	      Readonly.	 The last line of the last reply sent by  the  server.
	      This  can	 still	be read after the connection is closed, and is
	      not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_SESSION
	      Readonly.	 The name of the current FTP session; see the descrip‐
	      tion of the session subcommand.

       ZFTP_PREFS
	      A	 string	 of  preferences for altering aspects of zftp's behav‐
	      iour.  Each preference is a single character.  The following are
	      defined:

	      P	     Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data
		     transfers.	 This is slightly more efficient than sendport
		     mode.   If	 the letter S occurs later in the string, zftp
		     will use sendport mode if passive mode is not available.

	      S	     Sendport:	initiate transfers by the  FTP	PORT  command.
		     If	 this  occurs before any P in the string, passive mode
		     will never be attempted.

	      D	     Dumb:  use only the bare minimum of FTP  commands.	  This
		     prevents  the  variables  ZFTP_SYSTEM  and	 ZFTP_PWD from
		     being set, and will mean all connections default to ASCII
		     type.   It	 may prevent ZFTP_SIZE from being set during a
		     transfer if the server does  not  send  it	 anyway	 (many
		     servers do).

	      If  ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to
	      a default of `PS', i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise
	      fall back to sendport mode.

       ZFTP_VERBOSE
	      A	 string	 of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which
	      responses from the server should be printed.  All	 responses  go
	      to  standard  error.  If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear in the
	      string, raw responses from the server with reply codes beginning
	      with  that  digit	 will be printed to standard error.  The first
	      digit of the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to cor‐
	      respond to:

	      1.     A positive preliminary reply.

	      2.     A positive completion reply.

	      3.     A positive intermediate reply.

	      4.     A transient negative completion reply.

	      5.     A permanent negative completion reply.

	      It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service
	      not available', which forces termination	of  a  connection,  is
	      classified  as  421,  i.e.  `transient negative', an interesting
	      interpretation of the word `transient'.

	      The code 0 is special:  it indicates that all but the last  line
	      of  multiline  replies  read  from the server will be printed to
	      standard error in a processed format.   By  convention,  servers
	      use this mechanism for sending information for the user to read.
	      The appropriate reply code, if it	 matches  the  same  response,
	      takes priority.

	      If  ZFTP_VERBOSE	is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set
	      to the default value 450, i.e., messages destined for  the  user
	      and  all	errors	will  be  printed.  A null string is valid and
	      specifies that no messages should be printed.

   Functions
       zftp_chpwd
	      If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the
	      directory changes on the server, including when a user is logged
	      in, or when a connection is closed.  In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD
	      will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new directory.

       zftp_progress
	      If  this function is set by the user, it will be called during a
	      get, put or append operation each time sufficient data has  been
	      received from the host.  During a get, the data is sent to stan‐
	      dard output, so it is vital that this function should  write  to
	      standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard out‐
	      put.

	      When it is called with a transfer	 in  progress,	the  following
	      additional shell parameters are set:

	      ZFTP_FILE
		     The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.

	      ZFTP_TRANSFER
		     A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.

	      ZFTP_SIZE
		     The  total	 size  of the complete file being transferred:
		     the same as the first value provided by  the  remote  and
		     local  subcommands	 for a particular file.	 If the server
		     cannot  supply  this  value  for  a  remote  file	 being
		     retrieved,	 it  will not be set.  If input is from a pipe
		     the value may be incorrect and  correspond	 simply	 to  a
		     full pipe buffer.

	      ZFTP_COUNT
		     The  amount  of data so far transferred; a number between
		     zero and $ZFTP_SIZE, if that  is  set.   This  number  is
		     always available.

	      The  function  is initially called with ZFTP_TRANSFER set appro‐
	      priately and ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.  After the transfer is fin‐
	      ished,   the   function  will  be	 called	 one  more  time  with
	      ZFTP_TRANSFER set to GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy up.  It
	      is   otherwise  never  called  twice  with  the  same  value  of
	      ZFTP_COUNT.

	      Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up  to
	      the user to decide whether the function should be defined and to
	      use unfunction when necessary.

   Problems
       A connection may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as  this
       occurs  in  a  subshell	and the file information is not updated in the
       main shell.  In the case of type or mode changes or closing the connec‐
       tion  in	 a subshell, the information is returned but variables are not
       updated until the next call to zftp.  Other status changes in subshells
       will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should be other‐
       wise harmless).

       Deleting sessions while a zftp command is active in the background  can
       have  unexpected	 effects,  even	 if  it does not use the session being
       deleted.	 This is because all shell subprocesses share  information  on
       the state of all connections, and deleting a session changes the order‐
       ing of that information.

       On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after  a
       fork(),	so  that  operations  in subshells, on the left hand side of a
       pipeline, or in the background are not possible,	 as  they  should  be.
       This is presumably a bug in the operating system.

THE ZSH/ZLE MODULE
       The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor.	 See zshzle(1).

THE ZSH/ZLEPARAMETER MODULE
       The  zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that can be
       used to access internal information of the Zsh Line  Editor  (see  zsh‐
       zle(1)).

       keymaps
	      This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.

       widgets
	      This  associative	 array	contains one entry per widget defined.
	      The name of the widget is the key and the value  gives  informa‐
	      tion  about  the	widget.	 It is either the string `builtin' for
	      builtin  widgets,	 a  string  of	the   form   `user:name'   for
	      user-defined  widgets, where name is the name of the shell func‐
	      tion implementing the widget, or it is  a	 string	 of  the  form
	      `completion:type:name', for completion widgets. In the last case
	      type is the name of the builtin widgets  the  completion	widget
	      imitates in its behavior and name is the name of the shell func‐
	      tion implementing the completion widget.

THE ZSH/ZPROF MODULE
       When loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled.   The
       profiling  results  can be obtained with the zprof builtin command made
       available by this module.  There is no way to turn profiling off	 other
       than unloading the module.

       zprof [ -c ]
	      Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard
	      output.  The format is  comparable  to  that  of	commands  like
	      gprof.

	      At  the  top  there is a summary listing all functions that were
	      called at least once.  This  summary  is	sorted	in  decreasing
	      order  of	 the  amount of time spent in each.  The lines contain
	      the number of the function in order,  which  is  used  in	 other
	      parts of the list in suffixes of the form `[num]', then the num‐
	      ber of calls made to the function.  The next three columns  list
	      the  time	 in milliseconds spent in the function and its descen‐
	      dants, the average time in milliseconds spent  in	 the  function
	      and its descendants per call and the percentage of time spent in
	      all shell functions used in this function and  its  descendants.
	      The  following  three  columns  give  the	 same information, but
	      counting only the time spent in the function itself.  The	 final
	      column shows the name of the function.

	      After  the  summary,  detailed  information about every function
	      that was invoked is listed, sorted in decreasing	order  of  the
	      amount of time spent in each function and its descendants.  Each
	      of these entries consists of descriptions for the functions that
	      called  the  function  described,	 the  function itself, and the
	      functions that were called from it.   The	 description  for  the
	      function itself has the same format as in the summary (and shows
	      the same information).  The other lines don't show the number of
	      the  function  at	 the  beginning	 and have their function named
	      indented to make it easier to distinguish the line  showing  the
	      function described in the section from the surrounding lines.

	      The  information shown in this case is almost the same as in the
	      summary, but only refers to the call hierarchy being  displayed.
	      For example, for a calling function the column showing the total
	      running time lists the time spent in the described function  and
	      its  descendants only for the times when it was called from that
	      particular calling function.  Likewise, for a  called  function,
	      this  columns  lists the total time spent in the called function
	      and its descendants only for the times when it was  called  from
	      the function described.

	      Also  in	this case, the column showing the number of calls to a
	      function also shows a slash and then the total number of invoca‐
	      tions made to the called function.

	      As  long	as  the	 zsh/zprof module is loaded, profiling will be
	      done and multiple invocations of the zprof builtin command  will
	      show the times and numbers of calls since the module was loaded.
	      With the -c option, the zprof builtin  command  will  reset  its
	      internal counters and will not show the listing.

THE ZSH/ZPTY MODULE
       The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:

       zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]
	      The  arguments  following	 name  are  concatenated  with	spaces
	      between, then executed as a command, as if passed	 to  the  eval
	      builtin.	 The command runs under a newly assigned pseudo-termi‐
	      nal; this is useful for running commands non-interactively which
	      expect  an interactive environment.  The name is not part of the
	      command, but is used to refer to this command in later calls  to
	      zpty.

	      With  the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up so that input
	      characters are echoed.

	      With the -b option, input to and output from the pseudo-terminal
	      are made non-blocking.

       zpty -d [ names ... ]
	      The  second form, with the -d option, is used to delete commands
	      previously started, by supplying a list of their names.	If  no
	      names  are  given, all commands are deleted.  Deleting a command
	      causes the HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.

       zpty -w [ -n ] name [ strings ... ]
	      The -w option can be used to send the to command name the	 given
	      strings as input (separated by spaces).  If the -n option is not
	      given, a newline is added at the end.

	      If no strings are provided, the standard input is copied to  the
	      pseudo-terminal;	this may stop before copying the full input if
	      the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.

	      Note that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees this	 input
	      as  if  it were typed, so beware when sending special tty driver
	      characters such as word-erase, line-kill, and end-of-file.

       zpty -r [ -mt ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]
	      The -r option can be used to read	 the  output  of  the  command
	      name.   With  only a name argument, the output read is copied to
	      the standard output.  Unless the pseudo-terminal	is  non-block‐
	      ing, copying continues until the command under the pseudo-termi‐
	      nal exits; when non-blocking, only as much output as is  immedi‐
	      ately  available	is  copied.   The return status is zero if any
	      output is copied.

	      When also given a param argument, at most one line is  read  and
	      stored  in the parameter named param.  Less than a full line may
	      be read if the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.  The return sta‐
	      tus is zero if at least one character is stored in param.

	      If  a  pattern  is given as well, output is read until the whole
	      string read matches the pattern, even in the non-blocking	 case.
	      The  return  status  is zero if the string read matches the pat‐
	      tern, or if the command has exited but at	 least	one  character
	      could  still  be	read.  If the option -m is present, the return
	      status is zero only if the pattern matches.  As of this writing,
	      a maximum of one megabyte of output can be consumed this way; if
	      a full megabyte is read without matching the pattern, the return
	      status is non-zero.

	      In  all cases, the return status is non-zero if nothing could be
	      read, and is 2 if this is because the command has finished.

	      If the -r option is combined with	 the  -t  option,  zpty	 tests
	      whether output is available before trying to read.  If no output
	      is available, zpty immediately returns the status 1.  When  used
	      with  a  pattern,	 the  behaviour on a failed poll is similar to
	      when the command has exited:  the return value  is  zero	if  at
	      least  one  character  could  still  be read even if the pattern
	      failed to match.

       zpty -t name
	      The -t option without the -r option can be used to test  whether
	      the  command name is still running.  It returns a zero status if
	      the command is running and a non-zero value otherwise.

       zpty [ -L ]
	      The last form, without any arguments, is used to list  the  com‐
	      mands  currently	defined.   If  the -L option is given, this is
	      done in the form of calls to the zpty builtin.

THE ZSH/ZSELECT MODULE
       The zsh/zselect module makes available one builtin command:

       zselect [ -rwe -t timeout -a array ] [ fd ... ]
	      The zselect builtin is a front-end to the `select' system	 call,
	      which  blocks  until  a  file descriptor is ready for reading or
	      writing, or has an error condition, with	an  optional  timeout.
	      If  this	is not available on your system, the command prints an
	      error message and returns status 2 (normal errors return	status
	      1).   For	 more  information, see your systems documentation for
	      select(3).  Note there is no connection with the	shell  builtin
	      of the same name.

	      Arguments	  and  options	may  be	 intermingled  in  any	order.
	      Non-option arguments are file descriptors, which must be decimal
	      integers.	  By  default,	file  descriptors are to be tested for
	      reading, i.e. zselect will return when data is available	to  be
	      read  from  the  file descriptor, or more precisely, when a read
	      operation from the file descriptor will not block.  After a  -r,
	      -w and -e, the given file descriptors are to be tested for read‐
	      ing, writing, or error conditions.  These options and  an	 arbi‐
	      trary list of file descriptors may be given in any order.

	      (The presence of an `error condition' is not well defined in the
	      documentation for many  implementations  of  the	select	system
	      call.   According to recent versions of the POSIX specification,
	      it is really an exception condition, of which the only  standard
	      example  is out-of-band data received on a socket.  So zsh users
	      are unlikely to find the -e option useful.)

	      The option `-t timeout' specifies a timeout in hundredths	 of  a
	      second.	This  may  be zero, in which case the file descriptors
	      will simply be polled and zselect will return  immediately.   It
	      is  possible  to	call  zselect  with  no file descriptors and a
	      non-zero timeout for use	as  a  finer-grained  replacement  for
	      `sleep';	note,  however,	 the  return  status is always 1 for a
	      timeout.

	      The option `-a array' indicates that  array  should  be  set  to
	      indicate	the file descriptor(s) which are ready.	 If the option
	      is not given, the array reply will be  used  for	this  purpose.
	      The  array  will	contain	 a string similar to the arguments for
	      zselect.	For example,

		     zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1

	      might return immediately with status 0 and $reply containing `-r
	      0	 -w  1'	 to  show that both file descriptors are ready for the
	      requested operations.

	      The option `-A assoc' indicates that the associative array assoc
	      should  be  set  to  indicate  the  file descriptor(s( which are
	      ready.  This option overrides the option -a, nor will  reply  be
	      modified.	  The  keys of assoc are the file descriptors, and the
	      corresponding values are any of the characters `rwe' to indicate
	      the condition.

	      The  command returns status 0 if some file descriptors are ready
	      for reading.  If the operation timed out, or a timeout of 0  was
	      given and no file descriptors were ready, or there was an error,
	      it returns status 1 and the array will not be set (nor  modified
	      in  any way).  If there was an error in the select operation the
	      appropriate error message is printed.

THE ZSH/ZUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:

       zstyle [ -L [ pattern [ style ] ] ]
       zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style strings ...
       zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
       zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
       zstyle -abs context style name [ sep ]
       zstyle -Tt context style [ strings ...]
       zstyle -m context style pattern
	      This builtin command  is	used  to  define  and  lookup  styles.
	      Styles  are  pairs of names and values, where the values consist
	      of any number of strings.	 They are stored  together  with  pat‐
	      terns  and  lookup  is done by giving a string, called the `con‐
	      text', which is compared to the patterns.	 The definition stored
	      for the first matching pattern will be returned.

	      For  ordering  of	 comparisons,  patterns are searched from most
	      specific to least specific, and patterns that are	 equally  spe‐
	      cific  keep  the order in which they were defined.  A pattern is
	      considered to be more specific than another if it contains  more
	      components  (substrings  separated by colons) or if the patterns
	      for the components are more specific, where simple  strings  are
	      considered  to  be  more specific than patterns and complex pat‐
	      terns are considered to be more specific than the pattern `*'.

	      The  first  form	(without  arguments)  lists  the  definitions.
	      Styles  are  shown in alphabetic order and patterns are shown in
	      the order zstyle will test them.

	      If the -L option is given, listing is done in the form of	 calls
	      to  zstyle.  The optional first argument is a pattern which will
	      be matched against the string supplied as the  pattern  for  the
	      context; note that this means, for example, `zstyle -L ":comple‐
	      tion:*"' will match any  supplied	 pattern  beginning  `:comple‐
	      tion:', not just ":completion:*":	 use ":completion:\*" to match
	      that.  The optional second argument limits the output to a  spe‐
	      cific  style  (not  a  pattern).	 -L is not compatible with any
	      other options.

	      The other forms are the following:

	      zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style strings ...
		     Defines the given style for the pattern with the  strings
		     as	 the  value.   If  the -e option is given, the strings
		     will  be  concatenated  (separated	 by  spaces)  and  the
		     resulting string will be evaluated (in the same way as it
		     is done by the eval builtin command) when	the  style  is
		     looked  up.   In  this case the parameter `reply' must be
		     assigned to set the strings returned  after  the  evalua‐
		     tion.   Before  evaluating the value, reply is unset, and
		     if it is still unset after the evaluation, the  style  is
		     treated as if it were not set.

	      zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
		     Delete  style  definitions. Without arguments all defini‐
		     tions are deleted, with a	pattern	 all  definitions  for
		     that  pattern  are	 deleted  and if any styles are given,
		     then only those styles are deleted for the pattern.

	      zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
		     Retrieve a style definition. The name is used as the name
		     of	 an array in which the results are stored. Without any
		     further arguments, all  patterns  defined	are  returned.
		     With  a  pattern  the styles defined for that pattern are
		     returned and with both a pattern and a style,  the	 value
		     strings of that combination is returned.

	      The other forms can be used to look up or test patterns.

	      zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
		     The  parameter  name  is  set  to	the value of the style
		     interpreted as a string.  If the value  contains  several
		     strings  they  are	 concatenated with spaces (or with the
		     sep string if that is given) between them.

	      zstyle -b context style name
		     The value is stored in name as a  boolean,	 i.e.  as  the
		     string  `yes'  if	the value has only one string and that
		     string is equal to one of `yes', `true', `on', or `1'. If
		     the  value	 is  any  other	 string	 or  has more than one
		     string, the parameter is set to `no'.

	      zstyle -a context style name
		     The value is stored in name  as  an  array.  If  name  is
		     declared as an associative array,	the first, third, etc.
		     strings are used as the keys and the  other  strings  are
		     used as the values.

	      zstyle -t context style [ strings ...]
	      zstyle -T context style [ strings ...]
		     Test  the	value  of  a  style,  i.e.  the -t option only
		     returns a status (sets  $?).   Without  any  strings  the
		     return  status  is	 zero  if  the style is defined for at
		     least one matching pattern, has only one  string  in  its
		     value, and that is equal to one of `true', `yes', `on' or
		     `1'. If any strings are given the status is zero  if  and
		     only  if at least one of the strings is equal to at least
		     one of the strings in the value. If the style is  defined
		     but  doesn't  match, the return status is 1. If the style
		     is not defined, the status is 2.

		     The -T option tests the values of the style like -t,  but
		     it	 returns  status  zero (rather than 2) if the style is
		     not defined for any matching pattern.

	      zstyle -m context style pattern
		     Match a value. Returns status zero if the pattern matches
		     at least one of the strings in the value.

       zformat -f param format specs ...
       zformat -a array sep specs ...
	      This  builtin  provides  two  different forms of formatting. The
	      first form is selected with the -f option. In this case the for‐
	      mat string will be modified by replacing sequences starting with
	      a percent sign in it with strings from  the  specs.   Each  spec
	      should  be  of  the  form	 `char:string'	which will cause every
	      appearance of the sequence `%char' in format to be  replaced  by
	      the  string.  The `%' sequence may also contain optional minimum
	      and maximum field width specifications between the `%'  and  the
	      `char'  in the form `%min.maxc', i.e. the minimum field width is
	      given first and if the maximum field width is used, it has to be
	      preceded	by  a dot.  Specifying a minimum field width makes the
	      result be padded with spaces to  the  right  if  the  string  is
	      shorter  than  the  requested width.  Padding to the left can be
	      achieved by giving a negative minimum field width.  If a maximum
	      field  width  is	specified,  the string will be truncated after
	      that many characters.  After all `%'  sequences  for  the	 given
	      specs have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the
	      parameter param.

	      The %-escapes also understand ternary expressions	 in  the  form
	      used  by	prompts.  The % is followed by a `(' and then an ordi‐
	      nary format specifier character as described above.   There  may
	      be a set of digits either before or after the `('; these specify
	      a test number, which defaults to	zero.	Negative  numbers  are
	      also allowed.  An arbitrary delimiter character follows the for‐
	      mat specifier, which is followed by a piece of `true' text,  the
	      delimiter	 character again, a piece of `false' text, and a clos‐
	      ing parenthesis.	The complete expression (without  the  digits)
	      thus  looks like `%(X.text1.text2)', except that the `.' charac‐
	      ter is arbitrary.	 The value given for the format	 specifier  in
	      the  char:string	expressions  is	 evaluated  as	a mathematical
	      expression, and compared with the test number.  If they are  the
	      same,  text1 is output, else text2 is output.  A parenthesis may
	      be escaped in text2 as %).  Either of text1 or text2 may contain
	      nested %-escapes.

	      For example:

		     zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3

	      outputs  "The answer is 'yes'." to REPLY since the value for the
	      format specifier c is 3, agreeing with the digit argument to the
	      ternary expression.

	      The  second  form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning
	      strings.	Here, the specs are of	the  form  `left:right'	 where
	      `left'  and  `right'  are	 arbitrary strings.  These strings are
	      modified by replacing the colons by the sep string  and  padding
	      the  left	 strings  with	spaces	to  the	 right so that the sep
	      strings in the result (and hence the right strings  after	 them)
	      are  all	aligned	 if  the strings are printed below each other.
	      All strings without a colon are left unchanged and  all  strings
	      with  an empty right string have the trailing colon removed.  In
	      both cases the lengths of the strings are not used to  determine
	      how  the other strings are to be aligned.	 The resulting strings
	      are stored in the array.

       zregexparse
	      This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.

       zparseopts [ -D ] [ -K ] [ -M ] [ -E ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] specs
	      This builtin simplifies the parsing  of  options	in  positional
	      parameters,  i.e.	 the  set of arguments given by $*.  Each spec
	      describes one option and must be of the form `opt[=array]'.   If
	      an option described by opt is found in the positional parameters
	      it is copied into the array specified with the -a option; if the
	      optional	`=array'  is  given,  it  is  instead copied into that
	      array.

	      Note that it is an error to give any spec	 without  an  `=array'
	      unless one of the -a or -A options is used.

	      Unless the -E option is given, parsing stops at the first string
	      that isn't described by one of the specs.	 Even with -E, parsing
	      always stops at a positional parameter equal to `-' or `--'.

	      The  opt	description  must be one of the following.  Any of the
	      special characters can appear in the option name provided it  is
	      preceded by a backslash.

	      name
	      name+  The  name	is  the name of the option without the leading
		     `-'.  To specify a GNU-style  long	 option,  one  of  the
		     usual two leading `-' must be included in name; for exam‐
		     ple, a `--file'  option  is  represented  by  a  name  of
		     `-file'.

		     If	 a  `+'	 appears after name, the option is appended to
		     array each time it is found in the positional parameters;
		     without the `+' only the last occurrence of the option is
		     preserved.

		     If one of these forms is used, the option takes no	 argu‐
		     ment,  so	parsing stops if the next positional parameter
		     does not also begin with `-' (unless  the	-E  option  is
		     used).

	      name:
	      name:-
	      name:: If one or two colons are given, the option takes an argu‐
		     ment; with one colon, the argument is mandatory and  with
		     two  colons  it is optional.  The argument is appended to
		     the array after the option itself.

		     An optional argument is put into the same	array  element
		     as the option name (note that this makes empty strings as
		     arguments indistinguishable).  A  mandatory  argument  is
		     added as a separate element unless the `:-' form is used,
		     in which case the argument is put into the same element.

		     A `+' as described above may appear between the name  and
		     the first colon.

       The options of zparseopts itself are:

       -a array
	      As  described  above,  this  names the default array in which to
	      store the recognised options.

       -A assoc
	      If this is given, the options and their values are also put into
	      an associative array with the option names as keys and the argu‐
	      ments (if any) as the values.

       -D     If this option is given, all options found are removed from  the
	      positional parameters of the calling shell or shell function, up
	      to but not including any not described by the  specs.   This  is
	      similar to using the shift builtin.

       -K     With  this  option,  the	arrays	specified  with	 the -a and -A
	      options and with the `=array' forms are kept unchanged when none
	      of  the  specs  for  them	 is  used.   This allows assignment of
	      default values to them before calling zparseopts.

       -M     This changes the assignment  rules  to  implement	 a  map	 among
	      equivalent  option  names.   If any spec uses the `=array' form,
	      the string array is interpreted as the  name  of	another	 spec,
	      which  is used to choose where to store the values.  If no other
	      spec is found, the values are stored  as	usual.	 This  changes
	      only the way the values are stored, not the way $* is parsed, so
	      results may be unpredicable if the  `name+'  specifier  is  used
	      inconsistently.

       -E     This  changes  the parsing rules to not stop at the first string
	      that isn't described by one of the specs.	 It  can  be  used  to
	      test for or (if used together with -D) extract options and their
	      arguments, ignoring all other options and arguments that may  be
	      in the positional parameters.

       For example,

	      set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
	      zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar

       will have the effect of

	      foo=(-a)
	      bar=(-b x -c y -c z)

       The arguments from `baz' on will not be used.

       As an example for the -E option, consider:

	      set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
	      zparseopts -E -D b:=bar

       will have the effect of

	      bar=(-b y)
	      set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2

       I.e.,  the  option  -b  and its arguments are taken from the positional
       parameters and put into the array bar.

       The -M option can be used like this:

	      set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
	      zparseopts -A bar -M a=foo b+: c:=b

       to have the effect of

	      foo=(-a)
	      bar=(-a '' -b xyz)

ZSHCALSYS(1)							  ZSHCALSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcalsys - zsh calendar system

DESCRIPTION
       The shell is supplied with a series of functions to replace and enhance
       the  traditional Unix calendar programme, which warns the user of immi‐
       nent or future events, details of which are stored in a text file (typ‐
       ically  calendar	 in  the user's home directory).  The version provided
       here includes a mechanism for alerting the user when an event is due.

       In addition a function age is provided that can be used in a glob qual‐
       ifier;  it  allows  files  to  be  selected based on their modification
       times.

       The format of the calendar file and the dates used there in and in  the
       age function are described first, then the functions that can be called
       to examine and modify the calendar file.

       The functions here depend on the availability of the zsh/datetime  mod‐
       ule  which  is  usually installed with the shell.  The library function
       strptime() must be available; it is present on  most  recent  operating
       systems.

FILE AND DATE FORMATS
   Calendar File Format
       The  calendar file is by default ~/calendar.  This can be configured by
       the calendar-file style, see the section STYLES below.  The basic  for‐
       mat  consists  of a series of separate lines, with no indentation, each
       including a date and time specification followed by  a  description  of
       the event.

       Various	enhancements to this format are supported, based on the syntax
       of Emacs calendar mode.	An indented line indicates a continuation line
       that  continues	the  description  of the event from the preceding line
       (note the date may not be continued in this way).  An initial ampersand
       (&) is ignored for compatibility.

       An  indented  line  on which the first non-whitespace character is # is
       not displayed with the calendar entry, but is still scanned for	infor‐
       mation.	 This  can  be used to hide information useful to the calendar
       system but not to the user, such as the unique identifier used by  cal‐
       endar_add.

       The Emacs extension that a date with no description may refer to a num‐
       ber of succeeding events at different times is not supported.

       Unless the done-file style has been altered, any events which have been
       processed  are  appended to the file with the same name as the calendar
       file with the suffix .done, hence ~/calendar.done by default.

       An example is shown below.

   Date Format
       The format of the date and time is designed to allow flexibility	 with‐
       out admitting ambiguity.	 (The words `date' and `time' are both used in
       the documentation below; except where specifically noted this implies a
       string  that  may  include both a date and a time specification.)  Note
       that there is no localization support; month and day names must	be  in
       English	and separator characters are fixed.  Matching is case insensi‐
       tive, and only the first three letters of the  names  are  significant,
       although	 as  a	special	 case  a form beginning "month" does not match
       "Monday".  Furthermore, time zones  are	not  handled;  all  times  are
       assumed to be local.

       It  is  recommended  that, rather than exploring the intricacies of the
       system, users find a date format that is natural to them and  stick  to
       it.   This  will avoid unexpected effects.  Various key facts should be
       noted.

       ·      In particular, note the  confusion  between  month/day/year  and
	      day/month/year  when  the month is numeric; these formats should
	      be avoided if at all possible.  Many alternatives are available.

       ·      The year must be given in full  to  avoid	 confusion,  and  only
	      years from 1900 to 2099 inclusive are matched.

       The  following  give some obvious examples; users finding here a format
       they like and not subject to  vagaries  of  style  may  skip  the  full
       description.   As  dates	 and times are matched separately (even though
       the time may be embedded in the date), any date	format	may  be	 mixed
       with  any  format  for the time of day provide the separators are clear
       (whitespace, colons, commas).

	      2007/04/03 13:13
	      2007/04/03:13:13
	      2007/04/03 1:13 pm
	      3rd April 2007, 13:13
	      April 3rd 2007 1:13 p.m.
	      Apr 3, 2007 13:13
	      Tue Apr 03 13:13:00 2007
	      13:13 2007/apr/3

       More detailed rules follow.

       Times are parsed and extracted before dates.  They must use  colons  to
       separate	 hours	and minutes, though a dot is allowed before seconds if
       they are present.  This limits time formats to the following:

       ·      HH:MM[:SS[.FFFFF]] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

       ·      HH:MM.SS[.FFFFF] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

       Here, square brackets indicate optional elements, possibly with	alter‐
       natives.	  Fractions of a second are recognised but ignored.  For abso‐
       lute times (the normal format require by the calendar file and the  age
       function)  a  date  is  mandatory  but  a  time of day is not; the time
       returned is at the start of the date.  One  variation  is  allowed:  if
       a.m.  or	 p.m.  or  one of their variants is present, an hour without a
       minute is allowed, e.g. 3 p.m..

       Time zones are not handled, though if one is matched following  a  time
       specification  it  will	be  removed  to allow a surrounding date to be
       parsed.	This only happens if the format of the	timezone  is  not  too
       unusual.	 The following are examples of forms that are understood:

	      +0100
	      GMT
	      GMT-7
	      CET+1CDT

       Any  part  of  the timezone that is not numeric must have exactly three
       capital letters in the name.

       Dates suffer from the ambiguity between DD/MM/YYYY and MM/DD/YYYY.   It
       is  recommended this form is avoided with purely numeric dates, but use
       of ordinals, eg. 3rd/04/2007, will resolve the ambiguity as the ordinal
       is  always  parsed  as the day of the month.  Years must be four digits
       (and the first two must be 19  or  20);	03/04/08  is  not  recognised.
       Other  numbers may have leading zeroes, but they are not required.  The
       following are handled:

       ·      YYYY/MM/DD

       ·      YYYY-MM-DD

       ·      YYYY/MNM/DD

       ·      YYYY-MNM-DD

       ·      DD[th|st|rd] MNM[,] [ YYYY ]

       ·      MNM DD[th|st|rd][,] [ YYYY ]

       ·      DD[th|st|rd]/MM[,] YYYY

       ·      DD[th|st|rd]/MM/YYYY

       ·      MM/DD[th|st|rd][,] YYYY

       ·      MM/DD[th|st|rd]/YYYY

       Here, MNM is at least the first three letters of a month name,  matched
       case-insensitively.  The remainder of the month name may appear but its
       contents are  irrelevant,  so  janissary,  febrile,  martial,  apricot,
       maybe, junta, etc. are happily handled.

       Where  the  year	 is  shown  as	optional, the current year is assumed.
       There are only two such cases, the form Jun 20  or  14  September  (the
       only  two commonly occurring forms, apart from a "the" in some forms of
       English, which isn't currently supported).  Such dates will  of	course
       become ambiguous in the future, so should ideally be avoided.

       Times  may follow dates with a colon, e.g. 1965/07/12:09:45; this is in
       order to provide a format with no whitespace.  A comma  and  whitespace
       are allowed, e.g. 1965/07/12, 09:45.  Currently the order of these sep‐
       arators is not checked, so illogical  formats  such  as	1965/07/12,  :
       ,09:45  will  also  be matched.	For simplicity such variations are not
       shown in the list above.	 Otherwise, a time is only recognised as being
       associated  with	 a  date if there is only whitespace in between, or if
       the time was embedded in the date.

       Days of the week are not normally scanned, but will be ignored if  they
       occur  at  the  start  of  the date pattern only.  However, in contexts
       where it is useful to specify dates relative to today, days of the week
       with  no	 other date specification may be given.	 The day is assumed to
       be either today or within the past week.	 Likewise, the	words  yester‐
       day, today and tomorrow are handled.  All matches are case-insensitive.
       Hence if today is Monday, then Sunday is equivalent to yesterday,  Mon‐
       day  is	equivalent  to	today,	but Tuesday gives a date six days ago.
       This is not generally useful within the calendar file.  Dates  in  this
       format may be combined with a time specification; for example Tomorrow,
       8 p.m..

       For example, the standard date format:

	      Fri Aug 18 17:00:48 BST 2006

       is handled by matching HH:MM:SS	and  removing  it  together  with  the
       matched (but unused) time zone.	This leaves the following:

	      Fri Aug 18 2006

       Fri is ignored and the rest is matched according to the standard rules.

   Relative Time Format
       In  certain  places  relative  times  are handled.  Here, a date is not
       allowed;	 instead  a  combination  of  various  supported  periods  are
       allowed,	 together with an optional time.  The periods must be in order
       from most to least significant.

       In some cases, a more accurate calculation is possible when there is an
       anchor  date:   offsets of months or years pick the correct day, rather
       than being rounded, and it is possible to pick a particular  day	 in  a
       month as `(1st Friday)', etc., as described in more detail below.

       Anchors	are available in the following cases.  If one or two times are
       passed to the function calendar, the start time acts an anchor for  the
       end  time  when	the  end  time	is relative (even if the start time is
       implicit).  When examining calendar files, the  scheduled  event	 being
       examined	 anchors the warning time when it is given explicitly by means
       of the WARN keyword; likewise, the scheduled event anchors a repetition
       period  when  given  by the RPT keyword, so that specifications such as
       RPT 2 months, 3rd Thursday are handled properly.	 Finally, the -R argu‐
       ment to calendar_scandate directly provides an anchor for relative cal‐
       culations.

       The periods handled, with possible abbreviations are:

       Years  years, yrs, ys, year, yr, y, yearly.   A	year  is  365.25  days
	      unless there is an anchor.

       Months months, mons, mnths, mths, month, mon, mnth, mth, monthly.  Note
	      that m, ms, mn, mns are ambiguous and are not handled.  A	 month
	      is a period of 30 days rather than a calendar month unless there
	      is an anchor.

       Weeks  weeks, wks, ws, week, wk, w, weekly

       Days   days, dys, ds, day, dy, d, daily

       Hours  hours, hrs, hs, hour, hr, h, hourly

       Minutes
	      minutes, mins, minute, min, but not m, ms, mn or mns

       Seconds
	      seconds, secs, ss, second, sec, s

       Spaces between the numbers  are	optional,  but	are  required  between
       items, although a comma may be used (with or without spaces).

       The  forms  yearly  to  hourly  allow  the  number to be omitted; it is
       assumed to be 1.	 For example, 1 d and daily are equivalent.  Note that
       using  those forms with plurals is confusing; 2 yearly is the same as 2
       years, not twice yearly, so it is recommended they only be used without
       numbers.

       When an anchor time is present, there is an extension to handle regular
       events in the form of the nth someday of the month.  Such a  specifica‐
       tion must occur immediately after any year and month specification, but
       before any time of day, and must be in the form	n(th|st|rd)  day,  for
       example	1st  Tuesday  or  3rd  Monday.	 As  in other places, days are
       matched case insensitively, must be in  English,	 and  only  the	 first
       three letters are significant except that a form beginning `month' does
       not match `Monday'.  No attempt is made to sanitize the resulting date;
       attempts to squeeze too many occurrences into a month will push the day
       into the next month (but in the obvious fashion, retaining the  correct
       day of the week).

       Here are some examples:

	      30 years 3 months 4 days 3:42:41
	      14 days 5 hours
	      Monthly, 3rd Thursday
	      4d,10hr

   Example
       Here is an example calendar file.  It uses a consistent date format, as
       recommended above.

	      Feb 1, 2006 14:30 Pointless bureaucratic meeting
	      Mar 27, 2006 11:00 Mutual recrimination and finger pointing
		Bring water pistol and waterproofs
	      Mar 31, 2006 14:00 Very serious managerial pontification
		# UID 12C7878A9A50
	      Apr 10, 2006 13:30 Even more pointless blame assignment exercise WARN 30 mins
	      May 18, 2006 16:00 Regular moaning session RPT monthly, 3rd Thursday

       The second entry has a continuation line.  The third entry has  a  con‐
       tinuation  line that will not be shown when the entry is displayed, but
       the unique identifier will be used by the  calendar_add	function  when
       updating the event.  The fourth entry will produce a warning 30 minutes
       before the event (to allow you to equip yourself	 appropriately).   The
       fifth  entry  repeats  after a month on the 3rd Thursday, i.e. June 15,
       2006, at the same time.

USER FUNCTIONS
       This section  describes	functions  that	 are  designed	to  be	called
       directly by the user.  The first part describes those functions associ‐
       ated with the user's calendar; the second part  describes  the  use  in
       glob qualifiers.

   Calendar system functions
       calendar	 [  -abdDsv  ]	[  -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ] [ [
       start ] end ](
       calendar -r [ -abdDrsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S	showprog  ]  [
       start ]
	      Show events in the calendar.

	      With no arguments, show events from the start of today until the
	      end of the next working day after today.	 In  other  words,  if
	      today  is Friday, Saturday, or Sunday, show up to the end of the
	      following Monday, otherwise show today and tomorrow.

	      If end is given, show events from the start of today up  to  the
	      time  and	 date  given,  which is in the format described in the
	      previous section.	 Note that if this  is	a  date	 the  time  is
	      assumed  to be midnight at the start of the date, so that effec‐
	      tively this shows all events before the given date.

	      end may start with a +, in which case the remainder of the spec‐
	      ification is a relative time format as described in the previous
	      section indicating the range of time from the start time that is
	      to be included.

	      If  start is also given, show events starting from that time and
	      date.  The word now can be used to indicate the current time.

	      To implement an alert when events are due, include  calendar  -s
	      in your ~/.zshrc file.

	      Options:

	      -a     Show  all	items in the calendar, regardless of the start
		     and end.

	      -b     Brief:  don't display continuation lines  (i.e.  indented
		     lines  following  the  line with the date/time), just the
		     first line.

	      -B lines
		     Brief: display at most the first lines lines of the  cal‐
		     endar entry.  `-B 1' is equivalent to `-b'.

	      -C calfile
		     Explicitly	 specify  a calendar file instead of the value
		     of the calendar-file style or the default ~/calendar.

	      -d     Move any events that have passed from the	calendar  file
		     to	 the  "done"  file, as given by the done-file style or
		     the  default  which  is  the  calendar  file  with	 .done
		     appended.	This option is implied by the -s option.

	      -D     Turns  off	 the  option -d, even if the -s option is also
		     present.

	      -n num, -num
		     Show at least num events,	if  present  in	 the  calendar
		     file, regardless of the start and end.

	      -r     Show  all the remaining options in the calendar, ignoring
		     the given end time.  The start  time  is  respected;  any
		     argument given is treated as a start time.

	      -s     Use  the  shell's sched command to schedule a timed event
		     that will warn the user when an event is due.  Note  that
		     the  sched command only runs if the shell is at an inter‐
		     active prompt; a foreground  task	blocks	the  scheduled
		     task from running until it is finished.

		     The  timed event usually runs the programme calendar_show
		     to show the event, as described in	 the  section  UTILITY
		     FUNCTIONS below.

		     By	 default, a warning of the event is shown five minutes
		     before it is due.	The warning period can	be  configured
		     by	 the style warn-time or for a single calendar entry by
		     including WARN reltime in the first line  of  the	entry,
		     where reltime is one of the usual relative time formats.

		     A	repeated  event may be indicated by including RPT rel‐
		     date in the first line of the entry.  After the scheduled
		     event  has	 been displayed it will be re-entered into the
		     calendar file at a time reldate after the existing event.
		     Note  that	 this  is  currently  the only use made of the
		     repeat count, so that it is not  possible	to  query  the
		     schedule  for  a  recurrence  of an event in the calendar
		     until the previous event has passed.

		     If RPT is used, it is also possible to specify that  cer‐
		     tain  recurrences	of  an	event  are rescheduled or can‐
		     celled.  This is done with the OCCURRENCE	keyword,  fol‐
		     lowed  by	whitespace and the date and time of the occur‐
		     rence in the regular sequence, followed by whitespace and
		     either  the date and time of the rescheduled event or the
		     exact string CANCELLED.  In this case the date  and  time
		     must be in exactly the "date with local time" format used
		     by	  the	text/calendar	MIME	type	(RFC	2445),
		     <YYYY><MM><DD>T<hh><mm><ss>  (note	 the  presence	of the
		     literal character T).  The first word (the regular recur‐
		     rence)  may be something other than a proper date/time to
		     indicate that the	event  is  additional  to  the	normal
		     sequence;	 a  convention	that  retains  the  formatting
		     appearance is XXXXXXXXTXXXXXX.

		     Furthermore, it is useful	to  record  the	 next  regular
		     recurrence	 (as  then  the	 displayed  date  may be for a
		     rescheduled event so cannot be used for  calculating  the
		     regular sequence).	 This is specified by RECURRENCE and a
		     time or date in the same format.  calendar_add adds  such
		     an	 indication  when it encounters a recurring event that
		     does not include one, based on the headline date/time.

		     If calendar_add is used to	 update	 occurrences  the  UID
		     keyword  described	 there	should	be present in both the
		     existing entry and the added occurrence in order to iden‐
		     tify recurring event sequences.

		     For example,

			    Thu May 6, 2010 11:00 Informal chat RPT 1 week
			      # RECURRENCE 20100506T110000
			      # OCCURRENCE 20100513T110000 20100513T120000
			      # OCCURRENCE 20100520T110000 CANCELLED

		     The  event	 that  occurs  at  11:00  on  13th May 2010 is
		     rescheduled an hour later.	 The event that occurs a  week
		     later  is cancelled.  The occurrences are given on a con‐
		     tinuation line starting with a # character	 so  will  not
		     usually be displayed as part of the event.	 As elsewhere,
		     no account of time zones is taken with the	 times.	 After
		     the next event occurs the headline date/time will be `Thu
		     May 13, 2010 12:00' while the RECURRENCE  date/time  will
		     be	 `20100513T110000'  (note  that	 cancelled  and	 moved
		     events are not taken account of in the RECURRENCE,	 which
		     records what the next regular recurrence is, but they are
		     accounted for in the headline date/time).

		     It is safe to run calendar -s to reschedule  an  existing
		     event  (if	 the  calendar file has changed, for example),
		     and also to have it running in multiples instances of the
		     shell since the calendar file is locked when in use.

		     By	 default, expired events are moved to the "done" file;
		     see the -d option.	 Use -D to prevent this.

	      -S showprog
		     Explicitly specify a programme to	be  used  for  showing
		     events instead of the value of the show-prog style or the
		     default calendar_show.

	      -v     Verbose:  show more information about stages of  process‐
		     ing.  This is useful for confirming that the function has
		     successfully parsed the dates in the calendar file.

       calendar_add [ -BL ] event ...
	      Adds a single event to the calendar in the appropriate location.
	      The  event  can contain multiple lines, as described in the sec‐
	      tion Calendar File Format above.	Using  this  function  ensures
	      that  the	 calendar  file	 is sorted in date and time order.  It
	      also makes special arrangements for locking the file while it is
	      altered.	 The  old  calendar  is left in a file with the suffix
	      .old.

	      The option -B indicates that backing up the calendar  file  will
	      be  handled  by the caller and should not be performed by calen‐
	      dar_add.	The option -L indicates	 that  calendar_add  does  not
	      need  to	lock the calendar file as it is already locked.	 These
	      options will not usually be needed by users.

	      If the style reformat-date is true, the date and time of the new
	      entry  will be rewritten into the standard date format:  see the
	      descriptions of this style and the style date-format.

	      The function can use a unique identifier stored with each	 event
	      to ensure that updates to existing events are treated correctly.
	      The entry should contain the word UID, followed  by  whitespace,
	      followed	by a word consisting entirely of hexadecimal digits of
	      arbitrary length (all digits are significant, including  leading
	      zeroes).	 As  the UID is not directly useful to the user, it is
	      convenient to hide it on an indented continuation line  starting
	      with a #, for example:

		     Aug 31, 2007 09:30	 Celebrate the end of the holidays
		       # UID 045B78A0

	      The second line will not be shown by the calendar function.

	      It  is possible to specify the RPT keyword followed by CANCELLED
	      instead of a relative time.  This causes any  matched  event  or
	      series  of  events  to be cancelled (the original event does not
	      have to be marked as recurring in order to be cancelled by  this
	      method).	 A UID is required in order to match an existing event
	      in the calendar.

	      calendar_add will attempt to manage recurrences and  occurrences
	      of  repeating events as described for event scheduling by calen‐
	      dar -s above.  To reschedule or cancel  a	 single	 event	calen‐
	      dar_add should be called with an entry that includes the correct
	      UID but does not include the RPT keyword as  this	 is  taken  to
	      mean the entry applies to a series of repeating events and hence
	      replaces all existing information.   Each	 rescheduled  or  can‐
	      celled  occurrence  must have an OCCURRENCE keyword in the entry
	      passed to calendar_add which will be merged  into	 the  calendar
	      file.  Any existing reference to the occurrence is replaced.  An
	      occurrence that does not refer to	 a  valid  existing  event  is
	      added as a one-off occurrence to the same calendar entry.

       calendar_edit
	      This  calls  the	user's	editor	to edit the calendar file.  If
	      there are arguments, they are taken as the editor	 to  use  (the
	      file name is appended to the commands); otherwise, the editor is
	      given by the variable VISUAL, if set, else the variable EDITOR.

	      If the calendar scheduler was running, then  after  editing  the
	      file calendar -s is called to update it.

	      This  function  locks  out  the calendar system during the edit.
	      Hence it should be used to edit the calendar file	 if  there  is
	      any  possibility	of a calendar event occurring meanwhile.  Note
	      this can lead to another shell with calendar  functions  enabled
	      hanging  waiting for a lock, so it is necessary to quit the edi‐
	      tor as soon as possible.

       calendar_parse calendar-entry
	      This is the internal function that analyses the parts of a  cal‐
	      endar entry, which is passed as the only argument.  The function
	      returns status 1 if the argument could not be parsed as a calen‐
	      dar  entry  and  status  2 if the wrong number of arguments were
	      passed; it also sets the parameter reply to an empty associative
	      array.   Otherwise, it returns status 0 and sets elements of the
	      associative array reply as follows:
       time   The time as a string of digits in the same units	as  $EPOCHSEC‐
	      ONDS
       schedtime
	      The  regularly  scheduled time.  This may differ from the actual
	      event time time if this is a recurring event and the next occur‐
	      rence has been rescheduled.  Then time gives the actual time and
	      schedtime the time of the regular	 recurrence  before  modifica‐
	      tion.
       text1  The  text	 from  the line not including the date and time of the
	      event, but including any WARN or RPT keywords and values.
       warntime
	      Any warning time given by the WARN keyword as a string of digits
	      containing  the  time  at	 which	to  warn  in the same units as
	      $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note this is an absolute time, not the relative
	      time  passed  down.)   Not  set  no  WARN keyword and value were
	      matched.
       warnstr
	      The raw string matched after the WARN keyword, else unset.
       rpttime
	      Any recurrence time given by the RPT keyword as a string of dig‐
	      its  containing  the time of the recurrence in the same units as
	      $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note this is an absolute time.)	Not set if  no
	      RPT keyword and value were matched.
       schedrpttime
	      The  next	 regularly  scheduled  occurrence of a recurring event
	      before modification.  This may differ from rpttime, which is the
	      actual time of the event that may have been rescheduled from the
	      regular time.
       rptstr The raw string matched after the RPT keyword, else unset.
       text2  The text from the line after removal of the date	and  any  key‐
	      words and values.	 )

       calendar_showdate [ -r ] [ -f fmt ] date-spec ...
	      The  given  date-spec  is interpreted and the corresponding date
	      and time printed.	 If the initial date-spec begins with a + or -
	      it  is treated as relative to the current time; date-specs after
	      the first are treated as relative to the date calculated so  far
	      and  a  leading  + is optional in that case.  This allows one to
	      use the system  as  a  date  calculator.	 For  example,	calen‐
	      dar_showdate  '+1 month, 1st Friday' shows the date of the first
	      Friday of next month.

	      With the option -r nothing is printed but the value of the  date
	      and  time	 in seconds since the epoch is stored in the parameter
	      REPLY.

	      With the option -f fmt the given date/time conversion format  is
	      passed to strftime; see notes on the date-format style below.

	      In order to avoid ambiguity with negative relative date specifi‐
	      cations, options must occur in separate words; in	 other	words,
	      -r and -f should not be combined in the same word.

       calendar_sort
	      Sorts  the  calendar  file  into date and time order.    The old
	      calendar is left in a file with the suffix .old.

   Glob qualifiers
       The function age can be autoloaded and use separately from the calendar
       system,	although  it uses the function calendar_scandate for date for‐
       matting.	 It requires the zsh/stat builtin, but uses only  the  builtin
       zstat.

       age  selects  files  having a given modification time for use as a glob
       qualifier.  The format of the date is the same as  that	understood  by
       the  calendar  system,  described  in the section FILE AND DATE FORMATS
       above.

       The function can take one or  two  arguments,  which  can  be  supplied
       either directly as command or arguments, or separately as shell parame‐
       ters.

	      print *(e:age 2006/10/04 2006/10/09:)

       The example above matches all files modified between the start of those
       dates.  The second argument may alternatively be a relative time intro‐
       duced by a +:

	      print *(e:age 2006/10/04 +5d:)

       The example above is equivalent to the previous example.

       In addition to the special use of days of the week, today  and  yester‐
       day,  times with no date may be specified; these apply to today.	 Obvi‐
       ously such uses become problematic around midnight.

	      print *(e-age 12:00 13:30-)

       The example above shows files modified between 12:00 and 13:00 today.

	      print *(e:age 2006/10/04:)

       The example above matches all files modified on that date.  If the sec‐
       ond  argument  is  omitted it is taken to be exactly 24 hours after the
       first argument (even if the first argument contains a time).

	      print *(e-age 2006/10/04:10:15 2006/10/04:10:45-)

       The example above supplies times.  Note that whitespace within the time
       and  date  specification must be quoted to ensure age receives the cor‐
       rect arguments, hence the use of the additional colon to	 separate  the
       date and time.

	      AGEREF=2006/10/04:10:15
	      AGEREF2=2006/10/04:10:45
	      print *(+age)

       This shows the same example before using another form of argument pass‐
       ing.  The dates and times in the parameters AGEREF and AGEREF2 stay  in
       effect until unset, but will be overridden if any argument is passed as
       an explicit argument to age.  Any explicit argument causes both parame‐
       ters to be ignored.

       Instead	of an explicit date and time, it's possible to use the modifi‐
       cation time of a file as the date  and  time  for  either  argument  by
       introducing the file name with a colon:

	      print *(e-age :file1-)

       matches	all files created on the same day (24 hours starting from mid‐
       night) as file1.

	      print *(e-age :file1 :file2-)

       matches all files modified no earlier than  file1  and  no  later  than
       file2; precision here is to the nearest second.

STYLES
       The zsh style mechanism using the zstyle command is describe in zshmod‐
       ules(1).	 This is the same mechanism used in the completion system.

       The styles below are all examined in the	 context  :datetime:function:,
       for example :datetime:calendar:.

       calendar-file
	      The location of the main calendar.  The default is ~/calendar.

       date-format
	      A	 strftime  format string (see strftime(3)) with the zsh exten‐
	      sions providing various numbers with no leading zero or space if
	      the  number  is  a  single digit as described for the %D{string}
	      prompt format in the section EXPANSION OF	 PROMPT	 SEQUENCES  in
	      zshmisc(1).

	      This  is	used for outputting dates in calendar, both to support
	      the -v option and when adding recurring events back to the  cal‐
	      endar file, and in calendar_showdate as the final output format.

	      If  the  style is not set, the default used is similar the stan‐
	      dard system format as output by the date command (also known  as
	      `ctime format'): `%a %b %d %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'.

       done-file
	      The  location  of the file to which events which have passed are
	      appended.	 The default is the calendar file  location  with  the
	      suffix  .done.  The style may be set to an empty string in which
	      case a "done" file will not be maintained.

       reformat-date
	      Boolean, used by calendar_add.  If it is true, the date and time
	      of  new entries added to the calendar will be reformatted to the
	      format given by the style date-format or its default.  Only  the
	      date and time of the event itself is reformatted; any subsidiary
	      dates and times such as those associated with repeat and warning
	      times are left alone.

       show-prog
	      The  programme  run  by calendar for showing events.  It will be
	      passed the start time and stop time of the events	 requested  in
	      seconds  since  the epoch followed by the event text.  Note that
	      calendar -s uses a start time and stop time equal to one another
	      to indicate alerts for specific events.

	      The default is the function calendar_show.

       warn-time
	      The  time	 before an event at which a warning will be displayed,
	      if the first line of the event does not include the  text	 EVENT
	      reltime.	The default is 5 minutes.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       calendar_lockfiles
	      Attempt  to  lock	 the  files given in the argument.  To prevent
	      problems with network file locking this is done  in  an  ad  hoc
	      fashion by attempting to create a symbolic link to the file with
	      the name file.lockfile.  No other	 system	 level	functions  are
	      used  for locking, i.e. the file can be accessed and modified by
	      any utility that does not use this  mechanism.   In  particular,
	      the  user is not prevented from editing the calendar file at the
	      same time unless calendar_edit is used.

	      Three attempts are made to lock the file before giving  up.   If
	      the  module  zsh/zselect is available, the times of the attempts
	      are jittered so that multiple instances of the calling  function
	      are unlikely to retry at the same time.

	      The  files  locked  are  appended	 to the array lockfiles, which
	      should be local to the caller.

	      If all files were successfully locked, status zero is  returned,
	      else status one.

	      This  function  may  be used as a general file locking function,
	      although this will only work if only this mechanism is  used  to
	      lock files.

       calendar_read
	      This  is	a backend used by various other functions to parse the
	      calendar file, which is passed as the only argument.  The	 array
	      calendar_entries	is  set	 to the list of events in the file; no
	      pruning is done except that  ampersands  are  removed  from  the
	      start of the line.  Each entry may contain multiple lines.

       calendar_scandate
	      This  is a generic function to parse dates and times that may be
	      used separately from the calendar system.	  The  argument	 is  a
	      date  or time specification as described in the section FILE AND
	      DATE FORMATS above.  The parameter REPLY is set to the number of
	      seconds  since the epoch corresponding to that date or time.  By
	      default, the date and time may occur anywhere within  the	 given
	      argument.

	      Returns  status  zero  if	 the  date  and time were successfully
	      parsed, else one.

	      Options:
	      -a     The date and time are anchored to the start of the	 argu‐
		     ment;  they  will	not  be	 matched if there is preceding
		     text.

	      -A     The date and time are anchored to both the start and  end
		     of	 the  argument; they will not be matched if the is any
		     other text in the argument.

	      -d     Enable additional debugging output.

	      -m     Minus.  When -R anchor_time is also  given	 the  relative
		     time is calculated backwards from anchor_time.

	      -r     The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time.

	      -R anchor_time
		     The  argument  passed is to be parsed as a relative time.
		     The time is relative to anchor_time, a  time  in  seconds
		     since  the	 epoch, and the returned value is the absolute
		     time corresponding to advancing anchor_time by the	 rela‐
		     tive  time	 given.	  This	allows lengths of months to be
		     correctly taken into account.  If the final day does  not
		     exist in the given month, the last day of the final month
		     is given.	For example, if the anchor time is during 31st
		     January  2007 and the relative time is 1 month, the final
		     time is the same time of day during 28th February 2007.

	      -s     In addition to setting REPLY, set REPLY2 to the remainder
		     of	 the  argument	after  the  date  and  time  have been
		     stripped.	This is empty if the option -A was given.

	      -t     Allow a time with no date	specification.	 The  date  is
		     assumed to be today.  The behaviour is unspecified if the
		     iron tongue of midnight is tolling twelve.

       calendar_show
	      The function used by default to display events.	It  accepts  a
	      start  time  and end time for events, both in epoch seconds, and
	      an event description.

	      The event is always printed to standard output.  If the  command
	      line  editor is active (which will usually be the case) the com‐
	      mand line will be redisplayed after the output.

	      If the parameter DISPLAY is set and the start and end times  are
	      the  same	 (indicating a scheduled event), the function uses the
	      command xmessage to display a window with the event details.

BUGS
       As the system is based entirely on shell functions (with a little  sup‐
       port  from  the	zsh/datetime  module)  the  mechanisms used are not as
       robust as those provided by a dedicated calendar utility.  Consequently
       the user should not rely on the shell for vital alerts.

       There is no calendar_delete function.

       There  is  no localization support for dates and times, nor any support
       for the use of time zones.

       Relative periods of months and years do not take into account the vari‐
       able number of days.

       The  calendar_show  function is currently hardwired to use xmessage for
       displaying alerts on X Window System displays.  This should be  config‐
       urable and ideally integrate better with the desktop.

       calendar_lockfiles  hangs the shell while waiting for a lock on a file.
       If called from a scheduled task, it should instead reschedule the event
       that caused it.

ZSHTCPSYS(1)							  ZSHTCPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshtcpsys - zsh tcp system

DESCRIPTION
       A  module  zsh/net/tcp  is  provided to provide network I/O over TCP/IP
       from within the shell; see its description  in  zshmodules(1)  .	  This
       manual  page  describes	a  function suite based on the module.	If the
       module is installed, the functions are usually installed	 at  the  same
       time,  in  which	 case  they  will  be available for autoloading in the
       default function search path.  In addition to the  zsh/net/tcp  module,
       the  zsh/zselect	 module	 is  used to implement timeouts on read opera‐
       tions.  For troubleshooting tips, consult the corresponding advice  for
       the zftp functions described in zshzftpsys(1) .

       There  are  functions  corresponding  to the basic I/O operations open,
       close, read and send, named  tcp_open  etc.,  as	 well  as  a  function
       tcp_expect  for pattern match analysis of data read as input.  The sys‐
       tem makes it easy to receive data from and send data to multiple	 named
       sessions	 at once.  In addition, it can be linked with the shell's line
       editor in such a way that input data is automatically shown at the ter‐
       minal.	Other  facilities  available  including logging, filtering and
       configurable output prompts.

       To use the system where	it  is	available,  it	should	be  enough  to
       `autoload  -U tcp_open' and run tcp_open as documented below to start a
       session.	 The tcp_open function will autoload the remaining functions.

TCP USER FUNCTIONS
   Basic I/O
       tcp_open [-qz] host port [ sess ]
       tcp_open [-qz] [ -s sess | -l sess,... ] ...
       tcp_open [-qz] [-a fd | -f fd ] [ sess ]
	      Open a new session.  In the first and simplest form, open a  TCP
	      connection to host host at port port; numeric and symbolic forms
	      are understood for both.

	      If sess is given, this becomes the name of the session which can
	      be used to refer to multiple different TCP connections.  If sess
	      is not given, the function will  invent  a  numeric  name	 value
	      (note  this  is not the same as the file descriptor to which the
	      session is attached).  It is recommended that session names  not
	      include  `funny'	characters,  where  funny  characters  are not
	      well-defined but	certainly  do  not  include  alphanumerics  or
	      underscores, and certainly do include whitespace.

	      In  the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given
	      by name.	A  single  session  name  is  given  after  -s	and  a
	      comma-separated  list  after -l; both options may be repeated as
	      many times as necessary.	A failure to open any  session	causes
	      tcp_open	to  abort.   The  host and port are read from the file
	      .ztcp_sessions in the same directory as the user's zsh initiali‐
	      sation  files,  i.e. usually the home directory, but $ZDOTDIR if
	      that is set.  The file consists of lines each giving  a  session
	      name  and	 the  corresponding host and port, in that order (note
	      the session name comes first, not	 last),	 separated  by	white‐
	      space.

	      The  third form allows passive and fake TCP connections.	If the
	      option -a is used, its argument is a file	 descriptor  open  for
	      listening for connections.  No function front-end is provided to
	      open such a file descriptor, but a call to `ztcp -l  port'  will
	      create  one  with	 the  file  descriptor stored in the parameter
	      $REPLY.  The listening port can be closed with `ztcp -c fd'.   A
	      call  to	`tcp_open -a fd' will block until a remote TCP connec‐
	      tion is made to port on the local machine.   At  this  point,  a
	      session  is  created  in	the usual way and is largely indistin‐
	      guishable from an active connection  created  with  one  of  the
	      first two forms.

	      If  the  option  -f  is  used, its argument is a file descriptor
	      which is used directly as if it were a TCP  session.   How  well
	      the remainder of the TCP function system copes with this depends
	      on what actually underlies this file descriptor.	A regular file
	      is  likely  to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of some sort will work
	      better, but note that it is not a good idea  for	two  different
	      sessions to attempt to read from the same FIFO at once.

	      If  the option -q is given with any of the three forms, tcp_open
	      will not print informational messages, although it will  in  any
	      case exit with an appropriate status.

	      If  the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the case
	      if the shell is interactive, tcp_open installs a handler	inside
	      zle  which will check for new data at the same time as it checks
	      for keyboard input.  This is convenient as the shell consumes no
	      CPU  time	 while waiting; the test is performed by the operating
	      system.  Giving the option -z to any of the  forms  of  tcp_open
	      prevents	the handler from being installed, so data must be read
	      explicitly.  Note, however, this is not necessary for  executing
	      complete	sets of send and read commands from a function, as zle
	      is not active at this point.  Generally speaking, the handler is
	      only  active  when  the  shell is waiting for input at a command
	      prompt or in the vared builtin.  The option has no effect if zle
	      is not active; `[[ -o zle]]' will test for this.

	      The  first  session to be opened becomes the current session and
	      subsequent calls to tcp_open do not change it.  The current ses‐
	      sion  is	stored	in the parameter $TCP_SESS; see below for more
	      detail about the parameters used by the system.

	      The function tcp_on_open, if defined, is called when  a  session
	      is opened.  See the description below.

       tcp_close [-qn] [ -a | -l sess,... | sess ... ]
	      Close  the  named	 sessions,  or	the current session if none is
	      given, or all open sessions if -a is given.  The options -l  and
	      -s  are both handled for consistency with tcp_open, although the
	      latter is redundant.

	      If the session being closed is the  current  one,	 $TCP_SESS  is
	      unset,  leaving no current session, even if there are other ses‐
	      sions still open.

	      If the session was opened with tcp_open -f, the file  descriptor
	      is  closed  so  long  as	it  is	in the range 0 to 9 accessible
	      directly from the command line.  If the option -n is  given,  no
	      attempt  will  be	 made  to close file descriptors in this case.
	      The -n option is not used for genuine  ztcp  session;  the  file
	      descriptors are always closed with the session.

	      If  the  option  -q  is given, no informational messages will be
	      printed.

       tcp_read [-bdq] [ -t TO ] [ -T TO ]
	   [ -a | -u fd ... | -l sess,... | -s sess ...]
	      Perform a read operation on the current session, or on a list of
	      sessions	if  any	 are given with -u, -l or -s, or all open ses‐
	      sions if the option -a is given.	 Any  of  the  -u,  -l	or  -s
	      options may be repeated or mixed together.  The -u option speci‐
	      fies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this sys‐
	      tem are useful), the other two specify sessions as described for
	      tcp_open above.

	      The function checks for new data available on all	 the  sessions
	      listed.	Unless the -b option is given, it will not block wait‐
	      ing for new data.	 Any one line of data from any of  the	avail‐
	      able  sessions  will be read, stored in the parameter $TCP_LINE,
	      and displayed to standard output unless $TCP_SILENT  contains  a
	      non-empty	 string.   When	 printed to standard output the string
	      $TCP_PROMPT will be shown at the start of the line; the  default
	      form  for this includes the name of the session being read.  See
	      below for more information on these parameters.  In  this	 mode,
	      tcp_read	can  be	 called	 repeatedly  until it returns status 2
	      which indicates all pending input from  all  specified  sessions
	      has been handled.

	      With the option -b, equivalent to an infinite timeout, the func‐
	      tion will block until a line is available to read	 from  one  of
	      the   specified  sessions.   However,  only  a  single  line  is
	      returned.

	      The option  -d  indicates	 that  all  pending  input  should  be
	      drained.	 In  this  case tcp_read may process multiple lines in
	      the manner given above; only the last is	stored	in  $TCP_LINE,
	      but the complete set is stored in the array $tcp_lines.  This is
	      cleared at the start of each call to tcp_read.

	      The options -t and -T specify a timeout in seconds, which may be
	      a	 floating  point  number  for increased accuracy.  With -t the
	      timeout is applied before each line read.	 With -T, the  timeout
	      applies  to  the	overall operation, possibly including multiple
	      read operations if  the  option  -d  is  present;	 without  this
	      option, there is no distinction between -t and -T.

	      The  function  does not print informational messages, but if the
	      option -q is given, no error message is printed for a  non-exis‐
	      tent session.

	      A	 return	 status	 of  2 indicates a timeout or no data to read.
	      Any other non-zero return status indicates some error condition.

	      See tcp_log for how to control where data is sent by tcp_read.

       tcp_send [-cnq] [ -s sess | -l sess,... ] data ...
       tcp_send [-cnq] -a data ...
	      Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions  in
	      turn.  The underlying operation differs little from a `print -r'
	      to the session's file descriptor, although it attempts  to  pre‐
	      vent  the	 shell	from  dying  owing  to	a SIGPIPE caused by an
	      attempt to write to a defunct session.

	      The option -c causes tcp_send to	behave	like  cat.   It	 reads
	      lines  from  standard input until end of input and sends them in
	      turn to the specified session(s) exactly as if they  were	 given
	      as data arguments to individual tcp_send commands.

	      The  option  -n  prevents tcp_send from putting a newline at the
	      end of the data strings.

	      The remaining options all behave as for tcp_read.

	      The data arguments are not further processed once they have been
	      passed to tcp_send; they are simply passed down to print -r.

	      If  the  parameter $TCP_OUTPUT is a non-empty string and logging
	      is enabled then the data sent to each session will be echoed  to
	      the  log	file(s)	 with  $TCP_OUTPUT in front where appropriate,
	      much in the manner of $TCP_PROMPT.

   Session Management
       tcp_alias [-q] alias=sess ...
       tcp_alias [-q] [ alias ] ...
       tcp_alias -d [-q] alias ...
	      This function is not particularly well tested.

	      The first form creates an alias for a session  name;  alias  can
	      then  be	used  to  refer to the existing session sess.  As many
	      aliases may be listed as required.

	      The second form lists any aliases specified, or all  aliases  if
	      none.

	      The  third  form deletes all the aliases listed.	The underlying
	      sessions are not affected.

	      The option -q suppresses	an  inconsistently  chosen  subset  of
	      error messages.

       tcp_log [-asc] [ -n | -N ] [ logfile ]
	      With an argument logfile, all future input from tcp_read will be
	      logged to the named file.	 Unless -a  (append)  is  given,  this
	      file  will  first	 be truncated or created empty.	 With no argu‐
	      ments, show the current status of logging.

	      With the option -s, per-session logging is enabled.  Input  from
	      tcp_read	is output to the file logfile.sess.  As the session is
	      automatically discriminated by the filename,  the	 contents  are
	      raw   (no	 $TCP_PROMPT).	 The  option   -a  applies  as	above.
	      Per-session logging and logging of all data in one file are  not
	      mutually exclusive.

	      The  option -c closes all logging, both complete and per-session
	      logs.

	      The options -n and -N respectively turn off or restore output of
	      data  read  by  tcp_read to standard output; hence `tcp_log -cn'
	      turns off all output by tcp_read.

	      The function is purely a convenient front	 end  to  setting  the
	      parameters   $TCP_LOG,  $TCP_LOG_SESS,  $TCP_SILENT,  which  are
	      described below.

       tcp_rename old new
	      Rename session  old  to  session	new.   The  old	 name  becomes
	      invalid.

       tcp_sess [ sess [ command  ... ] ]
	      With  no	arguments,  list  all the open sessions and associated
	      file descriptors.	 The current session is marked	with  a	 star.
	      For   use	  in   functions,  direct  access  to  the  parameters
	      $tcp_by_name, $tcp_by_fd and $TCP_SESS is probably  more	conve‐
	      nient; see below.

	      With  a sess argument, set the current session to sess.  This is
	      equivalent to changing $TCP_SESS directly.

	      With additional arguments, temporarily set the  current  session
	      while  executing	the string command ....	 The first argument is
	      re-evaluated so as to expand aliases  etc.,  but	the  remaining
	      arguments	 are  passed  through  as the appear to tcp_sess.  The
	      original session is restored when tcp_sess exits.

   Advanced I/O
       tcp_command send-options ... send-arguments ...
	      This is a convenient front-end to tcp_send.  All	arguments  are
	      passed  to  tcp_send, then the function pauses waiting for data.
	      While data is arriving at least every $TCP_TIMEOUT (default 0.3)
	      seconds,	data  is handled and printed out according to the cur‐
	      rent settings.  Status 0 is always returned.

	      This is generally only useful for interactive  use,  to  prevent
	      the display becoming fragmented by output returned from the con‐
	      nection.	Within a programme or function it is generally	better
	      to handle reading data by a more explicit method.

       tcp_expect [ -q ] [ -p var ] [ -t  to | -T TO]
	   [ -a | -s sess ... | -l sess,... ] pattern ...
	      Wait  for	 input	matching any of the given patterns from any of
	      the specified sessions.  Input is ignored until  an  input  line
	      matches  one of the given patterns; at this point status zero is
	      returned, the matching line is stored in $TCP_LINE, and the full
	      set of lines read during the call to tcp_expect is stored in the
	      array $tcp_expect_lines.

	      Sessions are specified in the same way as tcp_read: the  default
	      is  to use the current session, otherwise the sessions specified
	      by -a, -s, or -l are used.

	      Each pattern is a standard zsh extended-globbing	pattern;  note
	      that  it	needs  to be quoted to avoid it being expanded immedi‐
	      ately by filename generation.  It must match the full  line,  so
	      to  match	 a substring there must be a `*' at the start and end.
	      The line matched	against	 includes  the	$TCP_PROMPT  added  by
	      tcp_read.	  It is possible to include the globbing flags `#b' or
	      `#m' in the patterns to make  backreferences  available  in  the
	      parameters  $MATCH,  $match,  etc., as described in the base zsh
	      documentation on pattern matching.

	      Unlike tcp_read, the default behaviour of tcp_expect is to block
	      indefinitely  until  the	required  input is found.  This can be
	      modified by specifying a timeout with -t or -T;  these  function
	      as  in  tcp_read,	 specifying  a	per-read  or  overall timeout,
	      respectively, in seconds, as an integer or  floating-point  num‐
	      ber.   As	 tcp_read,  the function returns status 2 if a timeout
	      occurs.

	      The function returns as soon as any one of  the  patterns	 given
	      match.   If  the	caller	needs  to  know	 which of the patterns
	      matched, the option -p var can be used; on return, $var  is  set
	      to  the  number of the pattern using ordinary zsh indexing, i.e.
	      the first is 1, and so on.  Note the absence of a `$'  in	 front
	      of  var.	 To  avoid  clashes,  the  parameter cannot begin with
	      `_expect'.

	      The option -q is passed directly down to tcp_read.

	      As all input is done via tcp_read, all  the  usual  rules	 about
	      output of lines read apply.  One exception is that the parameter
	      $tcp_lines will  only  reflect  the  line	 actually  matched  by
	      tcp_expect; use $tcp_expect_lines for the full set of lines read
	      during the function call.

       tcp_proxy
	      This is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection  and
	      execute  a  command  with	 I/O  redirected  to  the  connection.
	      Extreme caution should be taken as there is no security  whatso‐
	      ever  and	 this can leave your computer open to the world.  Ide‐
	      ally, it should only be used behind a firewall.

	      The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will lis‐
	      ten.

	      The remaining arguments give a command and its arguments to exe‐
	      cute with standard input, standard  output  and  standard	 error
	      redirected  to  the file descriptor on which the TCP session has
	      been accepted.  If no command is given, a new  zsh  is  started.
	      This  gives  everyone  on	 your  network	direct	access to your
	      account, which in many cases will be a bad thing.

	      The command is run in the	 background,  so  tcp_proxy  can  then
	      accept  new connections.	It continues to accept new connections
	      until interrupted.

       tcp_spam [-ertv] [ -a | -s  sess | -l sess,... ] cmd ...
	      Execute `cmd ...' for each session in turn.  Note this  executes
	      the  command and arguments; it does not send the command line as
	      data unless the -t (transmit) option is given.

	      The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard -a, -s
	      or  -l  options,	or  may	 be chosen implicitly.	If none of the
	      three options is given  the  rules  are:	first,	if  the	 array
	      $tcp_spam_list  is  set,	this is taken as the list of sessions,
	      otherwise all sessions are taken.	 Second, any sessions given in
	      the  array  $tcp_no_spam_list  are removed from the list of ses‐
	      sions.

	      Normally, any sessions added by the `-a' flag or when  all  ses‐
	      sions  are  chosen  implicitly  are spammed in alphabetic order;
	      sessions given by the $tcp_spam_list array  or  on  the  command
	      line  are	 spammed in the order given.  The -r flag reverses the
	      order however it was arrived it.

	      The -v flag specifies that a $TCP_PROMPT will be	output	before
	      each session.  This is output after any modification to TCP_SESS
	      by  the  user-defined  tcp_on_spam  function  described	below.
	      (Obviously that function is able to generate its own output.)

	      If  the  option -e is present, the line given as cmd ... is exe‐
	      cuted using eval, otherwise it is executed without  any  further
	      processing.

       tcp_talk
	      This  is	a  fairly  simple-minded attempt to force input to the
	      line editor to go straight to the default TCP_SESSION.

	      An escape string, $TCP_TALK_ESCAPE,  default  `:',  is  used  to
	      allow  access to normal shell operation.	If it is on its own at
	      the start of the line, or followed only by whitespace, the  line
	      editor  returns  to normal operation.  Otherwise, the string and
	      any following whitespace are skipped and the  remainder  of  the
	      line executed as shell input without any change of the line edi‐
	      tor's operating mode.

	      The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of use
	      of the command history.  For this reason, many users will prefer
	      to use some form of alternative approach for sending data easily
	      to  the  current	session.  One simple approach is to alias some
	      special character (such as `%') to `tcp_command --'.

       tcp_wait
	      The sole argument is an integer or floating point	 number	 which
	      gives  the seconds to delay.  The shell will do nothing for that
	      period except wait for input on  all  TCP	 sessions  by  calling
	      tcp_read	-a.   This  is similar to the interactive behaviour at
	      the command prompt when zle handlers are installed.

   `One-shot' file transfer
       tcp_point port
       tcp_shoot host port
	      This pair of functions provide a simple way to transfer  a  file
	      between  two  hosts  within the shell.  Note, however, that bulk
	      data transfer is currently done using cat.  tcp_point reads  any
	      data arriving at port and sends it to standard output; tcp_shoot
	      connects to port on host and  sends  its	standard  input.   Any
	      unused  port  may	 be used; the standard mechanism for picking a
	      port is to think of a random four-digit number above 1024	 until
	      one works.

	      To  transfer  a  file  from  host	 woodcock to host springes, on
	      springes:

		     tcp_point 8091 >output_file

	      and on woodcock:

		     tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file

	      As these two functions do not require tcp_open to set up	a  TCP
	      connection first, they may need to be autoloaded separately.

TCP USER-DEFINED FUNCTIONS
       Certain	functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the func‐
       tion system in certain contexts.	 This facility depends on  the	module
       zsh/parameter,  which is usually available in interactive shells as the
       completion system depends  on  it.   None  of  the  functions  need  be
       defined; they simply provide convenient hooks when necessary.

       Typically,  these are called after the requested action has been taken,
       so that the various parameters will reflect the new state.

       tcp_on_alias alias fd
	      When an alias is defined, this function will be called with  two
	      arguments: the name of the alias, and the file descriptor of the
	      corresponding session.

       tcp_on_awol sess fd
	      If the function tcp_fd_handler is handling input from  the  line
	      editor  and  detects that the file descriptor is no longer reus‐
	      able, by default it removes it from the list of file descriptors
	      handled  by  this	 method and prints a message.  If the function
	      tcp_on_awol is defined it	 is  called  immediately  before  this
	      point.   It may return status 100, which indicates that the nor‐
	      mal handling should still be performed; any other return	status
	      indicates	 that  no  further  action  should  be	taken  and the
	      tcp_fd_handler should return immediately with the given  status.
	      Typically	 the  action  of tcp_on_awol will be to close the ses‐
	      sion.

	      The variable TCP_INVALIDATE_ZLE will be a non-empty string if it
	      is  necessary  to	 invalidate the line editor display using `zle
	      -I' before printing output from the function.

	      (`AWOL' is military jargon for `absent without  leave'  or  some
	      variation.   It  has  no pre-existing technical meaning known to
	      the author.)

       tcp_on_close sess fd
	      This is called with the name of a session being closed  and  the
	      file  descriptor	which corresponded to that session.  Both will
	      be invalid by the time the function is called.

       tcp_on_open sess fd
	      This is called after a new session has  been  defined  with  the
	      session  name and file descriptor as arguments.  If it returns a
	      non-zero status, opening the session is assumed to fail and  the
	      session  is  closed  again;  however,  tcp_open will continue to
	      attempt to open any remaining  sessions  given  on  the  command
	      line.

       tcp_on_rename oldsess fd newsess
	      This  is	called after a session has been renamed with the three
	      arguments old session name, file descriptor, new session name.

       tcp_on_spam sess command ...
	      This is called once for each session spammed, just before a com‐
	      mand  is	executed for a session by tcp_spam.  The arguments are
	      the session name followed by the command list  to	 be  executed.
	      If  tcp_spam  was	 called	 with the option -t, the first command
	      will be tcp_send.

	      This function is called after $TCP_SESS is set  to  reflect  the
	      session  to be spammed, but before any use of it is made.	 Hence
	      it is possible to alter the value of $TCP_SESS within this func‐
	      tion.   For  example,  the  session  arguments to tcp_spam could
	      include extra information to be stripped off  and	 processed  in
	      tcp_on_spam.

	      If the function sets the parameter $REPLY to `done', the command
	      line is not executed; in addition, no prompt is printed for  the
	      -v option to tcp_spam.

       tcp_on_unalias alias fd
	      This  is	called with the name of an alias and the corresponding
	      session's file descriptor after an alias has been deleted.

TCP UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       The following functions are used by the TCP function  system  but  will
       rarely if ever need to be called directly.

       tcp_fd_handler
	      This  is	the  function installed by tcp_open for handling input
	      from within the line editor, if that is required.	 It is in  the
	      format documented for the builtin `zle -F' in zshzle(1) .

	      While active, the function sets the parameter TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
	      to 1.  This allows shell code called internally (for example, by
	      setting  tcp_on_read)  to tell if is being called when the shell
	      is otherwise idle at the editor prompt.

       tcp_output [ -q ] -P prompt -F fd -S sess
	      This function is used for both logging and  handling  output  to
	      standard	output,	 from  within  tcp_read and (if $TCP_OUTPUT is
	      set) tcp_send.

	      The prompt to use is specified by -P; the default is  the	 empty
	      string.  It can contain:
	      %c     Expands  to 1 if the session is the current session, oth‐
		     erwise  0.	  Used	with  ternary  expressions   such   as
		     `%(c.-.+)'	 to output `+' for the current session and `-'
		     otherwise.

	      %f     Replaced by the session's file descriptor.

	      %s     Replaced by the session name.

	      %%     Replaced by a single `%'.

	      The option -q suppresses output to standard output, but  not  to
	      any log files which are configured.

	      The  -S  and -F options are used to pass in the session name and
	      file descriptor for possible replacement in the prompt.

TCP USER PARAMETERS
       Parameters follow the usual  convention	that  uppercase	 is  used  for
       scalars	and  integers, while lowercase is used for normal and associa‐
       tive array.  It is always safe for user code to read these  parameters.
       Some  parameters	 may  also be set; these are noted explicitly.	Others
       are included in this group as they are set by the function  system  for
       the  user's  benefit,  i.e. setting them is typically not useful but is
       benign.

       It is often also useful to make settable parameters local  to  a	 func‐
       tion.   For example, `local TCP_SILENT=1' specifies that data read dur‐
       ing the function call will not be printed to standard  output,  regard‐
       less   of   the	 setting   outside  the	 function.   Likewise,	`local
       TCP_SESS=sess' sets a session for  the  duration	 of  a	function,  and
       `local  TCP_PROMPT='  specifies that no prompt is used for input during
       the function.

       tcp_expect_lines
	      Array.   The  set	 of  lines  read  during  the  last  call   to
	      tcp_expect, including the last ($TCP_LINE).

       tcp_filter
	      Array. May be set directly.  A set of extended globbing patterns
	      which, if matched in tcp_output, will cause the line not	to  be
	      printed  to  standard output.  The patterns should be defined as
	      described for the arguments to tcp_expect.  Output  of  line  to
	      log files is not affected.

       TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
	      Scalar.  Set to 1 within tcp_fd_handler to indicate to functions
	      called recursively that they have been called during  an	editor
	      session.	Otherwise unset.

       TCP_LINE
	      The last line read by tcp_read, and hence also tcp_expect.

       TCP_LINE_FD
	      The   file   descriptor	from   which   $TCP_LINE   was	 read.
	      ${tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]} will give the	corresponding  session
	      name.

       tcp_lines
	      Array.  The  set of lines read during the last call to tcp_read,
	      including the last ($TCP_LINE).

       TCP_LOG
	      May be set directly, although it is also controlled by  tcp_log.
	      The  name	 of  a	file to which output from all sessions will be
	      sent.  The output is proceeded by the usual $TCP_PROMPT.	If  it
	      is  not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's current
	      directory.

       TCP_LOG_SESS
	      May be set directly, although it is also controlled by  tcp_log.
	      The  prefix for a set of files to which output from each session
	      separately   will	  be	sent;	 the	full	filename    is
	      ${TCP_LOG_SESS}.sess.   Output to each file is raw; no prompt is
	      added.  If it is not an absolute path name, it will  follow  the
	      user's current directory.

       tcp_no_spam_list
	      Array.  May be set directly.  See tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_OUTPUT
	      May  be set directly.  If a non-empty string, any data sent to a
	      session by tcp_send will be logged.  This	 parameter  gives  the
	      prompt  to  be used in a file specified by $TCP_LOG but not in a
	      file generated from $TCP_LOG_SESS.  The prompt  string  has  the
	      same format as TCP_PROMPT and the same rules for its use apply.

       TCP_PROMPT
	      May  be  set  directly.	Used  as  the  prefix for data read by
	      tcp_read which is printed to standard output or to the log  file
	      given  by $TCP_LOG, if any.  Any `%s', `%f' or `%%' occurring in
	      the string will be replaced by the name of the session, the ses‐
	      sion's  underlying  file	descriptor,  or	 a single `%', respec‐
	      tively.  The expression `%c' expands to 1 if the	session	 being
	      read  is	the  current  session,	else 0; this is most useful in
	      ternary expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' which outputs `+' if  the
	      session is the current one, else `-'.

       TCP_READ_DEBUG
	      May be set directly.  If this has non-zero length, tcp_read will
	      give some limited diagnostics about data being read.

       TCP_SECONDS_START
	      This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.

	      The functions tcp_read and tcp_expect use	 the  shell's  SECONDS
	      parameter	 for  their own timing purposes.  If that parameter is
	      not of floating point type on entry to one of the functions,  it
	      will  create  a  local parameter SECONDS which is floating point
	      and set the parameter TCP_SECONDS_START to the previous value of
	      $SECONDS.	  If  the  parameter  is already floating point, it is
	      used without a local copy being created and TCP_SECONDS_START is
	      not set.	As the global value is zero, the shell elapsed time is
	      guaranteed to be the sum of $SECONDS and $TCP_SECONDS_START.

	      This can be avoided by setting SECONDS globally  to  a  floating
	      point  value  using `typeset -F SECONDS'; then the TCP functions
	      will never make a local copy and never set TCP_SECONDS_START  to
	      a non-zero value.

       TCP_SESS
	      May  be set directly.  The current session; must refer to one of
	      the sessions established by tcp_open.

       TCP_SILENT
	      May be set directly, although it is also controlled by  tcp_log.
	      If of non-zero length, data read by tcp_read will not be written
	      to standard output, though may still be written to a log file.

       tcp_spam_list
	      Array.  May be set directly.  See the description of  the	 func‐
	      tion tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_TALK_ESCAPE
	      May  be  set  directly.	See  the  description  of the function
	      tcp_talk for how this is used.

       TCP_TIMEOUT
	      May be set directly.  Currently this is only used by  the	 func‐
	      tion tcp_command, see above.

TCP USER-DEFINED PARAMETERS
       The following parameters are not set by the function system, but have a
       special effect if set by the user.

       tcp_on_read
	      This should be an associative array; if it is not, the behaviour
	      is undefined.  Each key is the name of a shell function or other
	      command, and the corresponding value is a shell  pattern	(using
	      EXTENDED_GLOB).	Every line read from a TCP session directly or
	      indirectly  using	 tcp_read  (which  includes  lines   read   by
	      tcp_expect)  is  compared	 against  the  pattern.	  If  the line
	      matches, the command given in the key is called with  two	 argu‐
	      ments: the name of the session from which the line was read, and
	      the line itself.

	      If any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero  sta‐
	      tus,  the	 line  is not output.  Thus a tcp_on_read handler con‐
	      taining only the instruction `return 1' can be used to  suppress
	      output  of  particular  lines  (see, however, tcp_filter above).
	      However, the line is still stored	 in  TCP_LINE  and  tcp_lines;
	      this occurs after all tcp_on_read processing.

TCP UTILITY PARAMETERS
       These  parameters  are  controlled  by the function system; they may be
       read directly, but should not usually be set by user code.

       tcp_aliases
	      Associative array.  The keys are the names  of  sessions	estab‐
	      lished  with  tcp_open;  each value is a space-separated list of
	      aliases which refer to that session.

       tcp_by_fd
	      Associative array.  The keys are session file descriptors;  each
	      value is the name of that session.

       tcp_by_name
	      Associative  array.   The	 keys  are the names of sessions; each
	      value is the file descriptor associated with that session.

TCP EXAMPLES
       Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.

       TO create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the dc manual page  for
       quite how infuriating the underlying command is):

	      tcp_proxy 7337 dc

       To connect to this from the same host with a session also named `dc':

	      tcp_open localhost 7337 dc

       To send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for out‐
       put (assuming dc is the current session):

	      tcp_command 2 4 + p

       To close the session:

	      tcp_close

       The tcp_proxy needs to be killed to be stopped.	 Note  this  will  not
       usually kill any connections which have already been accepted, and also
       that the port is not immediately available for reuse.

       The following chunk of code puts a  list	 of  sessions  into  an	 xterm
       header, with the current session followed by a star.

	      print -n "\033]2;TCP:" ${(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*} "\a"

TCP BUGS
       The  function  tcp_read	uses the shell's normal read builtin.  As this
       reads a complete line at once, data arriving without a terminating new‐
       line can cause the function to block indefinitely.

       Though  the  function suite works well for interactive use and for data
       arriving in small amounts, the performance when large amounts  of  data
       are being exchanged is likely to be extremely poor.

ZSHZFTPSYS(1)							 ZSHZFTPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshzftpsys - zftp function front-end

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the set of shell functions supplied with the source dis‐
       tribution as an interface to the zftp builtin command, allowing you  to
       perform	FTP operations from the shell command line or within functions
       or scripts.  The interface is similar to a traditional FTP client (e.g.
       the  ftp command itself, see ftp(1)), but as it is entirely done within
       the shell all the familiar completion, editing and  globbing  features,
       and  so on, are present, and macros are particularly simple to write as
       they are just ordinary shell functions.

       The prerequisite is that the zftp  command,  as	described  in  zshmod‐
       ules(1)	,  must	 be  available in the version of zsh installed at your
       site.  If the shell is configured to load new commands at run time,  it
       probably	 is:  typing  `zmodload zsh/zftp' will make sure (if that runs
       silently, it has worked).  If this is not the case, it is possible zftp
       was  linked  into the shell anyway: to test this, type `which zftp' and
       if zftp is available you will get the  message  `zftp:  shell  built-in
       command'.

       Commands	 given	directly with zftp builtin may be interspersed between
       the functions in this suite; in a few cases, using  zftp	 directly  may
       cause  some  of	the  status  information stored in shell parameters to
       become invalid.	Note in particular the description  of	the  variables
       $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.

INSTALLATION
       You  should  make sure all the functions from the Functions/Zftp direc‐
       tory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with  the
       two letters `zf'.  They may already have been installed on your system;
       otherwise, you will need to find them and  copy	them.	The  directory
       should  appear  as one of the elements of the $fpath array (this should
       already be the case if they were installed), and at least the  function
       zfinit  should  be  autoloaded; it will autoload the rest.  Finally, to
       initialize the use of the system you need to call the zfinit  function.
       The  following  code  in	 your .zshrc will arrange for this; assume the
       functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
	      autoload -U zfinit
	      zfinit

       Note that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load  the
       zftp  command.  If it is already built into the shell, change zfinit to
       zfinit -n.  It is helpful (though not essential) if the call to	zfinit
       appears	after  any  code to initialize the new completion system, else
       unnecessary compctl commands will be given.

FUNCTIONS
       The sequence of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially
       the  same  as that in a standard FTP client.  Note that, due to a quirk
       of the shell's getopts builtin, for those functions that handle options
       you must use `--' rather than `-' to ensure the remaining arguments are
       treated literally (a single `-' is treated as an argument).

   Opening a connection
       zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]
	      Set or show the parameters for a future  zfopen  with  no	 argu‐
	      ments.   If  no  arguments are given, the current parameters are
	      displayed (the password will be shown as a line  of  asterisks).
	      If a host is given, and either the user or password is not, they
	      will be prompted for; also, any parameter given as `?'  will  be
	      prompted	for, and if the `?' is followed by a string, that will
	      be used as the prompt.  As zfopen calls zfparams	to  store  the
	      parameters, this usually need not be called directly.

	      A	 single	 argument `-' will delete the stored parameters.  This
	      will also cause the memory of the last directory (and so on)  on
	      the other host to be deleted.

       zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
	      If  host	is present, open a connection to that host under user‐
	      name user with password password (and,  on  the  rare  occasions
	      when  it is necessary, account account).	If a necessary parame‐
	      ter is missing or given as `?' it will be prompted for.  If host
	      is not present, use a previously stored set of parameters.

	      If  the  command	was successful, and the terminal is compatible
	      with xterm or is sun-cmd, a summary will	appear	in  the	 title
	      bar,  giving the local host:directory and the remote host:direc‐
	      tory; this is handled  by	 the  function	zftp_chpwd,  described
	      below.

	      Normally,	 the  host,  user and password are internally recorded
	      for later re-opening, either by a zfopen with no	arguments,  or
	      automatically (see below).  With the option `-1', no information
	      is stored.  Also, if an open command with arguments failed,  the
	      parameters  will	not  be	 retained (and any previous parameters
	      will also be deleted).  A zfopen on its own,  or	a  zfopen  -1,
	      never alters the stored parameters.

	      Both zfopen and zfanon (but not zfparams) understand URLs of the
	      form ftp://host/path... as meaning to connect to the host,  then
	      change  directory	 to  path  (which  must	 be a directory, not a
	      file).  The `ftp://' can be omitted; the trailing `/' is	enough
	      to  trigger  recognition	of the path.  Note prefixes other than
	      `ftp:' are not recognized, and that  all	characters  after  the
	      first slash beyond host are significant in path.

       zfanon [ -1 ] host
	      Open  a connection host for anonymous FTP.  The username used is
	      `anonymous'.  The password (which will  be  reported  the	 first
	      time)  is	 generated  as	user@host;  this is then stored in the
	      shell parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manu‐
	      ally to a suitable string.

   Directory management
       zfcd [ dir ]
       zfcd -
       zfcd old new
	      Change  the  current  directory  on  the remote server:  this is
	      implemented to have many of the features of  the	shell  builtin
	      cd.

	      In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir.
	      The command `zfcd ..' is treated specially, so is guaranteed  to
	      work  on	non-UNIX  servers  (note this is handled internally by
	      zftp).  If dir is omitted, has the effect of `zfcd ~'.

	      The second form changes to the directory previously current.

	      The third form attempts  to  change  the	current	 directory  by
	      replacing the first occurrence of the string old with the string
	      new in the current directory.

	      Note that in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename
	      is  expected,  the string which on the local host corresponds to
	      `~' is converted back to a `~' before being passed to the remote
	      machine.	 This  is  convenient  because of the way expansion is
	      performed on the command line before  zfcd  receives  a  string.
	      For  example,  suppose  the  command is `zfcd ~/foo'.  The shell
	      will   expand   this   to	  a   full   path   such   as	 `zfcd
	      /home/user2/pws/foo'.   At  this stage, zfcd recognises the ini‐
	      tial path as corresponding to `~' and will send the directory to
	      the  remote  host	 as ~/foo, so that the `~' will be expanded by
	      the server to the correct remote host  directory.	  Other	 named
	      directories of the form `~name' are not treated in this fashion.

       zfhere Change  directory	 on the remote server to the one corresponding
	      to the current local directory, with special handling of `~'  as
	      in  zfcd.	  For  example,	 if  the  current  local  directory is
	      ~/foo/bar, then zfhere performs the effect of `zfcd ~/foo/bar'.

       zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]
	      Produce a long directory listing.	 The arguments dir-options and
	      dir are passed directly to the server and their effect is imple‐
	      mentation dependent, but specifying a particular	remote	direc‐
	      tory  dir	 is  usually possible.	The output is passed through a
	      pager given by the environment variable  $PAGER,	or  `more'  if
	      that is not set.

	      The directory is usually cached for re-use.  In fact, two caches
	      are maintained.  One is for use when there is no dir-options  or
	      dir,  i.e. a full listing of the current remote directory; it is
	      flushed when the current remote directory changes.  The other is
	      kept  for	 repeated  use	of  zfdir with the same arguments; for
	      example, repeated use of `zfdir /pub/gnu' will only require  the
	      directory	 to  be	 retrieved  on the first call.	Alternatively,
	      this cache can be re-viewed with the  -r	option.	  As  relative
	      directories  will	 confuse  zfdir,  the -f option can be used to
	      force the cache to be flushed before the	directory  is  listed.
	      The  option  -d will delete both caches without showing a direc‐
	      tory listing; it will also delete the cache of file names in the
	      current remote directory, if any.

       zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]
	      List  files  on the remote server.  With no arguments, this will
	      produce a simple list of	file  names  for  the  current	remote
	      directory.  Any arguments are passed directly to the server.  No
	      pager and no caching is used.

   Status commands
       zftype [ type ]
	      With no arguments, show the type of data to be transferred, usu‐
	      ally  ASCII  or  binary.	With an argument, change the type: the
	      types `A' or `ASCII' for ASCII data and `B' or `BINARY', `I'  or
	      `IMAGE' for binary data are understood case-insensitively.

       zfstat [ -v ]
	      Show  the	 status	 of the current or last connection, as well as
	      the status of some of zftp's  status  variables.	 With  the  -v
	      option,  a  more	verbose	 listing  is  produced by querying the
	      server for its version of events, too.

   Retrieving files
       The commands for retrieving files all take at  least  two  options.  -G
       suppresses remote filename expansion which would otherwise be performed
       (see below for a more detailed description of that).   -t  attempts  to
       set the modification time of the local file to that of the remote file:
       see the description of the function zfrtime below for more information.

       zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...
	      Retrieve all the listed files file1 ... one at a time  from  the
	      remote  server.	If  a  file  contains  a `/', the full name is
	      passed to the remote server, but	the  file  is  stored  locally
	      under  the  name	given  by  the	part after the final `/'.  The
	      option -c (cat) forces all files to be sent as a	single	stream
	      to standard output; in this case the -t option has no effect.

       zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...
	      As  zfget,  but  only  retrieve  files  where the version on the
	      remote server is newer (has a later modification time), or where
	      the  local file does not exist.  If the remote file is older but
	      the files have different sizes, or if the sizes are the same but
	      the  remote  file	 is  newer,  the user will usually be queried.
	      With the option -s, the command runs silently  and  will	always
	      retrieve the file in either of those two cases.  With the option
	      -v, the command prints more information about the files while it
	      is working out whether or not to transfer them.

       zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...
	      As  zfget,  but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter
	      than the corresponding remote file, the command assumes that  it
	      is  the result of a partially completed transfer and attempts to
	      transfer the rest of the file.  This is useful on a poor connec‐
	      tion which keeps failing.

	      Note  that  this	requires a commonly implemented, but non-stan‐
	      dard, version of the FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to  work
	      on all servers.

       zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file
       zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir
	      This  retrieves  files  from  the	 remote	 server with arguments
	      behaving similarly to the cp command.

	      In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local
	      file local-file.

	      In  the  second  form, copy all the remote files rfile1 ... into
	      the local directory ldir retaining  the  same  basenames.	  This
	      assumes UNIX directory semantics.

   Sending files
       zfput [ -r ] file1 ...
	      Send  all	 the  file1 ... given separately to the remote server.
	      If a filename contains a `/', the full filename is used  locally
	      to  find	the file, but only the basename is used for the remote
	      file name.

	      With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are
	      sent  recursively with all their subdirectories, including files
	      beginning with `.'.   This  requires  that  the  remote  machine
	      understand UNIX file semantics, since `/' is used as a directory
	      separator.

       zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...
	      As zfput, but only send files which are newer than  their	 local
	      equivalents, or if the remote file does not exist.  The logic is
	      the same as for zfuget, but reversed between  local  and	remote
	      files.

       zfcput file1 ...
	      As  zfput,  but if any remote file already exists and is shorter
	      than the local equivalent, assume it is the result of an	incom‐
	      plete  transfer  and  send the rest of the file to append to the
	      existing part.  As the FTP append command is part of  the	 stan‐
	      dard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.

       zfpcp local-file remote-file
       zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir
	      This  sends  files  to the remote server with arguments behaving
	      similarly to the cp command.

	      With  two	 arguments,  copy  local-file	to   the   server   as
	      remote-file.

	      With  more  than	two arguments, copy all the local files lfile1
	      ... into the existing remote directory rdir retaining  the  same
	      basenames.  This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

	      A	 problem  arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1 rdir, i.e.
	      the second form of copying but with two arguments, as  the  com‐
	      mand  has	 no  simple  way  of  knowing if rdir corresponds to a
	      directory or a filename.	It attempts to resolve this in various
	      ways.   First,  if the rdir argument is `.' or `..' or ends in a
	      slash, it is assumed to be a directory.  Secondly, if the opera‐
	      tion  of	copying to a remote file in the first form failed, and
	      the remote server sends back the expected failure code 553 and a
	      reply  including	the  string  `Is a directory', then zfpcp will
	      retry using the second form.

   Closing the connection
       zfclose
	      Close the connection.

   Session management
       zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]
	      Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once.  By default,
	      connections  take place in a session called `default'; by giving
	      the command `zfsession sessname' you can	change	to  a  new  or
	      existing	session	 with  a name of your choice.  The new session
	      remembers its own connection, as well as associated shell param‐
	      eters, and also the host/user parameters set by zfparams.	 Hence
	      you can have different sessions set up to connect	 to  different
	      hosts, each remembering the appropriate host, user and password.

	      With no arguments, zfsession prints the name of the current ses‐
	      sion; with the option -l it lists all sessions  which  currently
	      exist,  and  with	 the option -v it gives a verbose list showing
	      the host and directory for each session, where the current  ses‐
	      sion is marked with an asterisk.	With -o, it will switch to the
	      most recent previous session.

	      With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed;
	      everything to do with it is completely forgotten.	 If it was the
	      only session, a new session called `default' is created and made
	      current.	 It  is safest not to delete sessions while background
	      commands using zftp are active.

       zftransfer sess1:file1 sess2:file2
	      Transfer files between two sessions; no local copy is made.  The
	      file is read from the session sess1 as file1 and written to ses‐
	      sion sess2 as file file2; file1 and file2 may be relative to the
	      current  directories  of the session.  Either sess1 or sess2 may
	      be omitted (though the colon should be retained if  there	 is  a
	      possibility  of a colon appearing in the file name) and defaults
	      to the current session; file2 may be omitted or may end  with  a
	      slash,  in  which case the basename of file1 will be added.  The
	      sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.

	      The operation is performed using pipes, so it is	required  that
	      the  connections	still be valid in a subshell, which is not the
	      case under versions of some operating systems, presumably due to
	      a system bug.

   Bookmarks
       The two functions zfmark and zfgoto allow you to `bookmark' the present
       location (host, user and directory) of the current FTP  connection  for
       later use.  The file to be used for storing and retrieving bookmarks is
       given by the parameter $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when  one  of  the  two
       functions  is  called,  it  will	 be  set to the file .zfbkmarks in the
       directory where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).

       zfmark [ bookmark ]
	      If given an argument, mark the current host, user and  directory
	      under the name bookmark for later use by zfgoto.	If there is no
	      connection open, use the values for the last connection  immedi‐
	      ately  before  it	 was closed; it is an error if there was none.
	      Any existing bookmark under  the	same  name  will  be  silently
	      replaced.

	      If  not  given  an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the
	      points to which they refer in the form user@host:directory; this
	      is  the  format  in  which  they are stored, and the file may be
	      edited directly.

       zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark
	      Return to the location given by bookmark, as previously  set  by
	      zfmark.  If the location has user `ftp' or `anonymous', open the
	      connection with zfanon, so that no password is required.	If the
	      user and host parameters match those stored for the current ses‐
	      sion, if any, those will be  used,  and  again  no  password  is
	      required.	 Otherwise a password will be prompted for.

	      With  the	 option	 -n,  the  bookmark  is taken to be a nickname
	      stored by the ncftp program  in  its  bookmark  file,  which  is
	      assumed  to  be  ~/.ncftp/bookmarks.  The function works identi‐
	      cally in other ways.  Note that there is no mechanism for adding
	      or modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp functions.

   Other functions
       Mostly,	these  functions  will	not  be	 called	 directly  (apart from
       zfinit), but are described here for  completeness.   You	 may  wish  to
       alter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.

       zfinit [ -n ]
	      As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function
	      system.  The -n option should be used if	the  zftp  command  is
	      already built into the shell.

       zfautocheck [ -dn ]
	      This  function is called to implement automatic reopening behav‐
	      iour, as described in  more  detail  below.   The	 options  must
	      appear  in  the  first  argument;	 -n  prevents the command from
	      changing to the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting
	      the  variable  do_close,	which  it otherwise does as a flag for
	      automatically closing the connection after a transfer.  The host
	      and  directory  for  the last session are stored in the variable
	      $zflastsession, but the internal	host/user/password  parameters
	      must also be correctly set.

       zfcd_match prefix suffix
	      This performs matching for completion of remote directory names.
	      If the remote server is UNIX, it will attempt  to	 persuade  the
	      server  to list the remote directory with subdirectories marked,
	      which usually works but is not guaranteed.  On  other  hosts  it
	      simply calls zfget_match and hence completes all files, not just
	      directories.  On some systems, directories  may  not  even  look
	      like filenames.

       zfget_match prefix suffix
	      This  performs  matching for completion of remote filenames.  It
	      caches files for the  current  directory	(only)	in  the	 shell
	      parameter	 $zftp_fcache.	 It is in the form to be called by the
	      -K option of compctl, but also works when	 called	 from  a  wid‐
	      get-style	 completion function with prefix and suffix set appro‐
	      priately.

       zfrglob varname
	      Perform remote globbing, as  describes  in  more	detail	below.
	      varname  is  the name of a variable containing the pattern to be
	      expanded; if there were any matches, the same variable  will  be
	      set to the expanded set of filenames on return.

       zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]
	      Set  the	local file lfile to have the same modification time as
	      the remote file rfile, or the explicit time time in  FTP	format
	      CCYYMMDDhhmmSS  for  the	GMT  timezone.	 This uses the shell's
	      zsh/datetime module to perform the conversion from GMT to	 local
	      time.

       zftp_chpwd
	      This  function  is  called every time a connection is opened, or
	      closed, or the remote directory changes.	 This  version	alters
	      the  title bar of an xterm-compatible or sun-cmd terminal emula‐
	      tor to reflect the local and remote hostnames and current direc‐
	      tories.	It  works  best when combined with the function chpwd.
	      In particular, a function of the form

		     chpwd() {
		       if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
			 zftp_chpwd
		       else
			 # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
		       fi
		     }

	      fits in well.

       zftp_progress
	      This function shows the status of the  transfer.	 It  will  not
	      write  anything  unless  the output is going to a terminal; how‐
	      ever, if you transfer files in the background, you  should  turn
	      off  progress  reports  by hand using `zstyle ':zftp:*' progress
	      none'.  Note also that if you alter it, any output  must	be  to
	      standard error, as standard output may be a file being received.
	      The form of the progress meter, or whether it is	used  at  all,
	      can be configured without altering the function, as described in
	      the next section.

       zffcache
	      This is used to implement caching of files in the current direc‐
	      tory for each session separately.	 It is used by zfget_match and
	      zfrglob.

MISCELLANEOUS FEATURES
   Configuration
       Various styles are available using the standard shell style  mechanism,
       described  in  zshmodules(1).  Briefly,	the  command `zstyle ':zftp:*'
       style value ...'.  defines the style to have value value; more than one
       value  may be given, although that is not useful in the cases described
       here.  These values will then be used throughout the zftp function sys‐
       tem.   For more precise control, the first argument, which gives a con‐
       text in which the style applies, can be modified to include a  particu‐
       lar  function,  as  for example `:zftp:zfget': the style will then have
       the given value only in the zfget function.  Values for the same	 style
       in  different  contexts	may be set; the most specific function will be
       used, where strings are held to be more	specific  than	patterns,  and
       longer  patterns	 and  shorter  patterns.  Note that only the top level
       function name, as called by the user, is used; calling of  lower	 level
       functions is transparent to the user.  Hence modifications to the title
       bar in zftp_chpwd use  the  contexts  :zftp:zfopen,  :zftp:zfcd,	 etc.,
       depending  where	 it  was called from.  The following styles are under‐
       stood:

       progress
	      Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the progress of a
	      transfer.	  If  empty,  unset,  or `none', no progress report is
	      made; if `bar' a growing bar of inverse video is shown; if `per‐
	      cent'  (or  any other string, though this may change in future),
	      the percentage of the file transferred is shown.	The bar	 meter
	      requires	that  the  width  of the terminal be available via the
	      $COLUMNS parameter (normally this is set automatically).	If the
	      size  of	the  file  being transferred is not available, bar and
	      percent meters will simply show the number of bytes  transferred
	      so far.

	      When zfinit is run, if this style is not defined for the context
	      :zftp:*, it will be set to `bar'.

       update Specifies the minimum  time  interval  between  updates  of  the
	      progress	meter  in  seconds.  No update is made unless new data
	      has been received, so the actual time interval is	 limited  only
	      by $ZFTP_TIMEOUT.

	      As  described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to
	      1.

       remote-glob
	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', filename	generation  (globbing)
	      is performed on the remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see
	      below.

       titlebar
	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will put  the	remote
	      host  and	 remote directory into the titlebar of terminal emula‐
	      tors such as xterm or sun-cmd that allow this.

	      As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default  to
	      1.

       chpwd  If set to `1' `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will call the function
	      chpwd when a connection is closed.  This is useful if the remote
	      host  details were put into the terminal title bar by zftp_chpwd
	      and your usual chpwd also modifies the title bar.

	      When zfinit is run, it will determine whether chpwd  exists  and
	      if  so  it will set the default value for the style to 1 if none
	      exists already.

       Note that there is also an associative array  zfconfig  which  contains
       values  used  by	 the  function system.	This should not be modified or
       overwritten.

   Remote globbing
       The commands for retrieving files usually perform  filename  generation
       (globbing)  on  their  arguments; this can be turned off by passing the
       option -G to each of the commands.  Normally this operates by  retriev‐
       ing a complete list of files for the directory in question, then match‐
       ing these locally against the pattern supplied.	This has the advantage
       that  the  full	range  of  zsh patterns (respecting the setting of the
       option EXTENDED_GLOB) can be used.  However, it means that  the	direc‐
       tory part of a filename will not be expanded and must be given exactly.
       If the remote server does not support  the  UNIX	 directory  semantics,
       directory  handling  is problematic and it is recommended that globbing
       only be used within the current directory.  The list of	files  in  the
       current	directory,  if	retrieved,  will be cached, so that subsequent
       globs in the same  directory  without  an  intervening  zfcd  are  much
       faster.

       If  the	remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead per‐
       formed on the remote host: the server is asked for a list  of  matching
       files.	This  is  highly  dependent  on how the server is implemented,
       though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic glob  pat‐
       terns.	This  may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the
       entire list of directory contents.

   Automatic and temporary reopening
       As described for the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no param‐
       eters  will  reopen the connection to the last host (this includes con‐
       nections made with the zfanon command).	Opened in  this	 fashion,  the
       connection  starts in the default remote directory and will remain open
       until explicitly closed.

       Automatic re-opening is also available.	If a connection	 is  not  cur‐
       rently  open  and  a  command requiring a connection is given, the last
       connection is implicitly reopened.  In this case	 the  directory	 which
       was  current  when  the connection was closed again becomes the current
       directory (unless, of course, the command given changes it).  Automatic
       reopening  will	also  take  place  if  the connection was close by the
       remote server for whatever reason (e.g. a timeout).  It is  not	avail‐
       able if the -1 option to zfopen or zfanon was used.

       Furthermore,  if	 the command issued is a file transfer, the connection
       will be closed after  the  transfer  is	finished,  hence  providing  a
       one-shot mode for transfers.  This does not apply to directory changing
       or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen  a  connection  but
       will  leave  it open.  Also, automatic closure will only ever happen in
       the same command as automatic opening, i.e a zfdir directly followed by
       a zfget will never close the connection automatically.

       Information  about the previous connection is given by the zfstat func‐
       tion.  So, for example, if that reports:

	      Session:	      default
	      Not connected.
	      Last session:   ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles

       then the command zfget file.txt will attempt to reopen a connection  to
       ftp.bar.com, retrieve the file /pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately
       close the connection again.  On the other hand, zfcd ..	will open  the
       connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.

       Note  that  all	the above is local to each session; if you return to a
       previous session, the connection for that session is the one which will
       be reopened.

   Completion
       Completion  of  local and remote files, directories, sessions and book‐
       marks is supported.  The older,	compctl-style  completion  is  defined
       when zfinit is called; support for the new widget-based completion sys‐
       tem is provided in  the	function  Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp,	 which
       should  be  installed with the other functions of the completion system
       and hence should automatically be available.

ZSHCONTRIB(1)							 ZSHCONTRIB(1)

NAME
       zshcontrib - user contributions to zsh

DESCRIPTION
       The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items  contributed  by
       the  user community.  These are not inherently a part of the shell, and
       some may not be available in every zsh installation.  The most signifi‐
       cant of these are documented here.  For documentation on other contrib‐
       uted items such as shell functions, look for comments in	 the  function
       source files.

UTILITIES
   Accessing On-Line Help
       The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help
       widget (see zshzle(1)).	This invokes the  run-help  command  with  the
       command	word from the current input line as its argument.  By default,
       run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often fails when  the
       command	word  is  a  shell  builtin  or	 a  user-defined function.  By
       redefining the run-help alias, one can improve the  on-line  help  pro‐
       vided by the shell.

       The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution,
       is a Perl program that can be used to process the zsh manual to produce
       a  separate  help  file for each shell builtin and for many other shell
       features as well.  The autoloadable run-help function, found  in	 Func‐
       tions/Misc,  searches  for  these  helpfiles and performs several other
       tests to produce the most complete help possible for the command.

       There may already be a directory of help files on your system; look  in
       /usr/share/zsh  or /usr/local/share/zsh and subdirectories below those,
       or ask your system administrator.

       To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a direc‐
       tory where the individual command help files will reside.  For example,
       you might choose ~/zsh_help.  If you unpacked the zsh  distribution  in
       your home directory, you would use the commands:

	      mkdir ~/zsh_help
	      cd ~/zsh_help
	      man zshall | colcrt - | \
	      perl ~/zsh-5.0.5/Util/helpfiles

       Next,  to  use  the  run-help function, you need to add lines something
       like the following to your .zshrc or equivalent startup file:

	      unalias run-help
	      autoload run-help
	      HELPDIR=~/zsh_help

       The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help	files.
       If your system already has a help file directory installed, set HELPDIR
       to the path of that directory instead.

       Note that in order for `autoload run-help' to work, the	run-help  file
       must  be	 in one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zsh‐
       param(1)).  This should already be the case if you have a standard  zsh
       installation;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/run-help to an appro‐
       priate directory.

   Recompiling Functions
       If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update  your
       zsh  installation  to  track the latest developments, you may find that
       function digests compiled with the zcompile builtin are frequently  out
       of date with respect to the function source files.  This is not usually
       a problem, because zsh always looks for the newest file when loading  a
       function,  but  it may cause slower shell startup and function loading.
       Also, if a digest file is explicitly used as an element of  fpath,  zsh
       won't check whether any of its source files has changed.

       The  zrecompile	autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be
       used to keep function digests up to date.

       zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]
       zrecompile [ -qt ] -p args [ -- args ... ]
	      This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them
	      if at least one of the original files is newer than the compiled
	      file.  This works only if the names stored in the compiled files
	      are  full	 paths	or are relative to the directory that contains
	      the .zwc file.

	      In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a
	      directory	 containing *.zwc files that should be checked.	 If no
	      arguments are given, the directories and *.zwc  files  in	 fpath
	      are used.

	      When -t is given, no compilation is performed, but a return sta‐
	      tus of zero (true) is set if there are files  that  need	to  be
	      re-compiled  and non-zero (false) otherwise.  The -q option qui‐
	      ets the chatty output that describes what zrecompile is doing.

	      Without the -t option, the return status is zero	if  all	 files
	      that  needed  re-compilation  could  be compiled and non-zero if
	      compilation for at least one of the files failed.

	      If the -p option is given, the args are interpreted  as  one  or
	      more  sets  of  arguments	 for zcompile, separated by `--'.  For
	      example:

		     zrecompile -p \
				-R ~/.zshrc -- \
				-M ~/.zcompdump -- \
				~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*

	      This compiles ~/.zshrc into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that	doesn't	 exist
	      or  if  it  is  older  than  ~/.zshrc. The compiled file will be
	      marked for reading instead of mapping.  The  same	 is  done  for
	      ~/.zcompdump  and	 ~/.zcompdump.zwc,  but	 this compiled file is
	      marked  for  mapping.  The  last	line   re-creates   the	  file
	      ~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of the files matching the given pattern is
	      newer than it.

	      Without the -p  option,  zrecompile  does	 not  create  function
	      digests that do not already exist, nor does it add new functions
	      to the digest.

       The following shell loop is an example of a method for  creating	 func‐
       tion  digests  for  all functions in your fpath, assuming that you have
       write permission to the directories:

	      for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
		dir=$fpath[i]
		zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
		if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
		  continue
		fi
		files=($dir/*(N-.))
		if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
		  files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
		  if ( cd $dir:h &&
		       zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
		    fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
		  fi
		fi
	      done

       The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default  zsh
       installation fpath; you may need to use different options for your per‐
       sonal function directories.

       Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer  to
       them,  you can keep them up to date by running zrecompile with no argu‐
       ments.

   Keyboard Definition
       The large number of possible combinations of  keyboards,	 workstations,
       terminals, emulators, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to
       have built-in key bindings for  every  situation.   The	zkbd  utility,
       found  in  Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create key bindings for
       your configuration.

       Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:

	      zsh -f ~/zsh-5.0.5/Functions/Misc/zkbd

       When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your  terminal  type;  if
       the  default it offers is correct, just press return.  It then asks you
       to press a number of different keys  to	determine  characteristics  of
       your  keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it finds anything out of
       the ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.

       The keystrokes read by zkbd are recorded as a definition for  an	 asso‐
       ciative	array  named  key, written to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd
       within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR directory.  The name of the file  is
       composed	 from  the  TERM,  VENDOR  and	OSTYPE	parameters,  joined by
       hyphens.

       You may read this file into your .zshrc or another  startup  file  with
       the `source' or `.' commands, then reference the key parameter in bind‐
       key commands, like this:

	      source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
	      [[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
	      [[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
	      # etc.

       Note that in order for `autoload zkbd' to work, the zkdb file  must  be
       in  one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).
       This should already be the case if you have a  standard	zsh  installa‐
       tion;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appropriate direc‐
       tory.

   Dumping Shell State
       Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in  the	shell,
       particularly  if	 you  are using a beta version of zsh or a development
       release.	 Usually it is sufficient to send a description of the problem
       to  one of the zsh mailing lists (see zsh(1)), but sometimes one of the
       zsh developers will need to recreate your environment in order to track
       the problem down.

       The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the distribu‐
       tion, is provided for this purpose.  (It is also possible  to  autoload
       reporter,  but  reporter	 is  not installed in fpath by default.)  This
       script outputs a detailed dump of the  shell  state,  in	 the  form  of
       another script that can be read with `zsh -f' to recreate that state.

       To  use	reporter, read the script into your shell with the `.' command
       and redirect the output into a file:

	      . ~/zsh-5.0.5/Util/reporter > zsh.report

       You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such
       as  passwords  and delete them by hand before sending the script to the
       developers.  Also, as the output can be voluminous, it's best  to  wait
       for the developers to ask for this information before sending it.

       You  can	 also  use  reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state.
       This is sometimes useful for creating startup files for the first time.
       Most  of	 the output from reporter is far more detailed than usually is
       necessary for a startup file, but the  aliases,	options,  and  zstyles
       states  may  be	useful	because	 they  include	only  changes from the
       defaults.  The bindings state may be useful if you have created any  of
       your own keymaps, because reporter arranges to dump the keymap creation
       commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.

       As is usual with automated tools, if you create	a  startup  file  with
       reporter,  you  should edit the results to remove unnecessary commands.
       Note that if you're using the new completion  system,  you  should  not
       dump  the  functions state to your startup files with reporter; use the
       compdump function instead (see zshcompsys(1)).

       reporter [ state ... ]
	      Print to standard output the indicated  subset  of  the  current
	      shell state.  The state arguments may be one or more of:

	      all    Output everything listed below.
	      aliases
		     Output alias definitions.
	      bindings
		     Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
	      completion
		     Output  old-style	compctl	 commands.   New completion is
		     covered by functions and zstyles.
	      functions
		     Output autoloads and function definitions.
	      limits Output limit commands.
	      options
		     Output setopt commands.
	      styles Same as zstyles.
	      variables
		     Output shell parameter assignments, plus export  commands
		     for any environment variables.
	      zstyles
		     Output zstyle commands.

	      If the state is omitted, all is assumed.

       With the exception of `all', every state can be abbreviated by any pre‐
       fix, even a single letter; thus a is the same as aliases, z is the same
       as zstyles, etc.

   Manipulating Hook Functions
       add-zsh-hook [-dD] hook function
	      Several  functions are special to the shell, as described in the
	      section SPECIAL FUNCTIONS, see  zshmisc(1),  in  that  they  are
	      automatic	 called	 at  a	specific point during shell execution.
	      Each has an associated array consisting of names of functions to
	      be  called  at  the  same point; these are so-called `hook func‐
	      tions'.  The shell function add-zsh-hook provides a  simple  way
	      of adding or removing functions from the array.

	      hook  is one of chpwd, periodic, precmd, preexec, zshaddhistory,
	      zshexit, or zsh_directory_name, the special functions  in	 ques‐
	      tion.  Note that zsh_directory_name is called in a different way
	      from the other functions, but may	 still	be  manipulated	 as  a
	      hook.

	      function	is  name of an ordinary shell function.	 If no options
	      are given this will be added to the array	 of  functions	to  be
	      executed in the given context.

	      If  the  option  -d  is  given, the function is removed from the
	      array of functions to be executed.

	      If the option -D is given, the function is treated as a  pattern
	      and  any	matching names of functions are removed from the array
	      of functions to be executed.

	      The options -U, -z and -k are passed as  arguments  to  autoload
	      for  function.   For functions contributed with zsh, the options
	      -Uz are appropriate.

REMEMBERING RECENT DIRECTORIES
       The function cdr allows you to change the working directory to a previ‐
       ous working directory from a list maintained automatically.  It is sim‐
       ilar in concept to the directory stack controlled by  the  pushd,  popd
       and  dirs  builtins,  but  is  more  configurable, and as it stores all
       entries in files it is maintained  across  sessions  and	 (by  default)
       between	terminal  emulators in the current session.  (The pushd direc‐
       tory stack is not actually modified or used by cdr unless you configure
       it to do so as described in the configuration section below.)

   Installation
       The  system works by means of a hook function that is called every time
       the directory changes.  To install the system,  autoload	 the  required
       functions and use the add-zsh-hook function described above:

	      autoload -Uz chpwd_recent_dirs cdr add-zsh-hook
	      add-zsh-hook chpwd chpwd_recent_dirs

       Now  every time you change directly interactively, no matter which com‐
       mand you use, the directory to which you change will be	remembered  in
       most-recent-first order.

   Use
       All direct user interaction is via the cdr function.

       The  argument  to  cdr  is  a  number  N	 corresponding to the Nth most
       recently changed-to directory.  1 is the immediately  preceding	direc‐
       tory;  the current directory is remembered but is not offered as a des‐
       tination.  Note that if you have multiple windows open 1 may refer to a
       directory  changed  to  in another window; you can avoid this by having
       per-terminal  files  for	 storing  directory  as	 described   for   the
       recent-dirs-file style below.

       If  you	set  the  recent-dirs-default  style  described below cdr will
       behave the same as cd if given a non-numeric argument, or more than one
       argument.   The	recent directory list is updated just the same however
       you change directory.

       If the argument is omitted, 1 is assumed.  This is similar  to  pushd's
       behaviour of swapping the two most recent directories on the stack.

       Completion  for	the  argument to cdr is available if compinit has been
       run; menu selection is recommended, using:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:cdr:*:*' menu selection

       to allow you to cycle through recent directories;  the  order  is  pre‐
       served,	so  the	 first	choice is the most recent directory before the
       current one.  The verbose style	is  also  recommended  to  ensure  the
       directory  is  shown;  this  style  is  on  by  default so no action is
       required unless you have changed it.

   Options
       The behaviour of cdr may be modified by the following options.

       -l     lists the numbers and the corresponding directories in  abbrevi‐
	      ated  form  (i.e.	 with ~ substitution reapplied), one per line.
	      The directories here are not quoted (this would only be an issue
	      if  a  directory name contained a newline).  This is used by the
	      completion system.

       -r     sets the variable reply  to  the	current	 set  of  directories.
	      Nothing is printed and the directory is not changed.

       -e     allows  you  to edit the list of directories, one per line.  The
	      list can be edited to any extent you like; no sanity checking is
	      performed.   Completion  is  available.  No quoting is necessary
	      (except for newlines, where I have in  any  case	no  sympathy);
	      directories  are	in  unabbreviated from and contain an absolute
	      path, i.e. they start with /.  Usually the first entry should be
	      left as the current directory.

   Configuration
       Configuration is by means of the styles mechanism that should be famil‐
       iar from completion; if not, see the description of the zstyle  command
       in  see	zshmodules(1).	 The  context  for  setting  styles  should be
       ':chpwd:*' in case the meaning of the context is	 extended  in  future,
       for example:

	      zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-max 0

       sets  the  value	 of  the  recent-dirs-max style to 0.  In practice the
       style name is specific enough that a context of '*' should be fine.

       An exception is recent-dirs-insert, which is used  exclusively  by  the
       completion  system  and	so  has	 the  usual  completion system context
       (':completion:*' if nothing more specific is needed), though again  '*'
       should be fine in practice.

       recent-dirs-default
	      If  true, and the command is expecting a recent directory index,
	      and either there is more than one argument or  the  argument  is
	      not an integer, then fall through to "cd".  This allows the lazy
	      to use only one  command	for  directory	changing.   Completion
	      recognises  this, too; see recent-dirs-insert for how to control
	      completion when this option is in use.

       recent-dirs-file
	      The file where the list of directories is saved.	The default is
	      ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.chpwd-recent-dirs,  i.e. this is in your home
	      directory unless you have set  the  variable  ZDOTDIR  to	 point
	      somewhere	 else.	 Directory  names  are	saved in $'...' quoted
	      form, so each line in the file can be supplied directly  to  the
	      shell as an argument.

	      The  value  of  this  style  may be an array.  In this case, the
	      first file in the list will always be used for  saving  directo‐
	      ries while any other files are left untouched.  When reading the
	      recent directory list, if there are fewer than the maximum  num‐
	      ber of entries in the first file, the contents of later files in
	      the array will be appended with duplicates removed from the list
	      shown.   The  contents of the two files are not sorted together,
	      i.e. all the entries in the first file  are  shown  first.   The
	      special  value  + can appear in the list to indicate the default
	      file should be read at that point.  This allows effects like the
	      following:

		     zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file \
		     ~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-${TTY##*/} +

	      Recent  directories  are	read from a file numbered according to
	      the terminal.  If there are insufficient	entries	 the  list  is
	      supplemented from the default file.

	      It  is  possible	to use zstyle -e to make the directory config‐
	      urable at run time:

		     zstyle -e ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file pick-recent-dirs-file
		     pick-recent-dirs-file() {
		       if [[ $PWD = ~/text/writing(|/*) ]]; then
			 reply=(~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-writing)
		       else
			 reply=(+)
		       fi
		     }

	      In this example, if the current directory is ~/text/writing or a
	      directory	 under	it,  then use a special file for saving recent
	      directories, else use the default.

       recent-dirs-insert
	      Used by completion.  If recent-dirs-default is true,  then  set‐
	      ting  this  to true causes the actual directory, rather than its
	      index, to be inserted on the command line;  this	has  the  same
	      effect  as  using the corresponding index, but makes the history
	      clearer and the line easier to edit.  With this setting, if part
	      of  an  argument	was already typed, normal directory completion
	      rather than recent directory completion is done; this is because
	      recent  directory	 completion  is expected to be done by cycling
	      through entries menu fashion.

	      If the value of the style is always, then only  recent  directo‐
	      ries  will  be  completed; in that case, use the cd command when
	      you want to complete other directories.

	      If the value is  fallback,  recent  directories  will  be	 tried
	      first,  then  normal directory completion is performed if recent
	      directory completion failed to find a match.

	      Finally, if the value is both then both sets of completions  are
	      presented;  the  usual  tag mechanism can be used to distinguish
	      results, with recent directories tagged  as  recent-dirs.	  Note
	      that the recent directories inserted are abbreviated with direc‐
	      tory names where appropriate.

       recent-dirs-max
	      The maximum number of directories to save to the file.  If  this
	      is  zero	or  negative  there is no maximum.  The default is 20.
	      Note this includes the current directory, which  isn't  offered,
	      so  the highest number of directories you will be offered is one
	      less than the maximum.

       recent-dirs-prune
	      This style is an array determining what directories  should  (or
	      should  not) be added to the recent list.	 Elements of the array
	      can include:

	      parent Prune  parents  (more  accurately,	 ancestors)  from  the
		     recent  list.   If present, changing directly down by any
		     number of directories causes the current directory to  be
		     overwritten.    For   example,   changing	from  ~pws  to
		     ~pws/some/other/dir causes ~pws not to  be	 left  on  the
		     recent  directory	stack.	 This  only  applies to direct
		     changes to descendant directories; earlier directories on
		     the  list	are  not  pruned.   For example, changing from
		     ~pws/yet/another to ~pws/some/other/dir  does  not	 cause
		     ~pws to be pruned.

	      pattern:pattern
		     Gives  a  zsh  pattern for directories that should not be
		     added to the recent list (if not  already	there).	  This
		     element  can  be repeated to add different patterns.  For
		     example, 'pattern:/tmp(|/*)' stops /tmp  or  its  descen‐
		     dants  from  being	 added.	  The  EXTENDED_GLOB option is
		     always turned on for these patterns.

       recent-dirs-pushd
	      If set to true, cdr will use pushd instead of cd to  change  the
	      directory, so the directory is saved on the directory stack.  As
	      the directory stack is completely	 separate  from	 the  list  of
	      files saved by the mechanism used in this file there is no obvi‐
	      ous reason to do this.

   Use with dynamic directory naming
       It is possible to refer to recent directories using the dynamic	direc‐
       tory  name syntax by using the supplied function zsh_directory_name_cdr
       a hook:

	      autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook
	      add-zsh-hook -Uz zsh_directory_name zsh_directory_name_cdr

       When this is done, ~[1] will refer to the most recent  directory	 other
       than $PWD, and so on.  Completion after ~[...  also works.

   Details of directory handling
       This  section  is for the curious or confused; most users will not need
       to know this information.

       Recent directories are saved to a file immediately and hence  are  pre‐
       served across sessions.	Note currently no file locking is applied: the
       list is updated immediately on interactive commands  and	 nowhere  else
       (unlike history), and it is assumed you are only going to change direc‐
       tory in one window at once.  This is not safe on shared	accounts,  but
       in  any case the system has limited utility when someone else is chang‐
       ing to a different set of directories behind your back.

       To make this a little safer, only directory changes instituted from the
       command	line,  either  directly	 or  indirectly through shell function
       calls (but not through subshells, evals,	 traps,	 completion  functions
       and  the like) are saved.  Shell functions should use cd -q or pushd -q
       to avoid side effects if the change to the directory is to be invisible
       at   the	  command   line.    See   the	 contents   of	 the  function
       chpwd_recent_dirs for more details.

GATHERING INFORMATION FROM VERSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
       In a lot of cases, it is nice  to  automatically	 retrieve  information
       from version control systems (VCSs), such as subversion, CVS or git, to
       be able to provide it to the user; possibly in the  user's  prompt.  So
       that  you  can  instantly  tell	which branch you are currently on, for
       example.

       In order to do that, you may use the vcs_info function.

       The following VCSs are supported, showing the abbreviated name by which
       they are referred to within the system:
       Bazaar (bzr)
	      http://bazaar-vcs.org/
       Codeville (cdv)
	      http://codeville.org/
       Concurrent Versioning System (cvs)
	      http://www.nongnu.org/cvs/
       Darcs (darcs)
	      http://darcs.net/
       Fossil (fossil)
	      http://fossil-scm.org/
       Git (git)
	      http://git-scm.com/
       GNU arch (tla)
	      http://www.gnu.org/software/gnu-arch/
       Mercurial (hg)
	      http://mercurial.selenic.com/
       Monotone (mtn)
	      http://monotone.ca/
       Perforce (p4)
	      http://www.perforce.com/
       Subversion (svn)
	      http://subversion.tigris.org/
       SVK (svk)
	      http://svk.bestpractical.com/

       There   is   also   support  for	 the  patch  management	 system	 quilt
       (http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt). See	 Quilt	Support	 below
       for details.

       To load vcs_info:

	      autoload -Uz vcs_info

       It  can be used in any existing prompt, because it does not require any
       specific $psvar entries to be available.

   Quickstart
       To get this feature working quickly (including colors), you can do  the
       following (assuming, you loaded vcs_info properly - see above):

	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' actionformats \
		  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{3}|%F{1}%a%F{5}]%f '
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' formats	 \
		  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{5}]%f '
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:(sv[nk]|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%F{1}:%F{3}%r'
	      precmd () { vcs_info }
	      PS1='%F{5}[%F{2}%n%F{5}] %F{3}%3~ ${vcs_info_msg_0_}%f%# '

       Obviously,  the last two lines are there for demonstration. You need to
       call vcs_info from your precmd function. Once that is done you  need  a
       single quoted '${vcs_info_msg_0_}' in your prompt.

       To  be  able  to	 use '${vcs_info_msg_0_}' directly in your prompt like
       this, you will need to have the PROMPT_SUBST option enabled.

       Now call the vcs_info_printsys utility from the command line:

	      % vcs_info_printsys
	      ## list of supported version control backends:
	      ## disabled systems are prefixed by a hash sign (#)
	      bzr
	      cdv
	      cvs
	      darcs
	      fossil
	      git
	      hg
	      mtn
	      p4
	      svk
	      svn
	      tla
	      ## flavours (cannot be used in the enable or disable styles; they
	      ## are enabled and disabled with their master [git-svn -> git])
	      ## they *can* be used in contexts: ':vcs_info:git-svn:*'.
	      git-p4
	      git-svn
	      hg-git
	      hg-hgsubversion
	      hg-hgsvn

       You may not want all of these because there is no point in running  the
       code  to	 detect	 systems you do not use.  So there is a way to disable
       some backends altogether:

	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr cdv darcs mtn svk tla

       You may also pick a few from that list and enable only those:

	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable git cvs svn

       If you rerun vcs_info_printsys after one of these  commands,  you  will
       see  the	 backends  listed in the disable style (or backends not in the
       enable style - if you used that) marked as disabled  by	a  hash	 sign.
       That  means  the	 detection  of these systems is skipped completely. No
       wasted time there.

   Configuration
       The vcs_info feature can be configured via zstyle.

       First, the context in which we are working:
	      :vcs_info:vcs-string:user-context:repo-root-name

       vcs-string
	      is one of: git, git-svn, git-p4,	hg,  hg-git,  hg-hgsubversion,
	      hg-hgsvn,	 darcs,	 bzr, cdv, mtn, svn, cvs, svk, tla, p4 or fos‐
	      sil. When hooks are active the hooks name is added after a  `+'.
	      (See Hooks in vcs_info below.)

       user-context
	      is  a  freely configurable string, assignable by the user as the
	      first argument to vcs_info (see its description below).

       repo-root-name
	      is the name of a repository in which you want a style to	match.
	      So,  if  you  want a setting specific to /usr/src/zsh, with that
	      being a CVS checkout, you can set repo-root-name to zsh to  make
	      it so.

       There  are  three  special  values  for	vcs-string: The first is named
       -init-, that is in effect as long as there was  no  decision  what  VCS
       backend	to use. The second is -preinit-; it is used before vcs_info is
       run, when initializing the data exporting variables. The third  special
       value is formats and is used by the vcs_info_lastmsg for looking up its
       styles.

       The initial value of repo-root-name is -all- and it  is	replaced  with
       the actual name, as soon as it is known. Only use this part of the con‐
       text for defining the formats, actionformats or branchformat styles, as
       it  is  guaranteed  that	 repo-root-name	 is set up correctly for these
       only. For all other styles, just use '*' instead.

       There are two pre-defined values for user-context:
       default
	      the one used if none is specified
       command
	      used by vcs_info_lastmsg to lookup its styles

       You can of course use ':vcs_info:*' to match all VCSs in all  user-con‐
       texts at once.

       This is a description of all styles that are looked up.

       formats
	      A list of formats, used when actionformats is not used (which is
	      most of the time).

       actionformats
	      A list of formats, used if there is a special action going on in
	      your  current  repository; like an interactive rebase or a merge
	      conflict.

       branchformat
	      Some backends replace %b in the formats and actionformats styles
	      above,  not only by a branch name but also by a revision number.
	      This style lets you modify how that string should look.

       nvcsformats
	      These "formats" are exported when we  didn't  detect  a  version
	      control  system  for  the current directory or vcs_info was dis‐
	      abled. This is useful if you want vcs_info  to  completely  take
	      over  the generation of your prompt. You would do something like
	      PS1='${vcs_info_msg_0_}' to accomplish that.

       hgrevformat
	      hg uses both a hash and a revision number to  reference  a  spe‐
	      cific  changeset in a repository. With this style you can format
	      the revision string (see	branchformat)  to  include  either  or
	      both. It's only useful when get-revision is true. Note, the full
	      40-character revision id is not available (except when using the
	      use-simple  option)  because  executing  hg  more	 than once per
	      prompt is too slow; you may customize this behavior using hooks.

       max-exports
	      Defines the maximum number of vcs_info_msg_*_ variables vcs_info
	      will export.

       enable A	 list  of backends you want to use. Checked in the -init- con‐
	      text. If this list contains an item called NONE  no  backend  is
	      used  at all and vcs_info will do nothing. If this list contains
	      ALL, vcs_info will use all known	backends.  Only	 with  ALL  in
	      enable  will the disable style have any effect. ALL and NONE are
	      case insensitive.

       disable
	      A list of VCSs you don't want vcs_info to test for  repositories
	      (checked	in  the -init- context, too). Only used if enable con‐
	      tains ALL.

       disable-patterns
	      A list of patterns that are checked against $PWD. If  a  pattern
	      matches, vcs_info will be disabled. This style is checked in the
	      :vcs_info:-init-:*:-all- context.

	      Say, ~/.zsh is a directory under version control, in  which  you
	      do not want vcs_info to be active, do:
		     zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable-patterns "$HOME/.zsh(|/*)"

       use-quilt
	      If  enabled,  the	 quilt support code is active in `addon' mode.
	      See Quilt Support for details.

       quilt-standalone
	      If enabled, `standalone' mode detection is attempted if  no  VCS
	      is active in a given directory. See Quilt Support for details.

       quilt-patch-dir
	      Overwrite	 the value of the $QUILT_PATCHES environment variable.
	      See Quilt Support for details.

       quiltcommand
	      When quilt itself is called in quilt support the value  of  this
	      style is used as the command name.

       check-for-changes
	      If  enabled,  this  style causes the %c and %u format escapes to
	      show when the working directory  has  uncommitted	 changes.  The
	      strings  displayed  by  these  escapes can be controlled via the
	      stagedstr and unstagedstr styles. The only  backends  that  cur‐
	      rently  support  this  option  are  git and hg (hg only supports
	      unstaged).

	      For this	style  to  be  evaluated  with	the  hg	 backend,  the
	      get-revision  style  needs  to  be  set and the use-simple style
	      needs to be unset. The latter is the default; the former is not.

	      Note, the actions taken if this style is enabled are potentially
	      expensive (read: they may be slow, depending on how big the cur‐
	      rent repository is).  Therefore, it is disabled by default.

       stagedstr
	      This string will be used in the %c escape if  there  are	staged
	      changes in the repository.

       unstagedstr
	      This  string will be used in the %u escape if there are unstaged
	      changes in the repository.

       command
	      This style causes vcs_info to use the  supplied  string  as  the
	      command  to  use as the VCS's binary. Note, that setting this in
	      ':vcs_info:*' is not a good idea.

	      If the value of this style is empty (which is the default),  the
	      used  binary name is the name of the backend in use (e.g. svn is
	      used in an svn repository).

	      The repo-root-name part in the context  is  always  the  default
	      -all- when this style is looked up.

	      For  example,  this  style  can  be  used	 to  use binaries from
	      non-default installation directories. Assume, git	 is  installed
	      in  /usr/bin  but	 your  sysadmin	 installed  a newer version in
	      /usr/bin/local. Instead of changing  the	order  of  your	 $PATH
	      parameter, you can do this:
		     zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*:-all-' command /usr/local/bin/git

       use-server
	      This is used by the Perforce backend (p4) to decide if it should
	      contact the Perforce server to find out if a directory  is  man‐
	      aged  by Perforce.  This is the only reliable way of doing this,
	      but runs the risk of a delay if the server name cannot be found.
	      If  the server (more specifically, the host:port pair describing
	      the server) cannot be contacted, its name is put into the	 asso‐
	      ciative  array  vcs_info_p4_dead_servers	and  is	 not contacted
	      again during the session until it is removed by hand.  If you do
	      not  set	this  style, the p4 backend is only usable if you have
	      set the environment variable P4CONFIG to a file  name  and  have
	      corresponding  files  in	the  root directories of each Perforce
	      client.  See comments in	the  function  VCS_INFO_detect_p4  for
	      more detail.

       use-simple
	      If  there	 are  two different ways of gathering information, you
	      can select the simpler one by setting this style	to  true;  the
	      default is to use the not-that-simple code, which is potentially
	      a lot slower but might be more accurate in all  possible	cases.
	      This style is used by the bzr and hg backends. In the case of hg
	      it will invoke the external hexdump program to parse the	binary
	      dirstate cache file; this method will not return the local revi‐
	      sion number.

       get-revision
	      If set to true, vcs_info goes the extra mile to figure  out  the
	      revision	of a repository's work tree (currently for the git and
	      hg backends, where  this	kind  of  information  is  not	always
	      vital).  For  git,  the  hash value of the currently checked out
	      commit is available via the %i expansion.	 With  hg,  the	 local
	      revision	number and the corresponding global hash are available
	      via %i.

       get-mq If set to true, the hg backend will look for a  Mercurial	 Queue
	      (mq) patch directory. Information will be available via the `%m'
	      replacement.

       get-bookmarks
	      If set to true, the hg backend will try to get a list of current
	      bookmarks. They will be available via the `%m' replacement.

       use-prompt-escapes
	      Determines  if we assume that the assembled string from vcs_info
	      includes prompt escapes. (Used by vcs_info_lastmsg.)

       debug  Enable debugging output to track	possible  problems.  Currently
	      this style is only used by vcs_info's hooks system.

       hooks  A	 list  style  that  defines  hook-function names. See Hooks in
	      vcs_info below for details.

       The default values for these styles in all contexts are:

       formats
	      " (%s)-[%b]%u%c-"
       actionformats
	      " (%s)-[%b|%a]%u%c-"
       branchformat
	      "%b:%r" (for bzr, svn, svk and hg)
       nvcsformats
	      ""
       hgrevformat
	      "%r:%h"
       max-exports
	      2
       enable ALL
       disable
	      (empty list)
       disable-patterns
	      (empty list)
       check-for-changes
	      false
       stagedstr
	      (string: "S")
       unstagedstr
	      (string: "U")
       command
	      (empty string)
       use-server
	      false
       use-simple
	      false
       get-revision
	      false
       get-mq true
       get-bookmarks
	      false
       use-prompt-escapes
	      true
       debug  false
       hooks  (empty list)
       use-quilt
	      false
       quilt-standalone
	      false
       quilt-patch-dir
	      empty - use $QUILT_PATCHES
       quiltcommand
	      quilt

       In normal formats and  actionformats  the  following  replacements  are
       done:

       %s     The VCS in use (git, hg, svn, etc.).
       %b     Information about the current branch.
       %a     An  identifier  that  describes  the action. Only makes sense in
	      actionformats.
       %i     The current revision number or identifier. For hg the  hgrevfor‐
	      mat style may be used to customize the output.
       %c     The  string from the stagedstr style if there are staged changes
	      in the repository.
       %u     The string from the unstagedstr  style  if  there	 are  unstaged
	      changes in the repository.
       %R     The base directory of the repository.
       %r     The repository name. If %R is /foo/bar/repoXY, %r is repoXY.
       %S     A	   subdirectory	   within    a	  repository.	If   $PWD   is
	      /foo/bar/repoXY/beer/tasty, %S is beer/tasty.
       %m     A "misc" replacement. It is at the discretion of the backend  to
	      decide what this replacement expands to. It is currently used by
	      the hg and git backends to display patch information from the mq
	      and stgit extensions.

       In branchformat these replacements are done:

       %b     The branch name.
       %r     The current revision number or the hgrevformat style for hg.

       In hgrevformat these replacements are done:

       %r     The current local revision number.
       %h     The current global revision identifier.

       In patch-format and nopatch-format these replacements are done:

       %p     The name of the top-most applied patch (applied-string).
       %u     The number of unapplied patches (unapplied-string).
       %n     The number of applied patches.
       %c     The number of unapplied patches.
       %a     The number of all patches.
       %g     The names of active mq guards (hg backend).
       %G     The number of active mq guards (hg backend).

       Not  all VCS backends have to support all replacements. For nvcsformats
       no replacements are performed at all, it is just a string.

   Oddities
       If you want to use the %b (bold off) prompt expansion in formats, which
       expands	%b  itself, use %%b. That will cause the vcs_info expansion to
       replace %%b with %b, so that zsh's prompt expansion mechanism can  han‐
       dle  it. Similarly, to hand down %b from branchformat, use %%%%b. Sorry
       for this inconvenience, but it cannot be easily avoided. Luckily we  do
       not  clash  with	 a  lot of prompt expansions and this only needs to be
       done for those.

   Quilt Support
       Quilt is not a version control system, therefore	 this  is  not	imple‐
       mented  as a backend. It can help keeping track of a series of patches.
       People use it to keep a set of changes they want to use on top of soft‐
       ware  packages  (which  is  tightly  integrated	into the package build
       process - the Debian project does this for a large number of packages).
       Quilt  can  also	 help  individual  developers  keep track of their own
       patches on top of real version control systems.

       The vcs_info integration tries to support both ways of using  quilt  by
       having  two  slightly  different	 modes	of operation: `addon' mode and
       `standalone' mode).

       For `addon' mode to become active vcs_info must have already detected a
       real  version  control system controlling the directory. If that is the
       case, a directory that holds quilt's patches needs to  be  found.  That
       directory is configurable via the `QUILT_PATCHES' environment variable.
       If that	variable  exists  its  value  is  used,	 otherwise  the	 value
       `patches'  is assumed. The value from $QUILT_PATCHES can be overwritten
       using the `quilt-patches' style. (Note: you can use  vcs_info  to  keep
       the  value  of  $QUILT_PATCHES  correct all the time via the post-quilt
       hook).

       When the directory in question is found, quilt is assumed to be active.
       To  gather  more	 information,  vcs_info	 looks	for a directory called
       `.pc'; Quilt uses that directory to track its current  state.  If  this
       directory  does	not  exist we know that quilt has not done anything to
       the working directory (read: no patches have been applied yet).

       If patches are applied, vcs_info will try to find  out  which.  If  you
       want to know which patches of a series are not yet applied, you need to
       activate the get-unapplied style in the appropriate context.

       vcs_info allows for very detailed control over how the gathered	infor‐
       mation  is  presented  (see  the	 below	sections,  Styles and Hooks in
       vcs_info), all of which are documented below. Note there are  a	number
       of  other  patch tracking systems that work on top of a certain version
       control system (like stgit for git, or mq for  hg);  the	 configuration
       for  systems  like  that	 are  generally configured the same way as the
       quilt support.

       If the quilt support is working in `addon' mode, the produced string is
       available  as a simple format replacement (%Q to be precise), which can
       be used in formats and actionformats; see below for details).

       If, on the other hand, the support  code	 is  working  in  `standalone'
       mode,  vcs_info will pretend as if quilt were an actual version control
       system. That means that the version control  system  identifier	(which
       otherwise  would	 be  something	like  `svn'  or	 `cvs') will be set to
       `-quilt-'. This has implications on the used style context  where  this
       identifier is the second element. vcs_info will have filled in a proper
       value for the "repository's" root directory and the  string  containing
       the  information	 about	quilt's	 state will be available as the `misc'
       replacement (and %Q for compatibility with `addon' mode.

       What is left to discuss is  how	`standalone'  mode  is	detected.  The
       detection  itself is a series of searches for directories. You can have
       this detection enabled all the time in every directory that is not oth‐
       erwise  under  version control. If you know there is only a limited set
       of trees where you would like vcs_info to try and  look	for  Quilt  in
       `standalone'  mode to minimise the amount of searching on every call to
       vcs_info, there are a number of ways to do that:

       Essentially, `standalone' mode  detection  is  controlled  by  a	 style
       called  `quilt-standalone'. It is a string style and its value can have
       different effects. The simplest values are: `always' to	run  detection
       every  time  vcs_info  is  run,	and  `never' to turn the detection off
       entirely.

       If the value of quilt-standalone is something else, it  is  interpreted
       differently. If the value is the name of a scalar variable the value of
       that  variable  is  checked  and	 that  value  is  used	in  the	  same
       `always'/`never' way as described above.

       If  the	value  of  quilt-standalone  is an array, the elements of that
       array are used as directory names under which you want the detection to
       be active.

       If  quilt-standalone  is	 an  associative  array, the keys are taken as
       directory names under which you want the detection to  be  active,  but
       only if the corresponding value is the string `true'.

       Last,  but not least, if the value of quilt-standalone is the name of a
       function, the function is called without arguments and the return value
       decides whether detection should be active. A `0' return value is true;
       a non-zero return value is interpreted as false.

       Note, if there is both a	 function  and	a  variable  by	 the  name  of
       quilt-standalone, the function will take precedence.

   Function Descriptions (Public API)
       vcs_info [user-context]
	      The main function, that runs all backends and assembles all data
	      into ${vcs_info_msg_*_}. This is the function you want  to  call
	      from  precmd  if	you  want to include up-to-date information in
	      your prompt (see Variable description below). If an argument  is
	      given,  that  string  will  be  used  instead  of default in the
	      user-context field of the style context.

       vcs_info_hookadd
	      Statically registers a number of functions to a given hook.  The
	      hook  needs to be given as the first argument; what follows is a
	      list of hook-function names to register to the hook. The	`+vi-'
	      prefix  needs  to	 be left out here. See Hooks in vcs_info below
	      for details.

       vcs_info_hookdel
	      Remove hook-functions from a given hook. The hook	 needs	to  be
	      given  as	 the first non-option argument; what follows is a list
	      of hook-function names to un-register from the hook. If `-a'  is
	      used  as the first argument, all occurances of the functions are
	      unregistered. Otherwise only the last occurance is removed (if a
	      function	was  registered to a hook more than once) . The `+vi-'
	      prefix needs to be left out here. See Hooks  in  vcs_info	 below
	      for details.

       vcs_info_lastmsg
	      Outputs  the  last ${vcs_info_msg_*_} value.  Takes into account
	      the value of the	use-prompt-escapes  style  in  ':vcs_info:for‐
	      mats:command:-all-'. It also only prints max-exports values.

       vcs_info_printsys [user-context]
	      Prints  a	 list of all supported version control systems. Useful
	      to find out possible contexts (and which of them are enabled) or
	      values for the disable style.

       vcs_info_setsys
	      Initializes vcs_info's internal list of available backends. With
	      this function, you can add support for new VCSs without restart‐
	      ing the shell.

       All functions named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

   Variable Description
       ${vcs_info_msg_N_} (Note the trailing underscore)
	      Where  N	is  an integer, e.g., vcs_info_msg_0_. These variables
	      are the storage for the informational message the last  vcs_info
	      call has assembled. These are strongly connected to the formats,
	      actionformats and	 nvcsformats  styles  described	 above.	 Those
	      styles  are  lists.  The first member of that list gets expanded
	      into ${vcs_info_msg_0_}, the second into ${vcs_info_msg_1_}  and
	      the Nth into ${vcs_info_msg_N-1_}. These parameters are exported
	      into the environment. (See the max-exports style above.)

       All variables named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

   Hooks in vcs_info
       Hooks are places in vcs_info where you can run your own code. That code
       can  communicate	 with the code that called it and through that, change
       the system's behaviour.

       For configuration, hooks change the style context:
	      :vcs_info:vcs-string+hook-name:user-context:repo-root-name

       To register functions to a hook, you need to list  them	in  the	 hooks
       style in the appropriate context.

       Example:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+foo:*' hooks bar baz

       This  registers	functions to the hook `foo' for all backends. In order
       to  avoid  namespace  problems,	all  registered	 function  names   are
       prepended  by  a	 `+vi-',  so the actual functions called for the `foo'
       hook are `+vi-bar' and `+vi-baz'.

       If you would like to register a function to a hook  regardless  of  the
       current context, you may use the vcs_info_hookadd function. To remove a
       function that was added like that, the vcs_info_hookdel function can be
       used.

       If  something  seems weird, you can enable the `debug' boolean style in
       the proper context and the hook-calling code will print what  it	 tried
       to execute and whether the function in question existed.

       When  you  register more than one function to a hook, all functions are
       executed one after another until one function returns non-zero or until
       all  functions  have  been called. Context-sensitive hook functions are
       executed	 before	 statically  registered	 ones  (the  ones   added   by
       vcs_info_hookadd).

       You   may  pass	data  between  functions  via  an  associative	array,
       user_data.  For example:
	      +vi-git-myfirsthook(){
		  user_data[myval]=$myval
	      }
	      +vi-git-mysecondhook(){
		  # do something with ${user_data[myval]}
	      }

       There are a number of variables that are special in hook contexts:

       ret    The return value that the hooks system will return to the	 call‐
	      er.  The	default is an integer `zero'. If and how a changed ret
	      value changes the execution of the caller depends	 on  the  spe‐
	      cific hook. See the hook documentation below for details.

       hook_com
	      An  associated  array which is used for bidirectional communica‐
	      tion from the caller to hook functions. The used keys depend  on
	      the specific hook.

       context
	      The  active  context  of the hook. Functions that wish to change
	      this variable should make it local scope first.

       vcs    The current VCS after it was detected. The same values as in the
	      enable/disable  style  are  used.	 Available in all hooks except
	      start-up.

       Finally, the full list of currently available hooks:

       start-up
	      Called after starting vcs_info but before the VCS in this direc‐
	      tory is determined. It can be used to deactivate vcs_info tempo‐
	      rarily if necessary. When ret is set to 1, vcs_info  aborts  and
	      does  nothing;  when set to 2, vcs_info sets up everything as if
	      no version control were active and exits.

       pre-get-data
	      Same as start-up but after the VCS was detected.

       gen-hg-bookmark-string
	      Called in the Mercurial backend when a bookmark string is gener‐
	      ated; the get-revision and get-bookmarks styles must be true.

	      This  hook  gets	the  names  of	the  Mercurial	bookmarks that
	      vcs_info collected from `hg'.

	      When setting ret to non-zero, the string in  ${hook_com[hg-book‐
	      mark-string]}  will  be  used  in	 the  %m escape in formats and
	      actionformats and will be availabe in  the  global  backend_misc
	      array as ${backend_misc[bookmarks]}.

       gen-applied-string
	      Called in the git (with stgit), and hg (with mq) backends and in
	      quilt  support  when  the	 applied-string	 is   generated;   the
	      use-quilt	 zstyle must be true for quilt (the mq and stgit back‐
	      ends are active by default).

	      This hook gets the names of all applied patches  which  vcs_info
	      collected	 so  far  in  the opposite order, which means that the
	      first argument is the top-most patch and so forth.

	      When    setting	 ret	to    non-zero,	   the	  string    in
	      ${hook_com[applied-string]}  will	 be  used  in the %m escape in
	      formats and actionformats; it will be available  in  the	global
	      backend_misc  array  as  $backend_misc[patches]}; and it will be
	      available as %p in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

       gen-unapplied-string
	      Called in the git (with stgit), and hg (with mq) backend and  in
	      quilt  support  when  the	 unapplied-string  is  generated;  the
	      get-unapplied style must be true.

	      This hook gets the names of all unapplied patches which vcs_info
	      collected	 so  far  in  the  opposite order, which mean that the
	      first argument is the patch next-in-line to be  applied  and  so
	      forth.

	      When  setting  ret  to  non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[unap‐
	      plied-string]} will be available as %u in the  patch-format  and
	      nopatch-format styles.

       gen-mqguards-string
	      Called  in  the  hg backend when guards-string is generated; the
	      get-mq style must be true (default).

	      This hook gets the names of any active mq guards.

	      When    setting	 ret	to    non-zero,	   the	  string    in
	      ${hook_com[guards-string]}  will be used in the %g escape in the
	      patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

       no-vcs This  hooks  is  called  when  no	 version  control  system  was
	      detected.

	      The `hook_com' parameter is not used.

       post-quilt
	      Called  after  the quilt support is done. The following informa‐
	      tion is passed as arguments to the hook:	1.  the	 quilt-support
	      mode  (`addon'  or `standalone'); 2. the directory that contains
	      the patch series; 3. the directory  that	holds  quilt's	status
	      information (the `.pc' directory) or the string "-nopc-" if that
	      directory wasn't found.

	      The `hook_com' parameter is not used.

       set-branch-format
	      Called before `branchformat' is set. The only  argument  to  the
	      hook is the format that is configured at this point.

	      The  `hook_com'  keys  considered	 are  `branch' and `revision'.
	      They are set to the values figured out so far  by	 vcs_info  and
	      any  change will be used directly when the actual replacement is
	      done.

	      If    ret	   is	 set	to    non-zero,	   the	  string    in
	      ${hook_com[branch-replace]}  will	 be used unchanged as the `%b'
	      replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.

       set-hgrev-format
	      Called before a `hgrevformat' is set. The only argument  to  the
	      hook is the format that is configured at this point.

	      The  `hook_com' keys considered are `hash' and `localrev'.  They
	      are set to the values figured out so far	by  vcs_info  and  any
	      change  will  be	used  directly	when the actual replacement is
	      done.

	      If    ret	   is	 set	to    non-zero,	   the	  string    in
	      ${hook_com[rev-replace]}	will  be  used	unchanged  as the `%i'
	      replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.

       set-message
	      Called each time before a `vcs_info_msg_N_' message is set.   It
	      takes  two  arguments;  the  first  being the `N' in the message
	      variable name, the second is the currently configured formats or
	      actionformats.

	      There  are  a  number  of	 `hook_com'  keys, that are used here:
	      `action', `branch',  `base',  `base-name',  `subdir',  `staged',
	      `unstaged',  `revision', `misc', `vcs' and one `miscN' entry for
	      each backend-specific data field (N starting at zero). They  are
	      set  to the values figured out so far by vcs_info and any change
	      will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.

	      Since this hook is triggered multiple times (once for each  con‐
	      figured  formats	or actionformats), each of the `hook_com' keys
	      mentioned above (except for the miscN entries)  has  an  `_orig'
	      counterpart,  so	even if you changed a value to your liking you
	      can still get the original value in the next run.	 Changing  the
	      `_orig' values is probably not a good idea.

	      If  ret  is  set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[message]}
	      will be used unchanged as the message by vcs_info.

       If all of this sounds rather confusing, take a  look  at	 the  Examples
       section	below  and  also in the Misc/vcs_info-examples file in the Zsh
       source.	They contain some explanatory code.

   Examples
       Don't use vcs_info at all (even though it's in your prompt):
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable NONE

       Disable the backends for bzr and svk:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr svk

       Disable everything but bzr and svk:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable bzr svk

       Provide a special formats for git:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' formats	     ' GIT, BABY! [%b]'
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' actionformats ' GIT ACTION! [%b|%a]'

       All %x expansion in all sorts of formats	 ("formats",  "actionformats",
       branchformat,  you  name	 it) are done using the `zformat' builtin from
       the `zsh/zutil' module. That means you can do everything with these  %x
       items  what zformat supports. In particular, if you want something that
       is really long to have a fixed  width,  like  a	hash  in  a  mercurial
       branchformat, you can do this: %12.12i. That'll shrink the 40 character
       hash to its 12 leading characters. The form  is	actually  `%min.maxx'.
       More  is	 possible.   See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmod‐
       ules(1) for details.

       Use the quicker bzr backend
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:bzr:*' use-simple true

       If   you	  do   use   use-simple,   please   report    if    it	  does
       `the-right-thing[tm]'.

       Display the revision number in yellow for bzr and svn:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%{'${fg[yellow]}'%}:%r'

       If you want colors, make sure you enclose the color codes in %{...%} if
       you want to use the string provided by vcs_info in prompts.

       Here is how to print the	 VCS  information  as  a  command  (not	 in  a
       prompt):
	      alias vcsi='vcs_info command; vcs_info_lastmsg'

       This  way,  you	can  even  define  different  formats  for  output via
       vcs_info_lastmsg in the ':vcs_info:*:command:*' namespace.

       Now as promised, some code that uses hooks: say, you'd like to  replace
       the string `svn' by `subversion' in vcs_info's %s formats replacement.

       First,  we  will	 tell  vcs_info to call a function when populating the
       message variables with the gathered information:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion

       Nothing happens. Which is reasonable, since we didn't define the actual
       function	 yet.  To see what the hooks subsystem is trying to do, enable
       the `debug' style:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug true

       That should give you an idea what is going on. Specifically, the	 func‐
       tion  that we are looking for is `+vi-svn2subversion'. Note, the `+vi-'
       prefix. So, everything is in order, just as documented.	When  you  are
       done checking out the debugging output, disable it again:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug false

       Now, let's define the function:
	      function +vi-svn2subversion() {
		  [[ ${hook_com[vcs_orig]} == svn ]] && hook_com[vcs]=subversion
	      }

       Simple enough. And it could have even been simpler, if only we had reg‐
       istered our function in a less generic context. If we do it only in the
       `svn' backend's context, we don't need to test which the active backend
       is:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:svn+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
	      function +vi-svn2subversion() {
		  hook_com[vcs]=subversion
	      }

       And finally a little more elaborate example, that uses a hook to create
       a customised bookmark string for the hg backend.

       Again, we start off by registering a function:
	      zstyle ':vcs_info:hg+gen-hg-bookmark-string:*' hooks hgbookmarks

       And then we define the `+vi-hgbookmarks function:
	      function +vi-hgbookmarks() {
		  # The default is to connect all bookmark names by
		  # commas. This mixes things up a little.
		  # Imagine, there's one type of bookmarks that is
		  # special to you. Say, because it's *your* work.
		  # Those bookmarks look always like this: "sh/*"
		  # (because your initials are sh, for example).
		  # This makes the bookmarks string use only those
		  # bookmarks. If there's more than one, it
		  # concatenates them using commas.
		  local s i
		  # The bookmarks returned by `hg' are available in
		  # the functions positional parameters.
		  (( $# == 0 )) && return 0
		  for i in "$@"; do
		      if [[ $i == sh/* ]]; then
			  [[ -n $s ]] && s=$s,
			  s=${s}$i
		      fi
		  done
		  # Now, the communication with the code that calls
		  # the hook functions is done via the hook_com[]
		  # hash. The key, at which the `gen-hg-bookmark-string'
		  # hook looks at is `hg-bookmark-string'. So:
		  hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]=$s
		  # And to signal, that we want to use the sting we
		  # just generated, set the special variable `ret' to
		  # something other than the default zero:
		  ret=1
		  return 0
	      }

       Some longer examples and code snippets which might be useful are avail‐
       able in the examples file located at Misc/vcs_info-examples in the  Zsh
       source directory.

       This concludes our guided tour through zsh's vcs_info.

PROMPT THEMES
   Installation
       You  should  make  sure	all  the  functions from the Functions/Prompts
       directory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with
       the  string `prompt_' except for the special function`promptinit'.  You
       also need the `colors' function	from  Functions/Misc.	All  of	 these
       functions  may  already have been installed on your system; if not, you
       will need to find them and copy them.  The directory should  appear  as
       one of the elements of the fpath array (this should already be the case
       if they were installed), and at least the function promptinit should be
       autoloaded;  it will autoload the rest.	Finally, to initialize the use
       of the system you need to call the promptinit function.	The  following
       code  in	 your  .zshrc  will arrange for this; assume the functions are
       stored in the directory ~/myfns:

	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
	      autoload -U promptinit
	      promptinit

   Theme Selection
       Use the prompt command to select your preferred	theme.	 This  command
       may  be	added to your .zshrc following the call to promptinit in order
       to start zsh with a theme already selected.

       prompt [ -c | -l ]
       prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
       prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
	      Set or examine the prompt theme.	With no options	 and  a	 theme
	      argument,	 the theme with that name is set as the current theme.
	      The available themes are determined at  run  time;  use  the  -l
	      option  to  see  a  list.	 The special theme `random' selects at
	      random one of the available themes and sets your prompt to that.

	      In some cases the theme may be modified by  one  or  more	 argu‐
	      ments, which should be given after the theme name.  See the help
	      for each theme for descriptions of these arguments.

	      Options are:

	      -c     Show the currently selected theme and its parameters,  if
		     any.
	      -l     List all available prompt themes.
	      -p     Preview  the  theme  named	 by theme, or all themes if no
		     theme is given.
	      -h     Show help for the theme named by theme, or for the prompt
		     function if no theme is given.
	      -s     Set theme as the current theme and save state.

       prompt_theme_setup
	      Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the
	      prompt function to install that theme.  This function may define
	      other  functions	as necessary to maintain the prompt, including
	      functions used to preview the prompt or  provide	help  for  its
	      use.   You  should  not  normally	 call a theme's setup function
	      directly.

ZLE FUNCTIONS
   Widgets
       These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see  zshzle(1))
       which  can  be bound to keystrokes in interactive shells.  To use them,
       your .zshrc should contain lines of the form

	      autoload function
	      zle -N function

       followed by an appropriate bindkey command to  associate	 the  function
       with a key sequence.  Suggested bindings are described below.

       bash-style word functions
	      If  you  are  looking for functions to implement moving over and
	      editing words in the manner of  bash,  where  only  alphanumeric
	      characters are considered word characters, you can use the func‐
	      tions described in the next section.  The	 following  is	suffi‐
	      cient:

		     autoload -U select-word-style
		     select-word-style bash

       forward-word-match, backward-word-match
       kill-word-match, backward-kill-word-match
       transpose-words-match, capitalize-word-match
       up-case-word-match, down-case-word-match
       select-word-style, match-word-context, match-words-by-style
	      The  eight  `-match'  functions are drop-in replacements for the
	      builtin widgets without the suffix.  By default they behave in a
	      similar  way.   However,	by  the use of styles and the function
	      select-word-style, the way words are matched can be altered.

	      The  simplest  way  of  configuring  the	functions  is  to  use
	      select-word-style,  which can either be called as a normal func‐
	      tion with the appropriate argument, or invoked as a user-defined
	      widget  that  will  prompt  for  the first character of the word
	      style to be used.	 The first  time  it  is  invoked,  the	 eight
	      -match  functions	 will  automatically  replace the builtin ver‐
	      sions, so they do not need to be loaded explicitly.

	      The word styles available are as follows.	 Only the first	 char‐
	      acter is examined.

	      bash   Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.

	      normal As	 in  normal  shell  operation:	 word  characters  are
		     alphanumeric characters plus any  characters  present  in
		     the string given by the parameter $WORDCHARS.

	      shell  Words  are	 complete  shell  command  arguments, possibly
		     including complete quoted strings, or any tokens  special
		     to the shell.

	      whitespace
		     Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.

	      default
		     Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as
		     `normal'.

	      All but `default' can be input as an upper case character, which
	      has  the	same  effect  but with subword matching turned on.  In
	      this case, words with upper case	characters  are	 treated  spe‐
	      cially:  each separate run of upper case characters, or an upper
	      case character followed by any number of	other  characters,  is
	      considered a word.  The style subword-range can supply an alter‐
	      native character range to the default `[:upper:]'; the value  of
	      the  style is treated as the contents of a `[...]' pattern (note
	      that the outer brackets should not be supplied, only those  sur‐
	      rounding named ranges).

	      More  control  can  be  obtained	using  the  zstyle command, as
	      described in zshmodules(1).  Each style is looked up in the con‐
	      text  :zle:widget	 where	widget is the name of the user-defined
	      widget, not the name of the function implementing it, so in  the
	      case of the definitions supplied by select-word-style the appro‐
	      priate contexts are :zle:forward-word, and so on.	 The  function
	      select-word-style	 itself	 always defines styles for the context
	      `:zle:*' which can be overridden by more specific (longer)  pat‐
	      terns as well as explicit contexts.

	      The  style word-style specifies the rules to use.	 This may have
	      the following values.

	      normal Use the standard  shell  rules,  i.e.  alphanumerics  and
		     $WORDCHARS, unless overridden by the styles word-chars or
		     word-class.

	      specified
		     Similar to normal, but only the specified characters, and
		     not also alphanumerics, are considered word characters.

	      unspecified
		     The  negation  of	specified.   The  given characters are
		     those which will not be considered part of a word.

	      shell  Words are obtained by using the syntactic rules for  gen‐
		     erating  shell  command  arguments.  In addition, special
		     tokens which are never command arguments such as `()' are
		     also treated as words.

	      whitespace
		     Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.

	      The  first  three of those rules usually use $WORDCHARS, but the
	      value  in	 the  parameter	 can  be  overridden  by   the	 style
	      word-chars,  which  works in exactly the same way as $WORDCHARS.
	      In addition, the style word-class uses character class syntax to
	      group  characters	 and  takes precedence over word-chars if both
	      are set.	The word-class style does not include the  surrounding
	      brackets of the character class; for example, `-:[:alnum:]' is a
	      valid word-class to include all alphanumerics plus  the  charac‐
	      ters  `-'	 and  `:'.   Be	 careful including `]', `^' and `-' as
	      these are special inside character classes.

	      word-style may also have `-subword' appended  to	its  value  to
	      turn on subword matching, as described above.

	      The  style  skip-chars  is mostly useful for transpose-words and
	      similar functions.  If set,  it  gives  a	 count	of  characters
	      starting	at  the	 cursor	 position which will not be considered
	      part of the word and are treated as space,  regardless  of  what
	      they actually are.  For example, if

		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1

	      has  been set, and transpose-words-match is called with the cur‐
	      sor on the X of fooXbar, where X can be any character, then  the
	      resulting expression is barXfoo.

	      Finer  grained  control  can  be	obtained  by setting the style
	      word-context to an array of pairs	 of  entries.	Each  pair  of
	      entries consists of a pattern and a subcontext.  The shell argu‐
	      ment the cursor is on is matched against each  pattern  in  turn
	      until  one  matches;  if	it  does, the context is extended by a
	      colon and the corresponding subcontext.  Note that the  test  is
	      made against the original word on the line, with no stripping of
	      quotes.  Special handling is done	 between  words:  the  current
	      context is examined and if it contains the string back, the word
	      before the cursor is considered, else the word after  cursor  is
	      considered. Some examples are given below.

	      The  style  skip-whitespace-first	 is  only  used	 with the for‐
	      ward-word widget.	 If it is set to true, then forward-word skips
	      any  non-word-characters,	 followed  by any non-word-characters:
	      this is similar to the behaviour of other	 word-orientated  wid‐
	      gets,  and  also	that used by other editors, however it differs
	      from the standard zsh behaviour.	When  using  select-word-style
	      the  widget  is  set  in	the context :zle:* to true if the word
	      style is bash and false otherwise.  It may be overridden by set‐
	      ting it in the more specific context :zle:forward-word*.

	      Here are some examples of use of the styles, actually taken from
	      the simplified interface in select-word-style:

		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard
		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars ''

	      Implements bash-style word handling for all widgets,  i.e.  only
	      alphanumerics  are  word	characters;  equivalent to setting the
	      parameter WORDCHARS empty for the given context.

		     style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space

	      Uses space-delimited words for widgets with the word  `kill'  in
	      the  name.   Neither  of the styles word-chars nor word-class is
	      used in this case.

	      Here are some examples of	 use  of  the  word-context  style  to
	      extend the context.

		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-context "*/*" file "[[:space:]]" whitespace
		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:whitespace' word-style shell
		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-style normal
		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-chars ''

	      This  provides  two  different  ways  of	using  transpose-words
	      depending on whether the cursor is on whitespace	between	 words
	      or  on a filename, here any word containing a /.	On whitespace,
	      complete arguments as defined by standard shell  rules  will  be
	      transposed.   In	a  filename, only alphanumerics will be trans‐
	      posed.  Elsewhere, words will be transposed  using  the  default
	      style for :zle:transpose-words.

	      The  word	 matching  and	all the handling of zstyle settings is
	      actually implemented by the function match-words-by-style.  This
	      can  be  used  to	 create new user-defined widgets.  The calling
	      function should set the local parameter curcontext to  :zle:wid‐
	      get,   create   the   local  parameter  matched_words  and  call
	      match-words-by-style   with   no	  arguments.	 On    return,
	      matched_words will be set to an array with the elements: (1) the
	      start of the line	 (2)  the  word	 before	 the  cursor  (3)  any
	      non-word	characters  between  that  word and the cursor (4) any
	      non-word character at the cursor	position  plus	any  remaining
	      non-word	characters before the next word, including all charac‐
	      ters specified by the skip-chars style, (5) the word at or  fol‐
	      lowing  the  cursor  (6)	any non-word characters following that
	      word (7) the remainder of the line.  Any of the elements may  be
	      an  empty	 string;  the calling function should test for this to
	      decide whether it can perform its function.

	      It   is	possible   to	pass   options	 with	arguments   to
	      match-words-by-style to override the use of styles.  The options
	      are:
	      -w     word-style
	      -s     skip-chars
	      -c     word-class
	      -C     word-chars
	      -r     subword-range

	      For example, match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0 may be  used  to
	      extract the command argument around the cursor.

	      The   word-context   style   is	implemented  by	 the  function
	      match-word-context.  This should not usually need to  be	called
	      directly.

       copy-earlier-word
	      This  widget  works  like	 a combination of insert-last-word and
	      copy-prev-shell-word.   Repeated	invocations  of	  the	widget
	      retrieve	earlier	 words	on  the relevant history line.	With a
	      numeric argument N, insert the Nth word from the history line; N
	      may be negative to count from the end of the line.

	      If insert-last-word has been used to retrieve the last word on a
	      previous history line, repeated invocations  will	 replace  that
	      word with earlier words from the same line.

	      Otherwise,  the  widget  applies	to words on the line currently
	      being edited.  The widget style  can  be	set  to	 the  name  of
	      another  widget  that  should be called to retrieve words.  This
	      widget must accept the same three arguments as insert-last-word.

       cycle-completion-positions
	      After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the
	      new  function  based  completion	system may know about multiple
	      places in this string where characters  are  missing  or	differ
	      from  at	least one of the possible matches.  It will then place
	      the cursor on the position it considers to be the most interest‐
	      ing one, i.e. the one where one can disambiguate between as many
	      matches as possible with as little typing as possible.

	      This widget allows the cursor to be easily moved	to  the	 other
	      interesting  spots.   It	can  be	 invoked  repeatedly  to cycle
	      between all positions reported by the completion system.

       delete-whole-word-match
	      This is another function which works like the  -match  functions
	      described	 immediately  above,  i.e.  using styles to decide the
	      word boundaries.	However, it  is	 not  a	 replacement  for  any
	      existing function.

	      The  basic  behaviour  is	 to delete the word around the cursor.
	      There is no numeric prefix handling; only the single word around
	      the  cursor  is  considered.   If the widget contains the string
	      kill, the removed text will  be  placed  in  the	cutbuffer  for
	      future	yanking.    This   can	 be   obtained	 by   defining
	      kill-whole-word-match as follows:

		     zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match

	      and then binding the widget kill-whole-word-match.

       up-line-or-beginning-search, down-line-or-beginning-search
	      These   widgets	are   similar	to   the   builtin   functions
	      up-line-or-search	 and  down-line-or-search:   if in a multiline
	      buffer they move up or down within the  buffer,  otherwise  they
	      search  for  a  history  line  matching the start of the current
	      line.  In this case, however,  they  search  for	a  line	 which
	      matches  the  current line up to the current cursor position, in
	      the manner of  history-beginning-search-backward	and  -forward,
	      rather than the first word on the line.

       edit-command-line
	      Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.

		     bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line

       history-search-end
	      This    function	  implements	the   widgets	history-begin‐
	      ning-search-backward-end	  and	 history-beginning-search-for‐
	      ward-end.	  These commands work by first calling the correspond‐
	      ing builtin widget (see `History Control' in zshzle(1)) and then
	      moving  the  cursor to the end of the line.  The original cursor
	      position is remembered and restored before calling  the  builtin
	      widget  a	 second	 time,	so that the same search is repeated to
	      look farther through the history.

	      Although you autoload only one function, the commands to use  it
	      are slightly different because it implements two widgets.

		     zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
			    history-search-end
		     zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
			    history-search-end
		     bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
		     bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end

       history-beginning-search-menu
	      This  function implements yet another form of history searching.
	      The text before the cursor is used to select lines from the his‐
	      tory,  as	 for history-beginning-search-backward except that all
	      matches are shown in a numbered menu.   Typing  the  appropriate
	      digits  inserts the full history line.  Note that leading zeroes
	      must be typed (they are only shown when necessary	 for  removing
	      ambiguity).   The	 entire	 history is searched; there is no dis‐
	      tinction between forwards and backwards.

	      With a prefix argument, the search is not anchored to the	 start
	      of  the line; the string typed by the use may appear anywhere in
	      the line in the history.

	      If the widget name contains `-end' the cursor is	moved  to  the
	      end  of the line inserted.  If the widget name contains `-space'
	      any space in the text typed is treated as	 a  wildcard  and  can
	      match  anything (hence a leading space is equivalent to giving a
	      prefix argument).	 Both forms can be combined, for example:

		     zle -N history-beginning-search-menu-space-end \
			    history-beginning-search-menu

       history-pattern-search
	      The function  history-pattern-search  implements	widgets	 which
	      prompt  for a pattern with which to search the history backwards
	      or forwards.  The pattern is in the usual	 zsh  format,  however
	      the  first  character may be ^ to anchor the search to the start
	      of the line, and the last character  may	be  $  to  anchor  the
	      search  to  the end of the line.	If the search was not anchored
	      to the end of the line the cursor is positioned just  after  the
	      pattern found.

	      The  commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those in
	      the example immediately above:

		     autoload -U history-pattern-search
		     zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
		     zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search

       incarg Typing the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed  on
	      or  to  the  left of an integer causes that integer to be incre‐
	      mented by one.  With a numeric prefix argument,  the  number  is
	      incremented  by  the  amount of the argument (decremented if the
	      prefix argument is negative).  The shell parameter incarg may be
	      set to change the default increment to something other than one.

		     bindkey '^X+' incarg

       incremental-complete-word
	      This  allows  incremental	 completion of a word.	After starting
	      this command, a list of completion choices can  be  shown	 after
	      every  character	you type, which you can delete with ^H or DEL.
	      Pressing return accepts the completion so far and returns you to
	      normal  editing  (that  is,  the command line is not immediately
	      executed).  You can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G to abort
	      back to the state when you started, and ^D to list the matches.

	      This works only with the new function based completion system.

		     bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word

       insert-composed-char
	      This function allows you to compose characters that don't appear
	      on the keyboard to be inserted into the command line.  The  com‐
	      mand  is	followed by two keys corresponding to ASCII characters
	      (there is no prompt).  For accented characters, the two keys are
	      a	 base  character  followed by a code for the accent, while for
	      other special characters the  two	 characters  together  form  a
	      mnemonic	for  the  character to be inserted.  The two-character
	      codes are a subset of those given by RFC 1345 (see  for  example
	      http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc1345.html).

	      The  function may optionally be followed by up to two characters
	      which replace one or both of the characters read from  the  key‐
	      board;  if  both characters are supplied, no input is read.  For
	      example, insert-composed-char a: can be used within a widget  to
	      insert  an  a  with  umlaut into the command line.  This has the
	      advantages over use of a literal character that it is more  por‐
	      table.

	      For  best	 results  zsh  should have been built with support for
	      multibyte characters (configured with --enable-multibyte);  how‐
	      ever,  the  function  works  for the limited range of characters
	      available in single-byte character sets such as ISO-8859-1.

	      The character is converted into  the  local  representation  and
	      inserted	into  the  command  line at the cursor position.  (The
	      conversion is done within the shell, using  whatever  facilities
	      the C library provides.)	With a numeric argument, the character
	      and its code are previewed in the status line

	      The function may be run outside zle in which case it prints  the
	      character	 (together  with a newline) to standard output.	 Input
	      is still read from keystrokes.

	      See insert-unicode-char for an alternative way of inserting Uni‐
	      code characters using their hexadecimal character number.

	      The set of accented characters is reasonably complete up to Uni‐
	      code character U+0180, the set of special	 characters  less  so.
	      However,	it is very sporadic from that point.  Adding new char‐
	      acters is easy, however; see the function define-composed-chars.
	      Please send any additions to zsh-workers@zsh.org.

	      The codes for the second character when used to accent the first
	      are as follows.  Note that not every character  can  take	 every
	      accent.
	      !	     Grave.
	      '	     Acute.
	      >	     Circumflex.
	      ?	     Tilde.   (This  is not ~ as RFC 1345 does not assume that
		     character is present on the keyboard.)
	      -	     Macron.  (A horizontal bar over the base character.)
	      (	     Breve.  (A shallow dish shape over the base character.)
	      .	     Dot above the base character, or in the case of i no dot,
		     or in the case of L and l a centered dot.
	      :	     Diaeresis (Umlaut).
	      c	     Cedilla.
	      _	     Underline,	 however  there	 are  currently	 no underlined
		     characters.
	      /	     Stroke through the base character.
	      "	     Double acute (only supported on a few letters).
	      ;	     Ogonek.  (A little forward	 facing	 hook  at  the	bottom
		     right of the character.)
	      <	     Caron.  (A little v over the letter.)
	      0	     Circle over the base character.
	      2	     Hook over the base character.
	      9	     Horn over the base character.

	      The  most common characters from the Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek and
	      Hebrew alphabets are available; consult RFC 1345 for the	appro‐
	      priate sequences.	 In addition, a set of two letter codes not in
	      RFC 1345 are available for the  double-width  characters	corre‐
	      sponding to ASCII characters from !  to ~ (0x21 to 0x7e) by pre‐
	      ceding the character with ^, for example ^A for  a  double-width
	      A.

	      The following other two-character sequences are understood.

	      ASCII characters
		     These are already present on most keyboards:
	      <(     Left square bracket
	      //     Backslash (solidus)
	      )>     Right square bracket
	      (!     Left brace (curly bracket)
	      !!     Vertical bar (pipe symbol)
	      !)     Right brace (curly bracket)
	      '?     Tilde

	      Special letters
		     Characters	 found in various variants of the Latin alpha‐
		     bet:
	      ss     Eszett (scharfes S)
	      D-, d- Eth
	      TH, th Thorn
	      kk     Kra
	      'n     'n
	      NG, ng Ng
	      OI, oi Oi
	      yr     yr
	      ED     ezh

	      Currency symbols
	      Ct     Cent
	      Pd     Pound sterling (also lira and others)
	      Cu     Currency
	      Ye     Yen
	      Eu     Euro (N.B. not in RFC 1345)

	      Punctuation characters
		     References to "right" quotes indicate the shape (like a 9
		     rather  than  6) rather than their grammatical use.  (For
		     example, a "right" low double quote is used to open  quo‐
		     tations in German.)
	      !I     Inverted exclamation mark
	      BB     Broken vertical bar
	      SE     Section
	      Co     Copyright
	      -a     Spanish feminine ordinal indicator
	      <<     Left guillemet
	      --     Soft hyphen
	      Rg     Registered trade mark
	      PI     Pilcrow (paragraph)
	      -o     Spanish masculine ordinal indicator
	      >>     Right guillemet
	      ?I     Inverted question mark
	      -1     Hyphen
	      -N     En dash
	      -M     Em dash
	      -3     Horizontal bar
	      :3     Vertical ellipsis
	      .3     Horizontal midline ellipsis
	      !2     Double vertical line
	      =2     Double low line
	      '6     Left single quote
	      '9     Right single quote
	      .9     "Right" low quote
	      9'     Reversed "right" quote
	      "6     Left double quote
	      "9     Right double quote
	      :9     "Right" low double quote
	      9"     Reversed "right" double quote
	      /-     Dagger
	      /=     Double dagger

	      Mathematical symbols
	      DG     Degree
	      -2, +-, -+
		     - sign, +/- sign, -/+ sign
	      2S     Superscript 2
	      3S     Superscript 3
	      1S     Superscript 1
	      My     Micro
	      .M     Middle dot
	      14     Quarter
	      12     Half
	      34     Three quarters
	      *X     Multiplication
	      -:     Division
	      %0     Per mille
	      FA, TE, /0
		     For all, there exists, empty set
	      dP, DE, NB
		     Partial derivative, delta (increment), del (nabla)
	      (-, -) Element of, contains
	      *P, +Z Product, sum
	      *-, Ob, Sb
		     Asterisk, ring, bullet
	      RT, 0(, 00
		     Root sign, proportional to, infinity

	      Other symbols
	      cS, cH, cD, cC
		     Card suits: spades, hearts, diamonds, clubs
	      Md, M8, M2, Mb, Mx, MX
		     Musical notation: crotchet (quarter note), quaver (eighth
		     note), semiquavers (sixteenth notes), flag sign,  natural
		     sign, sharp sign
	      Fm, Ml Female, male

	      Accents on their own
	      '>     Circumflex (same as caret, ^)
	      '!     Grave (same as backtick, `)
	      ',     Cedilla
	      ':     Diaeresis (Umlaut)
	      'm     Macron
	      ''     Acute

       insert-files
	      This  function  allows  you  type	 a  file  pattern, and see the
	      results of the expansion at each step.  When you hit return, all
	      expansions are inserted into the command line.

		     bindkey '^Xf' insert-files

       insert-unicode-char
	      When  first  executed, the user inputs a set of hexadecimal dig‐
	      its.  This  is  terminated  with	another	 call  to  insert-uni‐
	      code-char.   The	digits	are then turned into the corresponding
	      Unicode character.  For example, if the widget is bound to  ^XU,
	      the character sequence `^XU 4 c ^XU' inserts L (Unicode U+004c).

	      See insert-composed-char for a way of inserting characters using
	      a two-character mnemonic.

       narrow-to-region [ -p pre ] [ -P post ]
	   [ -S statepm | -R statepm ] [ -n ] [ start end ])
       narrow-to-region-invisible
	      Narrow the editable portion of the buffer to the region  between
	      the  cursor  and	the  mark,  which may be in either order.  The
	      region may not be empty.

	      narrow-to-region may be used as a widget or called as a function
	      from  a  user-defined  widget;  by default, the text outside the
	      editable area remains visible.  A	 recursive-edit	 is  performed
	      and  the	original  widening  status  is then restored.  Various
	      options and arguments are available when it is called as a func‐
	      tion.

	      The  options  -p	pretext and -P posttext may be used to replace
	      the text before and after the display for the  duration  of  the
	      function; either or both may be an empty string.

	      If the option -n is also given, pretext or posttext will only be
	      inserted if there is text before or  after  the  region  respec‐
	      tively which will be made invisible.

	      Two numeric arguments may be given which will be used instead of
	      the cursor and mark positions.

	      The option -S statepm is used to narrow according to  the	 other
	      options  while  saving  the original state in the parameter with
	      name statepm, while the option -R statepm is used to restore the
	      state  from  the	parameter;  note in both cases the name of the
	      parameter is required.  In the second case,  other  options  and
	      arguments	 are  irrelevant.  When this method is used, no recur‐
	      sive-edit is performed; the  calling  widget  should  call  this
	      function with the option -S, perform its own editing on the com‐
	      mand line or pass control to the user via `zle  recursive-edit',
	      then  call  this	function  with	the  option  -R.  The argument
	      statepm must be a	 suitable  name	 for  an  ordinary  parameter,
	      except  that  parameters	beginning  with	 the  prefix _ntr_ are
	      reserved for use within narrow-to-region.	 Typically the parame‐
	      ter will be local to the calling function.

	      narrow-to-region-invisible  is  a simple widget which calls nar‐
	      row-to-region with arguments which replace any text outside  the
	      region with `...'.

	      The  display  is	restored (and the widget returns) upon any zle
	      command which would usually cause the line  to  be  accepted  or
	      aborted.	Hence an additional such command is required to accept
	      or abort the current line.

	      The return status of both	 widgets  is  zero  if	the  line  was
	      accepted, else non-zero.

	      Here is a trivial example of a widget using this feature.
		     local state
		     narrow-to-region -p $'Editing restricted region\n' \
		       -P '' -S state
		     zle recursive-edit
		     narrow-to-region -R state

       predict-on
	      This set of functions implements predictive typing using history
	      search.  After predict-on, typing characters causes  the	editor
	      to  look	backward  in  the history for the first line beginning
	      with what you have typed so  far.	  After	 predict-off,  editing
	      returns  to normal for the line found.  In fact, you often don't
	      even need to use predict-off, because if the line doesn't	 match
	      something in the history, adding a key performs standard comple‐
	      tion, and then inserts itself  if	 no  completions  were	found.
	      However,	editing	 in  the middle of a line is liable to confuse
	      prediction; see the toggle style below.

	      With the function based completion system (which is  needed  for
	      this),  you  should  be  able to type TAB at almost any point to
	      advance the cursor to the next ``interesting''  character	 posi‐
	      tion  (usually  the end of the current word, but sometimes some‐
	      where in the middle of the word).	 And of course as soon as  the
	      entire  line is what you want, you can accept with return, with‐
	      out needing to move the cursor to the end first.

	      The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional
	      widget functions:

	      delete-backward-and-predict
		     Replaces  the  backward-delete-char  widget.   You do not
		     need to bind this yourself.
	      insert-and-predict
		     Implements predictive typing by replacing the self-insert
		     widget.  You do not need to bind this yourself.
	      predict-off
		     Turns off predictive typing.

	      Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is neces‐
	      sary to create a keybinding for predict-off as well.

		     zle -N predict-on
		     zle -N predict-off
		     bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
		     bindkey '^Z' predict-off

       read-from-minibuffer
	      This is most useful when called as a function from inside a wid‐
	      get,  but	 will work correctly as a widget in its own right.  It
	      prompts for a value below the current command line; a value  may
	      be  input	 using	all  of	 the  standard zle operations (and not
	      merely the restricted set available when executing, for example,
	      execute-named-cmd).   The	 value is then returned to the calling
	      function in the parameter $REPLY and the editing buffer restored
	      to  its  previous	 state.	 If the read was aborted by a keyboard
	      break (typically ^G), the function returns status 1  and	$REPLY
	      is not set.

	      If  one  argument	 is  supplied to the function it is taken as a
	      prompt, otherwise `? ' is used.  If two arguments are  supplied,
	      they  are the prompt and the initial value of $LBUFFER, and if a
	      third argument is given it is the	 initial  value	 of  $RBUFFER.
	      This  provides  a	 default  value and starting cursor placement.
	      Upon return the entire buffer is the value of $REPLY.

	      One option is available: `-k num' specifies that num  characters
	      are  to be read instead of a whole line.	The line editor is not
	      invoked recursively in this case, so depending on	 the  terminal
	      settings	the  input may not be visible, and only the input keys
	      are placed in $REPLY, not the entire buffer.  Note  that	unlike
	      the read builtin num must be given; there is no default.

	      The  name	 is  a	slight	misnomer,  as  in fact the shell's own
	      minibuffer is not used.  Hence it is still possible to call exe‐
	      cuted-named-cmd and similar functions while reading a value.

       replace-string, replace-pattern
       replace-string-again, replace-pattern-again
	      The   function  replace-string  implements  three	 widgets.   If
	      defined under the same name as the function, it prompts for  two
	      strings;	the first (source) string will be replaced by the sec‐
	      ond everywhere it occurs in the line editing buffer.

	      If the widget name contains the word `pattern', for  example  by
	      defining	the  widget  using the command `zle -N replace-pattern
	      replace-string', then the matching is performed using  zsh  pat‐
	      terns.   All  zsh	 extended globbing patterns can be used in the
	      source string; note that unlike filename generation the  pattern
	      does  not	 need  to match an entire word, nor do glob qualifiers
	      have any effect.	In addition, the replacement string  can  con‐
	      tain  parameter or command substitutions.	 Furthermore, a `&' in
	      the replacement string will be replaced with the matched	source
	      string,  and a backquoted digit `\N' will be replaced by the Nth
	      parenthesised expression matched.	 The form `\{N}' may  be  used
	      to protect the digit from following digits.

	      If  the  widget instead contains the word `regex' (or `regexp'),
	      then  the	 matching  is  performed  using	 regular  expressions,
	      respecting  the  setting	of  the	 option RE_MATCH_PCRE (see the
	      description of the function regexp-replace below).  The  special
	      replacement  facilities described above for pattern matching are
	      available.

	      By default the previous source or replacement string will not be
	      offered  for editing.  However, this feature can be activated by
	      setting the style edit-previous in the context :zle:widget  (for
	      example,	:zle:replace-string) to true.  In addition, a positive
	      numeric argument forces the previous values  to  be  offered,  a
	      negative or zero argument forces them not to be.

	      The function replace-string-again can be used to repeat the pre‐
	      vious   replacement;   no	  prompting   is   done.    As	  with
	      replace-string,  if  the	name  of  the widget contains the word
	      `pattern' or `regex', pattern or regular expression matching  is
	      performed,  else	a  literal  string replacement.	 Note that the
	      previous source and replacement text are the same	 whether  pat‐
	      tern, regular expression or string matching is used.

	      In addition, replace-string shows the previous replacement above
	      the prompt, so long as there was one during the current session;
	      if the source string is empty, that replacement will be repeated
	      without the widget prompting for a replacement string.

	      For example, starting from the line:

		     print This line contains fan and fond

	      and invoking replace-pattern with the source string `f(?)n'  and
	      the replacement string `c\1r' produces the not very useful line:

		     print This line contains car and cord

	      The  range of the replacement string can be limited by using the
	      narrow-to-region-invisible widget.  One limitation of  the  cur‐
	      rent  version  is	 that  undo  will cycle through changes to the
	      replacement and source strings before  undoing  the  replacement
	      itself.

       send-invisible
	      This is similar to read-from-minibuffer in that it may be called
	      as a function from a widget or as	 a  widget  of	its  own,  and
	      interactively reads input from the keyboard.  However, the input
	      being typed is concealed and a  string  of  asterisks  (`*')  is
	      shown  instead.	The value is saved in the parameter $INVISIBLE
	      to which a reference is inserted into the editing buffer at  the
	      restored cursor position.	 If the read was aborted by a keyboard
	      break (typically ^G) or another  escape  from  editing  such  as
	      push-line, $INVISIBLE is set to empty and the original buffer is
	      restored unchanged.

	      If one argument is supplied to the function it  is  taken	 as  a
	      prompt, otherwise `Non-echoed text: ' is used (as in emacs).  If
	      a second and third argument are supplied they are used to	 begin
	      and  end	the  reference to $INVISIBLE that is inserted into the
	      buffer.  The default is to open with  ${,	 then  INVISIBLE,  and
	      close with }, but many other effects are possible.

       smart-insert-last-word
	      This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:

		     zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word

	      With  a numeric prefix, or when passed command line arguments in
	      a call from another widget, it  behaves  like  insert-last-word,
	      except  that words in comments are ignored when INTERACTIVE_COM‐
	      MENTS is set.

	      Otherwise, the rightmost ``interesting'' word from the  previous
	      command  is  found  and  inserted.   The	default	 definition of
	      ``interesting'' is that the word contains at  least  one	alpha‐
	      betic  character,	 slash,	 or backslash.	This definition may be
	      overridden by use of the match style.  The context used to  look
	      up  the  style  is  the  widget  name, so usually the context is
	      :insert-last-word.  However, you can bind this function to  dif‐
	      ferent widgets to use different patterns:

		     zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
		     zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
		     bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment

	      If  no  interesting word is found and the auto-previous style is
	      set to a true value, the search  continues  upward  through  the
	      history.	 When  auto-previous  is unset or false (the default),
	      the widget must be invoked repeatedly in order to search earlier
	      history lines.

       transpose-lines
	      Only useful with a multi-line editing buffer; the lines here are
	      lines within the current on-screen buffer,  not  history	lines.
	      The effect is similar to the function of the same name in Emacs.

	      Transpose	 the  current line with the previous line and move the
	      cursor to the start of the next line.  Repeating this (which can
	      be done by providing a positive numeric prefix argument) has the
	      effect of moving the line above the cursor down by a  number  of
	      lines.

	      With  a  negative	 numeric  prefix  argument, requires two lines
	      above the cursor.	 These two lines are transposed and the cursor
	      moved to the start of the previous line.	Using a numeric prefix
	      less than -1 has the effect of moving the line above the	cursor
	      up by minus that number of lines.

       which-command
	      This  function  is  a drop-in replacement for the builtin widget
	      which-command.  It has enhanced behaviour, in that it  correctly
	      detects  whether or not the command word needs to be expanded as
	      an alias; if so, it continues tracing the command word from  the
	      expanded	alias  until  it reaches the command that will be exe‐
	      cuted.

	      The style whence is available in the context :zle:$WIDGET;  this
	      may be set to an array to give the command and options that will
	      be used to investigate the command word found.  The  default  is
	      whence -c.

   Utility Functions
       These  functions	 are  useful  in constructing widgets.	They should be
       loaded with  `autoload  -U  function'  and  called  as  indicated  from
       user-defined widgets.

       split-shell-arguments
	      This  function splits the line currently being edited into shell
	      arguments and whitespace.	 The result is	stored	in  the	 array
	      reply.   The  array contains all the parts of the line in order,
	      starting with any whitespace before the first argument, and fin‐
	      ishing  with  any whitespace after the last argument.  Hence (so
	      long as the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set) whitespace is given by
	      odd  indices  in	the array and arguments by even indices.  Note
	      that no stripping of quotes is done; joining  together  all  the
	      elements of reply in order is guaranteed to produce the original
	      line.

	      The parameter REPLY is set to the index of  the  word  in	 reply
	      which  contains  the character after the cursor, where the first
	      element has index 1.  The parameter REPLY2 is set to  the	 index
	      of  the character under the cursor in that word, where the first
	      character has index 1.

	      Hence reply, REPLY and REPLY2 should all be made	local  to  the
	      enclosing function.

	      See  the	function modify-current-argument, described below, for
	      an example of how to call this function.

       modify-current-argument [ expr-using-$ARG | func ]
	      This function provides a simple method of allowing  user-defined
	      widgets to modify the command line argument under the cursor (or
	      immediately to the left of the cursor if the cursor  is  between
	      arguments).

	      The  argument can be an expression which when evaluated operates
	      on the shell parameter ARG, which will have been set to the com‐
	      mand  line  argument under the cursor.  The expression should be
	      suitably quoted to prevent it being evaluated too early.

	      Alternatively, if the argument does not contain the string  ARG,
	      it  is assumed to be a shell function, to which the current com‐
	      mand line argument is passed as the only argument.  The function
	      should  set  the variable REPLY to the new value for the command
	      line argument.  If the function returns non-zero status, so does
	      the calling function.

	      For example, a user-defined widget containing the following code
	      converts the characters in the argument under  the  cursor  into
	      all upper case:

		     modify-current-argument '${(U)ARG}'

	      The  following strips any quoting from the current word (whether
	      backslashes or one of the styles of  quotes),  and  replaces  it
	      with single quoting throughout:

		     modify-current-argument '${(qq)${(Q)ARG}}'

	      The  following  performs directory expansion on the command line
	      argument and replaces it by the absolute path:

		     expand-dir() {
		       REPLY=${~1}
		       REPLY=${REPLY:a}
		     }
		     modify-current-argument expand-dir

	      In practice  the	function  expand-dir  would  probably  not  be
	      defined  within  the  widget  where  modify-current-argument  is
	      called.

   Styles
       The behavior of several of the above widgets can be controlled  by  the
       use of the zstyle mechanism.  In particular, widgets that interact with
       the completion system pass along their context to any completions  that
       they invoke.

       break-keys
	      This  style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget. Its
	      value should be a pattern, and all keys  matching	 this  pattern
	      will cause the widget to stop incremental completion without the
	      key having any further effect. Like all styles used directly  by
	      incremental-complete-word,  this	style  is  looked up using the
	      context `:incremental'.

       completer
	      The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set
	      up their top-level context name before calling completion.  This
	      allows one to define different sets of completer	functions  for
	      normal  completion  and  for these widgets.  For example, to use
	      completion, approximation and correction for normal  completion,
	      completion  and  correction  for incremental completion and only
	      completion for prediction one could use:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
			     _complete _correct _approximate
		     zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
			     _complete _correct
		     zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
			     _complete

	      It is a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction,
	      because  they  may  be  automatically  invoked as you type.  The
	      _list and _menu completers should never be used with prediction.
	      The  _approximate,  _correct, _expand, and _match completers may
	      be used, but be aware that they may change  characters  anywhere
	      in  the  word  behind the cursor, so you need to watch carefully
	      that the result is what you intended.

       cursor The insert-and-predict widget uses this style,  in  the  context
	      `:predict', to decide where to place the cursor after completion
	      has been tried.  Values are:

	      complete
		     The cursor is left where it was when completion finished,
		     but only if it is after a character equal to the one just
		     inserted by the user.  If it is after another  character,
		     this value is the same as `key'.

	      key    The  cursor is left after the nth occurrence of the char‐
		     acter just inserted, where n is the number of times  that
		     character	appeared  in  the  word	 before completion was
		     attempted.	 In short, this has the effect of leaving  the
		     cursor after the character just typed even if the comple‐
		     tion code found out that no other characters need	to  be
		     inserted at that position.

	      Any other value for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor
	      at the position where the completion code left it.

       list   When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style says
	      if  the matches should be listed on every key press (if they fit
	      on the screen).  Use the context	prefix	`:completion:incremen‐
	      tal'.

	      The  insert-and-predict  widget uses this style to decide if the
	      completion should be shown even if there is  only	 one  possible
	      completion.   This  is  done  if	the value of this style is the
	      string always.  In this case  the	 context  is  `:predict'  (not
	      `:completion:predict').

       match  This  style  is used by smart-insert-last-word to provide a pat‐
	      tern (using full EXTENDED_GLOB syntax) that matches an interest‐
	      ing  word.   The	context	 is  the  name	of the widget to which
	      smart-insert-last-word is bound (see above).  The default behav‐
	      ior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'

	      However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'

	      Or  include  numbers as long as the word is at least two charac‐
	      ters long:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'

	      The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.

       prompt The incremental-complete-word widget shows  the  value  of  this
	      style  in	 the  status  line during incremental completion.  The
	      string value may contain any of the following substrings in  the
	      manner of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:

	      %c     Replaced  by the name of the completer function that gen‐
		     erated the matches (without the leading underscore).

	      %l     When the list style is set, replaced by `...' if the list
		     of	 matches  is too long to fit on the screen and with an
		     empty string otherwise.  If the list style is `false'  or
		     not set, `%l' is always removed.

	      %n     Replaced by the number of matches generated.

	      %s     Replaced  by  `-no	 match-',  `-no	 prefix-', or an empty
		     string if there is no completion matching the word on the
		     line, if the matches have no common prefix different from
		     the word on the line, or if there is such a  common  pre‐
		     fix, respectively.

	      %u     Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there
		     is any, and if it is different from the word on the line.

	      Like `break-keys', this uses the `:incremental' context.

       stop-keys
	      This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its
	      value  is	 treated similarly to the one for the break-keys style
	      (and uses the same context: `:incremental').  However,  in  this
	      case  all keys matching the pattern given as its value will stop
	      incremental completion and will then execute their  usual	 func‐
	      tion.

       toggle This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
	      in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
	      values, predictive typing is automatically toggled off in situa‐
	      tions where it is unlikely to be useful, such as when editing  a
	      multi-line  buffer or after moving into the middle of a line and
	      then deleting a character.  The default is to  leave  prediction
	      turned on until an explicit call to predict-off.

       verbose
	      This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
	      in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
	      values,  these  widgets  display a message below the prompt when
	      the predictive state is toggled.	This is most useful in	combi‐
	      nation  with  the	 toggle	 style.	  The default does not display
	      these messages.

       widget This style is similar to the command style: For widget functions
	      that  use zle to call other widgets, this style can sometimes be
	      used to override the widget which is called.   The  context  for
	      this  style  is  the name of the calling widget (not the name of
	      the calling function, because one function may be bound to  mul‐
	      tiple widget names).

		     zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word

	      Check  the  documentation	 for the calling widget or function to
	      determine whether the widget style is used.

EXCEPTION HANDLING
       Two functions are provided to enable zsh to provide exception  handling
       in a form that should be familiar from other languages.

       throw exception
	      The  function  throw throws the named exception.	The name is an
	      arbitrary string and is only used by the throw and  catch	 func‐
	      tions.   An exception is for the most part treated the same as a
	      shell error, i.e. an unhandled exception will cause the shell to
	      abort  all  processing  in a function or script and to return to
	      the top level in an interactive shell.

       catch exception-pattern
	      The function catch returns  status  zero	if  an	exception  was
	      thrown and the pattern exception-pattern matches its name.  Oth‐
	      erwise it returns status 1.   exception-pattern  is  a  standard
	      shell   pattern,	 respecting   the   current   setting  of  the
	      EXTENDED_GLOB option.  An alias catch is also defined to prevent
	      the  argument  to	 the function from matching filenames, so pat‐
	      terns may be used unquoted.  Note that  as  exceptions  are  not
	      fundamentally  different	from other shell errors it is possible
	      to catch shell errors by using an empty string as the  exception
	      name.   The shell variable CAUGHT is set by catch to the name of
	      the exception caught.  It is possible to rethrow an exception by
	      calling  the  throw  function  again  once an exception has been
	      caught.

       The functions are designed to be used together  with  the  always  con‐
       struct  described  in  zshmisc(1).  This is important as only this con‐
       struct provides the required support for exceptions.  A typical example
       is as follows.

	      {
		# "try" block
		# ... nested code here calls "throw MyExcept"
	      } always {
		# "always" block
		if catch MyExcept; then
		  print "Caught exception MyExcept"
		elif catch ''; then
		  print "Caught a shell error.	Propagating..."
		  throw ''
		fi
		# Other exceptions are not handled but may be caught further
		# up the call stack.
	      }

       If  all	exceptions  should  be	caught,	 the  following idiom might be
       preferable.

	      {
		# ... nested code here throws an exception
	      } always {
		if catch *; then
		  case $CAUGHT in
		    (MyExcept)
		    print "Caught my own exception"
		    ;;
		    (*)
		    print "Caught some other exception"
		    ;;
		  esac
		fi
	      }

       In common with exception handling in other languages, the exception may
       be  thrown by code deeply nested inside the `try' block.	 However, note
       that it must be thrown inside the current  shell,  not  in  a  subshell
       forked  for  a pipeline, parenthesised current-shell construct, or some
       form of command or process substitution.

       The system internally uses the shell variable EXCEPTION to  record  the
       name  of	 the exception between throwing and catching.  One drawback of
       this scheme is that if the exception is not handled the variable EXCEP‐
       TION  remains  set  and may be incorrectly recognised as the name of an
       exception if a shell error subsequently occurs.	Adding unset EXCEPTION
       at  the	start  of  the outermost layer of any code that uses exception
       handling will eliminate this problem.

MIME FUNCTIONS
       Three functions are available to provide handling of  files  recognised
       by extension, for example to dispatch a file text.ps when executed as a
       command to an appropriate viewer.

       zsh-mime-setup [ -fv ] [ -l [ suffix ... ] ]
       zsh-mime-handler [-l] command arguments ...
	      These  two   functions   use   the   files   ~/.mime.types   and
	      /etc/mime.types,	which  associate types and extensions, as well
	      as ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap files, which associate types  and
	      the  programs that handle them.  These are provided on many sys‐
	      tems with the Multimedia Internet Mail Extensions.

	      To enable the system,  the  function  zsh-mime-setup  should  be
	      autoloaded  and  run.   This  allows files with extensions to be
	      treated as executable; such files be completed by	 the  function
	      completion  system.   The	 function  zsh-mime-handler should not
	      need to be called by the user.

	      The system works by setting up suffix aliases with  `alias  -s'.
	      Suffix  aliases  already installed by the user will not be over‐
	      written.

	      For suffixes defined in lower case,  upper  case	variants  will
	      also automatically be handled (e.g. PDF is automatically handled
	      if handling for the suffix pdf is defined), but not vice versa.

	      Repeated calls to zsh-mime-setup do not  override	 the  existing
	      mapping  between suffixes and executable files unless the option
	      -f is given.  Note, however, that this does not override	exist‐
	      ing suffix aliases assigned to handlers other than zsh-mime-han‐
	      dler.

	      Calling zsh-mime-setup with the option  -l  lists	 the  existing
	      mappings	without	 altering  them.   Suffixes to list (which may
	      contain pattern characters that should be quoted from  immediate
	      interpretation  on  the command line) may be given as additional
	      arguments, otherwise all suffixes are listed.

	      Calling zsh-mime-setup with the option -v causes verbose	output
	      to be shown during the setup operation.

	      The  system  respects  the mailcap flags needsterminal and copi‐
	      ousoutput, see mailcap(4).

	      The functions use the following styles, which are	 defined  with
	      the  zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).	They should be
	      defined before zsh-mime-setup is run.   The  contexts  used  all
	      start with :mime:, with additional components in some cases.  It
	      is recommended that a trailing * (suitably quoted)  be  appended
	      to  style	 patterns  in  case  the system is extended in future.
	      Some examples are given below.

	      For files that have multiple suffixes, e.g. .pdf.gz,  where  the
	      context  includes	 the suffix it will be looked up starting with
	      the longest possible suffix until	 a  match  for	the  style  is
	      found.   For  example,  if .pdf.gz produces a match for the han‐
	      dler, that will be used; otherwise the handler for .gz  will  be
	      used.   Note  that,  owing to the way suffix aliases work, it is
	      always required that there be a handler for the shortest	possi‐
	      ble  suffix,  so	in this example .pdf.gz can only be handled if
	      .gz is also handled (though not necessarily in  the  same	 way).
	      Alternatively, if no handling for .gz on its own is needed, sim‐
	      ply adding the command

		     alias -s gz=zsh-mime-handler

	      to the initialisation code is sufficient; .gz will not  be  han‐
	      dled on its own, but may be in combination with other suffixes.

	      current-shell
		     If	 this  boolean	style is true, the mailcap handler for
		     the context in question is run  using  the	 eval  builtin
		     instead  of  by  starting a new sh process.  This is more
		     efficient, but may not work in the occasional cases where
		     the mailcap handler uses strict POSIX syntax.

	      disown If	 this  boolean style is true, mailcap handlers started
		     in the background will be disowned, i.e. not  subject  to
		     job  control  within  the	parent	shell.	 Such handlers
		     nearly always produce their  own  windows,	 so  the  only
		     likely  harmful  side effect of setting the style is that
		     it becomes harder to kill jobs from within the shell.

	      execute-as-is
		     This style gives a list of patterns to be matched against
		     files  passed  for	 execution with a handler program.  If
		     the file matches the pattern, the entire command line  is
		     executed  in  its current form, with no handler.  This is
		     useful for files which might have suffixes	 but  nonethe‐
		     less  be  executable in their own right.  If the style is
		     not set, the pattern *(*) *(/) is used; hence  executable
		     files  are executed directly and not passed to a handler,
		     and the option AUTO_CD may be used to change to  directo‐
		     ries that happen to have MIME suffixes.

	      execute-never
		     This  style  is useful in combination with execute-as-is.
		     It is set to an array of patterns corresponding  to  full
		     paths  to	files  that  should  never  be treated as exe‐
		     cutable, even if the file	passed	to  the	 MIME  handler
		     matches  execute-as-is.   This is useful for file systems
		     that don't handle execute permission or that contain exe‐
		     cutables  from another operating system.  For example, if
		     /mnt/windows is a Windows mount, then

			    zstyle ':mime:*' execute-never '/mnt/windows/*'

		     will ensure that any files found in  that	area  will  be
		     executed  as  MIME types even if they are executable.  As
		     this example shows, the complete  file  name  is  matched
		     against  the  pattern,  regardless	 of  how  the file was
		     passed to the handler.  The file is resolved  to  a  full
		     path  using  the  :A modifier described in the subsection
		     Modifers in zshexpn(1).RE; this means that symbolic links
		     are  resolved  where  possible,  so that links into other
		     file systems behave in the correct fashion.

	      file-path
		     Used if the style find-file-in-path is true for the  same
		     context.	Set  to	 an array of directories that are used
		     for searching for the file to be handled; the default  is
		     the  command  path	 given	by the special parameter path.
		     The shell option PATH_DIRS is respected; if that is  set,
		     the appropriate path will be searched even if the name of
		     the file to be handled as it appears on the command  line
		     contains  a  `/'.	The full context is :mime:.suffix:, as
		     described for the style handler.

	      find-file-in-path
		     If set, allows files whose names do not contain  absolute
		     paths  to be searched for in the command path or the path
		     specified by the file-path style.	If  the	 file  is  not
		     found  in	the path, it is looked for locally (whether or
		     not the current directory is in the path); if it  is  not
		     found  locally,  the  handler  will abort unless the han‐
		     dle-nonexistent style is set.  Files found	 in  the  path
		     are tested as described for the style execute-as-is.  The
		     full context is  :mime:.suffix:,  as  described  for  the
		     style handler.

	      flags  Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for
		     the handler style, and the format is as for the flags  in
		     mailcap.

	      handle-nonexistent
		     By	 default, arguments that don't correspond to files are
		     not passed to the MIME handler in	order  to  prevent  it
		     from  intercepting commands found in the path that happen
		     to have suffixes.	This style may be set to an  array  of
		     extended  glob patterns for arguments that will be passed
		     to the handler even if they don't exist.  If  it  is  not
		     explicitly	 set  it  defaults  to	[[:alpha:]]#:/*	 which
		     allows URLs to be passed to the MIME handler even	though
		     they  don't exist in that format in the file system.  The
		     full context is  :mime:.suffix:,  as  described  for  the
		     style handler.

	      handler
		     Specifies	a handler for a suffix; the suffix is given by
		     the context as :mime:.suffix:, and the format of the han‐
		     dler  is exactly that in mailcap.	Note in particular the
		     `.' and trailing colon to distinguish  this  use  of  the
		     context.	This  overrides	 any  handler specified by the
		     mailcap files.  If the handler requires a	terminal,  the
		     flags style should be set to include the word needstermi‐
		     nal, or if the output is to be displayed through a	 pager
		     (but  not	if  the	 handler is itself a pager), it should
		     include copiousoutput.

	      mailcap
		     A	list  of  files	 in  the  format  of  ~/.mailcap   and
		     /etc/mailcap  to  be  read	 during	 setup,	 replacing the
		     default list which consists of those two files.  The con‐
		     text  is :mime:.  A + in the list will be replaced by the
		     default files.

	      mailcap-priorities
		     This style is used to resolve  multiple  mailcap  entries
		     for  the  same MIME type.	It consists of an array of the
		     following elements,  in  descending  order	 of  priority;
		     later  entries will be used if earlier entries are unable
		     to resolve the entries being compared.  If	 none  of  the
		     tests resolve the entries, the first entry encountered is
		     retained.

		     files  The order of files (entries in the mailcap	style)
			    read.   Earlier  files  are preferred.  (Note this
			    does not resolve entries in the same file.)

		     priority
			    The priority flag from  the	 mailcap  entry.   The
			    priority  is  an  integer  from  0	to  9 with the
			    default value being 5.

		     flags  The test given by the mailcap-prio-flags option is
			    used to resolve entries.

		     place  Later  entries  are	 preferred; as the entries are
			    strictly ordered, this test always succeeds.

		     Note that as this style is handled during initialisation,
		     the  context  is always :mime:, with no discrimination by
		     suffix.

	      mailcap-prio-flags
		     This style is used when the keyword flags is  encountered
		     in	 the list of tests specified by the mailcap-priorities
		     style.  It should be set to a list of patterns,  each  of
		     which  is tested against the flags specified in the mail‐
		     cap entry (in other words, the sets of assignments	 found
		     with some entries in the mailcap file).  Earlier patterns
		     in the list are preferred to later ones, and matched pat‐
		     terns are preferred to unmatched ones.

	      mime-types
		     A	list  of  files	 in  the  format  of ~/.mime.types and
		     /etc/mime.types to be read during	setup,	replacing  the
		     default list which consists of those two files.  The con‐
		     text is :mime:.  A + in the list will be replaced by  the
		     default files.

	      never-background
		     If	 this  boolean style is set, the handler for the given
		     context is always run in  the  foreground,	 even  if  the
		     flags  provided  in the mailcap entry suggest it need not
		     be (for example, it doesn't require a terminal).

	      pager  If set, will be used instead of $PAGER or more to	handle
		     suffixes  where  the copiousoutput flag is set.  The con‐
		     text is as for handler, i.e. :mime:.suffix: for  handling
		     a file with the given suffix.

	      Examples:

		     zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap
		     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
		     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal

	      When  zsh-mime-setup is subsequently run, it will look for mail‐
	      cap entries in the two files given.  Files of suffix  .txt  will
	      be  handled  by running `less file.txt'.	The flag needsterminal
	      is set to show that this program must run attached to  a	termi‐
	      nal.

	      As there are several steps to dispatching a command, the follow‐
	      ing should be checked if attempting to execute a file by	exten‐
	      sion .ext does not have the expected effect.

	      The  command  `alias  -s ext' should show `ps=zsh-mime-handler'.
	      If it shows something else, another  suffix  alias  was  already
	      installed and was not overwritten.  If it shows nothing, no han‐
	      dler was installed:  this is most likely because no handler  was
	      found in the .mime.types and mailcap combination for .ext files.
	      In  that	case,  appropriate  handling  should   be   added   to
	      ~/.mime.types and mailcap.

	      If  the extension is handled by zsh-mime-handler but the file is
	      not opened correctly, either the handler defined for the type is
	      incorrect,  or  the flags associated with it are in appropriate.
	      Running zsh-mime-setup -l will show the handler  and,  if	 there
	      are any, the flags.  A %s in the handler is replaced by the file
	      (suitably quoted if necessary).  Check that the handler  program
	      listed  lists  and can be run in the way shown.  Also check that
	      the flags needsterminal or copiousoutput are set if the  handler
	      needs to be run under a terminal; the second flag is used if the
	      output should be sent to a pager.	  An  example  of  a  suitable
	      mailcap entry for such a program is:

		     text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal

	      Running  `zsh-mime-handler  -l  command line' prints the command
	      line that would be executed, simplified to remove the effect  of
	      any  flags,  and	quoted so that the output can be run as a com‐
	      plete zsh command line.  This is used by the  completion	system
	      to  decide how to complete after a file handled by zsh-mime-set‐
	      up.  )

	      pick-web-browser
		     This function is separate from  the  two  MIME  functions
		     described above and can be assigned directly to a suffix:

			    autoload -U pick-web-browser
			    alias -s html=pick-web-browser

		     It	 is provided as an intelligent front end to dispatch a
		     web browser.  It may be run as either  a  function	 or  a
		     shell  script.   The status 255 is returned if no browser
		     could be started.

		     Various styles are available to customize the  choice  of
		     browsers:

		     browser-style
			    The	 value of the style is an array giving prefer‐
			    ences in decreasing order for the type of  browser
			    to use.  The values of elements may be

			    running
				   Use	a  GUI browser that is already running
				   when an X Window display is available.  The
				   browsers listed in the x-browsers style are
				   tried in order until one is	found;	if  it
				   is,	the  file  will	 be  displayed in that
				   browser, so the  user  may  need  to	 check
				   whether  it	has  appeared.	 If no running
				   browser  is	found,	one  is	 not  started.
				   Browsers other than Firefox, Opera and Kon‐
				   queror  are	assumed	 to   understand   the
				   Mozilla syntax for opening a URL remotely.

			    x	   Start  a  new  GUI browser when an X Window
				   display  is	available.   Search  for   the
				   availability	 of one of the browsers listed
				   in the x-browsers style and start the first
				   one that is found.  No check is made for an
				   already running browser.

			    tty	   Start a terminal-based browser.  Search for
				   the	availability  of  one  of the browsers
				   listed in the tty-browsers style and	 start
				   the first one that is found.

			    If	the style is not set the default running x tty
			    is used.

		     x-browsers
			    An array in	 decreasing  order  of	preference  of
			    browsers  to  use  when running under the X Window
			    System.  The array consists of  the	 command  name
			    under which to start the browser.  They are looked
			    up in the context :mime: (which may be extended in
			    future,  so	 appending  `*'	 is recommended).  For
			    example,

				   zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror firefox

			    specifies that pick-web-browser should first  look
			    for	 a  running  instance  of  Opera, Konqueror or
			    Firefox, in that order, and if it  fails  to  find
			    any should attempt to start Opera.	The default is
			    firefox mozilla netscape opera konqueror.

		     tty-browsers
			    An array similar to	 x-browsers,  except  that  it
			    gives  browsers to use when no X Window display is
			    available.	The default is elinks links lynx.

		     command
			    If it is set this style is used to pick  the  com‐
			    mand  used to open a page for a browser.  The con‐
			    text is :mime:browser:new:$browser: to start a new
			    browser or :mime:browser:running:$browser: to open
			    a URL in a browser already running on the  current
			    X  display, where $browser is the value matched in
			    the x-browsers or tty-browsers style.  The	escape
			    sequence  %b in the style's value will be replaced
			    by the browser, while %u will be replaced  by  the
			    URL.  If the style is not set, the default for all
			    new instances is  equivalent  to  %b  %u  and  the
			    defaults for using running browsers are equivalent
			    to the values kfmclient openURL %u for  Konqueror,
			    firefox -new-tab %u for Firefox, opera -newpage %u
			    for Opera, and %b -remote  "openUrl(%u)"  for  all
			    others.

MATHEMATICAL FUNCTIONS
       zcalc [ -ef ] [ expression ... ]
	      A reasonably powerful calculator based on zsh's arithmetic eval‐
	      uation facility.	The syntax is similar to that of  formulae  in
	      most  programming languages; see the section `Arithmetic Evalua‐
	      tion' in	zshmisc(1)  for	 details.   The	 mathematical  library
	      zsh/mathfunc  will be loaded if it is available; see the section
	      `The zsh/mathfunc Module' in  zshmodules(1).   The  mathematical
	      functions correspond to the raw system libraries, so trigonomet‐
	      ric functions are evaluated using radians, and so on.

	      Each line typed is evaluated as an expression.  The prompt shows
	      a	 number, which corresponds to a positional parameter where the
	      result of that calculation is stored.  For example,  the	result
	      of the calculation on the line preceded by `4> ' is available as
	      $4.  The last value calculated is available as ans.   Full  com‐
	      mand  line  editing,  including the history of previous calcula‐
	      tions,  is  available;  the  history  is	saved  in   the	  file
	      ~/.zcalc_history.	  To  exit, enter a blank line or type `:q' on
	      its own (`q' is allowed for historical compatibility).

	      A line ending with a single backslash is	treated	 in  the  same
	      fashion  as  it  is  in  command line editing:  the backslash is
	      removed, the function prompts for more input (the prompt is pre‐
	      ceded  by	 `...'	to  indicate this), and the lines are combined
	      into one to get the final result.	 In addition, if the input  so
	      far  contains more open than close parentheses zcalc will prompt
	      for more input.

	      If arguments are given to zcalc on start up, they	 are  used  to
	      prime  the first few positional parameters.  A visual indication
	      of this is given when the calculator starts.

	      The constants PI (3.14159...) and E (2.71828...)	are  provided.
	      Parameter	 assignment  is possible, but note that all parameters
	      will be put into the global namespace.

	      The output  base	can  be	 initialised  by  passing  the	option
	      `-#base',	 for  example  `zcalc  -#16'  (the  `#' may have to be
	      quoted, depending on the globbing options set).

	      If the option `-e' is set, the function runs  non-interactively:
	      the  arguments  are treated as expressions to be evaluated as if
	      entered interactively line by line.

	      If the option `-f' is set, all numbers are treated  as  floating
	      point,  hence for example the expression `3/4' evaluates to 0.75
	      rather than 0.  Options must appear in separate words.

	      The prompt is configurable via the parameter ZCALCPROMPT,	 which
	      undergoes	 standard  prompt expansion.  The index of the current
	      entry is stored locally in the first element of the array psvar,
	      which  can  be referred to in ZCALCPROMPT as `%1v'.  The default
	      prompt is `%1v> '.

	      A few special commands are available; these are introduced by  a
	      colon.  For backward compatibility, the colon may be omitted for
	      certain commands.	 Completion is available if compinit has  been
	      run.

	      The  output  precision  may be specified within zcalc by special
	      commands familiar from many calculators.
	      :norm  The default output format.	 It corresponds to the	printf
		     %g	 specification.	 Typically this shows six decimal dig‐
		     its.

	      :sci digits
		     Scientific notation, corresponding to the printf %g  out‐
		     put format with the precision given by digits.  This pro‐
		     duces either fixed point or exponential notation  depend‐
		     ing on the value output.

	      :fix digits
		     Fixed point notation, corresponding to the printf %f out‐
		     put format with the precision given by digits.

	      :eng digits
		     Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf %E out‐
		     put format with the precision given by digits.

	      :raw   Raw  output:  this is the default form of the output from
		     a math evaluation.	 This may show more precision than the
		     number actually possesses.

	      Other special commands:
	      :!line...
		     Execute  line...  as  a  normal shell command line.  Note
		     that it is executed in the context of the function,  i.e.
		     with local variables.  Space is optional after :!.

	      :local arg ...
		     Declare  variables local to the function.	Note that cer‐
		     tain variables are used by the function for its own  pur‐
		     poses.   Other  variables may be used, too, but they will
		     be taken from or put into the global scope.

	      :function name [ body ]
		     Define a mathematical function or (with no	 body)	delete
		     it.   :function may be abbreviated to :func or simply :f.
		     The name may contain the same characters as a shell func‐
		     tion  name.   The function is defined using zmathfuncdef,
		     see below.

		     Note that zcalc takes care of  all	 quoting.   Hence  for
		     example:

			    :f cube $1 * $1 * $1

		     defines a function to cube the sole argument.

	      [#base]
		     This  is  not  a  special	command, rather part of normal
		     arithmetic syntax; however, when this form appears	 on  a
		     line  by  itself the default output radix is set to base.
		     Use, for example, `[#16]' to display  hexadecimal	output
		     preceded  by  an indication of the base, or `[##16]' just
		     to display the raw number in the given base.  Bases them‐
		     selves  are  always  specified in decimal. `[#]' restores
		     the normal output format.	Note that  setting  an	output
		     base  suppresses  floating	 point	output;	 use  `[#]' to
		     return to normal operation.

	      See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.

       zmathfuncdef [ mathfunc [ body ] ]
	      A convenient front end to functions -M.

	      With two arguments, define a mathematical function  named	 math‐
	      func  which  can	be  used in any form of arithmetic evaluation.
	      body is a mathematical expression to implement the function.  It
	      may  contain  references	to position parameters $1, $2, ...  to
	      refer to mandatory parameters and ${1:-defvalue} ...   to	 refer
	      to  optional  parameters.	  Note that the forms must be strictly
	      adhered to for the function to calculate the correct  number  of
	      arguments.  The implementation is held in a shell function named
	      zsh_math_func_mathfunc; usually the user will not need to	 refer
	      to  the  shell  function directly.  Any existing function of the
	      same name is silently replaced.

	      With one argument, remove the mathematical function mathfunc  as
	      well as the shell function implementation.

	      With  no	arguments, list all mathfunc functions in a form suit‐
	      able for restoring the definition.  The functions have not  nec‐
	      essarily been defined by zmathfuncdef.

USER CONFIGURATION FUNCTIONS
       The  zsh/newuser	 module	 comes	with  a function to aid in configuring
       shell options for new users.  If the module is installed, this function
       can  also be run by hand.  It is available even if the module's default
       behaviour, namely running the function for a new user logging in	 with‐
       out startup files, is inhibited.

       zsh-newuser-install [ -f ]
	      The  function  presents  the  user with various options for cus‐
	      tomizing their initialization scripts.  Currently only  ~/.zshrc
	      is  handled.   $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc  is used instead if the parameter
	      ZDOTDIR is set; this provides a way for the user to configure  a
	      file without altering an existing .zshrc.

	      By default the function exits immediately if it finds any of the
	      files .zshenv, .zprofile, .zshrc, or .zlogin in the  appropriate
	      directory.   The	option	-f  is	required in order to force the
	      function to continue.  Note  this	 may  happen  even  if	.zshrc
	      itself does not exist.

	      As  currently  configured, the function will exit immediately if
	      the user has root privileges; this behaviour cannot be  overrid‐
	      den.

	      Once  activated,	the  function's	 behaviour  is	supposed to be
	      self-explanatory.	 Menus are present allowing the user to	 alter
	      the  value  of options and parameters.  Suggestions for improve‐
	      ments are always welcome.

	      When the script exits, the user is given the opportunity to save
	      the  new	file  or  not; changes are not irreversible until this
	      point.  However, the script is careful to	 restrict  changes  to
	      the file only to a group marked by the lines `# Lines configured
	      by zsh-newuser-install'  and  `#	End  of	 lines	configured  by
	      zsh-newuser-install'.  In addition, the old version of .zshrc is
	      saved to a file with the suffix .zni appended.

	      If the function edits an existing .zshrc, it is up to  the  user
	      to  ensure that the changes made will take effect.  For example,
	      if control usually returns early from the	 existing  .zshrc  the
	      lines  will  not be executed; or a later initialization file may
	      override options or parameters, and so on.  The function	itself
	      does not attempt to detect any such conflicts.

OTHER FUNCTIONS
       There  are  a  large  number of helpful functions in the Functions/Misc
       directory of the zsh distribution.  Most are very  simple  and  do  not
       require documentation here, but a few are worthy of special mention.

   Descriptions
       colors This  function  initializes  several  associative	 arrays to map
	      color names to (and from) the ANSI standard eight-color terminal
	      codes.   These  are used by the prompt theme system (see above).
	      You seldom should need to run colors more than once.

	      The eight base colors are:  black,  red,	green,	yellow,	 blue,
	      magenta,	cyan,  and  white.   Each of these has codes for fore‐
	      ground and background.  In addition there	 are  eight  intensity
	      attributes:  bold,  faint,  standout, underline, blink, reverse,
	      and conceal.  Finally,  there  are  six  codes  used  to	negate
	      attributes:  none (reset all attributes to the defaults), normal
	      (neither bold nor faint), no-standout,  no-underline,  no-blink,
	      and no-reverse.

	      Some  terminals  do  not	support all combinations of colors and
	      intensities.

	      The associative arrays are:

	      color
	      colour Map all the color names to their integer codes, and inte‐
		     ger  codes	 to the color names.  The eight base names map
		     to the foreground color codes, as do names prefixed  with
		     `fg-', such as `fg-red'.  Names prefixed with `bg-', such
		     as `bg-blue', refer to the background codes.  The reverse
		     mapping  from  code  to  color yields base name for fore‐
		     ground codes and the bg- form for backgrounds.

		     Although it is a misnomer to call	them  `colors',	 these
		     arrays  also map the other fourteen attributes from names
		     to codes and codes to names.

	      fg
	      fg_bold
	      fg_no_bold
		     Map the eight basic color names to ANSI  terminal	escape
		     sequences	that  set  the	corresponding  foreground text
		     properties.  The fg sequences change  the	color  without
		     changing the eight intensity attributes.

	      bg
	      bg_bold
	      bg_no_bold
		     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape
		     sequences that set the corresponding  background  proper‐
		     ties.  The bg sequences change the color without changing
		     the eight intensity attributes.

	      In addition, the scalar parameters  reset_color  and  bold_color
	      are  set	to  the	 ANSI  terminal	 escapes  that	turn  off  all
	      attributes and turn on bold intensity, respectively.

       fned name
	      Same as zed -f.  This function does not appear in the  zsh  dis‐
	      tribution, but can be created by linking zed to the name fned in
	      some directory in your fpath.

       is-at-least needed [ present ]
	      Perform a greater-than-or-equal-to  comparison  of  two  strings
	      having  the format of a zsh version number; that is, a string of
	      numbers and text with segments separated by dots or dashes.   If
	      the  present string is not provided, $ZSH_VERSION is used.  Seg‐
	      ments are paired left-to-right in the two strings	 with  leading
	      non-number parts ignored.	 If one string has fewer segments than
	      the other, the missing segments are considered zero.

	      This is useful in startup files to set options and  other	 state
	      that are not available in all versions of zsh.

		     is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
		     is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
		     is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."

       nslookup [ arg ... ]
	      This  wrapper  function  for  the	 nslookup command requires the
	      zsh/zpty module (see zshmodules(1)).  It	behaves	 exactly  like
	      the  standard  nslookup  except  that  it	 provides customizable
	      prompts  (including  a  right-side  prompt)  and	completion  of
	      nslookup	commands,  host	 names,	 etc.  (if  you	 use the func‐
	      tion-based completion system).  Completion  styles  may  be  set
	      with the context prefix `:completion:nslookup'.

	      See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.

       regexp-replace var regexp replace
	      Use  regular  expressions to perform a global search and replace
	      operation on a variable.	If the	option	RE_MATCH_PCRE  is  not
	      set, POSIX extended regular expressions are used, else Perl-com‐
	      patible regular expressions  (this  requires  the	 shell	to  be
	      linked against the pcre library).

	      var  is  the  name  of  the variable containing the string to be
	      matched.	The variable will be modified directly	by  the	 func‐
	      tion.   The  variables  MATCH, MBEGIN, MEND, match, mbegin, mend
	      should be avoided as these are used by  the  regular  expression
	      code.

	      regexp is the regular expression to match against the string.

	      replace  is  the	replacement text.  This can contain parameter,
	      command and arithmetic expressions which will be	replaced:   in
	      particular,  a  reference to $MATCH will be replaced by the text
	      matched by the pattern.

	      The return status is 0 if at least one match was performed, else
	      1.

       run-help cmd
	      This function is designed to be invoked by the run-help ZLE wid‐
	      get, in place of the  default  alias.   See  `Accessing  On-Line
	      Help' above for setup instructions.

	      In  the  discussion which follows, if cmd is a file system path,
	      it is first reduced to its rightmost component (the file name).

	      Help is first sought by looking for a  file  named  cmd  in  the
	      directory	 named by the HELPDIR parameter.  If no file is found,
	      an assistant function, alias, or command named  run-help-cmd  is
	      sought.	If  found,  the assistant is executed with the rest of
	      the current command line (everything after the command name cmd)
	      as its arguments.	 When neither file nor assistant is found, the
	      external command `man cmd' is run.

	      An example assistant for the "ssh" command:

		     run-help-ssh() {
			 emulate -LR zsh
			 local -a args
			 # Delete the "-l username" option
			 zparseopts -D -E -a args l:
			 # Delete other options, leaving: host command
			 args=(${@:#-*})
			 if [[ ${#args} -lt 2 ]]; then
			     man ssh
			 else
			     run-help $args[2]
			 fi
		     }

	      Several of these assistants are provided in  the	Functions/Misc
	      directory.   These  must	be autoloaded, or placed as executable
	      scripts in your search path, in order to be found	 and  used  by
	      run-help.

	      run-help-git
	      run-help-svk
	      run-help-svn
		     Assistant functions for the git, svk, and svn commands.

       tetris Zsh  was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs, because
	      it lacked a Tetris game.	This function was  written  to	refute
	      this vicious slander.

	      This function must be used as a ZLE widget:

		     autoload -U tetris
		     zle -N tetris
		     bindkey keys tetris

	      To  start	 a game, execute the widget by typing the keys.	 What‐
	      ever command line you were editing disappears  temporarily,  and
	      your  keymap  is also temporarily replaced by the Tetris control
	      keys.  The previous editor state is restored when you  quit  the
	      game (by pressing `q') or when you lose.

	      If  you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of the
	      tetris widget will continue where you left off.  If you lost, it
	      will start a new game.

       zargs [ option ... -- ] [ input ... ] [ -- command [ arg ... ] ]
	      This  function  has  a similar purpose to GNU xargs.  Instead of
	      reading lines of arguments from the  standard  input,  it	 takes
	      them  from  the command line.  This is useful because zsh, espe‐
	      cially with recursive glob operators, often can construct a com‐
	      mand  line  for  a  shell	 function  that	 is longer than can be
	      accepted by an external command.

	      The option list represents options of the zargs command  itself,
	      which  are  the  same  as those of xargs.	 The input list is the
	      collection of strings (often file names) that become  the	 argu‐
	      ments  of the command, analogous to the standard input of xargs.
	      Finally, the arg	list  consists	of  those  arguments  (usually
	      options)	that are passed to the command each time it runs.  The
	      arg list precedes the elements from the input list in each  run.
	      If no command is provided, then no arg list may be provided, and
	      in that event the default command is `print' with arguments  `-r
	      --'.

	      For  example, to get a long ls listing of all plain files in the
	      current directory or its subdirectories:

		     autoload -U zargs
		     zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -l

	      Note that `--' is used both to mark the end of the  option  list
	      and  to  mark the end of the input list, so it must appear twice
	      whenever the input list may be empty.  If there is guaranteed to
	      be  at least one input and the first input does not begin with a
	      `-', then the first `--' may be omitted.

	      In the event that the string `--' is or may be an input, the  -e
	      option  may  be  used  to change the end-of-inputs marker.  Note
	      that this does not change the end-of-options marker.  For	 exam‐
	      ple, to use `..' as the marker:

		     zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -l

	      This  is a good choice in that example because no plain file can
	      be named `..', but the best end-marker depends  on  the  circum‐
	      stances.

	      The  options  -i,	 -I, -l, -L, and -n differ slightly from their
	      usage in xargs.  There are no input lines for zargs to count, so
	      -l and -L count through the input list, and -n counts the number
	      of arguments passed to each execution of command, including  any
	      arg  list.   Also, any time -i or -I is used, each input is pro‐
	      cessed separately as if by `-L 1'.

	      For details of the other zargs options, see xargs(1)  (but  note
	      the difference in function between zargs and xargs) or run zargs
	      with the --help option.

       zed [ -f ] name
       zed -b This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.

	      Only one name argument is allowed.  If the -f option  is	given,
	      the  name	 is taken to be that of a function; if the function is
	      marked for autoloading, zed searches for it  in  the  fpath  and
	      loads  it.   Note	 that  functions edited this way are installed
	      into the current shell, but not written  back  to	 the  autoload
	      file.

	      Without  -f,  name  is  the path name of the file to edit, which
	      need not exist; it is created on write, if necessary.

	      While editing, the function sets the main keymap to zed and  the
	      vi  command  keymap to zed-vicmd.	 These will be copied from the
	      existing main and vicmd keymaps if they do not exist  the	 first
	      time  zed is run.	 They can be used to provide special key bind‐
	      ings used only in zed.

	      If it creates the keymap, zed rebinds the return key to insert a
	      line  break and `^X^W' to accept the edit in the zed keymap, and
	      binds `ZZ' to accept the edit in the zed-vicmd keymap.

	      The bindings alone can be installed by running `zed  -b'.	  This
	      is  suitable  for	 putting  into	a startup file.	 Note that, if
	      rerun, this  will	 overwrite  the	 existing  zed	and  zed-vicmd
	      keymaps.

	      Completion  is available, and styles may be set with the context
	      prefix `:completion:zed'.

	      A zle widget zed-set-file-name is available.  This can be called
	      by  name	from  within  zed using `\ex zed-set-file-name' (note,
	      however, that because of zed's rebindings you will have to  type
	      ^j  at  the end instead of the return key), or can be bound to a
	      key in either of the zed or zed-vicmd keymaps after `zed -b' has
	      been  run.  When the widget is called, it prompts for a new name
	      for the file being edited.  When zed  exits  the	file  will  be
	      written  under  that  name  and  the  original file will be left
	      alone.  The widget has no effect with `zed -f'.

	      While zed-set-file-name is running, zed uses the keymap zed-nor‐
	      mal-keymap,  which  is  linked from the main keymap in effect at
	      the time zed initialised its bindings.  (This  is	 to  make  the
	      return  key  operate  normally.)	The result is that if the main
	      keymap has been changed, the widget won't notice.	 This is not a
	      concern for most users.

       zcp [ -finqQvwW ] srcpat dest
       zln [ -finqQsvwW ] srcpat dest
	      Same as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively.	These functions do not
	      appear in the zsh distribution, but can be  created  by  linking
	      zmv to the names zcp and zln in some directory in your fpath.

       zkbd   See `Keyboard Definition' above.

       zmv  [  -finqQsvwW  ] [ -C | -L | -M | -[pP] program ] [ -o optstring ]
       srcpat dest
	      Move (usually, rename) files matching the pattern srcpat to cor‐
	      responding  files	 having names of the form given by dest, where
	      srcpat contains parentheses surrounding patterns which  will  be
	      replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest.	For example,

		     zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'

	      renames	 `foo.lis'   to	  `foo.txt',   `my.old.stuff.lis'   to
	      `my.old.stuff.txt', and so on.

	      The pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern.   Any
	      file  whose  name	 is  not changed by the substitution is simply
	      ignored.	Any error (a substitution resulted in an empty string,
	      two  substitutions  gave the same result, the destination was an
	      existing regular file and -f was not given)  causes  the	entire
	      function to abort without doing anything.

	      Options:

	      -f     Force  overwriting	 of  destination files.	 Not currently
		     passed down to the mv/cp/ln command due  to  vagaries  of
		     implementations (but you can use -o-f to do that).
	      -i     Interactive:  show	 each  line to be executed and ask the
		     user whether to execute it.  `Y' or `y' will execute  it,
		     anything  else  will skip it.  Note that you just need to
		     type one character.
	      -n     No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
	      -q     Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now assumed by default, so
		     this has no effect.
	      -Q     Force bare glob qualifiers on.  Don't turn this on unless
		     you are actually using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
	      -s     Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.
	      -v     Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
	      -w     Pick out wildcard parts  of  the  pattern,	 as  described
		     above,  and  implicitly  add parentheses for referring to
		     them.
	      -W     Just like -w, with the addition of turning	 wildcards  in
		     the replacement pattern into sequential ${1} .. ${N} ref‐
		     erences.
	      -C
	      -L
	      -M     Force cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the  name
		     of the function.
	      -p program
		     Call  program instead of cp, ln or mv.  Whatever it does,
		     it should at least understand the form `program  --  old‐
		     name  newname'  where  oldname  and newname are filenames
		     generated by zmv.	program will be split into  words,  so
		     might  be e.g. the name of an archive tool plus a copy or
		     rename subcommand.
	      -P program
		     As -p program, except that program does not accept a fol‐
		     lowing  --	 to indicate the end of options.  In this case
		     filenames must already be in a sane form for the  program
		     in question.
	      -o optstring
		     The  optstring is split into words and passed down verba‐
		     tim to the cp, ln or mv command  called  to  perform  the
		     work.  It should probably begin with a `-'.

	      Further examples:

		     zmv -v '(* *)' '${1// /_}'

	      For any file in the current directory with at least one space in
	      the name, replace every space by an underscore and  display  the
	      commands executed.

	      For more complete examples and other implementation details, see
	      the zmv source file, usually located in one of  the  directories
	      named in your fpath, or in Functions/Misc/zmv in the zsh distri‐
	      bution.

       zrecompile
	      See `Recompiling Functions' above.

       zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]
	      This makes defining styles a bit simpler by using a  single  `+'
	      as  a  special token that allows you to append a context name to
	      the previously used context name.	 Like this:

		     zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \
			   + ':baz'	style2 value2 \
			   + ':frob'	style3 value3

	      This defines `style1' with `value1' for the context :foo:bar  as
	      usual,  but  it also defines `style2' with `value2' for the con‐
	      text :foo:bar:baz and `style3' with `value3' for	:foo:bar:frob.
	      Any  subcontext may be the empty string to re-use the first con‐
	      text unchanged.

   Styles
       insert-tab
	      The zed function sets this style in context  `:completion:zed:*'
	      to  turn	off completion when TAB is typed at the beginning of a
	      line.  You may override this by setting your own value for  this
	      context and style.

       pager  The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this	style  in  the context
	      `:nslookup' to determine the program used to display output that
	      does not fit on a single screen.

       prompt
       rprompt
	      The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this	style  in  the context
	      `:nslookup' to set the prompt and the right-side prompt, respec‐
	      tively.	The  usual  expansions for the PS1 and RPS1 parameters
	      may be used (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).

ZSHALL(1)							     ZSHALL(1)

FILES
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv
       $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout
       ${TMPPREFIX}*   (default is /tmp/zsh*)
       /etc/zshenv
       /etc/zprofile
       /etc/zshrc
       /etc/zlogin
       /etc/zlogout    (installation-specific - /etc is the default)

SEE ALSO
       sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)

       IEEE Standard for information Technology -  Portable  Operating	System
       Interface  (POSIX)  - Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN
       1-55937-255-9.

zsh 5.0.5			January 5, 2014			     ZSHALL(1)
[top]

List of man pages available for Alpinelinux

Copyright (c) for man pages and the logo by the respective OS vendor.

For those who want to learn more, the polarhome community provides shell access and support.

[legal] [privacy] [GNU] [policy] [cookies] [netiquette] [sponsors] [FAQ]
Tweet
Polarhome, production since 1999.
Member of Polarhome portal.
Based on Fawad Halim's script.
....................................................................
Vote for polarhome
Free Shell Accounts :: the biggest list on the net